Adobe Dreamweaver CC (2015) Help 2015 En

User Manual: adobe Dreamweaver - CC (2015) - Help Free User Guide for Adobe Dreamweaver Software, Manual

Open the PDF directly: View PDF PDF.
Page Count: 700 [warning: Documents this large are best viewed by clicking the View PDF Link!]

Adobe® Dreamweaver® CC Help
Last updated 6/3/2015
Legal notices
Legal notices
For legal notices, see http://help.adobe.com/en_US/legalnotices/index.html.
iii
Last updated 6/3/2015
Contents
Chapter 1: What's new
New features summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1
Chapter 2: Workspace and workflow
Dreamweaver workflow and workspace . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
Customizing the Dreamweaver workspace . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Working in the Document window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
Using toolbars, inspectors, and context menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
Use the Insert panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
CSS Designer panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
DOM panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Search files based on filename or content | Mac OS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Zoom in and out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
Keyboard shortcuts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
Optimizing the workspace for visual development . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
CEF integration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Chapter 3: Site management
About Dreamweaver sites . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
About dynamic sites . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Set up a local version of your site . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Connect to a remote server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Manage Sites dialog box options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Set up a testing server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Version Control and Advanced settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Import and export Dreamweaver site settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
Edit an existing remote website . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Set site preferences for transferring files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Chapter 4: File management
Creating and opening documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Managing files and folders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
Getting and putting files to and from your server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Checking in and checking out files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
Synchronizing files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Comparing files for differences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Cloaking files and folders in your Dreamweaver site . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Storing file information in Design Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
Testing your Dreamweaver site . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Chapter 5: Layout and design
Using visual aids for layout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
Using Frames . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
Laying out pages with CSS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
iv
DREAMWEAVER
Contents
Last updated 6/3/2015
Working with Bootstrap files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
Visual Media Queries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
Responsive design using fluid grid layouts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
Presenting content with tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Using jQuery UI widgets in Dreamweaver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
Using jQuery effects in Dreamweaver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
Colors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
Chapter 6: CSS
Understanding Cascading Style Sheets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186
CSS Designer panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Set CSS Styles preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
Create a CSS rule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
Set CSS properties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
Edit a CSS rule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207
Add a property to a CSS rule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
Apply, remove, or rename CSS class styles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
Move/export CSS rules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
Convert inline CSS to a CSS rule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211
Link to an external CSS style sheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211
Edit a CSS style sheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
Format CSS code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
Disable/Enable CSS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
Inspect CSS in Live view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
Check for cross-browser CSS rendering issues . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215
Use Design-Time style sheets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
Working with div tags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
Apply gradients to background . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
CSS3 transition effects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
Use Dreamweaver sample style sheets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235
The CSS Styles panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235
Chapter 7: Page content and assets
Set page properties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
Set CSS link properties for an entire page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241
Set CSS heading properties for an entire page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242
Set title and encoding properties for a page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242
Use a tracing image to design apage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
Understanding document encoding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
Select and view elements in the Document window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
Zoom in and out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Set download time and size preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247
Working with text . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247
Arabic and Hebrew text . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255
Edit in Live View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256
DOM panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266
Set text properties in the Property inspector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
v
DREAMWEAVER
Contents
Last updated 6/3/2015
Spell check a web page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272
Import tabular data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273
Import Microsoft Office documents (Windows only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273
Create a link to a Word or Excel document . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274
Use HTML Formatting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274
Use horizontal rules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
Modify font combinations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
Add Edge Web Fonts to the Font list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278
Insert dates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
Working with assets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
Creating and managing a list of favorite assets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
Insert and edit images . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287
Adding media objects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 297
Adding video . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304
Insert HTML5 video . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309
Inserting SWF files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 311
Adding web widgets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314
Adding Sound . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314
Insert HTML5 audio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316
Automating tasks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317
About assets and libraries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322
Working with library items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 324
Working with Photoshop and Dreamweaver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 327
Chapter 8: Linking and navigation
About linking and navigation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 334
Linking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336
Jump menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 343
Navigation bars . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 344
Image maps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345
Troubleshooting links . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 346
Chapter 9: Previewing
Preview and inspect web pages on multiple devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349
Previewing pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 352
Chapter 10: Coding
General information about coding in Dreamweaver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 357
Setting up your coding environment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 361
Setting coding preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 363
Writing and editing code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 370
Collapsing code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 387
Lint code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 389
Optimize code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 391
Editing code in Design view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 395
Working with head content for pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 401
Working with server-side includes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 405
vi
DREAMWEAVER
Contents
Last updated 6/3/2015
Managing tag libraries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 407
Importing custom tags into Dreamweaver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 410
Chapter 11: Javascript
Using JavaScript behaviors (general instructions) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 412
Applying built-in JavaScript behaviors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 415
Chapter 12: Cross-product
Add-Ons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 426
Cross-application integration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 429
Working with Fireworks and Dreamweaver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 430
Working with Flash and Dreamweaver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 435
Working with Adobe Bridgeand Dreamweaver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 436
Working with Device Central and Dreamweaver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 438
Working with ConnectNow and Dreamweaver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 439
AIR Extension for Dreamweaver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 440
Using Dreamweaver with Adobe Online services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 444
Extract in Dreamweaver CC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 451
Dreamweaver-Business Catalyst integration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 463
Import Microsoft Office documents (Windows only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 465
Chapter 13: Templates
About Dreamweaver templates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 467
Recognizing templates and template-based documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 471
Creating a Dreamweaver template . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 474
Creating editable regions in templates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 477
Creating repeating regions in templates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 478
Using optional regions in templates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 481
Defining editable tag attributes in templates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 483
Creating a nested template . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 484
Editing, updating, and deleting templates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 487
Exporting and importing template content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 491
Applying or removing a template from an existing document . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 492
Editing content in a template-based document . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 493
Template syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 496
Setting authoring preferences for templates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 497
Chapter 14: Mobile and multiscreen
Creating media queries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 499
Change page orientation for mobile devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 501
Creating web applications for mobile devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 501
Chapter 15: XML
About XML and XSLT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 505
Performing XSL transformationson the server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 511
Performing XSL transformationson the client . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 528
Missing character entities for XSLT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 529
vii
DREAMWEAVER
Contents
Last updated 6/3/2015
Chapter 16: Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Understanding web applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 532
Set up your computer for application development . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 539
Database connections for ColdFusion developers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 544
Database connections for ASP developers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 545
Database connections for PHP developers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 552
Troubleshooting database connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 554
Removing connection scripts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 558
Designing dynamic pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 559
Dynamic content sources overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 561
Defining sources of dynamic content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 565
Adding dynamic content to pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 579
Changing dynamic content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 583
Displaying database records . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 584
Viewing live data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 593
Adding custom server behaviors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 594
About building forms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 604
Using forms to collect information from users . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 604
Building ColdFusion forms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 608
Creating web forms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 619
Enhanced HTML5 support for form elements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 632
Chapter 17: Building applications visually
Building master and detail pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 635
Building search and results pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 642
Building a record insert page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 647
Building an update record page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 650
Building a delete record page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 655
Building pages with advanced data manipulation objects (ColdFusion, ASP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 662
Building a registration page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 666
Building a login page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 668
Building a page that only authorized users can access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 670
Securing a folder in your application (ColdFusion) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 673
Using ColdFusion components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 674
Chapter 18: Accessibility
Dreamweaver and accessibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 680
Chapter 19: Dreamweaver and Creative Cloud
Synchronizing Dreamweaver settings with Creative Cloud . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 684
Chapter 20: System Requirements
System requirements for Dreamweaver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 693
1
Last updated 6/3/2015
Chapter 1: What's new
New features summary
The 2015 release of Dreamweaver CC focuses on responsive design, improvements to code editing features, preview of
web pages on devices, and batch extract of web-optimized images with multiple resolutions from Photoshop comps.
Integration with the Bootstrap framework helps you build mobile-first, responsive websites. Visual Media Queries
further complement the responsive web designing experience by enabling you to visualize and modify your design at
various breakpoints.
This release also includes several enhancements to editing features in Live view and CSS Designer. This article
introduces these new features and enhancements, and provides links to resources for more help and learning.
What's new
2
What's new
Last updated 6/3/2015
What's changed
Device preview
Visual Media Queries
Linting support
Emmet support
Preview in Code View
New code snippets
Bootstrap integration
New menus in Live view
Support for Tables in Live View
Support for jQuery UI elements in Live View
DOM panel
SVG code hints in HTML documents
Technology previews
Code folding
Extract improvements
Enhancements to Live view editing
Coding toolbar changes
CSS Designer improvements
Testing server - workflow improvements
Changes to Business Catalyst workflow
Other changes
Device preview
Dreamweaver now lets you test your production-ready web pages simultaneously on multiple devices. You can see how
your web page reflows in various form factors and also test interactive features on your pages. All these without having
to install any mobile app or having to physically connect the devices to your desktop! Simply scan the auto generated
QR code with your devices and preview your web pages on the devices.
Live inspect, when triggered on desktop, reflects on all connected devices and helps you inspect various elements and
tweak the design as required.
For detailed information, see Preview and inspect web pages on multiple devices .
Visual Media Queries
Visual Media Query bars are a visual representation of the media queries present in a page. These bars help you visualize
your web page at different breakpoints and how different components of your web page reflow in different viewports.
While you view your page in different viewports, you can make design changes that are specific to a viewport without
affecting the page design in other viewports.
3
What's new
Last updated 6/3/2015
Visual Media Query consists of three bars as horizontal rows, each representing a category of media query:
Green: Media queries with max-width conditions
Blue : Media queries with both min-width and max-width conditions
Purple : Media queries with min-width conditions
For more information, see Visual Media Queries .
Support for linting code
With this new version of Dreamweaver, you can now debug your code for common errors using linting. Linting is the
process of analyzing code to flag potential errors or suspicious usage of code. Dreamweaver can lint HTML, CSS, and
JavaScript files when they are loaded, saved, or edited. The errors and warnings are then listed in the new Output panel.
For more information, see Lint code .
Support for Emmet
Are you an avid developer who types several lines of code in Dreamweaver? Save your time by using Emmet
abbreviations to code. Easy to remember and type, these abbeviations expand into full-fledged code in Code View when
you press the Tab key.
For detailed information, see Insert code using Emmet .
4
What's new
Last updated 6/3/2015
Preview in Code view
If you are working in Split view, you can see any changes to images or colors instantly in Live or Design view. But, when
you prefer to work only in Code view, images are just filenames, which tend to be unintuitive most often. Colors (unless
predefined colors are used), too, are only a set of obscure set of numbers. With this version of Dreamweaver, you can
quickly preview images and colors right within Code view. This feature helps you make a visual connection between
the image filenames and the color formats with the actual image or color they represent. As a result, you can take design
decisions faster and cut down the development time significantly.
For more information, see Preview images and colors in Code view .
The Code view also displays an error preview. The line number of the erroneous code is highlighted in red. When you
hover your mouse over the number, a brief description of the error is displayed.
Note: Only the first error in the line is displayed. If the line contains only a warning, the description of the warning is
displayed. If the line contains a warning and an error, only the error description is displayed.
New code snippets
Snippets are portions of code that you can reuse repeatedly in your projects. This release of Dreamweaver provides new
and updated code snippets:
Boostrap_Snippets
CSS_Animation_And_Transitions
CSS_Effects
CSS_Snippets
5
What's new
Last updated 6/3/2015
HTML_Snippets
JavaScript Snippets (updated)
PHP_Snippets
Preprocessor_Snippets
Responsive_Design_Snippets
For information on using code snippets, see Work with code snippets.
Bootstrap integration
Bootstrap is the most popular, free, HTML, CSS, and JavaScript framework for developing responsive, mobile-first
websites. The framework includes responsive CSS and HTML templates for buttons, tables, navigation, image
carousels, and other elements that you can use on your web page. A few optional JavaScript plug-ins too are available,
which enable developers with even basic coding knowledge to develop great responsive websites.
Dreamweaver lets you create Bootstrap documents and also edit existing web pages created using Bootstrap. You can
begin designing your Bootstrap website using one of the Bootstrap starter templates that you can choose from the New
Doc ument dialog box (Starter Templates > Bootstrap Templates).
Bootstrap-Agency
Bootstrap-eCommerce
Bootstrap-Portfolio
Bootstrap-Product
Bootstrap-Real Estate
Bootstrap-Resume
You can also create a custom Bootstrap document from the New Document dialog box (New Document > Bootstrap).
Then, build the website brick-by-brick using Bootstrap components such as accordions and carousels using the Insert
panel in Dreamweaver. Or, if you have Photoshop comps, use Extract to bring in images, fonts, styles, text, and more
into your Bootstrap document.
6
What's new
Last updated 6/3/2015
Whether it is a fully designed Bootstrap file or a work-in-progress design, you can edit them in Dreamweaver to not
only edit code, but also use visual editing features such as Live View editing, visual CSS designer, Visual Media Queries,
and Extract to make design changes.
Note: You can open websites created using only Bootstrap framework version 3 and later in Dreamweaver.
For detailed information, see Working with Bootstrap files .
Support for editing tables in Live view
You can edit tables in Live view easily and quickly using one or a combination of the following options:
Formatting options in Element Display
Modify > Table menu
Note: Modify menu is now enabled in Live view.
For more information, see Resize a tableand Format tables and cells.
New menus in Live view
The editing capabilites in Live view have now become better with the following menus available in Live view:
Modify
7
What's new
Last updated 6/3/2015
Format
Commands
Site
'Paste Special' option in Edit and context menu
Support for jQuery UI elements in Live view
Using the Insert panel, you can now directly insert jQuery widgets in Live view. Drag the required element from the
Insert panel on to Live view and hold your mouse to use one of the following features to insert:
Live Guides: These guides appear as you hover over the elements in Live view after dragging the required element
from the Insert panel. Using Live Guides, you can insert elements at the top or bottom, or to the left or right of an
element in focus.
DOM icon: The DOM icon appears when you pause for a brief while when the Live Guides appear. Click the icon
to view the DOM structure in a pop-up and drop the element at a precise location in the document structure.
Position Assist: Position Assist helps you position the element before, after, or nest within the element in focus (in
Live view).
Note: The features above are displayed based on the element you choose to insert.
For more information, see Insert elements directly in Live view .
DOM panel
Element Quick View is now replaced with the DOM panel (Windows > DOM). The DOM panel provides all the
functionalities that Element Quick View provided and more. This panel is available in all workspaces and is persistent,
which means, you can open two documents, open, and access their DOM panels simultaneously.
Using the DOM panel, you can:
Drag elements from the Insert panel to insert them precisely in the document structure.
Copy, paste, duplicate, move, or delete structural elements in the document.
View any element on the page in context with the document structure - the element in focus is highlighted in the
DOM panel.
For detailed information on using the DOM panel and editing the HTML structure using the panel, see DOM panel.
8
What's new
Last updated 6/3/2015
SVG code hints in HTML documents
Code hints for all SVG elements and attributes are now supported in HTML documents. Using these code hints, you
can now add SVG elements in Code view of HTML documents just like you add in an SVG document.
Technology Previews
Starting with this release, the Dreamweaver team provides previews of certain features to gather customer feedback.
Based on the feedback, these features will be improved upon further and included as core features of Dreamweaver. You
can access such features from the Technology Previews category of the Preferences dialog box.
The preview feature in this release is Code Highlighting. This feature highlights all occurences of any selected text in
Code view.
To use this feature, perform the following steps:
1Go to Preferences > Technology Previews.
2Enable Code Highlighting. Then, click Apply and Close to close the Preferences dialog box.
3Open the document in which you want to use code highlighting. You can use code highlighting in any type of
document, such as, HTML, JS, CSS, and LESS.
4In Code view, double-click the text - tag, word, or phrase - that needs to be highlighted.
All occurences of the selected text are highlighted in Code view.
You can navigate between the highlighted text using the following keyboard shortcuts:
Move forward: F3 (Win); Cmd+G (Mac)
Move backward: Shift+F3 (Win); Cmd+Shift+G (Mac)
9
What's new
Last updated 6/3/2015
Custom preview in Code view using showPreview API
With this release of Dreamweaver, you can generate a custom preview popup that gets displayed when you hover your
mouse over the code in Code view. To implement customized previews, you can use the new API, showPreview, along
with the existing mm:browsercontrol API. For example, you can use these APIs to display a preview of all the
parameters of a JavaScript function when you hover your mouse over the name of the function.
Code folding
In previous versions of Dreamweaver, you had to select code blocks in Code view and then collapse them. In this
version and later, you can collapse code blocks by simply hovering over the line numbers and clicking the triangle that
appears.
Code folding (collapsing) is available in HTML, CSS, LESS, Sass, SCSS, JS, PHP, XML, and SVG files and is based on
tag blocks.
The Copy, Cut, Paste, and drag-and-drop actions retain the code folding state. For example, when you copy a code block
that is collapsed, the Paste action pastes the copied text as a collapsed block.
In HTML files, unlike the earlier code collapse functionality, the collapsed content now contains the closing tag and is
rendered differently. Also, the number of characters displayed in a collapsed code block is now increased. This helps
you to preview the initial attributes, if any.
For detailed information, see Collapsing code.
Extract enhancements
Extract for devices
Support for % units
Extract for devices
Devices not only vary in sizes, but also in resolutions. Your plan for a responsive web design must account for multiple
resolution versions of images that are rendered appropriately on devices. However, it can be a daunting task to create
so many different resolution versions for all the images in your project.
Extract in Dreamweaver eases up this task to a large extent. While extracting an image from your Photoshop comp in
the 2015 release of Dreamweaver, you can choose to extract different resolution versions of that image too. The image
in Photoshop is automatically scaled in different, predefined resolutions during extraction.
You can then call these images in JavaScript or media queries to display them based on the device they are viewed upon.
For example, for high density retina display, you can use the 2X version of the image.
For more information, see Extract images from PSD files .
10
What's new
Last updated 6/3/2015
Support for % units
In the Extract panel, you can now view the width and height of images in % values in addition to pixels. You can also
view the measurements in %.
When you click an asset in the Extract panel, the pop-up that appears provides you an option to switch between pixels
and %. The unit you select in this pop-up is retained when you view measurements between assets.
Enhancements to Live view editing
11
What's new
Last updated 6/3/2015
Nested Insert in Live View
Now, you can insert elements within other elements in Live view. When you drag elements from the Insert panel, Asset
panel, or within Live view, and hover over different elements on the page, you will notice the visual feedback for nesting
elements (along with before and after guides).
Before/After guides: When you hover over top and bottom 30% of the element.
Nesting visual feedback: When you hover over the middle 40% of the element.
Editing Selectors directly in Element Display
You can now simply click the name of the Selector in Element Display to edit it. You can commit the changes by clicking
anywhere on the page.
Coding toolbar changes
The following options in the Coding toolbar related to collapsing code have been removed:
Collapse Full Tag
Collapse Selection
Note: These options have been removed from the right-click context menu and the Edit menu as well. You can now
Collapsing codeby hovering your mouse over the line number and clicking the triangle that appears. Also, the following
options are now not available for HTML, CSS, and JS files.
Highlight Invalid Code
Syntax Error Alerts in Info Bar
You can now use linting to find errors in the code and the Output panel displays the linting results.
CSS Designer improvements
All and Current modes
Code hints
Color coding for media queries
Other changes
All and Current modes
CSS Designer now provides two different modes of viewing and editing CSS properties:
All: All the CSS, media queries, and selectors in the current document are listed in this mode. This mode is not
sensitive to the selection in Design or Live view.
12
What's new
Last updated 6/3/2015
This mode is optimal if you want to create CSS, media queries, or selectors.
Current: Computed styles for any element selected in Design or Live view are listed in this mode. In a CSS file, if
the focus is on a selector, this mode displays the properties of that selector.
This mode is optimal if you want to edit the properties of selectors associated with the element selected in the
document.
Code hints
Dreamweaver now displays code hints in CSS Designer, similar to Code view, for setting new properties.
Note: Options that have further action associated with them, such as manage fonts, color picker, and browse, are not
available in CSS Designer.
Color coding for media queries
Media queries in the CSS Designer panel are now color coded to match Visual Media Queries .
Green: Media queries with max-width conditions
Blue : Media queries with both min-width and max-width conditions
Purple : Media queries with min-width conditions
13
What's new
Last updated 6/3/2015
Other changes
Show Set option: The Show Set check box in the Properties section is now selected by default when you first launch
Dreamweaver. Any change to this option (select or unselect) is persistent in all the subsequent Dreamweaver
sessions.
The panel scrolls to display Add Property at the center: When you click + in the Properties section, the section
scrolls so that the Add Property row is displayed at the center of the panel. If Properties section is too small, add
property row is displayed at the bottom of the panel.
Background highlighting while adding new property: When the focus is on the Add New Property text box, the
row is highlighted in grey background.
Change in the position of + and - buttons: + and - buttons that appear in each pane in the CSS Designer panel are
moved from extreme right to extereme left to make them more visible.
Custom category is renamed: The category name for Custom properties is changed More.
Testing server workflow changes
The testing server workflow improvements in this release aim to make editing of documents with server-side code in
Live view easy and seamless.
Changes in server setup
Unlike the previous versions of Dreamweaver, you can now designate a specific server as either a testing server or a
remote server, and not both. Check boxes in the user interface of server setup are replaced with radio buttons to enforce
the specification of servers.
If you import a site into Dreamweaver CC 2015, which has a single server specified as both testing and remote server,
a duplicate entry of the server is created. Then, one is marked as remote and the other is marked as testing server.
Automatic pushing of dynamic files
Dreamweaver now automatically syncs dynamic documents to your testing server when you open, create, or save
changes made to dynamic documents. Dreamweaver no longer displays "Update Testing Server" or "Push Dependent
Files" dialog boxes for testing server workflows.
For more information, see Set up a testing server .
14
What's new
Last updated 6/3/2015
Changes to Business Catalyst workflow
Business Catalyst extension is retired and will not be available for use with Dreamweaver CC 2015 release and later.
Dreamweaver CC 2014.1.1 is the last release that is compatible with the Business Catalyst extension.
To use Business Catalyst with Dreamweaver CC 2015 release and later, use the SFTP connection option in
Dreamweaver. For more information see the Business Catalyst documentation.
Here's the official announcement on this change on the Business Catalyst website.
Other changes
Insert panel is reorganized to group all options in Common, Layout ,and Media categories into a more logical
category - HTML.
Mini tour videos and the link to launch them from Help menu are removed. This option is not available for non-
English locales too.
The options present in the document bar drop-down at the bottom of a page are cleaned up - only Orientation, Full
Size, and Edit Sizes options are available now.
15
Last updated 6/3/2015
Chapter 2: Workspace and workflow
Dreamweaver workflow and workspace
Dreamweaver workflow overview
You can use several approaches to create a website. This is one approach:
Plan and set up your site
Determine where the files will go and examine site requirements, audience profiles, and site goals. Additionally,
consider technical requirements such as user access, as well as browser, plug-in, and download restrictions. After youve
organized your information and determined a structure, you can begin creating your site. (See About Dreamweaver
sites.)
Organize and manage your site files
In the Files panel you can easily add, delete, and rename files and folders to change the organization as needed. The
Files panel also has many tools for managing your site, transferring files to and from a remote server, setting up a Check
In/Check Out process to prevent files from being overwritten, and synchronizing the files on your local and remote
sites. From the Assets panel, you can easily organize the assets in a site; you can then drag most assets directly from the
Assets panel into a Dreamweaver document. You can also use Dreamweaver to manage aspects of your
Adobe®Contribute® sites. (See Managing files and foldersand Managing assets and libraries.)
Lay out your web pages
Choose the layout technique that works for you, or use the Dreamweaver layout options in conjunction with one
another to create your sites look. You can use Dreamweaver Fluid Grid layouts or default templates to get started. You
can create new pages based on a Dreamweaver template, then update the layout of those pages automatically when the
template changes. If you want to display multiple elements at once in a browser, you can use frames to lay out your
documents. (See Creating pages with CSS and Laying out pages with CSS.)
Add content to pages
Add assets and design elements such as text, images, rollover images, image maps, colors, movies, sound, HTML links,
jump menus, and more. You can use built-in page-creation features for such elements as titles and backgrounds, type
directly in the page, or import content from other documents. Dreamweaver also provides tools for maximizing website
performance and for testing pages to ensure compatibility with different web browsers. (See Adding content to pages.)
Create pages by hand coding
Coding web pages by hand is another approach to creating pages. Dreamweaver provides easy-to-use visual editing
tools, but it also provides a sophisticated coding environment; you can use either approach, or both, to create and edit
your pages. (See Working with page code.)
Set up a web application for dynamic content
16
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
Many websites contain dynamic pages that allow visitors to view information stored in databases, and usually allow
some visitors to add new information and edit information in the databases. To create such pages, you must first set up
a web server and application server, create or modify a Dreamweaver site, and connect to a database. (See Preparing to
build dynamic sites.)
Create dynamic pages
In Dreamweaver, you can define a variety of sources of dynamic content, including recordsets extracted from databases,
form parameters, and JavaBeans components. To add the dynamic content to a page, simply drag it on to the page.
You can set your page to display one record or many records at a time, display more than one page of records, add
special links to move from one page of records to the next (and back), and create record counters to help users keep
track of the records. (See Making pages dynamic.)
Test and publis h
Testing your pages is an ongoing process that happens throughout the development cycle. At the end of the cycle, you
publish the site on a server. Many developers also schedule periodic maintenance to ensure that the site remains current
and functional. (See Getting and putting files to and from your server.)
Workspace layout overview
The Dreamweaver workspace lets you view documents and object properties. The workspace also places many of the
most common operations in toolbars so that you can quickly make changes to your documents.
A Application bar B Extract panel C Document toolbar D Document window E Workspace switcher F Panel groups G Live View H Code View
I Tag selec tor
Workspace elements overview
The workspace includes the following elements:
17
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: Dreamweaver provides many other panels, inspectors, and windows. To open the panels, inspectors, and windows,
use the Window menu.
The Welcome screen Lets you open a recent document or create a new document. From the Welcome screen, you can
also learn more about Dreamweaver by taking a product tour or accessing learn and help content for users with varying
skill levels and read about the new features in the current and past releases. Welcome Screen lets you create a new Starter
Template too.
The Application bar Is across the top of the application window and contains a workspace switcher, menus (Windows
only), and other application controls.
The Document toolbar Contains buttons that provide options for different views of the Document window (such as
Design view, Live view, and Code view), various viewing options, and some common operations such as previewing in
a browser.
The Standard toolbar To display the Standard toolbar, select View > Toolbars > Standard. The toolbar contains buttons
for common operations from the File and Edit menus: New, Open, Browse in Bridge, Save, Save All, Print Code, Cut,
Copy, Paste, Undo, and Redo.
The Coding toolbar (Displayed in Code view only.) Contains buttons that let you perform many standard coding
operations.
The Document window Displays the current document as you create and edit it.
The Property inspector Lets you view and change a variety of properties for the selected object or text. Each object has
different properties.
The Tag selector Located in the Status bar at the bottom of the Document window. Shows the hierarchy of tags
surrounding the current selection. Click any tag in the hierarchy to select that tag and all its contents.
Panels Help you monitor and modify your work. Examples include the Insert panel, the CSS Designer panel, and the
Files panel. To expand a panel, double-click its tab.
The Extract panel Lets you upload and view your PSD files on Creative Cloud. Using this panel, you can extract CSS,
text, images, fonts, colors, gradients, and measurements from your PSD comps into your document.
The Insert panel Contains buttons for inserting various types of objects, such as images, tables, and media elements,
into a document. Each object is a piece of HTML code that lets you set various attributes as you insert it. For example,
you can insert a table by clicking the Table button in the Insert panel. If you prefer, you can insert objects using the
Insert menu instead of the Insert panel.
The Files panel Lets you manage your files and folders, whether they are part of a Dreamweaver site or on a remote
server. The Files panel also lets you access all the files on your local disk.
Document window overview
The Document window shows the current document. To switch to a document, click its tab.
You can select any of the following views:
Live view (View > Live View) Live view displays a more realistic representation of what your document will look like
in a browser, and lets you interact with the document exactly as you would in a browser. You can edit HTML elements
directly in Live View and instantly preview your changes in the same view as well. For more information on editing in
Live View, see Edit in Live View.
Design view (View > Design) A design environment for visual page layout, visual editing, and rapid application
development. In this view, Dreamweaver displays a fully editable, visual representation of the document, similar to what
you would see when viewing the page in a browser.
18
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
Code view (View > Code) A hand-coding environment for writing and editing HTML, JavaScript, and any other kind
of code.
Split Code view (View > Split Code) A split version of Code view that lets you scroll to work on different sections of
the document at the same time.
Code and Design view (View > Code And Design) Lets you see both Code view and Design view for the same
document in a single window.
Live Code view (View > Live Code) Only available when viewing a document in Live view. Live Code view displays the
actual code that a browser uses to execute the page, and can dynamically change as you interact with the page in Live
view. Live Code view is not editable.
When a Document window is maximized (the default), tabs appear at the top of the Document window showing the
filenames of all open documents. Dreamweaver displays an asterisk after the filename if you have made changes that
you havent saved yet.
Dreamweaver also displays the Related Files toolbar below the documents tab (or below the documents title bar if you
are viewing documents in separate windows). Related documents are documents associated with the current file, such
as CSS files or JavaScript files. To open one of these related files in the Document window, click its filename in the
Related Files toolbar.
Document toolbar overview
The Document toolbar contains buttons that let you toggle between different views of your document quickly. The
toolbar also contains some common commands and options related to viewing the document and transferring it
between the local and remote sites.
A Code view B Show Live and Code view C Live view D Go to Inspect mode E Show Live view source in Code view F Refresh G File path and
name H Preview/Debug in browser I Live view options J File management
The following options appear in the Document toolbar:
Code View Displays only the Code view in the Document window.
Show Live and Code Views Splits the Document window between the Code and the Live/Design views. Design view
option is not available for fluid grid documents.
Live View Displays an interactive, browser-based view of the document. You can also edit HTML elements in Live
View. The drop-down list adjacent to the Live options lets you switch between Live and Design views. This drop-down
list is not available in fluid grid documents.
Preview/Debug in Browser Allows you to preview or debug your document in a browser. Select a browser from the
pop-up menu.
File Management Displays the File Management pop-up menu.
Standard toolbar overview
The Standard toolbar contains buttons for common operations from the File and Edit menus: New, Open, Browse in
Bridge, Save, Save All, Print Code, Cut, Copy, Paste, Undo, and Redo. Use these buttons just as you would use the
equivalent menu commands.
19
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
Browser Navigation toolbar overview
The Browser Navigation toolbar becomes active in Live view, and shows you the address of the page youre looking at
in the Document window. Live view acts like a regular browser, so even if you browse to a site outside of your local site
(for example, http://www.adobe.com), Dreamweaver will load the page in the Document window.
A Browser controls B Address box C Live View options
By default, links are not active in Live view. Having links non-active lets you select or click link text in the Document
window without being taken to another page. To test links in Live view, you can enable one-time clicking or continuous
clicking by selecting Follow Links or Follow Links Continuously from the View options menu to the right of the address
box.
Coding toolbar overview
The Coding toolbar contains buttons that let you perform many standard coding operations, such as collapsing and
expanding code selections, highlighting invalid code, applying, and removing comments, indenting code, and inserting
recently used code snippets. The Coding toolbar appears vertically on the left side of the Document window, and is only
visible when Code view is displayed.
You cannot undock or move the Coding toolbar, but you can hide it (View > Toolbars > Coding). For information on
the different options available in the toolbar, see Insert code using the Coding toolbar.
You can also edit the Coding toolbar to display more buttons (such as Show Hidden Characters, and Auto Indent), or
hide buttons that you dont want to use. To do so, however, you must edit the XML file that generates the toolbar. For
more information, see Extending Dreamweaver.
20
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
Status bar overview
The Status bar at the bottom of the Document window provides additional information about the document you are
creating.
A Tag s elector B Mobile size C Tablet size D Desktop size E Window size
Tag selector
Shows the hierarchy of tags surrounding the current selection. Click any tag in the hierarchy to select that tag and all
its contents. Click <body> to select the entire body of the document. To set the class or ID attributes for a tag in the tag
selector, right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the tag and select a class or ID from the context menu.
Mobile size
Shows a preview of the document in mobile size - 480 X 800 by default. To change the default size, click Window Size
pop-up menu > Edit Sizes.
Tablet size
Shows a preview of the document in tablet size - 768 X 1024 by default. To change the default size, click Window Size
pop-up menu > Edit Sizes.
Desktop size
Shows a preview of the document in desktop size - 1000 px width by default. To change the default size, click Window
Size pop-up menu > Edit Sizes.
Window size pop-up menu
(Not available in Code view.) Lets you resize the Document window to predetermined or custom dimensions. When
you change the view size of a page in design or live view only the dimensions of the view size change. The document
size is unaltered.
In addition to predetermined and custom sizes, Dreamweaver also lists sizes specified in a media query. When you
select a size corresponding to a media query, Dreamweaver uses the media query to display the page. You can also
change the page orientation to preview the page for mobile devices where the page layout changes based on how the
device is held.
Property inspector overview
The Property Inspector lets you examine and edit the most common properties for the currently selected page element,
such as text or an inserted object. The contents of the Property Inspector vary depending on the element selected. For
example, if you select an image on your page, the Property Inspector changes to show properties for the image (such as
the file path to the image, the width and height of the image, the border around the image, if any, and so on).
The Property Inspector is at the lower edge of the workspace by default, but you can undock it and make it a floating
panel in the workspace.
21
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
Insert panel overview
The Insert panel contains buttons for creating and inserting objects such as tables, images, and links. The buttons are
organized into several categories, which you can switch by selecting the desired category from the drop-down list at the
top.
Some categories have buttons with pop-up menus. When you select an option from a pop-up menu, it becomes the
default action for the button. For example, if you select Image Placeholder from the Image buttons pop-up menu, the
next time you click the Image button, Dreamweaver inserts an image placeholder. Anytime you select a new option
from the pop-up menu, the default action for the button changes.
The Insert panel is organized in the following categories:
Common Lets you create and insert the most commonly used elements such as div tags and objects, such as images,
and tables.
Structure Lets you insert structural elements such as div tags, headings, lists, paragraphs, headers, and footers.
Media Lets you insert media elements such as Edge Animate composition, HTML5 audio and video, and Flash audio
and video.
Form Contains buttons for creating forms and inserting form elements, such as search, month, and password.
jQuery Mobile Contains buttons for building sites that use jQuery Mobile.
jQuery UI Lets you insert jQuery UI elements such as accordion, sliders, and buttons.
Templates Lets you save the document as a template and mark specific regiions as editable, optional, repeating, or
editable optional regions.
Favorites Lets you group and organize the Insert panel buttons you use the most in one common place.
Files panel overview
Use the Files panel to view and manage the files on your Dreamweaver site.
22
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
When you view sites, files, or folders in the Files panel, you can change the size of the viewing area, and expand or
collapse the Files panel. When the Files panel is collapsed, it displays the contents of the local site, the remote site, the
testing server, or the SVN repository as a list of files. When expanded, it displays the local site and either the remote
site, the testing server, or the SVN repository.
For Dreamweaver sites, you can also customize the Files panel by changing the view—either your local or remote site—
that appears by default in the collapsed panel.
The folders in the Files panel are displayed in different colors based on the view - Local, Remote, or Testing.
Local view
Remote Server view
23
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
Testi ng S er ver v i e w
Repository view
The Files panel interacts with the server at regular intervals to update its content. An error message is displayed when
you try to perform an action in the Files panel when it is running these auto-updates. To disable auto-updates, open
the Files panel options menu, and deselect Auto-Update in the View menu.
To update the contents of the panel manually, use the Refresh button in the panel. The current check-out status of files,
however, is updated only when auto-updates are enabled.
CSS Designer
CSS Designer panel (Windows > CSS Designer) is a CSS Property Inspector that lets you 'visually' create CSS styles,
files, and set properties, along with media queries.
24
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
The CSS Designer panel consists of the following panes:
Sources Lists all the CSS style sheets associated with the document. Using this pane, you can create and attach a CSS
to the document, or define styles within the document.
@Media Lists all the media queries in the source selected in the Sources pane. If you do not select a specific CSS, this
pane displays all the media queries associated with the document.
Selectors Lists all the selectors in the source selected in the Sources pane. If you also select a media query, this pane
narrows down the list of selectors for that media query. If no CSS or media queries are selected, this pane displays all
the selectors in the document.
When you select Global in the @Media pane, all the selectors that are not included in a media query of the selected
source are displayed.
Properties Displays properties that you can set for the specified selector. For more information, see Set properties .
CSS Designer is context-sensitive. This means, for any given context or selected page element, you can view the
associated selectors and properties. Further, when you select a selector in CSS Designer, the associated source and
media queries are highlighted in the respective panes.
For more information, see CSS Designer panel.
25
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
Visual guides overview
Dreamweaver provides several kinds of visual guides to help you design documents and predict approximately how
they appear in browsers. You can do any of the following:
Instantly snap the Document window to a desired window size to see how the elements fit on the page.
Use a tracing image as the page background to help you duplicate a design created in an illustration or image-editing
application such as Adobe® Photosho or Adobe® Fireworks®.
Use rulers and guides to provide a visual cue for precise positioning and resizing of page elements.
Use the grid for precise positioning and resizing of absolutely positioned elements (AP elements).
Grid marks on the page help you align AP elements, and when snapping is enabled, AP elements automatically snap
to the closest grid point when moved or resized. (Other objects, such as images and paragraphs, do not snap to the
grid.) Snapping works regardless of whether the grid is visible.
More Help topics
Working in the Document window
About Live view
Open Related Files
General information about coding in Dreamweaver
Preview pages in Live view
Setting coding preferences
View and edit head content
Using visual aids for layout
Previewing pages in Dreamweaver
Insert code with the Coding toolbar
Set window size and connection speed
Zoom in and out
Resize the Document window
Set download time and size preferences
Manage windows and panels
Use the Property inspector
Use the Insert panel
Work with files in the Files panel
Using visual aids for layout
Customizing the Dreamweaver workspace
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
26
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
Manage windows and panels
You can create a custom workspace by moving and manipulating Document windows and panels. You can also save
workspaces and switch among them. For Fireworks, renaming custom workspaces can lead to unexpected behavior.
Note: The following examples use Photoshop for demonstration purposes. The workspace behaves the same in all the
products.
Rearrange, dock, or float document windows
When you open more than one file, the Document windows are tabbed.
To rearrange the order of tabbed Document windows, drag a window’s tab to a new location in the group.
To undock (float or untab) a Document window from a group of windows, drag the window’s tab out of the group.
Note: In Photoshop you can also choose Window > Arrange > Float in Window to float a single Document window, or
Window > Arrange > Float All In Windows to float all of the Document windows at once. See tech note kb405298 for more
information.
Note: Dreamweaver does not support docking and undocking Document windows. Use the Document window’s Minimize
button to create floating windows (Windows), or choose Window > Tile Vertically to create side-by-side Document
windows. Search “Tile Vertically” in Dreamweaver Help for more information on this topic. The workflow is slightly
different for Macintosh users.
To dock a Document window to a separate group of Document windows, drag the window into the group.
To create groups of stacked or tiled documents, drag the window to one of the drop zones along the top, bottom, or
sides of another window. You can also select a layout for the group by using the Layout button on the Application bar.
Note: Some products do not support this functionality. However, your product may have Cascade and Tile commands in
the Window menu to help you lay out your documents.
To switch to another document in a tabbed group when dragging a selection, drag the selection over the document’s
tab for a moment.
Note: Some products do not support this functionality.
Dock and undock panels
A dock is a collection of panels or panel groups displayed together, generally in a vertical orientation. You dock and
undock panels by moving them into and out of a dock.
To dock a panel, drag it by its tab into the dock, at the top, bottom, or in between other panels.
To dock a panel group, drag it by its title bar (the solid empty bar above the tabs) into the dock.
To remove a panel or panel group, drag it out of the dock by its tab or title bar. You can drag it into another dock or
make it free-floating.
27
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
You can prevent panels from filling all the space in a dock. Drag the bottom edge of the dock up so it no longer meets
the edge of the workspace.
Move panels
As you move panels, you see blue highlighted drop zones, areas where you can move the panel. For example, you can
move a panel up or down in a dock by dragging it to the narrow blue drop zone above or below another panel. If you
drag to an area that is not a drop zone, the panel floats freely in the workspace.
Note: The position of the mouse (rather than the position of the panel), activates the drop zone, so if you can’t see the drop
zone, try dragging the mouse to the place where the drop zone should be.
To move a panel, drag it by its tab.
To move a panel group, drag the title bar.
A Title bar B Tab C Drop zone
28
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
Press Ctrl (Windows) or Command (Mac OS) while moving a panel to prevent it from docking. Press Esc while moving
the panel to cancel the operation.
Add and remove panels
If you remove all panels from a dock, the dock disappears. You can create a dock by moving panels to the right edge of
the workspace until a drop zone appears.
To remove a panel, right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Mac) its tab and then select Close, or deselect it from
the Window menu.
To add a panel, select it from the Window menu and dock it wherever you want.
Manipulate panel groups
To move a panel into a group, drag the panels tab to the highlighted drop zone in the group.
To rearrange panels in a group, drag a panels tab to a new location in the group.
To remove a panel from a group so that it floats freely, drag the panel by its tab outside the group.
To move a group, drag the title bar (the area above the tabs).
Stack floating panels
When you drag a panel out of its dock but not into a drop zone, the panel floats freely. The floating panel allows you to
position it anywhere in the workspace. You can stack floating panels or panel groups so that they move as a unit when
you drag the topmost title bar.
To stack floating panels, drag a panel by its tab to the drop zone at the bottom of another panel.
To change the stacking order, drag a panel up or down by its tab.
Note: Be sure to release the tab over the narrow drop zone between panels, rather than the broad drop zone in a title bar.
To remove a panel or panel group from the stack, so that it floats by itself, drag it out by its tab or title bar.
Resize panels
To minimize or maximize a panel, panel group, or stack of panels, double-click a tab. You can also double-click the
tab area (the empty space next to the tabs).
To resize a panel, drag any side of the panel. Some panels, such as the Color panel in Photoshop, cannot be resized
by dragging.
29
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
Collapse and expand panel icons
You can collapse panels to icons to reduce clutter on the workspace. In some cases, panels are collapsed to icons in the
default workspace.
To collapse or expand all panel icons in a column, click the double arrow at the top of the dock.
To expand a single panel icon, click it.
To resize panel icons so that you see only the icons (and not the labels), adjust the width of the dock until the text
disappears. To display the icon text again, make the dock wider.
To collapse an expanded panel back to its icon, click its tab, its icon, or the double arrow in the panels title bar.
In some products, if you select Auto-Collapse Icon Panels from the Interface or User Interface Options preferences, an
expanded panel icon collapses automatically when you click away from it.
To add a floating panel or panel group to an icon dock, drag it in by its tab or title bar. (Panels are automatically
collapsed to icons when added to an icon dock.)
To move a panel icon (or panel icon group), drag the icon. You can drag panel icons up and down in the dock, into
other docks (where they appear in the panel style of that dock), or outside the dock (where they appear as floating
icons).
Save and switch workspaces
By saving the current size and position of panels as a named workspace, you can restore that workspace even if you
move or close a panel. The names of saved workspaces appear in the workspace switcher in the Application bar.
30
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
Save a custom workspace
1With the workspace in the configuration you want to save, do one of the following:
(Illustrator) Choose Window > Workspace > Save Workspace.
(Photoshop, InDesign, InCopy) Choose Window > Workspace > New Workspace.
(Dreamweaver) Choose Window > Workspace Layout > New Workspace.
(Flash) Choose New Workspace from the workspace switcher in the Application bar.
(Fireworks) Choose Save Current from the workspace switcher in the Application bar.
2Type a name for the workspace.
3(Photoshop, InDesign) Under Capture, select one or more options:
Panel Locations Saves the current panel locations (InDesign only).
Keyboard shortcuts Saves the current set of keyboard shortcuts (Photoshop only).
Menus or Menu Customization Saves the current set of menus.
Display or switch workspaces
Select a workspace from the workspace switcher in the Application bar.
In Photoshop, you can assign keyboard shortcuts to each workspace to navigate among them quickly.
Delete a custom workspace
Select Manage Workspaces from the workspace switcher in the Application bar, select the workspace, and then click
Delete. (The option is not available in Fireworks.)
(Photoshop, InDesign, InCopy) Select Delete Workspace from the workspace switcher.
(Illustrator) Choose Window > Workspace > Manage Workspaces, select the workspace, and then click the Delete
icon.
(Photoshop, InDesign) Choose Window > Workspace >Delete Workspace, select the workspace, and then click
Delete.
Restore the default workspace
1Select the Default or Essentials workspace from the workspace switcher in the application bar. For Fireworks, see
the article http://www.adobe.com/devnet/fireworks/articles/workspace_manager_panel.html.
Note: In Dreamweaver, Designer is the default workspace.
2For Fireworks (Windows), delete these folders:Windows
Vista\\Users\<username>\AppData\Roaming\Adobe\Fireworks CS4\ Windows XP\\Documents and
Settings\<username>\Application Data\Adobe\Fireworks CS4
3(Photoshop, InDesign, InCopy) Select Window > Workspace > Reset [Workspace Name].
(Photoshop) Restore a saved workspace arrangement
In Photoshop, workspaces automatically appear as you last arranged them, but you can restore the original, saved
arrangement of panels.
To restore an individual workspace, choose Window > Workspace > Reset Workspace Name.
31
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
To restore all the workspaces installed with Photoshop, click Restore Default Workspaces in the Interface
preferences.
To rearrange the order of workspaces in the application bar, drag them.
Display tabbed documents (Dreamweaver Macintosh)
You can view multiple documents in a single Document window by using tabs to identify each document. You can also
display them as part of a floating workspace, in which each document appears in its own window.
Open a tabbed document in a separate window
Control-click the tab and select Move To New Window from the context menu.
Combine separate documents into tabbed windows
Select Window > Combine As Tabs.
Change the default tabbed document setting
1Select Dreamweaver > Preferences, and then select the General category.
2Select or deselect Open Documents in Tabs, and click OK.
Dreamweaver does not alter the display of documents that are currently open when you change preferences.
Documents opened after you select a new preference, however, display according to the preference you selected.
Turn on color icons
By default, Dreamweaver CS4 and later uses black and white icons that turn into colored icons when you hover over
them. You can turn color icons on permanently so that no hovering is required.
Do one of the following:
Choose View > Color Icons.
Switch to the Classic or Coder workspace.
To turn color icons off again, deselect Color Icons in the View menu, or switch to a different workspace.
Hide and display the Dreamweaver Welcome screen
The Welcome screen appears when you start Dreamweaver and anytime that you do not have any documents open. You
can choose to hide the Welcome screen, and then later display it again. When the Welcome screen is hidden and no
documents are open, the Document window is blank.
Hide the Welcome screen
Select the Dont Show Again option on the Welcome screen.
Display the Welcome screen
1Select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh).
2In the General category, select the Show Welcome Screen option.
32
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
About customizing Dreamweaver in multiuser systems
You can customize Dreamweaver to suit your needs even in a multiuser operating system such as Windows XP or Mac
OS X.
Dreamweaver prevents any user’s customized configuration from affecting any other users customized configuration.
To accomplish this goal, the first time you run Dreamweaver in one of the multiuser operating systems that it
recognizes, the application creates copies of a variety of configuration files. These user configuration files are stored in
a folder that belongs to you.
For example, in Windows XP, they’re stored in C:\Documents and Settings\username\Application
Data\Adobe\Dreamweaver\en_US\Configuration, which is hidden by default. To show hidden files and folders, select
Tools > Folder Options in Windows Explorer, click the View tab, and select the Show Hidden Files and Folders option.
In Windows Vista, they’re stored in C:\Users\username\AppData\Roaming\Adobe\Dreamweaver
\en_US\Configuration, which is hidden by default. To show hidden files and folders, select Tools > Folder Options in
Windows Explorer, click the View tab, and select the Show Hidden Files and Folders option.
In Mac OS X, they’re stored inside your Home folder; specifically, in Users/username/Library/Application
Support/Adobe/Dreamweaver/Configuration.
If you reinstall or upgrade Dreamweaver, Dreamweaver automatically makes backup copies of existing user
configuration files, so if you customized those files by hand, you still have access to the changes you made.
Set General preferences for Dreamweaver
1Select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh).
2Set any of the following options:
Open Documents In Tabs Opens all documents in a single window with tabs that let you switch between documents
(Macintosh only).
Show Welcome Screen Displays the Dreamweaver Welcome screen when you start Dreamweaver or when you don’t
have any documents open.
Reopen Documents on Startup Opens any documents that were open when you closed Dreamweaver. If this option
is not selected, Dreamweaver displays the Welcome screen or a blank screen when you start (depending on your
Show Welcome Screen setting).
Warn When Opening Read-Only Files Alerts you when you open a read-only (locked) file. Choose to unlock/check
out the file, view the file, or cancel.
Enable Related Files Lets you see which files are connected to the current document (for example, CSS or JavaScript
files). Dreamweaver displays a button for each related file at the top of the document, and opens the file if you click
the button.
Discover Dynamically-Related Files Lets you select whether Dynamically-Related Files appear in the Related Files
toolbar automatically, or after manual interaction. You can also choose to disable the discovery of Dynamically-
Related Files.
Update Links When Moving Files Determines what happens when you move, rename, or delete a document within
your site. Set this preference to always update links automatically, never update links, or prompt you to perform an
update. (See Update links automatically.)
Show Dialog When Inserting Objects Determines whether Dreamweaver prompts you to enter additional
information when inserting images, tables, Shockwave movies, and certain other objects by using the Insert panel
or the Insert menu. If this option is off, the dialog box does not appear and you must use the Property inspector to
33
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
specify the source file for images, the number of rows in a table, and so on. For roll over images and Fireworks
HTML, a dialog box always appears when you insert the object, regardless of this option setting. (To temporarily
override this setting, Control-click (Windows) or Command-click (Macintosh) when creating and inserting
objects.)
Enable Double-Byte Inline Input Lets you enter double-byte text directly into the Document window if you are
using a development environment or language kit that facilitates double-byte text (such as Japanese characters).
When this option is deselected, a text input window appears for entering and converting double-byte text; the text
appears in the Document window after it is accepted.
Switch To Plain Paragraph After Heading Specifies that pressing Enter (Windows) or Return (Macintosh) at the end
of a heading paragraph in Design or Live view creates a new paragraph tagged with a p tag. (A heading paragraph
is one thats tagged with a heading tag such as h1 or h2.) When the option is disabled, pressing Enter or Return at
the end of a heading paragraph creates a new paragraph tagged with the same heading tag (allowing you to type
multiple headings in a row and then go back and fill in details).
Allow Multiple Consecutive Spaces Specifies that typing two or more spaces in Design or Live view creates
nonbreaking spaces that appear in a browser as multiple spaces. (For example, you can type two spaces between
sentences, as you would on a typewriter.) This option is designed mostly for people who are used to typing in word
processors. When the option is disabled, multiple spaces are treated as a single space (because browsers treat
multiple spaces as single spaces).
Use <strong> and <em> in Place of <b> and <i> Specifies that Dreamweaver applies the strong tag whenever you
perform an action that would normally apply the b tag, and applies the em tag whenever you perform an action that
would normally apply the i tag. Such actions include clicking the Bold or Italic buttons in the text Property inspector
in HTML mode and choosing Format > Style > Bold or Format > Style > Italic. To use the b and i tags in your
documents, deselect this option.
Note: The World Wide Web Consortium discourages use of the b and i tags; the strong and em tags provide more
semantic information than the b and i tags do.
Warn when placing editable regions within <p> or <h1> - <h6> tags Specifies whether a warning message is
displayed whenever you save a Dreamweaver template that has an editable region within a paragraph or heading tag.
The message tells you that users will not be able to create more paragraphs in the region. It is enabled by default.
Centering Specifies whether you want to center elements using divalign="center" or the center tag when you click
the Align Center button in the Property inspector.
Note: Both of these approaches to centering have been officially deprecated as of the HTML 4.01 specification; you
should use CSS styles to center text. Both of these approaches are still technically valid as of the XHTML 1.0 Transitional
specification, but theyre no longer valid in the XHTML 1.0 Strict specification.
Maximum Number of History Steps Determines the number of steps that the History panel retains and shows. (The
default value should be sufficient for most users.) If you exceed the given number of steps in the History panel, the
oldest steps are discarded.
For more information, see Task automation.
Spelling Dictionary lists the available spelling dictionaries. If a dictionary contains multiple dialects or spelling
conventions (such as American English and British English), the dialects are listed separately in the Dictionary
pop-up menu.
34
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
Set Fonts preferences for documents in Dreamweaver
A document’s encoding determines how the document appears in a browser. Dreamweaver font preferences let you
view a given encoding in the font and size you prefer. The fonts you select in the Fonts Preferences dialog, however,
only affect the way fonts appear in Dreamweaver; they do not affect the way the document appears in a visitor’s browser.
To change the way fonts appear in a browser, you need to change the text by using the Property inspector or by applying
a CSS rule.
For information on setting a default encoding for new documents, see Creating and opening documents.
1Select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh).
2Select Fonts from the Category list on the left.
3Select an encoding type (such as Western European or Japanese) from the Font Settings list.
Note: To display an Asian language, you must be using an operating system that supports double-byte fonts.
4Select a font and size to use for each category of the selected encoding.
Note: To appear in the font pop-up menus, a font must be installed on your computer. For example, to see Japanese text
you must have a Japanese font installed.
Proportional Font The font that Dreamweaver uses to display normal text (for example, text in paragraphs,
headings, and tables). The default depends on your systems installed fonts. For most U.S. systems, the default is
Times New Roman 12 pt. (Medium) on Windows and Times 12 pt. on Mac OS.
Fixed Font The font Dreamweaver uses to display text within pre, code, and tt tags. The default depends on your
systems installed fonts. For most U.S. systems, the default is Courier New 10 pt. (Small) on Windows and Monaco
12 pt. on Mac OS.
Code View The font used for all text that appears in the Code view and Code inspector. The default depends on your
systems installed fonts.
Customize Dreamweaver highlighting colors
Use the Highlighting preferences to customize the colors that identify template regions, library items, third-party tags,
layout elements, and code in Dreamweaver.
Change a highlighting color
1Select Edit > Preferences and select the Highlighting category.
2Beside the object you want to change the highlighting color for, click the color box, and then use the color picker to
select a new color, or enter a hexadecimal value.
Activate or deactivate highlighting for an object
1Select Edit > Preferences and select the Highlighting category.
2Beside the object you want to activate or deactivate highlighting color for, select or deselect the Show option.
Restore default preferences
For procedures on restoring default Dreamweaver preferences, see Tech Note 83912.
35
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
More Help topics
Workspace layout overview
Update links automatically
Understanding document encoding
Use the color picker
Change the highlight color of div tags
Working in the Document window
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Switch between views in the Document window
You can view a document in the Document window in Code view, Split Code view, Design view, Code and Design views
(Split view), or Live view. You also have the option of viewing Split Code view or Code and Design views horizontally
or vertically. (Horizontal display is the default.)
Note: Design view option is not available for fluid grid documents.
Switch to Code view
Do one of the following:
Select View > Code.
In the Document toolbar, click the Code button.
Switch to Split Code view
Split Code view splits your document in two so that you can work on two sections of the code at once.
Select View > Split Code.
Switch to Design view
In the Document toolbar, click the drop-down list adjacent to Live option and click Design. To switch to full Design
view, click the Design button.
Show both Code and Design views
In the Document toolbar, click the Split button. Then, click the drop-down list adjacent to Live option and click Design.
Split views vertically or horizontally
1Make sure that you are in the Split view (Split Code or split Design/Live view).
36
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
2To split the view vertically, select View > Split Vertically. To split the view horizontally, deselect View > Split
Vertically.
Cascade or tile Document windows
If you have many documents open at once, you can cascade or tile them.
Cascade Document windows
Select Window > Cascade.
Tile Document windows
(Windows) Select Window > Tile Horizontally or Window > Tile Vertically.
(Macintosh) Select Window > Tile.
Resize the Document window
The Status bar displays the Document window’s current dimensions (in pixels). To design a page that looks its best at
a specific size, you can adjust the Document window to any of the predetermined sizes, edit those predetermined sizes,
or create sizes.
When you change the view size of a page in design or live view only the dimensions of the view size change. The
document size is unaltered.
In addition to predetermined and custom sizes, Dreamweaver also lists sizes specified in a media query. When you
select a size corresponding to a media query, Dreamweaver uses the media query to display the page. You can also
change the page orientation to preview the page for mobile devices where the page layout changes based on how the
device is held.
Resize the Document window to a predetermined size
Select one of the sizes from the Window Size pop-up menu at the bottom of the Document window. Dreamweaver
CS5.5 and later offers an extended list of choices, including choices for common mobile devices (as pictured below).
The window size shown reflects the inside dimensions of the browser window, without borders; the monitor size or
mobile device is listed to the right.
37
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
For less precise resizing, use your operating systems standard methods of resizing windows, such as dragging the
lower-right corner of a window.
Note: (Windows only) Documents within the Document window are maximized by default, and you can't resize a
document when it's maximized. To de-maximize the document, click the de-maximize button in the upper right
corner of the document.
Change the values listed in the Window Size pop-up menu
1Select Edit Sizes from the Window Size pop-up menu.
2Click any of the width or height values in the Window Sizes list, and type a new value.
To make the Document window adjust only to a specific width (leaving the height unchanged), select a height value
and delete it.
3Click the Description box to enter descriptive text about a specific size.
Add a new size to the Window Size pop-up menu
1Select Edit Sizes from the Window Size pop-up menu.
2Click the blank space below the last value in the Width column.
3Enter values for Width and Height.
To set the Width or Height only, simply leave one field empty.
4Click the Description field to enter descriptive text about the size you added.
For example, you might type SVGA or average PC next to the entry for an 800 x 600 pixel monitor, and 17-in. Mac
next to the entry for an 832 x 624 pixel monitor. Most monitors can be adjusted to a variety of pixel dimensions.
Set window size and connection speed
1Select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh).
2Select Window Sizes from the Category list on the left.
3Customize the Window Sizes as required.
Reports in Dreamweaver
You can run reports in Dreamweaver to find content, troubleshoot, or test content. You can generate the following types
of reports:
Search Lets you search for tags, attributes, and specific text within tags.
Reference Lets you search for helpful reference information.
Validation Lets you check for code or syntax errors.
Browser Compatibility Lets you test the HTML in your documents to see if any tags or attributes are unsupported by
your target browsers.
Link Checker Lets you find and fix broken, external, and orphaned links.
Site Reports Enable you to improve workflow and test HTML attributes in your site. Workflow reports include checked
out by, recently modified, and design notes; HTML reports include combinable nested font tags, accessibility, missing
Alt text, redundant nested tags, removable empty tags, and untitled documents.
FTP Log Enables you to view all FTP file-transfer activity.
38
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
Server Debug Lets you view information to debug an Adobe® ColdFusion® application.
Note: Support for ColdFusion is removed in Dreamweaver CC and later.
More Help topics
Document window overview
Preview pages in Live view
Manage windows and panels
Display tabbed documents (Dreamweaver Macintosh)
Status bar overview
Using toolbars, inspectors, and context menus
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Display toolbars
Use the Document and Standard toolbars to perform document-related and standard editing operations; the Coding
toolbar to insert code quickly; and the Style Rendering toolbar to display your page as it would appear in different
media types. You can choose to display or hide the toolbars as necessary.
Select View > Toolbars, and then select the toolbar.
Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) any of the toolbars and select the toolbar from the context
menu.
Note: To display or hide the Coding toolbar in the Code inspector (Window > Code Inspector), select Coding Toolbar from
the View Options pop-up menu at the top of the inspector.
Use the Property inspector
The Property inspector lets you examine and edit the most common properties for the currently selected page element,
such as text or an inserted object. The contents of the Property inspector vary depending on the element(s) selected.
To access help for a particular Property inspector, click the help button in the upper right corner of the Property
inspector, or select Help from a Property inspector’s Options menu.
Note: Use the Tag inspector to view and edit every attribute associated with a given tag’s properties.
Show or hide the Property inspector
Select Window > Properties.
Expand or collapse the Property inspector
Click the expander arrow in the lower-right corner of the Property inspector.
39
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
View and change properties for a page element
1Select the page element in the Document window.
You might have to expand the Property inspector to view all the properties for the selected element.
2Change any of the properties in the Property inspector.
Note: For information on specific properties, select an element in the Document window, and then click the Help icon
in the upper-right corner of the Property inspector.
3If your changes are not immediately applied in the Document window, apply the changes in one of these ways:
Click outside the property-editing text fields.
Press Enter (Windows) or Return (Macintosh).
Press Tab to switch to another property.
Use context menus
Context menus provide convenient access to the most useful commands and properties related to the object or window
youre working with. Context menus list only those commands that pertain to the current selection.
1Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the object or window.
2Select a command from the context menu.
40
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
More Help topics
Document toolbar overview
Standard toolbar overview
Coding toolbar overview
Style Rendering toolbar overview
Property inspector overview
Set text properties in the Property inspector
Dock and undock panels
Change attributes with the Tag inspector
Use the Insert panel
The Insert panel contains buttons for creating and inserting objects such as tables and images. The buttons are
organized into categories.
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Hide or show the Insert panel
Select Window > Insert.
Note: If you are working with certain types of files, such as XML, JavaScript, Java, and CSS, the Insert panel and the
Design view option are dimmed because you cannot insert items into these code files.
Show the buttons in a particular category
Select the category name from the Category pop-up menu. For example, to show buttons for the Layout category,
select Layout.
Display the pop-up menu for a button
Click the down arrow beside the buttons icon.
41
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
Insert an object
1Select the appropriate category from the Category pop-up menu of the Insert panel.
2Do one of the following:
Click an object button or drag the buttons icon into the Document window (into Design, Live, or Code View).
Click the arrow on a button, then select an option from the menu.
42
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
Depending on the object, a corresponding object-insertion dialog box may appear, prompting you to browse to
a file or specify parameters for an object. Or, Dreamweaver may insert code into the document, or open a tag
editor or a panel for you to specify information before the code is inserted.
For some objects, no dialog box appears if you insert the object in Design view, but a tag editor appears if you
insert the object in Code view. For a few objects, inserting the object in Design view causes Dreamweaver to
switch to Code view before inserting the object.
Note: Some objects, such as named anchors, are not visible when the page is viewed in a browser window. You can
display icons in Design view that mark the locations of such invisible objects.
More Help topics
Insert elements directly in Live View
Bypass the object-insertion dialog box and insert an empty placeholder
object
Control-click (Windows) or Option-click (Macintosh) the button for the object.
For example, to insert a placeholder for an image without specifying an image file, Control-click or Option-click the
Image button.
Note: This procedure does not bypass all object-insertion dialog boxes. Many objects, including AP elements and
framesets, do not insert placeholders or default-valued objects.
Modify preferences for the Insert panel
1Select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh).
2In the General category of the Preferences dialog box, deselect Show Dialog When Inserting Objects to suppress
dialog boxes when you insert objects such as images, tables, scripts, and head elements or by holding down the
Control key (Windows) or the Option key (Macintosh) while creating the object.
When you insert an object with this option off, the object is given default attribute values. Use the Property inspector
to change object properties after inserting the object.
Add, delete, or manage items in the Favorites category of the Insert panel
1Select any category in the Insert panel.
2Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) in the area where the buttons appear, and then select
Customize Favorites.
3In the Cutomize Favorite Objects dialog box, make changes as necessary, and click OK.
To add an object, select an object in the Available Objects pane on the left, and then click the arrow between the
two panes or double-click the object in the Available Objects pane.
Note: You can add one object at a time. You cannot select a category name, such as Common, to add an entire category
to your favorites list.
To delete an object or separator, select an object in the Favorite Objects pane on the right, and then click the
Remove Selected Object in Favorite Objects List button above the pane.
To move an object, select an object in the Favorite Objects pane on the right, and then click the Up or Down
arrow button above the pane.
43
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
To add a separator below an object, select an object in the Favorite Objects pane on the right, and then click the
Add Separator button below the pane.
4If youre not in the Favorites category of the Insert panel, select that category to see your changes.
Insert objects using buttons in the Favorites category
Select the Favorites category from the Category pop-up menu of the Insert panel, and then click the button for any
Favorites object that you added.
Display the Insert panel as a horizontal Insert bar
Unlike other panels in Dreamweaver, you can drag the Insert panel out of its default dock position and drop it into a
horizontal position at the top of the Document window. When you do so, it changes from a panel to a toolbar (though
you cannot hide and display it in the same way as other toolbars).
1Click the Insert panel’s tab and drag it to the top of the Document window.
2When you see a horizontal blue line across the top of the Document window, drop the Insert panel into position.
Note: The horizontal Insert bar is also a default part of the Classic workspace. To switch to the Classic workspace, select
Classic from the workspace switcher in the Application bar.
Return the horizontal Insert bar to a panel group
1Click the horizontal Insert bar’s gripper (on the left side of the Insert bar) and drag the bar to the place where your
panels are docked.
44
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
2Position the Insert panel and drop it. A blue line indicates where you can drop the panel.
Show horizontal Insert bar categories as tabs
Click the arrow beside the category name on the left end of the horizontal Insert bar, and then select Show as Tabs.
Show horizontal Insert bar categories as a menu
Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) a category tab in the horizontal Insert bar, and then select
Show as Menus.
More Help topics
Insert panel overview
Edit tags with Tag editors
Select and view elements in the Document window
CSS Designer panel
CSS Designer panel (Windows > CSS Designer) is a CSS Property Inspector that lets you 'visually' create CSS styles,
files, and set properties, along with media queries.
Watch v ide o
Use the visual CSS editor in Dreamweaver (8 min)
45
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: You can use Ctrl/Cmd+ Z to undo or Ctrl/Cmd + Y to redo all actions you perform in CSS Designer. The changes
are automatically reflected in Live View and the relevant CSS file is also refreshed. To let you know that the related file has
changed, the affected files tab is highlighted for a while (around 8 seconds).
The CSS Designer panel consists of the following panes and options:
All Lists all the CSS, media queries, and selectors in the current document. This mode is not sensitive to the selection.
This means, when you select an element on the page, the associated selector, media query, or CSS are not highlighted
in CSS Designer.
Use this option to begin with creating your selectors or media queries.
Current Lists all the computed styles for any selected element in Design or Live view of the current document. When
you use this mode for a CSS file in Code view, all the properties for the selector in focus are displayed.
Use this option to edit the properties of selectors associated with selected elements in the document.
Sources Lists all the CSS style sheets associated with the document. Using this pane, you can create and attach a CSS
to the document, or define styles within the document.
@Media Lists all the media queries in the source selected in the Sources pane. If you do not select a specific CSS, this
pane displays all the media queries associated with the document.
Selectors Lists all the selectors in the source selected in the Sources pane. If you also select a media query, this pane
narrows down the list of selectors for that media query. If no CSS or media queries are selected, this pane displays all
the selectors in the document.
When you select Global in the @Media pane, all the selectors that are not included in a media query of the selected
source are displayed.
Properties Displays properties that you can set for the specified selector. For more information, see Set properties .
CSS Designer is context-sensitive. This means, for any given context or selected page element, you can view the
associated selectors and properties. Further, when you select a selector in CSS Designer, the associated source and
media queries are highlighted in the respective panes.
Note: When you select a page element, 'Computed' is selected in the Selectors pane. Click a selector to view the associated
source, media query, or properties.
To view all the selectors, you can choose All Sources in the Sources pane. To view selectors that do not belong to any
media query in the selected source, click Global in the @Media pane.
More Help topics
Laying out pages with CSS
CSS3 transition effects
More Help topics
Add style to web pages with the CSS Designer panel
More Help topics
Using the CSS Designer panel
46
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
Create and attach style sheets
1In the Sources pane of the CSS Designer panel, click , and then click one of the following options:
Create a New CSS File: To create and attach a new CSS file to the document
Attach Existing CSS File: To attach an existing CSS file to the document
Define in Page: To define a CSS within the document
Based on the option you choose, Create A New CSS File or Attach Existing CSS File dialog boxes appear.
2Click Browse to specify the name of the CSS file and, if you are creating a CSS, the location to save the new file.
3Do one of the following:
Click Link to link the Dreamweaver document with the CSS file
Click Import to import the CSS file into the document.
4(Optional) Click Conditional Usage and specify the media query that you want to associate with the CSS file.
Define media queries
1In the CSS Designer panel, click a CSS Source in the Sources pane.
2Click in the @Media pane to add a new media query.
The Define Media Query dialog box appears and lists all the media query conditions supported by Dreamweaver.
3Select the Conditions as per your requirements. For detailed information on the media queries, see this article.
Ensure that you specify valid values for all the conditions you select. Else, corresponding media queries do not get
created successfully.
Note: Only 'And' operation is supported currently for multiple conditions.
If you add media query conditions through code, only the supported conditions are populated in the Define Media
Query dialog box. The Code text box in the dialog box, however, displays the code completely (including unsupported
conditions).
If you click on a media query in the Design/Live view, the viewport switches to match the selected media query. To view
the full size viewport, click Global in the @Media pane.
Define CSS Selectors
1In the CSS Designer, select a CSS source in the Sources pane or a media query in the @Media pane.
2In the Selectors pane, click . Based on the element selected in the document, CSS Designer smartly identifies and
prompts you with the relevant selector (upto three rules).
You can do one or more of the following:
Use the up or down arrow keys to make the suggested selector more specific or less specific.
Delete the suggested rule and type the required selector. Ensure that you type the name of the selector along with
the denotion for the Selector Type. For example, if you are specifying an ID, prefix the name of the selector with
a '#'.
To search for a specific selector, use the search box at the top of the pane.
To rename a selector, click the selector, and type the required name.
To reorganize the selectors, drag the selectors to the required position.
47
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
To move a selector from one source to another, drag the selector to the required source in the Source pane.
To duplicate a selector in the selected source, right-click the selector, and click Duplicate.
To duplicate a selector and add it into a media query, right-click the selector, hover the mouse over Duplicate Into
Media Query, and then choose the media query.
Note: The Duplicate Into Media Query option is available only when the source of the selected Selector contains
media queries. You cannot duplicate a Selector from one source into a media query of another source.
Copy-paste styles
You can now copy styles from one selector and paste into another. You can copy all styles or copy only specific category
of styles such as Layout, Text, and Border.
Right-click a selector and choose from the available options:
If a selector has no styles, Copy and Copy All Styles are disabled.
Paste Styles is disabled for remote sites that cannot be edited. But Copy and Copy All styles is available.
Pasting Styles that already exist partially on a selector (Overlapping) works. Union of all the selectors is pasted.
Copy-paste Styles also works for different linkages of CSS files – Import, Link, Inline Styles.
Set CSS properties
The properties are grouped into the following categories and are represented by different icons at the top of the
Properties pane:
Layout
Text
Border
Background
Others (list of 'text only' properties and not properties with visual controls)
Note: Before editing the properties of a CSS Selector, identify the elements associated with the CSS Selector using Reverse
Inspect. By doing so, you can evaluate if all the elements highlighted during Reverse Inspect actually require the changes.
See link for more information on Reverse Inspect.
48
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
Select the Show Set check box to view only the set properties. To view all the properties that you can specify for a
selector, deselect the Show Set check box.
To set a property, such as, width or border-collapse, click the required options displayed adjacent to the property in the
Properties pane. For information on setting gradient background or box controls such as margins, padding, and
position, see the following links:
Overridden properties are indicated using a strikethrough format.
More Help topics
Set margins, padding, and position
Apply gradients to background
Use Flexible Box layouts
Set margins, padding, and position
Using the box controls in CSS Designer's Properties pane, you can quickly set the margins, padding, and position
properties. If you prefer code, you can specify shorthand code for margin and padding in the quick edit boxes.
Click the values and type the required value. If you want all the four values to be the same and changed simultaneously,
click the link icon ( )at the center.
At any point in time, you can disable ( ) or delete ( ) specific values, for example, left margin value while retaining
the right, top, and bottom values.
49
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
Set border properties
Border Control properties are organized into logical tabs to help you quickly view or modify the properties.
If you prefer code, you can specify shorthand code for borders and border radius in the quick edit text box.
To specify the Border Control properties, first set the properties in the 'All Sides' tab. The other tabs are then enabled
and the properties set in the 'All Sides' tab are reflected for individual borders.
When you change a property in the individual border tabs, the value of the corresponding property in the 'All Sides'
tab changes to 'undefined' (default value).
In the example below, the border color was set to black and then changed to red for the Top border.
50
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
Border color set to black for all sides
51
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
The code that is inserted is based on the preference setting for shorthand or longhand.
Delete and disable controls are available for individual properties as before Dreamweaver CC 2014. Now, you can use
the delete and disable controls at the Border Control group level to apply these actions to all the properties.
During Inspect, the tabs are focused based on the priority of the "set" tabs. The highest priority is for "All sides" tab
followed by "Top", "Right", "Bottom" and "Left". For example, if only the top value for a border is set, the computed mode
takes the focus to the "Top" tab ignoring the "All sides" tab because "All sides" tab is not set.
Disable or delete properties
The CSS Designer panel lets you disable or delete each property. The following screenshot shows the disable ( ) and
delete ( ) icons for the width property. These icons are visible when you hover your mouse on the property.
Keyboard shortcuts
You can add or delete CSS selectors and properties using keyboard shortcuts. You can also navigate between the
property groups in the Properties pane.
Shortcut Workflow
CTRL + Alt +[Shift =] Adds Selector (If control is in the selector section)
CTRL + Alt+ S Add Selector (If control is anywhere in the application)
CTRL + Alt +[Shift =] Adds Property (If control is in the property section)
52
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
Identify page elements associated with a CSS Selector (13.1)
Most often, a single CSS Selector is associated with multiple page elements. For example, text in the main content of a
page, header, and footer text can all be associated with the same CSS Selector. When you edit the properties of the CSS
Selector, all the elements associated with the Selector are affected, including the ones that you do not intend to change.
Live Highlight helps you identify all the elements associated with a CSS Selector. If you want to change only one elment
or some of the elements, you can create a new CSS Selector for those elements, and then edit the properties.
To identify the page elements associated with a CSS Selector, hover your mouse over the Selector in Live View (with
Live Code 'off '). Dreamweaver highlights the associated elements with dotted lines.
To lock-in the highlight for the elements, click the Selector. The elements now are highlighted with a blue border.
CTRL + Alt+ P Adds Property (If control is anywhere in the application)
Select + Delete Deletes selector, if selector is selected
CTRL + Alt + (PgUp/PgDn) Jump between sections while in the properties subpanel
53
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
To remove the blue highlight around the elements, the Selector again.
Note: The following table summarizes the scenarios where Live Highlight is not available.
Disable Live Highlight
Live Highlight is enabled by default. To disable Live Highlight, click Live View options in Document Toolbar and click
Disable Live Highlight.
DOM panel
The DOM panel renders an interactive HTML tree for static and dynamic content. This view helps you visually map
elements in Live View with their HTML markup and the applied selectors in CSS Designer. You can also make edits to
the HTML structure in the DOM panel and see the changes take effect instantly in Live View.
Step-by-step tutorial
How to visualize and visually modify your HTML structure in Dreamweaver (30 min)
To open the DOM panel, select Window > DOM. You can also use the keyboard keys - Ctrl + / (Win); Cmd + / (Mac)
- to open the DOM panel.
When you drag elments to directly insert them in Live View, the </> icon appears before you drop the element. You can
click this icon to open the DOM panel and insert the element at the appropriate position in the document structure.
For more information, see Inserting elements directly in Live View .
The DOM panel displays only static elements in Code or Design view, and both static and dynamic elements in Live
view.
In fluid grid documents, the DOM panel only lets you visualize the HTML DOM structure and does not let you edit
the HTML structure.
Note: You can edit only the static content in the DOM panel. Read-only or dynamic elements are shown in a darker shade
of grey.
Mode Live Code Live Highlight displayed?
Code NA NA
Design NA NA
Live ON (button is pressed) No
OFF Yes
54
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
You can move around the DOM panel and place it at any convenient location on the user interface. You can also dock
the panel along with other panels.
How to use the DOM panel
1Open the required document and then open the DOM panel by selecting Window > DOM.
2Switch to Live view and click the element that you want to inspect or edit.
The HTML markup of the selected element is highlighted in the DOM panel.
The applied selector is highlighted in CSS Designer.
The relevant code is highlighted in the Code view.
The relevant tag is highlighted (in blue) in Tag Selector.
Alternatively, you can select an HTML element in the DOM panel. When you click any element in the DOM panel:
Live View scrolls to the corresponding element.
If Code View is open, the Code View scrolls to the code corresponding to the element.
CSS Designer (Selectors pane) scrolls to the closest corresponding selector (similar to you clicking the element
in Live View).
The tag is highlighted in the Tag Selector.
This syncing between different views and CSS Designer lets you visualize the HTML markup and styling associated
with the selected element at a glance.
3Proceed to edit the element as required (HTML or CSS editing). For information on using the DOM panel to edit
the HTML markup, see Edit HTML structure using the DOM panel . For information on CSS Designer, see CSS
Designer panel.
55
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
Edit HTML structure using the DOM panel
The current selected element on the page is highlighted in the DOM panel. You can navigate to any node or element
using the arrow keys.
To select an element or a node, click the element or node. To expand or collapse an element or a node, click the
HTML tag or double-click the selector adjacent to the tag.
To duplicate an element or a node, right-click the element or the node, and click Duplicate. When you duplicate an
element with an ID associated with it, the ID is incremented for the new (duplicate) element.
To copy an element or a node, right-click the element or the node, and click Copy. If you have copied an element
with children, the child elements are also copied.
To paste an element or a node, click the element or the node under which you want to nest the copied elements.
Then, right-click the element or the node and click Paste.
To paste the copied element as a child of a specific element or node, right-click the element or node (parent), and
then click Paste As Child.
To move or rearrange elements, drag the element to the required location within the DOM panel.
A green line appears to indicate where the dragged element will be positioned. If you drop the element over the element
highlighted in gray (reference element), then the dropped element is positioned as the first child of the reference
element.
To delete an element or a node, right-click the element or the node, and click Delete.
You can undo (Ctrl/Cmd + Z) or redo (Ctrl/Cmd + Y) the operations that you perform in the DOM panel.
Keyboard shortcuts:
Duplicate - Ctrl + D (Win)/ Cmd + D (Mac)
Delete - Del or Backspace
Copy - Ctrl + C (Win)/Cmd + C (Mac)
Paste - Ctrl + V (Win)/Cmd + V (Mac)
Undo - Ctrl + Z (Win)/Cmd + Z (Mac)
Redo - Ctrl + Y (Win)/Cmd + Y (Mac)
Note: Typically, when a page is edited, the Refresh button in the Document toolbar changes to Stop button indicating that
the page is reloading. After the page is reloaded, the Refresh button appears again to indicate that the page has completely
loaded. When you make changes in the DOM panel, the page may take a while to reload even after the Refresh button
appears back again after changing to Stop button.
56
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
A Location where the dragged element is placed B Reference element C Element being moved
Important: If your page contains JavaScript, the right-click menu in the DOM panel gets displayed for a while and then
becomes unavailable. To use the right-click menu, hide the Live View displays (Live View options > Hide Live View
Displays), and then disable JavaScript (Live View options > Disable JavaScript).
Search files based on filename or content | Mac OS
This feature is available only for Mac OS.
57
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
Use Live Search to locate files based on filename or text present in files. The site selected in the Files panel is used for
search. If there is no site selected in the panel, the search option does not appear.
Live Search uses the Spotlight API in Mac OS. Any customization that you apply to Spotlight preferences is also used
for Live Search. Spotlight displays all files on your computer that match your search query. Live Search searches files in
the local root folder of the site currently selected in the Files panel.
1Select Edit > Live Search. Alternatively, use CMD+SHIFT+F. The focus is set to the Live Search text box in Files
Panel.
2Enter the word or phrase in the text box. The results are displayed as you enter text in the text box.
Matching files Displays a maximum of 10 filenames that match your search criteria. The message More Than 10
Results Found is displayed if there are more than 10 matching files. Refine your search criteria if you do not find
your desired file in the options displayed.
Matching Text In Displays a maximum of 10 files that contain text matching the word or phrase you entered. For
more options, click Find All. The results are displayed in the Search panel.
3When you move the mouse cursor over a search result, a tool tip with the root-relative path of the file is displayed.
Press Enter, or click the item to open the file.
For files containing matching text, the first instance of the text is highlighted. Use Cmd+G to navigate to other
instances.
Note: To close the Live Search results panel, click outside the panel, or press Escape / Esc
Zoom in and out
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Dreamweaver lets you increase the magnification (zoom in) in the Document window so that you can check the pixel
accuracy of graphics, select small items more easily, design pages with small text, design large pages, and so on.
Note: The zooming tools are only available in Design view.
Zoom in or out on a page
1Click the Zoom tool (the magnifying glass icon) in the lower-right corner of the Document window.
2Do one of the following:
Click the spot on the page you want to magnify until you’ve achieved the desired magnification.
Drag a box over the area on the page that you want to zoom in on and release the mouse button.
Select a preset magnification level from the Zoom pop-up menu.
Type a magnification level in the Zoom text box.
You can also zoom in without using the Zoom tool by pressing Control+= (Windows) or Command+= (Macintosh).
3To zoom out (reduce magnification), select the Zoom tool, press Alt (Windows) or Option (Macintosh) and
click on the page.
You can also zoom out without using the Zoom tool by pressing Control+- (Windows) or Command+- (Macintosh).
58
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
Edit a page after zooming
Click the Select tool (the pointer icon) in the lower-right corner of the Document window, and click inside the page.
Pan a page after zooming
1Click the Hand tool (the hand icon) in the lower-right corner of the Document window.
2Drag the page.
Fill the Document window with a selection
1Select an element on the page.
2Select View > Fit Selection.
Fill the Document window with an entire page
Select View > Fit All.
Fill the Document window with the entire width of a page
Select View > Fit Width.
More Help topics
Status bar overview
Keyboard shortcuts
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Create a reference sheet for the current shortcut set
A reference sheet is a record of the current shortcut set. The information is stored in HTML table format. You can view
the reference sheet in a web browser or print it.
1Select Edit > Keyboard Shortcuts (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Keyboard Shortcuts (Macintosh).
2Click the Export Set As HTML button, which is the third button in the set of four at the top of the dialog box.
3In the Save dialog box that appears, enter the name for the reference sheet, and select the appropriate location for
saving the file.
Customize keyboard shortcuts
Use the Keyboard Shortcut Editor to create your own shortcut keys, including keyboard shortcuts for code snippets.
You can also remove shortcuts, edit existing shortcuts, and select a predetermined set of shortcuts in the Keyboard
Shortcut Editor.
59
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
Create a keyboard shortcut
Create your own shortcut keys, edit existing shortcuts, or select a predetermined set of shortcuts.
1Select Edit > Keyboard Shortcuts (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Keyboard Shortcuts (Macintosh).
2Set any of the following options and click OK:
Current Set Allows you to choose a set of predetermined shortcuts included with Dreamweaver, or any custom set
you’ve defined. The predetermined sets are listed at the top of the menu. For example, if you are familiar with the
shortcuts found in HomeSite or BBEdit, you can use those shortcuts by choosing the corresponding predetermined
set.
Commands Allows you to select a category of commands to edit. For example, you can edit menu commands, such
as the Open command, or code editing commands, such as Balance Braces.
To add or edit a keyboard shortcut for a code snippet, select Snippet from the Commands pop-up menu.
The command list Displays the commands associated with the category you selected from the Commands pop-up
menu, along with the assigned shortcuts. The Menu Commands category displays this list as a tree view that
replicates the structure of the menus. The other categories list the commands by name (such as Quit Application),
in a flat list.
Shortcuts Displays all shortcuts assigned to the selected command.
Add Item (+) Adds a new shortcut to the current command. Click this button to add a new blank line to the
Shortcuts. Enter a new key combination and click Change to add a new keyboard shortcut for this command. You
can assign two different keyboard shortcuts for each command; if there are already two shortcuts assigned to a
command, the Add Item button does nothing.
Remove Item (-) Removes the selected shortcut from the list of shortcuts.
Press Key Displays the key combination you enter when youre adding or changing a shortcut.
Change Adds the key combination shown in the Press Key to the list of shortcuts, or changes the selected shortcut
to the specified key combination.
Duplicate Set Duplicates the current set. Give the new set a name; the default name is the current sets name with
the word copy appended.
Rename Set Renames the current set.
Export as HTML File Saves the current set in an HTML table format for easy viewing and printing. You can open the
HTML file in your browser and print the shortcuts for easy reference.
Delete Set Deletes a set. (You cannot delete the active set.)
Remove a shortcut from a command
1Select Edit > Keyboard Shortcuts (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Keyboard Shortcuts (Macintosh).
2From the Commands pop-up menu, select a command category.
3In the Commands list, select a command and then select a shortcut.
4Click the Remove Item (-) button.
Add a shortcut to a command
1Select Edit > Keyboard Shortcuts (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Keyboard Shortcuts (Macintosh).
2From the Commands pop-up menu, select a command category.
60
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
3In the Commands list, select a command.
To add a keyboard shortcut for a code snippet, select Snippet from the Commands pop-up menu.
The shortcuts assigned to the command appear in the Shortcuts.
4Prepare to add a shortcut by doing one of the following:
If there are fewer than two shortcuts already assigned to the command, click the Add Item (+) button. A new
blank line appears in the Shortcuts and the insertion point moves to the Press Key.
If there are already two shortcuts assigned to the command, select one of them (that one will be replaced by the
new shortcut). Then click in the Press Key.
5Press a key combination. The key combination appears in the Press Key.
Note: If there is a problem with the key combination (for example, if the key combination is already assigned to another
command), an explanatory message appears just below the Shortcuts and you may be unable to add or edit the shortcut.
6Click Change. The new key combination is assigned to the command.
Edit an existing shortcut
1Select Edit > Keyboard Shortcuts (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Keyboard Shortcuts (Macintosh).
2From the Commands pop-up menu, select a command category.
3In the Commands list, select a command and then select a shortcut to change.
4Click in the Press Key and enter a new key combination.
5Click the Change button to change the shortcut.
Note: If there is a problem with the key combination (for example, if the key combination is already assigned to another
command), an explanatory message appears just below the Shortcuts field and you may be unable to add or edit the
shortcut.
About keyboard shortcuts and non-U.S. keyboards
The default Dreamweaver keyboard shortcuts work primarily on U.S.-standardized keyboards. Keyboards from other
countries (including those produced in the United Kingdom), may not provide the functionality necessary for utilizing
these shortcuts. If your keyboard does not support certain Dreamweaver-enabled shortcuts, Dreamweaver disables
their functionality.
To customize keyboard shortcuts that work with non-U.S.-standardized keyboards, see “Changing keyboard shortcut
mappings in Extending Dreamweaver.
More Help topics
Work with code snippets
Optimizing the workspace for visual development
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
61
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
Displaying web-application development panels
Select the Data category from the Category pop-up menu of the Insert panel to display a set of buttons that let you add
dynamic content and server behaviors to your page.
The number and type of buttons that appear vary depending upon the document type opened in the Document
window. Move your mouse over an icon to display a tooltip that describes what that button does.
The Insert panel includes buttons to add the following items to the page:
Recordsets
Dynamic text or tables
Record navigation bars
If you switch to Code view (View > Code), additional panels might appear in their own Insert panel category,
allowing you to insert code in the page. For example, if you view a ColdFusion page in Code view, a CFML panel
becomes available in the CFML category of the Insert panel.
Several panels provide ways for you to create dynamic pages:
Select the Bindings panel (Window > Bindings) to define sources of dynamic content for your page and add the
content to the page.
Select the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors) to add server-side logic to your dynamic pages.
Select the Databases panel (Window >Databases) to explore databases or create database connections.
Select the Components panel (Window > Components) to inspect, add, or modify code for ColdFusion
components.
Note: The Components panel is enabled only if you open a ColdFusion page.
A server behavior is the set of instructions inserted in a dynamic page at design time and executed on the server at run
time.
For a tutorial on setting up the development workspace, see www.adobe.com/go/vid0144.
View your database within Dreamweaver
After connecting to your database, you can view its structure and data within Dreamweaver.
1Open the Databases panel (Window > Databases).
The Databases panel displays all the databases for which you created connections. If youre developing a ColdFusion
site, the panel displays all the databases that have data sources defined in the ColdFusion Administrator.
Note: Dreamweaver looks at the ColdFusion server you defined for the current site.
If no database appears in the panel, you must create a database connection.
2To display the tables, stored procedures, and views in the database, click the Plus (+) sign beside a connection in the
list.
3To display the columns in the table, click a table name.
The column icons reflect the data type and indicate the primary key of the table.
4To view the data in a table, right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the table name in the list, and select
View Data from the pop-up menu.
62
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
Previewing dynamic pages in a browser
Web application developers often debug their pages by checking them often in a web browser. You can quickly view
dynamic pages in a browser without first manually uploading them to a server (press F12).
To preview dynamic pages, you must complete the Testing Server category of the Site Definition dialog box.
You can specify that Dreamweaver use temporary files instead of the original files. With this option, Dreamweaver runs
a temporary copy of the page on a web server before displaying it in your browser. (Dreamweaver then deletes the
temporary file from the server.) To set this option, select Edit > Preferences > Preview In Browser.
The Preview In Browser option does not upload related pages such as a results or a detail page, dependent files such as
image files, or server-side includes. To upload a missing file, select Window > Site to open the Site panel, select the file
under Local Folder, and click the blue up arrow in the toolbar to copy the file to the web server folder.
Restrict database information displayed in Dreamweaver
Advanced users of large database systems like Oracle should restrict the number of database items retrieved and
displayed by Dreamweaver at design time. An Oracle database may contain items that Dreamweaver cannot process at
design time. You can create a schema in Oracle and use it in Dreamweaver to filter out unnecessary items at design time.
Note: You cannot create a schema or catalog in Microsoft Access.
Other users may benefit from restricting the amount of information Dreamweaver retrieves at design time. Some
databases contain dozens or even hundreds of tables, and you might prefer not to list them all while you work. A schema
or catalog can restrict the number of database items that are retrieved at design time.
You must create a schema or catalog in your database system before you can apply it in Dreamweaver. Consult your
database system documentation or your system administrator.
Note: You cannot apply a schema or catalog in Dreamweaver if youre developing a ColdFusion application, or using
Microsoft Access.
1Open a dynamic page in Dreamweaver; then open the Databases panel (Window > Databases).
If the database connection exists, right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the connection in the list,
and select Edit Connection from the pop-up menu.
If the connection does not exist, click the Plus (+) button at the top of the panel and create it.
2In the dialog box for the connection, click Advanced.
3Specify your schema or catalog, and click OK.
Set the Property inspector for ColdFusion stored procedures and ASP
commands
Modify the selected stored procedure. The available options vary depending on the server technology.
Edit any of the options. When you select a new option in the inspector, Dreamweaver updates the page.
Input Name options
This Property inspector appears when Dreamweaver encounters an unrecognized input type. Typically this occurs
because of a typing or other data entry error.
63
Last updated 6/3/2015
Workspace and workflow
If you change the field type in the Property inspector to a value that Dreamweaver recognizes—for example, if you
correct the spelling error—the Property inspector updates to show the properties for the recognized type. Set any of the
following options in the Property inspector:
Input Name Assigns a name to the field. This box is required, and the name must be unique.
Type Sets the input type of the field. The contents of this box reflect the input type value that currently appears in your
HTML source code.
Value Sets the value of the field.
Parameters Opens the Parameters dialog box so you can view the current attributes of the field, as well as add or
remove attributes.
More Help topics
Development workspace tutorial
Set up a testing server
CEF integration
Dreamweaver is now integrated with the Chromium Embedded Framework (CEF), an open source framework
based on the Google Chromium project. This integration enables Dreamweaver to control resource loading,
navigation, context menus, printing and more, while taking advantage of the same performance and HTML5
technologies available in the Google Chrome Web browser.
Dreamweaver is integrated with CEF3 version, which is a multi-process implementation using asynchronous
messaging to communicate between Dreamweaver and one or more rendering processes (Webkit + V8 engine).
CEF3 uses Chromiums official Chromium content API and thus provides performance similar to Google Chrome.
For more information on CEF, see this article.
Here are the Dreamweaver features that are affected by the CEF integration:
Enhanced user experience
Rendering enhancements
Inspect
Codec
Pop-up menus
64
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
Error messages
Zoom/Scroll
Fluid Grid pages
Architectural changes
Code Navigator
Navigation
SSL Certificate
Live Code/Code View
External CSS
Dynamically Related Files
Live View options
Viewport
Enhanced user experience
Rendering enhancements
With CEF integration, many enhancements have been done to the way Dreamweaver renders objects and other UI
elements.
The following illustrations show how a div with border radius and gradient repeat is rendered in the old Apollo Webkit
and after CEF integration.
Inspect
The new inspect mode is the same as Google Chromes inspect. The “Margin” is marked in yellow and the “Padding
in purple. A set of horizontal and vertical rulers appear when you hover your mouse over the elements. The rulers
appear at top/bottom and left/right, based on the position of the element. The rulers show the value of the margin,
padding, width, and border properties applied to the element.
In addition, a tool tip with the following information also appears:
The name of the element (for example, div)
CSS class or ID, if defined.
The dimension of the element. The number shown is the sum of the width, padding, and the border applied to that
element.
65
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
Codec
Pop-up support
With CEF integration, Dreamweaver can now render HTML5 form elements such as month, date, and time. When you
click these controls, Dreamweaver now displays pop-up menus that you can use to select the required parameter.
Fluid Grid pages
When the FG Layout guides are turned OFF, Live view uses CEF Webkit for rendering. Fluid Grid pages in Live view
with FG Layout guides ON continues to use the old Apollo Webkit for rendering. Live view features such as Navigation
(address bar), Inspect Mode, and Live Code are available only in the CEF mode.
Error strings
The appearance of error strings in Dreamweaver now is the same as those in Google Chrome.
Video Audio
Theora mp3
h264 wav
ogg Vorbis
ogv pcm-u8
mp4 pcm_s16le
mov pcm_s24le
66
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
Zoom/Scroll
UI for scroll bars are different in Live view and Design view.
Zoom behavior in Dreamweaver is changed with CEF integration. Earlier, the Zoom was per tab and now in CEF live
view, Zoom is per page.
Scenario 1: Suppose that you Zoom a page to 300% in Live view. You then open the same page from a different tab
(follow links and reach this page). Then:
In CEF, the page retains the 300% zoom
In Apollo (older version), the page is rendered in the default 100% zoom
Scenario 2: Suppose that you zoom a page to 50% in a tab (Live view). You then navigate to another page in the same
tab. Then:
In CEF, other pages are opened in the default 100% zoom
In Apollo, all pages navigated to from this tab retain 50% zoom
Architectural changes
Code navigator
Code Navigator parses the document and lists all the styles applicable to the called element. It uses Browser control to
render the contents. When you hover your mouse; on any of the selectors, all the associated CSS properties are shown
as tool tip. When you click a selector, the insertion point is taken to the corresponding code.
SSL certificate
When you try to navigate to a secure (https) site, whose certificate is not recognized, then SSL certificate confirmation
dialog appears.
67
Workspace and workflow
Last updated 6/3/2015
Others
The following features are impacted due to CEF integration:
Dynamically Related Files
External CSS
Live View and Live Code sync
Navigation
Live View options (Follow links”,Follow Links Continuously,Use Testing Server For Document Source”, "Disable
javascript", "Freeze javascript")
Viewport
Target attribute for links
Context menu (The Follow Link and Disable Plugins options are removed from the right-click menu of a link)
Note: Due to CEF integration, the way you use <mm:browsercontrol> while developing extensions requires a change.
See this article for detailed information.
68
Last updated 6/3/2015
Chapter 3: Site management
About Dreamweaver sites
A Adobe Dreamweaver site is a collection of all of the files and assets in your website. You can create web pages on your
computer, upload them to a web server, and maintain the site by transferring updated files whenever you save them.
You can also edit and maintain websites that were created without Dreamweaver.
What is a Dreamweaver “site”?
In Dreamweaver the term “site” refers to a local or remote storage location for the documents that belong to a website.
A Dreamweaver site provides a way to organize and manage all of your web documents, upload your site to a web server,
track and maintain your links, and manage and share files. You should define a site to take full advantage of
Dreamweaver features.
Note: To define a Dreamweaver site, you only need to set up a local folder. To transfer files to a web server or to develop
web applications, you must also add information for a remote site and testing server.
A Dreamweaver site consists of as many as three parts, or folders, depending on your development environment and
the type of website you are developing:
Local root folder Stores the files you’re working on. Dreamweaver refers to this folder as your “local site. This folder is
typically on your local computer, but it can also be on a network server.
Remote folder Stores your files for testing, production, collaboration, and so on. Dreamweaver refers to this folder as
yourremote site” in the Files panel. Typically, your remote folder is on the computer where your web server is running.
The remote folder holds the files that users access on the Internet.
Together, the local and remote folders enable you to transfer files between your local hard disk and web server, making
it easy to manage files in your Dreamweaver sites. You work on files in the local folder, and then publish them to the
remote folder when you want other people to view them.
Testing server folder The folder where Dreamweaver processes dynamic pages.
For a tutorial on defining a Dreamweaver site, see www.adobe.com/go/learn_dw_comm08_en.
Understanding local and remote folder structure
When you want to use Dreamweaver to connect to a remote folder, you specify the remote folder in the Servers category
of the Site Setup dialog box. The remote folder that you specify (also referred to as the “host directory”) should
correspond to the local root folder of your Dreamweaver site. (The local root folder is the top-level folder of your
Dreamweaver site.) Remote folders, like local folders, can have any title, but commonly, Internet Service Providers
(ISPs) name the top-level remote folders for individual user accounts public_html, pub_html, or something similar. If
you are in charge of your own remote server, and can name the remote folder anything you want, it is a good idea for
your local root folder and remote folder to have the same name.
69
Site management
Last updated 6/3/2015
The following example shows a sample local root folder on the left and a sample remote folder on the right. The local
root folder on the local machine maps directly to the remote folder on the web server, rather than to any of the remote
folder’s sub folders, or folders that exist above the remote folder in the directory structure.
Note: The above example illustrates one local root folder on the local machine, and one top-level remote folder on the
remote web server. If, however, you are maintaining a number of Dreamweaver sites on your local machine, you would need
an equal number of remote folders on the remote server. In such a case the above example would not apply, and you would
instead create different remote folders within the public_html folder, and then map them to their corresponding local root
folders on your local machine.
When you first establish a remote connection, the remote folder on the web server is usually empty. Then, when you
use Dreamweaver to upload all of the files in your local root folder, the remote folder populates with all of your web
files. The directory structure of the remote folder and the local root folder should always be the same. (That is, there
should always be a one-to-one correspondence between the files and folders in your local root folder, and the files and
folders in your remote folder.) If the structure of the remote folder doesn’t match the structure of the local root folder,
Dreamweaver uploads files to the wrong place, where they might not be visible to site visitors. Additionally, image and
link paths can easily break when folder and file structures are not in synch.
The remote folder must exist before Dreamweaver can connect to it. If you don’t have a designated folder that acts as
your remote folder on the web server, create one or ask your ISP’s server administrator to create one for you.
About dynamic sites
Before you begin building dynamic web pages, there are a few preparations that must be done, including setting up a
web application server and connecting to a database for Coldfusion, ASP, and PHP applications. Adobe Dreamweaver
handles database connections differently depending on your server technology.
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
70
Site management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Set up a local version of your site
To set up a local version of your site, all you need to do is specify the local folder where you’ll store all of your site files.
The local folder can be on your local computer or on a network server. You can use the Manage Sites dialog box in
Dreamweaver to set up multiple sites and manage them.
1Identify or create the folder on your computer where you want to store the local version of your site files. (The folder
can be anywhere on your computer.) You’ll specify this folder as your local site in Dreamweaver.
2In Dreamweaver, choose Site > New Site.
3In the Site Setup dialog box, make sure the Site category is selected. (It should be selected by default.)
4In the Site Name text box, enter a name for your site. This name appears in the Files panel and in the Manage Sites
dialog box; it does not appear in the browser.
5In the Local Site Folder text box, specify the folder you identified in step one—the folder on your computer where
you want to store the local version of your site files. You can click the folder icon to the right of the text box to browse
to the folder.
6Click Save to close the Site Setup dialog box. You can now begin working on your local site files in Dreamweaver.
When youre ready, you can fill out the other categories in the Site Setup dialog box, including the Servers category,
where you can specify a remote folder on your remote server.
For a video tutorial on setting up a new Dreamweaver site, click here.
Connect to a remote server
A remote server (often referred to as the web server) is where you publish your site files so that people can view them
online. The remote server is simply another computer like your local computer with a collection of files and folders on
it. For example, an FTP server or a WebDav server.
Youll specify a folder for your site on the remote server, just as you specified a folder for your local site on your local
computer. Dreamweaver refers to the specified remote folder as your remote site.
When you set up a remote folder, you must select a connection method for Dreamweaver to upload and download files
to and from your web server. The most typical connection method is FTP, but Dreamweaver also supports
local/network, FTPS, SFTP, WebDav, and RDS connection methods. If you dont know which connection method to
use, ask your ISP or your server administrator.
Note: Dreamweaver also supports connections to IPv6-enabled servers. Supported connection types include FTP, SFTP,
WebDav, and RDS. For more information, see www.ipv6.org/
More Help topics
Video tutorial: Setup server login details
Setting up a testing server
Getting and putting files to and from your server
Checking in and checking out files
71
Site management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Specify a connection method
FTP connections
Use this setting if you connect to your web server using FTP.
Note: Business Catalyst supports only SFTP. If you are using Business Catalyst, see the section on SFTP connections on
this page.
1Select Site > Manage Sites.
2Click New to set up a new site, or select an existing Dreamweaver site and click the edit icon.
3In the Site Setup dialog box, select the Servers category and do one of the following:
Click the Add New Server button to add a new server
Select an existing server and click the Edit Existing Server button
The following illustration shows the Basic screen of the Server category with the text fields already populated.
4In the Server Name text box, specify a name for the new server. You can choose any name that you require.
5Select FTP from the Connect Using pop-up menu.
6In the FTP Address text box, enter the address of the FTP server to which you upload files for your website.
Your FTP address is the full Internet name of a computer system, such as ftp.mindspring.com. Enter the full address
without any additional text. In particular, don’t add a protocol name in front of the address.
If you do not know your FTP address, contact your web hosting company.
Note: Port 21 is the default port for receiving FTP connections. You can change the default port number by editing the
text box to the right. The result when you save your settings is a colon and the new port number appended to your FTP
address (for example, ftp.mindspring.com:29).
72
Site management
Last updated 6/3/2015
7In the Username and Password text boxes, enter the username and password that you use to connect to the FTP
server.
8Click Test to test your FTP address, username, and password.
Note: You must obtain the FTP address, username and password information from the system administrator for the
company hosting your site. No one else has access to this information. Enter the information exactly as your system
administrator gives it to you.
9Dreamweaver saves your password by default. Deselect the Save option if you prefer that Dreamweaver prompt you
for a password each time you connect to the remote server.
10 In the Root Directory text box, enter the directory (folder) on the remote server where you store documents that are
visible to the public.
If you’re uncertain about what to enter as the root directory, contact the server’s administrator or leave the text box
blank. On some servers, your root directory is the same as the directory you first connect to with FTP. To find out,
connect to the server. If a folder with a name like public_html, or www, or your user name, appears in the Remote
File view in your Files panel, thats probably the directory you should enter in the Root Directory text box.
11 In the Web URL text box enter the URL of your website (for example, http://www.mysite.com). Dreamweaver uses
the Web URL to create site root-relative links, and to verify links when you use the link checker.
For a more extensive explanation of this option, see Advanced Settings category.
12 Expand the More Options section if you still need to set more options.
13 Select Use Passive FTP if your firewall configuration requires use of passive FTP.
Passive FTP enables your local software to set up the FTP connection rather than requesting the remote server to
set it up. If you’re not sure whether you use passive FTP, check with your system administrator, or try both checking
and unchecking the Use Passive FTP option.
For more information, see TechNote 15220 on the Adobe website at www.adobe.com/go/tn_15220.
14 Select Use IPv6 Transfer Mode if you are using an IPv6-enabled FTP server.
With the deployment of version 6 of the Internet Protocol (IPv6), EPRT and EPSV have replaced the FTP commands
PORT and PASV, respectively. Thus, if you are trying to connect to an IPv6-enabled FTP server, you must use the
extended passive (EPSV) and the extended active (EPRT) commands for your data connection.
For more information, see www.ipv6.org/.
15 Select Use Proxy if you want to specify a proxy host or proxy port.
For more information, click the link to go to the Preferences dialog box, and then click the Help button in the Site
category of the Preferences dialog.
16 Click Save to close the Basic screen. Then in the Servers category, specify whether the server you just added or edited
is a remote server, a testing server, or both.
For help with troubleshooting FTP connectivity problems, see TechNote kb405912 on the Adobe website at
www.adobe.com/go/kb405912.
SFTP connections
Use Secure FTP (SFTP) if your server/firewall configuration requires the use of secure FTP. SFTP uses encryption and
identity keys to secure a connection to your remote/testing server.
Note: Your server must be running an SFTP service for you to select this option. If you don’t know whether your server is
running SFTP, check with your server administrator.
73
Site management
Last updated 6/3/2015
You can now authenticate connections to an SFTP server based on an ‘Identity Key’ (with or without a passphrase).
Dreamweaver supports only OpenSSH key files.
1Select Site > Manage Sites.
2Click New to set up a new site, or select an existing Dreamweaver site and click Edit.
3In the Site Setup dialog box, select the Servers category and do one of the following:
Click the Add New Server button to add a new server
Select an existing server and click the Edit Existing Server button
4In the Server Name text box, specify a name for the new server. The name can be anything of your choosing.
5Select SFTP from the Connect Using pop-up menu.
6Specify the other options in the dialog box based on one of the applicable scenarios below:
Scenario 1: No key, but have user name and password
Scenario 2: Have a key that does not require a passphrase
Scenario 3: Have a key that requires a passphrase
Scenario 1
You do not have a key and want to establish an SFTP connection using only the credentials - combination of user name
and password. In this case, use the “Username and Password” authentication method.
1Enter a friendly name for the server.
2From the Connect list, click SFTP, and enter a valid SFTP address and port.
3For the authentication method, click Username and Password, and then provide the user name and password.
To verify the connection, click Test.
74
Site management
Last updated 6/3/2015
4Enter a valid Root Directory.
5Enter a valid Web URL.
6Click Save.
Scenario 2
You have a key that does not require a passphrase. And, you want to establish an SFTP connection using the
combination of user name and Identity File. In this case, use the “Private Key File” authentication method.
1Enter a friendly name for the server.
2From the Connect list, click SFTP, and enter a valid SFTP address and port.
3For the authentication method, click Private Key File, and then provide the following:
User name
A valid Identity File
Leave the Passphrase blank and select Save Passphrase
Note: Dreamweaver supports only OpenSSH key files.
To verify the connection, click Test.
4Enter a valid Root Directory.
5Enter a valid Web URL.
6Click Save.
Scenario 3
You h ave a k e y t h a t requires a passphrase. And, you want to establish an SFTP connection using the combination of
user name, Identity File, and the Passphrase for the key. In this case, use the “Private Key File” authentication method.
75
Site management
Last updated 6/3/2015
1Enter a friendly name for the server.
2From the Connect list, click SFTP, and enter a valid SFTP address and port.
3For the authentication method, click Private Key File, and then provide the following:
User name
A valid Identity File
Passphrase for the Identity File
Note: Dreamweaver supports only OpenSSH key files.
To verify the connection, click Test.
4Enter a valid Root Directory.
5Enter a valid Web URL.
6Click Save.
Note: Port 22 is the default port for receiving SFTP connections.
The rest of the options are the same as the options for FTP connections. See the above section for more information.
FTPS connections
FTPS (FTP over SSL) provides both encryption and authentication support as compared to SFTP that offers only
encryption support.
When using FTPS for data transfer, you can choose to encrypt your credentials, and also the data being transmitted to
the server. In addition, you can choose to authenticate the server's credentials and connections. The credentials of a
server are validated against the current set of trusted CA server certificates in the Dreamweaver database. Certificate
Authorities (CAs), which include companies like VeriSign, Thawte, and so on, issue digitally signed server certificates
76
Site management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: This procedure describes options specific to FTPS. For information on regular FTP options, see the previous section.
1Select Site > Manage Sites.
2Click New to set up a new site, or select an existing Dreamweaver site and click Edit.
3In the Site Setup dialog box, select the Servers category and do one of the following:
Click the “+” (Add New Server) button to add a new server.
Select an existing server and click the Edit Existing Server button.
4In Server Name, specify a name for the new server.
5In Connect Using, select one of the following based on your requirement.
FTP over SSL/TLS (Implicit Encryption) The server terminates the connection if the security request is not received.
FTP over SSL/TLS (Explicit Encryption) If the client does not request security, the server can choose to proceed with
an insecure transaction, or refuse/limit the connection.
6In Authentication, choose one of the following options:
None The server’s credentials, signed or self-signed, are displayed. If you accept the servers credentials, the
certificate is added to a certificate store, trustedSites.db, in Dreamweaver. When you connect to the same server the
next time, Dreamweaver directly connects to the server.
Note: If the credentials of a self-signed certificate have changed on the server, you are prompted to accept the new
credentials.
Trusted The presented certificate is validated with the current set of trusted CA server certificates in the
Dreamweaver database. The list of trusted servers is stored in the cacerts.pem file.
Note: An error message is displayed if you select Trusted Server, and connect to a server with a self-signed certificate.
7Expand the More Options section to set more options.
Encrypt Only Command Channel Select this option if you want to encrypt only the commands that are being
transmitted. Use this option when the data being transmitted is already encrypted, or does not contain sensitive
information.
Encrypt Only User Name and Password Select this option if you want to encrypt only your user name and password.
8Click Save to close the Basic screen. Then in the Servers category, specify whether the server you added or edited is
a remote server, a testing server, or both.
For help with troubleshooting FTP connectivity problems, see TechNote kb405912 on the Adobe website at
www.adobe.com/go/kb405912.
Local or network connections
Use this setting to connect to a network folder, or if you are storing files or running your testing server on your local
computer.
1Select Site > Manage Sites.
2Click New to set up a new site, or select an existing Dreamweaver site and click Edit.
3In the Site Setup dialog box, select the Servers category and do one of the following:
Click the Add New Server button to add a new server
Select an existing server and click the Edit Existing Server button
4In the Server Name text box, specify a name for the new server. The name can be anything of your choosing.
77
Site management
Last updated 6/3/2015
5Select Local/Network from the Connect Using pop-up menu.
6Click the folder icon beside the Server Folder text box to browse to and select the folder where you store your site
files.
7In the Web URL text box enter the URL of your website (for example, http://www.mysite.com). Dreamweaver uses
the Web URL to create site root-relative links, and to verify links when you use the link checker.
For a more extensive explanation of this option, see Advanced Settings category.
8Click Save to close the Basic screen. Then in the Servers category, specify whether the server you just added or edited
is a remote server, a testing server, or both.
WebDAV connections
Use this setting if you connect to your web server using the Web-based Distributed Authoring and Versioning
(WebDAV) protocol.
For this connection method, you must have a server that supports this protocol, such as Microsoft Internet Information
Server (IIS) 5.0 or an appropriately configured installation of Apache web server.
Note: If you select WebDAV as your connection method, and you are using Dreamweaver in a multiuser environment, you
should also make sure that all of your users select WebDAV as the connection method. If some users select WebDAV, and
other users select other connection methods (FTP, for example), Dreamweavers check-in/check-out feature will not work
as expected, since WebDAV uses its own locking system.
1Select Site > Manage Sites.
2Click New to set up a new site, or select an existing Dreamweaver site and click Edit.
3In the Site Setup dialog box, select the Servers category and do one of the following:
Click the Add New Server button to add a new server
Select an existing server and click the Edit Existing Server button
4In the Server Name text box, specify a name for the new server. The name can be anything of your choosing.
5Select WebDAV from the Connect Using pop-up menu.
6For the URL, enter the complete URL to the directory on the WebDAV server you want to connect to.
This URL includes the protocol, port, and directory (if not the root directory). For example,
http://webdav.mydomain.net/mysite.
7Enter your username and password.
This information is for server authentication and is not related to Dreamweaver. If you are not sure of your username
and password, check with your system administrator or webmaster.
8Click Test to test your connection settings.
9Select the Save option if you want Dreamweaver to remember your password each time you start a new session.
10 In the Web URL text box enter the URL of your website (for example, http://www.mysite.com). Dreamweaver uses
the Web URL to create site root-relative links, and to verify links when you use the link checker.
For a more extensive explanation of this option, see Advanced Settings category.
11 Click Save to close the Basic screen. Then in the Servers category, specify whether the server you just added or edited
is a remote server, a testing server, or both.
78
Site management
Last updated 6/3/2015
RDS connections
Use this setting if you connect to your web server using Remote Development Services (RDS). For this connection
method, your remote server must be on a computer running Adobe® ColdFusio
1Select Site > Manage Sites.
2Click New to set up a new site, or select an existing Dreamweaver site and click Edit.
3In the Site Setup dialog box, select the Servers category and do one of the following:
Click the Add New Server button to add a new server
Select an existing server and click the Edit Existing Server button
4In the Server Name text box, specify a name for the new server. The name can be anything of your choosing.
5Select RDS from the Connect Using pop-up menu.
6Click the Settings button and provide the following information in the Configure RDS Server dialog box:
Enter the name of the host computer where your web server is installed.
The host name is probably an IP address or a URL. If you are unsure, ask your administrator.
Enter the port number that you connect to.
Enter your root remote folder as the host directory.
For example, c:\inetpub\wwwroot\myHostDir\.
Enter your RDS username and password.
Note: These options might not appear if you set your username and password in the ColdFusion Administrator security
settings.
Select the Save option if you want Dreamweaver to remember your settings.
7Click OK to close the Configure RDS Server dialog box.
8In the Web URL text box enter the URL of your website (for example, http://www.mysite.com). Dreamweaver uses
the Web URL to create site root-relative links, and to verify links when you use the link checker.
For a more extensive explanation of this option, see Advanced Settings category.
9Click Save to close the Basic screen. Then in the Servers category, specify whether the server you just added or edited
is a remote server, a testing server, or both.
Microsoft Visual SourceSafe connections
Support for Microsoft Visual SourceSafe has been deprecated as of Dreamweaver CS5.
Set Advanced server options
1Select Site > Manage Sites.
2Click New to set up a new site, or select an existing Dreamweaver site and click Edit.
3In the Site Setup dialog box, select the Servers category and do one of the following:
Click the Add New Server button to add a new server
Select an existing server and click the Edit Existing Server button
4Specify Basic options as necessary, and then click the Advanced button.
5Select Maintain Synchronization Information if you want to automatically synchronize your local and remote files.
(This option is selected by default.)
79
Site management
Last updated 6/3/2015
6Select Automatically Upload Files to Server on Save if you want Dreamweaver to upload your file to your remote site
when you save the file.
7Select Enable File Check Out if you want to activate the Check In/Out system.
8If you are using a Testing server, select a server model from the Server Model pop-up menu. For more information,
see .
Connect to or disconnect from a remote folder with network access
You don’t need to connect to the remote folder; youre always connected. Click the Refresh button to see your remote
files.
Connect to or disconnect from a remote folder with FTP access
In the Files panel:
To connect, click Connects to Remote Host in the toolbar.
To disconnect, click Disconnect in the toolbar.
Troubleshoot the remote folder setup
The following list provides information on common problems you may encounter in setting up a remote folder, and
how to resolve them.
There is also an extensive tech note that specifically provides FTP troubleshooting information on the Adobe website
at www.adobe.com/go/kb405912.
The Dreamweaver FTP implementation might not work properly with certain proxy servers, multilevel firewalls,
and other forms of indirect server access. If you encounter problems with FTP access, ask your local system
administrator for help.
For a Dreamweaver FTP implementation, you must connect to the remote systems root folder. Be sure to indicate
the remote systems root folder as the host directory. If you’ve specified the host directory using a single slash (/),
you might need to specify a relative path from the directory you are connecting to and the remote root folder. For
example, if the remote root folder is a higher level directory, you may need to specify a ../../ for the host directory.
Use underscores in place of spaces, and avoid special characters in file and folder names wherever possible. Colons,
slashes, periods, and apostrophes in file or folder names can sometimes cause problems.
If you encounter problems with long filenames, rename them with shorter names. On the Mac OS, filenames cannot
be more than 31 characters long.
Many servers use symbolic links (UNIX), shortcuts (Windows), or aliases (Macintosh) to connect a folder on one
part of the server’s disk with another folder elsewhere. Such aliases usually have no effect on your ability to connect
to the appropriate folder or directory; however, if you can connect to one part of the server but not another, there
might be an alias discrepancy.
If you encounter an error message such as “cannot put file,” your remote folder may be out of space. For more
detailed information, look at the FTP log.
Note: In general, when you encounter a problem with an FTP transfer, examine the FTP log by selecting Window >
Results (Windows) or Site > FTP Log (Macintosh), then clicking the FTP Log tag.
80
Site management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Manage Sites dialog box options
The Manage Sites dialog box is your gateway into various Dreamweaver site functions. From this dialog box, you can
initiate the process for creating a new site, editing an existing site, duplicating a site, removing a site, or importing or
exporting a sites settings.
Note: The Manage Sites dialog box does not let you connect to or publish files to a remote server. For instructions on
connecting to a remote server, see Connect to a remote server . If you are trying to connect to an existing website, see Edit
an existing remote website .
Manage Sites dialog box options (CS6 and later)
1Select Site > Manage Sites.
A site list appears. If you haven't created any sites yet, the site list will be blank.
2Do one of the following:
Create a new site Click the New Site button to create a new Dreamweaver site. Then specify the name and location
for your new site in the Site Setup dialog box. For more information, see Set up a local version of your site.
Import a site Click the Import Site button to import a site. For more information, see Import and export
Dreamweaver site settings.
Note: The import feature only imports site settings that have previously been exported from Dreamweaver. It does
not import site files to create a new Dreamweaver site. For information on creating a new site in Dreamweaver, see
Set up a local version of your site.
Create a new Business Catalyst site Click the New Business Catalyst Site button to create a new Business Catalyst
Site. For more information, see Create a temporary Business Catalyst site.
Import a Business Catalyst site Click the Import Business Catalyst Site button to import an existing Business
Catalyst site. For more information, see Import a Business Catalyst site.
3For existing sites, the following options are also available:
Delete Deletes the selected site and all of its setup information from your list of Dreamweaver sites; it does not
delete the actual site files. (If you want to remove the site files from your computer, you need to do that manually.)
To delete a site from Dreamweaver, select the site in the site list and then click the Delete button. You cannot undo
this action.
Edit Enables you to edit information such as username, password, and server information for an existing
Dreamweaver site. Select the existing site in the site list and click the Edit button to edit the existing site. (The Site
Setup dialog box opens once you click the Edit button for a selected site.) For more information on editing existing
site options, click the Help button in the various screens of the Site Setup dialog box.
Duplicate Creates a copy of an existing site. To duplicate a site, select the site in the site list and click the
Duplicate button. The duplicated site appears in the site list with the word “copy” appended to the name of the site.
To change the name of the duplicated site, leave the site selected and click the Edit button.
Export Enables you to export the selected site’s settings as an XML file (*.ste). For more information, see Import
and export site settings .
Manage Sites dialog box options (CS5 and CS5.5)
1Select Site > Manage Sites and select a site from the list on the left.
81
Site management
Last updated 6/3/2015
2Click a button to select one of the options, make any changes you need to make, and click Done.
New Enables you to create a new site. When you click the New button the Site Setup dialog box opens, letting you
name and specify the location for your new site. For more information, see Set up a local version of your site .
Edit Enables you to edit information such as username, password, and server information for an existing
Dreamweaver site. Select the existing site in the site list on the left and click the Edit button to edit the existing site.
For more information on editing existing site options, see Connect to a remote server .
Duplicate Creates a copy of an existing site. To duplicate a site, select the site in the site list on the left and click the
Duplicate button. The duplicated site appears in the site list with the word “copy” appended to the name of the site.
To change the name of the duplicated site, leave the site selected and click the Edit button.
Remove Deletes the selected site and all of its setup information from your list of Dreamweaver sites; it does not
delete the actual site files. (If you want to remove the site files from your computer, you need to do that manually.)
To delete a site from Dreamweaver, select the site in the site list and then click the Remove button. You cannot undo
this action.
Export/Import Enables you to either export the selected sites settings as an XML file (*.ste), or import a sites
settings. For more information, see Import and export site settings .
Note: The import feature only imports site settings that have previously been exported. It does not import site files to
create a new Dreamweaver site. For information on creating a new site in Dreamweaver, see Set up a local version of
your site .
More Help topics
About Dreamweaver sites
Edit an existing remote website in Dreamweaver
Set up a testing server
If you plan to develop dynamic pages, Dreamweaver needs the services of a testing server to generate and display
dynamic content while you work. The testing server can be your local computer, a development server, a staging server,
or a production server.
Dreamweaver automatically syncs dynamic documents to your testing server when you open, create, or save changes
made to dynamic documents. For more information, see
Set up a testing server
1Select Site > Manage Sites.
2Click New to set up a new site, or select an existing Dreamweaver site and click the edit icon.
3In the Site Setup dialog box, select the Servers category and do one of the following:
Click the Add New Server button to add a new server
Select an existing server and click the Edit Existing Server button
4Specify Basic options as necessary, and then click the Advanced button.
Note: You must specify a Web URL in the Basic screen when specifying a testing server. For more information, see the
next section.
5Under Testing Server, select the server model you want to use for your web application.
82
Site management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: As of Dreamweaver CS5, Dreamweaver no longer installs ASP.NET, ASP JavaScript, or JSP server behaviors. (You
can manually re-enable the deprecated server behaviors if you wish, but keep in mind that Dreamweaver no longer
officially supports them.) If you’re working on ASP.NET, ASP JavaScript, or JSP pages, however, Dreamweaver will still
support Live view, code coloring, and code hinting for those pages. You do not need to select ASP.NET, ASP JavaScript
or JSP in the Site Definition dialog box for any of these features to work.
6Click Save to close the Advanced screen. Then in the Servers category, specify the server you just added or edited as
a testing server.
About the Web URL for the testing server
You must specify a Web URL so Dreamweaver can use the services of a testing server to display data and to connect to
databases while you work. Dreamweaver uses the design-time connection to provide you with useful information about
the database, such as the names of the tables in your database and the names of the columns in your tables.
A Web URL for a testing server comprises the domain name and any of your websites home directory’s subdirectories
or virtual directories.
Note: The terminology used in Microsoft IIS may vary from server to server, but the same concepts apply to most web
servers.
The home directory The folder on the server mapped to your sites domain name. Suppose the folder you want to use
to process dynamic pages is c:\sites\company\, and this folder is your home directory (that is, this folder is mapped to
your sites domain name—for example, www.mystartup.com). In that case, the URL prefix is
http://www.mystartup.com/.
If the folder you want to use to process dynamic pages is a subfolder of your home directory, simply add the subfolder
to the URL. If your home directory is c:\sites\company\, your site’s domain name is www.mystartup.com, and the folder
you want to use to process dynamic pages is c:\sites\company\inventory. Enter the following Web URL:
http://www.mystartup.com/inventory/
If the folder you want to use to process dynamic pages is not your home directory or any of its subdirectories, you must
create a virtual directory.
A virtual directory A folder that is not physically contained in the home directory of the server even though it appears
to be in the URL. To create a virtual directory, specify an alias for the folders path in the URL. Suppose your home
directory is c:\sites\company, your processing folder is d:\apps\inventory, and you define an alias for this folder called
warehouse. Enter the following Web URL:
http://www.mystartup.com/warehouse/
Localhost Refers to the home directory in your URLs when the client (usually a browser, but in this case Dreamweaver)
runs on the same system as your web server. Suppose Dreamweaver is running on the same Windows system as the web
server, your home directory is c:\sites\company, and you defined a virtual directory called warehouse to refer to the
folder you want to use to process dynamic pages. The following are the Web URLs you would enter for selected web
servers:
Web server Web URL
ColdFusion MX 7 http://localhost:8500/warehouse/
IIS http://localhost/warehouse/
Apache (Windows) http://localhost:80/warehouse/
Jakarta Tomcat (Windows) http://localhost:8080/warehouse/
83
Site management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: By default the ColdFusion MX 7 web server runs on port 8500, the Apache web server runs on port 80, and the
Jakarta Tomcat web server runs on port 8080.
For Macintosh users running the Apache web server, your personal home directory is Users/MyUserName/Sites, where
MyUserName is your Macintosh user name. An alias called ~MyUserName is automatically defined for this folder
when you install Mac OS 10.1 or higher. Therefore, your default Web URL in Dreamweaver is as follows:
http://localhost/~MyUserName/
If the folder you want to use to process dynamic pages is Users:MyUserName:Sites:inventory, then the Web URL is as
follows:
http://localhost/~MyUserName/inventory/
More Help topics
Automatic pushing of dynamic files
When you make edits to the source code either in Code view or Live view, and save a dynamic document, Dreamweaver
automatically pushes the file to the testing server. If the dependent files are not present on the testing server,
Dreamweaver automatically pushes the dependent files as well. If the dependent files are already present on the server,
these files are not pushed and only the server-side document is pushed to the testing server.
Consider the following scenarios:
Scenario 1: You make changes to the source code and dependent files. The focus is in thesource code when you click
Save.
In this case, the following dialog box that lists all the affected, dependent files appears:
You can then choose the files that you want to push to the testing server.
Note: You can select Always Auto Save the Dependent Files to not see the prompt for subsequent operations. To revert
this preference at any point in time, go to the settings of the testing server (Site Setup), and in the Advanced tab,
uncheck Always Auto Save Dependent Files.
Scenario 2: You make changes to the source code and dependent files. The focus is on one of the dependent files when
you click Save.
84
Site management
Last updated 6/3/2015
In this case, only the dependent file is saved and pushed to the testing server.
Version Control and Advanced settings
Access the Version Control and Advanced settings categories in the Site Setup dialog box by choosing Site > Manage
Sites, selecting the site you want to edit, and clicking Edit.
Version Control category
You can get and check in files using Subversion. For more information, see Use Subversion (SVN) to get and check in
files.
Advanced Settings category
Local Info
Default Images Folder The folder in which you want to store images for your site. Enter the path to the folder, or click
the folder icon to browse to the folder. Dreamweaver uses the path to the folder when you add images to documents.
Links Relative To Specifies the kind of links Dreamweaver creates when you create links to other assets or pages in your
site. Dreamweaver can create two kinds of links: document-relative and site root-relative. For more information on the
differences between the two, see Absolute, document-relative, and site root-relative paths.
By default, Dreamweaver creates document-relative links. If you change the default setting and select the Site Root
option, make sure the correct Web URL for the site is entered in the Web URL text box (see below). Changing this
setting does not convert the path of existing links; the setting will only apply to new links you create visually with
Dreamweaver.
85
Site management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: Content linked by site-root relative links does not appear when you preview documents in a local browser unless you
specify a testing server, or select the Preview Using Temporary File option in Edit > Preferences > Preview In Browser. This
is because browsers don’t recognize site roots—servers do.
Web URL The URL of your website. Dreamweaver uses the Web URL to create site root-relative links, and to verify links
when you use the link checker.
Site root-relative links are useful if you are uncertain about the final location in the directory structure of the page you’re
working on, or if you think you might later relocate or reorganize files that contain links. Site root-relative links are
links whose paths to other site assets are relative to the site root, not the document, so if you move the document at
some point, the path to the assets remains correct.
For example, lets say that youve specified http://www.mysite.com/mycoolsite (the remote server’s site root directory)
as the Web URL, and that you also have an images folder in the mycoolsite directory on the remote server
(http://www.mysite.com/mycoolsite/images). Lets also say that your index.html file is in the mycoolsite directory.
When you create a site root-relative link from the index.html file to an image in the images directory, the link looks as
follows:
<img src="/mycoolsite/images/image1.jpg" />
This is different from a document-relative link, which would simply be:
<img src="images/image1.jpg" />
The appendage of /mycoolsite/ to the image source links the image relative to the site root, not the document. Assuming
the image stays in the image directory, the file path to the image (/mycoolsite/images/image1.jpg), will always be
correct, even if you move the index.html file to another directory.
For more information, see Absolute, document-relative, and site root-relative paths.
With regard to link verification, the Web URL is necessary for determining whether a link is internal or external to the
site. For example, if your web URL is http://www.mysite.com/mycoolsite, and the link checker finds a link with a URL
of http://www.yoursite.com on your page, the checker determines that the latter link is an external link and reports it
as such. Similarly, the link checker uses the Web URL to determine if links are internal to the site, and then checks to
see if those internal links are broken.
Case-sensitive Links Checking Checks that the case of the links matches the case of the filenames when Dreamweaver
checks links. This option is useful on UNIX systems where filenames are case-sensitive.
Enable Cache Indicates whether to create a local cache to improve the speed of link and site management tasks. If you
do not select this option, Dreamweaver asks you if you want to create a cache again before it creates the site. It is a good
idea to select this option because the Assets panel (in the Files panel group) only works if a cache is created.
Cloaking and other categories
For more information on the Cloaking, Design Notes, File View Columns, Contribute, Templates, or Spry categories,
click the Help button in the dialog box.
Import and export Dreamweaver site settings
You can export your site settings as an XML file that you can later import into Dreamweaver. Exporting/importing sites
enables you to transfer site settings to other machines and product versions, share site settings with other users, and
back up site settings.
86
Site management
Last updated 6/3/2015
The import/export feature does not import or export site files. It only imports/exports site settings to save you the time
of recreating sites in Dreamweaver. For information on creating a new site in Dreamweaver, see Set up a local version
of your site .
Export your site settings regularly so that you have a backup copy if anything happens to the site.
Export your site settings
1Select Site > Manage sites.
2 Select one or more sites whose settings you want to export and click Export (CS5/CS5.5) or the Export button
(CS6 and later):
To select more than one site, Control-click (Windows) or Command-click (Macintosh) each site.
To select a range of sites, Shift-click the first and last site in the range.
3If you want to back up your site settings for yourself, select the first option in the Exporting Site dialog box and click
OK. Dreamweaver saves remote server login information, such as the user name and password, as well as local path
information.
4If you want to share your settings with other users, select the second option in the Exporting Site dialog box and
click OK. (Dreamweaver does not save information that would not work for other users, such as your remote server
login information and local paths.)
5For each site whose settings you want to export, browse to a location where you want to save the site file and click
Save. (Dreamweaver saves each sites settings as an XML file, with an .ste file extension.)
6Click Done.
Note: Save the *.ste file to your site root folder or to your desktop to make it easy to find. If you cannot remember where
you put it, do a file search on your computer for files with the *.ste extension to locate it.
Import site settings
1Select Site > Manage sites.
2Click Import (CS5/CS5.5) or the Import Site button (CS6 and later).
3Browse to and select one or more sites—defined in files with an .ste file extension—whose settings you want to
import.
To select more than one site, Control-click (Windows) or Command-click (Macintosh) each .ste file. To select a
range of sites, Shift-click the first and last file in the range.
4Click Open and then click Done.
After Dreamweaver imports the site settings, the site names appear in the Manage Sites dialog box.
More Help topics
About Dreamweaver sites
Backing up and restoring site definitions
87
Site management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Edit an existing remote website
You can use Dreamweaver to copy an existing remote site (or any branch of a remote site) to your local disk and edit it
there, even if you didn’t use Dreamweaver to create the original site. You must have the correct connection information,
and connect to the sites remote server, before you can edit the site.
1Create a local folder to contain the existing site and set up the folder as the local folder for the site. (See Set up a local
version of your site .)
Note: You must locally duplicate the entire structure of the relevant branch of the existing remote site.
2Set up a remote folder, using the remote access information about the existing site. You must connect to the remote
site to download the files to your computer before you can edit them. (See Connect to a remote server .)
Make sure to choose the correct root folder for the remote site.
3In the Files panel (Window > Files), click the Connects To Remote Host button (for FTP access) or the Refresh
button (for network access) in the toolbar to view the remote site.
4Edit the site:
If you want to work with the entire site, select the root folder of the remote site in the Files panel, and click Get
File(s) in the toolbar to download the entire site to your local disk.
If you want to work with just one of the files or folders of the site, locate the file or folder in the Remote view of
the Files panel, and click Get File(s) in the toolbar to download that file to your local disk.
Dreamweaver automatically duplicates as much of the remote sites structure as is necessary to place the downloaded
file in the correct part of the site hierarchy. When editing only one part of a site, you should generally include dependent
files, such as image files.
More Help topics
About Dreamweaver sites
Editing an existing website (Dreamweaverblog)
Set site preferences for transferring files
You select preferences to control file transfer features that appear in the Files panel.
1Select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh).
2In the Preferences dialog box, select Site from the category list on the left.
3Set the options and click OK.
Always Show Specifies which site (remote or local) is always shown, and in which Files panel pane (left or right) the
local and remote files appear.
By default, the local site always appears on the right. Whichever pane is not chosen (the left one by default) is the
changeable pane: this pane can display the files in the other site (the remote site by default).
Dependent Files Displays a prompt for transferring dependent files (such as images, external style sheets, and other
files referenced in the HTML file) that the browser loads when it loads the HTML file. By default, both Prompt on
Get/Check Out and Prompt on Put/Check In are selected.
88
Site management
Last updated 6/3/2015
It’s usually a good idea to download dependent files when checking out a new file, but if the latest versions of the
dependent files are already on the local disk, theres no need to download them again. This is also true for uploading
and checking in files: no need if up-to-date copies are already at the destination.
If you deselect these options, your dependent files are not transferred. Therefore, to force the Dependent Files dialog
box to appear even when these options are deselected, hold down Alt (Windows) or Option (Macintosh) while
choosing the Get, Put, Check In, or Check Out commands.
FTP Connection Determines whether the connection to the remote site is terminated after the specified number of
minutes have passed with no activity.
FTP Time Out Specifies the number of seconds in which Dreamweaver attempts to make a connection with the
remote server.
If there is no response after the specified amount of time, Dreamweaver displays a warning dialog box alerting you
to this fact.
FTP Transfer options Determines whether Dreamweaver selects the default option, after a specified number of
seconds, when a dialog box appears during a file transfer and there is no user response.
Proxy Host Specifies the address of the proxy server through which you connect to outside servers if you are behind
a firewall.
If you are not behind a firewall, leave this space blank. If you are behind a firewall, select the Use Proxy option in
the Site Definition dialog box (Servers > Edit Existing Server (pencil icon) > More Options).
Proxy Port Specifies the port in your proxy or firewall through which you pass to connect to the remote server. If
you connect through a port other than 21 (the default for FTP), enter the number here.
Put Options: Save Files Before Putting Indicates that unsaved files are saved automatically before being put onto the
remote site.
Move Options: Prompt Before Moving Files on Server Alerts you when you attempt to move files on the remote site.
Manage Sites Opens the Manage Sites dialog box, where you can edit an existing site or create a new one.
You can define whether the types of files that you transfer are transferred as ASCII (text) or binary, by customizing
the FTPExtensionMap.txt file in the Dreamweaver/Configuration folder (on the Macintosh,
FTPExtensionMapMac.txt). For more information see, Extending Dreamweaver.
89
Last updated 6/3/2015
Chapter 4: File management
Creating and opening documents
The user interface in Dreamweaver CC and later has been simplified. As a result, you may not find some of the options
described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About creating Dreamweaver documents
Dreamweaver offers a flexible environment for working with a variety of web documents. In addition to HTML
documents, you can create and open a variety of text-based documents, including ColdFusion Markup Language
(CFML), ASP, JavaScript, and Cascading Style Sheets (CSS). Source code files, such as Visual Basic, .NET, C#, and Java,
are also supported.
Dreamweaver provides several options for creating a new document. You can create any of the following:
A new blank document or template
A document based on one of the predesigned page layouts that comes with Dreamweaver, including over 30 CSS-
based page layouts
A document based on one of your existing templates
You can also set document preferences. For example, if you typically work with one type of document, you can set
it as the default document type for new pages you create.
You can easily define document properties, such as meta tags, document title, and background colors, and several
other page properties in either Design view or Code view.
Dreamweaver file types
You can work with a variety of file types in Dreamweaver. The primary kind of file you will work with is the HTML file.
HTML files—or Hypertext Markup Language files—contain the tag-based language responsible for displaying a web
page in a browser. You can save HTML files with either the .html or .htm extension. Dreamweaver saves files using the
.html extension by default.
Dreamweaver lets you create and edit HTML5-based web pages. Starter layouts are also available for building HTML5
pages from scratch.
Following are some of the other common file types you might use when working in Dreamweaver:
CSS Cascading Style Sheet files have a .css extension. They are used to format HTML content and control the
positioning of various page elements.
GIF Graphics Interchange Format files have a .gif extension. GIF format is a popular web graphic format for cartoons,
logos, graphics with transparent areas, and animations. GIFs contain a maximum of 256 colors.
JPEG Joint Photographic Experts Group files (named after the organization that created the format) have a .jpg
extension, and are usually photographs or high-color images. The JPEG format is best for digital or scanned
90
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
photographs, images using textures, images with gradient color transitions, and any images that require more than 256
colors.
XML Extensible Markup Language files have a .xml extension. They contain data in a raw form that can be formatted
using XSL (Extensible Stylesheet Language).
XSL Extensible Stylesheet Language files have a .xsl or .xslt extension. They are used to style XML data that you want
to display on a web page.
Create a layout using a blank page
You can create a page that contains a predesigned CSS layout, or create a completely blank page and then create a layout
of your own.
1Select File > New.
2In the Blank Page category of the New Document dialog box, select the kind of page you want to create from the
Page Type column. For example, select HTML to create a plain HTML page.
3If you want your new page to contain a CSS layout, select a predesigned CSS layout from the Layout column;
otherwise, select None. Based on your selection, a preview and description of the selected layout appears on the right
side of the dialog box.
The predesigned CSS layouts provide the following types of columns:
Fixed Column width is specified in pixels. The column does not resize based on the size of the browser or the site
visitors text settings.
Liquid Column width is specified as a percentage of the site visitor’s browser width. The design adapts if the site
visitor makes the browser wider or narrower, but does not change based on the site visitors text settings.
Dreamweaver also offers two HTML5 CSS layouts: two- and three-column fixed.
Note: In Dreamweaver CC and later, only HTML5 CSS layouts are available.
4Select a document type from the DocType pop-up menu. In most cases, you can use the default selection, XHTML
1.0 Transitional or HTML5 (Dreamweaver CC).
Selecting one of the XHTML document type definitions from the DocType (DTD) menu makes your page XHTML-
compliant. For example, you can make an HTML document XHTML-compliant by selecting XHTML 1.0
Transitional or XHTML 1.0 Strict from the menu. XHTML (Extensible Hypertext Markup Language) is a
reformulation of HTML as an XML application. Generally, using XHTML gives you the benefits of XML, while
ensuring the backward and future compatibility of your web documents.
Note: For more information about XHTML, see the World Wide Web Consortium (W3C) website, which contains the
specification for XHTML 1.1 - Module-Based XHTML (www.w3.org/TR/xhtml11/) and XHTML 1.0
(www.w3c.org/TR/xhtml1/), as well as XHTML validator sites for web-based files (http://validator.w3.org/) and local
files (http://validator.w3.org/file-upload.html).
5If you selected a CSS layout in the Layout column, select a location for the layouts CSS from the Layout CSS pop-
up menu.
Add To Head Adds CSS for the layout to the head of the page youre creating.
Create New File Adds CSS for the layout to a new external CSS file and attaches the new style sheet to the page you’re
creating.
Link To Existing File Lets you specify an existing CSS file that already contains the CSS rules needed for the layout.
To do this, click the Attach Style Sheet icon above the Attach CSS file pane and select an existing CSS style sheet.
91
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
This option is particularly useful when you want to use the same CSS layout (the CSS rules for which are contained
in a single file) across multiple documents.
6(Optional) You can also attach CSS style sheets to your new page (unrelated to the CSS layout) when you create the
page. To do this, click the Attach Style Sheet icon above the Attach CSS File pane and select a CSS style sheet.
For a detailed walk-through of this process, see David Powerss article, Automatically attaching a style sheet to new
documents.
7Select Enable InContext Editing if you want to create a page that becomes InContext Editing-enabled as soon as you
save it.
An InContext Editing-enabled page must have at least one div tag that can be specified as an editable region. For
example, if you’ve selected the HTML page type, you must select one of the CSS layouts for your new page, since
these layouts already contain pre-defined div tags. The InContext Editing editable region is automatically placed on
the div tag with the content ID. You can later add more editable regions to the page if you like.
Note: InContext Editing is removed in Dreamweaver CC and later.
8Click Preferences if you want to set default document preferences, such as a document type, encoding, and a file
extension.
9Click Get More Content if you want to open Dreamweaver Exchange where you can download more page design
content.
10 Click the Create button.
11 Save the new document (File > Save).
12 In the dialog box that appears, navigate to the folder where you want to save the file.
It’s a good idea to save your file in a Dreamweaver site.
13 In the File Name box, type a name for the file.
Avoid using spaces and special characters in file and folder names, and do not begin a filename with a numeral. In
particular, do not use special characters (such as é, ç, or ¥) or punctuation marks (such as colons, slashes, or periods)
in the names of files you intend to put on a remote server; many servers change these characters during upload,
which will cause any links to the files to break.
Create a blank template
You can use the New Document dialog box to create Dreamweaver templates. By default, templates are saved in the
Templates folder of your site.
1Select File > New.
2In the New Document dialog box, select the Blank Template category.
3Select the kind of page you want to create from the Template Type column. For example, select HTML template to
create a plain HTML template, select ColdFusion template to create a ColdFusion template, and so on.
4If you want your new page to contain a CSS layout, select a predesigned CSS layout from the Layout column;
otherwise, select None. Based on your selection, a preview and description of the selected layout appears on the right
side of the dialog box.
The predesigned CSS layouts provide the following types of columns:
Fixed Column width is specified in pixels. The column does not resize based on the size of the browser or the site
visitors text settings.
92
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Liquid Column width is specified as a percentage of the site visitor’s browser width. The design adapts if the site
visitor makes the browser wider or narrower, but does not change based on the site visitors text settings.
5Select a document type from the DocType pop-up menu. In most cases, you will want to leave this selected to the
default selection, XHTML 1.0 Transitional.
Selecting one of the XHTML document type definitions from the DocType (DTD) menu makes your page XHTML-
compliant. For example, you can make an HTML document XHTML-compliant by selecting XHTML 1.0
Transitional or XHTML 1.0 Strict from the menu. XHTML (Extensible Hypertext Markup Language) is a
reformulation of HTML as an XML application. Generally, using XHTML gives you the benefits of XML, while
ensuring the backward and future compatibility of your web documents.
Note: For more information about XHTML, see the World Wide Web Consortium (W3C) website, which contains the
specification for XHTML 1.1 - Module-Based XHTML (www.w3.org/TR/xhtml11/) and XHTML 1.0
(www.w3c.org/TR/xhtml1/), as well as XHTML validator sites for web-based files (http://validator.w3.org/) and local
files (http://validator.w3.org/file-upload.html).
6If you selected a CSS layout in the Layout column, select a location for the layouts CSS from the Layout CSS pop-
up menu.
Add to Head Adds CSS for the layout to the head of the page youre creating.
Create New File Adds CSS for the layout to a new external CSS styles sheet and attaches the new style sheet to the
page youre creating.
Link To Existing File Lets you specify an existing CSS file that already contains the CSS rules needed for the layout.
To do this, click the Attach Style Sheet icon above the Attach CSS file pane and select an existing CSS style sheet.
This option is particularly useful when you want to use the same CSS layout (the CSS rules for which are contained
in a single file) across multiple documents.
7(Optional) You can also attach CSS style sheets to your new page (unrelated to the CSS layout) when you create the
page. To do this, click the Attach Style Sheet icon above the Attach CSS file pane and select a CSS style sheet.
8Select Enable InContext Editing if you want to create a page that becomes InContext Editing-enabled as soon as you
save it.
An InContext Editing-enabled page must have at least one div tag that can be specified as an editable region. For
example, if you’ve selected the HTML page type, you must select one of the CSS layouts for your new page, since
these layouts already contain pre-defined div tags. The InContext Editing editable region is automatically placed on
the div tag with the content ID. You can later add more editable regions to the page if you like.
9Click Preferences if you want to set default document preferences, such as a document type, encoding, and a file
extension.
10 Click Get More Content if you want to open Dreamweaver Exchange where you can download more page design
content.
11 Click the Create button.
12 Save the new document (File > Save). If you havent added editable regions to the template yet, a dialog box appears
telling you that there are no editable regions in the document. Click OK to close the dialog box.
13 In the Save As dialog box, select a site in which to save the template.
14 In the File Name box, type a name for the new template. You do not need to append a file extension to the name of
the template. When you click Save, the .dwt extension is appended to the new template, which is saved in the
Templates folder of your site.
93
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Avoid using spaces and special characters in file and folder names and do not begin a filename with a numeral. In
particular, do not use special characters (such as é, ç, or ¥) or punctuation (such as colons, slashes, or periods) in the
names of files you intend to put on a remote server; many servers change these characters during upload, which will
cause any links to the files to break.
Create a page based on an existing template
You can select, preview, and create a new document from an existing template. You can either use the New Document
dialog box to select a template from any of your Dreamweaver-defined sites or use the Assets panel to create a new
document from an existing template.
Create a document based on a template
1Select File > New.
2In the New Document dialog box, select the Page From Template category.
3In the Site column, select the Dreamweaver site that contains the template you want use, and then select a template
from the list on the right.
4Deselect Update Page When Template Changes if you don’t want to update this page each time you make changes
to the template on which this page is based.
5Click Preferences if you want to set default document preferences, such as a document type, encoding, and a file
extension.
6Click Get More Content if you want to open Dreamweaver Exchange where you can download more page design
content.
7Click Create and save the document (File > Save).
Create a document from a template in the Assets panel
1Open the Assets panel (Window > Assets), if it is not already open.
2In the Assets panel, click the Templates icon on the left to view the list of templates in your current site.
If you just created the template you want to apply, you might need to click the Refresh button to see it.
3Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the template you want to apply, then select New From
Template.
The document opens in the Document window.
4Save the document.
Create a page based on a Dreamweaver sample file
Dreamweaver comes with several professionally developed CSS design files and starter pages for mobile applications.
You c a n u s e t h e s e sample files as starting points for designing pages in your sites. When you create a document based
on a sample file, Dreamweaver creates a copy of the file.
You can preview a sample file and read a brief description of a documents design elements in the New Document dialog
box. In the case of CSS style sheets, you can copy a predesigned style sheet and apply it to your documents.
1Select File > New.
2In the New Document dialog box, select the Page From Sample category.
94
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
In Dreamweaver CC, select Starter Templates category.
3In the Sample Folder column, select CSS Style Sheet or Mobile Starters; then select a sample file from the list on the
right.
Note: CSS Style Sheet option is removed in Dreamweaver CC and later
4Click the Create button.
The new document opens in the Document window (Code and Design views). If you selected CSS Style Sheet, the
CSS style sheet opens in Code view.
5Save the document (File > Save).
6If the Copy Dependent Files dialog box appears, set the options, and then click Copy to copy the assets to the selected
folder.
You can choose your own location for the dependent files or use the default folder location Dreamweaver generates
(based on the sample files source name).
More Help topics
Use starter pages to create an application for mobile devices
Create other kinds of pages
The Other category of the New Document dialog box lets you create various types of pages that you might want to use
in Dreamweaver, including C#, VBScript, and text-only pages.
1Select File > New.
2In the New Document dialog box, select the Other category.
Note: Other category is removed in Dreamweaver CC and later.
3Select the kind of document you want to create from the Page Type column and click the Create button.
4Save the document (File > Save).
Save and revert documents
You can save a document using its current name and location, or save a copy of a document using a different name and
location.
When naming files, avoid using spaces and special characters in file and folder names. In particular, do not use special
characters (such as é, ç, or ¥) or punctuation (such as colons, slashes, or periods) in the names of files you intend to put
on a remote server; many servers change these characters during upload, which will cause any links to the files to break.
Also, do not begin a filename with a numeral.
Save a document
1Do one of the following:
To overwrite the current version on the disk, and save any changes you have made, select File > Save.
To save the file in a different folder or using a different name, select File > Save As.
2In the Save As dialog box that appears, navigate to the folder where you want to save the file.
3In the File Name text box, type a name for the file.
4Click Save to save the file.
95
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Save all open documents
1Select File > Save All.
2If there are any unsaved documents open, the Save As dialog box is displayed for each unsaved document.
In the dialog box that appears, navigate to the folder where you want to save the file.
3In the File Name box, type a name for the file and click Save.
Revert to the last saved version of a document
1Select File > Revert.
A dialog box asks if you want to discard your changes, and revert to the previously saved version.
2Click Yes to revert to the previous version; click No to keep your changes.
Note: If you save a document, and then exit Dreamweaver, you cannot revert to the previous version of the document
when you restart Dreamweaver.
Set default document type and encoding
You can define which document type is used as a default document for a site.
For example, if most pages in your site are of a specific file type (such as Cold Fusion, HTML, or ASP documents), you
can set document preferences that automatically create new documents of the specified file type.
1Select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh).
You can also click the Preferences button in the New Document dialog box to set new document preferences when
you create a new document.
2Click New Document from the category list on the left.
3Set or change preferences as necessary, and click OK to save them.
Default Document Select a document type that will be used for pages that you create.
Default Extension Specify the file extension you prefer (.htm or .html) for new HTML pages you create.
Note: This option is disabled for other file types.
Default Document Type (DDT) Select one of the XHTML document type definitions (DTD) to make new pages
XHTML-compliant. For example, you can make an HTML document XHTML-compliant by selecting XHTML 1.0
Transitional or XHTML 1.0 Strict from the menu.
Default Encoding Specify the encoding to be used when a new page is created, as well as when a document is opened
that does not specify any encoding.
If you select Unicode (UTF-8) as the document encoding, entity encoding is not necessary because UTF-8 can safely
represent all characters. If you select another document encoding, entity encoding may be necessary to represent
certain characters. For more information on character entities, see www.w3.org/TR/REC-
html40/sgml/entities.html.
If you select Unicode (UTF-8) as a default encoding, you can include a Byte Order Mark (BOM) in the document
by selecting the Include Unicode Signature (BOM) option.
A BOM is 2-4 bytes at the beginning of a text file that identifies a file as Unicode, as well as the byte order of the
following bytes. Because UTF-8 has no byte order, adding a UTF-8 BOM is optional. For UTF-16 and UTF-32, it is
required.
Unicode Normalization Form Select one of these options if you select Unicode (UTF-8) as a default encoding.
96
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
There are four Unicode Normalization Forms. The most important is Normalization Form C because it's the most
common one used in the Character Model for the World Wide Web. Adobe provides the other three Unicode
Normalization Forms for completeness.
Show New Document Dialog Box on Control+N Deselect this option (“on Command+N” for Macintosh) to
automatically create a document of the default document type when you use the key command.
In Unicode, there are characters that are visually similar but can be stored within the document in different ways.
For example, “ë” (e-umlaut) can be represented as a single character, “e-umlaut,” or as two characters, “regular Latin
e” + “combining umlaut.” A Unicode combining character is one that gets used with the previous character, so the
umlaut would appear above the “Latin e.” Both forms result in the same visual typography, but what is saved in the
file is different for each form.
Normalization is the process of making sure all characters that can be saved in different forms are all saved using
the same form. That is, all “ë” characters in a document are saved as single “e-umlaut or as “e” +combining umlaut,
and not as both forms in one document.
For more information on Unicode Normalization and the specific forms that can be used, see the Unicode website
at www.unicode.org/reports/tr15.
Converting HTML5 to an older doctype
Using File > Convert to switch from HTML5 to an older DOCTYPE doesn’t remove HTML5 elements or attributes.
Only the DOCTYPE changes, and trailing slashes (for XHTML) are inserted.
Semantic tags, such as <header> and <article>, and attributes such as required, placeholder, and type="number" are not
affected.
Note: Convert option is removed in Dreamweaver CC and later.
Set the default file extension of new HTML documents
You can define the default file extension of HTML documents created in Dreamweaver. For example, you can use an
.htm or .html extension for all new HTML documents.
1Select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh).
You can also click the Preferences button in the New Document dialog box to set new document preferences when
you create a new document.
2Click New Document from the category list on the left.
3Make sure that HTML is selected in the Default Document pop-up menu.
4In the Default Extension box, specify the file extension you want for new HTML documents created in
Dreamweaver.
For Windows, you can specify the following extensions: .html, .htm, .shtml, .shtm, .stm, .tpl, .lasso, .xhtml.
For Macintosh, you can specify the following extensions: .html, .htm, .shtml, .shtm, .tpl, .lasso, .xhtml, .ssi.
Open and edit existing documents
You can open an existing web page or text-based document, whether or not it was created in Dreamweaver, and edit it
in either Design view or Code view.
If the document you open is a Microsoft Word file that was saved as an HTML document, you can use the Cleanup
Word HTML command to remove the extraneous markup tags that Word inserts into HTML files.
97
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
To clean up HTML or XHTML that was not generated by Microsoft Word, use the Cleanup HTML command.
You can also open non-HTML text files, such as JavaScript files, XML files, CSS style sheets, or text files saved by word
processors or text editors.
1Select File > Open.
You can also use the Files panel to open files.
2Navigate to and select the file you want to open.
Note: If you haven’t already done so, its a good idea to organize files you plan to open and edit in a Dreamweaver site,
instead of opening them from another location.
3Click Open.
The document opens in the Document window. JavaScript, text, and CSS Style Sheets open in Code view by default.
You can update the document while working in Dreamweaver, and save the changes in the file.
Open Related Files
Dreamweaver lets you view files related to your main document, without losing the main document’s focus. For
example, if you have CSS and JavaScript files attached to a main document, Dreamweaver lets you view and edit these
related files in the Document window while keeping the main document visible.
Note: Dynamically Related Files (such as PHP files in Content Management Systems) are covered in the next Help section.
By default, Dreamweaver displays the names of all files related to a main document in a Related Files toolbar below the
main documents title. The order of the buttons in the toolbar follows the order of related files links that exist within
the main document.
Note: If a related file is missing, Dreamweaver still displays the corresponding button in the Related Files toolbar. If you
click the button, however, Dreamweaver does not display anything.
Dreamweaver supports the following kinds of related files:
Client-side script files
Server Side Includes
Spry data set sources (XML and HTML)
External CSS style sheets (including nested style sheets)
Open a related file from the Related Files toolbar
Do one of the following:
In the Related Files toolbar at the top of the document, click the filename of the related file you want to open.
In the Related Files toolbar, right-click the filename of the related file you want to open and select Open as Separate
File from the context menu. When you open a related file by this method, the main document does not remain
simultaneously visible.
Open a related file from the Code navigator
1Place the insertion point on a line or in an area that you know is affected by a related file.
2Wait for the Code Navigator indicator to appear, and then click it to open the Code Navigator.
98
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
3Hover over the items in the Code Navigator to see more information about them. For example, if you want to change
a particular CSS color property, but dont know which rule it resides in, you can find the property by hovering over
the available rules in the Code Navigator.
4Click the item youre interested in to open the corresponding related file.
Return to the source code of the main document
Click the Source Code button in the Related Files toolbar.
Change the display of related files
You can view related files in a number of ways:
When you open a related file from Design view or Code and Design views (Split view), the related file displays in a
split view above the Design view of the main document.
You can select View > Design View on Top if you want the related file to display at the bottom of the Document
window instead.
When you open a related file from vertically split Code and Design views (View > Split vertically), the related file
displays in a split view alongside the Design view of the main document.
You can select or deselect Design View on Left (View > Design View on Left), depending on where you want the
Design view.
When you open a related file from Split Code view or Vertical Split Code view (View > Split Code view, and View >
Split vertically), the related file displays in a split view beneath, above, or alongside the source code for the main
document, depending on the options you have selected.
The “code view” in the display option refers to the source code of the main document. For example, if you select
View > Code View on Top, Dreamweaver displays the source code of the main document in the top half of the
Document window. If you select View > Code View on Left, Dreamweaver displays the source code of the main
document on the left side of the Document window.
Standard Code view does not let you display related Documents at the same time as the main documents source
code.
Disable related files
1Select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh).
2In the General category, deselect Enable Related Files.
Open Dynamically-Related Files
The Dynamically-Related Files feature extends the functionality of the Related Files feature by allowing you to see the
related files of dynamic pages in the Related Files toolbar. Specifically, the Dynamically-Related Files feature lets you
see the numerous dynamic includes that are required to generate the runtime code for popular open-source PHP
Content Management System (CMS) frameworks such as WordPress, Drupal and Joomla!.
To use the Dynamically-Related Files feature, you must have access to a local or remote PHP application server running
WordPress, Drupal, or Joomla!. One common approach for testing pages is to set up a localhost PHP application server,
and test the pages locally.
Before you test pages, you’ll need to perform the following steps:
Set up a Dreamweaver site and make sure that you have filled out the Web URL text box the Site Setup dialog box.
99
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Set up a PHP application server.
Note: The server must be running before you attempt to work with Dynamically-Related Files in Dreamweaver.
Install WordPress, Drupal, or Joomla! on the application server. For more information, see:
WordPress Installation
Drupal Installation
Joomla Installation
In Dreamweaver, define a local folder where youll download and edit your CMS files.
Define the location of the installed WordPress, Drupal, or Joomla! files as your remote and testing folder.
Download (Get) your CMS files from the remote folder.
Set Dynamically-Related Files preferences
When you open a page that is associated with Dynamically-Related Files, Dreamweaver can discover the files
automatically, or let you discover the files manually (which you do by clicking a link in the Info bar above the page).
The default setting is manual discovery.
1Choose Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh OS).
2In the General category, make sure the Enable Related Files option is selected.
3Select Manually or Automatically from the Dynamically-Related Files pop-up menu. You can also disable the
discovery entirely by selecting Disabled.
Discover Dynamically-Related Files
1Open a page that has Dynamically-Related Files associated with it—for example, the site root index.php page of a
WordPress, Drupal, or Joomla! site.
2If the discovery of Dynamically-Related Files is set to manual (the default), click the Discover link in the Info bar
that appears above the page in the Document window.
If the discovery of Dynamically-Related Files is automatically enabled, then a list of Dynamically-Related Files
appears in the Related Files toolbar.
The order of Related and Dynamically-Related Files in the Related Files toolbar is as follows:
Static related files (i.e. related files that do not require any sort of dynamic processing)
External related files (i.e. .css and .js files) that are attached to dynamic path server include files
Dynamic path server include files (i.e. .php, .inc, and .module files)
Filter Related Files
Because Related Files and Dynamically-Related Files can often be numerous, Dreamweaver lets you filter Related Files
so that you can precisely locate the files you want to work with.
1Open a page that has Related Files associated with it.
2Discover Dynamically-Related Files if necessary.
3Click the Filter Related Files icon at the right side of the Related Files toolbar.
4Select the types of files you want to see in the Related Files toolbar. By default, Dreamweaver selects all Related Files.
5To create a custom filter, click the Filter Related Files icon and choose Custom Filter.
100
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
The Custom Filter dialog only allows for the filtering of exact file names (style.css), file extensions (.php), and
wildcard expressions using asterisks (*menu*). You can filter on multiple wildcard expressions by separating each
expression with a semi-colon (for example, style.css;*.js;*tpl.php).
Note: Filter settings do not persist once you close the file.
Clean up Microsoft Word HTML files
You can open documents saved by Microsoft Word as HTML files, and then use the Clean Up Word HTML command
to remove the extraneous HTML code generated by Word. The Clean Up Word HTML command is available for
documents saved as HTML files by Word 97 or later.
The code that Dreamweaver removes is primarily used by Word to format and display documents in Word and is not
needed to display the HTML file. Retain a copy of your original Word (.doc) file as a backup, because you may not be
able to reopen the HTML document in Word once you’ve applied the Clean Up Word HTML feature.
To clean up HTML or XHTML that was not generated by Microsoft Word, use the Cleanup HTML command.
1Save your Microsoft Word document as an HTML file.
Note: In Windows, close the file in Word to avoid a sharing violation.
2Open the HTML file in Dreamweaver.
To view the HTML code generated by Word, switch to Code view (View > Code).
3Select Commands > Clean Up Word HTML.
Note: If Dreamweaver is unable to determine which version of Word was used to save the file, select the correct version
from the pop-up menu.
4Select (or deselect) options for the cleanup. The preferences you enter are saved as default cleanup settings.
Dreamweaver applies the cleanup settings to the HTML document and a log of the changes appears (unless you
deselected that option in the dialog box).
Remove All Word Specific Markup Removes all Microsoft Word-specific HTML, including XML from HTMLtags,
Word custom metadata and link tags in the head of the document, Word XML markup, conditional tags and their
contents, and empty paragraphs and margins from styles. You can select each of these options individually using the
Detailed tab.
Clean Up CSS Removes all Word-specific CSS, including inline CSS styles when possible (where the parent style has
the same style properties), style attributes beginning with “mso,” non-CSS style declarations, CSS style attributes
from tables, and all unused style definitions from the head. You can further customize this option using the Detailed
tab.
Clean Up <font> Tags Removes HTML tags, converting the default body text to size 2 HTML text.
Fix Invalidly Nested Tags Removes the font markup tags inserted by Word outside the paragraph and heading
(block-level) tags.
Apply Source Formatting Applies the source formatting options you specify in HTML Format preferences and
SourceFormat.txt to the document.
Show Log On Completion Displays an alert box with details about the changes made to the document as soon as the
cleanup is finished.
5Click OK, or click the Detailed tab if you want to further customize the Remove All Word Specific Markup and
Clean Up CSS options, and then click OK.
101
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
More Help topics
Understanding Cascading Style Sheets
XHTML code
Business Catalyst InContext Editing
Laying out pages with CSS
Save frame and frameset files
Understanding document encoding
Clean up code
Start an external editor for media files
Work with files in the Files panel
Switch between views in the Document window
Navigate to related code
Previewing pages in Dreamweaver
Managing files and folders
About managing files and folders
Dreamweaver includes a Files panel that helps you manage and transfer files to and from a remote server. When you
transfer files between local and remote sites, parallel file and folder structures between the sites are maintained. When
transferring files between sites, Dreamweaver creates corresponding folders if they do not yet exist in a site. You can
also synchronize the files between your local and remote sites; Dreamweaver copies files in both directions as necessary
and removes unwanted files when appropriate.
Using the Files panel
The Files panel enables you to view files and folders, whether they are associated with a Dreamweaver site or not, and
perform standard file maintenance operations, such as opening and moving files.
Note: In previous versions of Dreamweaver the Files panel was called the Site panel.
You can move the Files panel as necessary and set preferences for the panel.
Use this panel to perform the following tasks:
Access sites, a server, and local drives
View files and folders
Manage files and folders in the Files panel
For Dreamweaver sites, use the following options to display or transfer files:
102
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
A Site pop-up menu B Connect/Disconnect C Refresh D View site FTP log E Site files view F Testing serve r G Repository view H Get File(s)
I Put File(s) J Check Out File(s) K Check In File(s) L Synchronize M Expand/Collapse
Note: The Site Files view, Testing Server view, and Synchronize buttons appear only in the expanded Files panel.
The Site pop-up menu Lets you select a Dreamweaver site and display that sites files. You can also use the Site menu to
access all the files on your local disk, much like Windows Explorer(Windows) or the Finder (Macintosh).
Connect/Disconnect (FTP, RDS, and WebDAV protocol) Connects to or disconnects from the remote site. By default,
Dreamweaver disconnects from the remote site if it has been idle for more than 30 minutes (FTP only). To change the
time limit, select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh), then select Site from the
category list on the left.
Refresh Refreshes the local and remote directory lists. Use this button to manually refresh the directory lists if you
deselected either Refresh Local File List Automatically or Refresh Remote File List Automatically in the Site Definition
dialog box.
Site Files view Displays the file structure of the remote and local sites in the panes of the Files panel. (A preference
setting determines which site appears in the left pane and which appears in the right pane.) Site Files view is the default
view for the Files panel.
Testing Server view Displays the directory structure of the testing server and the local site.
Repository view Displays the Subversion (SVN) Repository.
Get File(s) Copies the selected files from the remote site to your local site (overwriting the existing local copy of the file,
if any). If Enable File Check In And Check Out is enabled, the local copies are read-only; the files remain available on
the remote site for other team members to check out. If Enable File Check In and Check Out is disabled, the file copies
will have both read and write privileges.
Note: The files Dreamweaver copies are the files you select in the active pane of the Files panel. If the Remote pane is active,
the selected remote or testing server files are copied to the local site; if the Local pane is active, Dreamweaver copies the
remote or testing server version of the selected local files to the local site.
Put File(s) Copies the selected files from the local site to the remote site.
Note: The files Dreamweaver copies are the files you select in the active pane of the Files panel. If the Local pane is active,
the selected local files are copied to the remote site or testing server; if the Remote pane is active, Dreamweaver copies the
local versions of the selected remote server files to the remote site.
If you are putting a file that doesnt already exist on the remote site, and Enable File Check In and Out is enabled, the
file is added to the remote site as “checked out.” Click the Check In Files button if you want to add a file without the
checked out status.
Check Out File(s) Transfers a copy of the file from the remote server to your local site (overwriting the existing local
copy of the file, if any) and marks the file as checked out on the server. This option is not available if Enable File Check
In and Check Out in the Site Definitions dialog box is disabled for the current site.
Check In File(s) Transfers a copy of the local file to the remote server and makes the file available for editing by others.
The local file becomes read-only. This option is not available if the Enable File Check In and Check Out option in the
Site Definitions dialog box is disabled for the current site.
Synchronize Synchronizes the files between the local and remote folders.
The Expand/Collapse button Expands or collapses the Files panel to display one or two panes.
103
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
View files and folders
You can view files and folders in the Files panel, whether they are associated with a Dreamweaver site or not. When you
view sites, files, or folders in the Files panel, you can change the size of the viewing area, and, for Dreamweaver sites,
you can expand or collapse the Files panel.
For Dreamweaver sites, you can also customize the Files panel by changing the view—either your local or remote site—
that appears by default in the collapsed panel. Or, you can switch the content views in the expanded Files panel using
the Always Show option.
Open or close the Files panel
Select Window > Files.
Search files in the files panel (Mac OS, Creative Cloud users only)
Use Live Search to locate files based on filename or text present in files. The site selected in the Files panel is used for
search. If there is no site selected in the panel, the search option does not appear. For more information, see Search files
based on filenames or content.
Expand or collapse the Files panel (Dreamweaver sites only)
In the Files panel (Window > Files), click the Expand/Collapse button in the toolbar.
Note: If you click the Expand/Collapse button to expand the panel while it is docked, the panel maximizes so that you
cannot work in the Document window. To return to the Document window, click the Expand/Collapse button again to
collapse the panel. If you click the Expand/Collapse button to expand the panel while it is not docked, you can still work
in the Document window. Before you can dock the panel again, you must first collapse it.
When the Files panel is collapsed it displays the contents of the local site, the remote site, or the testing server as a
list of files. When expanded, it displays the local site and either the remote site or testing server.
Change the size of the view area in the expanded Files panel
In the Files panel (Window > Files), with the panel expanded, do one of the following:
Drag the bar that separates the two views to increase or decrease the view area of the right or left pane.
Use the scroll bars at the bottom of the Files panel to scroll through the views’ contents.
Change the site view in Files panel (Dreamweaver sites only)
Do one of the following:
In the collapsed Files panel (Window > Files), select Local View, Remote View, Testing Server, or Repository View
from the Site View pop-up menu.
Note: Local View appears in the Site View menu by default.
In the expanded Files panel (Window > Files), click the Site Files button (for the remote site), the Testing Server
button, or the Repository Files button.
104
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
A Site Files B Testing Server C Repository Files
Note: Before you can view a remote site, testing server or repository, you must set up a remote site, testing server, or
SVN repository.
View files outside of a Dreamweaver site
Navigate your computer using the Site pop-up menu, much as you would if you were using Windows
Explorer(Windows) or the Finder (Macintosh).
Work with files in the Files panel
You can open or rename files; add, move, or delete files; or refresh the Files panel after you make changes.
For Dreamweaver sites, you can also determine which files (on either the local or remote site) have been updated since
the last time they were transferred.
Open a file
1In the Files panel (Window > Files), select a site, server, or drive from the pop-up menu (where the current site,
server, or drive appears).
2Navigate to the file you want to open.
3Do one of the following:
Double-click the files icon.
Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the files icon, then select Open.
Dreamweaver opens the file in the Document window.
Create a file or folder
1In the Files panel (Window > Files), select a file or folder.
Dreamweaver will create the new file or folder inside the currently selected folder, or in the same folder as the
currently selected file.
2Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh), then select New File or New Folder.
3Enter a name for the new file or folder.
4Press Enter (Windows) or Return (Macintosh).
Delete a file or folder
1In the Files panel (Window > Files), select the file or folder you want to delete.
2Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh), then select Edit > Delete.
Rename a file or folder
1In the Files panel (Window > Files), select the file or folder you want to rename.
2Do one of the following to activate the name of the file or folder:
Click in the filename, pause, then click again.
105
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the files icon, then select Edit > Rename.
3Type the new name over the existing name.
4Press Enter (Windows) or Return (Macintosh).
Move a file or folder
1In the Files panel (Window > Files), select the file or folder you want to move.
2Do one of the following:
Copy the file or folder, then paste it in a new location.
Drag the file or folder to a new location.
3Refresh the Files panel to see the file or folder in its new location.
Refresh the Files panel
Do one of the following:
Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) any file or folder, then select Refresh.
(Dreamweaver sites only) Click the Refresh button in the Files panel toolbar (this option refreshes both panes).
Note: Dreamweaver refreshes the Files panel when you make changes in another application, then return to
Dreamweaver.
Find files in your Dreamweaver site
Dreamweaver makes it easy to find selected, open, checked out, or recently modified files in your site. You can also find
files that are newer in your local or remote site.
Find an open file in your site
1Open the file in the Document window.
2Select Site > Locate in Site.
Dreamweaver selects the file in the Files panel.
Note: If the open file in the Document window is not part of the current site in the Files panel, Dreamweaver attempts
to determine which of your Dreamweaver sites the file belongs to; if the current file belongs to only one local site,
Dreamweaver opens that site in the Files panel, then highlights the file.
Locate and select checked out files in a Dreamweaver site
In the collapsed Files panel (Window > Files), click the Options menu in the upper-right corner of the Files panel,
then select Edit > Select Checked Out Files.
Dreamweaver selects the files in the Files panel.
Find a selected file in your local or remote site
1Select the file in the Local or Remote view of the Files panel (Window > Files).
2Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh), then select Locate in Local Site or Locate in Local Site
(depending on where you selected the file).
Dreamweaver selects the file in the Files panel.
106
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Locate and select files that are newer in the local site than in the remote site
In the collapsed Files panel (Window > Files), click the Options menu in the upper-right corner of the Files panel,
then select Edit > Select Newer Local.
Dreamweaver selects the files in the Files panel.
Locate and select files that are newer in the remote site than in the local site
In the collapsed Files panel (Window > Files), click the Options menu in the upper-right corner of the Files panel,
then select Edit > Select Newer Remote.
Dreamweaver selects the files in the Files panel.
Find recently modified files in your site
1In the collapsed Files panel (Window > Files), click the Options menu in the upper-right corner of the Files panel,
and then select Edit > Select Recently Modified.
2Do one of the following to indicate search dates for the report:
To report on all files modified in the last several days, select Files Created or Modified in the Last and enter a
number in the box.
To report on all files modified within a specific time frame, click the Files Created or Modified in the Between
radio button, then specify a date range.
3(Optional) Enter a user name in the Modified By box to limit your search to files modified by a specific user between
the dates you indicated.
Note: This option is only available for reports on Contribute sites.
4Select a radio button to indicate where you want to view files listed in the report, if necessary:
Local Machine if the site contains static pages.
Testing Server if the site contains dynamic pages.
Note: This option assumes you defined a Testing Server in the Site Definition dialog box (XREF). If you have not defined
a Testing Server and entered a URL prefix for that server, or if you are running the report for more than one site, this
option is not available.
Other Location if you want to enter a path in the text box.
5Click OK to save your settings.
Dreamweaver highlights the files that were modified within the selected time frame in the Files panel.
Identify and delete unused files
You can identify and delete files that are no longer used by other files in your site.
1Select Site > Check Links Sitewide.
Dreamweaver checks all the links in your site and displays the broken ones in the Results panel.
2Select Orphaned Files from the menu on the Link Checker panel.
Dreamweaver displays all the files with no incoming links. This means that no files in your site link to these files.
3Select the files you want to delete and press Delete.
Note: Although no other file in the site links to these files, some of the listed files may link to other files. Use caution when
deleting the files.
107
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Access sites, a server, and local drives
You can access, modify, and save files and folders in your Dreamweaver sites, as well as files and folders that are not part
of a Dreamweaver site. In addition to Dreamweaver sites, you can access a server, a local drive, or your desktop.
Before you can access a remote server, you must set up Dreamweaver to work with that server.
Note: The best way to manage your files is to create a Dreamweaver site.
Open an existing Dreamweaver site
In the Files panel (Window > Files), select a site from the menu (where the current site, server, or drive appears).
Open a folder on a remote FTP or RDS server
1In the Files panel (Window > Files), select a server name from the menu (where the current site, server, or drive
appears).
Note: Server names appear for servers you’ve configured Dreamweaver to work with.
2Navigate to and edit files as you normally do.
Access a local drive or your desktop
1In the Files panel (Window > Files), select Desktop, Local Disk, or CD Drive from the menu (where the current site,
server, or drive appears).
2Navigate to a file, then do any of the following:
Open files in Dreamweaver or another application
Rename files
Copy files
Delete files
Drag files
108
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
When you drag a file from one Dreamweaver site to another or to a folder that is not part of a Dreamweaver site,
Dreamweavercopies the file to the location where you drop it. If you drag a file within the same Dreamweaver
site, Dreamweavermoves the file to the location where you drop it. If you drag a file that is not part of a
Dreamweaver site to a folder that is not part of a Dreamweaver site, Dreamweaver moves the file to the location
where you drop it.
Note: To move a file that Dreamweaver copies by default, hold down the Shift key (Windows) or the Command key
(Macintosh) while you drag. To copy a file that Dreamweaver moves by default, hold the Control key (Windows) or the
Option key (Macintosh) while you drag.
Customize the file and folder details displayed in the expanded Files panel
When you view a Dreamweaver site in the expanded Files panel, information about the files and folders is displayed in
columns. For example, you can see the file type or the date a file was modified.
You can customize the columns by doing any of the following (some operations are only available for columns you add,
not default columns):
Reorder or realign columns
Add new columns (for a maximum of 10 columns)
Hide columns (except the filename column)
Designate columns to be shared with all users connected to a site
Delete columns (custom columns only)
Rename columns (custom columns only)
Associate columns with a Design Note (custom columns only)
Change the order of the columns
Select a column name, and then click the up or down arrow button to change the position of the selected column.
Note: You can change the order of any column except Name, which is always the first column.
Add, delete, or change detail columns
1Select Site > Manage Sites.
2Select a site, then click Edit.
3Expand Advanced Settings and select the File View Columns category.
4Select a column and click the Plus (+) button to add a column, or the Minus (–) button to delete a column.
Note: The column is deleted immediately and without confirmation, so make certain that you want to delete the column
before clicking the Minus (–) button.
5In the Column Name box, enter a name for your column.
6Select a value from the Associate with Design Notes menu, or type in your own.
Note: You must associate a new column with a Design Note, so that there is data to display in the Files panel.
7Select an alignment to determine how text is aligned within the column.
8Select or deselect Show to reveal or hide the column.
9Select Share with All Users of This Site to share the column with all users connected to the remote site.
109
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Sort by any detail column in the Files panel
Click the heading for the column you want to sort.
Click the heading again to reverse the order (ascending or descending) by which Dreamweaver sorts the column.
Getting and putting files to and from your server
File transfer and dependent files
If youre working in a collaborative environment, use the Check In/Check Out system to transfer files between local
and remote sites. If you’re the only person working on the remote site, however, you can use the Get and Put commands
to transfer files without checking them in or out.
When you transfer a document between a local and remote folder using the Files panel, you have the option of
transferring the documents dependent files. Dependent files are images, external style sheets, and other files referenced
in your document that a browser loads when it loads the document.
Note: Its usually a good idea to download dependent files when checking out a new file, but if the latest versions of the
dependent files are already on the local disk, theres no need to download them again. This is also true for uploading and
checking in files: no need if up-to-date copies are already at the remote site.
Library items are treated as dependent files.
Some servers report errors when putting library items. However, you can cloak these files to prevent them from being
transferred.
About background file transfers
You can perform other, non-server-related, activities while you’re getting or putting files. Background file transfer
works for all of the transfer protocols supported by Dreamweaver: FTP, SFTP, LAN, WebDAV, Subversion, and RDS.
Non-server-related activities include common operations like typing, editing external style sheets, generating site-wide
reports, and creating new sites.
Server-related activities that Dreamweaver cannot perform during file transfers include the following:
Put/Get/Check in/Check out files
Undo check-out
Create a database connection
Bind dynamic data
Preview data in Live view
Insert a web service
Delete remote files or folders
Preview in a browser on a testing server
Save a file to a remote server
Insert an image from a remote server
110
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Open a file from a remote server
Auto put files upon saving
Drag files to the remote site
Cut, copy, or paste files on the remote site
Refresh Remote view
By default, the Background File Activity dialog box is open during file transfers. You can minimize the dialog box by
clicking the Minimize button in the upper right corner. Closing the dialog box during file transfers results in a
cancelation of the operation.
Get files from a remote server
Use the Get command to copy files from the remote site to your local site. You can use the Files panel or the Document
window to get files.
Dreamweaver creates a log of file activity during the transfer that you can view and save.
Note: You cannot turn background file transfer off. If you have the detail log open in the Background File Activity dialog
box, you can close that to improve performance.
Dreamweaver also records all FTP file transfer activity. If an error occurs when you are transferring a file using FTP,
the Site FTP log can help you determine the problem.
Get files from a remote server using the Files panel
1In the Files panel (Window > Files), select the desired files to download.
Usually you select these files in the Remote view, but you can select the corresponding files in the Local view if you
prefer. If the Remote view is active, then Dreamweaver copies the selected files to the local site; if the Local view is
active, then Dreamweaver copies the remote versions of the selected local files to the local site.
Note: To get only those files for which the remote version is more recent than the local version, use the Synchronize
command.
2Do one of the following to get the file:
Click the Get button in the Files panel toolbar.
Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the file in the Files panel, then select Get from the context
menu.
3Click Yes in the Dependent Files dialog box to download dependent files; if you already have local copies of the
dependent files, click No. The default is to not download dependent files. You can set this option at Edit >
Preferences > Site.
Dreamweaver downloads the selected files, as follows:
If youre using the Check In/Check Out system, getting a file results in a read-only local copy of the file; the file
remains available on the remote site or testing server for other team members to check out.
If youre not using the Check In/Check Out system, getting a file results in a copy that has both read and write
privileges.
Note: If you’re working in a collaborative environment—that is, if others are working on the same files—you should not
disable Enable File Check In and Check Out. If other people are using the Check In/Check Out system with the site, you
should use that system as well.
To stop the file transfer at any time, click the Cancel button in the Background File Activity dialog box.
111
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Get files from a remote server using the Document window
1Make sure the document is active in the Document window.
2Do one of the following to get the file:
Select Site > Get.
Click the File Management icon in the Document window toolbar, then select Get from the menu.
Note: If the current file is not part of the current site in the Files panel, Dreamweaver attempts to determine which
locally defined site the current file belongs to. If the current file belongs to only one local site, Dreamweaver opens that
site, then performs the Get operation.
Display the FTP log
1Click the Options menu in the upper right corner of the Files panel.
2Select View > Site FTP Log.
Note: In the Expanded Files Panel, you can click the FTP Log button to display the log.
Put files on a remote server
You can put files from the local site to the remote site, generally without changing the files checked out status.
There are two common situations in which you might use the Put command instead of Check In:
Youre not in a collaborative environment and you aren’t using the Check In/Check Out system.
You want to put the current version of the file on the server but youre going to keep editing it.
Note: If you put a file that didn’t previously exist on the remote site and you’re using the Check In/Check Out system, the
file is copied to the remote site and is then checked out to you so that you can continue editing.
You can use the Files panel or the Document window to put files. Dreamweaver creates a log of file activity during the
transfer that you can view and save.
Note: You cannot turn background file transfer off. If you have the detail log open in the Background File Activity dialog
box, you can close that to improve performance.
Dreamweaver also records all FTP file transfer activity. If an error occurs when you are transferring a file using FTP,
the Site FTP log can help you determine the problem.
For a tutorial on putting files on a remote server, see www.adobe.com/go/vid0163.
For a tutorial on troubleshooting publishing problems, see www.adobe.com/go/vid0164.
Put files on a remote or testing server using the Files panel
1In the Files panel (Window > Files), select the files to upload.
Usually you select these in the Local view, but you may select the corresponding files in the Remote view if you
prefer.
Note: You can put only those files for which the local version is more recent than the remote version.
2Do one of the following to put the file on the remote server:
Click the Put button in the Files panel toolbar.
Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the file in the Files panel, then select Put from the context
menu.
112
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
3If the file hasn’t been saved, a dialog box appears (if you set this preference in the Site category of the Preferences
dialog box) allowing you to save the file before putting it on the remote server. Click Yes to save the file or No to put
the previously saved version on the remote server.
Note: If you do not save the file, any changes you’ve made since the last time you saved will not be put onto the remote
server. However, the file remains open, so you can still save the changes after putting the file on the server if you want.
4Click Yes to upload dependent files along with the selected files, or click No to refrain from uploading dependent
files. The default is to not upload dependent files. You can set this option at Edit > Preferences > Site.
Note: It’s usually a good idea to upload dependent files when checking in a new file, but if the latest versions of the
dependent files are already on the remote server, theres no need to upload them again.
To stop the file transfer at any time, click the Cancel button in the Background File Activity dialog box.
Put files on a remote server using the Document window
1Make sure the document is active in the Document window.
2Do one of the following to put the file:
Select Site > Put.
Click the File Management icon in the Document window toolbar, then select Put from the menu.
Note: If the current file is not part of the current site in the Files panel, Dreamweaver attempts to determine which
locally defined site the current file belongs to. If the current file belongs to only one local site, Dreamweaver opens that
site, then performs the Put operation.
Display the FTP log
1Click the Options menu in the upper right corner of the Files panel.
2Select View > Site FTP Log.
Note: In the Expanded Files Panel, you can click the FTP Log button to display the log.
Manage file transfers
You can view the status of file transfer operations, as well as a list of transferred files and their outcomes (transfer
successful, skipped, or failed). You can also save a log of the file activity.
Note: Dreamweaver lets you perform other non-server-related activities while youre transferring files to or from a server.
Cancel a file transfer
Click the Cancel button in the Background File Activity dialog box. If the dialog box isnt showing, click the File
Activity button at the bottom of the Files panel.
Show the Background File Activity dialog box during transfers
Click the File Activity or Log button at the bottom of the Files panel.
Note: You cannot hide or remove the Log button. It’s a permanent part of the panel.
View details of the last file transfer
1Click the Log button at the bottom of the Files panel to open the Background File Activity dialog box.
2Click the Details expander arrow.
113
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Save a log of the last file transfer
1Click the Log button at the bottom of the Files panel to open the Background File Activity dialog box.
2Click the Save Log button and save the information as a text file.
You can review the file activity by opening the log file in Dreamweaver or in any text editor.
More Help topics
Checking in and checking out files
Enable and disable site cloaking
Checking in and checking out files
Synchronizing files
Synchronizing files
About the Check In/Check Out system
Putting files tutorial
Troubleshoot publishing problems tutorial
Checking in and checking out files
About the Check In/Check Out system
If you’re working in a collaborative environment, you can check files in and out from local and remote servers. If you’re
the only person working on the remote server, you can use the Put and Get commands without checking files in or out.
Note: You can use Get and Put functionality with a testing server, but you cannot use the Check In/ Check Out system with
a testing server.
Checking out a file is the equivalent of declaring “I’m working on this file nowdon’t touch it!” When a file is checked
out, the name of the person who checked out the file is displayed in the Files panel, along with a red check mark (if a
team member checked out the file) or green check mark (if you checked out the file) next to the files icon.
Checking in a file makes the file available for other team members to check out and edit. When you check in a file after
editing it, your local version becomes read-only and a lock symbol appears beside the file in the Files panel to prevent
you from making changes to the file.
Dreamweaver does not make checked-out files read-only on the remote server. If you transfer files with an application
other than Dreamweaver, you can overwrite checked-out files. However, in applications other than Dreamweaver, the
LCK file is visible next to the checked-out file in the file hierarchy to help prevent such accidents.
Set up the Check In/Check Out system
Before you can use the Check In/Check Out system, you must associate your local site with a remote server.
1Select Site > Manage Sites.
2Select a site and click Edit.
114
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
3In the Site Setup dialog box, select the Servers category and do one of the following:
Click the Add New Server button to add a new server
Select an existing server and click the Edit Existing Server button
4Specify Basic options as necessary, and then click the Advanced button.
5Select Enable File Check Out if you are working in a team environment (or working alone but from several different
machines). Deselect this option if you want to disable file check in and check out for your website.
This option is useful to let others know that you checked out a file for editing, or to alert yourself that you may have
left a more recent version of a file on another machine.
If you do not see Check In/Out options, it means that you have not set up a remote server.
6Select the Check Out Files when Opening option if you want to automatically check out files when you double-click
to open them from the Files panel.
Using File > Open to open a file doesnt check the file out even when this option is selected.
7Set the remaining options:
Check Out Name The check-out name appears in the Files panel alongside any files that are checked out; this enables
team members to communicate with the right person if a file they need is checked out.
Note: If you work alone from several different machines, use a different check-out name on each machine (for example,
AmyR-HomeMac and AmyR-OfficePC) so youll know where the latest version of the file is if you forget to check it in.
Email Address If you enter an e-mail address, when you check out a file, your name appears in the Files panel as a
link (blue and underlined) next to that file. If a team member clicks on the link, their default e-mail program opens
a new message with the user’s e-mail address and a subject that corresponds to the file and site name.
Check files into and out of a remote folder
After you set up the Check In/Check Out system, you can check in and check out files on a remote server using the Files
panel or from the Document window.
Check out files using the Files panel
1In the Files panel (Window > Files), select files to check out from the remote server.
Note: You can select files in the Local or Remote view, not the Testing Server view.
A red check mark indicates that another team member has the file checked out and a lock symbol indicates that the
file is read-only (Windows) or locked (Macintosh).
2Do one of the following to check out the file(s):
Click the Check Out button in the Files panel toolbar.
Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh), then select Check Out from the context menu.
3In the Dependent Files dialog box, click Yes to download dependent files along with the selected files, or click No to
refrain from downloading dependent files. The default is to not download dependent files. You can set this option
at Edit > Preferences > Site.
Note: It’s usually a good idea to download dependent files when checking out a new file, but if the latest versions of the
dependent files are already on the local disk, theres no need to download them again.
A green check mark appears beside the local files icon indicating that you have checked it out.
115
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: If you check out the currently active file, the currently open version of the file is overwritten by the new checked-
out version.
Check in files using the Files panel
1In the Files panel (Window > Files), select checked-out or new file(s).
Note: You can select files in the Local or Remote view, but not the Testing Server view.
2Do one of the following to check in the file(s):
Click the Check In button in the Files panel toolbar.
Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh), then select Check In from the context menu.
3Click Yes to upload dependent files along with the selected files, or click No to refrain from uploading dependent
files. The default is to not upload dependent files. You can set this option at Edit > Preferences > Site.
Note: It’s usually a good idea to upload dependent files when checking in a new file, but if the latest versions of the
dependent files are already on the remote server, theres no need to upload them again.
A lock symbol appears beside the local files icon indicating that the file is now read-only.
Note: If you check in the currently active file, the file may be automatically saved before it’s checked in, depending on
the preference options youve set.
Check in an open file from the Document window
1Make sure the file you want to check in is open in the Document window.
Note: You can check in only one open file at a time.
2Do one of the following:
Select Site > Check In.
Click the File Management icon in the Document window toolbar, then select Check In from the menu.
If the current file is not part of the active site in the Files panel, Dreamweaver attempts to determine which locally
defined site the current file belongs to. If the current file belongs to a site other than the one thats active in the
Files panel, Dreamweaver opens that site, then performs the check in operation.
Note: If you check in the currently active file, the file may be automatically saved before it’s checked in, depending on
the preference options youve set.
Undo a file check-out
If you check out a file, then decide not to edit it (or decide to discard the changes you made), you can undo the check-
out operation and the file returns to its original state.
To undo a file check-out, do one of the following:
Open the file in the Document window, then select Site > Undo Check Out.
In the Files panel (Window > Files), right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh), then select Undo Check
Out.
The local copy of the file becomes read-only, and any changes you’ve made to it are lost.
116
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Use WebDAV to check in and check out files
Dreamweaver can connect to a server that uses WebDAV (Web-based Distributed Authoring and Versioning), which
is a set of extensions to the HTTP protocol that allow users to collaboratively edit and manage files on remote web
servers. For more information, see www.webdav.org.
1If you have not already done so, define a Dreamweaver site that specifies the local folder you use to store your project
files.
2Select Site > Manage Sites, and then double-click your site in the list.
3In the Site Setup dialog box, select the Servers category and do one of the following:
Click the Add New Server button to add a new server
Select an existing server and click the Edit Existing Server button
4In the Basic screen, select WebDAV from the Connect Using pop-up menu, and complete the rest of the Basic screen
options, as necessary.
5Click the Advanced button.
6Select the Enable File Check Out option and enter the following information:
In the Check Out Name box, enter a name identifying you to other team members.
In the Email Address box, enter your e-mail address.
The name and e-mail addresses are used to identify ownership on the WebDAV server and appear in the Files
panel for contact purposes.
7Click Save.
Dreamweaver configures the site for WebDAV access. When you use the Check In or Check Out command on any
site file, the file is transferred using WebDAV.
Note: WebDAV may be unable to properly check out any files with dynamic content like PHP tags or SSIs because the
HTTP GET renders these as they are checked out.
Use Subversion (SVN) to get and check in files
Dreamweaver can connect to a server that uses Subversion (SVN), a versioning control system that lets users
collaboratively edit and manage files on remote web servers. Dreamweaver is not a full SVN client, but does let users
get the latest versions of files, make changes, and commit the files.
Note: Dreamweaver CS5 uses the Subversion 1.6.6 client library, and Dreamweaver CS5.5 uses the 1.6.9 client library.
Later versions of the Subversion client library are not backward-compatible. Be aware, if you update a third-party client
application (for example, TortoiseSVN) to work with a later version of Subversion, the updated Subversion application will
update local Subversion meta data, and Dreamweaver will no longer be able to communicate with Subversion. This issue
is not affected by updates to the Subversion server as those updates are backward-compatible. If you do upgrade to a third-
party client application that works with Subversion 1.7 or later, you’ll need to check with Adobe for updates before you can
use Subversion with Dreamweaver again. For more information on this issue, see www.adobe.com/go/dw_svn_en.
Adobe recommends that you use a third-party file comparison tool as you work with SVN version-controlled files.
When you compare files for differences, you can learn exactly what kinds of changes other users made to the files. For
more information on file comparison tools, use a web search engine such as Google Search to search for “file
comparison” or “diff” tools. Dreamweaver works with most third-party tools.
For a video overview of working with SVN and Dreamweaver, see www.adobe.com/go/lrvid4049_dw.
117
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Set up an SVN connection
Before you use Subversion (SVN) as a version control system with Dreamweaver, you must set up a connection to an
SVN server. You set up a connection to an SVN server in the Version Control category of the Site Definition dialog box.
The SVN server is a repository of files from which you and other users can get and commit files. It is different from the
remote server you typically use with Dreamweaver. When using SVN, the remote server remains the “live” server for
your web pages, and the SVN server exists to hold the repository of files over which you want to maintain version
control. The typical workflow is to get and commit files back and forth between the SVN server, and then publish them
to your remote server from Dreamweaver. The remote server setup is completely separate from the SVN set up.
You must have access to an SVN server and an SVN repository before you begin this set up. For more information about
SVN, see the Subversion website at http://subversion.apache.org/.
To set up the SVN connection, follow these steps:
1Choose Sites > Manage Sites, select the site you want to set up version control for, and click the Edit button.
Note: If you haven’t already set up local and remote folders for a Dreamweaver site, you’ll at least need to set up a local
site before proceeding. (The remote site is not required at this stage, but you will eventually need to set it up before
publishing your files to the Web.) For more information, see Working with Dreamweaver sites.
2In the Site Setup dialog box, select the Version Control category.
3Select Subversion from the Access pop-up menu.
4Set access options as follows:
Select a protocol from the Protocol pop-up menu. The available protocols are HTTP, HTTPS, SVN, and
SVN+SSH.
Note: Using the SVN+SSH protocol requires special configuration. For more information, see
www.adobe.com/go/learn_dw_svn_ssh_en.
Enter the address for the SVN server in the Server address text box (typically in the form of
servername.domain.com).
Enter the path to your repository on the SVN server in the Repository path text box (typically something like
/svn/your_root_directory. It is up to the server administrator to name the root folder for the SVN repository.)
(Optional) If you want to use a server port other than the default server port, select Non Default and enter the
port number in the text box.
Enter your SVN server user name and password.
5Click Test to test your connection, or click OK to close the dialog box. Then click Done to close the Manage Sites
dialog box.
Once the connection with the server established, your SVN repository is available for viewing in the Files panel. To view
it, you can select Repository View from the View pop-up menu, or click the Repository Files button in the expanded
Files panel.
Get the latest versions of files
When you get the latest version of a file from the SVN repository, Dreamweaver merges the contents of that file with
the contents of its corresponding local copy. (In other words, if someone else has updated the file since you last
committed it, those updates are merged into the local version of the file on your computer.) If the file does not yet exist
on the local hard drive, Dreamweaver simply gets the file.
118
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: When getting files for the first time from the repository, you should work with a local directory that is empty, or a
local directory that does not contain files with the same names as files in the repository. Dreamweaver will not mount
repository files to the local drive upon first try if the local drive contains files whose names match files in the remote
repository.
1Make sure that you’ve successfully set up an SVN connection.
2Do one of the following:
Display the local version of your SVN files in the Files panel by selecting Local view from the View pop-up menu.
(If you are working in the expanded Files panel, the Local view is automatically displayed.) Then right-click
(Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the file or folder youre interested in and select Version Control > Get
Latest Versions.
Display the SVN repository files by selecting Repository View from the View pop-up menu in the Files panel, or
by clicking the Repository Files button in the expanded Files panel. Then right-click (Windows) or Control-click
(Macintosh) the file or folder youre interested in and select Get Latest Versions.
Note: You can also either right-click a file and choose Check Out from the context menu, or select the file and click the Check
Out button to get the latest version. Because SVN does not support a check-out workflow, however, this action does not
actually check out the file in the traditional sense.
Commit files
1Make sure that you’ve successfully set up an SVN connection.
2Do one of the following:
Display the local version of your SVN files in the Files panel by selecting Local view from the View pop-up menu.
(If you are working in the expanded Files panel, the Local view is automatically displayed.) Then select the file
you want to commit and click the Check In button.
Display the SVN repository files by selecting Repository View from the View pop-up menu in the Files panel, or
by clicking the Repository Files button in the expanded Files panel. Then right-click (Windows) or Control-click
(Macintosh) the file you want to commit and select Check In.
3Review the actions in the Commit dialog box, make changes if necessary, and click OK.
You can change actions by selecting the file whose action you want to change, and clicking the buttons at the bottom
of the Commit dialog box. Two choices are available: commit and ignore.
Note: A green check mark on a file in the Files panel denotes a changed file that has not yet been committed to the
repository.
Update status of files or folders in the repository
You can update the SVN status of a single file or folder. The update does not refresh the entire display.
1Make sure that you’ve successfully set up an SVN connection.
2Display the SVN repository files by selecting Repository View from the View pop-up menu in the Files panel, or by
clicking the Repository Files button in the expanded Files panel.
3Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) any folder or file in the repository and select Update Status.
Update status of local file or folders
You can update the SVN status of a single file or folder. The update does not refresh the entire display.
1Make sure that you’ve successfully set up an SVN connection.
119
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
2Display the local version of your SVN files in the Files panel by selecting Local view from the View pop-up menu.
(If you are working in the expanded Files panel, the Local view is automatically displayed.)
3Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) any folder or file in the Files panel and select Update Status.
View revisions for a file
1Make sure that you’ve successfully set up an SVN connection.
2Do one of the following:
Display the local version of your SVN files in the Files panel by selecting Local view from the View pop-up menu.
(If you are working in the expanded Files panel, the Local view is automatically displayed.) Then right-click
(Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the file you want to see revisions for and select Version Control > Show
Revisions.
Display the SVN repository files by selecting Repository View from the View pop-up menu in the Files panel, or
by clicking the Repository Files button in the expanded Files panel. Then right-click (Windows) or Control-click
(Macintosh) the file you want to see revisions for and select Show Revisions.
3In the Revision History dialog box, select the revision or revisions you’re interested in and do one of the following:
Click Compare to Local to compare the selected revision with the local version of the file.
Note: You must install a third-party file comparison tool before you can compare files. For more information on file
comparison tools, use a web search engine such as Google Search to search for “file comparison” ordiff ” tools.
Dreamweaver works with most third-party tools.
Click Compare to compare two selected revisions. Control-click to select two revisions simultaneously.
Click View to view the selected revision. This action does not overwrite the current local copy of the same file.
You can save the selected revision to your hard drive just as you would save any other file.
Click Promote to make the selected revision the most current revision in the repository.
Lock and unlock files
Locking a file in the SVN repository lets other users know that you are working on a file. Other users can still edit the
file locally, but will not be able to commit the file until you’ve unlocked it. When you lock a file in the repository, youll
see an open-lock icon on the file. Other users see a completely locked icon.
1Make sure that you’ve successfully set up an SVN connection.
2Do one of the following:
Display the SVN repository files by selecting Repository View from the View pop-up menu in the Files panel, or
by clicking the Repository Files button in the expanded Files panel. Then right-click (Windows) or Control-click
(Macintosh) the file you’re interested in and select Lock or Unlock.
Display the local version of your SVN files in the Files panel by selecting Local view from the View pop-up menu.
(If you are working in the expanded Files panel, the Local view is automatically displayed.) Then right-click
(Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the file youre interested in and select Lock or Unlock.
Add a new file to the repository
A blue plus sign on a file in the Files panel denotes a file that does not yet exist in the SVN repository.
1Make sure that you’ve successfully set up an SVN connection.
2In the Files panel, select the file you want to add to the repository and click the Check In button.
3Make sure that the file is selected for Commit in the Commit dialog box and click OK.
120
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Move, copy, delete, or revert files
To move a file, drag the file to the destination folder in your local site.
When you move a file, Dreamweaver marks the file in the new location with an Add With History sign, and marks
the file in the old location with a Delete sign. When you Commit these files, the file in the old location disappears.
To copy a file, select the file, copy it (Edit > Copy), and paste (Edit > Paste) the file in the new location.
When you copy and paste a file, Dreamweaver marks the file in the new location with an Add With History sign.
To delete a file, select the file and press delete.
Dreamweaver gives you the option of whether you want to delete the local version of the file only, or both the local
version and the version on the SVN server. If you select to delete the local version only, the file on the SVN server
is not affected. If you select to delete the version on the SVN server as well, the local version is marked with a Delete
sign, and you must commit the file for the deletion to take place.
To revert a copied or moved file to its original location, right-click the file and select Version Control > Revert.
Resolve conflicting files
If your file conflicts with another file on the server, you can edit it and then mark it as resolved. For example, if you try
to check in a file that conflicts with another user’s changes, SVN will not let you commit the file. You can get the latest
version of the file from the repository, manually make changes to your working copy, and then mark your file as
resolved so that you can commit it.
1Make sure that you’ve successfully set up an SVN connection.
2Display the local version of your SVN files in the Files panel by selecting Local view from the View pop-up menu.
(If you are working in the expanded Files panel, the Local view is automatically displayed.)
3Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the file you want to resolve and select Version Control > Mark
as Resolved.
Go offline
You might find it useful to avoid repository access during other file-transfer activities by going off-line. Dreamweaver
will reconnect to the SVN repository as soon as you invoke an activity that requires a connection (Get Latest Versions,
Commit, and so on).
1Make sure that you’ve successfully set up an SVN connection.
2Display the local version of your SVN files in the Files panel by selecting Local view from the View pop-up menu.
(If you are working in the expanded Files panel, the Local view is automatically displayed.)
3Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) any file or folder in the Files panel and select Version Control
> Go Offline.
Clean up a local SVN site
This command lets you remove locks on files so that you can resume unfinished operations. You should use this
command to remove old locks if you receive “working copy locked” errors.
1Make sure that you’ve successfully set up an SVN connection.
2Display the local version of your SVN files in the Files panel by selecting Local view from the View pop-up menu.
(If you are working in the expanded Files panel, the Local view is automatically displayed.)
3Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the file you want to clean up and select Version Control >
Clean Up.
121
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
About moving files and folders in Subversion-controlled sites
When you move the local versions of files or folders in a Subversion-controlled site, you run the risk of creating
problems for other users who might be synching to the SVN repository. For example, if you move a file locally, and
don't commit that file to the repository for a few hours, another user might try to get the latest version of the file from
the files old location. For this reason, you should always commit files back to the SVN server immediately after you've
moved them locally.
Files and folders remain on the SVN server until you've manually deleted them. So even if you move a file to a different
local folder and commit it, the old version of the file remains in the previous location on the server. To avoid confusion,
delete the old copies of files and folders that you've moved.
When you move a file locally and commit it back to the SVN server, the files version history is lost.
More Help topics
Getting and putting files toand from your server
Working with Dreamweaver sites
Using the Files panel
Synchronizing files
Synchronize the files on your local and remote sites
After you’ve created files in your local and remote sites, you can synchronize the files between the two sites.
Note: If your remote site is an FTP server (rather than a networked server), then synchronizing your files uses FTP.
Before you synchronize your sites, you can verify which files you want to put, get, delete, or ignore. Dreamweaver also
confirms which files have been updated after you complete the synchronization.
Check which files are newer on the local or remote site, without synchronizing
In the Files panel, do one of the following:
Click the Options menu in the upper-right corner, and then select Edit > Select Newer Local or Edit > Select
Newer Remote.
In the Files panel, right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh), and then select Select > Newer Local or
Select > Newer Remote.
Display detailed synchronization information for a particular file
In the Files panel, right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the file you want information about, and then
select Display Synchronize information.
Note: You must have the Maintain Synchronization Information option selected in the Remote category of the Site
Definition dialog box for this feature to be available.
122
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Synchronize your files
1In the Files panel (Window > Files), select a site from the menu where the current site, server, or drive appears.
2(Optional) Select specific files or folders or go to the next step to synchronize the entire site.
3Click the Options menu in the upper-right corner of the Files panel and select Site > Synchronize.
You can also click the Synchronize button at the top of the Files panel to synchronize files.
4In the Synchronize menu, do one of the following:
To synchronize the entire site, select Entire Site Name Site.
To synchronize selected files only, select Selected Local Files Only (or Selected Remote Files Only if the Remote
view of the Files panel was where you made the most recent selection).
5Select the direction in which you want to copy the files:
Put Newer Files To Remote Uploads all the local files that don’t exist on the remote server or have changed since the
last upload.
Get Newer Files From Remote Downloads all the remote files that dont exist locally or have changed since the last
download.
Get And Put Newer Files Places the most recent versions of all the files on both the local and the remote sites.
6Select whether to delete the files on the destination site that don’t have counterparts on the origin site. (This is not
available if you select Get and Put from the Direction menu.)
If you select Put Newer Files to Remote and you select the Delete option, then any files in your remote site for which
there are no corresponding local files are deleted. If you select Get Newer Files from Remote, then any files in your
local site for which there are no corresponding remote files are deleted.
7Click Preview.
Note: Before you can synchronize the files, you must preview the actions Dreamweaver performs to accomplish this task.
If the newest version of each chosen file is already in both locations and nothing needs to be deleted, an alert appears
informing you that no synchronization is necessary. Otherwise, the Synchronize dialog box appears to let you
change the actions (put, get, delete, and ignore) for those files before executing the synchronization.
8Verify the action that will be performed for each file.
9To change the action for a particular file, select the file, and then click one of the action icons at the bottom of the
preview window.
Compare The Compare action works only if you installed and specified a file comparison tool in Dreamweaver. If
the action icon is grayed out, the action cannot be performed.
Mark Selected Files As Already Synched This option lets you specify that the selected file or files are already
synchronized.
10 Click OK to synchronize the files. You can view or save the details of the synchronization to a local file.
More Help topics
Manage file transfers
Check files into and out of a remote folder
Get files from a remote server
123
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Put files on a remote server
Comparing files for differences
Comparing files for differences
Compare local and remote files for differences
Dreamweaver can work with file comparison tools (also known asdiff tools”) to compare the code of local and remote
versions of the same file, two different remote files, or two different local files. Comparing local and remote versions is
useful if you’re working on a file locally and you suspect the copy of the file on the server has been modified by someone
else. Without leaving Dreamweaver, you can view and merge the remote changes into your local version before putting
the file to the server.
Comparing two local files or two remote files is also useful if you keep previous, renamed versions of your files. If you’ve
forgotten the changes made to a file from a previous version, a quick comparison will remind you.
Before you start, you must install a third-party file comparison tool on your system. For more information on file
comparison tools, use a web search engine such as Google Search to search for “file comparison” ordiff” tools.
Dreamweaver works with most third-party tools.
Specify a comparison tool in Dreamweaver
1Install the file comparison tool on the same system as Dreamweaver.
2In Dreamweaver, open the Preferences dialog box by selecting Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver >
Preferences (Macintosh), and then select the File Compare category.
3Do one of the following:
In Windows, click the Browse button and select the application that compares files.
On the Macintosh, click the Browse button and select the tool or script that launches the file comparison tool
from the command line, not the actual comparison tool itself.
Launch tools or scripts are typically located in the /usr/bin folder on your Macintosh. For example, if you want to
use FileMerge, browse to /usr/bin and select opendiff, which is the tool that launches FileMerge.
The following table lists common file comparison tools for the Macintosh and the location of their launch tools or
scripts on your hard disk:
Note: The usr folder is normally hidden in Finder. However, you can access it with the Browse button in Dreamweaver.
Note: The actual results displayed depends on the diff tool you are using. Check the user manual for your tool to understand
how to interpret the results.
If you use Select the following file
FileMerge /usr/bin/opendiff (or /Developer/usr/bin/opendiff)
BBEdit /usr/bin/bbdiff
TextWrangler /usr/bin/twdiff
124
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Compare two local files
You can compare two files located anywhere on your computer.
1In the Files panel, Control-click (Windows) or Command-click (Macintosh) the two files to select them.
To select files outside your defined site, select your local disk from the left pop-up menu in the Files panel and then
select the files.
2Right-click one of the selected files and select Compare Local Files from the context menu.
Note: If you have a one-button mouse, Control-click one of the selected files instead.
The file comparison tool starts and compares the two files.
Compare two remote files
You can compare two files located on your remote server. You must define a Dreamweaver site with remote settings
before you can accomplish this task.
1In the Files panel, display the files on the remote server by selecting Remote View from the right pop-up menu.
2Control-click (Windows) or Command-click (Macintosh) the two files to select them
3Right-click one of the selected files and select Compare Remote Files from the context menu.
Note: If you have a one-button mouse, Control-click one of the selected files instead.
The file comparison tool starts and compares the two files.
Compare a local file to a remote file
You can compare a local file to a file located on your remote server. To do this, you must first define a Dreamweaver
site with remote settings.
In the Files panel, right-click a local file and select Compare With Remote from the context menu.
Note: If you have a one-button mouse, Control-click the local file instead.
The file comparison tool starts and compares the two files.
Compare a remote file to a local file
You can compare a remote file to a local file. You must define a Dreamweaver site with remote settings before
accomplishing this task.
1In the Files panel, display the files on the remote server by selecting Remote View from the right pop-up menu.
2Right-click a file in the panel and select Compare with Local from the context menu.
Note: If you have a one-button mouse, Control-click the file instead.
Compare an open file to a remote file
You can compare a file open in Dreamweaver to its counterpart on the remote server.
In the Document window, select File > Compare with Remote.
The file comparison tool starts and compares the two files.
You can also right-click the document tab along the top of the Document window and select Compare with Remote
from the context menu.
125
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Compare before putting files
If you edit a file locally and then try to upload it to your remote server, Dreamweaver will notify you if the remote
version of the file has changed. You have the option of comparing the two files before you upload the file and overwrite
the remote version.
Before you start, you must install a file comparison tool on your system and specify it in Dreamweaver.
1After editing a file in a Dreamweaver site, put the file (Site > Put) to your remote site.
If the remote version of the file has been modified, youll receive a notification with the option of seeing the
differences.
2To view the differences, click the Compare button.
The file comparison tool starts and compares the two files.
If you haven’t specified a file comparison tool, you are prompted to specify one.
3After you’ve reviewed or merged the changes in the tool, you can proceed with the Put operation or cancel it.
Compare files when synchronizing
You can compare the local versions of your files with the remote versions when you synchronize your site files with
Dreamweaver.
Before you start, you must install a file comparison tool on your system and specify it in Dreamweaver.
1Right-click anywhere in the Files panel and select Synchronize from the context menu.
2Complete the Synchronize Files dialog box and click Preview.
After you click Preview, the selected files and the actions that will be taken during synchronization are listed.
3In the list, select each file you want to compare and click the Compare button (the icon with two small pages).
Note: The file must be text-based, such as HTML or ColdFusion files.
Dreamweaver starts the comparison tool, which compares the local and remote versions of each file you selected.
More Help topics
Synchronizing files
Cloaking files and folders in your Dreamweaver site
About site cloaking
Site cloaking enables you to exclude files and folders from operations such as Get or Put. You can also cloak all files of
a particular type (JPEG, FLV, XML, and so on) from site operations. Dreamweaver remembers your settings for each
site so that you dont have to make selections each time you work on that site.
For example, if you’re working on a large site and you don’t want to upload your multimedia files each day, you can use
site cloaking to cloak your multimedia folder. Dreamweaver will then exclude files in that folder from site operations
you perform.
126
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
You can cloak files and folders on the remote or local site. Cloaking excludes cloaked files and folders from the following
operations:
Performing Put, Get, Check In, and Check Out operations
Generating reports
Finding newer local and newer remote files
Performing sitewide operations, such as checking and changing links
Synchronizing
Working with Asset panel contents
Updating templates and libraries
Note: You can still perform an operation on a specific cloaked folder or file by selecting the item in the Files panel and
performing an operation on it. Performing an operation directly on a file or folder overrides cloaking.
Note: Dreamweaver excludes cloaked templates and library items from Get and Put operations only. Dreamweaver does
not exclude these items from batch operations, because it might cause them to become out of sync with their instances.
Enable and disable site cloaking
Site cloaking enables you to exclude folders, files, and file types in a site from sitewide operations such as Get or Put,
and is enabled by default. You can disable cloaking permanently or just temporarily to perform an operation on all files,
including cloaked files. When you disable site cloaking, all cloaked files are uncloaked. When you enable site cloaking
again, any previously cloaked files become cloaked again.
Note: You can also use the Uncloak All option to uncloak all files, but this does not disable cloaking; also there is no way to
re-cloak all files and folders that were previously cloaked, except to set cloaking again for each folder, file, and file type.
1In the Files panel (Window > Files) select a file or folder.
2Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh), and do one of the following:
Select Cloaking > (deselect to disable).
Select Cloaking > Settings to open the Cloaking category of the Site Setup dialog box. Select or deselect , and
select or deselect Cloak Files Ending With to enable or disable cloaking for specific file types. You can enter or
delete file suffixes in the text box that you want to cloak or uncloak.
Cloak and uncloak site files and folders
You can cloak specific files and folders, but you cannot cloak all files and folders or cloak an entire site. When you cloak
specific files and folders, you can cloak multiple files and folders at the same time.
1In the Files panel (Window > Files), select a site that has site cloaking enabled.
2Select the folder(s) or file(s) you want to cloak or uncloak.
3Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh), then select Cloaking > Cloak or Cloaking > Uncloak from the
context menu.
A red line through the file or folder icon appears or disappears, indicating that the folder is cloaked or uncloaked.
Note: You can still perform an operation on a specific cloaked file or folder by selecting the item in the Files panel and
performing an operation on it. Performing an operation directly on a file or folder overrides cloaking.
127
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Cloak and uncloak specific file types
You can indicate specific file types to cloak, so that Dreamweaver cloaks all files ending with a specified pattern. For
example, you can cloak all files ending with the .txt extension. The file types that you enter do not have to be file
extensions; they can be any pattern at the end of a filename.
Cloak specific file types within a site
1In the Files panel (Window > Files), select a site that has site cloaking enabled.
2Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh), then select Cloaking > Settings.
3Select the Cloak Files Ending With option, enter the file types to cloak in the box, and click OK.
For example, you might enter .jpg to cloak all files with names ending in .jpg in your site.
Separate multiple file types with one space; do not use a comma or semicolon.
In the Files panel, a red line appears through the affected files, indicating that they are cloaked.
Some software creates backup files ending in a particular suffix, such as .bak. You can cloak such files.
Note: You can still perform an operation on a specific cloaked file or folder by selecting the item in the Files panel and
performing an operation on it. Performing an operation directly on a file or folder overrides cloaking.
Uncloak specific file types within a site
1In the Files panel (Window > Files), select a site that has site cloaking enabled.
2Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh), then select Cloaking > Settings.
3In the Advanced Site Definition dialog box, do one of the following:
Deselect the Cloak Files Ending With option to uncloak all the file types listed in the box.
Delete specific file types from the box to uncloak those file types.
4Click OK.
The red lines disappear from the affected files, indicating that they are uncloaked.
Uncloak all files and folders
You can uncloak all files and folders in a site at the same time. This action cannot be undone; there is no way to re-cloak
all items that were previously cloaked. You have to re-cloak items individually.
If you want to temporarily uncloak all folders and files, then re-cloak those items, disable site cloaking.
1In the Files panel (Window > Files), select a site that has site cloaking enabled.
2Select any file or folder in that site.
3Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh), then select Cloaking > Uncloak All.
Note: This step also deselects the Cloak Files Ending With option in the Cloaking category of the Site Definition dialog
box.
The red lines through folder and file icons disappear, indicating that all files and folders in the site are uncloaked.
128
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Storing file information in Design Notes
About Design Notes
Design Notes are notes that you create for a file. Design Notes are associated with the file they describe, but stored in a
separate file. You can see which files have Design Notes attached in the expanded Files panel: A Design Notes icon
appears in the Notes column.
You can use Design Notes to keep track of extra file information associated with your documents, such as image source-
filenames and comments on file status. For example, if you copy a document from one site to another, you can add
Design Notes for that document, with the comment that the original document is in the other site folder.
You can also use Design Notes to keep track of sensitive information that you can’t put inside a document for security
reasons, such as notes on how a particular price or configuration was chosen, or what marketing factors influenced a
design decision.
If you open a file in Adobe® Fireworks® or Flash, and export it to another format, Fireworks and Flash automatically
save the name of the original source file in a Design Notes file. For example, if you open myhouse.png in Fireworks and
export it to myhouse.gif, Fireworks creates a Design Notes file called myhouse.gif.mno. This Design Notes file contains
the name of the original file, as an absolute file: URL. So, the Design Notes for myhouse.gif might contain the following
line:
fw_source="file:///Mydisk/sites/assets/orig/myhouse.png"
A similar Flash Design Note might contain the following line:
fl_source="file:///Mydisk/sites/assets/orig/myhouse.fla"
Note: To share Design Notes, users should define the same site-root path (for example, sites/assets/orig).
When you import the graphic into Dreamweaver, the Design Notes file is automatically copied into your site along with
the graphic. When you select the image in Dreamweaver and choose to edit it using Fireworks, Fireworks opens the
original file for editing.
Enable and disable Design Notes for a site
Design Notes are notes associated with a file, but stored in a separate file. Use Design Notes to keep track of extra file
information associated with your documents, such as image source-filenames and comments on file status.
You enable and disable Design Notes for a site in the Design Notes category of the Site Definition dialog box. When you
enable Design Notes, you can also choose to share them with others, if you want.
1Select Site > Manage Sites.
2In the Manage Sites dialog box, select a site, then click Edit.
3In the Site Setup dialog box, expand Advanced Settings and select the Design Notes category.
4Select Maintain Design Notes to enable Design Notes (deselect to disable them).
5If you want to delete all local Design Notes files for your site, click Clean Up, and then click Yes. (If you want to delete
remote Design Notes files, you’ll need to delete them manually).
Note: The Clean Up Design Notes command only deletes MNO (Design Notes) files. It does not delete the _notes folder
or the dwsync.xml file inside the _notes folder. Dreamweaver uses the dwsync.xml file to maintain information about
site synchronization.
129
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
6Select Enable Upload Design Notes For Sharing to upload Design Notes associated with your site with the rest of
your documents and click OK.
If you select this option, you can share Design Notes with the rest of your team. When you put or get a file,
Dreamweaver automatically puts or gets the associated Design Notes file.
If you do not select this option, Dreamweaver maintains Design Notes locally but does not upload them with
your files. If you work alone on your site, deselecting this option improves performance. Design Notes will not
be transferred to the remote site when you check in or put your files and you can still add and modify the Design
Notes for your site locally.
Associate Design Notes with files
You can create a Design Notes file for each document or template in your site. You can also create Design Notes for
applets, ActiveX controls, images, Flash content, Shockwave objects, and image fields in your documents.
Note: If you add Design Notes to a template file, documents you create with the template do not inherit the Design Notes.
1Do one of the following:
Open the file in the Document window and select File > Design Notes.
In the Files panel, right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the file, and select Design Notes.
Note: If the file resides in a remote site, you must first check out or get the file, and then select it in the local folder.
2In the Basic Info tab, select a status for the document from the Status menu.
3Click the date icon (above the Notes box) to insert the current local date in your notes.
4Type comments in the Notes box.
5Select Show When File Is Opened to make the Design Notes file appear every time the file is opened.
6In the All Info tab, click the Plus (+) button to add a new key-value pair; select a pair and click the Minus (–) button
to remove it.
For example, you might name a key Author (in the Name box) and define the value as Heidi (in the Value box).
7Click OK to save the notes.
Dreamweaver saves your notes to a folder called _notes, in the same location as the current file. The filename is the
document’s filename, plus the extension .mno. For example, if the filename is index.html, the associated Design
Notes file is named index.html.mno.
Work with Design Notes
After you associate a Design Note with a file, you can open the Design Note, change its status, or delete it.
Open Design Notes associated with a file
Do one of the following to open the Design Notes:
Open the file in the Document window, then select File > Design Notes.
In the Files panel, right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the file, then select Design Notes.
In the Notes column of the Files panel, double-click the yellow Design Notes icon.
130
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: To show the yellow Design Notes icons, select Site > Manage Sites > [your site name] > Edit > Advanced Settings
> File View Columns. Select Notes in the list panel and choose the Show option. When you click the Expand button on
the Files toolbar to show both the local and remote site, you have a Notes column in your local site that shows a yellow
note icon for any file with a Design Note.
Assign a custom Design Notes status
1Open Design Notes for a file or object (see the previous procedure).
2Click the All Info tab.
3Click the Plus (+) button.
4In the Name field, enter the word status.
5In the Value field, enter the status.
If a status value already existed, it’s replaced with the new one.
6Click the Basic Info tab and note that the new status value appears in the Status pop-up menu.
Note: You can have only one custom value in the status menu at a time. If you follow this procedure again, Dreamweaver
replaces the status value you entered the first time with the new status value you enter.
Delete unassociated Design Notes from your site
1Select Site > Manage Sites.
2Select the site and click Edit.
3In the Site Definition dialog box, select Design Notes from the category list on the left.
4Click the Clean Up button.
Dreamweaver prompts you to verify that it should delete any Design Notes that are no longer associated with a file
in your site.
If you use Dreamweaver to delete a file that has an associated Design Notes file, Dreamweaver deletes the Design
Notes file too; so usually orphan Design Notes files occur only if you delete or rename a file outside of Dreamweaver.
Note: If you deselect the Maintain Design Notes option before you click Clean Up, Dreamweaver deletes all Design Notes
files for your site.
More Help topics
Start an external editor for media files
Getting and putting files to and from your server
Check files into and out of a remote folder
Testing your Dreamweaver site
131
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Site testing guidelines
Before uploading your site to a server and declaring it ready for viewing, its a good idea to test it locally. (In fact, its a
good idea to test and troubleshoot your site frequently throughout its constructionyou can catch problems early and
avoid repeating them.)
You should make sure that your pages look and work as expected in the browsers youre targeting, that there are no
broken links, and that the pages don’t take too long to download. You can also test and troubleshoot your entire site by
running a site report.
The following guidelines will help you create a good experience for visitors to your site:
Make sure your pages function in the browsers youre targeting.
Your pages should be legible and functional in browsers that do not support styles, layers, plug-ins, or JavaScript. For
pages that fail badly in older browsers, consider using the Check Browser behavior to automatically redirect visitors to
another page.
Preview your pages in different browsers and platforms.
This gives you an opportunity to see differences in layout, color, font sizes, and default browser window size that cannot
be predicted in a target browser check.
Check your site for broken links and fix them.
Other sites undergo redesign and reorganization too, and the page youre linking to may have been moved or deleted.
You can run a link check report to test your links.
Monitor the file size of your pages and the time they take to download.
Keep in mind that if a page consists of one large table, in some browsers, visitors will see nothing until the entire table
finishes loading. Consider breaking up large tables; if this is not possible, consider putting a small amount of content—
such as a welcome message or an advertising banner—outside the table at the top of the page so users can view this
material while the table downloads.
Run a few site reports to test and troubleshoot the entire site.
You can check your entire site for problems, such as untitled documents, empty tags, and redundant nested tags.
Validate your code to locate tag or syntax errors.
Update and maintain the site after its published.
Publishing your site—that is, making it live—can be accomplished in several ways and is an ongoing process. An
important part of the process is defining and implementing a version-control system, either with the tools
Dreamweaver includes or through an external version-control application.
Use the discussion forums.
The Dreamweaver discussion forums can be found on the Adobe website at
www.adobe.com/go/dreamweaver_newsgroup.
The forums are a great resource for getting information on different browsers, platforms, and so on. You can also
discuss technical issues and share helpful hints with other Dreamweaver users.
For a tutorial on troubleshooting publishing problems, see www.adobe.com/go/vid0164.
132
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Use reports to test your site
You can run site reports on workflow or HTML attributes. You can also use the Reports command to check links in
your site.
Workflow reports can improve collaboration among members of a web team. You can run workflow reports that display
who has checked out a file, which files have Design Notes associated with them, and which files have been modified
recently. You can further refine Design Note reports by specifying name/value parameters.
Note: You must have a remote site connection defined to run the workflow reports.
HTML reports enable you to compile and generate reports for several HTML attributes. You can check combinable
nested font tags, missing Alt text, redundant nested tags, removable empty tags, and untitled documents.
After you run a report, you can save it as an XML file, then import it into a template instance or a database or
spreadsheet and print it, or display it on a website.
Note: You can also add different report types to Dreamweaver through the Adobe Dreamweaver Exchange website.
Run reports to test a site
1Select Site > Reports.
2Select what to report on from the Report On pop-up menu and set any of the report types to run (workflow or
HTML).
You cannot run a Selected Files In Site report unless you have already selected files in the Files panel.
3If you selected a workflow report, click Report Settings. Otherwise, skip this step.
Note: If you selected more than one workflow report, you need to click the Report Settings button for each report. Select
a report, click Report Settings, and enter settings; then, repeat the process for any other workflow reports.
Checked Out By Creates a report listing all documents checked out by a specific team member. Enter the name of a
team member, and then click OK to return to the Reports dialog box.
Design Notes Creates a report listing all Design Notes for selected documents or for the site. Enter one or more
name and value pairs, then select comparison values from the corresponding pop-up menus. Click OK to return to
the Reports dialog box.
Recently Modified Creates a report listing files that have changed during a specified time frame. Enter date ranges
and location for the files you want to view.
4If you selected an HTML report, select from the following reports:
Combinable Nested Font Tags Creates a report that lists all nested font tags that can be combined to clean up the
code.
For example, <font color="#FF0000"><font size="4">STOP!</font></font> is reported.
Missing Alt Text Creates a report listing all the img tags that don’t have alternate text.
Alternate text appears in place of images for text-only browsers or for browsers that have been set to download
images manually. Screen readers read alternate text, and some browsers display alternate text when the user mouses
over the image.
Redundant Nested Tags Creates a report detailing nested tags that should be cleaned up.
For example, <i> The rain <i> in</i> Spain stays mainly in the plain</i> is reported.
Removable Empty Tags Creates a report detailing all empty tags that can be removed to clean up the HTML code.
For example, you may have deleted an item or image in Code view, but left behind the tags that applied to that item.
133
File management
Last updated 6/3/2015
Untitled Documents Creates a report listing all the untitled documents found within the selected parameters.
Dreamweaver reports all documents with default titles, multiple title tags, or missing title tags.
5Click Run to create the report.
Depending on the type of report you run, you might be prompted to save your file, define your site, or select a folder
(if you havent already done so).
A list of results appears in the Site Reports panel (in the Results panel group).
Use and save a report
1Run a report (see the previous procedure).
2In the Site Reports panel, do any of the following to view the report:
Click the column heading you want to sort results by.
You can sort by filename, line number, or description. You can also run several different reports and keep the
different reports open.
Select any line in the report, then click the More Info button on the left side of the Site Reports panel for a
description of the problem.
Double-click any line in the report to view the corresponding code in the Document window.
Note: If you are in Design view, Dreamweaver changes the display to split view to show the reported problem in code.
3Click Save Report to save the report.
When you save a report, you can import it into an existing template file. You can then import the file into a database
or spreadsheet and print it, or use the file to display the report on a website.
After running HTML reports, use the Clean Up HTML command to correct any HTML errors the reports listed.
More Help topics
Fix broken links
Test links in Dreamweaver
Apply the Check Browser behavior
Validate XML documents
Check for browser compatibility
Troubleshoot publishing problems tutorial
Reports in Dreamweaver
Test links in Dreamweaver
Add and manage extensions in Dreamweaver
134
Last updated 6/3/2015
Chapter 5: Layout and design
Using visual aids for layout
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Set rulers
Rulers help you measure, organize, and plan your layout. They can appear on the left and top borders of the page,
marked in pixels, inches, or centimeters.
To toggle rulers on and off, select View > Rulers > Show.
To change the origin, drag the ruler-origin icon (at the upper-left corner of the Design view of the Document
window) anywhere on the page.
To reset the origin to its default position, select View > Rulers > Reset Origin.
To change the unit of measure, select View > Rulers, and then select Pixels, Inches, or Centimeters.
Set layout guides
Guides are lines that you drag onto the document from the rulers. They help you place and align objects more precisely.
You can also use guides to measure the size of page elements, or emulate the folds (visible areas) of web browsers.
To help you align elements, you can snap elements to guides, and snap guides to elements. (Elements must be absolutely
positioned in order for the snap feature to work.) You can also lock guides to prevent them from being accidentally
moved by another user.
Create a horizontal or vertical guide
1Drag from the corresponding ruler.
2Position the guide in the Document window and release the mouse button (reposition the guide by dragging it
again).
Note: By default, guides are recorded as absolute pixel measurements from the top or left side of the document, and are
shown relative to the origin of the ruler. To record the guide as a percentage, press the Shift key while you create or move
the guide.
Show or hide guides
Select View > Guides > Show Guides.
Snap elements to guides
To snap elements to guides, select View > Guides > Snap to Guides.
To snap guides to elements, select View > Guides > Guides Snap to Elements.
135
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: When you resize elements, such as absolutely-positioned elements (AP elements), tables, and images, the resized
elements snap to guides.
Lock or unlock all guides
Select View > Guides > Lock Guides.
View and move a guide to a specific position
1Hold the mouse pointer over the guide to view its position.
2Double-click the guide.
3Enter the new position in the Move Guide dialog box and click OK.
View the distance between guides
Press Control (Windows) or Command (Macintosh) and hold the mouse pointer anywhere between the two guides.
Note: The unit of measure is the same as the unit of measure used for the rulers.
Emulate the fold (visible area) of a web browser
Select View > Guides, and then select a preset browser size from the menu.
Remove a guide
Drag the guide off the document.
Change guide settings
Select View > Guides > Edit Guides, set the following options, and click OK.
Guide color Specifies the color of the guide lines. Click the color swatch and select a color from the color picker, or
type a hexadecimal number in the text box.
Distance Color Specifies the color of the lines that appear as distance indicators when you hold the mouse pointer
between guides. Click the color swatch and select a color from the color picker, or type a hexadecimal number in
the text box.
Show Guides Makes guides visible in Design view.
Snap to Guides Makes page elements snap to guides as you move elements around the page.
Lock Guides Locks guides in place.
Guides Snap to Elements Snaps guides to elements on the page as you drag guides.
Clear All Clears all guides from the page.
Using guides with templates
When guides are added to a Dreamweaver template, all instances of the template inherit the guides. Guides in template
instances, however, are treated as editable regions, so users can modify them. Modified guides in template instances are
restored to their original location whenever the instance is updated with the master template.
You can also add your own guides to instances of a template. Guides added in this manner are not overwritten when
the template instance is updated with the master template.
136
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
Use the layout grid
The grid displays a system of horizontal and vertical lines in the Document window. It is useful for placing objects
precisely. You can make absolutely-positioned page elements automatically snap to the grid as you move them, and
change the grid or control the snapping behavior by specifying grid settings. Snapping works whether or not the grid
is visible.
Show or hide the grid
Select View > Grid > Show Grid.
Enable or disable snapping
Select View > Grid > Snap to Grid.
Change grid settings
1Select View > Grid > Grid Settings.
2Set the options and click OK to apply the changes.
Color Specifies the color of the grid lines. Click the color swatch and select a color from the color picker, or type a
hexadecimal number in the text box.
Show Grid Makes the grid visible in Design view.
Snap to Grid Makes page elements snap to the lines of the grid.
Spacing Controls how far apart the grid lines are. Enter a number and select Pixels, Inches, or Centimeters from the
menu.
Display Specifies whether the grid lines appear as lines or dots.
Note: If Show Grid is not selected, the grid does not appear in the document and no changes are visible.
Use a tracing image
You can use a tracing image as a guide to re-create a page design that was created in a graphics application such as
Adobe Freehand or Fireworks.
A tracing image is a JPEG, GIF, or PNG image that is placed in the background of the Document window. You can hide
the image, set its opacity, and change its position.
The tracing image is visible only in Dreamweaver; it is not visible when you view the page in a browser. When the
tracing image is visible, the pages real background image and color are not visible in the Document window; however,
the background image and color will be visible when the page is viewed in a browser.
Place a tracing image in the Document window
1Do one of the following:
Select View > Tracing Image > Load.
Select Modify > Page Properties, then click Browse (next to the Tracing Image text box).
2In the Select Image Source dialog box, select an image file and click OK.
3In the Page Properties dialog box, specify the transparency for the image by dragging the Image Transparency slider,
then click OK.
137
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
To switch to another tracing image or change the transparency of the current tracing image at any time, select
Modify > Page Properties.
Show or hide the tracing image
Select View > Tracing Image > Show.
Change the position of a tracing image
Select View > Tracing Image > Adjust Position.
To precisely specify the position of the tracing image, enter coordinate values in the X and Y text boxes.
To move the image 1 pixel at a time, use the arrow keys.
To move the image 5 pixels at a time, press Shift and an arrow key.
Reset the position of the tracing image
Select View > Tracing Image > Reset Position.
The tracing image returns to the upper-left corner of the Document window (0,0).
Align the tracing image to a selected element
1Select an element in the Document window.
2Select View > Tracing Image > Align with Selection.
The upper-left corner of the tracing image is aligned with the upper-left corner of the selected element.
More Help topics
Align AP elements
Move AP elements
Align AP elements
Move AP elements
Using Frames
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
How frames and framesets work
A frame is a region in a browser window that can display an HTML document independent of whats being displayed
in the rest of the browser window. Frames provide a way to divide a browser window into multiple regions, each of
which can display a different HTML document. In the most common use of frames, one frame displays a document
containing navigation controls, while another frame displays a document with content
A frameset is an HTML file that defines the layout and properties of a set of frames, including the number of frames,
the size and placement of the frames, and the URL of the page that initially appears in each frame. The frameset file
itself doesn’t contain HTML content that displays in a browser, except in the noframes section; the frameset file simply
provides information to the browser about how a set of frames should look and what documents should appear in them.
138
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
To view a set of frames in a browser, enter the URL of the frameset file; the browser then opens the relevant documents
to display in the frames. The frameset file for a site is often named index.html, so that it displays by default if a visitor
doesn’t specify a filename.
The following example shows a frame layout consisting of three frames: one narrow frame on the side that contains a
navigation bar, one frame that runs along the top, containing the logo and title of the website, and one large frame that
takes up the rest of the page and contains the main content. Each of these frames displays a separate HTML document.
In this example, the document displayed in the top frame never changes as the visitor navigates the site. The side frame
navigation bar contains links; clicking one of these links changes the content of the main content frame, but the contents
of the side frame itself remain static. The main content frame on the right displays the appropriate document for the
link the visitor clicks on the left.
A frame is not a file; its easy to think of the document that currently appears in a frame as an integral part of the frame,
but the document isn’t actually part of the frame. The frame is a container that holds the document.
Note: A “page” refers either to a single HTML document or to the entire contents of a browser window at a given moment,
even if several HTML documents appear at once. The phrasea page that uses frames,” for example, usually refers to a set
of frames and the documents that initially appear in those frames.
A site that appears in a browser as a single page comprising three frames actually consists of at least four HTML
documents: the frameset file, plus the three documents containing the content that initially appears in the frames.
When you design a page using framesets in Dreamweaver, you must save each of these four files in order for the page
to work properly in the browser.
Deciding whether to use frames
Adobe discourages the use of frames for web page layout. Some of the disadvantages of using frames include:
Precise graphical alignment of elements in different frames can be difficult.
Testing the navigation can be time-consuming.
The URLs of the individual framed pages don’t appear in browsers, so it can be difficult for a visitor to bookmark a
specific page (unless you provide server code that enables them to load a framed version of a particular page).
139
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
For a full treatment of why you should not use frames, see Gary Whites explanation at
http://apptools.com/rants/framesevil.php.
The most common use of frames, if you do decide to use them, is for navigation. A set of frames often includes one
frame containing a navigation bar and another frame to display the main content pages. Using frames in this way has
a couple of advantages:
A visitors browser doesn’t need to reload the navigation-related graphics for every page.
Each frame has its own scroll bar (if the content is too large to fit in a window), so a visitor can scroll the frames
independently. For example, a visitor who scrolls to the bottom of a long page of content in a frame doesnt need to
scroll back up to the top to use the navigation bar if the navigation bar is in a different frame.
In many cases, you can create a web page without frames that accomplishes the same goals as a set of frames. For
example, if you want a navigation bar to appear on the left side of your page, you can either replace your page with a set
of frames, or just include the navigation bar on every page in your site. (Dreamweaver helps you create multiple pages
that use the same layout.) The following example shows a page design with a framelike layout that doesn’t use frames.
Poorly designed sites use frames unnecessarily, such as a frameset that reloads the contents of the navigation frames
every time the visitor clicks a navigation button. When frames are used well (for example, to keep navigation controls
static in one frame while allowing the contents of another frame to change), they can be very useful for a site.
Not all browsers provide good frame support, and frames may be difficult for visitors with disabilities to navigate, so if
you do use frames, always provide a noframes section in your frameset, for visitors who can’t view them. You might also
provide an explicit link to a frameless version of the site.
Nested framesets
A frameset inside another frameset is called a nested frameset. A single frameset file can contain multiple nested
framesets. Most web pages that use frames are actually using nested frames, and most of the predefined framesets in
Dreamweaver also use nesting. Any set of frames in which there are different numbers of frames in different rows or
columns requires a nested frameset.
140
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
For example, the most common frame layout has one frame in the top row (where the company’s logo appears) and two
frames in the bottom row (a navigation frame and a content frame). This layout requires a nested frameset: a two-row
frameset, with a two-column frameset nested in the second row.
A Main frameset B Menu frame and content frame are nested within the main frameset.
Dreamweaver takes care of nesting framesets as needed; if you use the frame-splitting tools in Dreamweaver, you dont
need to worry about the details of which frames are nested and which are not.
There are two ways to nest framesets in HTML: the inner frameset can be defined either in the same file as the outer
frameset, or in a separate file of its own. Each predefined frameset in Dreamweaver defines all of its framesets in the
same file.
Both kinds of nesting produce the same visual results; it’s not easy to tell, without looking at the code, which kind of
nesting is being used. The most likely situation in which an external frameset file would be used in Dreamweaver is
when you use the Open in Frame command to open a frameset file inside a frame; doing this may result in problems
with setting targets for links. Its generally simplest to keep all framesets defined in a single file.
Work with framesets in the Document window
Dreamweaver enables you to view and edit all of the documents associated with a set of frames in one Document
window. This approach enables you to see approximately how the framed pages will appear in a browser as you edit
them. However, some aspects of this approach can be confusing until you get used to them. In particular, each frame
displays a separate HTML document. Even if the documents are empty, you must save them all before you can preview
them (because the frameset can be accurately previewed only if it contains the URL of a document to display in each
frame).
To ensure that your frameset appears correctly in browsers, follow these general steps:
1Create your frameset and specify a document to appear in each frame.
2Save every file thats going to appear in a frame. Remember that each frame displays a separate HTML document,
and you must save each document, along with the frameset file.
3Set the properties for each frame and for the frameset (including naming each frame, setting scrolling and non-
scrolling options).
4Set the Target property in the Property inspector for all your links so that the linked content appears in the correct
area.
141
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
Create frames and framesets
There are two ways to create a frameset in Dreamweaver: You can select from several predefined framesets or you can
design it yourself.
Choosing a predefined frameset sets up all the framesets and frames needed to create the layout and is the easiest way
to create a frames-based layout quickly. You can insert a predefined frameset only in the Document window’s Design
view.
You can also design your own frameset in Dreamweaver by adding “splitters” to the Document window.
Before creating a frameset or working with frames, make the frame borders visible in the Document windows Design
view by selecting View >Visual Aids > Frame Borders.
Create a predefined frameset and display an existing document in a frame
1Place the insertion point in a document and do one of the following:
Choose Insert > HTML > Frames and select a predefined frameset.
In the Layout category of the Insert panel, click the drop-down arrow on the Frames button and select a
predefined frameset.
The frameset icons provide a visual representation of each frameset as applied to the current document. The blue
area of a frameset icon represents the current document, and the white areas represent frames that will display
other documents.
2If you have set up Dreamweaver to prompt you for frame accessibility attributes, select a frame from the pop-up
menu, enter a name for the frame, and click OK. (For visitors who use screen readers, the screen reader will read
this name when it encounters the frame in a page.)
Note: If you click OK without entering a new name, Dreamweaver gives the frame a name that corresponds to its
position (left frame, right frame, and so on) in the frameset.
Note: If you press Cancel, the frameset appears in the document, but Dreamweaver does not associate accessibility tags
or attributes with it.
Select Window > Frames to view a diagram of the frames you are naming.
Create an empty predefined frameset
1Select File > New.
2In the New Document dialog box, select the Page from Sample category.
3Select the Frameset folder in the Sample Folder column.
4Select a frameset from the Sample Page column and click Create.
5If you have activated the frame accessibility attributes in Preferences, the Frame Tag Accessibility Attributes dialog
box appears; complete the dialog box for each frame and click OK.
Note: If you press Cancel, the frameset appears in the document, but Dreamweaver does not associate accessibility tags
or attributes with it.
Create a frameset
Select Modify > Frameset, then select a splitting item (such as Split Frame Left or Split Frame Right) from the
submenu.
Dreamweaver splits the window into frames. If you had an existing document open, it appears in one of the frames.
142
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
Split a frame into smaller frames
To split the frame where the insertion point is, select a splitting item from the Modify > Frameset submenu.
To split a frame or set of frames vertically or horizontally, drag a frame border from the edge into the middle of
the Design view.
To split a frame using a frame border that isnt at the edge of the Design view, Alt-drag (Windows) or Option-
drag (Macintosh) a frame border.
To divide a frame into four frames, drag a frame border from one of the corners of the Design view into the
middle of a frame.
To create three frames, start with two frames, then split one of them. It’s not easy to merge two adjacent frames without
editing the frameset code, so changing four frames into three frames is harder than changing two frames into three
frames.
Delete a frame
Drag a frame border off the page or to a border of the parent frame.
If theres unsaved content in a document in a frame thats being removed, Dreamweaver prompts you to save the
document.
Note: You can’t remove a frameset entirely by dragging borders. To remove a frameset, close the Document window that
displays it. If the frameset file has been saved, delete the file.
Resize a frame
To set approximate sizes for frames, drag frame borders in the Document window’s Design view.
To specify exact sizes, and to specify how much space the browser allocates to a row or column of frames when the
browser window size doesn’t allow the frames to display at full size, use the Property inspector.
Select frames and framesets
To make changes to the properties of a frame or frameset, begin by selecting the frame or frameset you want to change.
You can select a frame or frameset either in the Document window or by using the Frames panel.
The Frames panel provides a visual representation of the frames within a frameset. It shows the hierarchy of the
frameset structure in a way that may not be apparent in the Document window. In the Frames panel, a very thick border
surrounds each frameset; each frame is surrounded by a thin gray line and is identified by a frame name.
143
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
In the Document window’s Design view, when a frame is selected, its borders are outlined with a dotted line; when a
frameset is selected, all the borders of the frames within the frameset are outlined with a light dotted line.
Note: Placing the insertion point in a document thats displayed in a frame is not the same as selecting a frame. There are
various operations (such as setting frame properties) for which you must select a frame.
Select a frame or frameset in the Frames panel
1Select Window > Frames.
2In the Frames panel:
To select a frame, click the frame. (A selection outline appears around the frame in both the Frames panel and
the Document window’s Design view.)
To select a frameset, click the border that surrounds the frameset.
Select a frame or frameset in the Document window
To select a frame, Shift-Alt-click (Windows) or Shift-Option-click (Macintosh) inside a frame in Design view.
To select a frameset, click one of the framesets internal frame borders in Design view. (Frame borders must be visible
to do this; select View >Visual Aids > Frame Borders to make frame borders visible if they arent.)
Note: It’s generally easier to select framesets in the Frames panel than in the Document window. For more information, see
the above topics.
Select a different frame or frameset
To select the next or previous frame or frameset at the same hierarchical level as the current selection, press Alt+Left
Arrow or Alt+Right Arrow (Windows), or Command+Left Arrow or Command+Right Arrow (Macintosh). Using
these keys, you can cycle through frames and framesets in the order in which they’re defined in the frameset file.
To select the parent frameset (the frameset that contains the current selection), press Alt+Up Arrow (Windows) or
Command+Up Arrow (Macintosh).
144
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
To select the first child frame or frameset of the currently selected frameset (that is, first in the order in which they’re
defined in the frameset file), press Alt+Down Arrow (Windows) or Command+Down Arrow (Macintosh).
Open a document in a frame
You can specify the initial content of a frame by either inserting new content into an empty document in a frame, or
opening an existing document in a frame.
1Place the insertion point in a frame.
2Select File > Open in Frame.
3Select a document to open in the frame, and click OK (Windows) or Choose (Macintosh).
4(Optional) To make this document the default document to display in the frame when the frameset is opened in a
browser, save the frameset.
Save frame and frameset files
Before you can preview a frameset in a browser, you must save the frameset file and all of the documents that will
display in the frames. You can save each frameset file and framed document individually, or you can save the frameset
file and all documents appearing in frames at once.
Note: When you use visual tools in Dreamweaver to create a set of frames, each new document that appears in a frame is
given a default filename. For example, the first frameset file is named UntitledFrameset-1, while the first document in a
frame is named UntitledFrame-1.
Save a frameset file
Select the frameset in the Frames panel or the Document window.
To save the frameset file, select File > Save Frameset.
To save the frameset file as a new file, select File > Save Frameset As.
Note: If the frameset file has not previously been saved, these two commands are equivalent.
Save a document that appears in a frame
Click in the frame, then select File > Save Frame or File > Save Frame As.
Save all files associated with a set of frames
Select File > Save All Frames.
This saves all open documents in the frameset, including the frameset file and all framed documents. If the frameset
file has not yet been saved, a heavy border appears around the frameset (or the unsaved frame) in the Design view,
and you can select a filename.
Note: If you used File > Open in Frame to open a document in a frame, then when you save the frameset, the document
you opened in the frame becomes the default document to be displayed in that frame. If you don’t want that document
to be the default, don’t save the frameset file.
View and set frame properties and attributes
Use the Property inspector to view and set most frame properties, including borders, margins, and whether scroll bars
appear in frames. Setting a frame property overrides the setting for that property in a frameset.
145
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
You may also want to set some frame attributes, such as the title attribute (which is not the same as the name attribute),
to improve accessibility. You can enable the accessibility authoring option for frames to set attributes when you create
frames, or you can set attributes after inserting a frame. To edit accessibility attributes for a frame, use the Tag inspector
to edit the HTML code directly.
View or set frame properties
1Select a frame by doing one of the following:
Alt-click (Windows) or Shift-Option-click (Macintosh) a frame in the Document window’s Design view.
Click a frame in the Frames panel (Window > Frames).
2In the Property inspector (Window > Properties), click the expander arrow in the lower-right corner to see all of the
frame properties.
3Set the frame Property inspector options.
Frame Name The name used by a links target attribute or by a script to refer to the frame. A frame name must be a
single word; underscores (_) are allowed, but hyphens (-), periods (.), and spaces are not. A frame name must start
with a letter (as opposed to a numeral). Frame names are case-sensitive. Don’t use terms that are reserved words in
JavaScript (such as top or navigator) as frame names.
To make a link change the contents of another frame, you must name the target frame. To make it easier to create
cross-frame links later, name each of your frames when you create it.
Src Specifies the source document to display in the frame. Click the folder icon to browse to and select a file.
Scroll Specifies whether scroll bars appear in the frame. Setting this option to Default doesn’t set a value for the
corresponding attribute, allowing each browser to use its default value. Most browsers default to Auto, meaning that
scroll bars appear only when there is not enough room in a browser window to display the full contents of the
current frame.
No Resize Prevents visitors from dragging the frame borders to resize the frame in a browser.
Note: You can always resize frames in Dreamweaver; this option applies only to visitors viewing the frames in a browser.
Borders Shows or hides the borders of the current frame when its viewed in a browser. Selecting a Borders option
for a frame overrides the frameset’s border settings.
Border options are Yes (show borders), No (hide borders), and Default; most browsers default to showing borders,
unless the parent frameset has Borders set to No. A border is hidden only when all frames that share the border have
Borders set to No, or when the parent frameset’s Borders property is set to No and the frames sharing the border
have Borders set to Default.
Border Color Sets a border color for all of the frames borders. This color applies to all borders that touch the frame,
and overrides the specified border color of the frameset.
Margin Width Sets the width in pixels of the left and right margins (the space between the frame borders and the
content).
Margin Height Sets the height in pixels of the top and bottom margins (the space between the frame borders and
the content).
Note: Setting the margin width and height for a frame is not the same as setting margins in the Modify > Page Properties
dialog box.
To change the background color of a frame, set the background color of the document in the frame in page
properties.
146
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
Set accessibility values for a frame
1In the Frames panel (Window > Frames), select a frame by placing the insertion point in one of the frames.
2Select Modify > Edit Tag <frameset>.
3Select Style Sheet/Accessibility from the category list on the left, enter values, and click OK.
Edit accessibility values for a frame
1Display Code view or Code and Design views for your document, if youre currently in Design view.
2In the Frames panel (Window > Frames), select a frame by placing the insertion point in one of the frames.
Dreamweaver highlights the frame tag in the code.
3Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) in the code, and then select Edit Tag.
4In the tag editor, make your changes and click OK.
Change the background color of a document in a frame
1Place the insertion point in the frame.
2Select Modify > Page Properties.
3In the Page Properties dialog box, click the Background color menu, and select a color.
View and set frameset properties
Use the Property inspector to view and set most frameset properties, including the frameset title, borders, and frame
sizes.
Set a title for a frameset document
1Select a frameset by doing one of the following:
Click a border between two frames in the frameset in the Document window’s Design view.
Click the border that surrounds a frameset in the Frames panel (Window > Frames).
2In the Title box of the Document toolbar, type a name for the frameset document.
When a visitor views the frameset in a browser, the title appears in the browser’s title bar.
View or set frameset properties
1Select a frameset by doing one of the following:
Click a border between two frames in the frameset in the Document window’s Design view.
Click the border that surrounds a frameset in the Frames panel (Window > Frames).
2In the Property inspector (Window > Properties), click the expander arrow in the lower-right corner and set the
frameset options.
Borders Determines whether borders should appear around frames when the document is viewed in a browser. To
display borders, select Yes; to prevent the browser from displaying borders, select No. To allow the browser to
determine how borders are displayed, select Default.
Border Width Specifies a width for all the borders in the frameset.
Border Color Sets a color for the borders. Use the color picker to select a color, or type the hexadecimal value for a
color.
147
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
RowCol Selection Sets frame sizes for rows and columns of the selected frameset, click a tab on the left side or top
of the RowCol Selection area; then enter a height or width in the Value text box.
3To specify how much space the browser allocates to each frame, select from the following choices in the Units menu:
Pixels Sets the size of the selected column or row to an absolute value. Choose this option for a frame that should
always be the same size, such as a navigation bar. Frames with sizes specified in pixels are allocated space before
frames with sizes specified as percent or relative. The most common approach to frame sizes is to set a left-side
frame to a fixed pixel width and to set a right-size frame to relative, which enables the right frame to stretch to take
up all the remaining space after the pixel width is allocated.
Note: If all of your widths are specified in pixels, and a visitor views the frameset in a browser that’s too wide or too
narrow for the width you specified, then the frames stretch or shrink proportionately to fill the available space. The same
applies to heights specified in pixels. Thus, it’s generally a good idea to specify at least one width and height as relative.
Percent Specifies that the selected column or row should be a percentage of the total width or height of its frameset.
Frames with units set to Percent are allocated space after frames with units set to Pixels, but before frames with units
set to Relative.
Relative Specifies that the selected column or row be allocated the rest of the available space after Pixels and Percent
frames have had space allocated; that remaining space is divided proportionally among the frames with sizes set to
Relative.
Note: When you select Relative from the Units menu, any number you’ve entered in the Value field disappears; if you
want to specify a number, you must re-enter it. If theres only one row or column set to Relative, though, theres no need
to enter a number, since that row or column receives all the remaining space after the other rows and columns have space
allocated. To be certain of full cross-browser compatibility, you can enter 1 in the Value field; thats equivalent to entering
no value.
Control frame content with links
To use a link in one frame to open a document in another frame, you must set a target for the link. The target attribute
of a link specifies the frame or window in which the linked content opens.
For example, if your navigation bar is in the left frame, and you want the linked material to appear in the main content
frame on the right, you must specify the name of the main content frame as the target for each of the navigation bar
links. When a visitor clicks a navigation link, the specified content opens in the main frame.
1In Design view, select text or an object.
2In the Link box in the Property inspector (Window > Properties), do one of the following:
Click the folder icon and select the file to link to.
Drag the Point to File icon to the Files panel and select the file to link to.
3In the Target menu in the Property inspector, select the frame or window in which the linked document should
appear:
_blank opens the linked document in a new browser window, leaving the current window untouched.
_parent opens the linked document in the parent frameset of the frame the link appears in, replacing the entire
frameset.
148
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
_self opens the link in the current frame, replacing the content in that frame.
_top opens the linked document in the current browser window, replacing all frames.
Frame names also appear in this menu. Select a named frame to open the linked document in that frame.
Note: Frame names appear only when you’re editing a document within a frameset. When you edit a document in its
own Document window, frame names do not appear in the Target pop-up menu. If you’re editing a document outside
of the frameset, you can type the target frames name in the Target text box.
If you’re linking to a page outside of your site, always use target="_top" or target="_blank" to ensure that the page
doesn’t appear to be part of your site.
Provide content for browsers without frame support
Dreamweaver lets you specify content to display in text-based browsers and in older graphical browsers that do not
support frames. This content is stored in the frameset file, wrapped in a noframes tag. When a browser that doesn’t
support frames loads the frameset file, the browser displays only the content enclosed by the noframes tag.
Note: Content in the noframes area should be more than just a note saying “You should upgrade to a browser that can
handle frames.” Some site visitors use systems that don’t allow them to view frames.
1Select Modify > Frameset > Edit NoFrames Content.
Dreamweaver clears the Design view, and the words “NoFrames Content” appear at the top of the Design view.
2Do one of the following:
In the Document window, type or insert the content just as you would for an ordinary document.
Select Window > Code Inspector, place the insertion point between the body tags that appear inside the noframes
tags, then type the HTML code for the content.
3Select Modify > Frameset > Edit NoFrames Content again to return to the normal view of the frameset document.
Using JavaScript behaviors with frames
There are several JavaScript behaviors and navigation-related commands that are particularly appropriate for use with
frames:
Set Text Of Frame Replaces the content and formatting of a given frame with the content you specify. The content can
include any valid HTML. Use this action to dynamically display information in a frame.
Go To URL Opens a new page in the current window or in the specified frame. This action is particularly useful for
changing the contents of two or more frames with one click.
Insert Jump Menu Sets up a menu list of links that open files in a browser window when clicked. You can also target a
particular window or frame in which the document opens.
For more information, see Adding JavaScript behaviors .
More Help topics
Dreamweaver and accessibility
Apply the Set Text Of Frame behavior
Apply the Go To URL behavior
149
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
Apply the Set Nav Bar Image behavior
Apply the Jump Menu behavior
Laying out pages with CSS
About CSS page layout
A CSS page layout uses the Cascading Style Sheets format, rather than traditional HTML tables or frames, to organize
the content on a web page. The basic building block of the CSS layout is the div tag—an HTML tag that in most cases
acts as a container for text, images, and other page elements. When you create a CSS layout, you place div tags on the
page, add content to them, and position them in various places. Unlike table cells, which are restricted to existing
somewhere within the rows and columns of a table, div tags can appear anywhere on a web page. You can position div
tags absolutely (by specifying x and y coordinates), or relatively (by specifying its location with respect to its current
location). You can also position div tags by specifying floats, paddings, and margins—the preferred method by today’s
web standards.
Creating CSS layouts from scratch can be difficult because there are so many ways to do it. You can create a simple two-
column CSS layout by setting floats, margins, paddings, and other CSS properties in a nearly infinite number of
combinations. Additionally, the problem of cross-browser rendering causes certain CSS layouts to display properly in
some browsers, and display improperly in others. Dreamweaver makes it easy for you to build pages with CSS layouts
by providing 16 pre-designed layouts that work across different browsers.
Using the pre-designed CSS layouts that come with Dreamweaver is the easiest way to create a page with a CSS layout,
but you can also create CSS layouts using Dreamweaver absolutely-positioned elements (AP elements). An AP element
in Dreamweaver is an HTML page element—specifically, a div tag, or any other tag—that has an absolute position
assigned to it. The limitation of Dreamweaver AP elements, however, is that since they are absolutely positioned, their
positions never adjust on the page according to the size of the browser window.
If you are an advanced user, you can also insert div tags manually and apply CSS positioning styles to them to create
page layouts.
About CSS page layout structure
Before proceeding with this section, you should be familiar with basic CSS concepts.
The basic building block of the CSS layout is the div tag—an HTML tag that in most cases acts as a container for text,
images, and other page elements. The following example shows an HTML page that contains three separate div tags:
one large “container” tag, and two other tags—a sidebar tag, and a main content tag—within the container tag.
150
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
A Container div B Sidebar div C Main Content div
Following is the code for all three div tags in the HTML:
<!--container div tag-->
<div id="container">
<!--sidebar div tag-->
<div id="sidebar">
<h3>Sidebar Content</h3>
<p>Lorem ipsum dolor sit amet, consectetuer adipiscing elit.</p>
<p>Maecenas urna purus, fermentum id, molestie in, commodo porttitor, felis.</p>
</div>
<!--mainContent div tag-->
<div id="mainContent">
<h1> Main Content </h1>
<p>Lorem ipsum dolor sit amet, consectetuer adipiscing elit. Praesent aliquam, justo
convallis luctus rutrum.</p>
<p>Phasellus tristique purus a augue condimentum adipiscing. Aenean sagittis. Etiam leo
pede, rhoncus venenatis, tristique in, vulputate at, odio.</p>
<h2>H2 level heading </h2>
<p>Lorem ipsum dolor sit amet, consectetuer adipiscing elit. Praesent aliquam, justo
convallis luctus rutrum, erat nulla fermentum diam, at nonummy quam ante ac quam.</p>
</div>
</div>
In the above example, there is no “styling” attached to any of the div tags. Without CSS rules defined, each div tag and
its contents fall into a default location on the page. However, if each div tag has a unique id (as in the above example),
you can use the ids to create CSS rules that, when applied, change the style and positioning of the div tags.
The following CSS rule, which can reside in the head of the document or in an external CSS file, creates styling rules
for the first, or “container” div tag on the page:
#container {
width: 780px;
background: #FFFFFF;
margin: 0 auto;
border: 1px solid #000000;
text-align: left;
}
The #container rule styles the container div tag to have a width of 780 pixels, a white background, no margin (from the
left side of the page), a solid, black, 1-pixel border, and text that is aligned left. The results of applying the rule to the
container div tag are as follows:
151
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
A Text alig ned le f t B White background C 1-pixel solid black border
The next CSS rule creates styling rules for the sidebar div tag:
#sidebar {
float: left;
width: 200px;
background: #EBEBEB;
padding: 15px 10px 15px 20px;
}
The #sidebar rule styles the sidebar div tag to have a width of 200 pixels, a gray background, a top and bottom padding
of 15 pixels, a right padding of 10 pixels, and a left padding of 20 pixels. (The default order for padding is top-right-
bottom-left.) Additionally, the rule positions the sidebar div tag with float: left—a property that pushes the sidebar div
tag to the left side of the container div tag. The results of applying the rule to the sidebar div tag are as follows:
A Width 200 pixels B Top and bottom padding, 15 pixels
Lastly, the CSS rule for the main container div tag finishes the layout:
#mainContent {
margin: 0 0 0 250px;
padding: 0 20px 20px 20px;
}
The #mainContent rule styles the main content div with a left margin of 250 pixels, which means that it places 250 pixels
of space between the left side of the container div, and the left side of the main content div. Additionally, the rule
provides for 20 pixels of spacing on the right, bottom, and left sides of the main content div. The results of applying the
rule to the mainContent div are as follows:
152
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
The complete code looks as follows:
A 20 pixels left padding B 20 pixels right padding C 20 pixels bottom padding
<head>
<meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=iso-8859-1" />
<title>Untitled Document</title>
<style type="text/css">
#container {
width: 780px;
background: #FFFFFF;
margin: 0 auto;
border: 1px solid #000000;
text-align: left;
}
#sidebar {
float: left;
width: 200px;
background: #EBEBEB;
padding: 15px 10px 15px 20px;
}
#mainContent {
margin: 0 0 0 250px;
padding: 0 20px 20px 20px;
}
</style>
</head>
<body>
<!--container div tag-->
153
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
<div id="container">
<!--sidebar div tag-->
<div id="sidebar">
<h3>Sidebar Content</h3>
<p>Lorem ipsum dolor sit amet, consectetuer adipiscing elit.</p>
<p>Maecenas urna purus, fermentum id, molestie in, commodo porttitor, felis.</p>
</div>
<!--mainContent div tag-->
<div id="mainContent">
<h1> Main Content </h1>
<p>Lorem ipsum dolor sit amet, consectetuer adipiscing elit. Praesent aliquam, justo
convallis luctus rutrum.</p>
<p>Phasellus tristique purus a augue condimentum adipiscing. Aenean sagittis. Etiam leo
pede, rhoncus venenatis, tristique in, vulputate at, odio.</p>
<h2>H2 level heading </h2>
<p>Lorem ipsum dolor sit amet, consectetuer adipiscing elit. Praesent aliquam, justo
convallis luctus rutrum, erat nulla fermentum diam, at nonummy quam ante ac quam.</p>
</div>
</div>
</body>
Note: The above example code is a simplified version of the code that creates the two-column fixed left sidebar layout when
you create a new document using the predesigned layouts that come with Dreamweaver.
Create a page with a CSS layout
When creating a new page in Dreamweaver, you can create one that already contains a CSS layout. Dreamweaver comes
with 16 different CSS layouts that you can choose from. Additionally, you can create your own CSS layouts and add
them to the configuration folder so that they appear as layout choices in the New Document dialog box.
Dreamweaver CSS layouts render correctly in the following browsers: Firefox (Windows and Macintosh) 1.0, 1.5, 2.0,
and 3.6; Internet Explorer (Windows) 5.5, 6.0, 7.0, and 8.0; Opera (Windows and Macintosh) 8.0, 9.0, and 10.0; Safari
2.0, 3.0, and 4.0; and Chrome 3.0.
Create a page with a CSS layout
1Select File > New.
2In the New Document dialog box, select the Blank Page category. (It’s the default selection.)
3For Page Type, select the kind of page you want to create.
Note: You must select an HTML page type for the layout. For example, you can select HTML, ColdFusion®, PHP, and
so on. You cannot create an ActionScript™, CSS, Library Item, JavaScript, XML, XSLT, or ColdFusion Component page
with a CSS layout. Page types in the Other category of the New Document dialog box are also restricted from including
CSS page layouts.
4For Layout, select the CSS layout you want to use. You can choose from 16 different layouts. The Preview window
shows the layout and gives a brief description of the selected layout.
The predesigned CSS layouts provide the following types of columns:
Fixed Column width is specified in pixels. The column does not resize based on the size of the browser or the site
visitors text settings.
Liquid Column width is specified as a percentage of the site visitor’s browser width. The design adapts if the site
visitor makes the browser wider or narrower, but does not change based on the site visitors text settings.
5Select a document type from the DocType pop-up menu.
154
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
6Select a location for the layouts CSS from the Layout CSS in pop-up menu.
Add To Head Adds CSS for the layout to the head of the page youre creating.
Create New File Adds CSS for the layout to a new external CSS stylesheet and attaches the new stylesheet to the page
you’re creating.
Link To Existing File Lets you specify an existing CSS file that already contains the CSS rules needed for the layout.
This option is particularly useful when you want to use the same CSS layout (the CSS rules for which are contained
in a single file) across multiple documents.
7Do one of the following:
If you selected Add to Head from the Layout CSS in pop-up menu (the default option), click Create.
If you selected Create New File from the Layout CSS pop-up menu, click Create, and then specify a name for the
new external file in the Save Style Sheet File As dialog box.
If you selected Link to Existing File from the Layout CSS in pop-up menu, add the external file to the Attach CSS
file text box by clicking the Add Style Sheet icon, completing the Attach External Style Sheet dialog box, and
clicking OK. When you’re finished, click Create in the New Document dialog box.
Note: When you select the Link to Existing File option, the file you specify must already have the rules for the CSS file
contained within it.
When you put the layout CSS in a new file or link to an existing file, Dreamweaver automatically links the file to the
HTML page you’re creating.
Note: Internet Explorer conditional comments (CCs), which help work around IE rendering issues, remain embedded
in the head of the new CSS layout document, even if you select New External File or Existing External File as the
location for your layout CSS.
8(Optional) You can also attach CSS style sheets to your new page (unrelated to the CSS layout) when you create the
page. To do this, click the Attach Style Sheet icon above the Attach CSS file pane and select a CSS style sheet.
For a detailed walk-through of this process, see David Powerss article, Automatically attaching a style sheet to new
documents.
Add custom CSS layouts to the list of choices
1Create an HTML page that contains the CSS layout youd like to add to the list of choices in the New Document
dialog box. The CSS for the layout must reside in the head of the HTML page.
To make your custom CSS layout consistent with the other layouts that come with Dreamweaver, you should save
your HTML file with the .htm extension.
2Add the HTML page to the Adobe Dreamweaver CS5\Configuration\BuiltIn\Layouts folder.
3(Optional) Add a preview image of your layout (for example a .gif or .png file) to the Adobe Dreamweaver
CS5\Configuration\BuiltIn\Layouts folder. The default images that come with Dreamweaver are 227 pixels wide x
193 pixels high PNG files.
Give your preview image the same file name as your HTML file so that you can easily keep track of it. For example,
if your HTML file is called myCustomLayout.htm, call your preview image myCustomLayout.png.
4(Optional) Create a notes file for your custom layout by opening the Adobe Dreamweaver
CS5\Configuration\BuiltIn\Layouts\_notes folder, copying and pasting any of the existing notes files in the same
folder, and renaming the copy for your custom layout. For example, you could copy the oneColElsCtr.htm.mno file,
and rename it myCustomLayout.htm.mno.
155
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
5(Optional) After you’ve created a notes file for your custom layout, you can open the file and specify the layout name,
description, and preview image.
More Help topics
Understanding Cascading StyleSheets
Create a layout using a blank page
Set default document type and encoding
Link to an external CSS style sheet
Working with Bootstrap files
Bootstrap is the most popular, free, HTML, CSS, and JavaScript framework for developing responsive, mobile-first
websites. The framework includes responsive CSS and HTML templates for buttons, tables, navigation, image
carousels, and other elements that you can use on your web page. A few optional JavaScript plug-ins too are available,
which enable developers with even basic coding knowledge to develop great responsive websites.
Dreamweaver lets you create Bootstrap documents and also edit existing web pages created using Bootstrap. Whether
it is a fully designed Bootstrap file or a work-in-progress design, you can edit them in Dreamweaver to not only edit
code, but also use visual editing features such as Live View editing, visual CSS designer, Visual Media Queries, and
Extract to make design changes.
Note: You can open websites created using only Bootstrap framework version 3 and later in Dreamweaver.
Create Bootstrap documents
You can begin designing your Bootstrap website using one of the following options in the New Document dialog box:
Bootstrap starter templates (Starter Templates > Bootstrap Templates) - Use this option if you want to get started
quickly without the hassle of laying out your pages from scratch. Simply edit the text and replace the assets, if
necessary, and your responsive website is ready. See Using Bootstrap starter templates for more information.
Create an HTML document based on Bootstrap framework (New Document > HTML > Bootstrap) - Use this
option if you want to build your website brick-by-brick using CSS and Bootstrap components within Dreamweaver.
See Creating HTML documents based on Bootstrap framework for more information.
Note: In the new Bootstrap documents, CSS Designer is disabled. If you want to modify the styles in the Bootstrap
document, create or attach another CSS to the document.
Using Bootstrap starter templates
Bootstrap starter templates let you create web pages for popular themes in a jiffy. All the dependent files in the
framework are available for you to copy instantly.
1Click File > New.
2In the New Document dialog box that appears, click Starter Templates, and then select the required template from
the list of Bootstrap Templates.
3Click Create.
4Choose a location to save the new document and click Save.
5When prompted to copy the dependent files, click Copy.
156
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
An HTML page that is based on the template you chose is created. You can now modify the page by adding or
deleting components, editing text, or assets as required.
Creating HTML documents based on Bootstrap framework
You can start building your responsive website by creating an HTML document based on Bootstrap framework. You
can choose to create a set of Bootstrap framework files or use the existing files. Once the document is created, you can
add Bootstrap components such as accordions and carousels using the Insert panel in Dreamweaver. Or, if you have
Photoshop comps, you can use Extract to bring in images, fonts, styles, text, and more into your Bootstrap document.
1Click File > New.
2In the New Document dialog box that appears, click New Document > HTML, and then click the Bootstrap tab.
3To create a new bootstrap.css file (and the other bootstrap files), perform the following actions:
Specify whether you want to create a new Bootstrap CSS or use an existing CSS.
If you choose to create a new CSS, a "css" folder is created in the site root, and the bootstrap.css file is copied into the
new folder. If you choose to use an existing CSS, specify the path or browse to the location of the CSS.
aClick Create New.
b(Optional) if you want to attach any other CSS to your document, click in the Attach CSS section. The Attach
External Style Sheet dialog box appears. Specify the settings and click OK.
cInclude A Pre-built Layout option provides a basic Bootstrap document structure as shown below:
157
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
If you do not want the basic structure and want to start off with a blank document, deselect the Include A Pre-
built Layout option.
d(Optional) The default layout contains 12 columns with 30 px gutter. The default screen sizes are 768 px, 992 px,
and 1200 px.
If you want to modify these settings, click Customize. The bootstrap.css file is modified accordingly.
eIf you want the Extract panel to be opened (in case it is closed) to let you start right away by extracting assets
from Photoshop comps.
After you create the document, you will find three folders - css, js, and fonts - in the site root folder. If no site is
defined, you will be prompted to choose a folder where these folders can be created.
4To use existing Bootstrap framework files, perform the following actions:
aClick Use Existing and specify the path of the bootstrap.css file. You can also browse to the location where the
CSS is saved.
158
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
b(Optional) if you want to attach any other CSS to your document, click in the Attach CSS section. The Attach
External Style Sheet dialog box appears. Specify the settings and click OK.
cInclude A Pre-built Layout option provides a basic Bootstrap document structure. If you do not want the basic
structure and want to start off with a blank document, deselect the Include A Pre-built Layout option.
5Click Create.
Note: The bootstrap.css file that is created is read-only. You will see that the options to add, edit, or delete selectors or modify
the properties of the selectors are disabled in CSS Designer.If you want to modify the styling of your Bootstrap document,
create another CSS file to override the existing styles, and then attach it to the document.
Open Bootstrap files
Note: It is recommended that you open and edit documents created in Bootstrap version 3 and later in Dreamweaver.
You can open Bootstrap files using one of the following ways:
File > Open and browse to the Bootstrap HTML file.
(Recommended) Create a Dreamweaver site and point the site folder to the folder that contains all your Bootstrap
files.
When you open a Bootstrap HTML file in Dreamweaver:
The rows are highlighted in gray dashed lines with rounded corners
The columns are highlighted in blue dashed lines
159
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
A Row B Column
Dreamweaver recognizes the CSS files associated with any Bootstrap HTML file if the CSS filename contains
'bootstrap'. The CSS file reference can be any or all of the following:
Local path:
The minified or unminified CSS file is present locally. For example:
<link href="css/bootstrap.css" rel="stylesheet"> or<link href="css/bootstrap.min.css" rel="stylesheet">
Remote path:
A remote minified or unminified CSS file. For example:
<link href="http://somewebsite.com/css/bootstrap.css" rel="stylesheet"> <link
href="http://somewebsite.com/css/bootstrap.min.css" rel="stylesheet">
CDN
<link href="http://maxcdn.bootstrapcdn.com/bootstrap/3.3.1/css/bootstrap.min.css" rel="stylesheet">
Note: Bootstrap style sheets in both link and import tags are supported in Dreamweaver. However, nested import - link to
a style sheet that in turn imports another style sheet - is not supported.
Hide, unhide, and manage hidden Bootstrap elements
Sometimes, you may require an element to be displayed in one viewport while in another viewport, you may want to
hide the element for design purposes.
To hide a Bootstrap element, right-click and select Hide Element. The element is temporarily hidden from the view.
To view and unhide hidden elements, right-click and select Manage Hidden Elements. The hidden elements appear
with a gray, hashed background. Click the eye icon to unhide the element.
160
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
Add Bootstrap components
The Bootstrap Components option in the Insert panel lists all the Bootstrap components that you can add to your web
page in Dreamweaver.
To add a component, drag it from the panel onto the web page. Before you drop the component, take note of the visual
aids such as Live Guides, Precision Insert (using DOM), and Position Assist. Use these aids to place the components
quickly, and accurately on your page. For more information on inserting elements in your web page, see the article on
Use the Insert panel.
Add rows
Click the required row after which you want to add the new row. Then, click . A Bootstrap row along with two child
column elements with six columns each is added.
The code for the added row is as follows:
<div class="row"> <div class="col-*-6"></div> <div class="col-*-6"></div> </div>
where * represents the current screen size in Dreamweaver.
Add columns
Select the required column and then click . The selected column is duplicated without its children.
All empty columns are assigned a minimum height of 20px. However, this height is not actually added to the page; it is
shown only in Live view for easier insertion of elements within the columns.
161
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
Resize and offset columns
Resizing and offsetting columns become imperative especially when you are creating responsive designs for various
viewports.
Resize columns
Click the required column and drag the handle on the right to resize. When you resize a column, the col-*-n class is
added, where * represents the current media query (xs, sm, md, or lg) and n represents the number of columns that it
occupies.
Dreamweaver detects the current screen size and adds the appropriate class. To resize columns to suit specific
viewports, change the viewport size using the options in the lower-right corner or the scrubber. Then resize the
columns as appropriate.
Offset columns
Click the required column and drag the handle on the left to offset the column. The offset is shown as a hashed area.
When you offset the column, the col-*-offset-n class is added, where * represents the current media query (xs, sm, md,
or lg) and n represents the number of columns by which it shifts.
Dreamweaver detects the current screen size and adds the right class. To offset columns to suit specific viewports,
change the viewport size using the options in the lower-right corner or the scrubber. Then, offset the columns as
appropriate.
Visual Media Queries
Media Queries is a CSS3 module that helps you design responsive websites by defining different style rules for different
devices or media types. Based on these rules, content is rendered to adapt to various conditions, such as, screen sizes,
browser window sizes, device sizes and orientation, and resolution.
You can add media queries using the @media rule to your CSS. Or, you can create separate style sheets for different
media types and then call them using the following syntax:
<link rel='stylesheet' media='all' href='normal.css' />
<link rel='stylesheet' media='print' href='print.css' />
<link rel='stylesheet' media='screen and (min-width: 701px)' href='medium.css' />
The browser on a device checks the media query and uses the corresponding CSS file to display the web page.
For more information, see this article.
You can add the media queries by adding the relevant code to your HTML or CSS files. In addition, Dreamweaver lets
you create and manage media queries easily using:
Visual Media Query bar
CSS Designer
The basic difference between these two methods is the visual aspect. If you prefer to code and then view the changes in
Live view, use the CSS Designer. If you prefer to visualize your page at different breakpoints and simultaneously make
design changes, Visual Media Query is a better bet.
162
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
Visual Media Query bars
Visual Media Query bars are a visual representation of the media queries present in a page. These bars help you visualize
your web page at different breakpoints and how different components of your web page reflow in different viewports.
While you view your page in different viewports, you can make design changes that are specific to a viewport without
affecting the page design in other viewports.
Visual Media Query consists of three bars as horizontal rows, each representing a category of media query:
Green: Media queries with max-width conditions
Blue : Media queries with both min-width and max-width conditions
Purple : Media queries with min-width conditions
Note: The media queries listed in the CSS designer panel are also prefixed with these colors.
Each category can consist of one or more media queries. If a media query condition is not defined in the document,
then the corresponding visual media qurey bar, too, will not be displayed. For example, if the document does not
contain min-width conditions, then the purple bar is not displayed.
The breakpoint values are indicated on the bars - min-width at the left and max-width at the right of the bar.
A Breakpoints B Visual Media Query bars C Add media query icon D Scrubber
Hide or show Visual Media Queries
The Visual Media Query bar is visible in Live View by default. To hide the bar, you can use the Hide/Show button in the
Document Toolbar.
Switch between breakpoints
To view your page in a specific size (breakpoint), click the corresponding media query bar. The document will snap to
the breakpoint.
Alternatively, you can drag the scrubber to the required breakpoint.
To resize the view to the size of the Dreamweaver document window, do one of the following actions:
Double-click anywhere in the grey area at the right of the document where you see the text 'Double Click To Fit
Width'. If you don't see the grey area, drag the scrubber to the left.
163
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
Select the Full Width option in the drop-down list at the bottom of the document window.
If you do not see this option, drag the scrubber to decrease the size of the web page.
To undo, press Ctrl+Z (Win) or Cmd+Z (Mac).
Edit media queries visually
1Click the Visual Media Query bar that corresponds to the media query that you want to edit.
Resize handles appear. For media queries that have both min and max-width values, resize handles appear on both
the sides of the bar.
2Drag the handles to the required size.
The media queries are automatically updated with the new min-width and/or max-width values. A notification is
displayed to indicate that the media query was successfully edited. If there are multiple media queries that
correspond to the visual media query bar, all the media queries are updated. The number of media queries that were
updated is displayed along with the success message.
To undo, press Ctrl+Z (Win) or Cmd+Z (Mac).
Add new media queries
1Drag the scrubber along the ruler to the required size.
2Click . You are prompted to click specific areas on the ruler to create the media query.
3Click the indicated area on the ruler based on the media query (min or max) condition you require.
To cancel, drag the scrubber to a new position.
164
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
4In the pop-up that appears, one of the media query conditions (based on your choice) is prepopulated with the
current position of the scrubber. If you need both min and max conditions, specify the required value. Then, select
a CSS source in which the media query must be added.
If you choose to create a new CSS file, another pop-up appears. Specify the name and the path of the new CSS file
and click OK.
To undo, press Ctrl+Z (Win) or Cmd+Z (Mac).
Delete media queries
1Right-click the corresponding Visual Media Query bar.
2Click Delete and then click the media query that you want to delete.
3Click OK to confirm that you want to delete all the media queries and the associated selectors.
To undo, press Ctrl+Z (Win) or Cmd+Z (Mac).
View the code for media queries
1Right-click the required Visual Media Query bar and hover your mouse on Go To Code.
A list of all media queries in that particular breakpoint range along with the files in the which they are declared
appears.
2Click the required media query to navigate to the corresponding code in Code View.
If the Code View is not visible, the document is switched to Split view to display the code.
Responsive design using fluid grid layouts
The layout of a website has to respond and adapt to the dimensions of the device on which it is displayed (responsive
design). A fluid grid layout provides a visual way to create different layouts corresponding to devices on which the
website is displayed.
For example, your website is going to be viewed on desktops, tablets, and mobile phones. You can use fluid grid layouts
to specify layouts for each of these devices. Depending on whether the website is displayed on a desktop, tablet, or
mobile phone, the corresponding layout is used to display the website.
More info: Adaptive Layout versus Responsive Layout
Note: Inspect mode is not available for Fluid Grid Layout documents.
More Help topics
Create media queries
Using fluid grid layouts
Watch this video tutorial to learn how to use fluid grid layouts: Exploring fluid grid layouts.
165
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
Create a fluid grid layout
1Select File > Fluid Grid (legacy).
2The default value for the number of columns in the grid is displayed in the center of the media type. To customize
the number of columns for a device, edit the value as required.
3To set the width of a page as compared to the screen size, set the value in percentage.
4You can additionally change the gutter width. The gutter is the space between two columns.
5Specify the CSS options for the page.
When you click Create, you are asked to specify a CSS file. You can do one of the following:
Create a new CSS file.
Open an existing CSS file.
Specify the CSS file being opened as a Fluid Grid CSS file.
The Fluid Grid for mobile phones is displayed by default. Also, the Insert panel for Fluid Grid is displayed. Use the
options in the Insert panel to create your layout.
To switch to designing the layout for other devices, click the corresponding icon in the options below the Design
view.
6Save the file. When you save the HTML file, you are prompted to save the dependent files such as boilerplate.css and
respond.min.js to a location on your computer. Specify a location, and click Copy.
The boilerplate.css is based on the HTML5 boilerplate. It is a set of CSS styles that ensures consistency in the way
your web page is rendered across multiple devices. respond.min.js is a JavaScript library that helps provide support
for media queries in older versions of browser.
Edit fluid grid documents
You can edit fluid grid documents directly in Live View to:
Associate HTML classes and IDs to elements. For more information, see Element Display .
Edit image attributes and text. For more information, see Quick Property Inspector and Edit text in Live View .
Insert new elements. For more informaiton, see Insert fluid grid elements.
You can also visualize the HTML DOM structure of a fluid grid document using DOM panel.
Insert fluid grid elements
The Insert panel (Window > Insert) lists the elements that you can use in a fluid grid layout. While inserting the
elements, you can choose to insert them as fluid elements.
1In the Insert panel, click the element that you want to insert.
2In the dialog box that appears, click Before, After, or Nest to position the element with respect to the reference
element highlighted in the document.
166
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
3Select a class, or enter a value for the ID. The Class menu displays classes from the CSS file that you specified when
creating the page.
4Select the Insert As Fluid Element check box.
5When you select an inserted element, the options to hide, duplicate, or delete the Div are displayed. For Divs layered
on top of each other, the option to swap Divs is displayed.
Elements on a page can be traversed cyclically using the up and down arrow keys. Select the element boundary and
then press the arrow key.
Nesting elements
To nest fluid elements within other fluid elements, ensure that the focus is inside the parent element. Then, insert the
required child element.
Nested Duplication is also supported. Nested Duplication duplicates the HTML (of the selected element) and generates
the relevant Fluid CSS. Absolute elements contained within the selected element are positioned appropriately. Nested
elements can also be duplicated using the duplicate button.
When you delete a parent element, the CSS corresponding to the element, its children, and associated HTML are
deleted. Nested elements can also be deleted together using the Delete button (Keyboard Shortcut: Ctrl+Delete).
Option Description
Swap Div Swaps the currently selected element with the element above or
below.
Hide Hides the element. To unhide an element, do one of the following:
To unhide ID selectors, change the display property in the CSS file
to block. (display:block) To unhide class selectors, remove the
applied class (hide_<MediaType>) in the source code.
Move up a row Moves the element up by a row
Duplicate Duplicates the currently selected element. CSS linked to element
is also duplicated.
Delete For ID selectors, deletes both the HTML as well as CSS. To delete
HTML only, press Delete. For class selectors, only HTML is deleted.
Align For class selectors, the Align option acts as a zero margin button.
For ID selectors, the align button aligns the element to the grid.
167
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
Presenting content with tables
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About tables
Tables are a powerful tool for presenting tabular data and for laying out text and graphics on an HTML page. A table
consists of one or more rows; each row consists of one or more cells. Although columns aren’t usually explicitly
specified in HTML code, Dreamweaver enables you to manipulate columns as well as rows and cells.
Dreamweaver displays the table width and the column width for each table column when the table is selected or when
the insertion point is in the table. Next to the widths are arrows for the table header menu and the column header
menus. Use the menus for quick access to common table-related commands. You can enable or disable the widths and
menus.
If you do not see a width for the table or for a column, then that table or column does not have a specified width in the
HTML code. If two numbers appear, then the visual width as it appears in Design view doesnt match the width
specified in the HTML code. This can happen when you resize a table by dragging its lower-right corner or when you
add content to a cell that’s larger than its set width.
For example, if you set a columns width to 200 pixels and then add content that stretches the width to 250 pixels, two
numbers appear for that column: 200 (the width specified in the code) and (250) in parentheses (the visual width of the
column as its rendered on your screen).
Note: You can also lay out your pages using CSS positioning.
Table formatting precedence in HTML
When formatting tables in Design view, you can set properties for the entire table or for selected rows, columns, or cells
in the table. When a property, such as background color or alignment, is set to one value for the whole table and another
value for individual cells, cell formatting takes precedence over row formatting, which in turn takes precedence over
table formatting.
The order of precedence for table formatting is as follows:
1Cells
2Rows
3Table
For example, if you set the background color for a single cell to blue, then set the background color of the entire table
to yellow, the blue cell does not change to yellow, since cell formatting takes precedence over table formatting.
Note: When you set properties on a column, Dreamweaver changes the attributes of the td tag corresponding to each cell
in the column.
About splitting and merging table cells
You can merge any number of adjacent cells—as long as the entire selection is a line or a rectangle of cells—to produce
a single cell that spans several columns or rows. You can split a cell into any number of rows or columns, regardless of
whether it was previously merged. Dreamweaver automatically restructures the table (adding any necessary colspan or
rowspan attributes) to create the specified arrangement.
168
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
In the following example, the cells in the middle of the first two rows have been merged into a single cell that spans two
rows.
Insert a table and add content
Use the Insert panel or the Insert menu to create a new table. Then, add text and images to table cells the same way that
you add text and images outside of a table.
Note: The Layout mode feature is deprecated as of Dreamweaver CS4 and later. Layout mode created page layouts using
layout tables, which are no longer recommended by Adobe. For more information on Layout mode and why it was
deprecated, see the Dreamweaver Team Blog.
1In the Design view of the Document window, place the insertion point where you want the table to appear.
Note: If your document is blank, you can place the insertion point only at the beginning of the document.
Select Insert > Table.
In the Common category of the Insert panel, click Table.
2Set the attributes of the Table dialog box and click OK to create the table.
Rows Determines the number of table rows.
Columns Determines the number of table columns.
Table Width Specifies the width of the table in pixels, or as a percentage of the browser window’s width.
Border Thickness Specifies the width, in pixels, of the tables borders.
Cell Spacing Determines the number of pixels between adjacent table cells.
When you don’t explicitly assign values for border thickness or cell spacing and cell padding, most browsers display
the table border thickness and cell padding set to 1 and cell spacing were set to 2. To ensure that browsers display the
table with no border, padding or spacing, set Cell Padding and Cell Spacing to 0.
Cell Padding Determines the number of pixels between a cells border and its contents.
None Does not enable column or row headings for the table.
Left Makes the first column of the table a column for headings, so that you can enter a heading for each row of the
table.
Top Makes the first row of the table a row for headings, so that you can enter a heading for each column of the table.
Both Enables you to enter column and row headings in the table.
It’s a good idea to use headers in case any of your website visitors use screen readers. Screen readers read table
headings and help screen-reader users keep track of table information.
Caption Provides a table title which displays outside of the table.
Align Caption Specifies where the table caption appears in relation to the table.
Summary Provides a table description. Screen readers read the summary text, but the text does not appear in the
user’s browser.
169
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
Import and export tabular data
You can import tabular data that has been created in another application (such as Microsoft Excel) and saved in a
delimited text format (with items separated by tabs, commas, colons, or semicolons) into Dreamweaver and format it
as a table.
You can also export table data from Dreamweaver into a text file, with the contents of adjacent cells separated by a
delimiter. You can use commas, colons, semicolons, or spaces as delimiters. When you export a table, the entire table is
exported; you cannot select portions of a table to export.
If you want only some of the data from a table—for example, the first six rows or the first six columns—then copy the
cells containing that data, paste those cells outside of the table (to create a new table), and export the new table.
Import table data
1Do one of the following:
Select File > Import > Tabular Data.
In the Data category of the Insert panel, click the Import Tabular Data icon .
Select Insert > Table Objects > Import Tabular Data.
2Specify the options for the tabular data and click OK.
Data File The name of the file to import. Click the Browse button to select a file.
Delimiter The delimiter used in the file you’re importing.
If you select Other, a text box appears to the right of the pop-up menu. Enter the delimiter used in your file.
Note: Specify the delimiter that was used when the data file was saved. If you don’t do this, the file will not be imported
properly, and your data will not be correctly formatted in a table.
Table Width The width of the table.
Select Fit to Data to make each column wide enough to fit the longest text string in the column.
Select Set to specify a fixed table width in pixels or as a percentage of the browser window’s width.
Border Specifies the width, in pixels, of the tables borders.
Cell Padding The number of pixels between a cells content and the cell boundaries.
Cell Spacing The number of pixels between adjacent table cells.
If you don’t explicitly assign values for borders, cell spacing, and cell padding, most browsers display the table with
borders and cell padding set to 1, and cell spacing set to 2. To ensure that browsers display the table with no padding
or spacing, set Cell Padding and Cell Spacing to 0. To view cell and table boundaries when the border is set to 0, select
View > Visual Aids > Table Borders.
Format Top Row Determines what formatting, if any, is applied to the top row of the table. Select from four
formatting options: no formatting, bold, italic, or bold italic.
Export a table
1Place the insertion point in any cell of the table.
2Select File > Export > Table.
3Specify the following options:
Delimiter Specifies which delimiter character should be used to separate items in the exported file.
170
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
Line Breaks Specifies which operating system youll be opening the exported file in: Windows, Macintosh, or UNIX.
(Different operating systems have different ways of indicating the end of a line of text.)
4Click Export.
5Enter a name for the file and click Save.
Select table elements
You can select an entire table, row, or column at once. You can also select one or more individual cells.
When you move your pointer over a table, row, column, or cell, Dreamweaver highlights all the cells in that selection
so that you know which cells will be selected. This is useful when you have tables without borders, cells that span
multiple columns or rows, or nested tables. You can change the highlight color in preferences.
If you position the pointer over a tables border, then hold the Control key (Windows) or Command key (Macintosh),
the entire structure of the table—that is, all cells in the table—is highlighted. This is useful when you have nested tables
and want to see the structure of one of the tables.
Select an entire table
Do one of the following:
Click the upper-left corner of the table, anywhere on the top or bottom edge of the table, or on a row or columns
border.
Note: The pointer changes to the table grid icon when you can select the table (unless you click a row or column
border).
Click in a table cell, then select the <table> tag in the tag selector at the lower-left corner of the Document
window.
Click in a table cell, then select Modify > Table > Select Table.
Click in a table cell, click the table header menu, then select Select Table. Selection handles appear on the selected
tables lower and right edges.
Select individual or multiple rows or columns
1Position the pointer to point to the left edge of a row or the top edge of a column.
2When the pointer changes to a selection arrow, click to select a row or column, or drag to select multiple rows or
columns.
Select a single column
1Click in the column.
2Click the column header menu and choose Select Column.
171
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
Select a single cell
Do one of the following:
Click in the cell, then select the <td> tag in the tag selector at the lower-left corner of the Document window.
Control-click (Windows) or Command-click (Macintosh) in the cell.
Click in the cell and select Edit >Select All.
Select Edit > Select All again when a cell is selected to select the entire table.
Select a line or a rectangular block of cells
Do one of the following:
Drag from a cell to another cell.
Click in one cell, Control-click (Windows) or Command-click (Macintosh) in the same cell to select it, then
Shift-click another cell.
All of the cells within the linear or rectangular region defined by the two cells are selected.
Select nonadjacent cells
Control-click (Windows) or Command-click (Macintosh) the cells, rows, or columns you want to select.
If each cell, row, or column you Control-click or Command-click isn’t already selected, it’s added to the selection. If
it is already selected, its removed from the selection.
Change the highlight color for table elements
1Select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh).
2Select Highlighting from the category list on the left, make either of the following changes, and click OK.
To change the highlighting color for table elements, click the Mouse-Over color box, then select a highlight color
using the color picker (or enter the hexadecimal value for the highlight color in the text box).
To enable or disable highlighting for table elements, select or deselect the Show option for Mouse-Over.
Note: These options affect all objects, such as absolutely-positioned elements (AP elements), that Dreamweaver
highlights when you move the pointer over them.
172
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
Set table properties
You can use the Property inspector to edit tables.
1Select a table.
2In the Property inspector (Window > Properties), change properties as necessary.
Table Id An ID for the table.
Rows and Cols The number of rows and columns in the table.
W The width of the table in pixels, or as a percentage of the browser window’s width.
Note: You usually don’t need to set the height of a table.
CellPad The number of pixels between a cells content and the cell boundaries.
CellSpace The number of pixels between adjacent table cells.
Align Determines where the table appears, relative to other elements in the same paragraph, such as text or images.
Left aligns the table to the left of other elements (so that text in the same paragraph wraps around the table to the
right); Right aligns the table to the right of other elements (with text wrapping around it to the left); and Center
centers the table (with text appearing above and/or below the table). Default indicates that the browser should use
its default alignment.
When alignment is set to Default, other content is not displayed next to the table. To display a table next to other
content, use Left or Right alignment.
Border Specifies the width, in pixels, of the tables borders.
If you don’t explicitly assign values for the border, cell spacing, and cell padding, most browsers display the table with
the border and cell padding set to 1 and cell spacing set to 2. To ensure that browsers display the table with no
padding or spacing, set Border to 0, Cell Padding and Cell Spacing to 0. To view cell and table boundaries when the
border is set to 0, select View > Visual Aids > Table Borders.
Class sets a CSS class on the table.
Note: You might need to expand the Table Property inspector to see the following options. To expand the Table Property
inspector, click the expander arrow in the lower-right corner.
Clear Column Widths and Clear Row Heights delete all explicitly specified row height or column width values from
the table.
Convert Table Widths To Pixels and Convert Table Heights To Pixels set the width or height of each column in the
table to its current width in pixels (also sets the width of the whole table to its current width in pixels).
Convert Table Widths To Percent and Convert Table Heights To Percent set the width or height of each column in
the table to its current width expressed as a percentage of the Document window’s width (also sets the width of the
whole table to its current width as a percentage of the Document window’s width).
If you entered a value in a text box, press Tab or Enter (Windows) or Return (Macintosh) to apply the value.
Set cell, row, or column properties
You can use the Property inspector to edit cells and rows in a table.
1Select the column or row.
173
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
2In the Property inspector (Window > Properties), set the following options:
Horz Specifies the horizontal alignment of the contents of a cell, row, or column. You can align the contents to the
left, right, or center of the cells, or you can indicate that the browser should use its default alignment (usually left for
regular cells and center for header cells).
Vert Specifies the vertical alignment of the contents of a cell, row, or column. You can align the contents to the top,
middle, bottom, or baseline of the cells, or indicate that the browser should use its default alignment (usually
middle).
W and H The width and height of selected cells in pixels, or as a percentage of the entire tables width or height. To
specify a percentage, follow the value with a percent symbol (%). To let the browser determine the proper width or
height based on the contents of the cell and the widths and heights of the other columns and rows, leave the field
blank (the default).
By default, a browser chooses a row height and column width to accommodate and the widest image or the longest
line in a column. This is why a column sometimes becomes much wider than the other columns in the table when
you add content to it.
Note: You can specify a height as a percentage of the total table height, but the row may not display at the specified
percentage height in browsers.
Bg The background color for a cell, column, or row, chosen with the color picker.
Merge Cells Combines selected cells, rows, or columns into one cell. You can merge cells only if they form a
rectangular or linear block.
Split Cell Divides a cell, creating two or more cells. You can split only one cell at a time; this button is disabled if
more than one cell is selected.
No Wrap Prevents line wrapping, keeping all the text in a given cell on a single line. If No Wrap is enabled, cells
widen to accommodate all data as you type it or paste it into a cell. (Normally, cells expand horizontally to
accommodate the longest word or widest image in the cell, then expand vertically as necessary to accommodate
other contents.)
Header Formats the selected cells as table header cells. The contents of table header cells are bold and centered by
default.
You can specify widths and heights as either pixels or percentages, and you can convert from pixels to percentages
and back.
Note: When you set properties on a column, Dreamweaver changes the attributes of the td tag corresponding to each
cell in the column. When you set certain properties for a row, however, Dreamweaver changes the attributes of the tr tag
rather than changing the attributes of each td tag in the row. When you’re applying the same format to all the cells in a
row, applying the format to the tr tag produces cleaner, more concise HTML code.
3Press Tab or Enter (Windows) or Return (Macintosh) to apply the value.
Use Expanded Tables mode for easier table editing
Expanded Tables mode temporarily adds cell padding and spacing to all tables in a document and increases the tables
borders to make editing easier. This mode enables you to select items in tables or precisely place the insertion point.
For example, you might expand a table to place the insertion point to the left or right of an image, without inadvertently
selecting the image or table cell.
174
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
A Table in Standard mode B Table in Expanded tables mode
Note: After you make your selection or place the insertion point, you should return to the Standard mode of Design view
to make your edits. Some visual operations, such as resizing, will not give expected results in Expanded Tables mode.
Switch to Expanded Tables mode
1If you are working in Code view, select View > Design or View > Code And Design (you cannot switch to Expanded
Tables mode in Code view).
2Do one of the following:
Select View > Table Mode > Expanded Tables Mode.
In the Layout category of the Insert panel, click Expanded Tables Mode.
A bar labeled Expanded Tables Mode appears across the top of the Document window. Dreamweaver adds cell
padding and spacing to all tables on the page and increases the tables’ borders.
Switch out of Expanded Tables mode
Do one of the following:
Click Exit in the bar labeled Expanded Tables Mode at the top of the Document window.
Select View > Table Mode > Standard Mode.
In the Layout category of the Insert panel, click Standard Mode.
Format tables and cells
You can change the appearance of tables by setting properties for the table and its cells or by applying a preset design
to the table. Before you set table and cell properties, be aware that the order of precedence for formatting is cells, rows,
and tables.
To format the text inside a table cell, use the same procedures you would use to format text outside of a table.
Change the format of a table, row, cell, or column
1Select a table, cell, row, or column.
2In the Property inspector (Window > Properties), click the expander arrow in the lower-right corner and change
properties as necessary.
3Change the properties as necessary.
For more information on the options, click the Help icon on the Property inspector.
Note: When you set properties on a column, Dreamweaver changes the attributes of the td tag corresponding to each
cell in the column. When you set certain properties for a row, however, Dreamweaver changes the attributes of the tr tag
rather than changing the attributes of each td tag in the row, When you’re applying the same format to all the cells in a
row, applying the format to the tr tag produces cleaner, more concise HTML code.
175
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
Add or edit accessibility values for a table in Code view
Edit the appropriate attributes in the code.
To quickly locate the tags in the code, click in the table, then select the <table> tag in the tag selector at the bottom
of the Document window.
Add or edit accessibility values for a table in Design view
To edit the table caption, highlight the caption and type a new caption.
To edit the caption alignment, place the insertion point in the table caption, right-click (Windows) or
Control-click (Macintosh), then select Edit Tag Code.
To edit the table summary, select the table, right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh), then select Edit
Tag Code.
Resizing tables, columns, and rows
Resizing tables
You can resize an entire table or individual rows and columns. When you resize an entire table, all of the cells in the
table change size proportionately. If a tables cells have explicit widths or heights specified, resizing the table changes the
visual size of the cells in the Document window but does not change the specified widths and heights of the cells.
You can resize a table by dragging one of its selection handles. Dreamweaver displays the table width, along with a table
header menu, at the top or bottom of the table when the table is selected or the insertion point is in the table.
Sometimes the column widths set in the HTML code do not match their apparent widths on the screen. When this
happens, you can make the widths consistent. Table and column widths and header menus appear in Dreamweaver to
help you lay out your tables; you can enable or disable the widths and menus as necessary.
Resizing columns and rows
You can change the width of a column or the height of a row in the Property inspector or by dragging the borders of
the column or row. If you have trouble resizing, you can clear the column widths or row heights and start over.
Note: You can also change cell widths and heights directly in the HTML code using Code view.
Dreamweaver displays column widths, along with column header menus, at the tops or bottoms of columns when the
table is selected or the insertion point is in the table; you can enable or disable the column header menus as necessary.
Resize a table
Select the table. If you are in Live view, Element Display is shown when you select the table. Click the sandwich icon
to enter the table formatting mode.
To resize the table horizontally, drag the selection handle on the right.
To resize the table vertically, drag the selection handle on the bottom.
To resize the table in both dimensions, drag the selection handle at the lower-right corner.
To exit the table formatting mode in Live view, press Esc or click outside the table. You can use Modify > Table menu
options to modify the table further.
Note: The options in Modify > Table menu vary based on whether you have selected the entire table or a single cell.
In Live view, Element Display shows 'table' when the entire table is selected and 'td' when a specific cell is selected.
To switch from a cell formatting to table formatting mode, click the table border.
176
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
Change a columns width and keep the overall table width
In Design view, drag the right border of the column you want to change.
The width of the adjacent column also changes, so you actually resize two columns. Visual feedback shows you how
the columns will adjust; the overall table width does not change.
Note: In tables with percentage-based widths (not pixels), if you drag the right border of the rightmost column, the entire
tables width changes, and all of the columns grow wider or narrow proportionately.
Change a columns width and maintain the size of the other columns
In Design view, hold the Shift key and drag the columns border.
The width of one column changes. Visual feedback shows you how the columns will adjust; the overall table width
changes to accommodate the column you are resizing.
Change a row’s height visually
Drag the lower border of the row.
Make column widths in code consistent with visual widths
1Click in a cell.
2Click the table header menu, then select Make All Widths Consistent.
Dreamweaver resets the width specified in the code to match the visual width.
Clear all set widths or heights in a table
1Select the table.
2Do one of the following:
Select Modify > Table > Clear Cell Widths, or Modify > Table > Clear Cell Heights.
177
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
In the Property inspector, (Window > Properties), click the Clear Row Heights button or the Clear Column
Widths button .
Click the table header menu, then selectClear All Heights or Clear All Widths.
Clear a columns set width
Click in the column, click the column header menu, and select Clear Column Width.
Enable or disable table and column widths and menus
1Select View > Visual Aids > Table Widths.
2Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) in the table, then select Table > Table Widths.
Add and remove rows and columns
To add and remove rows and columns, use the Modify > Table or column header menu.
Pressing Tab in the last cell of a table automatically adds another row to the table.
Add a single row or column
Click in a cell and do one of the following:
Select Modify > Table > Insert Row or Modify > Table > Insert Column.
A row appears above the insertion point or a column appears to the left of the insertion point.
Click the column header menu, and then select Insert Column Left or Insert Column Right.
Add multiple rows or columns
1Click in a cell.
2Select Modify > Table > Insert Rows Or Columns, complete the dialog box, and click OK.
Insert Indicates whether to insert rows or columns.
Number of Rows or Number of Columns The number of rows or columns to insert.
Where Specifies whether the new rows or columns should appear before or after the row or column of the selected
cell.
178
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
Delete a row or column
Do one of the following:
Click in a cell within the row or column you want to delete, then select Modify > Table > Delete Row, or Modify
> Table > Delete Column.
Select a complete row or column, then select Edit > Clear or press Delete.
Add or delete rows or columns using the Property inspector
1Select the table.
2In the Property inspector (Windows > Properties), do one of the following:
To add or delete rows, increase or decrease the Rows value.
To add or delete columns, increase or decrease the Cols value.
Note: Dreamweaver does not warn you if you are deleting rows and columns that contain data.
Split and merge cells
Use the Property inspector or the commands in the Modify > Table submenu to split or merge cells.
Merge two or more cells in a table
1Select the cells in a contiguous line and in the shape of a rectangle.
In the following illustration, the selection is a rectangle of cells, so the cells can be merged.
In the following illustration, the selection is not a rectangle, so the cells can’t be merged.
2Do one of the following:
Select Modify > Table > Merge Cells.
In the expanded HTML Property inspector (Window > Properties), click Merge Cells .
Note: If you don’t see the button, click the expander arrow in the lower-right corner of the Property inspector so that
you see all the options..
179
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
The contents of the individual cells are placed in the resulting merged cell. The properties of the first cell selected
are applied to the merged cell.
Split a cell
1Click in the cell and do one of the following:
Select Modify > Table > Split Cell.
In the expanded HTML Property inspector (Window > Properties), click Split Cell .
Note: If you don’t see the button, click the expander arrow in the lower-right corner of the Property inspector so that
you see all the options.
2In the Split Cell dialog box, specify how to split the cell:
Split Cell Into Specifies whether to split the cell into rows or columns.
Number Of Rows/Number Of Columns Specifies how many rows or columns to split the cell into.
Increase or decrease the number of rows or columns spanned by a cell
Do one of the following:
Select Modify > Table > Increase Row Span, or Modify > Table > Increase Column Span.
Select Modify > Table > Decrease Row Span, or Modify > Table > Decrease Column Span.
Copy, paste, and delete cells
You can copy, paste, or delete a single table cell or multiple cells at once, preserving the cells’ formatting.
You can paste cells at the insertion point or in place of a selection in an existing table. To paste multiple table cells, the
contents of the Clipboard must be compatible with the structure of the table or the selection in the table in which the
cells will be pasted.
Cut or copy table cells
1Select one or more cells in a contiguous line and in the shape of a rectangle.
In the following illustration, the selection is a rectangle of cells, so the cells can be cut or copied.
In the following illustration, the selection is not a rectangle, so the cells cant be cut or copied.
180
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
2Select Edit > Cut or Edit > Copy.
Note: If you selected an entire row or column and you select Edit > Cut, the entire row or column is removed from the
table (not just the contents of the cells).
Paste table cells
1Select where you want to paste the cells:
To replace existing cells with the cells you are pasting, select a set of existing cells with the same layout as the cells
on the clipboard. (For example, if you’ve copied or cut a 3 x 2 block of cells, you can select another 3 x 2 block of
cells to replace by pasting.)
To paste a full row of cells above a particular cell, click in that cell.
To paste a full column of cells to the left of a particular cell, click in that cell.
Note: If you have less than a full row or column of cells in the clipboard, and you click in a cell and paste the cells from
the clipboard, the cell you clicked in and its neighbors may (depending on its location in the table) be replaced with the
cells you are pasting.
To create a new table with the pasted cells, place the insertion point outside of the table.
2Select Edit > Paste.
If you are pasting entire rows or columns into an existing table, the rows or columns are added to the table. If you
are pasting an individual cell, the contents of the selected cell are replaced. If you are pasting outside a table, the rows,
columns, or cells are used to define a new table.
Remove cell content but leave the cells intact
1Select one or more cells.
Note: Make sure the selection does not consist entirely of complete rows or columns.
2Select Edit > Clear or press Delete.
Note: If only complete rows or columns are selected when you select Edit > Clear or press Delete, the entire rows or
columns—not just their contents—are removed from the table.
Delete rows or columns that contain merged cells
1Select the row or column.
2Select Modify > Table > Delete Row, or Modify > Table > Delete Column.
181
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
Nest tables
A nested table is a table inside a cell of another table. You can format a nested table as you would any other table;
however, its width is limited by the width of the cell in which it appears.
1Click in a cell of the existing table.
2Select Insert > Table, set the Insert Table options, and click OK.
Sort tables
You can sort the rows of a table based on the contents of a single column. You can also perform a more complicated
table sort based on the contents of two columns.
You cannot sort tables that contain colspan or rowspan attributes—that is, tables that contain merged cells.
1Select the table or click in any cell.
2Select Commands > Sort Table, set the options in the dialog box, and click OK.
Sort By Determines which columns values will be used to sort the tables rows.
Order Determines whether to sort the column alphabetically or numerically, and whether to sort it in ascending
order (A to Z, lower numbers to higher numbers) or descending order.
When the contents of a column are numbers, select Numerically. An alphabetic sort applied to a list of one- and two-
digit numbers results in the numbers being sorted as if they were words (resulting in ordering such as 1, 10, 2, 20,
3, 30) rather than being sorted as numbers (resulting in ordering such as 1, 2, 3, 10, 20, 30).
Then By/Order Determines the sorting order for a secondary sort on a different column. Specify the secondary-sort
column in the Then By pop-up menu, and the secondary sort order in the Order pop-up menus.
Sort Includes The First Row Specifies that the first row of the table should be included in the sort. If the first row is
a heading that should not be moved, do not select this option.
Sort Header Rows Specifies to sort all the rows in the tables thead section (if any) using the same criteria as the body
rows. (Note that thead rows remain in the thead section and still appear at the top of the table even after sorting.)
For information about the thead tag, see the Reference panel (select Help > Reference).
Sort Footer Rows Specifies to sort all the rows in the tables tfoot section (if any) using the same criteria as the body
rows. (Note that tfoot rows remain in the tfoot section and still appear at the bottom of the table even after sorting.)
For information about the tfoot tag, see the Reference panel (select Help > Reference).
Keep All Row Colors The Same After The Sort Has Been Completed Specifies that table row attributes (such as color)
should remain associated with the same content after the sort. If your table rows are formatted with two alternating
colors, do not select this option to ensure that the sorted table still has alternating-colored rows. If the row attributes
are specific to the content of each row, then select this option to ensure that those attributes remain associated with
the correct rows in the sorted table.
Using jQuery UI widgets in Dreamweaver
Spry widgets are replaced with jQuery widgets in Dreamweaver CC and later. While you can still modify existing spry
widgets on your page, you cannot add new spry widgets.
Widgets are small web applications written in languages such as DHTML and JavaScript that can be inserted and
executed within a web page. Among other things, web widgets help provide a way to replicate desktop experiences on
a web page.
182
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
jQuery UI widgets such as accordion, tabs, datepicker, slider, and autocomplete bring the experience of the desktop to
the web.
For example, the Tabs widget can be used to replicate the tab feature of dialog boxes in desktop applications.
Tutorial
How to author HTML, CSS, jQuery, and PHP 5.4 (15 min)
Learn how the latest support for HTML5, CSS3, jQuery and PHP5.4 in Dreamweaver can help you author static,
dynamic, mobile or responsive projects.
Insert a jQuery widget
When you insert a jQuery widget, the following are automatically added to the code:
References to all dependent files
Script tag containing the jQuery API for the widget. Additional widgets are added to the same script tag.
For more information on jQuery widgets, see http://jqueryui.com/demos/
Note: For jQuery effects, external reference to jquery-1.8.24.min.js is not added because this file is automatically included
when you add an effect.
1Ensure that your cursor is at a location on the page where you want to insert the widget.
2Select Insert > jQuery UI, and choose the widget that you want to insert.
If you use the Insert panel, the widgets are present in the jQuery UI section of the Insert panel.
When you select a jQuery widget, its properties are displayed in the Properties panel.
You can preview jQuery widgets in the Live view or in browser that supports jQuery widgets.
Modifying jQuery widgets
1Select the widget that you want to modify.
2In the Properties panel, modify the properties.
For example, to add an extra tab to the Tabs widget, select the widget and click "+" in the Properties panel.
More Help topics
Using jQuery widgets in web pages in Dreamweaver
Using jQuery effects in Dreamweaver
Spry effects are replaced with jQuery effects in Dreamweaver CC. While you can still modify existing spry effects on
your page, you cannot add new spry effects.
Add jQuery effects
1In the Design or Code view of your Dreamweaver document, select the element to which you want to apply a jQuery
effect.
2Select Windows > Behaviors to open the Behaviors panel.
183
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
3Click , click Effects, and then click the required effect.
The customization panel with the settings for the selected effect appears.
4Specify the settings, such as, the target element to which the effect is to be applied, and the duration for the effect.
The target element can be the same as the element you selected initially or a different element on the page. For
example, if you want users to click an element A to hide or show an element B, the target element is B.
5To add multiple jQuery effects, repeat the steps above.
When you choose multiple effects, Dreamweaver applies the effects in the order they are displayed in the Behaviors
panel. To change the order of the effects, use the arrow keys at the top of the panel.
Dreamweaver automatically inserts the relevant code into your document. For example, if you have selected the 'Fade'
effect, the following code is inserted:
External file references for the dependent files that is required for jQuery effects to work:
<script src="jQueryAssets/jquery-1.7.2.min.js" type="text/javascript"></script><script
src="jQueryAssets/jquery-ui-effects.custom.min.js" type="text/javascript"></script>
The following code is applied to the element in the body tag:
<li id="earthFrm" onclick="MM_DW_effectAppearFade($('#earthForms'),'show','fade',1000)">
Earth Forms</li>
A script tag along with the following code is added:
<script type="text/javascript"> function MM_DW_effectAppearFade(obj,method,effect,speed) {
obj[method](effect, {}, speed); }</script>
Event-based jQuery effects
When you apply a jQuery effect, it is assigned to the onClick event by default. You can change the trigger event for the
effect using the Behaviors panel.
1Select the required page element.
2In the Windows > Behaviors panel, click the Show Set Events icon.
3Click the row that corresponds to the effect that is currently applied. Note that the first column changes to a drop-
down list providing a list of events that you can choose from.
4Click the required event.
Remove jQuery effects
1Select the required page element.
The Behaviors panel lists all the effects that are currently applied to the selected page element.
2Click the effect you want to delete and then click .
184
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
Colors
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Web-safe colors
In HTML, colors are expressed either as hexadecimal values (for example, #FF0000) or as color names (red). A web-
safe color is one that appears the same in Safari and Microsoft Internet Explorer on both Windows and Macintosh
systems when running in 256-color mode. The conventional wisdom is that there are 216 common colors, and that any
hexadecimal value that combines the pairs 00, 33, 66, 99, CC, or FF (RGB values 0, 51, 102, 153, 204, and 255,
respectively) represents a web-safe color.
Testing, however, reveals that there are only 212 web-safe colors rather than a full 216, because Internet Explorer on
Windows does not correctly render the colors #0033FF (0,51,255), #3300FF (51,0,255), #00FF33 (0,255,51), and
#33FF00 (51,255,0).
When web browsers first made their appearance, most computers displayed only 265 colors (8 bits per channel (bpc).
Today, the majority of computers display thousands or millions of colors (16- and 32-bpc), so the justification for using
the browser-safe palette is greatly diminished if you are developing your site for users with current computer systems.
One reason to use the web-safe color palette is if you are developing for alternative web devices such as PDA and cell
phone displays. Many of this devices offer only black and white (1-bpc) or 256 color (8-bpc) displays.
The Color Cubes (default) and the Continuous Tone palettes in Dreamweaver use the 216-color web-safe palette;
selecting a color from these palettes displays the color’s hexadecimal value.
To select a color outside the web-safe range, open the system color picker by clicking the Color Wheel button in the
upper-right corner of the Dreamweaver color picker. The system color picker is not limited to web-safe colors.
UNIX versions of browsers use a different color palette than the Windows and Macintosh versions. If you are
developing exclusively for UNIX browsers (or your target audience is Windows or Macintosh users with 24-bpc
monitors and UNIX users with 8-bpc monitors), consider using hexadecimal values that combine the pairs 00, 40, 80,
BF, or FF, which produce web-safe colors for SunOS.
Use the color picker
In Dreamweaver, many of the dialog boxes, as well as the Property inspector for many page elements, contain a color
box, which opens a color picker. Use the color picker to select a color for a page element. You can also set the default
text color for your page elements.
1Click a color box in any dialog box or in the Property inspector.
The color picker appears.
2Do one of the following:
Use the eyedropper to select a color swatch from the palette. All colors in the Color Cubes (default) and
Continuous Tone palettes are web-safe; other palettes are not.
185
Layout and design
Last updated 6/3/2015
Use the eyedropper to pick up a color from anywhere on your screen—even outside the Dreamweaver windows.
To pick up a color from the desktop or another application, press and hold the mouse button; this allows the
eyedropper to retain focus, and select a color outside of Dreamweaver. If you click the desktop or another
application, Dreamweaver picks up the color where you clicked. However, if you switch to another application,
you may need to click a Dreamweaver window to continue working in Dreamweaver.
To expand your color selection, use the pop-up menu at the upper-right corner of the color picker. You can select
Color Cubes, Continuous Tone, Windows OS, Mac OS, and Grayscale.
Note: The Color Cubes and Continuous Tone palettes are web-safe, whereas Windows OS, Mac OS and Grayscale are
not.
To clear the current color without choosing a different color, click the Default Color button .
To open the system color picker, click the Color Wheel button .
186
Last updated 6/3/2015
Chapter 6: CSS
Understanding Cascading Style Sheets
About Cascading Style Sheets
Cascading Style Sheets (CSS) is a collection of formatting rules that control the appearance of content in a web page.
Using CSS styles to format a page separates content from presentation. The content of your page—the HTML code—
resides in the HTML file, and the CSS rules defining the presentation of the code reside in another file (an external style
sheet) or in another part of the HTML document (usually the head section). Separating content from presentation
makes it much easier to maintain the appearance of your site from a central location because you dont need to update
every property on every page whenever you want to make a change. Separating content from presentation also results
in simpler and cleaner HTML code, which provides shorter browser loading times, and simplifies navigation for people
with accessibility issues (for example, those using screen readers).
CSS gives you great flexibility and control over the exact appearance of your page. With CSS you can control many text
properties including specific fonts and font sizes; bold, italics, underlining, and text shadows; text color and
background color; link color and link underlining; and much more. By using CSS to control your fonts, you can also
ensure a more consistent treatment of your page layout and appearance in multiple browsers.
In addition to text formatting, you can use CSS to control the format and positioning of block-level elements in a web
page. A block-level element is a standalone piece of content, usually separated by a new line in the HTML, and visually
formatted as a block. For example, h1 tags, p tags, and div tags all produce block-level elements on a web page. You can
set margins and borders for block-level elements, position them in a specific location, add background color to them,
float text around them, and so on. Manipulating block-level elements is in essence the way you lay out pages with CSS.
About CSS rules
A CSS formatting rule consists of two partsthe selector and the declaration (or in most cases, a block of declarations).
The selector is a term (such as p, h1,a class name, or an id) that identifies the formatted element, and the declaration
block defines what the style properties are. In the following example, h1 is the selector, and everything that falls between
the braces ({}) is the declaration block:
h1 {
font-size: 16 pixels;
font-family: Helvetica;
font-weight:bold;
}
An individual declaration consists of two parts, the property (such as font-family) and value (such as Helvetica). In the
previous CSS rule, a particular style has been created for h1 tags: the text for all h1 tags linked to this style will be 16
pixels in size, Helvetica font, and bold.
187
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
The style (which comes from a rule, or a collection of rules) resides in a place separate from the actual text its
formattingusually in an external style sheet, or in the head portion of an HTML document. Thus, one rule for h1 tags
can apply to many tags at once (and in the case of external style sheets, the rule can apply to many tags at once on many
different pages). In this way, CSS provides extremely easy update capability. When you update a CSS rule in one place,
the formatting of all the elements that use the defined style are automatically updated to the new style.
You can define the following types of styles in Dreamweaver:
Class styles let you apply style properties to any element or elements on the page.
HTML tag styles redefine the formatting for a particular tag, such as h1. When you create or change a CSS style for
the h1 tag, all text formatted with the h1 tag is immediately updated.
Advanced styles redefine the formatting for a particular combination of elements, or for other selector forms as
allowed by CSS (for example, the selector td h2 applies whenever an h2 header appears inside a table cell.) Advanced
styles can also redefine the formatting for tags that contain a specific id attribute (for example, the styles defined by
#myStyle apply to all tags that contain the attribute-value pair id="myStyle").
CSS rules can reside in the following locations:
External CSS style sheets Collections of CSS rules stored in a separate, external CSS (.css) file (not an HTML file). This
file is linked to one or more pages in a website using a link or an @import rule in the head section of a document.
Internal (or embedded) CSS style sheets Collections of CSS rules included in a style tag in the head portion of an
HTML document.
Inline styles Defined within specific instances of tags throughout an HTML document. (Using Inline styles is not
recommended.)
Dreamweaver recognizes styles defined in existing documents as long as they conform to CSS style guidelines.
Dreamweaver also renders most applied styles directly in Design view. (Previewing the document in a browser window,
however, gives you the most accurate “live” rendering of the page.) Some CSS styles are rendered differently in
Microsoft Internet Explorer, Netscape, Opera, Apple Safari, or other browsers, and some are not currently supported
by any browser.
To display the O’Reilly CSS reference guide included with Dreamweaver, select Help > Reference and select OReilly CSS
Reference from the pop-up menu in the Reference panel.
188
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
About cascading styles
The term cascading refers to the way a browser ultimately displays styles for specific elements on a web page. Three
different sources are responsible for the styles you see on a web page: the style sheet created by the author of the page,
the user’s customized style selections (if any), and the default styles of the browser itself. The previous topics describe
creating styles for a web page as the author of both the web page and the style sheet attached to that page. But browsers
also have their own default style sheets that dictate the rendering of web pages, and in addition to that, users can
customize their browsers by making selections that adjust the display of web pages. The final appearance of a web page
is the result of the rules of all three of these sources coming together (or “cascading”) to render the web page in an
optimal way.
A common tag—the paragraph tag, or <p> tag—illustrates the concept. By default, browsers come with style sheets that
define the font and font size for paragraph text (that is, text that falls between <p> tags in the HTML code). In Internet
Explorer, for example, all body text, including paragraph text, displays in Times New Roman, Medium font by default.
As the author of a web page, however, you can create a style sheet that overrides the browser’s default style for paragraph
font and font size. For example, you can create the following rule in your style sheet:
p {
font-family: Arial;
font-size: small;
}
When a user loads the page, the paragraph font and font size settings set by you as the author override the default
paragraph text settings of the browser.
Users can make selections to customize the browser display in an optimal way for their own use. In Internet Explorer,
for example, the user can select View > Text Size > Largest to expand the page font to a more readable size if they think
the font is too small. Ultimately (at least in this case), the user’s selection overrides both the default browser styles for
paragraph font size and the paragraph styles created by the author of the web page.
Inheritance is another important part of the cascade. Properties for most elements on a web page are inherited—for
example, paragraph tags inherit certain properties from body tags, span tags inherit certain properties from paragraph
tags, and so on. Thus, if you create the following rule in your style sheet:
body {
font-family: Arial;
font-style: italic;
}
All paragraph text on your web page (as well as text that inherits properties from the paragraph tag) will be Arial and
italic because the paragraph tag inherits these properties from the body tag. You can, however, become more specific
with your rules, and create styles that override the standard formula for inheritence. For example, if you create the
following rules in your style sheet:
body {
font-family: Arial;
font-style: italic;
}
p {
font-family: Courier;
font-style: normal;
}
189
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
All body text will be Arial and italic except paragraph (and its inherited) text, which will display as Courier normal
(non-italic). Technically, the paragraph tag first inherits the properties that are set for the body tag, but then ignores
those properties because it has properties of its own defined. In other words, while page elements generally inherit
properties from above, the direct application of a property to a tag always causes an override of the standard formula
for inheritance.
The combination of all of the factors discussed above, plus other factors like CSS specificity (a system that gives
different weight to particular kinds of CSS rules), and the order of CSS rules, ultimately create a complex cascade where
items with higher priorities override properties that have lower priorities. For more information on the rules governing
the cascade, inheritance, and specificity, visit www.w3.org/TR/CSS2/cascade.html.
About text formatting and CSS
By default, Dreamweaver uses Cascading Style Sheets (CSS) to format text. The styles that you apply to text using the
Property inspector or menu commands create CSS rules that are embedded in the head of the current document.
You can also use the CSS Styles panel to create and edit CSS rules and properties. The CSS Styles panel is a much more
robust editor than the Property inspector, and displays all CSS rules defined for the current document, whether those
rules are embedded in the head of the document or in an external style sheet. Adobe recommends that you use the CSS
Styles panel (rather than the Property inspector) as the primary tool for creating and editing your CSS. As a result, your
code will be cleaner and easier to maintain.
In addition to styles and style sheets you create, you can use style sheets that come with Dreamweaver to apply styles to
your documents.
For a tutorial about formatting text with CSS, see www.adobe.com/go/vid0153.
About Shorthand CSS properties
The CSS specification allows for the creation of styles using an abbreviated syntax known as shorthand CSS. Shorthand
CSS lets you specify the values of several properties using a single declaration. For example, the font property lets you
set font-style, font-variant, font-weight, font-size, line-height, and font-family properties on a single line.
A key issue to note when using shorthand CSS, is that values omitted from a shorthand CSS property are assigned their
default value. This may cause pages to be incorrectly displayed when two or more CSS rules are assigned to the same
tag.
For example, the h1 rule shown below uses longhand CSS syntax. Note that the font-variant, font-stretch, font-size-
adjust, and font-style properties have been assigned their default values.
h1 {
font-weight: bold;
font-size: 16pt;
line-height: 18pt;
font-family: Arial;
font-variant: normal;
font-style: normal;
font-stretch: normal;
font-size-adjust: none
}
Rewritten as a single, shorthand property, the same rule might appear as follows:
h1 { font: bold 16pt/18pt Arial }
190
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
When written using shorthand notation, omitted values are automatically assigned their default values. Thus, the
previous shorthand example omits the font-variant, font-style, font-stretch, and font-size-adjust tags.
If you have styles defined in more than one location (for example, both embedded in an HTML page and imported from
an external style sheet) using both the short and long forms of CSS syntax, be aware that omitted properties in a
shorthand rule may override (or cascade) properties that are explicitly set in another rule.
For this reason, Dreamweaver uses the long form of CSS notation by default. This prevents possible problems caused
by a shorthand rule overriding a longhand rule. If you open a web page that was coded with shorthand CSS notation
in Dreamweaver, be aware that Dreamweaver will create any new CSS rules using the longhand form. You can specify
how Dreamweaver creates and edits CSS rules by changing the CSS editing preferences in the CSS Styles category of the
Preferences dialog box (Edit > Preferences in Windows; Dreamweaver > Preferences on the Macintosh).
Note: The CSS Styles panel creates rules using only longhand notation. If you create a page or CSS style sheet using the CSS
Styles panel, be aware that hand coding shorthand CSS rules may result in the shorthand properties overriding those
created in longhand form. For this reason, use longhand CSS notation to create your styles.
More Help topics
Working with div tags
Laying out pages with CSS
Understanding CSS tutorial
Apply, remove, or rename class styles
Working with text
CSS Styles panel
Create a new CSS rule
Formatting text with CSS tutorial
CSS Designer panel
CSS Designer panel (Windows > CSS Designer) is a CSS Property Inspector that lets you 'visually' create CSS styles,
files, and set properties, along with media queries.
Watch v ide o
Use the visual CSS editor in Dreamweaver (8 min)
191
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: You can use Ctrl/Cmd+ Z to undo or Ctrl/Cmd + Y to redo all actions you perform in CSS Designer. The changes
are automatically reflected in Live View and the relevant CSS file is also refreshed. To let you know that the related file has
changed, the affected files tab is highlighted for a while (around 8 seconds).
The CSS Designer panel consists of the following panes and options:
All Lists all the CSS, media queries, and selectors in the current document. This mode is not sensitive to the selection.
This means, when you select an element on the page, the associated selector, media query, or CSS are not highlighted
in CSS Designer.
Use this option to begin with creating your selectors or media queries.
Current Lists all the computed styles for any selected element in Design or Live view of the current document. When
you use this mode for a CSS file in Code view, all the properties for the selector in focus are displayed.
Use this option to edit the properties of selectors associated with selected elements in the document.
Sources Lists all the CSS style sheets associated with the document. Using this pane, you can create and attach a CSS
to the document, or define styles within the document.
@Media Lists all the media queries in the source selected in the Sources pane. If you do not select a specific CSS, this
pane displays all the media queries associated with the document.
Selectors Lists all the selectors in the source selected in the Sources pane. If you also select a media query, this pane
narrows down the list of selectors for that media query. If no CSS or media queries are selected, this pane displays all
the selectors in the document.
When you select Global in the @Media pane, all the selectors that are not included in a media query of the selected
source are displayed.
Properties Displays properties that you can set for the specified selector. For more information, see Set properties .
192
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
CSS Designer is context-sensitive. This means, for any given context or selected page element, you can view the
associated selectors and properties. Further, when you select a selector in CSS Designer, the associated source and
media queries are highlighted in the respective panes.
Note: When you select a page element, 'Computed' is selected in the Selectors pane. Click a selector to view the associated
source, media query, or properties.
To view all the selectors, you can choose All Sources in the Sources pane. To view selectors that do not belong to any
media query in the selected source, click Global in the @Media pane.
More Help topics
Laying out pages with CSS
CSS3 transition effects
More Help topics
Add style to web pages with the CSS Designer panel
More Help topics
Using the CSS Designer panel
Create and attach style sheets
1In the Sources pane of the CSS Designer panel, click , and then click one of the following options:
Create a New CSS File: To create and attach a new CSS file to the document
Attach Existing CSS File: To attach an existing CSS file to the document
Define in Page: To define a CSS within the document
Based on the option you choose, Create A New CSS File or Attach Existing CSS File dialog boxes appear.
2Click Browse to specify the name of the CSS file and, if you are creating a CSS, the location to save the new file.
3Do one of the following:
Click Link to link the Dreamweaver document with the CSS file
Click Import to import the CSS file into the document.
4(Optional) Click Conditional Usage and specify the media query that you want to associate with the CSS file.
Define media queries
1In the CSS Designer panel, click a CSS Source in the Sources pane.
2Click in the @Media pane to add a new media query.
The Define Media Query dialog box appears and lists all the media query conditions supported by Dreamweaver.
3Select the Conditions as per your requirements. For detailed information on the media queries, see this article.
Ensure that you specify valid values for all the conditions you select. Else, corresponding media queries do not get
created successfully.
Note: Only 'And' operation is supported currently for multiple conditions.
193
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
If you add media query conditions through code, only the supported conditions are populated in the Define Media
Query dialog box. The Code text box in the dialog box, however, displays the code completely (including unsupported
conditions).
If you click on a media query in the Design/Live view, the viewport switches to match the selected media query. To view
the full size viewport, click Global in the @Media pane.
Define CSS Selectors
1In the CSS Designer, select a CSS source in the Sources pane or a media query in the @Media pane.
2In the Selectors pane, click . Based on the element selected in the document, CSS Designer smartly identifies and
prompts you with the relevant selector (upto three rules).
You can do one or more of the following:
Use the up or down arrow keys to make the suggested selector more specific or less specific.
Delete the suggested rule and type the required selector. Ensure that you type the name of the selector along with
the denotion for the Selector Type. For example, if you are specifying an ID, prefix the name of the selector with
a '#'.
To search for a specific selector, use the search box at the top of the pane.
To rename a selector, click the selector, and type the required name.
To reorganize the selectors, drag the selectors to the required position.
To move a selector from one source to another, drag the selector to the required source in the Source pane.
To duplicate a selector in the selected source, right-click the selector, and click Duplicate.
To duplicate a selector and add it into a media query, right-click the selector, hover the mouse over Duplicate Into
Media Query, and then choose the media query.
Note: The Duplicate Into Media Query option is available only when the source of the selected Selector contains
media queries. You cannot duplicate a Selector from one source into a media query of another source.
Copy-paste styles
You can now copy styles from one selector and paste into another. You can copy all styles or copy only specific category
of styles such as Layout, Text, and Border.
Right-click a selector and choose from the available options:
194
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
If a selector has no styles, Copy and Copy All Styles are disabled.
Paste Styles is disabled for remote sites that cannot be edited. But Copy and Copy All styles is available.
Pasting Styles that already exist partially on a selector (Overlapping) works. Union of all the selectors is pasted.
Copy-paste Styles also works for different linkages of CSS files – Import, Link, Inline Styles.
Set CSS properties
The properties are grouped into the following categories and are represented by different icons at the top of the
Properties pane:
Layout
Text
Border
Background
Others (list of 'text only' properties and not properties with visual controls)
Note: Before editing the properties of a CSS Selector, identify the elements associated with the CSS Selector using Reverse
Inspect. By doing so, you can evaluate if all the elements highlighted during Reverse Inspect actually require the changes.
See link for more information on Reverse Inspect.
Select the Show Set check box to view only the set properties. To view all the properties that you can specify for a
selector, deselect the Show Set check box.
To set a property, such as, width or border-collapse, click the required options displayed adjacent to the property in the
Properties pane. For information on setting gradient background or box controls such as margins, padding, and
position, see the following links:
Overridden properties are indicated using a strikethrough format.
More Help topics
Set margins, padding, and position
Apply gradients to background
Use Flexible Box layouts
195
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
Set margins, padding, and position
Using the box controls in CSS Designer's Properties pane, you can quickly set the margins, padding, and position
properties. If you prefer code, you can specify shorthand code for margin and padding in the quick edit boxes.
Click the values and type the required value. If you want all the four values to be the same and changed simultaneously,
click the link icon ( )at the center.
At any point in time, you can disable ( ) or delete ( ) specific values, for example, left margin value while retaining
the right, top, and bottom values.
Set border properties
Border Control properties are organized into logical tabs to help you quickly view or modify the properties.
196
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
If you prefer code, you can specify shorthand code for borders and border radius in the quick edit text box.
To specify the Border Control properties, first set the properties in the 'All Sides' tab. The other tabs are then enabled
and the properties set in the 'All Sides' tab are reflected for individual borders.
When you change a property in the individual border tabs, the value of the corresponding property in the 'All Sides'
tab changes to 'undefined' (default value).
In the example below, the border color was set to black and then changed to red for the Top border.
197
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
Border color set to black for all sides
The code that is inserted is based on the preference setting for shorthand or longhand.
Delete and disable controls are available for individual properties as before Dreamweaver CC 2014. Now, you can use
the delete and disable controls at the Border Control group level to apply these actions to all the properties.
198
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
During Inspect, the tabs are focused based on the priority of the "set" tabs. The highest priority is for "All sides" tab
followed by "Top", "Right", "Bottom" and "Left". For example, if only the top value for a border is set, the computed mode
takes the focus to the "Top" tab ignoring the "All sides" tab because "All sides" tab is not set.
Disable or delete properties
The CSS Designer panel lets you disable or delete each property. The following screenshot shows the disable ( ) and
delete ( ) icons for the width property. These icons are visible when you hover your mouse on the property.
Keyboard shortcuts
You can add or delete CSS selectors and properties using keyboard shortcuts. You can also navigate between the
property groups in the Properties pane.
Identify page elements associated with a CSS Selector (13.1)
Most often, a single CSS Selector is associated with multiple page elements. For example, text in the main content of a
page, header, and footer text can all be associated with the same CSS Selector. When you edit the properties of the CSS
Selector, all the elements associated with the Selector are affected, including the ones that you do not intend to change.
Live Highlight helps you identify all the elements associated with a CSS Selector. If you want to change only one elment
or some of the elements, you can create a new CSS Selector for those elements, and then edit the properties.
Shortcut Workflow
CTRL + Alt +[Shift =] Adds Selector (If control is in the selector section)
CTRL + Alt+ S Add Selector (If control is anywhere in the application)
CTRL + Alt +[Shift =] Adds Property (If control is in the property section)
CTRL + Alt+ P Adds Property (If control is anywhere in the application)
Select + Delete Deletes selector, if selector is selected
CTRL + Alt + (PgUp/PgDn) Jump between sections while in the properties subpanel
199
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
To identify the page elements associated with a CSS Selector, hover your mouse over the Selector in Live View (with
Live Code 'off '). Dreamweaver highlights the associated elements with dotted lines.
To lock-in the highlight for the elements, click the Selector. The elements now are highlighted with a blue border.
To remove the blue highlight around the elements, the Selector again.
Note: The following table summarizes the scenarios where Live Highlight is not available.
Mode Live Code Live Highlight displayed?
Code NA NA
Design NA NA
Live ON (button is pressed) No
OFF Yes
200
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
Disable Live Highlight
Live Highlight is enabled by default. To disable Live Highlight, click Live View options in Document Toolbar and click
Disable Live Highlight.
Set CSS Styles preferences
Note: In Dreamweaver CC and later, CSS Styles panel is replaced with CSS Designer. For more information, see CSS
Designer.
CSS style preferences control how Dreamweaver writes the code that defines CSS styles. CSS styles can be written in a
shorthand form that some people find easier to work with. Some older versions of browsers, however, do not correctly
interpret the shorthand.
1Select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh) and from the Category list select
CSS Styles.
2Set the CSS style options you want to apply:
When Creating CSS Rules Use Shorthand For Lets you select which CSS style properties Dreamweaver writes in
shorthand.
When Editing CSS Rules Use Shorthand Controls whether Dreamweaver rewrites existing styles in shorthand.
Select If Original Used Shorthand to leave all styles as they are.
Select According to Settings Above to rewrite styles in shorthand for the properties selected in Use Shorthand For.
When Double-Clicking In CSS Panel Lets you select a tool for editing CSS rules.
3Click OK.
Create a CSS rule
In Dreamweaver CC and later, CSS Styles panel is replaced with CSS Designer. For more information, see CSS
Designer.CSS Designer panel
You can create a CSS rule to automate the formatting of HTML tags or a range of text identified by class or ID attributes.
1Place the insertion point in the document, and then do one of the following to open the New CSS Rule dialog box:
Select Format > CSS Styles > New.
In the CSS Styles panel (Window > CSS Styles), click the New CSS Rule (+) button located in the lower-right side
of the panel.
Select text in the Document window, select New CSS Rule from the Targeted Rule pop-up menu in the CSS
Property inspector (Window > Properties); then click the Edit Rule button or select an option from the Property
inspector (for example, click the Bold button), to initiate a new rule.
2In the New CSS Rule dialog box, specify the selector type for the CSS rule you want to create:
To create a custom style that can be applied as a class attribute to any HTML element, select the Class option from
the Selector Type pop-up menu and then enter a name for the style in the Selector Name text box.
201
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: Class names must begin with a period and can contain any combination of letters and numbers (for example,
.myhead1). If you don’t enter a beginning period, Dreamweaver automatically enters it for you.
To define the formatting for a tag that contains a specific ID attribute, select the ID option from the Selector Type
pop-up menu and then enter the unique ID (for example, containerDIV) in the Selector Name text box.
Note: IDs must begin with a pound (#) sign and can contain any combination of letters and numbers (for example,
#myID1). If you don’t enter a beginning pound sign, Dreamweaver automatically enters it for you.
To redefine the default formatting of a specific HTML tag, select the Tag option from the Selector Type pop-up
menu; then enter an HTML tag in the Selector Name text box or select one from the pop-up menu.
To define a compound rule that affects two or more tags, classes, or IDs simultaneously, select the Compound
option and enter the selectors for your compound rule. For example if you enter div p, all p elements within div
tags will be affected by the rule. A description text area explains exactly which elements the rule will affect as you
add or delete selectors.
3Select the location in which you want to define the rule, and then click OK:
To place the rule in a style sheet that is already attached to the document, select the style sheet.
To create an external style sheet, select New Style Sheet File.
To embed the style in the current document, select This Document Only.
4In the CSS Rule Definition dialog box, select the style options you want to set for the new CSS rule. For more
information, see the next section.
5When you are finished setting style properties, click OK.
Note: Clicking OK without setting style options results in a new, empty rule.
Set CSS properties
In Dreamweaver CC and later, CSS Styles panel is replaced with CSS Designer. For more information, see CSS Designer.
You can define properties for CSS rules such as text font, background image and color, spacing and layout properties,
and the appearance of list elements. First create a new rule, then set any of the following properties.
Define CSS type properties
You use the Type category in the CSS Rule Definition dialog box to define basic font and type settings for a CSS style.
1Open the CSS Styles panel (Shift + F11) if it isn’t already open.
2Double-click an existing rule or property in the top pane of the CSS Styles panel.
3In the CSS Rule Definition dialog box, select Type, and then set the style properties.
Leave any of the following properties empty if they are not important to the style:
Font-family Sets the font family (or series of families) for the style. Browsers display text in the first font in the series
that is installed on the user’s system. For compatibility with Internet Explorer, list a Windows font first. The font
attribute is supported by both browsers.
Font-size Defines the size of the text. You can choose a specific size by selecting the number and the unit of
measurement, or you can choose a relative size. Pixels work well to prevent browsers from distorting your text. The
size attribute is supported by both browsers.
202
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
Font-style Specifies Normal, Italic, or Oblique as the font style. The default setting is Normal. The style attribute is
supported by both browsers.
Line-height Sets the height of the line on which the text is placed. This setting is traditionally called leading. Select
Normal to have the line height for the font size calculated automatically, or enter an exact value and select a unit of
measurement.The line height attribute is supported by both browsers.
Text-decoration Adds an underline, overline, or line-through to the text, or makes the text blink. The default setting
for regular text is None. The default setting for links is Underline. When you set the link setting to none, you can
remove the underline from links by defining a special class.The decoration attribute is supported by both browsers.
Font-weight Applies a specific or relative amount of boldface to the font. Normal is equivalent to 400; Bold is
equivalent to 700. The weight attribute is supported by both browsers.
Font-variant Sets the small caps variant on text. Dreamweaver does not display this attribute in the Document
window. The variant attribute is supported by Internet Explorer but not Navigator.
Text-transform Capitalizes the first letter of each word in the selection or sets the text to all uppercase or lowercase.
The case attribute is supported by both browsers.
Color Sets the text color. The color attribute is supported by both browsers.
4When you are finished setting these options, select another CSS category on the left side of the panel to set additional
style properties, or click OK.
Define CSS style background properties
Use the Background category of the CSS Rule Definition dialog box to define background settings for a CSS style. You
can apply background properties to any element in a web page. For example, create a style which adds a background
color or background image to any page element, for example behind text, a table, the page, and so on. You can also set
the positioning of a background image.
1Open the CSS Styles panel (Shift+F11) if it isn’t already open.
2Double-click an existing rule or property in the top pane of the CSS Styles panel.
3In the CSS Rule Definition dialog box, select Background, then set the style properties.
Leave any of the following properties empty if they are not important to the style:
Background Color Sets the background color for the element. The background color attribute is supported by both
browsers.
Background Image Sets the background image for the element.The background image attribute is supported by
both browsers.
Background Repeat Determines whether and how the background image is repeated. The Repeat attribute is
supported by both browsers.
No Repeat displays the image once at the beginning of the element.
Repeat tiles the image horizontally and vertically behind the element.
Repeat-x and Repeat-y display a horizontal and vertical band of images, respectively. Images are clipped to fit
within the boundaries of the element.
Note: Use the Repeat property to redefine the body tag and set a background image that does not tile or repeat.
Background Attachment Determines whether the background image is fixed at its original position or scrolls along
with the content. Note that some browsers may treat the Fixed option as Scroll. This is supported by Internet
Explorer but not Netscape Navigator.
203
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
Background Position (X) and Background Position (Y) Specify the initial position of the background image in
relation to the element. This can be used to align a background image to the center of the page, both vertically (Y)
and horizontally (X). If the attachment property is Fixed, the position is relative to the Document window, not to
the element.
4When you are finished setting these options, select another CSS category on the left side of the panel to set additional
style properties, or click OK.
Define CSS style block properties
You use the Block category of the CSS Rule Definition dialog box to define spacing and alignment settings for tags and
properties.
1Open the CSS Styles panel (Shift+F11) if it isn’t already open.
2Double-click an existing rule or property in the top pane of the CSS Styles panel.
3In the CSS Rule Definition dialog box, select Block, then set any of the following style properties. (Leave the property
blank if it is not important to the style.)
Word Spacing Sets the spacing between words. To set a specific value, in the pop-up menu, select Value, then enter
a numeric value. In the second pop-up menu, select a measurement unit (for example, pixel, points, and so on).
Note: You can specify negative values, but the display depends on the browser. Dreamweaver does not display this
attribute in the Document window.
Letter Spacing Increases or decreases space between letters or characters. To decrease the space between characters
specify a negative value, for example (-4). Letter spacing settings override justified text settings. The Letter Spacing
attribute is supported by Internet Explorer 4 and later and Netscape Navigator 6.
Vertical Align Specifies the vertical alignment of the element to which it is applied. Dreamweaver displays this
attribute in the Document window only when it is applied to the <img> tag.
Text Align Sets how text is aligned within the element. The Text Align attribute is supported by both browsers.
Text Indent Specifies how far the first line of text indents. A negative value may be used to create an outdent, but
the display depends on the browser. Dreamweaver displays this attribute in the Document window only when the
tag is applied to block-level elements. The Text Indent attribute is supported by both browsers.
Whitespace Determines how white space within the element is handled. Select from three options: Normal
collapses white space; Pre handles it as if the text were enclosed in pre tags (that is, all white space, including spaces,
tabs, and returns, is respected); Nowrap specifies that the text only wraps when a br tag is encountered.
Dreamweaver does not display this attribute in the Document window. The Whitespace attribute is supported by
Netscape Navigator and Internet Explorer 5.5.
Display Specifies whether an element is displayed and if so how it is displayed. None disables the display of an
element to which it is assigned.
4When you are finished setting these options, select another CSS category on the left side of the panel to set additional
style properties, or click OK.
Define CSS style box properties
Use the Box category of the CSS Rule Definition dialog box to define settings for tags and properties that control the
placement of elements on the page.
204
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
You can apply settings to individual sides of an element when applying padding and margin settings, or use the Same
For All setting to apply the same setting to all sides of an element.
1Open the CSS Styles panel (Shift + F11) if it isn’t already open.
2Double-click an existing rule or property in the top pane of the CSS Styles panel.
3In the CSS Rule Definition dialog box, select Box, and set any of the following style properties. (Leave the property
blank if it is not important to the style.)
Width and Height Sets the width and height of the element.
Float Specifies the side around which other elements flow around the floated element. The floated element is fixed
to the float side and other contents flow around it on the opposite side.
For example, an image that is floated right is fixed to the right, and content that you add later flows to the left of the
image.
For more information, see http://css-tricks.com/all-about-floats/
Clear Specifies the sides of an element that do not allow other floating elements.
Padding Specifies the amount of space between the content of an element and its border (or margin if there is no
border). Deselect the Same For All option to set the padding for individual sides of the element.
Same For All Sets the same padding properties to the Top, Right, Bottom, and Left of the element to which it is
applied.
Margin Specifies the amount of space between the border of an element (or the padding if there is no border) and
another element. Dreamweaver displays this attribute in the Document window only when it is applied to block-
level elements (paragraphs, headings, lists, and so on). Deselect Same For All to set the margin for individual sides
of the element.
Same For All Sets the same margin properties to the Top, Right, Bottom, and Left of the element to which it is
applied.
4When you are finished setting these options, select another CSS category on the left side of the panel to set additional
style properties, or click OK.
Define CSS style border properties
Use the Border category of the CSS Rule Definition dialog box to define settings, such as width, color, and style, for the
borders around elements.
1Open the CSS Styles panel (Shift+F11) if it isn’t already open.
2Double-click an existing rule or property in the top pane of the CSS Styles panel.
3In the CSS Rule Definition dialog box, select Border, and set any of the following style properties. (Leave the
property blank if it is not important to the style.)
Type Sets the style appearance of the border. The way the style appears depends on the browser. Deselect Same For
All to set the border style for individual sides of the element.
Same For All Sets the same border style properties to the Top, Right, Bottom, and Left of the element to which it is
applied.
Width Sets the thickness of the element’s border. The Width attribute is supported by both browsers. Deselect Same
For All to set the border width for individual sides of the element.
Same For All Sets the same border width to the Top, Right, Bottom, and Left of the element to which it is applied.
205
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
Color Sets the color of the border. You can set each sides color independently, but the display depends on the
browser. Deselect Same For All to set the border color for individual sides of the element.
Same For All Sets the same border color to the Top, Right, Bottom, and Left of the element to which it is applied.
4When you are finished setting these options, select another CSS category on the left side of the panel to set additional
style properties, or click OK.
Define CSS style list properties
The List category of the CSS Rule Definition dialog box defines list settings, such as bullet size and type, for list tags.
1Open the CSS Styles panel (Shift+F11) if it isn’t already open.
2Double-click an existing rule or property in the top pane of the CSS Styles panel.
3In the CSS Rule Definition dialog box, select List, and set any of the following style properties. (Leave the property
blank if it is not important to the style.)
List style type Sets the appearance of bullets or numbers. Type is supported by both browsers.
List style image Lets you specify a custom image for bullets. Click Browse (Windows) or Choose (Macintosh) to
browse to an image, or type the images path.
List style position Sets whether list item text wraps and indents (outside) or whether the text wraps to the left
margin (inside).
4When you are finished setting these options, select another CSS category on the left side of the panel to set additional
style properties, or click OK.
Define CSS style positioning properties
The Positioning style properties determine how the content related to the selected CSS style is positioned on the page.
1Open the CSS Styles panel (Shift+F11) if it isn’t already open.
2Double-click an existing rule or property in the top pane of the CSS Styles panel.
3In the CSS Rule Definition dialog box, select Positioning, and then set the style properties you want.
Leave any of the following properties empty if they are not important to the style:
Position Determines how the browser should position the selected element as follows:
Absolute places the content using the coordinates entered in the Placement boxes relative to the nearest
absolutely- or relatively-positioned ancestor, or, if no absolutely- or relatively-positioned ancestor exists, to the
upper-left corner of the page.
Relative places the content block using the coordinates entered in the Placement boxes relative to blocks position
in the text flow of the document. For example, giving an element a relative position and top and left coordinates
of 20px each will shift the element 20px to the right and 20px down from its normal position in the flow.
Elements can also be positioned relatively, with or without top, left, right, or bottom coordinates, to establish a
context for absolutely-positioned children.
Fixed places the content using the coordinates entered in the Placement boxes, relative to the top left corner of
the browser. The content will remain fixed in this position as the user scrolls the page.
Static places the content at its location in the text flow. This is the default position of all positionable HTML
elements.
206
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
Visibility Determines the initial display condition of the content. If you do not specify a visibility property, by
default the content inherits the parent tags value. The default visibility of the body tag is visible. Select one of the
following visibility options:
Inherit inherits the visibility property of the content’s parent.
Visible displays the content, regardless of the parent’s value.
Hidden hides the content, regardless of the parents value.
Z-Index Determines the stacking order of the content. Elements with a higher z-index appear above elements with
a lower z-index (or none at all). Values can be positive or negative. (If your content is absolutely positioned, its easier
to change the stacking order using the AP Elements panel).
Overflow Determines what happens if the contents of a container (for example, a DIV or a P) exceed its size. These
properties control the expansion as follows:
Visible increases the container’s size so that all of its contents are visible. The container expands down and to the
right.
Hidden maintains the container’s size and clips any content that doesn’t fit. No scroll bars are provided.
Scroll adds scroll bars to the container regardless of whether the contents exceed the container’s size. Specifically
providing scroll bars avoids confusion caused by the appearance and disappearance of scroll bars in a dynamic
environment. This option is not displayed in the Document window.
Auto makes scroll bars appear only when the container’s contents exceed its boundaries. This option is not
displayed in the Document window.
Placement Specifies the location and size of the content block. How the browser interprets the location depends on
the setting for Type. Size values are overridden if the content of the content block exceeds the specified size.
The default units for location and size are pixels. You can also specify the following units: pc (picas), pt (points), in
(inches), mm (millimeters), cm (centimeters), (ems), (exs), or % (percentage of the parent’s value). The
abbreviations must follow the value without a space: for example, 3mm.
Clip Defines the part of the content that is visible. If you specify a clipping region, you can access it with a scripting
language such as JavaScript and manipulate the properties to create special effects such as wipes. These wipes can
be set up by using the Change Property behavior.
4When you are finished setting these options, select another CSS category on the left side of the panel to set additional
style properties, or click OK.
Define CSS style extension properties
Extensions style properties include filters, page break, and pointer options.
Note: There are a number of other extension properties available in Dreamweaver, but to access them, you need to go
through the CSS Styles panel. You can easily see a list of extension properties available by opening the CSS Styles panel
(Windows > CSS Styles), clicking the Show Category View button at the bottom of the panel, and expanding the Extensions
category.
1Open the CSS Styles panel (Shift + F11) if it isn’t already open.
2Double-click an existing rule or property in the top pane of the CSS Styles panel.
207
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
3In the CSS Rule Definition dialog box, select Extensions, and set any of the following style properties. (Leave the
property blank if it is not important to the style.)
Page break before Forces a page break during printing either before or after the object controlled by the style. Select
the option you want to set in the pop-up menu. This option is not supported by any 4.0 browser, but support may
be provided by future browsers.
Cursor Changes the pointer image when the pointer is over the object controlled by the style. Select the option you
want to set in the pop-up menu. Internet Explorer 4.0 and later, and Netscape Navigator 6 support this attribute.
Filter Applies special effects to the object controlled by the style, including blur and inversion. Select an effect from
the pop-up menu.
4When you are finished setting these options, select another CSS category on the left side of the panel to set additional
style properties, or click OK.
Edit a CSS rule
Note: In Dreamweaver CC and later, CSS Styles panel is replaced with CSS Designer. For more information, see CSS
Designer.
You can easily edit both internal and external rules that you have applied to a document.
When you edit a CSS style sheet that controls the text in your document, you instantly reformat all of the text controlled
by that CSS style sheet. Edits to an external style sheet affect all the documents linked to it.
You can set an external editor to use for editing style sheets.
Edit a rule in the CSS Styles panel (Current mode)
1Open the CSS Styles panel by selecting Window > CSS Styles.
2Click the Current button at the top of the CSS Styles panel.
3Select a text element in the current page to display its properties.
4Do one of the following:
Double-click a property in the Summary for Selection pane to display the CSS Rule Definition dialog box, and
then make your changes.
Select a property in the Summary for Selection pane, and then edit the property in the Properties pane below.
Select a rule in the Rules pane, and then edit the rules properties in the Properties pane below.
Note: You can change the double-clicking behavior for editing CSS, as well as other behaviors, by changing
Dreamweaver preferences.
Edit a rule in the CSS Styles panel (All mode)
1Open the CSS Styles panel by selecting Window > CSS Styles.
2Click the All button at the top of the CSS Styles panel.
3Do one of the following:
Double-click a rule in the All Rules pane to display the CSS Rule Definition dialog box, and then make your
changes.
208
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
Select a rule in the All Rules pane, and then edit the rules properties in the Properties pane below.
Select a rule in the All Rules pane, and then click the Edit Style button in the lower-right corner of the CSS Styles
panel.
Note: You can change the double-clicking behavior for editing CSS, as well as other behaviors, by changing
Dreamweaver preferences.
Change the name of a CSS selector
1In the CSS Styles panel (All mode) select the selector you want to change.
2Click the selector again to make the name editable.
3Make your changes and press Enter (Windows) or Return (Macintosh).
More Help topics
Set text properties in the Property inspector
Add a property to a CSS rule
Note: In Dreamweaver CC and later, CSS Styles panel is replaced with CSS Designer. For more information, see CSS
Designer.
You can use the CSS Styles panel to add properties to rules.
1In the CSS Styles panel (Window > CSS), select a rule in the All Rules pane (All mode), or select a property in the
Summary for Selection pane (Current mode).
2Do one of the following:
If Show Only Set Properties view is selected in the Properties pane, click the Add Properties link and add a
property.
If Category view or List view is selected in the Properties pane, fill in a value for the property you want to add.
Apply, remove, or rename CSS class styles
Note: In Dreamweaver CC and later, CSS Styles panel is replaced with CSS Designer. For more information, see CSS
Designer.
Class styles are the only type of CSS style that can be applied to any text in a document, regardless of which tags control
the text. All class styles associated with the current document are displayed in the CSS Styles panel (with a period [.]
preceding their name) and in the Style pop-up menu of the text Property inspector.
Youll see most styles updated immediately, however, you should preview your page in a browser to verify a style was
applied as expected. When you apply two or more styles to the same text, the styles may conflict and produce
unexpected results.
When previewing styles defined in an external CSS style sheet, be sure to save the style sheet to ensure that your changes
are reflected when you preview the page in a browser.
209
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
Apply a CSS class style
1In the document, select the text to which you want to apply a CSS style.
Place the insertion point in a paragraph to apply the style to the entire paragraph.
If you select a range of text within a single paragraph, the CSS style affects only the selected range.
To specify the exact tag to which the CSS style should be applied, select the tag in the tag selector located at the lower
left of the Document window.
2To apply a class style, do one of the following:
In the CSS Styles panel (Window > CSS Styles), select All mode, right-click the name of the style you want to
apply, and select Apply from the context menu.
In the HTML Property inspector, select the class style you want to apply from the Class pop-up menu.
In the Document window, right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the selected text, and in the
context menu, select CSS Styles and then select the style you want to apply.
Select Format > CSS Styles, and in the submenu select the style you want to apply.
Remove a class style from a selection
1Select the object or text you want to remove the style from.
2In the HTML Property inspector (Window > Properties), select None from the Class pop-up menu.
Rename a class style
1In the CSS styles panel, right-click the CSS class style you want to rename and select Rename Class.
You can also rename a class by selecting Rename Class from the CSS Styles panel options menu.
2In the Rename Class dialog box, make sure that the class you want to rename is selected in the Rename Class pop-up
menu.
3In the New Name text box, enter the new name for the new class and click OK.
If the class youre renaming is internal to the head of the current document, Dreamweaver changes the class name
as well as all instances of the class name in the current document. If the class you’re renaming is in an external CSS
file, Dreamweaver opens and changes the class name in the file. Dreamweaver also launches a site-wide Find and
Replace dialog box so that you can search for all instances of the old class name in your site.
Move/export CSS rules
Note: In Dreamweaver CC and later, CSS Styles panel is replaced with CSS Designer. For more information, see CSS
Designer.
The CSS management features in Dreamweaver make it easy for you to move or export CSS rules to different locations.
You can move rules from document to document, from the head of a document to an external style sheet, between
external CSS files, and more.
Note: If the rule youre trying to move conflicts with a rule in the destination style sheet, Dreamweaver displays the Rule
With Same Name Exists dialog box. If you elect to move the conflicting rule, Dreamweaver places the moved rule
immediately adjacent to the conflicting rule in the destination style sheet.
210
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
Move/export CSS rules to a new style sheet
1Do one of the following:
In the CSS Styles panel, select the rule or rules you want to move. Then right-click the selection and select Move
CSS Rules from the context menu. To select multiple rules, Control-click (Windows) or Command-click
(Macintosh) the rules you want to select.
In Code view, select the rule or rules you want to move. Then right-click the selection and select CSS Styles >
Move CSS Rules from the context menu.
Note: Partial selection of a rule will result in the relocation of the entire rule.
2In the Move To External Style Sheet dialog box, select the new style sheet option and click OK.
3In the Save Style Sheet File As dialog box, enter a name for the new style sheet and click Save.
When you click Save, Dreamweaver saves a new style sheet with the rules you selected and attaches it to the current
document.
You can also move rules by using the Coding toolbar. The Coding toolbar is available in Code view only.
Move/export CSS rules to an existing style sheet
1Do one of the following:
In the CSS Styles panel, select the rule or rules you want to move. Then right-click the selection and select Move
CSS Rules from the context menu. To select multiple rules, Control-click (Windows) or Command-click
(Macintosh) the rules you want to select.
In Code view, select the rule or rules you want to move. Then right-click the selection and select CSS Styles >
Move CSS Rules from the context menu.
Note: Partial selection of a rule will result in the relocation of the entire rule.
2In the Move To External Style Sheet dialog box, select an existing style sheet from the pop-up menu or browse to an
existing style sheet and click OK.
Note: The pop-up menu displays all style sheets that are linked to the current document.
You can also move rules by using the Coding toolbar. The Coding toolbar is available in Code view only.
Rearrange or move CSS rules by dragging
In the CSS Styles panel (All mode), select a rule and drag it rule to the desired location. You can select and drag to
re-order rules within a style sheet, or move a rule to another style sheet or the document head.
You can move more than one rule at a time by Control-clicking (Windows) or Command-clicking (Macintosh)
multiple rules to select them.
Select multiple rules before moving them
In the CSS Styles panel, Control-click (Windows) or Command-click (Macintosh) the rules you want to select.
More Help topics
Insert code using the Coding toolbar
211
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
Convert inline CSS to a CSS rule
Note: In Dreamweaver CC and later, CSS Styles panel is replaced with CSS Designer. For more information, see CSS
Designer.
In-line styles are not recommended best practices. To make your CSS cleaner and more organized, you can convert
inline styles to CSS rules that reside in the head of the document or in an external style sheet.
1In Code view (View > Code), select the entire style attribute that contains the inline CSS you want to convert
2Right-click and select CSS Styles > Convert Inline CSS to Rule.
3In the Convert Inline CSS dialog box, enter a class name for the new rule, and then do one of the following:
Specify a style sheet where you want the new CSS rule to appear and click OK.
Select the head of the document as the location where you want the new CSS rule to appear and click OK.
You can also convert rules by using the Coding toolbar. The Coding toolbar is available in Code view only.
More Help topics
Insert code using the Coding toolbar
Link to an external CSS style sheet
Note: In Dreamweaver CC and later, CSS Styles panel is replaced with CSS Designer. For more information, see CSS
Designer.
When you edit an external CSS style sheet, all documents linked to that CSS style sheet are updated to reflect those
edits. You can export the CSS styles found in a document to create a new CSS style sheet, and attach or link to an
external style sheet to apply the styles found there.
You can attach to your pages any style sheet that you create or copy into your site. In addition, Dreamweaver is shipped
with prebuilt style sheets that can be automatically moved into your site and attached to your pages.
1Open the CSS Styles panel by doing one of the following:
Select Window > CSS Styles.
Press Shift + F11.
2In the CSS Styles panel, click the Attach Style Sheet button. (It’s in the lower-right corner of the panel.)
3Do one of the following:
Click Browse to browse to an external CSS style sheet.
Type the path to the style sheet in the File/URL box.
4For Add As, select one of the options:
To create a link between the current document and an external style sheet, select Link. This creates a link href
tag in the HTML code, and references the URL where the published style sheet is located. This method is
supported by both Microsoft Internet Explorer and Netscape Navigator.
212
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
You cannot use a link tag to add a reference from one external style sheet to another. If you want to nest style
sheets, you must use an import directive. Most browsers also recognize the import directive within a page (rather
than just within style sheets). There are subtle differences in how conflicting properties are resolved when
overlapping rules exist within external style sheets that are linked versus imported to a page. If you want to
import, rather than link to, an external style sheet, select Import.
5In the Media pop-up menu, specify the target medium for the style sheet.
For more information on media-dependent style sheets, see the World Wide Web Consortium website at
www.w3.org/TR/CSS21/media.html.
6Click the Preview button to verify that the style sheet applies the styles you want to the current page.
If the styles applied are not what you expect them to be, click Cancel to remove the style sheet. The page will revert
to its previous appearance.
7Click OK.
More Help topics
Create a page based on a Dreamweaver sample file
Edit a CSS style sheet
Note: In Dreamweaver CC and later, CSS Styles panel is replaced with CSS Designer. For more information, see CSS
Designer.
A CSS style sheet typically includes one or more rules. You can edit an individual rule in a CSS style sheet using the CSS
Styles panel, or if you prefer, you can work directly in the CSS style sheet.
1In the CSS Styles panel (Window > CSS Styles), select All mode.
2In the All rules pane, double-click the name of the style sheet you want to edit.
3In the Document window, modify the style sheet as desired, and then save the style sheet.
Format CSS code
Note: In Dreamweaver CC and later, CSS Styles panel is replaced with CSS Designer. For more information, see CSS
Designer.
You can set preferences that control the format of your CSS code whenever you create or edit a CSS rule using the
Dreamweaver interface. For example, you can set preferences that will place all CSS properties on separate lines, place
a blank line between CSS rules, and so on.
When you set CSS code formatting preferences, the preferences you select are automatically applied to all new CSS rules
that you create. You can, however, also apply these preferences manually to individual documents. This might be useful
if you have an older HTML or CSS document that needs formatting.
Note: CSS code formatting preferences apply to CSS rules in external or embedded style sheets only (not to in-line styles)
Set CSS code formatting preferences
1Select Edit > Preferences.
213
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
2In the Preferences dialog box, select the Code Format category.
3Next to Advanced Formatting, click the CSS button.
4In the CSS Source Format Options dialog box, select the options that you want to apply to your CSS source code. A
preview of the CSS as it would look according to the options you’ve selected appears in the Preview window below.
Indent Properties With Sets the indentation value for properties within a rule. You can specify tabs or spaces.
Each Property On A Separate Line Places each property within a rule on a separate line.
Opening Brace On Separate Line Places the opening brace for a rule on a separate line from the selector.
Only If More Than One Property Places single-property rules on the same line as the selector.
All Selectors For A Rule On Same Line Places all selectors for the rule on the same line.
Blank Line Between Rules Inserts a blank line between each rule.
5Click OK.
Note: CSS code formatting also inherits the Line Break Type preference that you set in the Code Format category of the
Preferences dialog box.
Format CSS code in a CSS style sheet manually
1Open a CSS style sheet.
2Select Commands > Apply Source Formatting.
The formatting options you set in CSS code formatting preferences are applied to the entire document. You cannot
format individual selections.
Format embedded CSS code manually
1Open an HTML page that contains CSS embedded in the head of the document.
2Select any part of the CSS code.
3Select Commands > Apply Source Formatting To Selection.
The formatting options you set in CSS code formatting preferences are applied to all CSS rules in the head of the
document only.
Note: You can select Commands > Apply Source Formatting to format the entire document according to your specified
code formatting preferences.
More Help topics
Change the code format
Disable/Enable CSS
Note: In Dreamweaver CC and later, CSS Styles panel is replaced with CSS Designer. For more information, see CSS
Designer.
The Disable/Enable CSS Property feature lets you comment out portions of CSS from the CSS Styles panel, without
having to make changes directly in the code. When you comment out portions of the CSS, you can see what kinds of
effects particular properties and values have on your page.
214
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
When you disable a CSS property, Dreamweaver adds CSS comment tags and a [disabled] label to the CSS property
you’ve disabled. You can then easily re-enable or delete the disabled CSS property according to your preference.
For a video overview from the Dreamweaver engineering team about working with CSS Disable/Enable, see
www.adobe.com/go/dwcs5css_en.
1In the Properties pane of the CSS Styles panel (Window > CSS Styles), select the property you want to disable.
2Click the Disable/Enable CSS Property icon in the lower-right corner of the Properties pane. The icon also appears
if you hover to the left of the property itself.
Once you click the Disable/Enable CSS Property icon, a Disabled icon appears to the left of the property. To re-
enable the property, click the Disabled icon, or right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh OS) the property
and select Enable.
3(Optional) To enable or delete all of the disabled properties in a selected rule, right-click (Windows) or Control-click
(Macintosh OS) any rule or property in which properties are disabled, and selectEnable All Disabled in Selected
Rule, or Delete all Disabled in Selected rule.
Inspect CSS in Live view
Note: In Dreamweaver CC and later, CSS Styles panel is replaced with CSS Designer. For more information, see CSS
Designer.
Inspect mode works together with Live View to help you quickly identify HTML elements and their associated CSS
styles. With Inspect mode turned on, you can hover over elements on your page to see the CSS box model attributes for
any block-level element.
Note: For more information on the CSS box model, see the CSS 2.1 specification.
In addition to seeing a visual representation of the box model in Inspect mode, you can also use the CSS Styles panel
as you hover over elements in the Document window. When you have the CSS Styles panel open in Current mode and
hover over an element on the page, the rules and properties in the CSS Styles panel automatically update to show you
the rules and properties for that element. Additionally, any view or panel related to the element youre hovering over
updates as well (for example, Code view, the Tag selector, the Property inspector, and so on).
1With your document open in the Document window, click the Inspect button (next to the Live View button in the
Document toolbar).
Note: If youre not already in Live view, Inspect mode automatically enables it.
2Hover over elements on the page to see the CSS box model. Inspect mode highlights different colors for the border,
margin, padding, and content.
3(Optional) Press the left arrow on your computer keyboard to highlight the parent of the currently highlighted
element. Press the right arrow to return to highlighting for the child element.
4(Optional) Click an element to lock a highlight selection.
Note: Clicking an element to lock a highlight selection turns off Inspect mode.
More Help topics
Previewing pages in Dreamweaver
The CSS Styles panel
215
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
Check for cross-browser CSS rendering issues
Note: In Dreamweaver CC and later, CSS Styles panel is replaced with CSS Designer. For more information, see CSS
Designer.
The Browser Compatibility Check (BCC) feature helps you locate combinations of HTML and CSS that have problems
in certain browsers. When you run a BCC on an open file, Dreamweaver scans the file and reports any potential CSS
rendering issues in the Results panel. A confidence rating, indicated by a quarter, half, three-quarter, or completely
filled circle, indicates the likelihood of the bugs occurrence (a quarter-filled circle indicating a possible occurrence, and
a completely-filled circle indicating a very likely occurrence). For each potential bug that it finds, Dreamweaver also
provides a direct link to documentation about the bug on Adobe CSS Advisor, a website that details commonly known
browser rendering bugs, and offers solutions for fixing them.
By default, the BCC feature checks against the following browsers: Firefox 1.5; Internet Explorer (Windows) 6.0 and
7.0; Internet Explorer (Macintosh) 5.2; Netscape Navigator 8.0; Opera 8.0 and 9.0; Safari 2.0.
This feature replaces the former Target Browser Check feature, but retains the CSS functionality of that feature. That is,
the new BCC feature still tests the code in your documents to see if any of the CSS properties or values are unsupported
by your target browsers.
Three levels of potential browser-support problems can arise:
An error indicates CSS code that might cause a serious visible problem in a particular browser, such as causing parts
of a page to disappear. (Error is the default designation for browser support problems, so in some cases, code with
an unknown effect is also marked as an error.)
A warning indicates a piece of CSS code that isn’t supported in a particular browser, but that wont cause any serious
display problems.
An informational message indicates code that isn’t supported in a particular browser, but that has no visible effect.
Browser compatibility checks do not alter your document in any way.
Run a browser compatibility check
Select File > Check Page > Browser Compatibility.
Select the element affected by a found issue
Double-click the issue in the Results panel.
Jump to the next or previous found issue in the code
Select Next Issue or Previous Issue from the Browser Compatibility Check menu in the Document toolbar.
Select browsers for Dreamweaver to check against
1In the Results panel (Window > Results), select the Browser Compatibility Check tab.
2Click the green arrow in the upper-left corner of the Results panel and select Settings.
3Select the checkbox next to each browser you want to check against.
4For each selected browser, select a minimum version to check against from the corresponding pop-up menu.
216
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
For example, to see if CSS rendering bugs might appear in Internet Explorer 5.0 and later and Netscape Navigator
7.0 and later, select the checkboxes next to those browser names, and select 5.0 from the Internet Explorer pop-up
menu and 7.0 from the Netscape pop-up menu.
Exclude an issue from the browser compatibility check
1Run a browser compatibility check.
2In the Results panel, Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the issue that you want to exclude from
future checking.
3Select Ignore Issue from the context menu.
Edit the Ignored Issues list
1In the Results panel (Window > Results), select the Browser Compatibility Check tab.
2Click the green arrow in the upper-left corner of the Results panel and select Edit Ignored Issues List.
3In the Exceptions.xml file, find the issue that you want deleted from the Ignored Issues list and delete it.
4Save and close the Exceptions.xml file.
Save a browser compatibility check report
1Run a browser compatibility check.
2Click the Save Report button on the left side of the Results panel.
Hover over buttons in the Results panel to see button tool tips.
Note: Reports are not saved automatically; if you want to keep a copy of a report, you must follow the above procedure
to save it.
View a browser compatibility check report in a browser
1Run a browser compatibility check.
2Click the Browse Report button on the left side of the Results panel.
Hover over buttons in the Results panel to see button tool tips.
Open the Adobe CSS Advisor website
1In the Results panel (Window > Results), select the Browser Compatibility Check tab.
2Click the link text at the bottom right of the panel.
More Help topics
Validate XML documents
CSS Advisor
217
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
Use Design-Time style sheets
Note: In Dreamweaver CC and later, CSS Styles panel is replaced with CSS Designer. For more information, see CSS
Designer.
Design-Time style sheets allow you to show or hide design applied by a CSS style sheet as you work in a Dreamweaver
document. For example, you can use this option to include or exclude the effect of a Macintosh-only or a Windows-
only style sheet as you design a page.
Design-Time style sheets only apply while you are working in the document; when the page is displayed in a browser
window, only the styles that are actually attached to or embedded in the document appear in a browser.
Note: You can also enable or disable styles for an entire page using the Style Rendering toolbar. To display the toolbar, select
View > Toolbars > Style Rendering. The Toggle Displaying of CSS Styles button (the right-most button) works
independently of the other media buttons on the toolbar.
To use a Design-time style sheet, follow these steps.
1Open the Design-Time Style Sheets dialog box by doing one of the following:
Right-click in the CSS Styles panel, and in the context menu select Design-time.
Select Format > CSS Styles > Design-time.
2In the dialog box, set options to show or hide a selected style sheet:
To display a CSS style sheet at design-time, click the Plus (+) button above Show Only At Design Time, then in
the Select a Style Sheet dialog box, browse to the CSS style sheet you want to show.
To hide a CSS style sheet, click the Plus (+) button above Hide At Design-Time, then in the Select a Style Sheet
dialog box, browse to the CSS style sheet you want to show.
To remove a style sheet from either list, click the style sheet you want to remove, then click the appropriate Minus
(–) button.
3Click OK to close the dialog box.
The CSS Styles panel updates with the selected style sheet’s name along with an indicator, “hidden” or “design,” to
reflect the style sheets status.
More Help topics
Style Rendering toolbar overview
Working with div tags
Note: In Dreamweaver CC and later, CSS Styles panel is replaced with CSS Designer. For more information, see CSS
Designer.
(Creative Cloud users only): Seven new semantic tags are available when you select Insert > Layout. The new tags are :
Article, Aside, HGroup, Navigation, Section, Header, and Footer. For more information, see Insert HTML5 semantic
elements from the Insert panel.
More Help topics
Video tutorial: Use div elements
Tutorial: How to use CSS to style divs and other layout elements
218
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
Tutorial: Style the header and navigation menu
Laying out pages with CSS
Manage tag libraries
Insert and edit div tags
You can create page layouts by manually inserting div tags and applying CSS positioning styles to them. A div tag is a
tag that defines logical divisions within the content of a web page. You can use div tags to center blocks of content, create
column effects, create different areas of color, and much more.
If youre unfamiliar using div tags and Cascading Style Sheets (CSS) to create web pages, you can create a CSS layout
based on one of the pre-designed layouts that come with Dreamweaver. If youre uncomfortable working with CSS, but
are familiar with using tables, you can also try using tables.
Note: Dreamweaver treats all div tags with an absolute position as AP elements (absolutely positioned elements), even if
you didn’t create those div tags using the AP Div drawing tool.
Insert div tags
You can use div tags to create CSS layout blocks and position them in your document. This is useful if you have an
existing CSS style sheet with positioning styles attached to your document. Dreamweaver enables you to quickly insert
a div tag and apply existing styles to it.
1In the Document window, place the insertion point where you want the div tag to appear.
2Do one of the following:
Select Insert > Layout Objects > Div Tag.
In the Layout category of the Insert panel, click the Insert Div Tag button .
3Set any of the following options:
Insert Lets you select the location of the div tag and the tag name if it is not a new tag.
Class Displays the class style currently applied to the tag. If you attached a style sheet, classes defined in that style
sheet appear in the list. Use this pop-up menu to select the style you want to apply to the tag.
ID Lets you change the name used to identify the div tag. If you attached a style sheet, IDs defined in that style sheet
appear in the list. IDs for blocks that are already in your document are not listed.
Note: Dreamweaver alerts you if you enter the same ID as another tag in your document.
New CSS Rule Opens the New CSS Rule dialog box.
4Click OK.
The div tag appears as a box in your document with placeholder text. When you move the pointer over the edge of
the box, Dreamweaver highlights it.
If the div tag is absolutely positioned, it becomes an AP element. (You can edit div tags that aren’t absolutely
positioned.)
Edit div tags
After you insert a div tag, you can manipulate it or add content to it.
Note: Div tags that are absolutely positioned become AP elements.
219
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
When you assign borders to div tags, or when you have CSS Layout Outlines selected, they have visible borders. (CSS
Layout Outlines is selected by default in the View > Visual Aids menu.) When you move the pointer over a div tag,
Dreamweaver highlights the tag. You can change the highlight color or disable highlighting.
When you select a div tag, you can view and edit rules for it in the CSS Styles panel. You can also add content to the div
tag by simply placing your insertion point inside the div tag, and then adding content just as you would add content to
a page.
View and edit rules applied to a div tag
1Do one of the following to select the div tag:
Click the border of the div tag.
Look for the highlighting to see the border.
Click inside the div tag, and press Control+A (Windows) or Command+A (Macintosh) twice.
Click inside the div tag, then select the div tag from the tag selector at the bottom of the Document window.
2Select Window > CSS Styles to open the CSS Styles panel if it is not already open.
Rules applied to the div tag appear in the panel.
3Make edits as necessary.
Place the insertion point in a div tag to add content
Click anywhere inside the tags borders.
Change the placeholder text in a div tag
Select the text, and then type over it or press Delete.
Note: You can add content to the div tag just as you would add content to a page.
Change the highlight color of div tags
When you move the pointer over the edge of a div tag in Design view, Dreamweaver highlights the borders of the tag.
You can enable or disable highlighting as necessary, or change the highlight color in the Preferences dialog box.
1Select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh).
2Select Highlighting from the category list on the left.
3Make either of the following changes and click OK:
To change the highlighting color for div tags, click the Mouse-Over color box, and then select a highlight color
using the color picker (or enter the hexadecimal value for the highlight color in the text box).
To enable or disable highlighting for div tags, select or deselect the Show checkbox for Mouse-Over.
Note: These options affect all objects, such as tables, that Dreamweaver highlights when you move the pointer over them.
CSS layout blocks
220
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
Visualizing CSS layout blocks
You can visualize CSS layout blocks while you work in Design view. A CSS layout block is an HTML page element that
you can position anywhere on your page. More specifically, a CSS layout block is either a div tag without display:inline,
or any other page element that includes the display:block, position:absolute, or position:relative CSS declarations.
Following are a few examples of elements that are considered CSS layout blocks in Dreamweaver:
A div tag
An image with an absolute or relative position assigned to it
An a tag with the display:block style assigned to it
A paragraph with an absolute or relative position assigned to it
Note: For purposes of visual rendering, CSS layout blocks do not include inline elements (that is, elements whose code falls
within a line of text), or simple block elements like paragraphs.
Dreamweaver provides a number of visual aids for viewing CSS layout blocks. For example, you can enable outlines,
backgrounds, and the box model for CSS layout blocks while you design. You can also view tooltips that display
properties for a selected CSS layout block when you float the mouse pointer over the layout block.
The following list of CSS layout block visual aids describes what Dreamweaver renders as visible for each:
CSS Layout Outlines Displays the outlines of all CSS layout blocks on the page.
CSS Layout Backgrounds Displays temporarily assigned background colors for individual CSS layout blocks, and hides
any other background colors or images that normally appear on the page.
Whenever you enable the visual aid to view CSS layout block backgrounds, Dreamweaver automatically assigns each
CSS layout block a distinct background color. (Dreamweaver selects the colors using an algorithmic process—there is
no way for you to assign the colors yourself.) The assigned colors are visually distinctive, and are designed to help you
differentiate between CSS layout blocks.
CSS Layout Box Model Displays the box model (that is, padding and margins) of the selected CSS layout block.
View CSS layout blocks
You can enable or disable CSS layout block visual aids as necessary.
View CSS layout block outlines
Select View > Visual Aids > CSS Layout Outlines.
View CSS layout block backgrounds
Select View > Visual Aids > CSS Layout Backgrounds.
View CSS layout block box models
Select View > Visual Aids > CSS Layout Box Model.
You can also access CSS layout block visual aid options by clicking the Visual Aids button on the Document toolbar.
221
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
Use visual aids with non-CSS layout block elements
You can use a Design-time style sheet to display the backgrounds, borders, or box model for elements that aren’t
normally considered CSS layout blocks. To do so, you must first create a Design-time style sheet that assigns the
display:block attribute to the appropriate page element.
1Create an external CSS style sheet by selecting File > New, selecting Basic page in the Category column, selecting
CSS in the Basic page column, and clicking Create.
2In the new style sheet, create rules that assign the display:block attribute to the page elements you want to display as
CSS layout blocks.
For example, if you wanted to display a background color for paragraphs and list items, you could create a style sheet
with the following rules:
p{
display:block;
}
li{
display:block;
}
3Save the file.
4In Design view, open the page to which you want to attach the new styles.
5Select Format > CSS Styles > Design-time.
6In the Design-time Style Sheets dialog box, click the plus (+) button above the Show Only at Design Time text box,
select the style sheet you just created, and click OK.
7Click OK to close the Design-time Style Sheets dialog box.
The style sheet is attached to your document. If you had created a style sheet using the previous example, all
paragraphs and list items would be formatted with the display:block attribute, thereby allowing you to enable or
disable CSS layout block visual aids for paragraphs and list items.
Working with AP elements
About AP elements in Dreamweaver
An AP element (absolutely positioned element) is an HTML page element—specifically, a div tag, or any other tag—
that has an absolute position assigned to it. AP elements can contain text, images, or any other content that you can
place in the body of an HTML document.
With Dreamweaver, you can use AP elements to lay out your page. You can place AP elements in front of and behind
each other, hide some AP elements while showing others, and move AP elements across the screen. You can place a
background image in one AP element, then place a second AP element, containing text with a transparent background,
in front of that.
AP elements will usually be absolutely positioned div tags. (These are the kinds of AP elements Dreamweaver inserts
by default.) But remember, you can classify any HTML element (for example, an image) as an AP element by assigning
an absolute position to it. All AP elements (not just absolutely positioned div tags) appear in the AP elements panel.
222
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
HTML code for AP Div elements
Dreamweaver creates AP elements using the div tag. When you draw an AP element using the Draw AP Div tool,
Dreamweaver inserts a div tag in the document and assigns the div an id value (by default apDiv1 for the first div you
draw, apDiv2 for the second div you draw, and so on). Later, you can rename the AP Div to anything you want using
the AP elements panel or the Property inspector. Dreamweaver also uses embedded CSS in the head of the document
to position the AP Div, and to assign the AP Div its exact dimensions.
The following is sample HTML code for an AP Div:
<head>
<meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=iso-8859-1" />
<title>Sample AP Div Page</title>
<style type="text/css">
<!--
#apDiv1 {
position:absolute;
left:62px;
top:67px;
width:421px;
height:188px;
z-index:1;
}
-->
</style>
</head>
<body>
<div id="apDiv1">
</div>
</body>
</html>
You can change properties for AP Divs (or any AP element) on your page, including x and y coordinates, z-index (also
called the stacking order), and visibility.
Insert an AP Div
Dreamweaver lets you easily create and position AP Divs on your page. You can also create nested AP Divs.
When you insert an AP Div, Dreamweaver displays an outline of the AP Div in Design view by default, and highlights
the block when you move the pointer over it. You can disable the visual aid that shows AP Div (or any AP element)
outlines by disabling both AP Element Outlines and CSS Layout Outlines in the View > Visual Aids menu. You can also
enable backgrounds and the box model for AP elements as a visual aid while you design.
After you create an AP Div, you can add content to it by simply placing your insertion point in the AP Div, and then
adding content just as you would add content to a page.
Draw a single AP Div or multiple AP Divs consecutively
1In the Layout category of the Insert panel, click the Draw AP Div button .
2In the Document window’s Design view, do one of the following:
Drag to draw a single AP Div.
Control-drag (Windows) or Command-drag (Macintosh) to draw multiple AP Divs consecutively.
You can continue to draw new AP Divs as long as you do not release the Control or Command key.
223
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
Insert an AP Div at a particular place in the document
Place the insertion point in the Document window, and then select Insert > Layout Objects > AP Div.
Note: This procedure places the tag for the AP Div wherever you clicked in the Document window. The visual rendering
of the AP Div may thus affect other page elements (like text) that surround it.
Place the insertion point in an AP Div
Click anywhere inside the AP Div’s borders.
The AP Div’s borders are highlighted, and the selection handle appears, but the AP Div itself is not selected.
Show AP Div borders
Select View > Visual Aids and select either AP Div Outlines or CSS Layout Outlines.
Note: Selecting both options simultaneously has the same effect.
Hide AP Div borders
Select View > Visual Aids and deselect both AP Div Outlines and CSS Layout Outlines.
Work with nested AP Divs
A nested AP Div is an AP Div that has code contained within the tags of another AP Div. For example, the following
code shows two AP Divs that are not nested, and two AP Divs that are nested:
<div id="apDiv1"></div>
<div id="apDiv2"></div>
<div id="apDiv3">
<div id="apDiv4"></div>
</div>
The graphical depiction for either set of AP Divs might look as follows:
In the first set of div tags, one div is sitting on top of the other on the page. In the second set, the apDiv4 div is actually
inside of the apDiv3 div. (You can change AP Div stacking order in the AP Elements panel.)
Nesting is often used to group AP Divs together. A nested AP Div moves with its parent AP Div and can be set to inherit
visibility from its parent.
You can enable the Nesting option to automatically nest when you draw an AP Div starting inside another AP Div. To
draw inside or over another AP Div, you must also have the Prevent Overlaps option deselected.
224
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
Draw a nested AP Div
1Make sure Prevent Overlaps is deselected in the AP Elements panel (Window > AP Elements).
2In the Layout category of the Insert panel, click the Draw AP Div button .
3In the Document window’s Design view, drag to draw an AP Div inside an existing AP Div.
If Nesting is disabled in AP Elements preferences, Alt-drag (Windows) or Option-drag (Macintosh) to nest an AP
Div inside an existing AP Div.
Nested AP Divs may appear differently in different browsers. When you create nested AP Divs, check their
appearance in various browsers frequently during the design process.
Insert a nested AP Div
1Make sure Prevent Overlaps is deselected.
2Place the insertion point inside an existing AP Div in the Document window’s Design view, then select Insert >
Layout Objects > AP Div.
Nest AP Divs automatically when you draw an AP Div inside another AP Div
Select the Nesting option in the AP Elements preferences.
View or set AP element preferences
Use the AP Elements category in the Preferences dialog box to specify the default settings for new AP elements you
create.
1Select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh).
2Select AP elements from the Category list on the left and specify any of the following preferences, and then click OK.
Visibility Determines whether AP elements are visible by default. The options are default, inherit, visible, and
hidden.
Width and Height Specify a default width and height (in pixels) for AP elements you create using Insert > Layout
Objects > AP Div.
Background Color Specifies a default background color. Select a color from the color picker.
Background Image Specifies a default background image. Click Browse to locate the image file on your computer.
Nesting: Nest When Created Within An AP Div Specifies whether an AP Div that you draw starting from a point
within the boundaries of an existing AP Div should be a nested AP Div. Hold down Alt (Windows) or Option
(Macintosh) to temporarily change this setting while you’re drawing an AP Div.
View or set properties for a single AP element
When you select an AP element, the Property inspector displays AP element properties.
1Select an AP element.
2In the Property inspector (Window > Properties), click the expander arrow in the lower-right corner, if it isn’t
already expanded, to see all properties.
225
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
3Set any of the following options:
CSS-P Element Specifies an ID for the selected AP element. The ID identifies the AP element in the AP Elements
panel and in JavaScript code.
Use only standard alphanumeric characters; do not use special characters such as spaces, hyphens, slashes, or
periods. Every AP element must have its own unique ID.
Note: The CSS-P Property inspector presents the same options for relatively-positioned elements.
L and T (left and top) Specify the position of the AP elements upper-left corner relative to the upper-left corner of
the page, or of the parent AP element if nested.
W and H Specify the width and height of the AP element.
Note: If the content of the AP element exceeds the specified size, the bottom edge of the AP element (as it appears in the
Design view in Dreamweaver) stretches to accommodate the content. (The bottom edge doesn’t stretch when the AP
element appears in a browser, unless the Overflow property is set to Visible.)
W and H The default unit for position and size is pixels (px). You can instead specify the following units: pc (picas),
pt (points), in (inches), mm (millimeters), cm (centimeters), or % (percentage of the parent AP elements
corresponding value). The abbreviations must follow the value without a space: for example, 3mm indicates 3
millimeters.
Z-Index Determines the z-index, or stacking order, of the AP element.
In a browser, higher-numbered AP elements appear in front of lower-numbered AP elements. Values can be positive
or negative. Its easier to change the stacking order of AP elements using the AP Elements panel than to enter specific
z-index values.
Vis Specifies whether the AP element is initially visible or not. Select from the following options:
Default does not specify a visibility property. When no visibility is specified, most browsers default to Inherit.
Inherit uses the visibility property of the AP elements parent.
Visible displays the AP element contents, regardless of the parents value.
Hidden hides the AP element contents, regardless of the parents value.
Use a scripting language, such as JavaScript, to control the visibility property and dynamically display AP element
contents.
Bg Image Specifies a background image for the AP element.
Click the folder icon to browse to and select an image file.
Bg Color Specifies a background color for the AP element.
Leave this option blank to specify a transparent background.
Class Specifies the CSS class used to style the AP element.
Overflow Controls how AP elements appear in a browser when the content exceeds the AP elements specified size.
226
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
Visible indicates that the extra content appears in the AP element; effectively, the AP element stretches to
accommodate it. Hidden specifies that extra content is not displayed in the browser. Scroll specifies that the browser
should add scroll bars to the AP element whether theyre needed or not. Auto causes the browser to display scroll
bars for the AP element only when needed (that is, when the AP elements contents exceed its boundaries.)
Note: The overflow option has uneven support across browsers.
Clip Defines the visible area of an AP element.
Specify left, top, right, and bottom coordinates to define a rectangle in the coordinate space of the AP element
(counting from the upper-left corner of the AP element). The AP element is “clipped” so that only the specified
rectangle is visible. For example, to make an AP elements contents invisible except for a 50-pixel-wide, 75-pixel-
high visible rectangle at the upper-left corner of the AP element, set L to 0, T to 0, R to 50, and B to 75.
Note: Although CSS specifies different semantics for clip, Dreamweaver interprets clip the way that most browsers do.
4If you entered a value in a text box, press Tab or Enter (Windows) or Return (Macintosh) to apply the value.
View or set properties for multiple AP elements
When you select two or more AP elements, the Property inspector displays text properties and a subset of the full AP
element properties, allowing you to modify several AP elements at once.
Select multiple AP elements
Hold down Shift while selecting AP elements.
View and set properties for multiple AP elements
1Select multiple AP elements.
2In the Property inspector (Window > Properties), click the expander arrow in the lower-right corner, if it isn’t
already expanded, to see all properties.
3Set any of the following properties for multiple AP elements:
L and T (left and top) Specify the position of the AP elements’ upper-left corners relative to the upper-left corner of
the page, or of the parent AP element if nested.
W and H Specify the width and height of the AP elements.
Note: If the content of any AP element exceeds the specified size, the bottom edge of the AP element (as it appears in the
Design view in Dreamweaver) stretches to accommodate the content. (The bottom edge doesn’t stretch when the AP
element appears in a browser, unless the Overflow property is set to Visible.)The default unit for position and size is
pixels (px). You can instead specify the following units: pc (picas), pt (points), in (inches), mm (millimeters), cm
(centimeters), or % (percentage of the parent AP elements corresponding value). The abbreviations must follow the
value without a space: for example, 3mm indicates 3 millimeters.
Vis Specifies whether the AP elements are initially visible or not. Select from the following options:
Default does not specify a visibility property. When no visibility is specified, most browsers default to Inherit.
227
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
Inherit uses the visibility property of the AP elements’ parent.
Visible displays the AP elements’ contents, regardless of the parents value.
Hidden hides the AP element contents, regardless of the parents value.
Use a scripting language, such as JavaScript, to control the visibility property and dynamically display AP element
contents.
Tag Specifies the HTML tag used to define the AP elements.
Bg Image Specifies a background image for the AP elements.
Click the folder icon to browse to and select an image file.
Bg Color Specifies a background color for the AP elements. Leave this option blank to specify a transparent
background.
4If you entered a value in a text box, press Tab or Enter (Windows) or Return (Macintosh) to apply the value.
AP Elements panel overview
You use the AP Elements panel (Window > AP Elements) to manage the AP elements in your document. Use the AP
Elements panel to prevent overlaps, to change the visibility of AP elements, to nest or stack AP elements, and to select
one or more AP elements.
Note: An AP element in Dreamweaver is an HTML page element—specifically, a div tag, or any other tag—that has an
absolute position assigned to it. The AP Elements panel does not display relatively-positioned elements.
AP elements are displayed as a list of names, in order of z-index; by default, the first created AP element (with a z-index
of 1) appears at the bottom of the list, and the most recently created AP element appears at the top. You can, however,
change the z-index of an AP element by changing its place in the stacking order. For example, if you created eight AP
elements and wanted to move the fourth AP element to the top, you could assign it a higher z-index than the others.
Select AP elements
You can select one or more AP elements to manipulate them or change their properties.
Select an AP element in the AP elements panel
In the AP elements panel (Window > AP elements), click the name of the AP element.
Select an AP element in the Document window
Do one of the following:
Click an AP element’s selection handle.
If the selection handle isnt visible, click anywhere inside the AP element to make the handle visible.
Click an AP elements border.
Control-Shift-click (Windows) or Command-Shift-click (Macintosh) inside an AP element.
Click inside an AP element and press Control+A (Windows) or Command+A (Macintosh) to select the contents
of the AP element. Press Control+A or Command+A again to select the AP element.
Click inside an AP element and select its tag in the tag selector.
228
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
Select multiple AP elements
Do one of the following:
In the AP Elements panel (Window > AP Elements), Shift-click two or more AP element names.
In the Document window, Shift-click inside or on the border of two or more AP elements.
Change the stacking order of AP elements
Use the Property inspector or the AP Elements panel to change the stacking order of AP elements. The AP element at
the top of the AP Elements panel list is at the top of the stacking order, and appears in front of the other AP elements.
In HTML code, the stacking order, or z-index, of the AP elements determines the order in which they are drawn in a
browser. The higher the z-index of an AP element, the higher that AP element is in the stacking order. (For example,
an element with a z-index of 4 will appear on top of an element with a z-index of 3; 1 is always the lowest number in
the stacking order.) You can change the z-index for each AP element using the AP Elements panel or Property inspector.
Change the stacking order of AP elements using the AP Elements panel
1Select Window > AP Elements to open the AP Elements panel.
2Double-click the z-index number next to the AP element whose z-index you want to change.
3Change the number and press Return/Enter.
Type a higher number to move the AP element up in the stacking order.
Type a lower number to move the AP element down in the stacking order.
Change the stacking order of AP elements using the Property inspector
1Select Window > AP Elements to open the AP Elements panel to see the current stacking order.
2In the AP Elements panel or in the Document window, select the AP element whose z-index you want to change.
3In the Property inspector (Window > Properties), type a number in the Z-Index text box.
Type a higher number to move the AP element up in the stacking order.
Type a lower number to move the AP element down in the stacking order.
Show and hide AP elements
While working on your document, you can show and hide AP elements manually, using the AP Elements panel, to see
how the page will appear under different conditions.
Note: The currently selected AP element always becomes visible and appears in front of other AP elements while it’s selected.
Change AP element visibility
1Select Window > AP Elements to open the AP Elements panel.
2Click in the eye icon column for an AP element to change its visibility.
An open eye means the AP element is visible.
A closed eye means the AP element is invisible.
If there is no eye icon, usually the AP element inherits visibility from its parent. (When AP elements are not
nested, the parent is the document body, which is always visible.)
Also, no eye icon appears when no visibility is specified (which appears in the Property inspector as Default
visibility).
229
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
Change the visibility of all AP elements at once
In the AP Elements panel (Window > AP Elements), click the header eye icon at the top of the column.
Note: This procedure can set all AP elements to visible or hidden, but not to inherit.
Resize AP elements
You can resize an individual AP element, or simultaneously resize multiple AP elements to make them the same width
and height.
If the Prevent Overlaps option is on, you will not be able to resize an AP element so that it overlaps with another AP
element.
Resize an AP element
1In Design view, select an AP element.
2Do one of the following to resize the AP element:
To resize by dragging, drag any of the AP elements resize handles.
To resize one pixel at a time, hold down Control (Windows) or Option (Macintosh) while pressing an arrow key.
The arrow keys move the right and bottom borders of the AP element; you cant resize using the top and left
borders with this technique.
To resize by the grid snapping increment, hold down Shift-Control (Windows) or Shift-Option (Macintosh)
while pressing an arrow key.
In the Property inspector (Window > Properties), type values for width (W) and height (H).
Resizing an AP element changes the width and height of the AP element. It does not define how much of the AP
elements content is visible. You can define the visible region within an AP element in preferences.
Resize multiple AP elements at once
1In the Design view, select two or more AP elements.
2Do one of the following:
Select Modify > Arrange > Make Same Width Or Modify > Arrange > Make Same Height.
The first selected AP elements conform to the width or height of the last selected AP element.
In the Property inspector (Window > Properties), under Multiple CSS-P Element, enter width and height values.
The values are applied to all selected AP elements.
Move AP elements
You can move AP elements in the Design view in much the same way that you move objects in most basic graphics
applications.
If the Prevent Overlaps option is on, you will not be able to move a AP element so that it overlaps another AP element.
1In the Design view, select an AP element or multiple AP elements.
2Do one of the following:
To move by dragging, drag the selection handle of the last selected AP element (highlighted in black).
To move one pixel at a time, use the arrow keys.
230
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
Hold down the Shift key while pressing an arrow key to move the AP element by the current grid-snapping
increment.
Align AP elements
Use the AP element alignment commands to align one or more AP elements with a border of the last AP element
selected.
When you align AP elements, child AP elements that aren’t selected may move because their parent AP element is
selected and moved. To prevent this, don’t use nested AP elements.
1In the Design view, select the AP element.
2Select Modify > Arrange, and then select an alignment option.
For example, if you select Top, all of the AP elements move so that their top borders are in the same vertical position
as the top border of the last selected AP element (highlighted in black).
Converting AP elements to tables
Instead of using tables to create your layout, some web designers prefer to work with AP elements. Dreamweaver
enables you to create your layout using AP elements, then (if you want) convert them into tables. For example, you
might need to convert your AP elements to tables if you need to support browsers before version 4.0. Converting AP
elements to tables, however, is highly discouraged because it can result in tables with a large number of empty cells, not
to mention bloated code. If you need a page layout that uses tables, it is best to create that page layout using the standard
table layout tools available in Dreamweaver.
You can convert back and forth between AP elements and tables to adjust the layout and optimize page design. (When
you convert a table back to AP elements, however, Dreamweaver converts the table back to AP Divs, regardless of the
type of AP element you might have had on the page before the conversion to tables.) You cannot convert a specific table
or AP element on a page; you must convert AP elements to tables and tables to AP Divs for an entire page.
Note: You can’t convert AP elements to tables or tables to AP Divs in a template document or in a document to which a
template has been applied. Instead, create your layout in a non-template document and convert it before saving it as a
template.
Convert between AP elements and tables
You can create your layout using AP elements, then convert the AP elements to tables so that your layout can be viewed
in older browsers.
Before you convert to tables, make sure AP elements do not overlap. Also, make sure you’re in Standard Mode (View >
Table Mode > Standard Mode).
Convert AP elements to a table
1Select Modify > Convert > AP Divs To Table.
2Specify any of the following options and click OK:
Most Accurate Creates a cell for every AP element, plus any additional cells that are necessary to preserve the space
between AP elements.
Smallest: Collapse Empty Cells Specifies that the AP elements’ edges should be aligned if they are positioned within
the specified number of pixels.
If you select this option, the resulting table will have fewer empty rows and columns, but may not match your layout
precisely.
231
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
Use Transparent GIFs Fills the tables last row with transparent GIFs. This ensures that the table is displayed with the
same column widths in all browsers.
When this option is enabled, you cannot edit the resulting table by dragging its columns. When this option is
disabled, the resulting table will not contain transparent GIFs, but the widths of the columns may vary from browser
to browser.
Center On Page Centers the resulting table on the page. If this option is disabled, the table starts at the left edge of
the page.
Convert tables to AP Divs
1Select Modify > Convert > Tables to AP Divs.
2Specify any of the following options and click OK:
Prevent AP Element Overlaps Constrains the positions of AP elements when they are created, moved, and resized
so that they dont overlap.
Show AP Elements Panel Displays the AP elements panel.
Show Grid and Snap To Grid Let you use a grid to help position AP elements.
The tables are converted to AP Divs. Empty cells are not converted to AP elements unless they have background
colors.
Note: Page elements that were outside of tables are also placed in AP Divs.
Prevent AP element overlaps
Because table cells cannot overlap, Dreamweaver cannot create a table from overlapping AP elements. If you plan to
convert the AP elements in a document to tables, use the Prevent Overlap option to constrain AP element movement
and positioning so that AP elements dont overlap.
When this option is on, an AP element can’t be created in front of, moved or resized over, or nested within an existing
AP element. If you activate this option after creating overlapping AP elements, drag each overlapping AP element to
move it away from other AP elements. Dreamweaver does not automatically fix existing overlapping AP elements in
the page when you enable Prevent AP element Overlaps.
When this option and snapping are enabled, an AP element won’t snap to the grid if it would cause two AP elements to
overlap. Instead, it will snap to the edge of the closest AP element.
Note: Certain actions allow you to overlap AP elements even when the Prevent Overlaps option is enabled. If you insert an
AP element using the Insert menu, enter numbers in the Property inspector, or reposition AP elements by editing the HTML
source code, you can cause AP elements to overlap or nest while this option is enabled. If overlaps happen, drag overlapping
AP elements in the Design view to separate them.
In the AP Elements panel (Window > AP Elements), select the Prevent Overlaps option.
In the Document window, select Modify > Arrange > Prevent AP Element Overlaps.
Apply gradients to background
Using the CSS Designer panel, you can apply gradients to the background of your websites. The gradient property is
available in the background category.
232
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
Click adjacent to the gradient property to open the gradients panel. Using this panel, you can:
Choose colors from different color models (RGBa, Hexadecimal, or HSLa). Then, save different color combinations
as color swatches.
To reset the new color to the original color, click the original color (K).
To change the order of the swatches, drag the swatches to the required position.
To delete a color swatch, drag the swatch out of the panel.
Use color stops to create complex gradients. Click anywhere between the default color stops to create a color stop.
To delete a color stop, drag the color stop out of the panel.
Specify the angle for linear gradient.
To repeat the pattern, select Repeating.
Save custom gradients as swatches.
A Color stop B Gradient swatch C Add gradient swatch D Linear repeating E Color models F Eye Dropper G Color slider H Lightness slider
I Opacity slider J Add color swatch K Color swatch L Original color M Selected color N Angle for linear gradient
233
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: The Eye Dropper tool is available in Dreamweaver 13.1 and later.
Let's understand the following code:
background-image: linear-gradient(57deg,rgba(255,255,255,1.00) 0%,rgba(21,8,8,1.00)
46.63%,rgba(255,0,0,1.00) 100%)
57deg: Indicates the angle of the linear gradient
rgba(255, 255, 255, 1.00): Color for the first color stop
0%: Indicates color stop
Note: Only '%' values for color stops are supported in Dreamweaver. If you use other values such as, px or em, Dreamweaver
reads them as 'nil'. Also, Dreamweaver does not support CSS colors and if you specify these colors in the code, such colors
are read as 'nil'.
Rendering gradients in web browsers
When you use gradients as background, you can configure Dreamweaver to render the gradients appropriately on
different web browsers. Dreamweaver adds appropriate vendor prefixes to the code that enables web browsers to display
gradients suitably.
Dreamweaver can write the following vendor prefixes along with w3c format:
Webkit
Mozilla
Opera
Dreamweaver Live View (old Webkit format)
By default, Dreamweaver writes vendor prefixes for Webkit and Dreamweaver Live View. You can choose the other
required vendors from the Preferences dialog box (Preferences > CSS Styles).
Note: For Box shadow, Webkit and w3c prefixes are always generated irrespective of whether you have selected them in the
Preferences or not.
Any changes to the gradients are reflected in the vendor-specific syntaxes too. If you open an existing file containing
vendor-specific syntaxes in Dreamweaver CC, ensure that you choose the required vendor prefixes in Preferences.
Because, by default, Dreamweaver updates only Webkit, and Dreamweaver Live View-related code when you use or
change gradients. So, the other vendor-specific syntaxes in your code do not get updated.
Swap background images and gradients
You can change the order (in which they appear in the code) of the background images and gradients with a single click.
Click adjacent to the url or the gradient property in CSS Designer.
Note: Dreamweaver CC contains a basic implementation of the swap background feature. When you have multiple values
or images, swap may not work as expected. Also, suppose that you have an image, second image, and then a gradient
applied to the background. Swapping the gradient results in the following order: gradient, second image, first image.
234
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
CSS3 transition effects
You can create, modify, and delete CSS3 transitions using the CSS Transitions panel.
To create a CSS3 transition, create a transition class by specifying values for the transition properties of the element. If
you select an element before creating a transition class, the transition class is automatically applied to the selected
element.
You can choose to add the generated CSS code to the current document or specify an external CSS file.
Create and apply CSS3 transition effect
1(Optional) Select an element (paragraph, heading, and so on) to which you want to apply the transition.
Alternatively, you can create a transition and apply it later to an element.
2Select Window > CSS Transitions.
3Click .
4Create a transition class using the options in the New Transition dialog box.
Target Rule Enter a name for the selector. The selector can be any CSS selector such as a tag, a rule, an ID, or a
compound selector. For example, if you want to add transition effects to all <hr> tags, enter hr
Transition On Select a state to which you want to apply the transition. For example, if you want to apply the
transition when the mouse moves over the element, use the hover option.
Use the Same Transition for All Properties Select this option if you want to specify the same Duration, Delay, and
Timing Function for all CSS properties that you want to transition.
Use a Different Transition for Each Property Select this option if you want to specify a different Duration, Delay,
and Timing Function for each of CSS properties that you want to transition.
Property Click to add a CSS property to transition.
Duration Enter a duration in seconds (s) or milliseconds (ms) for the transition effect.
Delay The time, in seconds or milliseconds, before the transition effect starts.
Timing function Select a transition style from the available options.
End Value The end value for the transition effect. For example, if you want the font-size to increase to 40px at the
end of the transition effect, specify 40px for the font-size property.
Choose Where To Create The Transition To embed the style in the current document, select This Document Only.
If you want to create an external style sheet for the CSS3 code, select New Style Sheet File. When you click Create
Transition, you are prompted for a location to save the new CSS file. After the style sheet is created, it is added to the
Choose Where To Create Transition menu.
Edit CSS3 transition effects
1In the CSS Transitions panel, select the transition effect that you want to edit.
235
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
2Click .
3Use the Edit Transition dialog to change previously entered values for the transition.
Disable CSS shorthand for Transitions
See What is a CSS Shorthand Property? for information on CSS Shorthand, and its benefits.
1Select Edit > Preferences.
2Select CSS Styles.
3 In Use Shorthand For, deselect Transition.
Use Dreamweaver sample style sheets
Note: In Dreamweaver CC and later, CSS Styles panel is replaced with CSS Designer. For more information, see CSS
Designer.
Dreamweaver provides sample style sheets that you can apply to your pages or that you can use as starting points to
develop your own styles.
1Open the CSS Styles panel by doing one of the following:
Select Window > CSS Styles.
Press Shift+F11.
2In the CSS Styles panel, click the Attach External Style Sheet button. (It’s in the lower-right corner of the panel.)
3In the Attach External Style Sheet dialog box, click Sample Style Sheets.
4In the Sample Style Sheets dialog box, select a style sheet from the list box.
As you select style sheets within the list box, the Preview pane displays the text and color formatting of the selected
style sheet.
5Click the Preview button to apply the style sheet and verify that it applies the styles you want to the current page.
If the styles applied are not what you expect them to be, select another style sheet from the list, and click Preview to
see those styles.
6By default, Dreamweaver saves the style sheet in a folder named CSS just below the root of the site you defined for
your page. If that folder does not exist, Dreamweaver creates it. You can save the file to another location by clicking
Browse and browsing to another folder.
7When you find a style sheet whose formatting rules meet your design criteria, click OK.
The CSS Styles panel
Note: In Dreamweaver CC and later, CSS Styles panel is replaced with CSS Designer. For more information, see CSS
Designer.
236
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
The CSS Styles panel lets you track the CSS rules and properties affecting a currently selected page element (Current
mode), or all of the rules and properties that are available to the document (All mode). A toggle button at the top of
panel lets you switch between the two modes. The CSS Styles panel also lets you modify CSS properties in both All and
Current mode.
The CSS Styles panel in Current mode
In Current mode, the CSS Styles panel displays three panes: a Summary for Selection pane that displays the CSS
properties for the current selection in the document, a Rules pane that displays the location of selected properties (or
a cascade of rules for the selected tag, depending on your selection), and a Properties pane that lets you edit CSS
properties for the rule applied to the selection.
You can resize any of the panes by dragging the borders between the panes, and can resize columns by dragging
dividers.
The Summary for Selection pane displays a summary of CSS properties and their values for the item currently selected
in the active document. The summary shows the properties for all rules that directly apply to the selection. Only set
properties are shown.
For example, the following rules create a class style and a tag (in this case paragraph) style:
.foo{
color: green;
font-family: ‘Arial’;
}
p{
font-family: ‘serif’;
font-size: 12px;
}
When you select paragraph text with a class style of .foo in the Document window, the Summary for Selection pane
displays the relevant properties for both rules, because both rules apply to the selection. In this case, the Summary for
Selection pane would list the following properties:
237
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
font-size: 12px
font-family: ‘Arial’
color: green
The Summary for Selection pane arranges properties in increasing order of specificity. In the above example, the tag
style defines the font size and the class style defines the font family and the color. (The font family defined by the class
style overrides the font family defined by the tag style because class selectors have higher specificity than tag selectors.
For more information on CSS specificity, see www.w3.org/TR/CSS2/cascade.html.)
The Rules pane displays two different views—About view or Rules view—depending on your selection. In About view
(the default view), the pane displays the name of the rule that defines the selected CSS property, and the name of the
file containing the rule. In Rules view, the pane displays a cascade, or hierarchy, of all rules that apply directly or
indirectly to the current selection. (The tag to which the rule directly applies appears in the right column.) You can
toggle between the two views by clicking the Show Information and Show Cascade buttons in the upper-right corner
of the Rules pane.
When you select a property in the Summary for Selection pane, all of the properties for the defining rule appear in the
Properties pane. (The defining rule is also selected in the Rules pane, if Rules view is selected.) For example, if you have
a rule called .maintext that defines a font family, font size, and color, then selecting any of those properties in the
Summary for Selection pane will display all of the properties defined by the .maintext rule in the Properties pane, as
well as the selected .maintext rule in the Rules pane. (Additionally, selecting any rule in the Rules pane displays that
rules properties in the Properties pane.) You can then use the Properties pane to quickly modify your CSS, whether it
is embedded in the current document or linked by means of an attached style sheet. By default, the Properties pane
shows only those properties that have already been set, and arranges them in alphabetical order.
You can choose to display the Properties pane in two other views. Category view displays properties grouped into
categories, such as Font, Background, Block, Border, and so on, with set properties at the top of each category, displayed
in blue text. List view displays an alphabetical list of all available properties, and likewise sorts set properties to the top,
displaying them in blue text. To switch between views, click the Show Category View, Show List View, or Show Only Set
Properties button, located at the lower-left corner of the Properties pane.
In all views, set properties are displayed in blue; properties irrelevant to a selection are displayed with a red strike-
through line. Holding the mouse over a rule that is irrelevant displays a message explaining why the property is
irrelevant. Typically a property is irrelevant because its overridden or not an inherited property.
Any changes you make in the Properties pane are applied immediately, letting you preview your work as you go.
The CSS Styles panel in All mode
In All mode, the CSS Styles panel displays two panes: an All Rules pane (on top), and a Properties pane (on bottom).
The All Rules pane displays a list of rules defined in the current document as well as all rules defined in style sheets
attached to the current document. The Properties pane lets you edit CSS properties for any selected rule in the All Rules
pane.
238
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
You can resize either pane by dragging the border between the panes, and can resize the Properties columns by dragging
their divider.
When you select a rule in the All Rules pane, all of the properties that are defined in that rule appear in the Properties
pane. You can then use the Properties pane to quickly modify your CSS, whether it is embedded in the current
document or linked in an attached style sheet. By default, the Properties pane shows only those properties that have
been previously set, and arranges them in alphabetical order.
You can choose to display properties in two other views. Category view displays properties grouped into categories,
such as Font, Background, Block, Border, and so on, with set properties at the top of each category. List view displays
an alphabetical list of all available properties, and likewise sorts set properties to the top. To switch between views, click
the Show Category View, Show List View, or Show Only Set Properties button, located at the lower-left corner of the
Properties pane. In all views, set properties are displayed in blue.
Any changes you make in the Properties pane are applied immediately, letting you preview your work as you go.
CSS Styles panel buttons and views
In both All and Current modes, the CSS Styles panel contains three buttons that let you alter the view in the Properties
pane (the bottom pane):
A Category View B List View C Set Properties View
Category View Divides the Dreamweaver-supported CSS properties into eight categories: font, background, block,
border, box, list, positioning, and extensions. Each category’s properties are contained in a list that you expand or
collapse by clicking the Plus (+) button next to the category name. Set properties appear (in blue) at the top of the list.
List View Displays all of the Dreamweaver-supported CSS properties in alphabetical order. Set properties appear (in
blue) at the top of the list.
Set Properties View Displays only those properties that have been set. Set Properties view is the default view.
In both All and Current modes, the CSS Styles panel also contains the following buttons:
239
CSS
Last updated 6/3/2015
A Attach Style Sheet B New CSS Rule C Edit Style D Disable/enable CSS property E Delete CSS rule
Attach Style Sheet Opens the Link External Style Sheet dialog box. Select an external style sheet to link to or import
into your current document.
New CSS Rule Opens a dialog box in which you can select the type of style you’re creatingfor example, to create a class
style, redefine an HTML tag, or to define a CSS selector.
Edit Style Opens a dialog box in which you can edit the styles in the current document or in an external style sheet.
Delete CSS Rule Removes the selected rule or property from the CSS Styles panel, and removes the formatting from
any element to which it was applied. (It does not, however, remove class or ID properties referenced by that style). The
Delete CSS Rule button can also detach (or “unlink”) an attached CSS style sheet.
Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the CSS Styles panel to open a context menu of options for working
with CSS style sheet commands.
Open the CSS Styles panel
You use the CSS Styles panel to view, create, edit, and remove CSS styles, as well as to attach external style sheets to
documents.
Do one of the following:
Select Window > CSS Styles.
Press Shift+F11.
Click the CSS button in the Property inspector.
240
Last updated 6/3/2015
Chapter 7: Page content and assets
Set page properties
For each page you create in Dreamweaver, you can specify layout and formatting properties using the Page Properties
dialog box (Modify > Page Properties). The Page Properties dialog box lets you specify the default font family and font
size, background color, margins, link styles, and many other aspects of page design. You can assign new page properties
for each new page you create, and modify those for existing pages. Changes you make in the Page Properties dialog box
apply to the entire page.
Dreamweaver gives you two methods for modifying page properties: CSS or HTML. Adobe recommends using CSS to
set backgrounds and modify page properties.
Note: The page properties you choose apply only to the active document. If a page uses an external CSS style sheet,
Dreamweaver does not overwrite the tags set in the style sheet, as this affects all other pages using that style sheet.
Set CSS page font, background color, and background image properties
Use the Page Properties dialog box to specify several basic page layout options for your web pages, including the font,
background color, and background image.
1Select Modify > Page Properties, or click the Page Properties button in the text Property inspector.
2Select the Appearance (CSS) category and set the options.
Page Font Specifies the default font family to use in your web pages. Dreamweaver uses the font family you specify
unless another font is specifically set for a text element.
Size Specifies the default font size to use in your web pages. Dreamweaver uses the font size you specify unless
another font size is specifically set for a text element.
Text Color Specifies the default color to render fonts with.
Background Color Sets a background color for your page. Click the Background color box and select a color from
the Color Picker.
Background Image Sets a background image. Click the Browse button, then browse to and select the image.
Alternatively, enter the path to the background image in the Background Image box.
Dreamweaver tiles (repeats) the background image if it does not fill the entire window, just as browsers do. (To
prevent the background image from tiling, use Cascading Style Sheets to disable image tiling.)
Repeat Specifies how the background image will be displayed on the page:
Select the No-repeat option to display the background image only once.
Select the Repeat option to repeat, or tile, the image both horizontally and vertically.
Select the Repeat-x option to tile the image horizontally.
Select the Repeat-y option to tile the image vertically.
Left Margin and Right Margin Specify the size of the left and right page margins.
241
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Top Margin and Bottom Margin Specify the size of the top and bottom page margins.
Set HTML page properties
Setting properties in this category of the Page Properties dialog box results in HTML rather than CSS formatting of
your page.
1Select Modify > Page Properties, or click the Page Properties button in the text Property inspector.
2Select the Appearance (HTML) category and set the options.
Background Image Sets a background image. Click the Browse button, then browse to and select the image.
Alternatively, enter the path to the background image in the Background Image box.
Dreamweaver tiles (repeats) the background image if it does not fill the entire window, just as browsers do. (To
prevent the background image from tiling, use Cascading Style Sheets to disable image tiling.)
Background Sets a background color for your page. Click the Background color box and select a color from the
Color Picker.
Text Specifies the default color to render fonts with.
Link Specifies the color to apply to link text.
Visited Links Specifies the color to apply to visited links.
Active Links Specifies the color to apply when a mouse (or pointer) clicks on a link
Left Margin and Right Margin Specify the size of the left and right page margins.
Top Margin and Bottom Margin Specify the size of the top and bottom page margins.
Set CSS link properties for an entire page
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
You can specify fonts, font sizes, colors, and other items for your links. By default, Dreamweaver creates CSS rules for
your links and applies them to all links you use on the page. (The rules are embedded in the head section of the page.)
Note: If you want to customize individual links on a page, you need to create individual CSS rules, and then apply them to
the links separately.
1Select Modify > Page Properties, or click the Page Properties button in the text Property inspector.
2Choose the Links (CSS) category and set the options.
Link Font Specifies the default font family to use for link text. By default, Dreamweaver uses the font family specified
for the entire page unless you specify another font.
Size Specifies the default font size to use for link text.
Link Color Specifies the color to apply to link text.
Visited Links Specifies the color to apply to visited links.
Rollover Links Specifies the color to apply when a mouse (or pointer) hovers over a link.
Active Links Specifies the color to apply when a mouse (or pointer) clicks on a link
242
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Underline Style Specifies the underline style to apply to links. If your page already has an underline link style
defined (through an external CSS style sheet for example), the Underline Style menu defaults to a “don’t change
option. This option alerts you to a link style that has been defined. If you modify the underline link style using the
Page Properties dialog box, Dreamweaver will change the previous link definition.
Set CSS heading properties for an entire page
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
You can specify fonts, font sizes, and colors for your page headings. By default, Dreamweaver creates CSS rules for your
headings and applies them to all headings you use on the page. (The rules are embedded in the head section of the
page.)
Headings are available for selection in HTML Property inspector.
1Select Modify > Page Properties, or click the Page Properties button in the text Property inspector.
2Choose the Headings (CSS) category and set the options.
Heading Font Specifies the default font family to use for headings. Dreamweaver will use the font family you specify
unless another font is specifically set for a text element.
Heading 1 through Heading 6 Specify the font size and color to use for up to six levels of heading tags.
Set title and encoding properties for a page
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
The Title/Encoding Page Properties options let you specify the document encoding type that is specific to the language
used to author your web pages as well as specify which Unicode Normalization Form to use with that encoding type.
1Select Modify > Page Properties, or click the Page Properties button in the text Property inspector.
2Choose the Title/Encoding category and set the options.
Title Specifies the page title that appears in the title bar of the Document window and most browser windows.
Document Type (DTD) Specifies a document type definition. For example, you can make an HTML document
XHTML-compliant by selecting XHTML 1.0 Transitional or XHTML 1.0 Strict from the pop-up menu.
Encoding Specifies the encoding used for characters in the document.
If you select Unicode (UTF-8) as the document encoding, entity encoding is not necessary because UTF-8 can safely
represent all characters. If you select another document encoding, entity encoding may be necessary to represent
certain characters. For more information on character entities, see www.w3.org/TR/REC-
html40/sgml/entities.html.
Reload Converts the existing document, or reopens it using the new encoding.
Unicode Normalization Form Enabled only if you select UTF-8 as a document encoding. There are four Unicode
Normalization Forms. The most important is Normalization Form C because its the most common form used in
the Character Model for the World Wide Web. Adobe provides the other three Unicode Normalization Forms for
completeness.
243
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
In Unicode, some characters are visually similar but can be stored within the document in different ways. For
example, “ë” (e-umlaut) can be represented as a single character, “e-umlaut,” or as two characters, “regular Latin e
+ “combining umlaut.” A Unicode combining character is one that gets used with the previous character, so the
umlaut would appear above the “Latin e.” Both forms result in the same visual typography, but what is saved in the
file is different for each form.
Normalization is the process of making sure all characters that can be saved in different forms are all saved using
the same from. That is, all “ë” characters in a document are saved as single “e-umlaut or as “e” +combining umlaut,
and not as both forms in one document.
For more information on Unicode Normalization and the specific forms that can be used, see the Unicode website
at www.unicode.org/reports/tr15.
Include Unicode Signature (BOM) Includes a Byte Order Mark (BOM) in the document. A BOM is 2 to 4 bytes at
the beginning of a text file that identifies a file as Unicode, and if so, the byte order of the following bytes. Because
UTF-8 has no byte order, adding a UTF-8 BOM is optional. For UTF-16 and UTF-32, it is required.
Use a tracing image to design apage
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
You can insert an image file to use as a guide in designing your page. The image appears as a background image, which
you can “design over” as you lay out your page.
1Select Modify > Page Properties, or click the Page Properties button in the text Property inspector.
2Choose the Tracing Image category and set the options.
Tracing Image Specifies an image to use as a guide for copying a design. This image is for reference only, and does
not appear when the document is displayed in a browser.
Transparency Determines the opacity of the tracing image, from completely transparent to completely opaque.
Understanding document encoding
Document encoding specifies the encoding used for characters in the document. Document encoding is specified in a
meta tag in the head of the document; it tells the browser and Dreamweaver how the document should be decoded and
what fonts should be used to display the decoded text.
For example, if you specify Western European (Latin1), this meta tag is inserted:
<meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=iso-8859-1">.
Dreamweaver displays the document using the fonts you specify in Fonts Preferences for the Western European
(Latin1) encoding; a browser displays the document using the fonts the browser user specifies for the Western
European (Latin1) encoding.
If you specify Japanese (Shift JIS), this meta tag is inserted:
<meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=Shift_JIS">.
Dreamweaver displays the document using the fonts you specify for the Japanese encoding; a browser displays the
document using the fonts the browser user specifies for the Japanese encodings.
244
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
You can change document encoding for a page and change the default encoding that Dreamweaver uses to create new
documents, including the fonts used to display each encoding.
Select and view elements in the Document window
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
To select an element in the Design view of the Document window, click the element. If an element is invisible, you must
make it visible before you can select it.
Some HTML code doesnt have a visible representation in a browser. For example, comment tags don’t appear in
browsers. However, it can be useful while youre creating a page to be able to select such invisible elements, edit them,
move them, and delete them.
Dreamweaver enables you to specify whether it shows icons marking the location of invisible elements in the Design
view of the Document window. To indicate which element markers appear, you can set options in Invisible Elements
preferences. For example, you can specify that named anchors be visible, but not line breaks.
You can create certain invisible elements (such as comments and named anchors) using buttons in the Common
category of the Insert panel. You can then modify these elements using the Property inspector.
Select elements
To select a visible element in the Document window, click the element or drag across the element.
To select an invisible element, select View > Visual Aids > Invisible Elements (if that menu item isn’t already selected)
and then click the elements marker in the Document window.
Some objects appear on the page in a place other than where their code is inserted. For example, in Design view an
absolutely-positioned element (AP element) can be anywhere on the page, but in Code view the code defining the
AP element is in a fixed location. When invisible elements are showing, Dreamweaver displays markers in the
Document window to show the location of the code for such elements. Selecting a marker selects the entire element;
for example, selecting the marker for an AP element selects the entire AP element.
To select a complete tag (including its contents, if any), click a tag in the tag selector at the lower left of the Document
window. (The tag selector appears in both Design view and Code view.) The tag selector always shows the tags that
contain the current selection or insertion point. The leftmost tag is the outermost tag containing the current
selection or insertion point. The next tag is contained in that outermost tag, and so on; the rightmost tag is the
innermost one that contains the current selection or insertion point.
In the following example, the insertion point is in a paragraph tag, <p>. To select the table containing the paragraph
you want to select, select the <table> tag to the left of the <p> tag.
View the HTML code associated with the selected text or object
Do one of the following:
In the Document toolbar, click the Show Code View button.
Select View > Code.
In the Document toolbar, click the Show Code and Design Views button.
245
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Select View > Code and Design.
Select Window > Code Inspector.
When you select something in either code editor (Code view or the Code inspector), it’s generally also selected
in the Document window. You may need to synchronize the two views before the selection appears.
Show or hide marker icons for invisible elements
Select View > Visual Aids > Invisible Elements.
Note: Showing invisible elements may slightly change the layout of a page, moving other elements by a few pixels, so for
precision layout, hide the invisible elements.
Set invisible elements preferences
Use Invisible Elements preferences to specify which kinds of elements will be visible when you select View > Visual Aids
> Invisible Elements.
1Select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh), then click Invisible Elements.
2Select which elements should be made visible and click OK.
Note: A check mark next to the name of the element in the dialog box means the element is visible when View > Visual
Aids > Invisible Elements is selected.
Named Anchors Displays an icon that marks the location of each named anchor (a name = "") in the document.
Scripts Displays an icon that marks the location of JavaScript or VBScript code in the body of the document. Select
the icon to edit the script in the Property inspector or to link to an external script file.
Comments Displays an icon that marks the location of HTML comments. Select the icon to see the comment in the
Property inspector.
Line Breaks Displays an icon that marks the location of each line break (BR). This option is deselected by default.
Client-Side Image Maps Displays an icon marking the location of each client-side image map in the document.
Embedded Styles Displays an icon showing the location of CSS styles embedded in the body section of the
document. If CSS styles are placed in the head section of a document, they do not appear in the Document window.
Hidden Form Fields Displays an icon that marks the location of form fields that have the type attribute set to
"hidden".
Form Delimiter Displays a border around a form so you can see where to insert form elements. The border shows
the extent of the form tag, so any form elements inside that border are properly enclosed in form tags.
Anchor Points For AP elements Displays an icon that marks the location of code defining an AP element. The AP
element itself can be anywhere on the page. (AP elements are not invisible elements; only the code defining the AP
element is invisible.) Select the icon to select the AP element; you can then see the contents of the AP element even
if the AP element is marked as hidden.
Anchor Points For Aligned Elements Displays an icon showing the location of HTML code for elements that accept
the align attribute. These include images, tables, ActiveX objects, plug-ins, and applets. In some cases, the code for
the element may be separated from the visible object.
Visual Server Markup Tags Displays the location of server markup tags (such as Active Server Pages tags and
ColdFusion tags) whose content cannot be displayed in the Document window. These tags typically generate HTML
tags when processed by a server. For example, a <CFGRAPH> tag generates an HTML table when processed by a
246
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
ColdFusion server. Dreamweaver reperesents the tag with a ColdFusion invisible element since Dreamweaver
cannot determine the final, dynamic output of the page.
Nonvisual Server Markup Tags Displays the location of server markup tags (such as Active Server Pages tags and
ColdFusion tags) whose content cannot be displayed in the Document window. These tags are typically set-up,
processing, or logic tags (for example, <CFSET>, <CFWDDX>, and <CFXML>) that do not generate HTML tags.
CSS Display: None Displays an icon showing the location of content thats hidden by the display:none property in
the linked or embedded stylesheet.
Show Dynamic Text As Displays any dynamic text on your page in the format of {Recordset:Field} by default. If the
length of these values is long enough to distort your pages formatting, you can change the display to {} instead.
Server-Side Includes Displays the actual contents of each server-side include file.
More Help topics
Viewing code
Use the Insert panel
Zoom in and out
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Dreamweaver lets you increase the magnification (zoom in) in the Document window so that you can check the pixel
accuracy of graphics, select small items more easily, design pages with small text, design large pages, and so on.
Note: The zooming tools are only available in Design view.
Zoom in or out on a page
1Click the Zoom tool (the magnifying glass icon) in the lower-right corner of the Document window.
2Do one of the following:
Click the spot on the page you want to magnify until you’ve achieved the desired magnification.
Drag a box over the area on the page that you want to zoom in on and release the mouse button.
Select a preset magnification level from the Zoom pop-up menu.
Type a magnification level in the Zoom text box.
You can also zoom in without using the Zoom tool by pressing Control+= (Windows) or Command+= (Macintosh).
3To zoom out (reduce magnification), select the Zoom tool, press Alt (Windows) or Option (Macintosh) and
click on the page.
You can also zoom out without using the Zoom tool by pressing Control+- (Windows) or Command+- (Macintosh).
Edit a page after zooming
Click the Select tool (the pointer icon) in the lower-right corner of the Document window, and click inside the page.
247
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Pan a page after zooming
1Click the Hand tool (the hand icon) in the lower-right corner of the Document window.
2Drag the page.
Fill the Document window with a selection
1Select an element on the page.
2Select View > Fit Selection.
Fill the Document window with an entire page
Select View > Fit All.
Fill the Document window with the entire width of a page
Select View > Fit Width.
More Help topics
Status bar overview
Set download time and size preferences
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Dreamweaver calculates size based on the entire contents of the page, including all linked objects, such as images and
plug-ins. Dreamweaver estimates download time based on the connection speed entered in Status Bar preferences.
Actual download time varies depending on general Internet conditions.
A good guideline to use when checking download times for a particular web page is the 8-second rule. That is, most
users will not wait longer than 8 seconds for a page to load.
1Select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh).
2Select Status Bar from the Category list on the left.
3Select a connection speed with which to calculate download time and click OK.
More Help topics
Set window size and connection speed
Working with text
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
248
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Add text to a document
To add text to a Dreamweaver document, you can type text directly in the Document window, or you can cut and paste
text. You can also import text from other documents.
When you paste text into a Dreamweaver document, you can use either the Paste or the Paste Special command. The
Paste Special command lets you specify the format of pasted text in different ways. For example, if you wanted to paste
text from a formatted Microsoft Word document into your Dreamweaver document, but wanted to strip out all of the
formatting so that you could apply your own CSS style sheet to the pasted text, you could select the text in Word, copy
it to your Clipboard, and use the Paste Special command to select the option that lets you paste text only.
When using the Paste command to paste text from other applications, you can set paste preferences as default options.
Note: Control+V (Windows) and Command+V (Macintosh) always paste text only (no formatting) in Code view.
Add text to your document by doing one of the following:
Extract text from your PSD compositions using the Extract panel. For detailed information, see Copy text from
PSD files .
Type text directly into the Document window.
Copy text from another application, switch to Dreamweaver, position the insertion point in the Design view of
the Document window, and select Edit > Paste or Edit > Paste Special.
When you select Edit > Paste Special, you can select several paste formatting options.
You can also paste text using the following keyboard shortcuts:
Insert special characters
Certain special characters are represented in HTML by a name or a number, referred to as an entity. HTML includes
entity names for characters such as the copyright symbol (&copy;), the ampersand (&amp;), and the registered-
trademark symbol (&reg;). Each entity has both a name (such as &mdash;) and a numeric equivalent (such as &#151;).
HTML uses the angle brackets <> in its code, but you may need to express the special characters for greater than or less
than without Dreamweaver interpreting them as code. In this case, use &gt; for greater than (>) and &lt; for less than
(<).
Unfortunately, many older browsers don’t properly display many of the named entities.
1In the Document window, place the insertion point where you want to insert a special character.
2Do one of the following:
Select the name of the character from the Insert > HTML > Special Characters submenu.
In the Text category of the Insert panel, click the Characters button and select the character from the submenu.
Paste option Keyboard shortcut
Paste Control+V (Windows)
Command+V (Macintosh)
Paste Special Control+Shift+V (Windows)
Command+Shift+V (Macintosh)
249
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
There are many other special characters available; to select one of them, select Insert > HTML > Special Characters
> Other or click the Characters button in the Text category of the Insert panel and select the Other Characters option.
Select a character from the Insert Other Character dialog box, and click OK.
Add space between characters
HTML only allows for one space between characters; to add additional space in a document you must insert a non-
breaking space. You can set a preference to automatically add non-breaking spaces in a document.
Insert a non-breaking space
Do one of the following:
Select Insert > HTML > Special Characters > Non-Breaking Space.
Press Control+Shift+Spacebar (Windows) or Option+Spacebar (Macintosh).
In the Text category of the Insert panel, click the Characters button and select the Non-Breaking Space icon.
Set a preference to add non-breaking spaces
1Select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh).
2In the General category make sure Allow Multiple Consecutive Spaces is checked.
Add paragraph spacing
Dreamweaver works similarly to many word processing application: you press Enter (Windows) or Return (Macintosh)
to create a new paragraph. Web browsers automatically insert a blank line of space between paragraphs. You can add a
single line of space between paragraphs by inserting a line break.
Add a paragraph return
Press Enter (Windows) or Return (Macintosh).
Add a line break
Do one of the following:
Press Shift+Enter (Windows) or Shift+Return (Macintosh).
Select Insert > HTML > Special Characters > Line Break.
In the Text category of the Insert panel, click the Characters button and select the Line Break icon.
Create bulleted and numbered lists
You can create numbered (ordered) lists, bulleted (unordered) lists, and definition lists from existing text or from new
text as you type in the Document window.
Definition lists do not use leading characters like bullet points or numbers and are often used in glossaries or
descriptions. Lists can also be nested. Nested lists are lists that contain other lists. For example, you might want an
ordered or bulleted list nested within another numbered or ordered list.
You use the List Properties dialog box to set the appearance of an entire list or for an individual list item. You can set
number style, reset numbering, or set bullet style options for individual list items or for the entire list.
250
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Create a new list
1In the Dreamweaver document, place the insertion point where you want to add a list, then do one of the following:
In the HTML Property inspector, click either the Bulleted or Numbered List button.
Select Format > List and select the type of list desired—Unordered (bulleted) List, Ordered (numbered) List, or
Definition List.
The leading character for the specified list item appears in the Document window.
2Type the list item text, then press Enter (Windows) or Return (Macintosh) to create another list item.
3To complete the list, press Enter twice (Windows) or press Return twice (Macintosh).
Create a list using existing text
1Select a series of paragraphs to make into a list.
2In the HTML Property inspector, click the Bulleted or Numbered List button, or select Format > List and select the
type of list desired—Unordered List, Ordered List, or Definition List.
Create a nested list
1Select the list items you want to nest.
2In the HTML Property inspector, click the Blockquote button, or select Format > Indent.
Dreamweaver indents the text and creates a separate list with the original lists HTML attributes.
3Apply a new list type or style to the indented text by following the same procedure used above.
Set list properties for an entire list
1In the Document window, create at least one list item. The new style will automatically apply to additional items you
add to the list.
2With the insertion point in the list items text, select Format > List > Properties to open the List Properties dialog box.
3Set the options you want to define the list:
List Type Specifies list properties while List Item specifies an individual item in a list. Use the pop-up menu to select
a bulleted, numbered, directory, or menu list. Depending on the List Type you select different options appear in the
dialog box.
Style Determines the style of numbers or bullets used for a numbered or bulleted list. All items in the list will have
this style unless you specify a new style for items within the list.
Start Count Sets the value for the first item in a numbered list.
4Click OK to set the choices.
Set list properties for a list item
1In the Document window, place the insertion point in the text of a list item you want to affect
2Select Format > List > Properties.
3Under List Item, set the options you want to define:
New Style Specifies a style for the selected list item. Styles in the New Style menu are related to the type of list
displayed in the List Type menu. For example, if the List Item menu displays Bulleted List, only bullet options are
available in the New Style menu.
Reset Count To Sets a specific number from which to number list item entries.
251
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
4Click OK to set the options.
Search for and replace text
You can use the Find And Replace command to search for text and for HTML tags and attributes in a document or a
set of documents. The Search panel, in the Results panel group, shows the results of a Find All search.
Note: To search for files in a site, use different commands: Locate In Local Site and Locate In Remote Site.
Search for and replace text
1Open the document to search in, or select documents or a folder in the Files panel.
2Select Edit > Find And Replace.
3Use the Find In option to specify which files to search:
Selected Text Confines the search to the text thats currently selected in the active document.
Current Document Confines the search to the active document.
Open Documents Searches all documents that are currently open.
Folder Confines the search to a specific folder. After choosing Folder, click the folder icon to browse to and select a
folder to search.
Selected Files In Site Confines the search to the files and folders that are currently selected in the Files panel.
Entire Current Local Site Expands the search to all the HTML documents, library files, and text documents in the
current site.
4Use the Search pop-up menu to specify the kind of search you want to perform:
Source Code Searches for specific text strings in the HTML source code. You can search for specific tags using this
option, but the Specific Tag search provides a more flexible approach to searching for tags.
Text Searches for specific text strings in the text of the document. A text search ignores any HTML that interrupts
the string. For example, a search for the black dog would match both the black dog and the <i>black</i> dog.
Text (Advanced) Searches for specific text strings that are either within or not within a tag or tags. For example, in
a document that contains the following HTML, searching for tries and specifying Not Inside Tag and the i tag would
find only the second instance of the word tries: John <i>tries</i> to get his work done on time, but he doesnt always
succeed. He tries very hard. .
Specific Tag Searches for specific tags, attributes, and attribute values, such as all td tags with valign set to top.
Note: Pressing Control+Enter or Shift+Enter (Windows), or Control+Return, Shift+Return, or Command+Return
(Macintosh), adds line breaks within the text search fields, allowing you to search for a Return character. When
performing such a search, deselect the Ignore Whitespace Differences option if you’re not using regular expressions. This
search finds a Return character in particular, not simply the occurrence of a line break; for instance, it doesn’t find a tag
or a tag. Return characters appear as spaces in the Design view, not as line breaks.
5Use the following options to expand or limit the search:
Match Case Limits the search to text that exactly matches the case of the text you want to find. For example, if you
search for the brown derby, you will not find The Brown Derby.
Ignore Whitespace Treats all whitespace as a single space for the purposes of matching. For example, with this
option selected, this text would match this text and this text but not thistext. This option is not available when the
Use Regular Expressions option is selected; you must explicitly write your regular expression to ignore whitespace.
Note that <p> and <br> tags do not count as whitespace.
252
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Match Whole Word Limits the search to text that matches one or more complete words.
Note: Using this option is equivalent to doing a regular-expression search for a search string that starts and ends with
\b, the word-boundary regular expression.
Use Regular Expressions Causes certain characters and short strings (such as ?, *, \w, and \b) in your search string
to be interpreted as regular expression operators. For example, a search for the b\w*\b dog will match both the black
dog and the barking dog.
Note: If you are working in Code view and make changes to your document, and try to find and replace anything other
than source code, a dialog box appears letting you know that Dreamweaver is synchronizing the two views before doing
the search.
6To search without replacing, click Find Next or Find All:
Find Next Jumps to and selects the next occurrence of the search text or tags in the current document. If there are
no more instances of the tag in the current document, Dreamweaver proceeds to the next document, if you are
searching in more than one document.
Find All Opens the Search panel in the Results panel group. If you are searching a single document, Find All displays
all occurrences of the search text or tags, with some surrounding context. If you are searching a directory or site,
Find All displays a list of documents that contain the tag.
7To replace found text or tags, click Replace or Replace All.
8When you’re finished, click Close.
Search again without displaying the Find And Replace dialog box
Press F3 (Windows) or Command+G (Macintosh).
View a particular search result in context
1Select Window > Results to display the Search panel.
2Double-click a line in the Search panel.
If youre searching the current file, the Document window displays the line containing that search result.
If youre searching a set of files, the file containing that search result opens.
Perform the same search again
Click the Find And Replace button.
Stop a search in progress
Click the Stop button.
Search for a specific tag
Use the Find And Replace dialog box to search for text or tags in a document, and to replace the found material with
other text or tags.
1Select Edit > Find And Replace.
2In the Search pop-up menu, select Specific Tag.
3Select a specific tag or [any tag] from the pop-up menu next to the Search pop-up menu, or type a tag name in the
text box.
253
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
4(Optional.) Limit the search with one of the following tag modifiers:
With Attribute Specifies an attribute that must be in the tag for it to match. You can specify a particular value for the
attribute or select [any value].
Without Attribute Selects an attribute that must not be in the tag for it to match. For example, select this option to
search for all img tags with no alt attribute.
Containing Specifies text or a tag that must be contained within the original tag for it to match. For example, in the
code <b><font size="4">heading 1</font></b>, the font tag is contained within the b tag.
Not Containing Specifies text or a tag that must not be contained within the original tag for it to match.
Inside Tag Specifies a tag that the target tag must be contained in for it to match.
Not Inside Tag Specifies a tag that the target tag must not be contained in for it to match.
5(Optional.) To limit the search further, click the Plus (+) button and repeat step 3.
6If you didnt apply any tag modifiers in steps 3 and 4, then click the Minus (-) button to remove the tag modifiers
pop-up menu.
7If you want to perform an action when the tag is found (such as removing or replacing the tag), select the action
from the Action pop-up menu and, if applicable, specify any additional information necessary to perform the
action.
Search for specific text (Advanced)
Use the Find and Replace dialog box to search for text or tags in a document, and to replace the found material with
other text or tags.
1Select Edit > Find and Replace.
2In the Search pop-up menu, select Text (Advanced).
3Enter text in the text field adjacent to the Search pop-up menu.
For example, type the word Untitled.
4Select Inside Tag or Not Inside Tag, and then select a tag from the adjacent pop-up menu.
For example, select Inside Tag and then title.
5(Optional.) Click the Plus (+) button to limit the search with one of the following tag modifiers:
With Attribute Specifies an attribute that must be in the tag for it to match. You can specify a particular value for the
attribute or select [any value].
Without Attribute Selects an attribute that must not be in the tag for it to match. For example, select this option to
search for all img tags with no alt attribute.
Containing Specifies text or a tag that must be contained within the original tag for it to match. For example, in the
code <b><font size="4">heading 1</font></b>, the font tag is contained within the b tag.
Not Containing Specifies text or a tag that must not be contained within the original tag for it to match.
Inside Tag Specifies a tag that the target tag must be contained in for it to match.
Not Inside Tag Specifies a tag that the target tag must not be contained in for it to match.
6(Optional.) To limit the search further, repeat step 4.
254
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Define abbreviations and acronyms
HTML provides tags that let you define the abbreviations and acronyms you use in your page for search engines, spell
checkers, language translation programs, or speech synthesizers. For example, you might want to specify that the
abbreviation ME in your page stands for mechanical engineer, or the acronym WHO stands for World Health
Organization.
1Select the abbreviation or acronym in the text of your page.
2Select Insert > HTML > Text Objects > Abbreviation, or Insert > HTML > Text Objects > Acronym.
3Enter the full text of the acronym or abbreviation.
4Enter the language, such as en for English, de for German, or it for Italian.
Set copy and paste preferences
You can set special paste preferences as default options when using Edit > Paste to paste text from other applications.
For example, if you always want to paste text as text only, or text with basic formatting, you can set the default option
in the Copy/Paste Preferences dialog box.
Note: When you paste text into a Dreamweaver document, you can use either the Paste or the Paste Special command. The
Paste Special command lets you specify the format of pasted text in different ways. For example, if you wanted to paste text
from a formatted Microsoft Word document into your Dreamweaver document, but wanted to strip out all of the
formatting so that you could apply your own CSS style sheet to the pasted text, you could select the text in Word, copy it to
your Clipboard, and use the Paste Special command to select the option that lets you paste text only.
Note: Preferences set in the Copy/Paste Preferences dialog box apply only to material pasted into Design view.
1Select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver Preferences (Macintosh).
2Click the Copy/Paste category.
3Set the following options and click OK.
Text Only Lets you paste unformatted text. If the original text is formatted, all formatting, including line breaks and
paragraphs, will be removed.
Text With Structure Lets you paste text that retains structure, but does not retain basic formatting. For example, you
can paste text and retain the structure of paragraphs, lists, and tables, without retaining bold, italics, and other
formatting.
Text With Structure Plus Basic Formatting Lets you paste both structured and simple HTML-formatted text (e.g.,
paragraphs and tables, as well as text formatted with the b, i, u, strong, em, hr, abbr, or acronym tag).
Text With Structure Plus Full Formatting Lets you paste text that retains all structure, HTML formatting, and CSS
styles.
Note: The Full Formatting option cannot retain CSS styles that come from an external style sheet, nor can it retain styles
if the application from which you are pasting does not retain styles upon pasting to the Clipboard.
Retain Line Breaks Lets you keep line breaks in pasted text. This option is disabled if you have selected Text Only.
Clean Up Word Paragraph Spacing Select this option if you selected Text With Structure or Text With Structure Plus
Basic Formatting, and want to eliminate extra space between paragraphs when you paste your text.
More Help topics
Video tutorial: How to work with HTML text
Extract text from PSD files
255
Page content and assets
Set CSS properties
Viewing code
Regular expressions
Arabic and Hebrew text
New and improved features for working in Arabic and Hebrew are available in the Middle East and North African
edition of this software.
Bi-directional text flow
Text in Middle Eastern languages is mostly written from right to left (RTL). However, in general, the most commonly
used form is bi-directional (bidi) text - a mix of left-to-right and right-to-left text. An example of bidi text is a paragraph
that includes Arabic and English text. In CS6, you can use Dreamweaver to type Arabic, Hebrew, or bidi text, in design
view and code view.
In Dreamweaver Middle Eastern version, Right-to-left direction attribute can be applied to two notional objects,
paragraphs and characters. The direction attribute can be applied to tags supported in the HTML specification. The
direction attribute can take values: ltr (default), rtl, or inherit.
When you enter Arabic, Hebrew, or mixed text, Dreamweaver recognizes the languages as Right-to-left (RTL) and
displays it text appropriately.
Tag editor
You can apply direction and language settings using the Tag Editor.
Text direction and Unicode-bidi in CSS Rules
You can specify the Text direction as a CSS rule. In the CSS Rule definition dialog box, specify Direction and Unicode-
bidi options.
Table properties
Right-to-left tables are right aligned, and columns are ordered from right to left. The resizing handles appear on the left
side. On tabbing, the cursor moves in RTL direction..
Specify the table direction using the Properties panel.
Last updated 6/3/2015
256
Last updated 6/3/2015
DOM panel: (Windows > DOM) Shows the HTML structure of your document and lets you copy-paste, duplicate,
delete, and rearrange the elements within the view. See DOM panelfor more information.
Element Display: Appears above the selected HTML element in Live View. Element Display lets you associate
HTML elements with classes and IDs. See Associate HTML elements with classes and IDs for more information.
Quick Property Inspector: Appears when you click the Sandwich icon in Element Display or select text. Quick
Property Inspector lets you edit image attributes and format text in Live View. See Quick Property Inspector for
more information.
Live View Property Inspector: Appears below the Document window and lets you edit various HTML and CSS
properties in Live View. See Live View Property Inspector for more information.
Insert panel: (Window > Insert) Lets you drag elements from the panel directly into Live View. See Insert elements
directly in Live View for more information.
Note: If your page changes dynamically (because of scripts) or has metarefresh enabled, then the edits that you do in Live
View may be lost.
Tips:
If Live View goes blank when you are editing the page, switch off Live View and switch it on again.
If you do not see the edits reflected on the page, click the refresh button in Live View.
Content that is rendered dynamically through databases or JavaScript, and non-editable regions in templates cannot be
edited in Live View. When you click such elements in Live View, a grey border appears around them to indicate that the
elements cannot be edited.
Page content and assets
Div properties
Use Direction to specify the Div direction in the Properties.
Edit in Live View
Live View uses a chromium-based rendering engine so that your content looks the same in Dreamweaver as it looks in
your favourite web browsers. During development, you can switch to Live View to quickly preview your page. And, to
save time switching between different views (code and design view), you can edit HTML elements directly within Live
View.
Live View refreshes instantly to show the changes on the page.
Hands-on tutorial
How to design, edit, and preview web pages with new Live View features
(Try-it, 60 min)
You can use the following components to edit your page in Live View:
257
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: In Live View, only those options that are applicable for the selected element are made available in the main menu.
Options that are not applicable are greyed out when the element is selected.
Element Display
Using Element Display, you can associate HTML elements with classes and IDs directly in Live View. The Element
Display hints you with the available classes and IDs to help you quickly view and choose the required option.
You can also format tables using Element Display. For more information, see link.
Associate HTML elements with classes and IDs
Click the required element in Live View. The Element Display appears and displays the currently associated class and
ID.
While in Live View, you can also click the HTML element in the DOM panel to see the Element Display for the element.
To dissociate the HTML element from a class or ID, click ‘x’ adjacent to the class or ID.
To change the class or ID associated with the HTML element, click in the box. A list of available classes and IDs
appears. Click the required option.
To add a class or an ID and apply it to the element, click ‘+’, and type in the name. To save the changes, click '+' or
press Enter.
You can then use the CSS Designer to define a selector that includes this class or ID.
Note: Element Display of transitional elements does not move along with the elements when the transition is triggered.
However, the changes that you make using the Element Display take effect even though it is not at the same location as the
transitional element.
Quick Property Inspector
Quick Property Inspector appears right above the selected elements in Live View. Using this Property Inspector, you
can edit attributes, or format text in Live View.
258
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
To show or hide Quick Property Inspector, press Ctrl+Alt+H (Win)/CMD+Ctrl+H (Mac).
Note: Code navigator icon is not displayed in Live View when you use Quick Property Inspector.
More Help topics
Edit HTML attributes
Edit text directly in Live View
Format text
Live View Property Inspector
Live View Property Inspector is the traditional Property Inspector that is available below the Document window.
The Live View Property Inspector lets you examine and edit the most common properties for the currently selected
page element, such as text or an inserted object. The contents of the Live View Property Inspector vary depending on
the element selected.
Note: Live View Property Inspector is not available in Fluid Grid pages.
To access Help for a particular Property Inspector, click the Help button in the upper right corner of the Property
Inspector. Or, select Help from a Property Inspector’s Options menu.
259
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
The following are the elements that you can edit using Live View Property Inspector:
HTML
CSS
Image
Table
Media - only HTML5 Audio and HTML5 Video
Anchor
Form
FormButton
FormTextArea
FormSubmitButton
FormRange
FormRadioButton
FormList
FormImage
FormFile
FormCheckBox
FormColor
FormDate
FormDateTime
FormDateTimeLocal
FormMonth
FormTime
FormWeek
FormNumber
FormLabel
FormHidden
FormGeneric
Note: jQuery UI and template-related properties are not available for editing in the Live View Property Inspector.
Edit HTML attributes
You can quickly add, edit, or remove HTML attributes of images directly in Live View using the Quick Property
Inspector.
The Quick Property Inspector for images appears when you click the sandwich icon . Depending on the space
available, the Property Inspector appears on the right, left, top, bottom, or above the image. You can move around the
Property Inspector and place it at any convenient position.
260
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
To edit the attributes, click the sandwich icon in the Quick Property Inspector. You can change the source of the image
along with other attributes such as “title” and ”alt, and the changes are reflected instantaneously. Similarly you can also
adjust the Width and Height of the image in Live View.
The changes that you make are saved when you do any of the following:
Click anywhere outside the Property Inspector
Press Enter
Press Tab to edit another attribute in the Property Inspector
Save the file
When images are loaded dynamically, you can use the Quick Property Inspector of the image to quickly inspect the
attributes that are set for the image.
Edit text directly in Live View
You can now edit text elements directly in Live View. You can simply double-click the text element to edit it. Or, you
can click the text element to see the Element Display and then press Enter.
Note: When you press Enter after entering into the edit mode, the results vary depending on where the insertion point was
before you pressed Enter. The changes are similar to what happens when you press Enter while editing text in Design View.
261
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
The orange border around the text element indicates that the mode is changed to edit mode.
The insertion point is positioned at the position of double-click. To select all the text in the text element, triple-click
the text element.
Note: If you delete all the text and type in the text again, the strong and em tags are reordered or rearranged.
Cut, copy-paste, and undo-redo are supported while you edit text in Live View. When you paste text, it is pasted as plain
text.
The following table lists the supported and unsupported scenarios during text editing in Live View:
Format text
You can now change the formatting of text and hyperlink text directly in Live View. To see the text formatting options,
select a word or a phrase. The Quick Property Inspector with formatting options appears just above the selected text.
Supported Not supported
All HTML elements that can contain text Editing of invalid or broken tags. If the HTML contains broken or invalid
tags, then editing of such tags is governed by the way browsers
perceive these tags:
If browsers fix your HTML for you such that it closes
the broken tag, then you may be allowed to edit the
tags in Live View.
If browsers add a new tag while rendering, then you
cannot edit the broken or invalid tags.
HTML files derived from templates in Live View Editing of jQuery Pages
Structural tags containing inline elements. They are presented
together in a single box for editing.
Editing of tags that have both static and dynamic content. While you
can edit the selectors for such tags, you cannot edit text directly in Live
View. If you double-click such elements in Live View, a grey border
appears around them, indicating that text editing is not supported.
Static text in dynamic pages
Fluid Grid pages in Live View without grids
Text containing entities
262
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Insert elements directly in Live View
Using the Insert panel, you can directly drag elements into the required position in the document in Live View. Visual
aids in Live View such as Live Guides and DOM icons help you position the dragged elements with respect to a hovered
element.
Live Guides (in green) appear as you hover the mouse over different elements on the page before dropping the element.
These guides indicate the positions where the element can be inserted. They can appear above, below, left, or to the
right of the element that is hovered over.
Above and Below - Appears while hovering over all types of elements/tags, except inline tags. When you hover the
mouse in the first (top) 50% of the element, guides appear above the hovered element. When you hover the mouse
in the last (bottom) 50% of the element, guides appear below the hovered element.
Left and Right - Appears while hovering over inline tags, for example, <a>, <span>, or over tags that have the 'float
property' set.
263
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
When you pause for a while before dropping the element, the DOM icon (</>) appears. When you hover your mouse
over this icon, the DOM panel opens and you can drop the element inside the DOM structure of the document.
To insert elements directly in Live View, perform the following steps:
1Switch to Live View.
2From the Insert panel, click the required element and drag it into the document. Alternatively, you can just click the
required element in the Insert panel.
Tip: If you are unable to drag an element from the Insert panel on to the page, restart your computer and try again.
3Drop the element at the top, bottom, right or left of an element based on Live Guides. Or, drop the element at a
precise place in the document structure by clicking </> and using the DOM panel.
The element gets inserted into the page and is highlighted.
Note: Insert panel is not available in Live View for Fluid Grid pages.
Marquee selection
Marquee selection allows you to easily select a block of text by clicking and dragging inside the tag in Live View. When
you click and drag a block of text in Dreamweaver releases prior to 2014.1, the element used to move as a whole.
Note: Marquee selection in live view is restricted to browser-supported operations.
Selection and dragging-and-dropping of elements
In Live View, you can move an element by clicking on the tag name and then dragging to the desired location. When
you click on a tag name, a hand cursor icon appears indicating that you can drag the tag from the point. When ou start
dragging the tag, guides help you place it in the precise location.
By clicking on the tag name in Live View, you can select the full contents of that tag in Code View.
264
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Keyboard navigation in Live View
You can traverse page elements or selectors in Element Display using your keyboard to quicken the editing process.
Traverse page elements
Up and Down arrow keys help you traverse page elements in Live View. The traversal is based on the DOM structure
of the document.
Keyboard navigation in Live View facilitates easy access to nested and wrapped elements.
When you access an element using the up or down arrow key, the Element Display for that element appears. You can
then navigate to the selectors in the Element Display or press Enter to edit the text directly in Live View.
265
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Traverse selectors
Press the Tab key to traverse through the selectors in Element Display. The selector in focus is displayed with an amber
border as shown below:
If you press the Tab key after the last applied selector, the add selector text box appears.
You can use Ctrl+[ or Cmd+[ to select the parent element and Ctrl+] or Cmd+] to select the child element.
Disable editing in Live View
If you prefer not to use Element Display and Quick Property Inspector in Live View, you can disable these editing
features.
Keyboard shortcuts:
(Win) Ctrl+Alt+H
(Mac) Cmd+Ctrl+H
1Switch to Live View and click Live View Options ( ).
2Select Hide Live View Displays.
266
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Unsupported scenarios
Dreaweaver template files cannot be edited in Live View.
Tags that have both static and dynamic content. While you can edit the selectors for such tags, you cannot edit text
in Live View. If you double-click such elements in Live View, a grey border appears around them, indicating that text
editing is not supported.
Tags that have pseudo selectors applied to them. You may encounter unexpected results when you try to edit such
elements in Live View.
DOM panel
The DOM panel renders an interactive HTML tree for static and dynamic content. This view helps you visually map
elements in Live View with their HTML markup and the applied selectors in CSS Designer. You can also make edits to
the HTML structure in the DOM panel and see the changes take effect instantly in Live View.
Step-by-step tutorial
How to visualize and visually modify your HTML structure in Dreamweaver (30 min)
To open the DOM panel, select Window > DOM. You can also use the keyboard keys - Ctrl + / (Win); Cmd + / (Mac)
- to open the DOM panel.
When you drag elments to directly insert them in Live View, the </> icon appears before you drop the element. You can
click this icon to open the DOM panel and insert the element at the appropriate position in the document structure.
For more information, see Inserting elements directly in Live View .
The DOM panel displays only static elements in Code or Design view, and both static and dynamic elements in Live
view.
In fluid grid documents, the DOM panel only lets you visualize the HTML DOM structure and does not let you edit
the HTML structure.
Note: You can edit only the static content in the DOM panel. Read-only or dynamic elements are shown in a darker shade
of grey.
267
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
You can move around the DOM panel and place it at any convenient location on the user interface. You can also dock
the panel along with other panels.
How to use the DOM panel
1Open the required document and then open the DOM panel by selecting Window > DOM.
2Switch to Live view and click the element that you want to inspect or edit.
The HTML markup of the selected element is highlighted in the DOM panel.
The applied selector is highlighted in CSS Designer.
The relevant code is highlighted in the Code view.
The relevant tag is highlighted (in blue) in Tag Selector.
Alternatively, you can select an HTML element in the DOM panel. When you click any element in the DOM panel:
Live View scrolls to the corresponding element.
If Code View is open, the Code View scrolls to the code corresponding to the element.
CSS Designer (Selectors pane) scrolls to the closest corresponding selector (similar to you clicking the element
in Live View).
The tag is highlighted in the Tag Selector.
This syncing between different views and CSS Designer lets you visualize the HTML markup and styling associated
with the selected element at a glance.
3Proceed to edit the element as required (HTML or CSS editing). For information on using the DOM panel to edit
the HTML markup, see Edit HTML structure using the DOM panel . For information on CSS Designer, see CSS
Designer panel.
268
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Edit HTML structure using the DOM panel
The current selected element on the page is highlighted in the DOM panel. You can navigate to any node or element
using the arrow keys.
To select an element or a node, click the element or node. To expand or collapse an element or a node, click the
HTML tag or double-click the selector adjacent to the tag.
To duplicate an element or a node, right-click the element or the node, and click Duplicate. When you duplicate an
element with an ID associated with it, the ID is incremented for the new (duplicate) element.
To copy an element or a node, right-click the element or the node, and click Copy. If you have copied an element
with children, the child elements are also copied.
To paste an element or a node, click the element or the node under which you want to nest the copied elements.
Then, right-click the element or the node and click Paste.
To paste the copied element as a child of a specific element or node, right-click the element or node (parent), and
then click Paste As Child.
To move or rearrange elements, drag the element to the required location within the DOM panel.
A green line appears to indicate where the dragged element will be positioned. If you drop the element over the element
highlighted in gray (reference element), then the dropped element is positioned as the first child of the reference
element.
To delete an element or a node, right-click the element or the node, and click Delete.
You can undo (Ctrl/Cmd + Z) or redo (Ctrl/Cmd + Y) the operations that you perform in the DOM panel.
Keyboard shortcuts:
Duplicate - Ctrl + D (Win)/ Cmd + D (Mac)
Delete - Del or Backspace
Copy - Ctrl + C (Win)/Cmd + C (Mac)
Paste - Ctrl + V (Win)/Cmd + V (Mac)
Undo - Ctrl + Z (Win)/Cmd + Z (Mac)
Redo - Ctrl + Y (Win)/Cmd + Y (Mac)
Note: Typically, when a page is edited, the Refresh button in the Document toolbar changes to Stop button indicating that
the page is reloading. After the page is reloaded, the Refresh button appears again to indicate that the page has completely
loaded. When you make changes in the DOM panel, the page may take a while to reload even after the Refresh button
appears back again after changing to Stop button.
269
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
A Location where the dragged element is placed B Reference element C Element being moved
Important: If your page contains JavaScript, the right-click menu in the DOM panel gets displayed for a while and then
becomes unavailable. To use the right-click menu, hide the Live View displays (Live View options > Hide Live View
Displays), and then disable JavaScript (Live View options > Disable JavaScript).
Set text properties in the Property inspector
You can use the text Property inspector to apply HTML formatting or Cascading Style Sheet (CSS) formatting. When
you apply HTML formatting, Dreamweaver adds properties to the HTML code in the body of your page. When you
apply CSS formatting, Dreamweaver writes properties to the head of the document or to a separate style sheet.
270
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: When you create CSS inline styles, Dreamweaver adds style attribute code directly to the body of the page.
About formatting text (CSS versus HTML)
Formatting text in Dreamweaver is similar to using a standard word processor. You can set default formatting styles
(Paragraph, Heading 1, Heading 2, and so on) for a block of text, change the font, size, color, and alignment of selected
text, or apply text styles such as bold, italic, code (monospace), and underline.
Dreamweaver has two Property inspectors, integrated into one: the CSS Property inspector and the HTML Property
inspector. When you use the CSS Property inspector, Dreamweaver formats text using Cascading Style Sheets (CSS).
CSS gives web designers and developers greater control over web page design, while providing improved features for
accessibility and reduced file size. The CSS Property inspector lets you access existing styles, as well as create new ones.
Using CSS is a way to control the style of a web page without compromising its structure. By separating visual design
elements (fonts, colors, margins, and so on) from the structural logic of a web page, CSS gives web designers visual and
typographic control without sacrificing the integrity of the content. In addition, defining typographic design and page
layout from within a single, distinct block of codewithout having to resort to image maps, font tags, tables, and spacer
GIFs—allows for faster downloads, streamlined site maintenance, and a central point from which to control design
attributes across multiple web pages.
You can store styles created with CSS directly in the document, or for more power and flexibility, you can store styles
in an external style sheet. If you attach an external style sheet to several web pages, all the pages automatically reflect
any changes you make to the style sheet. To access all CSS rules for a page, use the CSS Styles panel (Window > CSS
Styles). To access rules that apply to a current selection, use the CSS Styles panel (Current mode) or the Targeted Rule
pop-up menu in the CSS Property inspector.
If you prefer, you can use HTML markup tags to format text in your web pages. To use HTML tags instead of CSS,
format your text using the HTML Property inspector.
Note: You can combine CSS and HTML 3.2 formatting within the same page. Formatting is applied in a hierarchical
manner: HTML 3.2 formatting overrides formatting applied by external CSS style sheets, and CSS embedded in a
document overrides external CSS.
Edit CSS rules in the Property inspector
1Open the Property inspector (Window > Properties), if it isn’t already open and click the CSS button.
2Do one of the following:
Place the insertion point inside a block of text thats been formatted by a rule you want to edit. The rule appears
in the Targeted Rule pop-up menu.
Select a rule from the Targeted Rule pop-up menu.
3Make changes to the rule by using the various options in the CSS Property inspector.
Targeted Rule Is the rule you are editing in the CSS Property inspector. When you have an existing style applied to
text, the rule affecting the text’s format appears when you click inside the text on the page. You can also use the
Targeted Rule pop-up menu to create new CSS rules, new in-line styles, or apply existing classes to selected text. If
you’re creating a new rule, you’ll need to complete the New CSS Rule dialog box. For more information, see the links
at the end of this topic.
Edit Rule Opens the CSS Rule Definition dialog box for the targeted rule. If you select New CSS Rule from the
Targeted Rule pop-up menu and click the Edit Rule button, Dreamweaver opens the New CSS Rule definition dialog
box instead.
CSS Panel Opens the CSS Styles panel and displays properties for the targeted rule in Current view.
271
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Font Changes the font of the targeted rule.
Size Sets the font size for the targeted rule.
Text Color Sets the selected color as the font color in the targeted rule. Select a web-safe color by clicking the color
box, or enter a hexadecimal value (for example, #FF0000) in the adjacent text field.
Bold Adds the bold property to the targeted rule.
Italic Adds the italics property to the targeted rule.
Left, Center, and Right Align Adds the respective alignment properties to the targeted rule.
note: The Font, Size, Text Color, Bold, Italic, and Alignment properties always display the properties for the rule that
applies to the current selection in the Document window. When you change any of these properties, you affect the
targeted rule.
Set HTML formatting in the Property inspector
1Open the Property inspector (Window > Properties), if it isn’t already open, and click the HTML button.
2Select the text you want to format.
3Set the options you want to apply to the selected text:
Format Sets the paragraph style of the selected text. Paragraph applies the default format for a <p> tag, Heading 1
adds an H1 tag, and so on.
ID Assigns an ID to your selection. The ID pop-up menu (if applicable) lists all of the documents unused, declared
IDs.
Class Displays the class style that is currently applied to the selected text. If no styles have been applied to the
selection, the pop-up menu shows No CSS Style. If multiple styles have been applied to the selection, the menu is
blank.
Use the Style menu to do any of the following:
Select the style you want to apply to the selection.
Select None to remove the currently selected style.
Select Rename to rename the style.
Select Attach Style Sheet to open a dialog box that lets you attach an external style sheet to the page.
Bold Applies either <b> or <strong> to the selected text according to the style preference set in the General category
of the Preferences dialog box.
Italic Applies either <i> or <em> to the selected text according to the style preference set in the General category of
the Preferences dialog box.
Unordered List Creates a bulleted list of the selected text. If no text is selected, a new bulleted list is started.
Ordered List Creates a numbered list of the selected text. If no text is selected, a new numbered list is started.
Blockquote and Remove Blockquote Indent or remove indentation from the selected text by applying or removing
the blockquote tag. In a list, indenting creates a nested list and removing the indentation unnests the list.
Link Creates a hypertext link of the selected text. Click the folder icon to browse to a file in your site; type the URL;
drag the Point-To-File icon to a file in the Files panel; or drag a file from the Files panel into the box.
Title Specifies the textual tooltip for a hypertext link.
272
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Target Specifies the frame or window in which the linked document will load:
_blank loads the linked file in a new, unnamed browser window.
_parent loads the linked file in the parent frameset or window of the frame that contains the link. If the frame
containing the link is not nested, the linked file loads into the full browser window.
_self loads the linked file in the same frame or window as the link. This target is implied, so you generally don’t
need to specify it.
_top loads the linked file in the full browser window, thereby removing all frames.
Rename a class from the HTML Property inspector
Dreamweaver displays all of the classes available to your page in the Class menu of the HTML Property inspector. You
can rename styles in this list by selecting the Rename option at the end of the list of class styles.
1Select Rename from the text Property inspector Style pop-up menu.
2Select the style you want to rename from the Rename Style pop-up menu.
3Enter a new name in the New Name text field and click OK.
More Help topics
Open the CSS Styles panel
Understanding Cascading StyleSheets
Spell check a web page
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Use the Check Spelling command to check the spelling in the current document. The document must be a web page
(for example, an HTML, ColdFusion, or PHP page). The Check Spelling command does not work on text files or XML
files.
Additionally, the Check Spelling command ignores HTML tags and attribute values.
Note: Dreamweaver can only spell check the file that is currently open in the Document window. It cannot spell check all
of the files in a site simultaneously.
By default, the spelling checker uses the U.S. English spelling dictionary. To change the dictionary, select Edit >
Preferences > General (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences > General (Macintosh), then in the Spelling
Dictionary pop-up menu select the dictionary you want to use.
1Select Commands > Check Spelling or press Shift+F7.
When Dreamweaver encounters an unrecognized word, the Check Spelling dialog box appears.
2Select the appropriate option based on how you want the discrepancy handled.
Add To Personal Adds the unrecognized word to your personal dictionary.
Ignore Ignores this instance of the unrecognized word.
Change Replaces this instance of the unrecognized word with text that you type in the Change To text box or with
the selection in the Suggestions list.
273
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Ignore All Ignores all instances of the unrecognized word.
Change All Replaces all instances of the unrecognized word in the same manner.
Note: Dreamweaver does not provide a way of deleting entries that have been added to personal dictionaries.
Import tabular data
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
You can import tabular data into your document by first saving the files (such as Microsoft Excel files or database files)
as delimited text files.
You can import and format tabular data and import text from Microsoft Word HTML documents.
You can also add text from Microsoft Excel documents to a Dreamweaver document by importing the contents of the
Excel file into a web page.
1Select File > Import > Import Tabular Data, or Insert > Table Objects > Import Tabular Data.
2Browse for the file you want or enter its name in the text box.
3Select the delimiter used when the file was saved as delimited text. Your options are Tab, Comma, Semicolon, Colon,
and Other.
If you select Other, a blank field appears next to the option. Enter the character that was used as a delimiter.
4Use the remaining options to format or define the table into which the data will be imported and click OK.
More Help topics
Open and edit existing documents
Import and export tabular data
Import Microsoft Office documents (Windows only)
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
You can insert the full contents of a Microsoft Word or Excel document in a new or existing web page. When you import
a Word or Excel document, Dreamweaver receives the converted HTML and inserts it into your web page. The files
size, after Dreamweaver receives the converted HTML, must be less than 300K.
Instead of importing the entire contents of a file, you can also paste portions of a Word document and preserve the
formatting.
Note: If you use Microsoft Office 97, you cannot import the contents of a Word or Excel document; you must insert a link
to the document.
1Open the web page into which you want to insert the Word or Excel document.
2In Design view, do one of the following to select the file:
Drag the file from its current location to the page where you want the content to appear.
274
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Select File > Import > Word Document or File > Import > Excel Document.
3In the Insert Document dialog box, browse to the file you want to add, select any of the formatting options from the
Formatting pop-up menu at the bottom of the dialog box, and then click Open.
Text Only Inserts unformatted text. If the original text is formatted, all formatting will be removed.
Text With Structure Inserts text that retains structure, but does not retain basic formatting. For example, you can
paste text and retain the structure of paragraphs, lists, and tables, without retaining bold, italics, and other
formatting.
Text With Structure Plus Basic Formatting Inserts both structured and simple HTML-formatted text (e.g.,
paragraphs and tables, as well as text formatted with the b, i, u, strong, em, hr, abbr, or acronym tag).
Text With Structure Plus Full Formatting Inserts text that retains all structure, HTML formatting, and CSS styles.
Clean Up Word Paragraph Spacing Eliminates extra space between paragraphs when you paste your text if you
selected Text With Structure or Basic Formatting.
The contents of the Word or Excel document appear in your page.
Create a link to a Word or Excel document
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
You can insert a link to a Microsoft Word or Excel document in an existing page.
1Open the page where you want the link to appear.
2Drag the file from its current location to your Dreamweaver page, positioning the link wherever you want.
3Select Create A Link, and then click OK.
4If the document you are linking to is located outside of your sites root folder, Dreamweaver prompts you to copy the
document to the site root.
By copying the document to the sites root folder, you ensure that the document will be available when you publish
the website.
5When you upload your page to your web server, make sure to upload the Word or Excel file, too.
Your page now contains a link to the Word or Excel document. The link text is the name of the linked file; you can
change the link text in the Document window if you wish.
Use HTML Formatting
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
While CSS is the preferred method for formatting text, Dreamweaver still lets you format text with HTML.
275
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Format paragraphs
Use the Format pop-up menu in the HTML Property inspector or the Format > Paragraph Format submenu to apply
the standard paragraph and heading tags.
1Place the insertion point in the paragraph, or select some of the text in the paragraph.
2Using the Format > Paragraph Format submenu or the Format pop-up menu in the Property inspector, select an
option:
Select a paragraph format (for example, Heading 1, Heading 2, Preformatted Text, and so on). The HTML tag
associated with the selected style (for example, h1 for Heading 1, h2 for Heading 2, pre for Preformatted text, and
so on) is applied to the entire paragraph.
Select None to remove a paragraph format.
When you apply a heading tag to a paragraph, Dreamweaver automatically adds the next line of text as a standard
paragraph. To change this setting, select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences
(Macintosh); then in the General category, under Editing Options, make sure Switch To Plain Paragraph After
Heading is not selected.
Change the color of text
You can change the default color of all the text in a page, or you can change the color of selected text in the page.
Define default text colors for a page
Select Modify > Page Properties > Appearance (HTML) or Links (HTML), and then select colors for the Text Color,
Link Color, Visited Links, and Active Links options.
Note: The active link color is the color that a link changes to while its being clicked. Some web browsers may not use the
color you specify.
Change the color of selected text
Select Format > Color, select a color from the system color picker, and then click OK.
Align text
You align text with HTML using the Format > Align submenu. You can center any element on a page using the Format
> Align > Center command.
Align text on a page
1Select the text you want to align or simply insert the pointer at the beginning of the text.
2Select Format > Align and select an alignment command.
Center page elements
1Select the element (image, plug-in, table, or other page element) you want to center.
2Select Format > Align > Center.
Note: You can align and center complete blocks of text; you cannot align or center part of a heading or part of a
paragraph.
276
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Indent text
Using the Indent command applies the blockquote HTML tag to a paragraph of text, indenting text on both sides of the
page.
1Place the insertion point in the paragraph you want to indent.
2Select Format > Indent or Outdent, or select List > Indent or Outdent from the context menu.
Note: You can apply multiple indents to a paragraph. Each time you select this command, the text indents further from
both sides of the document.
Apply font styles
You can use HTML to apply text formatting to one letter, or to entire paragraphs and blocks of text in a site. Use the
Format menu to set or change font characteristics for selected text. You can set the font type, style (such as bold or
italic), and size.
1Select the text. If no text is selected, the option applies to subsequent text you type.
2Select from the following options:
To change the font, select a font combination from the Format > Font submenu. Select Default to remove
previously applied fonts. Default applies the default font for the selected text (either the browser default font or
the font assigned to that tag in the CSS style sheet).
To change the font style, select a font style (Bold, Italic, Underline, and so on) from the Format > Style submenu.
More Help topics
Set text propertiesin the Property inspector
Set CSS properties
Use the color picker
Creating pages with CSS
Create a new CSS rule
Use horizontal rules
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Horizontal rules (lines) are useful for organizing information. On a page, you can visually separate text and objects with
one or more rules.
Create a horizontal rule
1In the Document window, place the insertion point where you want to insert a horizontal rule.
2Select Insert > HTML > Horizontal Rule.
Modify a horizontal rule
1In the Document window, select the horizontal rule.
277
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
2Select Window > Properties to open the Property inspector, and modify the properties as desired:
The ID text box Lets you specify an ID for the horizontal rule.
W and H Specify the width and height of the rule in pixels or as a percentage of the page size.
Align Specifies the alignment of the rule (Default, Left, Center, or Right). This setting applies only if the width of
the rule is less than the width of the browser window.
Shading Specifies whether the rule is drawn with shading. Deselect this option to draw the rule in a solid color.
Class Lets you attach a style sheet, or apply a class from an already attached style sheet.
Modify font combinations
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Use the Edit Font List command to set the font combinations that appear in the Property inspector and the Format >
Font submenu.
Font combinations determine how a browser displays text in your web page. A browser uses the first font in the
combination that is installed on the users system; if none of the fonts in the combination is installed, the browser
displays the text as specified by the users browser preferences.
Modify font combinations
1Select Format > Font > Edit Font List.
2Select the font combination from the list at the top of the dialog box.
The fonts in the selected combination are listed in the Chosen Fonts list in the lower-left corner of the dialog box.
To the right is a list of all available fonts installed on your system.
3Do one of the following:
To add or remove fonts from a font combination, click the arrows button (<< or >>) between the Chosen Fonts
list and the Available Fonts list.
To add or remove a font combination, click the Plus (+) and Minus (–) buttons at the top of the dialog box.
To add a font that is not installed on your system, type the font name in the text field below the Available Fonts
list and click the << button to add it to the combination. Adding a font not installed on your system is useful, for
example, for specifying a Windows-only font when you are developing pages on a Macintosh.
To move the font combination up or down in the list, click the arrow buttons at the top of the dialog box.
Add a new combination to the font list
1Select Format > Font > Edit Font List.
2Select a font from the Available Fonts list and click the << button to move the font to the Chosen Fonts list.
3Repeat step 2 for each subsequent font in the combination.
To add a font that is not installed on your system, type the font name in the text field below the Available Fonts list
and click the << button to add the font to the combination. Adding a font not installed on your system is useful, for
example, for specifying a Windows-only font when you are developing pages on a Macintosh.
278
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
4When you have finished selecting specific fonts, select a generic font family from the Available Fonts menu and click
the << button to move the generic font family to the Chosen Fonts list.
Generic font families include cursive, fantasy, monospace, sans-serif, and serif. If none of the fonts in the Chosen
Fonts list are available on the user’s system, the text appears in the default font associated with the generic font
family. For example, the default monospace font on most systems is Courier.
Add Edge Web Fonts to the Font list
You can add both Adobe Edge Web Fonts to the Font list in Dreamweaver. In the Font list, Dreamweaver supported font
stacks are listed first ahead of Web fonts and Edge Web Fonts.
Add Adobe Edge Web Fonts to the Font list
You can now use Adobe Edge Web Fonts in your web pages. When an Edge font is used in a page, an additional script
tag is added to reference a JavaScript file. This file downloads the font from the Creative Cloud server directly to the
browser’s cache.
When displaying the page, fonts are downloaded from the Creative Cloud server even if the font is available on the
user's computer.
For example, a Script tag that uses only the font "Abel" has the format:
<!--The following script tag downloads a font from the Adobe Edge Web Fonts server for use within the web page. We
recommend that you do not modify it.-->
<script>var adobewebfontsappname ="dreamweaver"</script>
<script src="http://use.edgefonts.net/abel:n4:default.js" type="text/javascript"></script>
1Select Modify > Manage Fonts.
2The Adobe Edge Fonts tab displays all the Adobe Edge Web Fonts that you can add to the Font list.
3To find and add fonts from this list to the Font list, do the following:
Click the font that you would like to add to the font list.
To deselect a font, click the font again.
Use filters to shortlist preferred fonts. For example, to shortlist fonts of the Serif type, click .
You can use multiple filters. For example, to shortlist filters of Serif type that can be used for paragraphs, click
and .
To search a font by its name, enter its name in the search box.
4Click to filter the fonts that you have selected.
5Click Done.
6Open the Font list from any location. For example, you could use the Font list in the CSS section of the Properties
panel.
In the Font list, the Dreamweaver font stacks are listed ahead of the web fonts. Scroll down the list to locate your
selected fonts.
279
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Add local web fonts to the Font list
You can add web fonts from your computer to the Font list in Dreamweaver. The added fonts are reflected in all Font
menus in Dreamweaver. Fonts of the type EOT, WOFF, TTF, and SVG are supported.
1Select Modify > Manage Fonts.
2In the dialog that appears, click the Local Web Fonts tab.
3Click the Browse button corresponding to the font type that you wish to add. For example, if your font is in the EOT
format, click the Browse button corresponding to EOT Font.
4Navigate to the location on your compuer containing the font. Select the file and open it. If other formats for the font
exist in that location, they are automatically added to the dilaog. The Font Name is also automatically picked from
the name of the font.
5Select the option that asks you to confirm that you have licensed the font for website use.
6Click Done. The list of fonts is displayed in Current List of Local Fonts.
To remove a web font from the font list, select the font in Current List of Local Fonts, and click Remove.
Create custom font stacks
A font stack is a list of fonts in a CSS font-family declaration. Using the Custom Font Stacks tab of the Manage Fonts
dialog, you can do the following:
Add new font stacks using the “+” button.
To edit existing font stacks, select the font stack from the Font List. Use the “>>” and "<<" buttons to update the list
of Chosen Fonts.
Delete existing font stacks using the “-“ button.
Reorder stacks using the arrow buttons.
Preview inserted fonts
You cannot preview Edge and Web fonts in the Design view. Switch to Live view or preview the page in a browser to
preview them.
Update web font script tag across files
When you update the font in a CSS file that is linked to multiple HTML files, you are prompted to update the script tag
in the related HTML files. When you click Update, the script tags in all the affected HTML files is updated.
Update web font script tag on a page
Select Commands > Clean Up Web Fonts Script Tag (Current Page) to update any web fonts on the web page that are
not reflected in the script tag.
Insert dates
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
280
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Dreamweaver provides a convenient Date object, which inserts the current date in whatever format you prefer (with or
without the time) and provides the option of updating that date whenever you save the file.
Note: The dates and times shown in the Insert Date dialog box are not the current date, nor do they reflect the dates/times
that a visitor sees when they display your site. They are examples only of the way you want to display this information.
1In the Document window, place the insertion point where you want the date to be inserted.
2Do one of the following:
Select Insert > Date.
In the Common category of the Insert panel, click the Date button.
3In the resulting dialog box, select a format for the name of the day of the week, a format for the date, and a format
for the time.
4If you want the inserted date to be updated every time you save the document, select Update Automatically On Save.
If you want the date to become plain text when it’s inserted, and never update automatically, deselect that option.
5Click OK to insert the date.
If you have selected Update Automatically On Save, you can edit the date format after it has been inserted into the
document by clicking on the formatted text and selecting Edit Date Format in the Property inspector.
Working with assets
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Assets panel overview
Use the Assets panel (Window > Assets) to manage assets in the current site. The Assets panel displays assets for the
site associated with the active document in the Document window.
Note: You must define a local site before you can view assets in the Assets panel.
281
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
The Assets panel provides different ways to view assets:
Site list Shows all of the assets in your site, including colors and URLs that are used in any document in your site.
Favorites list Shows only the assets you’ve explicitly chosen.
To switch between these two views, select either the Site or Favorites radio button above the preview area. (These two
views are not available for the Templates and Library categories.)
Note: Most of the Assets panel operations work the same in both lists. There are a few tasks, however, that you can perform
only in the Favorites list.
In both lists, assets fall into one of the following categories:
Images Image files in GIF, JPEG, or PNG formats.
Colors Colors used in documents and style sheets, including colors of text, backgrounds, and links.
URLs External links in your current site documents, including FTP, gopher, HTTP, HTTPS, JavaScript, e-mail
(mailto), and local file (file://) links.
Media Media files such as Adobe Flash (only SWF) files, Adobe Shockwave files, QuickTime, or MPEG files.
Scripts JavaScript or VBScript files. Scripts in HTML files (rather than in independent JavaScript or VBScript files)
do not appear in the Assets panel. This category is available only in Code and Design View.
Templates Master page layouts used on multiple pages. Modifying a template automatically modifies all pages
attached to it. This category is available only in Code and Design View.
Library items Design elements that you use in multiple pages; when you modify a library item, all pages containing
that item are updated. This category is available only in Code and Design View.
Note: To appear in the Assets panel, a file must fall into one of these categories. Some other types of files are sometimes
called assets, but they aren’t shown in the panel.
By default, assets in a category are listed alphabetically by name, but you can sort them by type and several other criteria.
You can also preview assets and resize the columns and the preview area.
View an asset in the preview area
Select the asset in the Assets panel.
282
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Display assets in a category
Click a category icon on the left side of the Assets panel.
Sort assets
Click a column heading.
For example, to sort the list of images by type (so that all the GIF images are together, all the JPEG images are
together, and so on), click the Type column heading.
Resize a column
Drag the line separating two column headings.
Resize the preview area
Drag the splitter bar (between the preview area and the list of assets) up or down.
Refresh the Assets panel
It can take a few seconds to create the Site list because Dreamweaver must first read the site cache.
Certain changes dont appear immediately in the Assets panel. For instance, when you add or remove an asset from your
site, the changes dont appear in the Assets panel until you refresh the Site list by clicking the Refresh Site List button.
If you add or remove an asset outside Dreamweaver—usingWindows Explorer or the Finder, for example—you must
rebuild the site cache to update the Assets panel.
When you remove the only instance of a particular color or URL in your site, or when you save a new file that contains
a color or URL that isn’t already used in the site, the changes don’t appear in the Assets panel until you refresh the Site
list.
To refresh the Site list manually, click the Refresh Site List button . Dreamweaver creates the site cache or updates
it as necessary.
To refresh the Site list and manually rebuild the site cache, right-click (Windows) or Command-click (Macintosh)
in the Assets list, then select Refresh Site List.
Add an asset to a document
You can insert most assets into a document by dragging them into Live View, Code View, and Design View in the
Document window, or by using the Insert button in the panel. You can drag the assets from both the list view and the
preview pane of the Assets panel.
Note: Dragging from the preview pane is supported only on Mac.
You can insert colors and URLs in Design or Live View. In Design View, you can apply colors and URLs to selected
elements.
1In the document, place the insertion point where you want the asset to appear.
2In the Assets panel, select from the asset category buttons at the left.
Note: Select any category except Templates. A template is applied to an entire document; it can’t be inserted into a
document.
3Select either Site or Favorites at the top of the panel, then select the asset.
There are no Site or Favorites lists for library items; skip this step if youre inserting a library item.
283
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
4Do one of the following:
Drag the asset from the panel to the document. You can drag from the list view as well as from the preview pane.
Note: On Windows, you cannot drag assets from the preview pane.
You can drag scripts into the head content area of the Document window; if that area isn’t visible, select View >
Head Content.
Select the asset in the panel and click Insert.
If the inserted asset is a color, it applies to text appearing after the insertion point.
Apply color to text using the Assets panel
The Assets panel shows the colors you’ve already applied to various elements, such as text, table borders, backgrounds,
and so on.
1In Design View, perform the following steps:
aSelect the text in the document.
bIn the Assets panel, select the Colors category .
cSelect the desired color, and click Apply.
2In Live View, perform the following steps:
aIn the Assets panel, select the Colors category .
bDo one of the following:
Right-click the color in Assets panel, and click Copy Color Value. The color value is copied to your clipboard.
You can now paste the color value (Ctrl+v, Cmd+v) in CSS Designer.
Drag the color from preview and hover the mouse on elements in Live View. When you drop the color, the
New CSS Rule dialog appears and when you click OK, the color is applied to the selected element.
Click Apply in the Assets panel. The New CSS Rule dialog appears and when you click OK, the color is applied
to the selected element.
Assign URLs to images or text
1In Design View, perform the following steps:
aSelect the text or image.
bIn the Assets panel, select the URLs category in either the Sites or Favorites view, depending on where the URL
is stored.
Note: URLs for your sites files are stored in the Sites view by default. The Favorites view holds URLs that you have
added yourself.
cSelect the URL.
dDo one of the following:
Drag the URL from the panel to the selection in Design View.
Select the URL, then click Insert.
2In Live View, perform the following steps:
aIn the Assets panel, select the URLs category in either the Sites or Favorites view, depending on where the URL
is stored.
284
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
bDo one of the following:
Drag the URL from the preview or the list view. Hover the mouse on elements in Live View. When you drop
the URL, <a> wraps the element highlighted in Live View.
Click the required element in Live View. Choose the URL in the Assets panel and click Apply. The selected
element is wrapped with the <a> tag.
Select and edit assets
The Assets panel allows you to select multiple assets at once. It also provides a quick way to begin editing assets.
Select multiple assets
1In the Assets panel, select an asset.
2Select the other assets in one of the following ways:
Shift-click to select a consecutive series of assets.
Control-click (Windows) or Command-click (Macintosh) to add an individual asset to the selection (whether or
not its adjacent to the existing selection). Control-click or Command-click a selected asset to deselect it.
Edit an asset
When you edit an asset in the Assets panel, the behavior varies according to the asset type. For some assets, such as
images, you use an external editor, which opens automatically if you have defined an editor for that asset type. You can
edit colors and URLs in the Favorites list only. When you edit templates and library items, you make the changes within
Dreamweaver.
1In the Assets panel, do one of the following:
Double-click the asset.
Select the asset, then click the Edit button .
Note: If the asset must be edited in an external editor and one doesn’t open automatically, select Edit > Preferences
(Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh), select the File Types/Editors category, and make sure you have
defined an external editor for that asset type.
2Make your changes.
3When you finish, do one of the following:
If the asset is file-based (anything other than a color or URL), save it (in the editor you used), and close it.
If the asset is a URL, click OK in the Edit URL dialog box.
Note: If the asset is a color, the color picker closes automatically after you pick a color. To dismiss the color picker without
picking a color, press Esc.
Reuse assets in another site
The Assets panel shows all the assets (of recognized types) in your current site. To use an asset from the current site in
another site, you must copy it to the other site. You can copy an individual asset, a set of individual assets, or an entire
Favorites folder at once.
You may need to locate the file in the Files panel that corresponds to an asset in the Assets panel before you transfer the
asset to or from your remote site.
285
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: The Files panel might show a different site from the one that the Assets panel shows. This is because the Assets panel
is associated with the active document.
Locate an asset file in the Files panel
1In the Assets panel, select the category of the asset you want to find.
2Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the assets name or icon in the Assets panel, then select Locate
In Site from the context menu.
Note: Locate In Site is unavailable for colors and URLs, which do not correspond to files in the site.
The Files panel opens, with the asset file selected. The Locate In Site command locates the file corresponding to the
asset itself; it does not locate files that use that asset.
Copy assets from the Asset panel to another site
1In the Assets panel, select the category of the asset you want to copy.
2Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) one or more assets in either the Site list or Favorites list, select
Copy To Site, and select the target site name from the submenu listing all the sites you’ve defined.
Note: In the Favorites list, you can copy a Favorites folder as well as individual assets.
The assets are copied to their corresponding locations in the target site. Dreamweaver creates new folders in the
target sites hierarchy as needed. The assets are also added to the target sites Favorites list.
Note: If the asset you copied is a color or a URL, it appears only in the target sites Favorites list. Because colors and URLs
don’t correspond to files, theres no file to copy into the other site.
More Help topics
Creating and managing a list of favorite assets
Working with library items
Add or remove favorite assets
Start an external editor for media files
Creating and managing a list of favorite assets
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Managing favorite assets
The complete list of all recognized assets list can become cumbersome for some large sites. You can add frequently used
assets to a Favorites list, group related assets together, give them nicknames to remind yourself what theyre for, and
find them easily in the Assets panel.
Note: Favorite assets are not stored as separate files on your disk; they’re references to the assets in the Site list.
Dreamweaver keeps track of which assets from the Site list to display in the Favorites list.
Most of the operations of the Assets panel are the same in the Favorites list as in the Site list. However, there are several
tasks that you can perform only in the Favorites list.
286
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Add or remove favorite assets
There are several ways to add assets to your sites Favorites list in the Assets panel.
Adding a color or URL to the Favorites list requires an extra step. You can’t add new colors or URLs to the Site list; the
Site list contains only assets that are already in use in your site.
Note: There are no Favorites lists for templates and library items.
Add assets to the Favorites list
Do one of the following:
Select one or more assets in the Site list of the Assets panel, then click the Add To Favorites button .
Select one or more assets in the Site list of the Assets panel, right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh),
then select Add To Favorites.
Select one or more files in the Files panel, right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh), then select Add To
Favorites. Dreamweaver ignores files that dont correspond to a category in the Assets panel.
Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) an element in the Document window’s Design view, then select
the context menu command to add the element to a Favorites category.
The context menu for text contains either Add To Color Favorites or Add To URL Favorites, depending on whether
the text has a link attached. You can add only those elements that match one of the categories in the Assets panel.
Add a new color or URL to the Favorites list
1In the Assets panel, select the Colors or URLs category.
2Select the Favorites option at the top of the panel.
3Click the New Color or New URL button .
4Do one of the following:
Select a color using the color picker, then give the color a nickname if desired.
To close the color picker without selecting a color, press Esc or click the gray bar at the top of the color picker.
Enter a URL and a nickname in the Add New URL dialog box, then click OK.
Remove assets from the Favorites list
1In the Assets panel, select the Favorites option at the top of the panel.
2Select one or more assets (or a folder) in the Favorites list.
3Click the Remove From Favorites button .
The assets are removed from the Favorites list, but not from the Site list. If you remove a Favorites folder, the folder
and all its contents are removed.
Create a nickname for a favorite asset
You can give nicknames (for instance, PageBackgroundColor rather than #999900) to assets only in the Favorites list.
The Site list retains their real filenames (or values, in the case of colors and URLs).
1In the Assets panel (Window > Assets), select the category that contains your asset.
2Select the Favorites option at the top of the panel.
287
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
3Do one of the following:
Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the assets name or icon in the Assets panel, then select Edit
Nickname.
Click the asset’s name once, pause, then click it again. (Do not double-click; double-clicking opens the item for
editing.)
4Type a nickname for the asset, then press Enter (Windows) or Return (Macintosh).
Group assets in a Favorites folder
Placing an asset in Favorites folder does not change the location of the assets file on your disk.
1In the Assets panel, select the Favorites option at the top of the panel.
2Click the New Favorites Folder button .
3Type a name for the folder, then press Enter (Windows) or Return (Macintosh).
4Drag assets into the folder.
More Help topics
Assets panel overview
Use the color picker
Assets panel overview
Insert and edit images
Many different types of graphic file formats exist, but three graphic file formats are generally used in web pages—GIF,
JPEG, and PNG. GIF and JPEG file formats are the best supported and can be viewed in most browsers. You can easily
insert images and edit them using the Dreamweaver user interface.
GIF (Graphic Interchange Format) GIF files use a maximum of 256 colors, and are best for displaying noncontinuous-
tone images or those with large areas of flat colors, such as navigation bars, buttons, icons, logos, or other images with
uniform colors and tones.
JPEG (Joint Photographic Experts Group) The JPEG file format is the superior format for photographic or continuous-
tone images, because JPEG files can contain millions of colors. As the quality of a JPEG file increases, so does the file
size and the file download time. You can often strike a good balance between the quality of the image and the file size
by compressing a JPEG file.
PNG (Portable Network Group) The PNG file format is a patent-free replacement for GIFs that includes support for
indexed-color, gray scale, and true-color images, and alpha channel support for transparency. PNG is the native file
format of Adobe® Fireworks®. PNG files retain all the original layer, vector, color, and effects information (such as drop
shadows), and all elements are fully editable at all times. Files must have the .png file extension to be recognized as PNG
files by Dreamweaver.
Insert an image
When you insert an image into a Dreamweaver document, a reference to the image file is generated in the HTML source
code. To ensure that this reference is correct, the image file must be in the current site. If it is not in the current site,
Dreamweaver asks whether you want to copy the file into the site.
288
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Dreamweaver also allows you to insert images dynamically. Dynamic images are those images that change often. For
example, advertising banner rotation systems need to randomly select a single banner from a list of potential banners,
and then dynamically display the selected banner’s image when a page is requested.
You can also drag and drop any layer in the Extract panel to any place in Dreamweaver Live View using Live Guides
and Element Quick View. The Extract Panel allows you to upload PSD files in to it and then drag and drop any layer in
the PSD file directly to your Dreamweaver document.
After you insert an image, you can set image tag accessibility attributes that can be read by screen readers for visually
impaired users. These attributes can be edited in HTML code.
For a tutorial on inserting images, see Adding images.
For information on extracting images from your PSD compositions, see Extract images from PSD files .
1Place the insertion point where you want the image to appear in the Document window and do one of the following:
In the Common category of the Insert panel, click the Images icon .
In the Common category of the Insert panel, click the Images button and select the Image icon. With the Image
icon displayed in the Insert panel, you can drag the icon to the Document window (or to the Code view window
if you are working in the code).
Select Insert > Image.
Drag an image from the Assets panel (Window > Assets) to the desired location in the Document window; then
skip to step 3.
Drag an image from the Files panel to the desired location in the Document window; then skip to step 3.
Drag an image from the desktop to the desired location in the Document window; then skip to step 3.
In Live View, drag an image from the Extract panel or the Layers tab and drop the element at the top, bottom,
right or left of an element based on Live Guides (as explained in the following image), or drop the element at a
precise place in the document structure by clicking </> and using Element Quick View.
2In the dialog box that appears, do one of the following:
Select File System to choose an image file.
Select Data Source to choose a dynamic image source.
Click the Sites And Servers button to choose an image file in a remote folder of one of your Dreamweaver sites.
3Browse to select the image or content source you want to insert.
If you are working in an unsaved document, Dreamweaver generates a file:// reference to the image file. When you
save the document anywhere in the site, Dreamweaver converts the reference to a document-relative path.
Note: When inserting images it’s also possible to use an absolute path to an image that resides on a remote server (i.e.,
an image that is not available on the local hard drive). If you experience performance problems while working, however,
you might want to disable viewing the image in Design view by deselecting Commands > Display External Files.
4Click OK.
Set image properties
The Images Property inspector allows you to set properties for an image. If you do not see all of the image properties,
click the expander arrow in the lower-right corner.
289
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
1Click the image and select Window > Properties to view the Property inspector for a selected image.
2In the text box below the thumbnail image, enter a name so you can refer to the image when using a Dreamweaver
behavior (such as Swap Image) or when using a scripting language such as JavaScript or VBScript.
3Set any of the image options.
W and H The width and height of the image, in pixels. Dreamweaver automatically updates these text boxes with the
images original dimensions when you insert an image in a page.
If you set W and H values that do not correspond to the actual width and height of the image, the image may not
display properly in a browser. (To restore the original values, click the W and H text box labels, or the Reset image
size button that appears to the right of the W and H text boxes in entering a new value.)
Note: You can change these values to scale the display size of this image instance, but this does not reduce download
time, because the browser downloads all image data before scaling the image. To reduce download time and to ensure
that all instances of an image appear at the same size, use an image-editing application to scale images.
Src Specifies the source file for the image. Click the folder icon to browse to the source file, or type the path.
Link Specifies a hyperlink for the image. Drag the Point-To-File icon to a file in the Files panel, click the folder icon
to browse to a document on your site, or manually type the URL.
Alt Specifies alternative text that appears in place of the image for text-only browsers or for browsers that have been
set to download images manually. For visually impaired users who use speech synthesizers with text-only browsers,
the text is spoken out loud. In some browsers, this text also appears when the pointer is over the image.
Map Name and Hotspot tools Allow you to label and create a client-side image map.
Target Specifies the frame or window in which the linked page should load. (This option is not available when the
image isnt linked to another file.) The names of all the frames in the current frameset appear in the Target list. You
can also choose from the following reserved target names:
_blank loads the linked file into a new, unnamed browser window.
_parent loads the linked file into the parent frameset or window of the frame that contains the link. If the frame
containing the link is not nested, the linked file loads into the full browser window.
_self loads the linked file into the same frame or window as the link. This target is the default, so you usually don’t
need to specify it.
_top loads the linked file into the full browser window, thereby removing all frames.
Edit Starts the image editor you specified in External Editors preferences and opens the selected image.
Update from original When the web image (that is, the image on the Dreamweaver page) is out of sync with the
original Photoshop file, Dreamweaver detects that the original file has been updated, and displays one of the Smart
Object icons arrows in red. When you select the web image in Design view and click the Update from Original
button in the Property inspector, the image updates automatically, reflecting any changes that you made to the
original Photoshop file.
Edit image settings Opens the Image Optimization dialog box and lets you optimize the image.
290
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Crop Trims the size of an image, removing unwanted areas from the selected image.
Resample Resamples a resized image, improving its picture quality at its new size and shape.
Brightness and Contrast Adjusts the brightness and contrast settings of an image.
Sharpen Adjusts the sharpness of an image.
Note: You can also edit image attributes in Live View using the Edit in Live View.
Edit image accessibility attributes in code
If you inserted accessibility attributes for an image, you can edit those values in the HTML code.
1In the Document window, click the image or select the image tag in code.
2Do one of the following to enter a name or a brief description for the image in less than 50 characters in to the
Alternate Text box. The screen reader reads the information you enter here.
Edit the appropriate image attributes in Code view.
Edit image attributes in Live View using the Edit in Live View.
Edit the Alt value in the Property inspector.
Visually resize an image
You can visually resize elements such as images, plug-ins, Shockwave or SWF files, applets, and ActiveX controls in
Dreamweaver.
Visually resizing an image helps you see how the image affects the layout at different dimensions but it does not scale
the image file to the proportions that you specify. If you visually resize an image in Dreamweaver without using an
image-editing application (such as Adobe Fireworks) to scale the image file to the desired size, the user’s browser scales
the image when the page is loaded. This might cause a delay in page download time and the improper display of the
image in the user’s browser. To reduce download time and to ensure that all instances of an image appear at the same
size, use an image-editing application to scale images.
When you resize an image in Dreamweaver, you can resample it to accommodate its new dimensions. Resampling adds
or subtracts pixels from a resized JPEG and GIF image files to match the appearance of the original image as closely as
possible. Resampling an image reduces its file size and improves download performance.
Visually resize an element
1Select the element (for example, an image or SWF file) in the Document window.
Resize handles appear at the bottom and right sides of the element and in the lower-right corner. If resize handles
dont appear, click somewhere other than the element you want to resize and then reselect it, or click the appropriate
tag in the tag selector to select the element.
291
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
2Resize the element by doing one of the following:
To adjust the width of the element, drag the selection handle on the right side.
To adjust the height of the element, drag the bottom selection handle.
To adjust the width and the height of the element at the same time, drag the corner selection handle.
To preserve the element’s proportions (its width-to-height ratio) as you adjust its dimensions, Shift-drag the
corner selection handle.
To adjust the width and height of an element to a specific size (for example, 1 x 1 pixel), use the Property
inspector to enter a numeric value. Elements can be visually resized to a minimum of 8 x 8 pixels.
3To return a resized element to its original dimensions, in the Property inspector, delete the values in the W and H
text boxes, or click the Reset Size button in the image Property inspector.
Revert an image to its original size
Click the Reset size button in the image Property inspector.
Resample a resized image
1Resize the image as described above.
2Click the Resample button in the image Property inspector.
Note: You cannot resample image placeholders or elements other than bitmap images.
Insert an image placeholder
An image placeholder is a graphic you use until final artwork is ready to be added to a web page. You can set the
placeholder’s size and color, as well as provide it with a text label.
1In the Document window, place the insertion point where you want to insert a placeholder graphic.
2Select Insert > Image Objects > Image Placeholder.
3For Name (Optional), enter text you want to appear as a label for the image placeholder. Leave the text box blank if
you do not want a label to appear. The name must begin with a letter and can contain only letters and numbers;
spaces and high ASCII characters are not allowed.
4For Width and Height (Required), type a number to set the image size in pixels.
5For Color (Optional), do one of the following to apply a color:
Use the color picker to select a color.
Enter the colors hexadecimal value (for example, #FF0000).
Enter a web-safe color name (for example, red).
6For Alternate Text (Optional), enter text to describe the image for viewers using a text-only browser.
Note: An image tag is automatically inserted into the HTML code containing an empty src attribute.
7Click OK.
The placeholder’s color, size attributes, and label appear as follows:
292
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
When viewed in a browser, the label and size text do not appear.
Replace an image placeholder
An image placeholder does not display an image in a browser. Before you publish your site you should replace any
image placeholders you’ve added with web-friendly image files, such as GIFs or JPEGs.
If you have Fireworks, you can create a new graphic from the Dreamweaver image placeholder. The new image is set to
the same size as the placeholder image. You can edit the image, then replace it in Dreamweaver.
1In the Document window, do one of the following:
Double-click the image placeholder.
Click the image placeholder to select it; then in the Property inspector (Window > Properties), click the folder
icon next to the Src text box.
2In the Image Source dialog box, navigate to the image you want to replace the image placeholder with and click OK.
Set image placeholder properties
To set properties for an image placeholder, select the placeholder in the Document window; then select Window >
Properties to display the Property inspector. To see all properties, click the expander arrow in the lower-right corner.
Use the Property inspector to set a name, width, height, image source, alternate text description, alignment and color
for a placeholder image.
In the placeholder Property inspector, the gray text box and the Align text box are disabled. You can set these properties
in the image Property inspector when you replace the placeholder with an image.
Set any of the following options:
W and H Set the width and height of the image placeholder, in pixels.
Src Specifies the source file for the image. For a placeholder image, this text box is empty. Click the Browse button
to select a replacement image for the placeholder graphic.
Link Specifies a hyperlink for the image placeholder. Drag the Point-to-File icon to a file in the Files panel, click the
folder icon to browse to a document on your site, or manually type the URL.
Alt Specifies alternative text that appears in place of the image for text-only browsers or for browsers that have been
set to download images manually. For visually impaired users who use speech synthesizers with text-only browsers,
the text is spoken out loud. In some browsers, this text also appears when the pointer is over the image.
Create Starts Fireworks to create a replacement image. The Create button is disabled unless Fireworks is also
installed on your computer.
Update from original When the web image (that is, the image on the Dreamweaver page) is out of sync with the
original Photoshop file, Dreamweaver detects that the original file has been updated, and displays one of the Smart
Object icons arrows in red. When you select the web image in Design view and click the Update from Original
293
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
button in the Property inspector, the image updates automatically, reflecting any changes that you made to the
original Photoshop file.
Color Specifies a color for the image placeholder.
Edit images in Dreamweaver
You can resample, crop, optimize, and sharpen images in Dreamweaver. You can also adjust their brightness and
contrast.
Image-editing features
Dreamweaver provides basic image-editing features that let you modify images without having to use an external
image-editing application such as Fireworks or Photoshop. The Dreamweaver image-editing tools are designed to let
you easily work with content designers responsible for creating image files for use on your website.
Note: You do not need to have Fireworks or other image-editing applications installed on your computer to use the
Dreamweaver image-editing features.
Select Modify > Image. Set any of these Dreamweaver image-editing features:
Resample Adds or subtracts pixels from a resized JPEG and GIF image files to match the appearance of the original
image as closely as possible. Resampling an image reduces its file size and improves download performance.
When you resize an image in Dreamweaver, you can resample it to accommodate its new dimensions. When a
bitmap object is resampled, pixels are added to or removed from the image to make it larger or smaller. Resampling
an image to a higher resolution typically causes little loss of quality. Resampling to a lower resolution, however,
always causes data loss and usually a drop in quality.
Crop Edit images by reducing the area of the image. Typically, you’ll want to crop an image to place more emphasis
on the subject of the image, and remove unwanted aspects surrounding the center of interest in the image.
Brightness and Contrast Modifies the contrast or brightness of pixels in an image. This affects the highlights,
shadows, and midtones of an image. You typically use Brightness/Contrast when correcting images that are too dark
or too light.
Sharpen Adjusts the focus of an image by increasing the contrast of edges found within the image. When you scan
an image, or take a digital photo, the default action of most image capturing software is to soften the edges of objects
in the image. This prevents extremely fine details from becoming lost in the pixels from which digital images are
composed. However, to bring out the details in digital image files, it is often necessary to sharpen the image, thereby
increasing edge contrast, and making the image appear sharper.
Note: Dreamweaver image-editing features apply only to JPEG, GIF, and PNG image file formats. Other bitmap image
file formats cannot be edited using these image-editing features.
Crop an image
Dreamweaver lets you crop (or trim) bitmap file images.
Note: When you crop an image, the source image file is changed on disk. For this reason, you may want to keep a backup
copy of the image file in the event you need to revert to the original image.
1Open the page containing the image you want to crop, select the image, and do either of the following:
Click the Crop Tool icon in the image Property inspector.
Select Modify > Image > Crop.
Crop handles appear around the selected image.
294
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
2Adjust the crop handles until the bounding box surrounds the area of the image that you want to keep.
3Double-click inside the bounding box or press Enter to crop the selection.
4A dialog box informs you that the image file you are cropping will be changed on disk. Click OK. Every pixel in the
selected bitmap outside the bounding box is removed, but other objects in the image remain.
5Preview the image and ensure that it meets your expectations. If not, select Edit > Undo Crop to revert to the original
image.
Note: You can undo the effect of the Crop command (and revert to the original image file) up until the time that you
quit Dreamweaver, or edit the file in an external image-editing application.
Optimize an image
You can optimize images in your web pages from within Dreamweaver.
1Open the page containing the image you want to optimize, select the image, and do either of the following:
Click the Edit Image Settings button in the image Property inspector.
Select Modify > Image > Optimize.
2Make your edits in the Image Optimization dialog box and click OK.
Sharpen an image
Sharpening increases the contrast of pixels around the edges of objects to increase the images definition or sharpness.
1Open the page containing the image you want to sharpen, select the image, and do either of the following:
Click the Sharpen button in the image Property inspector.
Select Modify > Image > Sharpen.
2You can specify the degree of sharpening Dreamweaver applies to the image by dragging the slider control, or
entering a value between 0 and 10 in the text box. As you adjust the sharpness of the image using the Sharpness
dialog box, you can preview the change to the image.
3Click OK when you are satisfied with the image.
4Save your changes by selecting File > Save, or revert to the original image by selecting Edit > Undo Sharpen.
Note: You can only undo the effect of the Sharpen command (and revert to the original image file) prior to saving the
page containing the image. After you save the page, the changes made to the image are permanently saved.
Adjust the brightness and contrast of an image
Brightness/Contrast modifies the contrast or brightness of pixels in an image. This affects the highlights, shadows, and
midtones of an image. You typically use Brightness/Contrast when correcting images that are too dark or too light.
1Open the page containing the image you want to adjust, select the image, and do either of the following:
Click the Brightness/Contrast button in the image Property inspector.
Select Modify > Image > Brightness/Contrast.
2Drag the Brightness and Contrast sliders to adjust the settings. Values range from -100 to 100.
3Click OK.
295
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Create a rollover image
You can insert rollover images in your page. A rollover is an image that, when viewed in a browser, changes when the
pointer moves across it.
You must have two images to create the rollover: a primary image (the image displayed when the page first loads) and
a secondary image (the image that appears when the pointer moves over the primary image). Both images in a rollover
should be the same size; if the images are not the same size, Dreamweaver resizes the second image to match the
properties of the first image.
Rollover images are automatically set to respond to the onMouseOver event. You can set an image to respond to a
different event (for example, a mouse click) or change a rollover image.
1In the Document window, place the insertion point where you want the rollover to appear.
2Insert the rollover using one of these methods:
In the Common category of the Insert panel, click the Images button and select the Rollover Image icon. With
the Rollover Image icon displayed in the Insert panel, you can drag the icon to the Document window.
Select Insert > Image Objects > Rollover Image.
3Set the options and click OK.
Image Name The name of the rollover image.
Original image The image you want to display when the page loads. Enter the path in the text box, or click Browse
and select the image.
Rollover Image The image you want to display when the pointer rolls over the original image. Enter the path or click
Browse to select the image.
Preload Rollover Image Preloads the images in the browsers cache so no delay occurs when the user rolls the
pointer over the image.
Alternate Text (Optional) Text to describe the image for viewers using a text-only browser.
When clicked, Go to URL The file that you want to open when a user clicks the rollover image. Enter the path or click
Browse and select the file.
Note: If you don’t set a link for the image, Dreamweaver inserts a null link (#) in the HTML source code to which the
rollover behavior is attached. If you remove the null link, the rollover image will no longer work.
4Select File > Preview in Browser or press F12.
5In the browser, move the pointer over the original image to see the rollover image.
Note: You cannot see the effect of a rollover image in Design view.
Use an external image editor
While in Dreamweaver, you can open a selected image in an external image editor; when you return to Dreamweaver
after saving the edited image file, any changes you made to the image are visible in the Document window.
You can set up Fireworks as your primary external editor. You can also set which file types an editor opens; and you can
select multiple image editors. For example, you can set preferences to start Fireworks when you want to edit a GIF, and
to start a different image editor when you want to edit a JPG or JPEG.
296
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Start the external image editor
Do one of the following:
Double-click the image you want to edit.
Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the image you want to edit, then select Edit With > Browse
and select an editor.
Select the image you want to edit, and click Edit in the Property inspector.
Double-click the image file in the Files panel to start the primary image editor. If you havent specified an image
editor, Dreamweaver starts the default editor for the file type.
Note: When you open an image from the Files panel, the Fireworks integration features are not in effect; Fireworks does
not open the original PNG file. To use the Fireworks integration features, open images from within the Document
window.
If you don’t see an updated image after returning to the Dreamweaver window, select the image and then click the
Refresh button in the Property inspector.
Set an external image editor for an existing file type
You can select an image editor for opening and editing graphic files.
1Open the File Types/Editors Preferences dialog box by doing one of the following:
Select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh), and select File Types/Editors
in the Category list on the left.
Select Edit > Edit with External Editor and select File Types/Editors.
2In the Extensions list, select the file extension you want to set an external editor for.
3Click the Add (+) button above the Editors list.
4In the Select External Editor dialog box, browse to the application you want to start as an editor for this file type.
5In the Preferences dialog box, click Make Primary if you want this editor to be the primary editor for this file type.
6If you want to set up an additional editor for this file type, repeat steps 3 and 4.
Dreamweaver automatically uses the primary editor when you edit this image type. You can select the other listed
editors from the context menu for the image in the Document window.
Add a new file type to the Extensions list
1Open the File Types/Editors Preferences dialog box by doing one of the following:
Select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh), and select File Types/Editors
in the Category list on the left.
Select Edit > Edit with External Editor and select File Types/Editors.
2In the File Types/Editors Preferences dialog box, click the Add (+) button above the Extensions list.
A text box appears in the Extensions list.
3Type the file extension of the file type you want to start an editor for.
4To select an external editor for the file type, click the Add (+) button above the Editors list.
5In the dialog box that appears, select the application you want to use to edit this image type.
6Click Make Primary if you want this editor to be the primary editor for the image type.
297
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Change an existing editor preference
1Open the File Types/Editors Preferences dialog box by doing one of the following:
Select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh), and select File Types/Editors
in the Category list on the left.
Select Edit > Edit with External Editor and select File Types/Editors.
2In the File Types/Editors preferences dialog box, in the Extensions list select the file type you are changing to view
the existing editor(s).
3In the Editors list, select the editor you want to want to affect, then do one of the following:
Click the Add (+) or Delete (–) buttons above the Editors list to add or remove an editor.
Click the Make Primary button, to change which editor starts by default for editing.
Applying behaviors to images
You can apply any available behavior to an image or image hotspot. When you apply a behavior to a hotspot,
Dreamweaver inserts the HTML source code into the area tag. Three behaviors apply specifically to images: Preload
Images, Swap Image, and Swap Image Restore.
Preload Images Loads images that do not appear on the page right away (such as those that will be swapped in with
behaviors, AP elements, or JavaScript) into the browser cache. This prevents delays caused by downloading when it is
time for the images to appear.
Swap Image Swaps one image for another by changing the SRC attribute of the img tag. Use this action to create button
rollovers and other image effects (including swapping more than one image at a time).
Swap Image Restore Restores the last set of swapped images to their previous source files. This action is automatically
added whenever you attach the Swap Image action to an object by default; you should never need to select it manually.
You can also use behaviors to create more sophisticated navigation systems, such as jump menus.
Adding media objects
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Insert and edit media objects
In addition to SWF and FLV files, you can insert QuickTime or Shockwave movies, Java applets, ActiveX controls, or
other audio or video objects in a Dreamweaver document. If you inserted accessibility attributes with a media object,
you can set the accessibility attributes and edit those values in the HTML code.
1Place the insertion point in the Document window where you want to insert the object.
2Insert the object by doing one of the following:
In the Common category of the Insert panel, click the Media button and select the icon for the type of object you
want to insert.
Select the appropriate object from the Insert > Media submenu.
If the object you want to insert is not a Shockwave, Applet, or ActiveX object, select Plugin from the Insert >
Media submenu.
298
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
A dialog box appears letting you select a source file and specify certain parameters for the media object.
To prevent such dialog boxes from appearing, select Edit > Preferences > General (Windows) or Dreamweaver >
Preferences > General (Macintosh) and deselect the Show Dialog When Inserting Objects option. To override
whatever preference is set for showing dialog boxes, hold down the Control (Windows) or Option (Macintosh) key while
inserting the object. (For example, to insert a placeholder for a Shockwave movie without specifying the file, hold down
Control or Option, and either click the Shockwave button in Media pop-up menu of the Common Insert panel, or select
Insert > Media > Shockwave.)
3Complete the Select File dialog box, and click OK.
Note: The Accessibility Attributes dialog box appears if you have chosen to show attributes when inserting media in the
Edit > Preferences dialog box.
4Set the accessibility attributes.
Note: You can also edit media object attributes by selecting the object and editing the HTML code in Code view, or right-
clicking (Windows) or Control-clicking (Macintosh), and selecting Edit Tag Code.
Title Enter a title for the media object.
Access Key Enter a keyboard equivalent (one letter) in the text box to select the form object in the browser. This lets
a visitor to the site use the Control key (Windows) with the Access Key to access the object. For example, if you enter
B as the Access Key, use Control+B to select the object in the browser.
Tab Index Enter a number for the tab order of the form object. Setting a tab order is useful when you have other
links and form objects on the page and need the user to tab through them in a specific order. If you set tab order for
one object, be sure to set the tab order for all of them.
5Click OK to insert the media object.
Note: If you click Cancel, a media object placeholder appears in the document, but Dreamweaver does not associate
accessibility tags or attributes with it.
To specify a source file, or to set dimensions and other parameters and attributes, use the Property inspector for each
object. You can edit accessibility attributes for an object.
Start an external editor for media files
You can start an external editor from Dreamweaver to edit most media files. You can also specify the editor you want
Dreamweaver to start to edit the file.
1Make sure the media file type is associated to an editor on your system.
To find out what editor is associated with the file type, select Edit > Preferences in Dreamweaver and select File
Types/Editors from the Category list. Click the files extension in the Extensions column to view the associated editor
or editors in the Editors column. You can change the editor associated to a file type.
2Double-click the media file in the Files panel to open it in the external editor.
The editor that starts when you double-click the file in the Files panel is called the primary editor. If you double-
click an image file, for example, Dreamweaver opens the file in the primary external image editor such as Adobe
Fireworks.
3If you don’t want to use the primary external editor to edit the file, you can use another editor on your system to edit
the file by doing one of the following:
In the Files panel, right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the filename and select Open With from
the context menu.
299
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
In Design view, right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the media element within the current page,
and select Edit With from the context menu.
Specify the editor to start from Dreamweaver
You can specify the editor you want Dreamweaver to use for editing a file type, and add or delete file types that
Dreamweaver recognizes.
Explicitly specify which external editors should be started for a given file type
1Select Edit > Preferences and select File Types/Editors from the Category list.
Filename extensions, such as .gif, .wav, and .mpg, are listed on the left under Extensions. Associated editors for a
selected extension are listed on the right under Editors.
2Select the file type extension in the Extensions list and do one of the following:
To associate a new editor with the file type, click the Plus (+) button above the Editors list and complete the dialog
box that appears.
For example, select the application icon for Acrobat to associate it with the file type.
To make an editor the primary editor for a file type (that is, the editor that opens when you double-click the file
type in the Files panel), select the editor in the Editors list and click Make Primary.
To dissociate an editor from a file type, select the editor in the Editors list and click the Minus (-) button above
the Editors list.
Add a new file type and associated editor
1Click the Plus (+) button above the Extensions list and enter a file type extension (including the period at the
beginning of the extension) or several related extensions separated by spaces.
For example, you might enter .xml .xsl if you wanted to associate them with an XML editor installed on your system.
2Select an editor for the file type by clicking the Plus (+) button above the Editors list and completing the dialog box
that appears.
Remove a file type
Select the file type in the Extensions list and click the Minus (-) button above the Extensions list.
Note: You can’t undo after removing a file type, so be sure that you want to remove it.
Use Design Notes with media objects
As with other objects in Dreamweaver, you can add Design Notes to a media object. Design Notes are notes associated
with a particular file, that are stored in a separate file. You can use Design Notes to keep track of extra file information
associated with your documents, such as image source filenames and comments on file status.
1Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the object in the Document window.
Note: You must define your site before adding Design Notes to any object.
2Select Design Notes for Page from the context menu.
3Enter the information you want in the Design Note.
You can also add a Design Note to a media object from the Files panel by selecting the file, revealing the context
menu, and choosing Design Notes from the context menu.
300
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Insert Shockwave movies
You can use Dreamweaver to insert Shockwave movies into your documents. Adobe® Shockwave®, a standard for
interactive multimedia on the web, is a compressed format that allows media files created in Adobe® Director® to be
downloaded quickly and played by most popular browsers.
1In the Document window, place the insertion point where you want to insert a Shockwave movie and do one of the
following:
In the Common category of the Insert panel, click the Media button and select the Shockwave icon from the
popup menu.
Select Insert > Media > Shockwave.
2In the dialog box that appears, select a movie file.
3In the Property inspector, enter the width and height of the movie in the W and H text boxes.
Add video (non-FLV)
You can add video to your web page in different ways and using different formats. Video can be downloaded to the user
or it can be streamed so that it plays while it is downloading.
1Place the clip in your site folder.
These clips are often in the AVI or MPEG file format.
2Link to the clip or embed it in your page.
To link to the clip, enter text for the link such as “Download Clip, select the text, and click the folder icon in the
Property inspector. Browse to the video file and select it.
Note: The user must download a helper application (a plug-in) to view common streaming formats like Real Media,
QuickTime, and Windows Media.
Insert plug-in content
You can create content such as a QuickTime movie for a browser plug-in, and then use Dreamweaver to insert that
content into an HTML document. Typical plug-ins include RealPlayer and QuickTime, while some content files include
mp3s and QuickTime movies.
You can preview movies and animations that rely on browser plug-ins directly in the Design view of the Document
window. You can play all plug-in elements at one time to see how the page will look to the user, or you can play each
one individually to ensure that you have embedded the correct media element.
Note: You cannot preview movies or animations that rely on ActiveX controls.
After inserting content for a plug-in, use the Property inspector to set parameters for that content. To view the following
properties in the Property inspector, select a plug-in object.
The Property inspector initially displays the most commonly used properties. Click the expander arrow in the lower-
right corner to see all properties.
Insert plug-in content and set its properties
1In the Design view of the Document window, place the insertion point where you want to insert the content, then
do one of the following:
In the Common category of the Insert panel, click the Media button and select the Plugin icon from the
menu.
301
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Select Insert > Media > Plugin.
2In the dialog box that appears, select a content file for a plug-in and click OK.
3Set the plug-in options in the Property inspector.
Name Specifies a name to identify the plug-in for scripting. Enter a name in the unlabeled text box on the far left
side of the Property inspector.
W and H Specify, in pixels, the width and height allocated to the object on the page.
Src Specifies the source data file. Click the folder icon to browse to a file, or enter a filename.
Plg Url Specifies the URL of the pluginspace attribute. Enter the complete URL of the site where users can download
the plug-in. If the user viewing your page does not have the plug-in, the browser tries to download it from this URL.
Align Determines how the object is aligned on the page.
V Space and H Space Specify the amount of white space in pixels above, below, and on both sides of the plug-in.
Border Specifies the width of the border around the plug-in.
Parameters Opens a dialog box for entering additional parameters to pass to the plug-in. Many plug-ins respond to
special parameters.
You can also view the attributes assigned to the selected plug-in by clicking the Attribute button. You can edit, add,
and delete attributes such as width and height in this dialog box.
Play plug-in content in the Document window
1Insert one or more media elements using one of the methods described in the previous section.
2Do one of the following:
Select one of the media elements you have inserted, and select View > Plugins > Play or click the Play button in
the Property inspector.
Select View > Plugins > Play All to play all of the media elements on the selected page that rely on plug-ins.
Note: Play All only applies to the current document; it does not apply to other documents in a frameset, for example.
Stop playing plug-in content
Select a media element and select View > Plugins >Stop, or click the Stop button in the Property inspector.
You can also select View > Plugins > Stop All to stop all plug-in content from playing.
Troubleshooting plug-ins
If you have followed the steps to play plug-in content in the Document window, but some of the plug-in content does
not play, try the following:
Make sure the associated plug-in is installed on your computer, and that the content is compatible with the version
of the plug-in you have.
Open the file Configuration/Plugins/UnsupportedPlugins.txt in a text editor and look to see if the problematic
plug-in is listed. This file keeps track of plug-ins that cause problems in Dreamweaver and are therefore
unsupported. (If you experience problems with a particular plug-in, consider adding it to this file.)
Check that you have enough memory. Some plug-ins require an additional 2 to 5 MB of memory to run.
302
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Insert an ActiveX control
You can insert an ActiveX control in your page. ActiveX controls (formerly known as OLE controls) are reusable
components, somewhat like miniature applications, that can act like browser plug-ins. They run in Internet Explorer
with Windows, but they don’t run on the Macintosh browsers. The ActiveX object in Dreamweaver lets you supply
attributes and parameters for an ActiveX control in your visitor’s browser.
After inserting an ActiveX object, use the Property inspector to set attributes of the object tag and parameters for the
ActiveX control. Click Parameters in the Property inspector to enter names and values for properties that don’t appear
in the Property inspector. There is no widely accepted standard format for parameters for ActiveX controls; to find out
which parameters to use, consult the documentation for the ActiveX control you’re using.
In the Document window, place the insertion point where you want to insert the content and do one of the
following:
In the Common category of the Insert panel, click the Media button and select the ActiveX icon .
In the Common category of the Insert panel, click the Media button and select the ActiveX icon. With the
ActiveX icon displayed in the Insert panel, you can drag the icon to the Document window.
Select Insert > Media > ActiveX. An icon marks where the ActiveX control will appear on the page in Internet
Explorer.
ActiveX properties
The Property inspector initially displays the most commonly used properties. Click the expander arrow in the
lower-right corner to see all properties.
Name Specifies a name to identify the ActiveX object for scripting. Enter a name in the unlabeled text box on the far
left side of the Property inspector.
W and H Specify the width and height of the object, in pixels.
Class ID Identifies the ActiveX control to the browser. Enter a value or select one from the pop-up menu. When the
page is loaded, the browser uses the class ID to locate the ActiveX control required for the ActiveX object associated
with the page. If the browser doesn’t locate the specified ActiveX control, it attempts to download it from the location
specified in Base.
Embed Adds an embed tag within the object tag for the ActiveX control. If the ActiveX control has another plug-in
equivalent, the embed tag activates the plug-in. Dreamweaver assigns the values you entered as ActiveX properties to
their plug-in equivalents.
Align Determines how the object is aligned on the page.
Parameters Opens a dialog box for entering additional parameters to pass to the ActiveX object. Many ActiveX
controls respond to special parameters.
Src Defines the data file to be used for a plug-in if the Embed option is turned on. If you dont enter a value,
Dreamweaver attempts to determine the value from the ActiveX properties entered already.
V Space and H Space Specify the amount of white space, in pixels, above, below, and on both sides of the object.
Base Specifies the URL containing the ActiveX control. Internet Explorer downloads the ActiveX control from this
location if it has not been installed in the visitors system. If you don’t specify a Base parameter and if your visitor doesnt
already have the relevant ActiveX control installed, the browser can’t display the ActiveX object.
Alt Img Specifies an image to be displayed if the browser doesnt support the object tag. This option is available only
when the Embed option is deselected.
303
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Data Specifies a data file for the ActiveX control to load. Many ActiveX controls, such as Shockwave and RealPlayer,
do not use this parameter.
Insert a Java applet
You can insert a Java applet into an HTML document using Dreamweaver. Java is a programming language that allows
the development of lightweight applications (applets) that can be embedded in web pages.
After inserting a Java applet, use the Property inspector to set parameters. To view the following properties in the
Property inspector, select a Java applet.
1In the Document window, place the insertion point where you want to insert the applet, and then do one of the
following:
In the Common category of the Insert panel, click the Media button and select the Applet icon .
Select Insert > Media > Applet.
2Select a file containing a Java applet.
Java applet properties
The Property inspector initially displays the most commonly used properties. Click the expander arrow in the
lower-right corner to see all properties.
Name Specifies a name to identify the applet for scripting. Enter a name in the unlabeled text box on the far left side
of the Property inspector.
W and H Specify the width and height of the applet, in pixels.
Code Specifies the file containing the applet’s Java code. Click the folder icon to browse to a file, or enter a filename.
Base Identifies the folder containing the selected applet. When you select an applet, this text box is filled automatically.
Align Determines how the object is aligned on the page.
Alt Specifies alternative content (usually an image) to be displayed if the user’s browser doesn’t support Java applets or
has Java disabled. If you enter text, Dreamweaver inserts the text as the value of the applets alt attribute. If you select an
image, Dreamweaver inserts an img tag between the opening and closing applet tags.
V Space and H Space Specify the amount of white space in pixels above, below, and on both sides of the applet.
Parameters Opens a dialog box for entering additional parameters to pass to the applet. Many applets respond to
special parameters.
Using behaviors to control media
You can add behaviors to your page to start and stop various media objects.
Control Shockwave Or Flash Play, stop, rewind, or go to a frame in a Shockwave movie or SWF file.
Play Sound Lets you play a sound; for example, you can play a sound effect whenever the user moves the mouse pointer
over a link.
Check Plugin Lets you check to see if visitors to your site have the required plug-in installed, then route them to
different URLs, depending on whether they have the right plug-in. This only applies to plug-ins, as the Check Plugin
behavior does not check for ActiveX controls.
304
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Use parameters to control media objects
Define special parameters to control Shockwave and SWF files, ActiveX controls, plug-ins, and Java applets. Parameters
are used with the object, embed, and applet tags. Parameters set attributes specific to different types of objects. For
example, a SWF file can use a quality parameter <paramname="quality"value="best"> for the object tag. The Parameter
dialog box is available from the Property inspector. See the documentation for the object youre using for information
on the parameters it requires.
Note: There is no widely accepted standard for identifying data files for ActiveX controls. Consult the documentation for
the ActiveX control you’re using to find out which parameters to use.
Enter a name and value for a parameter
1Select an object that can have parameters (such as a Shockwave movie, an ActiveX control, a plug-in, or a Java applet)
in the Document window.
2Open the dialog box using one of the following methods:
Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the object, and select Parameters from the context menu.
Open the Property inspector if it isn’t already open, and click the Parameters button found in the lower half of
the Property inspector. (Make sure the Property inspector is expanded.)
3Click the Plus (+) button and enter the parameter name and value in the appropriate columns.
Remove a parameter
Select a parameter and press the minus (–) button.
Reorder parameters
Select a parameter, and use the up and down arrow buttons.
More Help topics
Optimize the work space for accessible page design
Enable and disable Design Notes for a site
Storing file information in Design Notes
Set SWF file properties
Apply the Control Shockwave or SWF behavior
Apply the Play Sound behavior
Apply the Check Plugin behavior
Adding video
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Embed videos in web pages (HTML5)
HTML5 supports video and audio tags that allow users to play video and audio files in a browser, without an external
plug-in or player. Dreamweaver supports code hints for adding video and audio tags.
305
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Live View renders the video, providing a preview of the video that you are embedding in the web page.
Note: Although you can embed any video in your web page, Live View does not always render all videos. The audio and
video tags are supported in Dreamweaver using the Apple QuickTime plug-in. In Windows, if the Apple QuickTime plug-
in is not installed, then the web page does not render the media content.
Inserting FLV files
Insert FLV files
You can easily add FLV video to your web pages without using the Flash authoring tool. You must have an encoded FLV
file before you begin.
Dreamweaver inserts a SWF component that displays the FLV file; when viewed in a browser, this component displays
the selected FLV file, as well as a set of playback controls.
Dreamweaver gives you the following options for delivering FLV video to your site visitors:
Progressive Download Video Downloads the FLV file to the site visitors hard disk and then plays it. Unlike traditional
download and play” methods of video delivery, however, progressive download allows the video file to start playing
before the download is complete.
Streaming Video Streams the video content and plays it on a web page after a short buffer period that ensures smooth
play back. To enable streaming video on your web pages, you must have access to Adobe® Flash® Media Server.
You must have an encoded FLV file before you can use it in Dreamweaver. You can insert video files created with two
kinds of codecs (compression/decompression technologies): Sorenson Squeeze and On2.
As with regular SWF files, when you insert an FLV file, Dreamweaver inserts code that detects whether the user has the
correct version of Flash Player to view the video. If the user does not have the correct version, the page displays
alternative content that prompts the user to download the latest version of Flash Player.
Note: To view FLV files, users must have Flash Player 8 or later installed on their computers. If a user does not have the
required version of Flash Player installed, but does have Flash Player 6.0 r65 or later installed, the browser displays a Flash
Player express installer instead of the alternative content. If the user declines the express install, the page then displays the
alternative content.
306
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
For more information about working with video, visit the Video Technology Center at
www.adobe.com/go/flv_devcenter.
Insert an FLV file
1Select Insert > Media > FLV.
2In the Insert FLV dialog box, select Progressive Download or Streaming Video from the Video Type pop-up menu.
3Complete the rest of the dialog box options and click OK.
Note: Microsoft Internet Information Server (IIS) does not process nested object tags. For ASP pages, Dreamweaver uses
nested object/embed code instead of nested object code when inserting SWF or FLV files.
Set options for progressive download video
The Insert FLV dialog box lets you set options for progressive download delivery of an FLV file inserted in a web page.
1Select Insert > Media > FLV (or click the FLV icon in the Media category of the Common insert bar).
2In the Insert FLV dialog box, select Progressive Download Video from the Video Type menu.
3Specify the following options:
URL Specifies a relative or absolute path to the FLV file. To specify a relative path (for example,
mypath/myvideo.flv), click the Browse button, navigate to the FLV file, and select it. To specify an absolute path,
type the URL (for example, http://www.example.com/myvideo.flv) of the FLV file.
Skin Specifies the appearance of the video component. A preview of the selected skin appears beneath the Skin pop-
up menu.
Width Specifies the width of the FLV file, in pixels. To have Dreamweaver determine the exact width of the FLV file,
click the Detect Size button. If Dreamweaver cannot determine the width, you must type a width value.
Height Specifies the height of the FLV file, in pixels. To have Dreamweaver determine the exact height of the FLV
file, click the Detect Size button. If Dreamweaver cannot determine the height, you must type a height value.
Note: Total With Skin is the width and height of the FLV file plus the width and height of the selected skin.
Constrain Maintains the same aspect ratio between the width and height of the video component. This option is
selected by default.
Auto Play Specifies whether to play the video when the web page is opened.
Auto Rewind Specifies whether the playback control returns to starting position after the video finishes playing.
4Click OK to close the dialog box and add the FLV file to your web page.
The Insert FLV command generates a video player SWF file and a skin SWF file that are used to display your video
content on a web page. (To see the new files, you may need to click the Refresh button in the Files panel.) These files
are stored in the same directory as the HTML file to which youre adding video content. When you upload the
HTML page containing the FLV file, Dreamweaver uploads these files as dependent files (as long as you click Yes in
the Put Dependent Files dialog box).
Set options for streaming video
The Insert FLV dialog box lets you set options for streaming video download of an FLV file inserted in a web page.
1Select Insert > Media > FLV (or click the FLV icon in the Media category of the Common insert bar).
307
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
2Select Streaming Video from the Video Type pop-up menu.
Server URI Specifies the server name, application name, and instance name in the form
rtmp://www.example.com/app_name/instance_name.
Stream Name Specifies the name of the FLV file that you want to play (for example, myvideo.flv). The .flv extension
is optional.
Skin Specifies the appearance of the video component. A preview of the selected skin appears beneath the Skin pop-
up menu.
Width Specifies the width of the FLV file, in pixels. To have Dreamweaver determine the exact width of the FLV file,
click the Detect Size button. If Dreamweaver cannot determine the width, you must type a width value.
Height Specifies the height of the FLV file, in pixels. To have Dreamweaver determine the exact height of the FLV
file, click the Detect Size button. If Dreamweaver cannot determine the height, you must type a height value.
Note: Total With Skin is the width and height of the FLV file plus the width and height of the selected skin.
Constrain Maintains the same aspect ratio between the width and height of the video component. This option is
selected by default.
Live Video Feed Specifies whether the video content is live. If Live Video Feed is selected, Flash Player plays a live
video feed streamed from Flash® Media Server. The name of the live video feed is the name specified in the Stream
Name text box.
Note: When you select Live Video Feed, only the volume control appears on the component’s skin, because you cannot
manipulate live video. Additionally, the Auto Play and Auto Rewind options have no effect.
Auto Play Specifies whether to play the video when the web page is opened.
Auto Rewind Specifies whether the playback control returns to starting position after the video finishes playing.
Buffer Time Specifies the time, in seconds, required for buffering before the video starts playing. The default buffer
time is set to 0 so that the video starts playing instantly after the Play button is clicked. (If Auto Play is selected, the
video starts playing as soon as a connection is made with the server.) You might want to set a buffer time if you are
delivering video that has a higher bit rate than the site visitors connection speed, or when Internet traffic might
cause bandwidth or connectivity problems. For example, if you want to send 15 seconds of video to the web page
before the web page starts to play the video, set the buffer time to 15.
3Click OK to close the dialog box and add the FLV file to your web page.
The Insert FLV command generates a video player SWF file and a skin SWF file that are used to display your video
on a web page. The command also generates a main.asc file that you must upload to your Flash Media Server. (To
see the new files, you may need to click the Refresh button in the Files panel.) These files are stored in the same
directory as the HTML file to which you’re adding video content. When you upload the HTML page containing the
FLV file, dont forget to upload the SWF files to your web server, and the main.asc file to your Flash Media Server.
Note: If you already have a main.asc file on your server, check with your server administrator before uploading the
main.asc file generated by the Insert FLV command.
You can easily upload all of the required media files by selecting the video component placeholder in the
Dreamweaver Document window, and clicking the Upload Media button in the Property inspector (Window >
Properties). To see a list of required files, click Show required files.
Note: The Upload Media button does not upload the HTML file that contains the video content.
308
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Edit Flash Player download information
When you insert an FLV file in a page, Dreamweaver inserts code that detects whether the user has the correct version
of Flash Player. If not, the page displays default alternative content that prompts the user to download the latest version.
You can change this alternative content at any time.
This procedure also applies to SWF files.
Note: If a user does not have the required version but does have Flash Player 6.0 r65 or later, the browser displays a Flash
Player express installer. If the user declines the express install, the page then displays the alternative content.
1In the Design view of the Document window, select the SWF file or FLV file.
2Click the eye icon in the tab of the SWF file or FLV file.
You can also press Control + ] to switch to alternative content view. To return to SWF/FLV view, press Control + [
until all of the alternative content is selected. Then press Control + [ again.
3Edit the content just as you would edit any other content in Dreamweaver.
Note: You cannot add SWF files or FLV files as alternative content.
4Click the eye icon again to return to the SWF or FLV file view.
Troubleshoot FLV files
This section details some of the most common causes of problems with FLV files.
Viewing problems caused by absence of related files
The code generated by Dreamweaver CS4 and later relies on four dependent files, different from the FLV file itself:
swfobject_modified.js
expressInstall.swf
FLVPlayer_Progressive.swf
The skin file (for example Clear_Skin_1.swf)
Note that there are two more dependent files for Dreamweaver CS4 and later, compared to Dreamweaver CS3.
The first two of these files (swfobject_modified.js and expressInstall.swf) are installed in a folder called Scripts, which
Dreamweaver creates in the root of your site if it doesn't already exist.
The second two files (FLVPlayer_Progressive.swf and the skin file) are installed in the same folder as the page in which
the FLV is embedded. The skin file contains the controls for the FLV, and its name depends on the skin chosen in the
options described in Dreamweaver Help. For example, if you choose Clear Skin, the file is named Clear_Skin_1.swf.
All four dependent files MUST be uploaded to your remote server for the FLV to display correctly.
Forgetting to upload these files is the most common cause of FLV files failing to run correctly in a web page. If one of
the files is missing, you might see a "white box" on the page.
To ensure that you've uploaded all of the dependent files, use the Dreamweaver Files panel to upload the page in which
the FLV appears. When you upload the page, Dreamweaver asks you if you want to upload dependent files (unless
you've turned off this option). Click yes to upload dependent files.
Viewing problems when previewing pages locally
Because of security updates in Dreamweaver CS4, you cannot use the Preview in Browser command to test a page with
an embedded FLV unless you define a local testing server in your Dreamweaver site definition and use the testing server
to preview the page.
309
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Normally, you require a testing server only if you are developing pages with ASP, ColdFusion, or PHP (see Set up your
computer for application development ). If you are building websites that use only HTML, and haven't defined a testing
server, pressing F12 (Windows) Opt+F12 (Macintosh) produces a jumble of skin controls onscreen. The workaround
is either to define the testing server and use the testing server to preview your page, or upload your files to a remote
server and view them there.
Note: It’s possible that security settings may also be responsible for an inability to preview local FLV content, but Adobe has
not been able to confirm this. You can try changing your security settings to see if it helps. For more information on changing
your security settings, see Tech Note 117502.
Other possible causes for problems with FLV files
If you are having trouble previewing locally, make sure the Preview using temporary file option is deselected under
Edit > Preferences > Preview in Browser
Make sure you have the latest FlashPlayer plug-in
Be wary of moving files and folders around outside of Dreamweaver. When you move files and folders outside of
Dreamweaver, Dreamweaver cannot guarantee the correct paths to FLV-related files.
You can temporarily replace the FLV file thats giving you trouble with a known working FLV file. If the replacement
FLV file works, then the problem is with the original FLV file, and not with your browser or computer.
Edit or delete an FLV component
Change the settings for the video on your web page, by selecting the video component placeholder in the Dreamweaver
Document window and using the Property inspector. Another way is to delete the video component and reinsert it by
selecting Insert > Media > FLV.
Edit the FLV component
1Select the video component placeholder in the Dreamweaver Document window by clicking the FLV icon at the
center of the placeholder.
2Open the Property inspector (Window > Properties) and make your changes.
Note: You cannot change video types (from progressive download to streaming, for example) by using the Property
inspector. To change the video type, delete the FLV component, and reinsert it by selecting Insert > Media > FLV.
Delete the FLV component
Select the FLV component placeholder in the Dreamweaver Document window and press Delete.
Remove FLV detection code
For Dreamweaver CS4 and later, Dreamweaver inserts Flash Player detection code directly in the object tag that
contains the FLV file. For Dreamweaver CS3 and earlier, however, the detection code resides outside the FLV files object
tag. For this reason, if you want to delete FLV files from pages created with Dreamweaver CS3 and earlier, you must
remove the FLV files and use the Remove FLV detection command to remove the detection code.
Select Commands > Remove Flash Video Detection.
Insert HTML5 video
Dreamweaver allows you to insert HTML5 video into web pages.
The HTML5 video element provides a standard way to embed movies or videos in web pages.
310
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
For more information on HTML5 video element, see the article on HTML5 Video at W3schools.com.
More Help topics
Adding HTML5 video in Dreamweaver
Insert HTML5 video
1Ensure that your cursor is at the location where you want to insert the video.
2Select Insert > Media > HTML5 Video. The HTML5 video element is inserted at the specified location.
3In the Properties panel, specify values for the various options.
Source / Alt Source 1 / Alt Source 2: In Source, enter the location of the video file. Alternatively, click the folder
icon to select a video file from the local file system. Support for a video format varies on different browsers. If the
video format in Source is not supported on a browser, the video format specified in Alt Source 1 or Alt Source 2
is used. The browser selects the first recognized format to display the video.
To quickly add videos to the three fields, use multiple selection. When you choose three video formats for the same
video from a folder, the first format in the list is used for the Source. The following formats in the list are used to
auto-fill Alt Source 1 and Alt Source 2.
See the table below for more information on browser and supported video format. For the latest info, see HTML5 -
Browser Support.
Title: Specify a title for the video.
Width (W): Enter the width in pixel of the video.
Height (H): Enter the height in pixel of the video.
Controls: Select if you want to display the video controls such as Play, Pause, and Mute in the HTML page.
Autoplay: Select if you want the video to start playing as soon as it loads on the web page.
Poster: Enter the location of the image you want displayed until the video completes downloading, or until the
user clicks Play. The Width and Height values are auto-filled when you insert the image.
Loop: Select this option if you want the video to continuously play until the user stops playing the movie.
Muted: Select this option if you want to mute the audio portion of the video.
Flash Video: Select a SWF file for browsers that do not support HTML5 video.
Fallback text: Provide the text to display if the browser doesn't support HTML5.
Preload: Specifies the author preferences on how the video should be loaded when the page loads. Selecting Auto
loads the entire video on page download. Selecting Metadata downloads only the metadata after the page
download is complete.
Browser MP4 WebM Ogg
Internet Explorer 9 YES NO NO
Firefox 4.0 NO YES YES
Google Chrome 6 YES YES YES
Apple Safari 5 YES NO NO
Opera 10.6 NO YES YES
311
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Preview the video in browser
1Save the web page.
2Select File > Preview in Browser. Select the browser in which you want to preview the video.
Inserting SWF files
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About FLA, SWF, and FLV file types
Before you use Dreamweaver to insert content created with Adobe Flash, you should be familiar with the following
different file types:
FLA file (.fla) The source file for any project and created in the Flash authoring tool. This type of file can only be opened
in Flash (not in Dreamweaver or in browsers). You can open the FLA file in Flash, then publish it as a SWF or SWT file
to use in browsers.
SWF file (.swf) A compiled version of the FLA (.fla) file, optimized for viewing on the web. This file can be played back
in browsers and previewed in Dreamweaver, but cannot be edited in Flash.
FLV file (.flv) A video file that contains encoded audio and video data for delivery through Flash® Player. For example,
if you had a QuickTime or Windows Media video file, you would use an encoder (such as Flash® Video Encoder, or
Sorensen Squeeze) to convert the video file to an FLV file. For more information, visit the Video Technology Center at
www.adobe.com/go/flv_devcenter.
Insert and preview SWF files
Use Dreamweaver to add SWF files to your pages, and then preview them in a document or a browser. You can also set
properties for SWF files in the Property inspector.
For a tutorial on adding SWF files to web pages, see www.adobe.com/go/vid0150.
Insert a SWF file
1In the Design view of the Document window, place the insertion point where you want to insert the content, then
do one of the following:
In the Common category of the Insert panel, select Media and click the SWF icon .
Select Insert > Media > SWF.
2In the dialog box that appears, select a SWF file (.swf).
A SWF file placeholder appears in the Document window.
312
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
The placeholder has a tabbed blue outline. The tab indicates the type of asset (SWF file) and the ID of the SWF file.
The tab also displays an eye icon. It acts as toggle between the SWF file and the download information users see
when they dont have the correct version of Flash Player.
3Save the file.
Dreamweaver informs you that two dependent files, expressInstall.swf and swfobject_modified.js, are being saved
to a Scripts folder in your site. Don’t forget to upload these files when you upload the SWF file to your web server.
Browsers can’t display the SWF file properly unless you have also uploaded these dependent files.
Note: Microsoft Internet Information Server (IIS) does not process nested object tags. For ASP pages, Dreamweaver uses
nested object/embed code instead of nested object code when inserting SWF or FLV files.
Edit Flash Player download information
When you insert a SWF file in a page, Dreamweaver inserts code that detects whether the user has the correct version
of Flash Player. If not, the page displays default alternative content that prompts the user to download the latest version.
You can change this alternative content at any time.
This procedure also applies to FLV files.
Note: If a user does not have the required version but does have Flash Player 6.0 r65 or later, the browser displays a Flash
Player express installer. If the user declines the express install, the page then displays the alternative content.
1In the Design view of the Document window, select the SWF file or FLV file.
2Click the eye icon in the tab of the SWF file or FLV file.
You can also press Control + ] to switch to alternative content view. To return to SWF/FLV view, press Control + [
until all of the alternative content is selected. Then press Control + [ again.
3Edit the content just as you would edit any other content in Dreamweaver.
Note: You cannot add SWF files or FLV files as alternative content.
4Click the eye icon again to return to the SWF (or FLV) file view.
Preview SWF files in the Document window
1In the Document window, click the SWF file placeholder to select the content.
2In the Property inspector (Window > Properties), click the Play button. Click Stop to end the preview. You can also
preview the SWF file in a browser by pressing F12.
To preview all SWF files in a page, press Control+Alt+Shift+P (Windows) or Command+Option+Shift+P
(Macintosh). All SWF files are set to Play.
313
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Set SWF file properties
You can set properties for SWF files using the Property inspector. The properties are also applicable to Shockwave
movies.
Select a SWF file or a Shockwave movie and set the options in the Property inspector (Window > Properties). To see
all properties, click the expander arrow in the lower-right corner of the Property inspector.
ID Specifies a unique ID for the SWF file. Enter an ID in the unlabeled text box on the far left side of the Property
inspector. As of Dreamweaver CS4, a unique ID is required.
W and H Specify the width and height of the movie, in pixels.
File Specifies the path to the SWF file or Shockwave file. Click the folder icon to browse to a file, or type a path.
Src Specifies the path to the source document (the FLA file), when Dreamweaver and Flash are both installed on
your computer. To edit a SWF file, update the movies source document.
Bg Specifies a background color for the movie area. This color also appears while the movie is not playing (while
loading and after playing).
Edit Starts Flash to update a FLA file (a file created in the Flash authoring tool). This option is disabled if you do
not have Flash installed on your computer.
Class Lets you apply a CSS class to the movie.
Loop Makes the movie play continuously. When Loop is not selected, the movie plays once and stops.
Autoplay Automatically plays the movie when the page loads.
V Space and H Space Specifies the number of pixels of white space above, below, and on both sides of the movie.
Quality Controls anti-aliasing during playback of the movie. High settings improve the appearance of movies.
However, at high settings movies require a faster processor to render correctly on the screen. Low favors speed over
appearance, whereas High favors appearance over speed. Auto Low favors speed at first but improves appearance
when possible. Auto High favors both qualities equally at first but later sacrifices appearance for speed if necessary.
Scale Determines how the movie fits into the dimensions set in the width and height text boxes. The Default setting
displays the entire movie.
Align Determines how the movie is aligned on the page.
Wmode Sets the Wmode parameter for the SWF file to avoid conflicts with DHTML elements, such as Spry widgets.
The default value is Opaque, which allows DHTML elements to appear on top of SWF files in a browser. If the SWF
file includes transparencies and you want DHTML elements to appear behind them, select the Transparent option.
Select the Window option to remove the Wmode parameter from the code and allow the SWF file to appear on top
of other DHTML elements.
Play Plays the movie in the Document window.
Parameters Opens a dialog box for entering additional parameters to pass to the movie. The movie must be
designed to receive these additional parameters.
Insert FlashPaper documents
The Insert FlashPaper feature has been deprecated as of Dreamweaver CS5.
314
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
More Help topics
Working with Flash and Dreamweaver
Inserting FLV files
Working with Flash and Dreamweaver
Edit a SWF file from Dreamweaver in Flash
SWF files and DHTML layers
Insert Shockwave movies
Inserting FLV files
Working with Flash tutorial
Adding web widgets
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
A web widget is a web page component comprised of HTML, CSS, and JavaScript. Examples of web widgets include
accordions, tabbed panels, and calendars.
You can make your own personal selection of web widgets available in Dreamweaver by using the Adobe Widget
Browser—an AIR application that lets you browse, configure, and preview widgets using a visual interface.
1Select Insert > Widget.
2In the Widget dialog box, select a widget and preset (if applicable) and click OK.
You can also add a web widget to a Dreamweaver page (CS5.5 and later) by doing the following:
1In the Widget Browser, navigate to My Widgets.
2Select the widget you want to add.
3Click and hold the Drag and Drop in Dreamweaver icon at the upper left corner of the Live View tab. Drag the
widget to Dreamweaver into Design view (Windows) or Design or Code view (Macintosh OS).
You cannot drag and drop the widget into Live view, but you can use Live view to test the widget once you’ve dropped
it into the page.
More Help topics
Adobe Widget Browser Help
Working with Spry widgets (general instructions)
Adding Sound
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
315
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Audio file formats
You can add sound to a web page. There are several different types of sound files and formats, including .wav, .midi,
and .mp3. Some factors to consider before deciding on a format and method for adding sound are its purpose, your
audience, file size, sound quality, and differences in browsers.
Note: Sound files are handled very differently and inconsistently by different browsers. You may want to add a sound file
to a SWF file and then embed the SWF file to improve consistency.
The following list describes the more common audio file formats along with some of the advantages and disadvantages
of each for web design.
.midi or .mid (Musical Instrument Digital Interface) This format is for instrumental music. MIDI files are supported by
many browsers and don’t require a plug-in. Although their sound quality is very good, it can vary depending on a
visitor’s sound card. A small MIDI file can provide a long sound clip. MIDI files cannot be recorded and must be
synthesized on a computer with special hardware and software.
.wav (Waveform Extension) These files have good sound quality, are supported by many browsers, and don’t require a
plug-in. You can record your own WAV files from a CD, tape, microphone, and so on. However, the large file size
severely limits the length of sound clips that you can use on your web pages.
.aif (Audio Interchange File Format, or AIFF) The AIFF format, like WAV format, has good sound quality, can be played
by most browsers, and doesn’t require a plug-in; you can also record AIFF files from a CD, tape, microphone, and so
on. However, the large file size severely limits the length of sound clips that you can use on your web pages.
.mp3 (Motion Picture Experts Group Audio, or MPEG-Audio Layer-3) A compressed format that makes sound files
substantially smaller. The sound quality is very good: if an mp3 file is recorded and compressed properly, its quality can
rival that of a CD. mp3 technology lets you stream” the file so that a visitor doesn’t have to wait for the entire file to
download before hearing it. However, the file size is larger than a Real Audio file, so an entire song could still take quite
a while to download over a typical dial-up (telephone line) modem connection. To play mp3 files, visitors must
download and install a helper application or plug-in, such as QuickTime, Windows Media Player or RealPlayer.
.ra, .ram, .rpm, or Real Audio This format has a high degree of compression, with smaller file sizes than mp3. Entire
song files can be downloaded in a reasonable amount of time. Because the files can be “streamed” from a normal web
server, visitors can begin listening to the sound before the file has completely downloaded. Visitors must download and
install the RealPlayer helper application or plug-in to play these files.
.qt, .qtm, .mov or QuickTime This format is both an audio and video format developed by Apple Computer. QuickTime
is included with Apple Macintosh operating systems, and is used by most Macintosh applications that use audio, video,
or animation. PCs can also play files in QuickTime format, but require a special QuickTime driver. QuickTime supports
most encoding formats, including Cinepak, JPEG, and MPEG.
Note: In addition to the more common formats listed above, there are many different audio and video file formats available
for use on the web. If you encounter a media file format that you are unfamiliar with, locate the creator of the format for
information on how best to use and deploy it.
Link to an audio file
Linking to an audio file is a simple and effective way to add sound to a web page. This method of incorporating sound
files lets visitors choose whether they want to listen to the file, and makes the file available to the widest audience.
1Select the text or image you want to use as the link to the audio file.
2In the Property inspector, click the folder icon next to the Link text box to browse for the audio file, or type the files
path and name in the Link text box.
316
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Embed a sound file
Embedding audio incorporates the sound directly into the page, but the sound only plays if visitors to your site have
the appropriate plug-in for the chosen sound file. Embed files if you want to use the sound as background music, or if
you want to control the volume, the way the player looks on the page, or the beginning and ending points of the sound
file.
When incorporating sound files in your web pages, carefully consider their appropriate use in your web site, and how
visitors to your site use these media resources. Always provide a control to either enable or disable the playing of the
sound, in the event that visitors don’t want to listen to the audio content.
1In Design view, place the insertion point where you want to embed the file and do one of the following:
In the Common category of the Insert panel, click the Media button and select the Plugin icon from the pop-
up menu.
Select Insert > Media > Plugin.
2Browse for the audio file and click OK.
3Enter the width and height by entering the values in the appropriate text boxes in the Property inspector or by
resizing the plug-in placeholder in the Document window.
These values determine the size at which the audio controls are displayed in the browser.
More Help topics
Insert and edit media objects
Insert HTML5 audio
Dreamweaver allows you to insert and preview HTML5 audio in web pages. The HTML5 audio element provides a
standard way to embed audio content into web pages.
For more information on HTML5 audio element, see the article on HTML5 audio at W3schools.com.
Insert HTML5 audio
1Ensure that your cursor is at the location where you want to insert the audio.
2Select Insert > Media > HTML5 Audio. The audio file is inserted at the specified location.
3In the Properties panel, enter the following information:
Source / Alt Source 1 / Alt Source 2: In Source, enter the location of the audio file. Alternatively, click the folder
icon to select an audio file from your computer. Support for audio formats varies on different browsers. If the
audio format in Source is not supported, the format specified in Alt Source 1 or Alt Source 2 is used. The browser
selects the first recognized format to display the audio.
To quickly add videos to the three fields, use multiple selection. When you choose three video formats for the same
video from a folder, the first format in the list is used for the Source. The following formats in the list are used to
auto-fill Alt Source 1 and Alt Source 2.
317
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Title: Enter a title for the audio file.
Fallback text: Enter the text to be displayed in browsers that do not support HTML5.
Controls: Select if you want to display audio controls such as Play, Pause, and Mute in the HTML page.
Autoplay: Select if you want the audio to start playing as soon as it loads on the web page.
Loop Audio: Select this option if you want the audio to continuously play until the user stops playing it.
Mute: Select this option if you want to mute the audio after download.
Preload: Selecting Auto loads the entire audio file on page download. Selecting Metadata downloads only the
metadata after the page download is complete.
Preview the audio in browser
1Save the web page.
2Select File > Preview in Browser. Select the browser in which you want to preview the audio.
Automating tasks
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Task automation
The History panel records the steps you take when you complete a task. Automate a frequently performed task by
replaying those steps from the History panel or creating a new command that performs the steps automatically.
Certain mouse movements, such as selecting by clicking in the Document window, can’t be played back or saved. When
you make such a movement, a black line appears in the History panel (the line does not become obvious until you
perform another action). To avoid this, use the arrow keys instead of the mouse to move the insertion point within the
Document window
Some other steps also aren’t repeatable, such as dragging a page element to somewhere else on the page. When you
perform such a step, an icon with a small red X appears in the History panel.
Browser MP3 Wav Ogg
Internet Explorer 9 YES NO NO
Firefox 4.0 NO YES YES
Google Chrome 6 YES YES YES
Apple Safari 5 YES YES NO
Opera 10.6 NO YES YES
318
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Saved commands are retained permanently (unless you delete them), while recorded commands are discarded when
you exit from Adobe Dreamweaver, and copied sequences of steps are discarded when you copy something else
Use the History panel
The History panel (Window > History) shows a list of the steps you’ve performed in the active document since you
created or opened that document (but not steps you’ve performed in other frames, in other Document windows, or in
the Site panel). Use the History panel to undo multiple steps at once and to automate tasks.
A Slider (thumb) B Steps C Replay button D Copy Steps button E Save As Command button
The slider, or thumb, in the History panel initially points to the last step that you performed.
Note: You can’t rearrange the order of steps in the History panel. Don’t think of the History panel as an arbitrary collection
of commands; think of it as a way to view the steps youve performed, in the order in which you performed them.
Undo the last step
Do one of the following:
Select Edit > Undo.
Drag the History panel slider up one step in the list.
Note: To scroll automatically to a particular step, you must click to the left of the step; clicking the step itself selects the
step. Selecting a step is different from going back to that step in your undo history.
Undo multiple steps at once
Drag the slider to point to any step, or click to the left of a step along the path of the slider.
The slider scrolls automatically to that step, undoing steps as it scrolls.
Note: As with undoing a single step, if you undo a series of steps and then do something new in the document, you can
no longer redo the undone steps; they disappear from the History panel.
Set the number of steps that the History panel retains and shows
The default number of steps is sufficient for most users’ needs. The higher the number, the more memory the History
panel requires, which can affect performance and slow your computer significantly.
1Select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh).
2Select General from the Category list on the left.
3Enter a number for Maximum Number Of History Steps.
When the History panel reaches this maximum number of steps, the earliest steps are discarded.
319
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Erase the history list for the current document:
In the History panels context menu, select Clear History.
This command also clears all undo information for the current document; after choosing Clear History, you cant
undo the steps that are cleared. Clear History does not undo steps; it merely removes the record of those steps from
memory.
Repeat steps
Use the History panel to repeat the last step you performed, repeat a series of adjacent steps, or repeat a series of
nonadjacent steps. Replay the steps directly from the History panel.
Repeat one step
Do one of the following:
Select Edit > Redo.
In the History panel, select a step and click the Replay button. The step is replayed and a copy of it appears in the
History panel.
Repeat a series of steps
1Select steps in the History panel:
To select adjacent steps, drag from one step to another (don’t drag the slider; just drag from the text label of one
step to the text label of another step), or select the first step, and then Shift-click the last step.
To select nonadjacent steps, select a step, and then Control-click (Windows) or Command-click (Macintosh) to
select or deselect other steps.
The steps played are the selected (highlighted) steps, not necessarily the step the slider currently points to.
Note: Although you can select a series of steps that includes a black line indicating a step that cant be recorded, that step
is skipped when you replay the steps.
2Click Replay.
The steps are replayed in order, and a new step, Replay Steps, appears in the History panel.
Make or extend a selection
Hold down the Shift key while pressing an arrow key.
If a black mouse-movement indicator line appears while youre performing a task you want to repeat later, you can
undo back to before that step and try another approach, perhaps using the arrow keys.
Apply steps in the History panel to objects
You can apply a set of steps from the History panel to any object in the Document window.
If you select multiple objects and then apply steps to them from the History panel, the objects are treated as a single
selection and Dreamweaver attempts to apply the steps to that combined selection; however, you can apply a set of steps
only to a single object at a time.
To apply the steps to each object in a set of objects, you must make the last step in the series select the next object in the
set. The second procedure demonstrates this principle in a specific scenario: setting the vertical and horizontal spacing
of a series of images.
320
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Apply steps to one other object
1Select the object.
2Select the relevant steps in the History panel, and click Replay.
Apply steps to multiple objects
1Start with a document in which each line consists of a small image (such as a graphical bullet or an icon) followed
by text.
The goal is to set the images off from the text and from the other images above and below them.
2Open the Property inspector (Window > Properties), if it isn’t already open.
3Select the first image.
4In the Property inspector, enter numbers in the V Space and H Space boxes to set the images spacing.
5Click the image again to make the Document window active without moving the insertion point.
6Press the Left Arrow key to move the insertion point to the left of the image.
7Press the Down Arrow key to move the insertion point down one line, leaving it just to the left of the second image
in the series.
8Press Shift+Right Arrow to select the second image.
Note: Do not select the image by clicking it, or you won’t be able to replay all the steps.
9In the History panel, select the steps that correspond to changing the images spacing and selecting the next image.
Click Replay to replay those steps.
The current images spacing changes, and the next image is selected.
10 Continue to click Replay until all the images are spaced correctly.
Copy and paste steps between documents
Each open document has its own history of steps. You can copy steps from one document and paste them into another.
Closing a document clears its history. If you know you will want to use steps from a document later, copy or save the
steps before you close the document.
1In the document containing the steps you want to reuse, select the steps in the History panel.
321
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
2Click Copy Steps in the History panel .
Note: The Copy Steps button in the History panel is different from the Copy command in the Edit menu. You can’t use
Edit > Copy to copy steps, although you do use Edit > Paste to paste them.
Be careful when you copy steps that include a Copy or a Paste command:
Don’t use Copy Steps if one of the steps is a Copy command; you may not be able to paste such steps the way you
want.
If your steps include a Paste command, you can’t paste those steps, unless the steps also include a Copy command
before the Paste command.
3Open the other document.
4Place the insertion point where you want it, or select an object to apply the steps to.
5Select Edit > Paste.
The steps are played back as they’re pasted into the document’s History panel. The History panel shows them as only
one step, called Paste Steps.
If you pasted steps into a text editor or into Code view or the Code inspector, they appear as JavaScript code. This
can be useful for learning to write your own scripts.
Create and use commands from history steps
Save a set of history steps as a named command, which then becomes available in the Commands menu. Create and
save a new command if you might use a set of steps again, especially the next time you start Dreamweaver.
Create a command
1Select a step or set of steps in the History panel.
2Click the Save As Command button, or select Save As Command from the History panels context menu.
3Enter a name for the command and click OK.
The command appears in the Commands menu.
Note: The command is saved as a JavaScript file (or sometimes an HTML file) in your
Dreamweaver/Configuration/Commands folder. If you are using Dreamweaver on a multiuser operating system, the file
is saved in the specific user’s Commands folder.
Use a saved command
1Select an object to apply the command to, or place the insertion point where you want to apply the command.
2Select the command from the Commands menu.
Edit a command name
1Select Commands > Edit Command List.
2Select a command to rename, enter a new name for it, and then click Close.
Delete a name from the Commands menu
1Select Commands > Edit Command List.
2Select a command.
3Click Delete, and then click Close.
322
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Record and save commands
Record a temporary command for short-term use, or record and save a command to use later. Dreamweaver retains
only one recorded command at a time; as soon as you start recording a new command, the old command is lost, unless
you save it before recording the new command.
Temporarily record a series of steps
1Select Commands > Start Recording, or press Control+Shift+X (Windows) or Command+Shift+X (Macintosh).
The pointer changes to indicate that you’re recording a command.
2When you finish recording, select Commands > Stop Recording, or press Control+Shift+X (Windows) or
Command+Shift+X (Macintosh).
Play back a recorded command
Select Commands > Play Recorded Command.
Save a recorded command
1Select Commands > Play Recorded Command.
2Select the Run Command step that appears in the History panels step list, and then click the Save As Command
button.
3Enter a name for the command, and click OK.
The command appears in the Commands menu.
More Help topics
Writing and editing code
About assets and libraries
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About assets
You can use Adobe Dreamweaver to keep track of and preview assets stored in your site, such as images, movies, colors,
scripts, and links. You can also drag an asset directly to insert it in a page of the current document.
You obtain assets from various sources. For example, you might create assets in an application such as Adobe®
Fireworks® or Adobe® Flash®, receive them from a co-worker, or copy them from a clip-art CD or graphics website.
Dreamweaver also provides access to two special types of assets—libraries and templates. Both are linked assets: when
you edit a library item or template, Dreamweaver updates all documents that use those assets. Library items generally
represent small design assets, such as a site logo or copyright. To control a larger design area, use a template instead.
323
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
About library items
A library is a special Dreamweaver file containing a collection of individual assets or copies of assets that you can place
in your web pages. The assets in a library are called library items. Items that you can store in a library include images,
tables, sounds, and files created with Adobe Flash. You can automatically update all the pages that use a library item
whenever you edit the item.
For example, suppose you’re building a large site for a company that wants a slogan to appear on every page. You can
create a library item to contain the slogan and use that library item on every page. If the slogan changes, you can change
the library item and automatically update every page that uses it.
Dreamweaver stores library items in a Library folder within the local root folder for each site. Each site has its own
library.
You can create a library item from any element in the body section of a document, including text, tables, forms, Java
applets, plug-ins, ActiveX elements, navigation bars, and images.
For linked items such as images, the library stores only a reference to the item. The original file must remain at the
specified location for the library item to work correctly.
It can still be useful to store an image in a library item, though. For example, you could store a complete img tag in a
library item, which would allow you to easily change the images alt text, or even its src attribute, throughout the site.
(Don’t use this technique to change an images width and height attributes, though, unless you also use an image editor
to change the actual size of the image.)
Note: If the library item contains links, the links may not work in the new site. Also, images in a library item aren’t copied
to the new site.
When you use a library item, Dreamweaver inserts a link to it, rather than the item itself, in the web page. That is,
Dreamweaver inserts a copy of the HTML source code for that item into the document and adds an HTML comment
containing a reference to the original, external item. It is this external reference that makes automatic updating possible.
When you create a library item that includes an element with a Dreamweaver behavior attached to it, Dreamweaver
copies the element and its event handler (the attribute that specifies which event triggers the action, such as onClick,
onLoad, or onMouseOver, and which action to call when the event occurs) to the library item file. Dreamweaver does
not copy the associated JavaScript functions into the library item. Instead, when you insert the library item into a
document, Dreamweaver automatically inserts the appropriate JavaScript functions into the head section of that
document (if they arent already there).
Note: If you hand-code JavaScript (that is, if you create it without using Dreamweaver behaviors), you can make it part of
a library item if you use the Call JavaScript behavior to execute the code. If you don’t use a Dreamweaver behavior to
execute the code, the code isn’t retained as part of the library item.
There are special requirements for editing the behaviors in library items. Library items cannot contain style sheets,
because the code for those elements is part of the head section.
More Help topics
About Dreamweaver templates
Edit a behavior in a library item
324
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Working with library items
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Create a library item
Library items are elements that you want to reuse or update frequently throughout your website.
Create a library item based on a selection
1In the Document window, select a portion of a document to save as a library item.
2Do one of the following:
Drag the selection into the Library category .
Click the New Library Item button at the bottom of the Library category.
Select Modify > Library > Add Object To Library.
3Type a name for the new library item, then press Enter (Windows) or Return (Macintosh).
Dreamweaver saves each library item as a separate file (with the file extension .lbi) in the Library folder of the sites
local root folder.
Create an empty library item
1Make sure nothing is selected in the Document window.
If something is selected, it will be placed in the new library item.
2In the Assets panel, select the Library category .
3Click the New Library Item button at the bottom of the panel.
4While the item is still selected, enter a name for it, then press Enter (Windows) or Return (Macintosh).
Insert a library item into a document
When you add a library item to a page, the actual content is inserted in the document along with a reference to the
library item.
1Place the insertion point in the Document window.
2In the Assets panel, select the Library category .
3Do one of the following:
Drag a library item from the Assets panel to the Document window.
To insert the contents of a library item without including a reference to the item in the document, press Control
(Windows) or Option (Macintosh) while dragging an item out of the Assets panel. If you insert an item this way, you
can edit the item in the document, but the document won’t be updated when you update pages that use that library item.
Select a library item, and click Insert.
Edit library items and update documents
When you edit a library item, you can update all documents that use that item. If you choose not to update, the
documents remain associated with the library item; you can update them later.
325
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
You can rename items to break their connection with documents or templates, delete items from the sites library, and
recreate a missing library item.
Note: The CSS Styles panel is unavailable as you edit a library item, because library items can contain only body elements
and Cascading Style Sheets (CSS) code is inserted in the head section of a document. The Page Properties dialog box is also
unavailable, because a library item can’t include a body tag or its attributes.
Edit a library item
1In the Assets panel, select the Library category .
2Select a library item.
3Either Click the Edit button or double-click the library item.
Dreamweaver opens a new window, similar to the Document window, for editing the library item. The gray
background indicates that youre editing a library item instead of a document.
4Make and then save your changes.
5Specify whether to update the documents on the local site that use the library item. Select Update to update
immediately. If you select Don’t Update, documents won’t be updated until you choose Modify > Library > Update
Current Page or Update Pages.
Update the current document to use the current version of all library items
Select Modify > Library > Update Current Page.
Update the entire site or all documents that use a particular library item
1Select Modify > Library > Update Pages.
2In the Look In pop-up menu, specify what to update:
To update all pages in the selected site to use the current version of all library items, select Entire Site, then select
the site name from the adjacent pop-up menu.
To update all pages in the current site that use the library item, select Files That Use, then select a library item
name from the adjacent pop-up menu.
3Make sure that Library Items is selected in the Update option.
To update templates at the same time, select Templates as well.
4Click Start.
Dreamweaver updates the files as indicated. If you selected the Show Log option, Dreamweaver generates a report
showing whether files were updated successfully, along with other information.
Rename a library item
1In the Assets panel, select the Library category .
2Select the library item, pause, and then click again. (Do not double-click; double-clicking opens the item for
editing.)
3Enter a new name.
4Click elsewhere, or press Enter (Windows) or Return (Macintosh).
5Specify whether to update documents that use the item by choosing either Update or Dont Update.
326
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Delete a library item from a library
When you delete a library item, Dreamweaver removes it from the library but doesn’t change the contents of any
documents that use the item.
1In the Assets panel, select the Library category .
2Select the library item.
3Either click the Delete button or press the Delete key, then confirm that you want to delete the item.
Note: If you delete a library item, you can’t use Undo to retrieve it. You may be able to recreate it, however.
Recreate a missing or deleted library item
1Select an instance of the item in one of your documents.
2Click the Recreate button in the Property inspector (Window > Properties).
Customize highlighting of library items
You can customize the highlight color of library items and show or hide highlighting by setting Highlighting
preferences.
Change the highlight color of library items
1Select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh).
2Select the Highlighting category from the list on the left of the Preferences dialog box.
3Click the Library Items color box, then select a highlight color using the color picker (or enter the hexadecimal color
value in the text box).
4Select Show to display the highlight color in the Document window.
5Click OK.
To show or hide highlighting in the Document window
To show highlighting, select View > Visual Aids > Invisible Elements. To hide highlighting, deselect Invisible
Elements.
Edit the properties of a library item
You can use the Property inspector to open a library item for editing, detach a selected library item from its source file,
or overwrite an item with the currently selected library item.
1Select a library item in a document.
2Select one of these options in the Property inspector (Window > Properties):
Src Displays the filename and location of the source file for the library item. You cant edit this information.
Open Opens the library items source file for editing. This is equivalent to selecting the item in the Assets panel and
clicking the Edit button.
Detach From Original Breaks the link between the selected library item and its source file. You can edit the detached
item in the document, but its no longer a library item and isn’t updated when you change the original.
Recreate Overwrites the original library item with the current selection. Use this option to re-create library items
if the original library item is missing or has been accidentally deleted.
327
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Make library items editable in a document
If you’ve added a library item to your document and you want to edit the item specifically for that page, you must break
the link between the item in the document and the library. Once you’ve made an instance of a library item editable, that
instance isn’t updated when the library item changes.
1Select a library item in the current document.
2Click Detach From Original in the Property inspector (Window > Properties).
Edit a behavior in a library item
To edit a behavior in a library item, you must first insert the item in a document, then make the item editable in that
document. After you’ve made the changes, you can re-create the library item, replacing the item in the library with the
edited item from your document.
1Open a document that contains the library item.
Note the name of the library item, as well as the exact tags it contains. You’ll need this information later.
2Select the library item, and then click Detach From Original in the Property inspector (Window > Properties).
3Select the element that has the behavior attached to it.
4In the Behaviors panel (Window > Behaviors), double-click the action you want to change.
5In the dialog box that appears, make your changes, then click OK.
6In the Assets panel, select the Library category .
7Record the exact name and capitalization of the original library item; select it, then click the Delete button.
8In the Document window, select all the elements that make up the library item.
Be careful to select exactly the same elements that were in the original library item.
9In the Assets panel, click the New Library Item button , then give the new item the same name as the item you
deleted, using the same spelling and capitalization.
10 To update the library item in your sites other documents, select Modify > Library > Update Pages.
11 In the Look In pop-up menu, select Files That Use.
12 In the adjacent pop-up menu, select the name of the library item you just created.
13 In the Update option, make sure Library Items is selected, then click Start.
14 When the updates are complete, click Close.
More Help topics
About library items
Use the color picker
Using JavaScript behaviors
Working with Photoshop and Dreamweaver
328
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
About Photoshop integration
You can insert Photoshop image files (PSD format) into web pages in Dreamweaver and let Dreamweaver optimize
them as web-ready images (GIF, JPEG, and PNG formats). When you do this, Dreamweaver inserts the image as a
Smart Object and maintains a live connection to the original PSD file.
You can also paste all or part of a multi-layered or multi-sliced Photoshop image into a web page in Dreamweaver.
When you copy and paste from Photoshop, however, no live connection to the original file is maintained. To update
the image, make your changes in Photoshop, and copy and paste again.
Note: If you use this integration feature often, you may want to store your Photoshop files in your Dreamweaver site for
easier access. If you do, be sure to cloak them to avoid exposure of the original assets, as well as unnecessary transfers
between the local site and the remote server.
For a tutorial on Photoshop integration with Dreamweaver, see Integrating Dreamweaver with Photoshop.
About Smart Objects and Photoshop-Dreamweaver workflows
There are two main workflows for working with Photoshop files in Dreamweaver: the copy/paste workflow, and the
Smart Objects workflow.
Copy/paste workflow
The copy/paste workflow lets you select slices or layers in a Photoshop file, and then use Dreamweaver to insert them
as web-ready images. If you want to update the content later on, however, you must open the original Photoshop file,
make your changes, copy your slice or layer to the clipboard again, and then paste the updated slice or layer into
Dreamweaver. This workflow is only recommended when you want to insert part of a Photoshop file (for example, a
section of a design comp) as an image on a web page.
Smart Objects workflow
When working with complete Photoshop files, Adobe recommends the Smart Objects workflow. A Smart Object in
Dreamweaver is an image asset placed on a web page that has a live connection to an original Photoshop (PSD) file. In
Dreamweaver Design view, a Smart Object is denoted by an icon in the upper left corner of the image.
329
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
When the web image (that is, the image on the Dreamweaver page) is out of sync with the original Photoshop file,
Dreamweaver detects that the original file has been updated, and displays one of the Smart Object icons arrows in red.
When you select the web image in Design view and click the Update from Original button in the Property inspector,
the image updates automatically, reflecting any changes that you made to the original Photoshop file.
When you use the Smart Objects workflow, you do not need to open Photoshop to update a web image. Additionally,
any updates you make to a Smart Object in Dreamweaver are non-destructive. That is, you can change the web version
of the image on your page while keeping the original Photoshop image intact.
You can also update a Smart Object without selecting the web image in Design view. The Assets panel lets you update
all Smart Objects, including images that might not be selectable in the Document window (for example, CSS
background images).
Image optimization settings
For both the copy/paste and the Smart Object workflows, you can specify optimization settings in the Image
Optimization dialog box. This dialog box lets you specify the file format and image quality. If you are copying a slice or
a layer, or inserting a Photoshop file as a Smart Object for the first time, Dreamweaver displays this dialog so that you
can easily create the web image.
If you copy and paste an update to a particular slice or layer, Dreameaver remembers the original settings and re-creates
the web image with those settings. Likewise, when you update a Smart Object using the Property inspector,
Dreamweaver uses the same settings you used when you first inserted the image. You can change an images settings at
any time by selecting the web image in Design view, and then clicking the Edit Image Settings button in the Property
inspector.
Storing Photoshop files
If youve inserted a web image, and have not stored the original Photoshop file in your Dreamweaver site, Dreamweaver
recognizes the path to the original file as an absolute local file path. (This is true for both the copy/paste and Smart
Object workflows.) For example, if the path to your Dreamweaver site is C:\Sites\mySite, and your Photoshop file is
stored in C:\Images\Photoshop, Dreameaver will not recognize the original asset as part of the site called mySite. This
will cause problems if you ever want to share the Photoshop file with other team members because Dreamweaver will
only recognize the file as being available on a particular local hard drive.
If you store the Photoshop file inside your site, however, Dreamweaver establishes a site-relative path to the file. Any
user with access to the site will also be able to establish the correct path to the file, assuming that you have also provided
the original file for them to download.
For a video tutorial on roundtrip editing with Photoshop, see Roundtrip editing with Photoshop.
Create a Smart Object
When you insert a Photoshop image (PSD file) into your page, Dreamweaver creates a Smart Object. A Smart Object is
a web-ready image that maintains a live connection to the original Photoshop image. Whenever you update the original
image in Photoshop, Dreamweaver gives you the option of updating the image in Dreamweaver with the click of a
button.
1In Dreamweaver (Design or Code view), place the insertion point on your page where you want the image inserted.
2Select Insert > Image.
You can also drag the PSD file to the page from the Files panel if youre storing your Photoshop files in your website.
If you do so, you’ll skip the next step.
3Locate your Photoshop PSD image file in the Select Image Source dialog box by clicking the Browse button and
navigating to it.
330
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
4In the Image Optimization dialog box that appears, adjust optimization settings as needed and click OK.
5Save the web-ready image file to a location within your websites root folder.
Dreamweaver creates the Smart Object based on the selected optimization settings and places a web-ready version of
the image on your page. The Smart Object maintains a live connection to the original image and lets you know when
the two are out of synch.
Note: If you decide later that you want to change the optimization settings for an image placed in your pages, you can select
the image, click the Edit Image Settings button in the Property inspector, and make changes in the Image Optimization
dialog box. Changes made in the Image Optimization dialog box are applied non-destructively. Dreamweaver never
modifies the original Photoshop file, and always re-creates the web image based on the original data.
For a video tutorial on roundtrip editing with Photoshop, see Roundtrip editing with Photoshop.
Update a Smart Object
If you change the Photoshop file to which your Smart Object is linked, Dreamweaver notifies you that the web-ready
image is out of sync with the original. In Dreamweaver, Smart Objects are denoted by an icon at the upper left corner
of the image. When the web-ready image in Dreamweaver is in sync with the original Photoshop file, both of the arrows
in the icon are green. When the web-ready image is out of sync with the original Photoshop file, one of the icons arrows
turns read.
To update a Smart Object with the current contents of the original Photoshop file, select the Smart Object in the
Document window, and then click the Update from Original button in the Property inspector.
Note: You do not need Photoshop installed to make the update from Dreamweaver.
Update multiple Smart Objects
You can update multiple Smart Objects at once using the Assets panel. The Assets panel also lets you see Smart Objects
that might not be selectable in the Document window (for example, CSS background images).
1In the Files panel, click the Assets tab to view site assets.
2Make sure that Images view is selected. If it isn’t, click the Images button.
3Select each image asset in the Assets panel. When you select a Smart Object, you’ll see the Smart Object icon in the
upper left corner of the image. Regular images do not have this icon.
4For each Smart Object that you want to update, right-click the filename and select Update from Original. You can
also Control-click to select multiple filenames and update them all at once.
Note: You do not need Photoshop installed to make the update from Dreamweaver.
Resize a Smart Object
You can resize a Smart Object in the Document window just as you would any other image.
1Select the Smart Object in the Document window and drag the resize handles to resize the image. You can maintain
the width and height proportions by holding down the Shift key as you drag.
2Click the Update from Original button in the Property inspector.
When you update the Smart Object, the web image non-destructively re-renders at the new size, based on the
current contents of the original file, and the original optimization settings.
331
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Edit a Smart Object’s original Photoshop file
After you create a Smart Object on your Dreamweaver page, you can edit the original PSD file in Photoshop. After you
make your changes in Photoshop, you can then easily update the web image in Dreamweaver.
Note: Make sure that you have Photoshop set as your primary external image editor.
1Select the Smart Object in the Document window.
2Click the Edit button in the Property inspector.
3Make your changes in Photoshop and save the new PSD file.
4In Dreamweaver, select the Smart Object again and click the Update from Original button.
Note: If you changed the size of your image in Photoshop, you need to reset the size of the web image in Dreamweaver.
Dreamweaver updates a Smart Object based only on the contents of the original Photoshop file, and not its size. To sync
the size of a web image with the size of the original Photoshop file, right-click the image and select Reset Size To Original.
Smart Object states
The following table lists the various states for Smart Objects.
Copy and paste a selection from Photoshop
You can copy all or some of a Photoshop image and paste the selection into your Dreamweaver page as a web-ready
image. You can copy a single layer or a set of layers for a selected area of the image or you can copy a slice of the image.
When you do this, however, Dreamweaver does not create a Smart Object.
SmartObject state Description Recommended action
Images synched The web image is in sync with the current
contents of the original Photoshop file. Width
and height attributes in the HTML code match
the dimensions of the web image.
None
Original asset modified The original Photoshop file has been modified
after the creation of the web image in
Dreamweaver.
Use the Update From Original button in the
Property inspector to sync the two images.
Dimensions of web image are different from
selected HTML width and height
The width and height attributes in the HTML
code are different from the width and height
dimensions of the web image that
Dreamweaver created upon insertion. If the
web image’s dimensions are smaller than the
selected HTML width and height values, the
web image can appear pixelated.
Use the Update From Original button in the
Property inspector to re-create the web image
from the original Photoshop file.
Dreamweaver uses the currently specified
HTML width and height dimensions when it
re-creates the image.
Dimensions of original asset are too small for
selected HTML width and height
The width and height attributes in the HTML
code are larger than the width and height
dimensions of the original Photoshop file. The
web image can appear pixelated.
Don’t create web images with dimensions
larger than the dimensions of the original
Photoshop file.
Original asset not found Dreamweaver cannot find the original
Photoshop file specified in the Original text
box of the Property inspector.
Correct the file path in the Original text box of
the Property inspector, or move the
Photoshop file to the location thats currently
specified.
332
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: While the Update from Original functionality is not available for pasted images, you can still open and edit the
original Photoshop file by selecting the pasted image and clicking the Edit button in the Property inspector.
1In Photoshop, do one of the following:
Copy all or part of a single layer by using the Marquee tool to select the portion you want to copy, and then choose
Edit > Copy. This copies only the active layer for the selected area into the clipboard. If you have layer-based
effects, they are not copied.
Copy and merge multiple layers by using the Marquee tool to select the portion you want to copy, and then
choose Edit > Copy Merged. This flattens and copies all the selected areas active and lower layers into the
clipboard. If you have layer-based effects associated with any of these layers, they are copied.
Copy a slice by using the Slice Select tool to select the slice, and then choose Edit > Copy. This flattens and copies
all the slices active and lower layers into the clipboard.
You can choose Select > All to quickly select all of an image for copying.
2In Dreamweaver (Design or Code view), place the insertion point on your page where you want the image inserted.
3Select Edit > Paste.
4In the Image Optimization dialog box, adjust optimization settings as needed and click OK.
5Save the web-ready image file to a location within your websites root folder.
Dreamweaver defines the image according to your optimization settings and places a web-ready version of your image
in your page. Information about the image, such as the location of the original PSD source file, is saved in a Design
Note, regardless of whether you have enabled Design Notes for your site. The Design Note allows you to return to edit
the original Photoshop file from Dreamweaver.
Edit pasted images
After you paste Photoshop images in your Dreamweaver pages, you can edit the original PSD file in Photoshop. When
using the copy/paste workflow, Adobe recommends that you always make your edits to the original PSD file (rather
than the web-ready image itself), and then repaste to maintain single sourcing.
Note: Make sure that you have Photoshop set as your primary external image editor for the file type you want to edit.
1In Dreamweaver, select a web-ready image that was originally created in Photoshop and do one of the following:
Click the Edit button in the images Property inspector.
Press Control (Windows) or Command (Macintosh) as you double-click the file.
Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) an image, choose Edit Original With from the context
menu, and then choose Photoshop.
Note: This assumes that Photoshop is set as the primary external image editor for PSD image files. You may also want
to set Photoshop as the default editor for JPEG, GIF, and PNG file types.
2Edit the file in Photoshop.
3Return to Dreamweaver and paste the updated image or selection into your page.
If you want to reoptimize the image at any time, you can select the image and click the Edit Image Settings button in
the Property inspector.
333
Page content and assets
Last updated 6/3/2015
Setting Image Optimization dialog box options
When you create a Smart Object or paste a selection from Photoshop, Dreamweaver displays the Image Optimization
dialog box. (Dreamweaver also displays this dialog box for any other kind of image if you select the image and click the
Edit Image Settings button in the Property inspector.) This dialog box lets you define and preview settings for web-
ready images using the right mix of color, compression, and quality.
A web-ready image is one that can be displayed by all modern web browsers and looks the same no matter what system
or browser the viewer is using. In general, the settings result in a trade-off between quality and file size.
Note: Whatever settings you select only affect the imported version of the image file. The original Photoshop PSD or
Fireworks PNG file always remains untouched.
Preset Choose a Preset that best suits your requirements. The file size of the image changes based on your chosen
preset. An instant preview of the image with the applied setting is displayed in the background.
For example, for images that have to be displayed with a high degree of clarity, choose PNG24 for Photos (Sharp
Details). Select GIF For Background Images (Patterns) if you are inserting a pattern that will act as the background of
the page.
When you select a preset, the configurable options for the preset are displayed. If you want to further customize
optimization settings, modify the values for these options.
334
Last updated 6/3/2015
Chapter 8: Linking and navigation
About linking and navigation
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About links
After you’ve set up a Dreamweaver site to store your website documents and have created HTML pages, you’ll want to
create connections from your documents to other documents.
Dreamweaver provides several ways to create links to documents, images, multimedia files, or downloadable software.
You can establish links to any text or image anywhere within a document, including text or images in a heading, list,
table, absolutely-positioned element (AP element), or frame.
There are several different ways of creating and managing links. Some web designers prefer to create links to
nonexistent pages or files as they work, while others prefer to create all the files and pages first and then add the links.
Another way to manage links is to create placeholder pages, in which you add and test links before completing all your
site pages.
Absolute, document-relative, and site root-relative paths
Understanding the file path between the document youre linking from and the document or asset you’re linking to is
essential to creating links.
Each web page has a unique address, called a Uniform Resource Locator (URL). However, when you create a local link
(a link from one document to another on the same site), you generally dont specify the entire URL of the document
you’re linking to; instead, you specify a relative path from the current document or from the sites root folder.
There are three types of link paths:
Absolute paths (such as http://www.adobe.com/support/dreamweaver/contents.html).
Document-relative paths (such as dreamweaver/contents.html).
Site root–relative paths (such as /support/dreamweaver/contents.html).
Using Dreamweaver, you can easily select the type of document path to create for your links.
Note: It is best to use the type of linking you prefer and are most comfortable with—either site root- or document-relative.
Browsing to links, as opposed to typing in the paths, ensures that you always enter the right path.
Absolute paths
Absolute paths provide the complete URL of the linked document, including the protocol to use (usually http:// for web
pages), for example, http://www.adobe.com/support/dreamweaver/contents.html. For an image asset, the complete
URL might be something like http://www.adobe.com/support/dreamweaver/images/image1.jpg.
335
Linking and navigation
Last updated 6/3/2015
You must use an absolute path to link to a document or asset on another server. You can also use absolute paths for local
links (to documents in the same site), but that approach is discouraged—if you move the site to another domain, all of
your local absolute-path links will break. Using relative paths for local links also provides greater flexibility if you need
to move files within your site.
Note: When inserting images (not links), you can use an absolute path to an image on a remote server (that is, an image
that is not available on the local hard drive).
Document-relative paths
Document-relative paths are usually best for local links in most websites. They’re particularly useful when the current
document and the linked document or asset are in the same folder and are likely to remain together. You can also use
a document-relative path to link to a document or asset in another folder by specifying the path through the folder
hierarchy from the current document to the linked document.
The basic idea of document-relative paths is to omit the part of the absolute path that is the same for both the current
document and the linked document or asset, providing only the portion of the path that differs.
For example, suppose you have a site with the following structure:
To link from contents.html to hours.html (both in the same folder), use the relative path hours.html.
To link from contents.html to tips.html (in the resources subfolder), use the relative path resources/tips.html. At
each slash (/), you move down one level in the folder hierarchy.
To link from contents.html to index.html (in the parent folder, one level above contents.html), use the relative path
../index.html. Two dots and a slash (../) moves you up one level in the folder hierarchy.
To link from contents.html to catalog.html (in a different subfolder of the parent folder), use the relative path
../products/catalog.html. Here, ../ moves you up to the parent folder, and products/ moves you down to the products
subfolder.
When you move files as a group—for example, when you move an entire folder, so that all the files inside that folder
retain the same relative paths to each other—you dont need to update document-relative links between those files.
However, when you move an individual file that contains document-relative links, or an individual file targeted by
a document-relative link, you do need to update those links. (If you move or rename files using the Files panel,
Dreamweaver updates all relevant links automatically.)
Site root–relative paths
Site root–relative paths describe the path from the sites root folder to a document. You may want to use these paths if
you are working on a large website that uses several servers, or one server that hosts several sites. However, if you are
not familiar with this type of path, you may want to stick to document-relative paths.
A site root–relative path begins with a leading forward slash, which stands for the root folder of the site. For example,
/support/tips.html is a site root–relative path to a file (tips.html) in the support subfolder of the sites root folder.
336
Linking and navigation
Last updated 6/3/2015
A site root–relative path is often the best way to specify links if you frequently move HTML files from one folder to
another in your website. When you move a document that contains site root–relative links, you don’t need to change
the links since the links are relative to the site root, and not to the document itself; for example, if your HTML files use
site root–relative links for dependent files (such as images), then if you move an HTML file, its dependent-file links are
still valid.
However, when you move or rename the documents targeted by site root–relative links, you must update those links,
even if the documents’ paths relative to each other haven’t changed. For example, if you move a folder, you must update
all site root–relative links to files in that folder. (If you move or rename files using the Files panel, Dreamweaver updates
all relevant links automatically.)
More Help topics
Test links in Dreamweaver
Set the relative path of new links
Working with Dreamweaver sites
Linking
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Linking files and documents
Before creating a link, make sure you understand how absolute, document-relative, and site root–relative paths work.
You can create several types of links in a document:
A link to another document or to a file, such as a graphic, movie, PDF, or sound file.
A named anchor link, which jumps to a specific location in a document.
An e-mail link, which creates a new blank e-mail message with the recipient’s address already filled in.
Null and script links, which you use to attach behaviors to an object or to create a link that executes JavaScript code.
You can use the Property inspector and the Point-To-File icon to create links from an image, an object, or text to
another document or file.
Dreamweaver creates the links to other pages in your site using document-relative paths. You can also tell Dreamweaver
to create new links using site root–relative paths.
Note: Always save a new file before creating a document-relative path; a document-relative path is not valid without a
definite starting point. If you create a document-relative path before saving the file, Dreamweaver temporarily uses an
absolute path beginning with file:// until the file is saved; when you save the file, Dreamweaver converts the file:// path to
a relative path.
For a tutorial on creating links, see www.adobe.com/go/vid0149.
337
Linking and navigation
Last updated 6/3/2015
Attaching JavaScript behaviors to links
You can attach a behavior to any link in a document. Consider using the following behaviors when you insert linked
elements into documents:
Set Text Of Status Bar Determines the text of a message and displays it in the status bar at the lower left of the browser
window. For example, you can use this behavior to describe the destination of a link in the status bar instead of showing
the URL associated with it.
Open Browser Window Opens a URL in a new window. You can specify the properties of the new window, including
its name, size, and attributes (whether it is resizable, has a menu bar, and so on).
Jump Menu Edits a jump menu. You can change the menu list, specify a different linked file, or change the browser
location in which the linked document opens.
Link to documents using the Property inspector
You can use the Property inspectors folder icon or Link box to create links from an image, an object, or text to another
document or file.
1Select text or an image in the Document window’s Design view.
2Open the Property inspector (Window > Properties) and do one of the following:
Click the folder icon to the right of the Link box to browse to and select a file.
The path to the linked document appears in the URL box. Use the Relative To pop-up menu in the Select HTML
File dialog box to make the path document-relative or root-relative, and then click Select. The type of path you
select applies only to the current link. (You can change the default setting of the Relative To box for the site.)
Type the path and filename of the document in the Link box.
To link to a document in your site, enter a document-relative or site root–relative path. To link to a document
outside your site, enter an absolute path including the protocol (such as http://). You can use this approach to
enter a link for a file that hasn’t been created yet.
3From the Target pop-up menu, select a location in which to open the document:
_blank loads the linked document in a new, unnamed browser window.
_parent loads the linked document in the parent frame or parent window of the frame that contains the link. If
the frame containing the link is not nested, then the linked document loads in the full browser window.
_self loads the linked document in the same frame or window as the link. This target is the default, so you usually
don’t have to specify it.
_top loads the linked document in the full browser window, thereby removing all frames.
If all the links on your page will be set to the same target, you can specify this target once by selecting Insert > HTML
> Head Tags > Base and selecting the target information. For information about targeting frames, see Control frame
content with links.
Link to documents using the Point-To-File icon
1Select text or an image in the Document window’s Design view.
2Create a link in one of two ways:
Drag the Point-To-File icon (target icon) at the right of the Link box in the Property inspector and point to a
visible anchor in the current document, a visible anchor in another open document, an element that has a unique
ID assigned to it, or a document in the Files panel.
338
Linking and navigation
Last updated 6/3/2015
Shift-drag from the selection and point to a visible anchor in the current document, a visible anchor in another
open document, an element that has a unique ID assigned to it, or a document in the Files panel.
Note: You can link to another open document only if your documents are not maximized in the Document window. To
tile documents, select Window > Cascade or Window > Tile. When you point to an open document, that document
moves to the foreground of your screen while you are making your selection.
Add a link using the Hyperlink command
The Hyperlink command lets you create a text link to an image, an object, or to another document or file.
1Place the insertion point in the document where you want the link to appear.
2Do one of the following to display the Insert Hyperlink dialog box:
Select Insert > Hyperlink.
In the Common category of the Insert panel, click the Hyperlink button.
3Enter the text of the link and, after Link, the name of the file to link to (or click the folder icon to browse to the
file).
4In the Target pop-up menu, select the window in which the file should open or type its name.
The names of all the frames you’ve named in the current document appear in the pop-up list. If you specify a frame
that doesnt exist, the linked page opens in a new window that has the name you specified. You can also select from
the following reserved target names:
_blank loads the linked file into a new, unnamed browser window.
_parent loads the linked file into the parent frameset or window of the frame that contains the link. If the frame
containing the link is not nested, the linked file loads into the full browser window.
_self loads the linked file into the same frame or window as the link. This target is the default, so you usually don’t
need to specify it.
_top loads the linked file into the full browser window, thereby removing all frames.
5In the Tab Index box, enter a number for the tab order.
6In the Title box, enter a title for the link.
7In the Access Key box, enter a keyboard equivalent (one letter) to select the link in the browser.
8Click OK.
Set the relative path of new links
By default, Dreamweaver creates links to other pages in your site using document-relative paths. To use site root–
relative path instead, you must first define a local folder in Dreamweaver by choosing a local root folder to serve as the
equivalent of the document root on a server. Dreamweaver uses this folder to determine the site root–relative paths to
files.
1Select Site > Manage Sites.
2In the Manage Sites dialog box, double-click your site in the list.
3In the Site Setup dialog box, expand Advanced Settings and select the Local Info category.
4Set the relative path of new links by selecting the Document or Site Root option.
Changing this setting will not convert the path of existing links after you click OK. The setting applies only to new
links you create with Dreamweaver.
339
Linking and navigation
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: Content linked with a site root–relative path does not appear when you preview documents in a local browser
unless you specify a testing server, or select the Preview Using Temporary File option in Edit > Preferences > Preview In
Browser. This is because browsers dont recognize site rootsservers do. A quick way to preview content linked with site
root–relative paths is to put the file on a remote server, then select File > Preview In Browser.
5Click Save.
The new path setting applies only to the current site.
Link to a specific place in a document
You can use the Property inspector to link to a particular section of a document by first creating named anchors. Named
anchors let you set markers in a document, which are often placed at a specific topic or at the top of a document. You
can then create links to these named anchors, which quickly take your visitor to the specified position.
Creating a link to a named anchor is a two-step process. First, you create a named anchor; then you create a link to the
named anchor.
Note: You can’t place a named anchor in an absolutely-positioned element (AP element).
Create a named anchor
1In the Document window’s Design view, place the insertion point where you want the named anchor.
2Do one of the following:
Select Insert > Named Anchor.
Press Control+Alt+A (Windows) or Command+Option+A (Macintosh).
In the Common category of the Insert panel, click the Named Anchor button.
3In the Anchor Name box, type a name for the anchor, and click OK. (The anchor name can’t contain spaces).
The anchor marker appears at the insertion point.
Note: If you do not see the anchor marker, select View > Visual Aids > Invisible Elements.
Link to a named anchor
1In the Document window’s Design view, select text or an image to create a link from.
2In the Link box of the Property inspector, type a number sign (#) and the name of the anchor. For example, to link
to an anchor named “top” in the current document, type #top. To link to an anchor namedtop in a different
document in the same folder, type filename.html#top.
Note: Anchor names are case-sensitive.
Link to a named anchor using the Point-To-File method
1Open the document containing the named anchor.
Note: If you don’t see the anchor, select View > Visual Aids > Invisible Elements to make it visible.
2In the Document window’s Design view, select text or an image you want to link from. (If this is another open
document, you must switch to it.)
3Do one of the following:
Click the Point-To-File icon (target icon) to the right of the Link box in the Property inspector and drag it to
the anchor you want to link to: either an anchor within the same document or an anchor in another open
document.
340
Linking and navigation
Last updated 6/3/2015
Shift-drag in the Document window from the selected text or image to the anchor you want to link to: either an
anchor within the same document or an anchor in another open document.
Create an e-mail link
An e-mail link opens a new blank message window (using the mail program associated with the user’s browser) when
clicked. In the e-mail message window, the To box is automatically updated with the address specified in the e-mail link.
Create an e-mail link using the Insert Email Link command
1In the Document window’s Design view, position the insertion point where you want the e-mail link to appear, or
select the text or image you want to appear as the e-mail link.
2Do one of the following to insert the link:
Select Insert > Email Link.
In the Common category of the Insert panel, click the Email Link button.
3In the Text box, type or edit the body of the e-mail.
4In the Email box, type the e-mail address, then click OK.
Create an e-mail link using the Property inspector
1Select text or an image in the Document window’s Design view.
2In the Link box of the Property inspector, type mailto: followed by an e-mail address.
Do not type any spaces between the colon and the e-mail address.
Auto-populate the subject line of an e-mail
1Create an e-mail link using the Property inspector as outlined above.
2In the Link box of the Property inspector, add ?subject= after the email, and type a subject after the equals sign. Do
not type any spaces between the question mark and the end of the e-mail address.
The complete entry would look as follows:
mailto:someone@yoursite.com?subject=Mail from Our Site
Create null and script links
A null link is an undesignated link. Use null links to attach behaviors to objects or text on a page. For instance, you can
attach a behavior to a null link so that it swaps an image or displays an absolutely-positioned element (AP element)
when the pointer moves over the link.
Script links execute JavaScript code or call a JavaScript function and are useful for giving visitors additional information
about an item without leaving the current web page. Script links can also be used to perform calculations, validate
forms, or do other processing tasks when a visitor clicks a specific item.
Create a null link
1Select text, an image, or an object in the Document window’s Design view.
2In the Property inspector, type javascript:; (the word javascript, followed by a colon, followed by a semicolon) in the
Link box.
341
Linking and navigation
Last updated 6/3/2015
Create a script link
1Select text, an image, or an object in the Document window’s Design view.
2In the Link box of the Property inspector, type javascript: followed by some JavaScript code or a function call. (Do
not type a space between the colon and the code or call.)
Update links automatically
Dreamweaver can update links to and from a document whenever you move or rename the document within a local
site. This feature works best when you store your entire site (or an entire self-contained section of it) on your local disk.
Dreamweaver does not change files in the remote folder until you put the local files on or check them in to the remote
server.
To make the updating process faster, Dreamweaver can create a cache file in which to store information about all the
links in your local folder. The cache file is updated invisibly as you add, change, or delete links on your local site.
Enable automatic link updates
1Select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh).
2In the Preferences dialog box, select General from the category list on the left.
3In the Document Options section of the General preferences, select an option from the Update Links When Moving
Files pop-up menu.
Always Automatically updates all links to and from a selected document whenever you move or rename it.
Never Does not automatically update all links to and from a selected document when you move or rename it.
Prompt Displays a dialog box that lists all the files affected by the change. Click Update to update the links in these
files, or click Dont Update to leave the files unchanged.
4Click OK.
Create a cache file for your site
1Select Site > Manage Sites.
2Select a site, and then click Edit.
3In the Site Setup dialog box, expand Advanced Settings and select the Local Info category.
4In the Local Info category, select Enable Cache.
The first time you change or delete links to files in your local folder after starting Dreamweaver, Dreamweaver
prompts you to load the cache. If you click Yes, Dreamweaver loads the cache and updates all the links to the file you
just changed. If you click No, the change is noted in the cache, but Dreamweaver does not load the cache or update
links.
It may take a few minutes to load the cache on larger sites because Dreamweaver must determine whether the cache
is up to date by comparing the timestamps of the files on the local site against the timestamps recorded in the cache.
If you have not changed any files outside Dreamweaver, you can safely click the Stop button when it appears.
Re-create the cache
In the Files panel, select Site > Advanced > Recreate Site Cache.
342
Linking and navigation
Last updated 6/3/2015
Change a link sitewide
In addition to having Dreamweaver update links automatically whenever you move or rename a file, you can manually
change all links (including e-mail, FTP, null, and script links) so that they point somewhere else.
This option is most useful when you want to delete a file that other files link to, but you can use it for other purposes.
For example, suppose you link the words “this months movies” to /movies/july.html throughout your site. On August
1 you would change those links so that they point to /movies/august.html.
1Select a file in the Local view of the Files panel.
Note: If you are changing an e-mail, FTP, null, or script link, you do not need to select a file.
2Select Site > Change Link Sitewide.
3Complete these options in Change Link Sitewide dialog box:
Change All Links To Click the folder icon to browse to and select the target file from which to unlink. If you are
changing an e-mail, FTP, null, or script link, type the full text of the link you are changing.
Into Links to Click the folder icon to browse to and select the new file to link to. If you are changing an e-mail,
FTP, null, or script link, type the full text of the replacement link.
4Click OK.
Dreamweaver updates any documents that link to the selected file, making them point to the new file, using the path
format already used in the document (for example, if the old path was document-relative, the new path is also
document-relative).
After you change a link sitewide, the selected file becomes an orphan (that is, no files on your local disk point to it).
You can safely delete it without breaking any links in your local Dreamweaver site.
Note: Because these changes occur locally, you must manually delete the corresponding orphan file in the remote folder
and put or check in any files in which links were changed; otherwise, visitors to your site won’t see the changes.
Test links in Dreamweaver
Links are not active within Dreamweaver; that is, you cannot open a linked document by clicking the link in the
Document window.
Do one of the following:
Select the link and select Modify > Open Linked Page.
Press Control (Windows) or Command (Macintosh) and double-click the link.
Note: The linked document must reside on your local disk.
More Help topics
Video tutorial: How to add hyperlinks to the whole or part of an image
Absolute, document-relative, and site root-relative paths
Creating links tutorial
Applying built-in JavaScript behaviors
Working with Dreamweaver sites
Fix broken links
343
Linking and navigation
Last updated 6/3/2015
Apply a behavior
Find broken, external, and orphaned links
Jump menus
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About jump menus
A jump menu is a pop-up menu in a document, visible to your site visitors, listing links to documents or files. You can
create links to documents in your website, links to documents on other websites, e-mail links, links to graphics, or links
to any file type that can be opened in a browser.
Each option in a jump menu is associated with a URL. When users choose an option, they are redirected (“jump”) to
the associated URL. Jump menus are inserted within the Jump Menu form object.
A jump menu can contain three components:
(Optional) A menu selection prompt, such as a category description for the menu items, or instructions, such as
“Choose one”.
(Required) A list of linked menu items: a user selects an option and a linked document or file opens.
(Optional) A Go button.
Insert a jump menu
1Open a document, and then place the insertion point in the Document window.
2Do one of the following:
Select Insert > Form > Jump Menu.
In the Forms category of the Insert panel, click the Jump Menu button.
3Complete the Insert Jump menu dialog box and click OK. Here is a partial list of options:
Plus and Minus buttons Click Plus to insert an item; click Plus again to add another one. To delete an item, select it
and click Minus.
Arrow buttons Select an item and click the arrows to move it up or down in the list.
Text Type the name of an unnamed item. If your menu includes a selection prompt (such as “Choose one”), type it
here as the first menu item (if so, you must also choose the Select First Item After URL Change option at the bottom).
When Selected Go To URL Browse to the target file or type its path.
Open URLs In Specify whether to open the file in the same window or in a frame. If the frame you want to target
doesn’t appear in the menu, close the Insert Jump Menu dialog box and name the frame.
Insert Go Button After Menu Select to insert a Go button rather than a menu selection prompt.
Select First Item After URL Change Select if you inserted a menu selection prompt (“Choose one”) as the first menu
item.
344
Linking and navigation
Last updated 6/3/2015
Edit jump menu items
You can change the order of items in the menu or the file an item links to, and you can add, delete, or rename an item.
To change the location in which a linked file opens, or to add or change a menu selection prompt, you must apply the
Jump Menu behavior from the Behaviors panel.
1Open the Property inspector (Window > Properties) if it isn’t already open.
2In the Document window’s Design view, click the jump menu object to select it.
3In the Property inspector, click the List Values button.
4Use the List Values dialog box to make your changes to the menu items, and then click OK.
Troubleshooting jump menus
After a user selects a jump menu item, there is no way to reselect that menu item if the user navigates back to that page,
or if the Open URL In box specifies a frame. There are two ways to work around this problem:
Use a menu selection prompt, such as a category, or a user instruction, such as “Choose one. The menu selection
prompt is reselected automatically after each menu selection.
Use a Go button, which allows a user to revisit the currently chosen link. When you use a Go button with a jump
menu, the Go button becomes the only mechanism that “jumps” the user to the URL associated with the selection
in the menu. Selecting a menu item in the jump menu no longer re-directs the user automatically to another page
or frame.
Note: Select only one of these options per jump menu, in the Insert Jump Menu dialog box, because they apply to an entire
jump menu.
More Help topics
Apply the Jump Menu behavior
Apply the Jump Menu Go behavior
View and set frame properties and attributes
Navigation bars
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About navigation bars
The navigation bar feature has been deprecated as of Dreamweaver CS5.
Adobe recommends using the Spry Menu Bar widget if you want to create a navigation bar.
More Help topics
Working with the Spry Menu Bar widget
345
Linking and navigation
Last updated 6/3/2015
Image maps
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About image maps
An image map is an image that has been divided into regions called hotspots; when a user clicks a hotspot, an action
occurs (for example, a new file opens).
Client-side image maps store the hypertext link information in the HTML document—not in a separate map file as
server-side image maps do. When a site visitor clicks a hotspot in the image, the associated URL is sent directly to the
server. This makes client-side image maps faster than server-side image maps, because the server does not need to
interpret where the visitor clicked. Client-side image maps are supported by Netscape Navigator 2.0 and later versions,
NCSA Mosaic 2.1 and 3.0, and all versions of Internet Explorer.
Dreamweaver does not alter references to server-side image maps in existing documents; you can use both client-side
image maps and server-side image maps in the same document. However, browsers that support both types of image
maps give priority to client-side image maps. To include a server-side image map in a document, you must write the
appropriate HTML code.
Insert client-side image maps
When you insert a client-side image map, you create a hotspot area and then define a link that opens when a user clicks
the hotspot area.
Note: You can create multiple hotspot areas, but they are part of the same image map.
1In the Document window, select the image.
2In the Property inspector, click the expander arrow in the lower-right corner to see all properties.
3In the Map Name box, enter a unique name for the image map. If you are using multiple image maps in the same
document, make sure each map has a unique name.
4To define the image map areas, do one of the following:
Select the circle tool and drag the pointer over the image to create a circular hotspot.
Select the rectangle tool and drag the pointer over the image to create a rectangular hotspot.
Select the polygon tool and define an irregularly shaped hotspot by clicking once for each corner point. Click
the arrow tool to close the shape.
After you create the hotspot, the hotspot Property inspector appears.
5In the hotspot Property inspector’s Link box, click the folder icon to browse to and select the file you want to
open when the user clicks the hotspot, or type the path.
6In the Target pop-up menu, select the window in which the file should open or type its name.
The names of all the frames you’ve named in the current document appear in the pop-up list. If you specify a frame
that doesn’t exist, the linked page loads into a new window that has the name you specified. You can also select from
the following reserved target names:
_blank loads the linked file into a new, unnamed browser window.
_parent loads the linked file into the parent frameset or window of the frame that contains the link. If the frame
containing the link is not nested, the linked file loads into the full browser window.
346
Linking and navigation
Last updated 6/3/2015
_self loads the linked file into the same frame or window as the link. This target is the default, so you usually don’t
need to specify it.
_top loads the linked file into the full browser window, thereby removing all frames.
Note: The target option isn’t available until the selected hotspot contains a link.
7In the Alt box, type alternative text for display in text-only browsers or browsers that download images manually.
Some browsers display this text as a tooltip when the user moves the pointer over the hotspot.
8Repeat steps 4 through 7 to define additional hotspots in the image map.
9When you finish mapping the image, click a blank area in the document to change the Property inspector.
Modify image map hotspots
You can easily edit the hotspots you create in an image map. You can move a hotspot area, resize hotspots, or move a
hotspot forward or back in an absolutely-positioned element (AP element).
You can also copy an image with hotspots from one document to another, or copy one or more hotspots from an image
and paste them on another image; hotspots associated with the image are also copied to the new document.
Select multiple hotspots in an image map
1Use the pointer hotspot tool to select a hotspot.
2Do one of the following:
Shift-click the other hotspots you want to select.
Press Control+A (Windows) or Command+A (Macintosh) to select all of the hotspots.
Move a hotspot
1Use the pointer hotspot tool to select the hotspot.
2Do one of the following:
Drag the hotspot to a new area.
Use the Control + arrow keys to move a hotspot by 10 pixels in the selected direction.
Use the arrow keys to move a hotspot by 1 pixel in the selected direction.
Resize a hotspot
1Use the pointer hotspot tool to select the hotspot.
2Drag a hotspot selector handle to change the size or shape of the hotspot.
Troubleshooting links
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Find broken, external, and orphaned links
Use the Check Links feature to search for broken links and orphaned files (files that still exist in the site but that aren’t
linked to by any other files in the site). You can search an open file, a portion of a local site, or an entire local site.
347
Linking and navigation
Last updated 6/3/2015
Dreamweaver verifies links only to documents within the site; Dreamweaver compiles a list of external links in the
selected document or documents but does not verify them.
You can also identify and delete files that are no longer used by other files in your site.
Check links in the current document
1Save the file to a location within your local Dreamweaver site.
2Select File > Check Page > Links.
The Broken Links report appears in the Link Checker panel (in the Results panel group).
3In the Link Checker panel, select External Links from the Show pop-up menu to view another report.
The External Links report appears in the Link Checker panel (in the Results panel group).
You can check for orphaned files when you check links across an entire site.
4To save the report, click the Save Report button in the Link Checker panel. The report is a temporary file; it will be
lost if you dont save it.
Check links in part of a local site
1In the Files panel, select a site from the Current Sites pop-up menu.
2In Local view, select the files or folders to check.
3Initiate the check by doing one of the following:
Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) one of the selected files, and then select Check Links >
Selected Files/Folders from the context menu.
Select File > Check Page > Links.
The Broken Links report appears in the Link Checker panel (in the Results panel group).
4In the Link Checker panel, select External Links from the Show pop-up menu to view another report.
The External Links report appears in the Link Checker panel (in the Results panel group).
You can check for orphaned files when you check links across an entire site.
5To save a report, click the Save Report button in the Link Checker panel.
Check links across the entire site
1In the Files panel, select a site from the Current Sites pop-up menu.
2Select Site > Check Links Sitewide.
The Broken Links report appears in the Link Checker panel (in the Results panel group).
3In the Link Checker panel, select External Links or Orphaned Files from the Show pop-up menu to view another
report.
A list of files that fit the report type you selected appears in the Link Checker panel.
Note: If you select Orphaned Files as your report type, you can delete orphaned files from the Link Checker panel directly
by selecting a file from the list and pressing the Delete key.
4To save a report, click the Save Report button in the Link Checker panel.
348
Linking and navigation
Last updated 6/3/2015
Fix broken links
After you run a links reports, you can fix broken links and image references directly in the Link Checker panel, or you
can open files from the list and fix links in the Property inspector.
Fix links in the Link Checker panel
1Run a link check report.
2In the Broken Links column (not the Files column) of the Link Checker panel (in the Results panel group), select
the broken link.
A folder icon appears next to the broken link.
3Click the folder icon next to the broken link and browse to the correct file, or type the correct path and filename.
4Press Tab or Enter (Windows) or Return (Macintosh).
If there are other broken references to this same file, you are prompted to fix the references in the other files as well.
Click Yes to have Dreamweaver update all the documents on the list that reference this file. Click No to have
Dreamweaver update the current reference only.
Note: If Enable File Check In And Check Out is enabled for the site, Dreamweaver attempts to check out files that require
changes. If it cannot check out a file, Dreamweaver displays a warning dialog box and leaves broken references
unchanged.
Fix links in the Property inspector
1Run a link check report.
2In the Link Checker panel (in the Results panel group), double-click an entry in the File column.
Dreamweaver opens the document, selects the broken image or link, and highlights the path and filename in the
Property inspector. (If the Property inspector is not visible, select Window > Properties to open it.)
3To set a new path and filename in the Property inspector, click the folder icon to browse to the correct file, or
type over the highlighted text.
If you are updating an image reference and the new image appears at the incorrect size, click the W and H labels in
the Property inspector or click the Refresh button to reset the height and width values.
4Save the file.
As links are fixed, their entries disappear from the Link Checker list. If an entry still appears in the list after you enter
a new path or filename in the Link Checker (or after you save changes in the Property inspector), Dreamweaver
cannot find the new file and still considers the link broken.
More Help topics
Identify and delete unused files
349
Last updated 6/3/2015
Chapter 9: Previewing
Preview and inspect web pages on multiple devices
Dreamweaver now lets you test your production-ready web pages simultaneously on multiple devices. You can see how
your web page reflows in various form factors and also test interactive features on your pages. All these without having
to install any mobile app or having to physically connect the devices to your desktop! Simply scan the auto generated
QR code with your devices and preview your web pages on the devices.
Live inspect, when triggered on desktop, reflects on all connected devices and helps you inspect various elements and
tweak the design as required.
Prerequisites
Supported devices
All Android and iOS devices
Ensure that you have a QR code scanner installed on your devices.
Ensure that your desktop and mobile devices are connected to the
Internet and are on the same network.
Ensure that you have your Adobe ID credentials handy. You need the
Adobe ID that you use for Dreamweaver on your desktop to log in to
the devices during the preview.
If you are an enterprise customer, check if you have the required
permissions to access the Device Preview service.
On the devices, ensure that JavaScript and cookies are enabled in the
browser settings.
350
Previewing
Last updated 6/3/2015
Preview web pages on devices
1On your desktop computer, launch Dreamweaver, and open the web page that you want to preview on devices.
2Click the Device Preview icon in the document toolbar.
The Device Preview pop-up appears with a QR code and a short URL.
3Scan the QR code with the mobile device on which you want to preview the web document. To connect multiple
devices, scan the QR code with each of those devices.
Alternatively, you can copy (using the copy button) the short link that is displayed and paste it in a browser on your
desktop.
4On the devices, a login screen appears. Log in using your Adobe ID credentials. Ensure that you use the same Adobe
ID that you use for Dreamweaver/Creative Cloud.
351
Previewing
Last updated 6/3/2015
5After a successful login, the names of the connected devices appear in the Device Preview pop-up. And, you will see
a preview of your web page on the connected devices.
Note: To map the device names in the pop-up with the actual device, hover your mouse on the device names. A feedback
screen appears on the corresponding device.
Inspect web pages on devices
To inspect the web page on all the connected devices, click the Inspect icon in Dreamweaver.
352
Previewing
Last updated 6/3/2015
To inspect the web page on a specific device, click the inspect icon that corresponds to the device name in the
Device Preview pop-up. The viewport in Dreamweaver is set to match the viewport on the corresponding device
and inspect is triggered on that specific device and Dreamweaver.
Click the Inspect icon in Dreamweaver again to exit the Inspect mode.
All the edits that you do to your web page on the desktop are reflected immediately on the devices after they are
committed.
Troubleshoot issues with Device Preview
If you run into issues while connecting your devices or previewing your web pages on devices, see the information in
the article Device Preview - Troubleshooting .
Previewing pages
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Design view gives you an idea of how your page will look on the web but does not render pages exactly as browsers do.
Live view presents a more accurate depiction, and lets you work in Code view so that you can see changes to the design.
The Preview in Browser feature lets you see how your pages will look in specific browsers.
Previewing pages in Dreamweaver
About Live view
Live view differs from the traditional Dreamweaver design view in that it provides a more realistic rendering of what
your page will look like in a browser, which is also editable. Live view does not replace the Preview in Browser
command, but rather provides another way of seeing what your page looks like “live” without having to leave the
Dreamweaver workspace.
353
Previewing
Last updated 6/3/2015
You can switch to Live view any time you are in Design view. Switching to Live view, however, is not related to switching
between any of the other traditional views in Dreamweaver (Code/Split/Design). When you switch to Live view from
Design view, you are simply toggling the Design view between editable and “live.
While Design view remains frozen once you enter Live view, Code view remains editable, so you can change your code,
and then refresh Live view to see your changes take effect. When you’re in Live view, you have the additional option of
viewing live code. Live Code view is like Live view in that it displays a version of the code that the browser is executing
in order to render the page. Like Live view, Live Code view is a non-editable view.
An additional advantage of Live view is the ability to freeze JavaScript. For example, you can switch to Live view and
hover over Spry-based table rows that change color as the result of user interaction. When you freeze JavaScript, Live
view freezes the page in its current state. You can then edit your CSS or JavaScript and refresh the page to see the
changes take effect. Freezing JavaScript in Live view is useful if you want to see and change properties for the different
states of pop-up menus or other interactive elements that you can’t see in traditional Design view.
More Help topics
Edit in Live View
Preview pages in Live view
1Make sure that you are in Design view (View > Design) or Code and Design views (View > Code and Design).
2Click the Live view button.
3(Optional) Make your changes in Code view, in the CSS Styles panel, in an external CSS style sheet, or in another
related file.
Even though you can’t edit in Live view, your options for making edits in other areas (for example, in the CSS Styles
panel or in Code view) change as you click in Live view.
You can work with related files (such as CSS style sheets) while keeping Live view in focus by opening the related file
from the Related Files toolbar at the top of the document.
4If you’ve made changes in Code view or in a related file, refresh Live view by clicking the Refresh button in the
Document tool bar, or by pressing F5.
5To return to the editable Design view, click the Live view button again.
Preview Live Code
The code displayed in Live Code view is similar to what you would see if you viewed the page source from a browser.
While such page sources are static, providing you with only the source of the page from the browser, Live Code view is
dynamic, and updates as you interact with the page in Live view.
1Make sure that you are in Live view.
2Click the Live Code button.
Dreamweaver displays the live code that the browser would use to execute the page. The code is highlighted in
yellow and is uneditable.
When you interact with interactive elements on the page, Live Code highlights the dynamic changes in the code.
3To turn off highlighting for changes in Live Code view, choose View > Live View Options > Highlight Changes in
Live Code.
354
Previewing
Last updated 6/3/2015
4To return to the editable Code view, click the Live Code button again.
To change Live Code preferences, choose Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh
OS), and select the Code Coloring category.
Freeze JavaScript
Do one of the following:
Press F6
Select Freeze JavaScript from the Live View buttons pop-up menu.
An info bar at the top of the document tells you that JavaScript is frozen. To close the info bar, click the close link.
Live view options
Besides the Freeze JavaScript option, there are some other options available from the Live View buttons pop-up menu,
or from the View > Live View Options menu item.
Freeze JavaScript Freezes elements affected by JavaScript in their current state.
Disable JavaScript Disables JavaScript and re-renders the page as it would look if a browser did not have JavaScript
enabled.
Disable Plug-ins Disables plug-ins and re-renders the page as it would look if a browser did not have plug-ins enabled.
Highlight Changes in Live Code Turns highlighting for changes in Live Code off or on.
Edit the Live View Page in a New Tab Lets you open new tabs for site documents you browse to using the Browser
Navigation toolbar or the Follow Link(s) feature. You must browse to the document first, then select Edit the Live View
Page in a New Tab to create a new tab for it.
Follow Link Makes the next link you click in Live View active. Alternatively you can Control-click a link in Live view
to make it active.
Follow Links Continuously Makes links in Live View continuously active until you disable them again, or close the page.
Automatically Sync Remote Files Automatically syncs the local and remote file when you click the Refresh icon in the
Browser Navigation toolbar. Dreamweaver puts your file to the server before refreshing so that both files are in sync.
Use Testing Server for Document Source Used mainly by dynamic pages (such as ColdFusion pages), and selected by
default for dynamic pages. When this option is selected, Dreamweaver uses the version of the file on the sites testing
server as the source for the Live view display.
Use Local Files for Document Links The default setting for non-dynamic sites. When this option is selected for dynamic
sites that use a testing server, Dreamweaver uses the local versions of files that are linked to the document (for example,
CSS and JavaScript files), instead of the files on the testing server. You can then make local changes to related files so
that you can see how they look before putting them to the testing server. If this option is deselected, Dreamweaver uses
the testing server versions of related files.
HTTP Request Settings Takes you to an advanced settings dialog box where you can enter values for displaying live
data. For more information, click the Help button in the dialog box.
Previewing pages in browsers
355
Previewing
Last updated 6/3/2015
Preview in a browser
You can preview a page in a browser at any time; you don’t have to upload it to a web server first. When you preview a
page, all browser-related functions should work, including JavaScript behaviors, document-relative and absolute links,
ActiveX® controls, and Netscape Navigator plug-ins, provided that you installed the required plug-ins or ActiveX
controls in your browsers.
Before previewing a document, save the document; otherwise, the browser does not display your most recent changes.
1Do one of the following to preview the page:
Select File > Preview In Browser, and then select one of the listed browsers.
Note: If no browsers are listed, select Edit > Preferences or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh), and then select
the Preview In Browser category on the left to select a browser.
Press F12 (Windows) or Option+F12 (Macintosh) to display the current document in the primary browser.
Press Control+F12 (Windows) or Command+F12 (Macintosh) to display the current document in the secondary
browser.
2Click links and test content in your page.
Note: Content linked with a site root-relative path does not appear when you preview documents in a local browser
unless you specify a testing server, or select the Preview Using Temporary File option in Edit&nbsp;> Preferences >
Preview In Browser. This is because browsers don’t recognize site roots—servers do.
To preview content linked with root-relative paths, put the file on a remote server, and then select File > Preview In
Browser to view it.
3Close the page in the browser when you finish testing.
Set browser preview preferences
You can set preferences for the browser to use when previewing a site and define default primary and secondary
browsers.
1Select File > Preview In Browser > Edit Browser List.
2To add a browser to the list, click the Plus (+) button, complete the Add Browser dialog box, and then click OK.
3To delete a browser from the list, select the browser, and then click the Minus (-) button.
4To change settings for a selected browser, click the Edit button, make changes in the Edit Browser dialog box, and
then click OK.
5Select the Primary Browser or the Secondary Browser option to specify whether the selected browser is the primary
or secondary browser.
F12 (Windows) or Option+F12 (Macintosh) opens the primary browser; Control+F12 (Windows) or
Command+F12 (Macintosh) opens the secondary browser.
6Select Preview Using Temporary File to create a temporary copy for previewing and server debugging. (Deselect this
option if you want to update the document directly.)
More Help topics
Browser Navigation toolbar overview
Switch between views in the Document window
Open Related Files
356
Previewing
Last updated 6/3/2015
Live View video tutorial
Site root–relative paths
Working with Device Central and Dreamweaver
357
Last updated 6/3/2015
Chapter 10: Coding
General information about coding in Dreamweaver
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Supported languages
In addition to text-editing capabilities, Adobe Dreamweaver provides various features, such as code hints, to help you
code in the following languages:
HTML
XHTML
CSS
JavaScript
ColdFusion Markup Language (CFML)
VBScript (for ASP)
C# and Visual Basic (for ASP.NET)
JSP
PHP
Other languages, such as Perl, are not supported by the language-specific coding features in Dreamweaver; for example,
you can create and edit Perl files, but code hints don’t apply to that language.
Invalid markup
If your document contains invalid code, Dreamweaver displays that code in Design view and optionally highlights it in
Code view. If you select the code in either view, the Property inspector displays information about why its invalid and
how to fix it.
Note: The option to highlight invalid code in Code view is turned off by default. To turn it on, switch to Code View (View
> Code) and then select View > Code View Options > Highlight Invalid Code.
You can also specify preferences for automatically rewriting various kinds of invalid code when you open a document.
Automatic code modification
You can set options that instruct Dreamweaver to automatically clean up your hand-written code according to criteria
that you specify. However, your code is never rewritten unless the code rewriting options are enabled or you perform
an action that changes the code. For example, Dreamweaver does not alter your white space or change the case of
attributes unless you use the Apply Source Formatting command.
A few of these code rewriting options are enabled by default.
358
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
The Roundtrip HTML capabilities in Dreamweaver let you move your documents back and forth between a text-based
HTML editor and Dreamweaver with little or no effect on the content and structure of the documents original HTML
source code. These capabilities include the following:
Use a third-party text editor to edit the current document.
By default, Dreamweaver does not make changes in code created or edited in other HTML editors, even if the code
is invalid, unless you enable code-rewriting options.
Dreamweaver does not change tags it doesn’t recognize—including XML tags—because it has no criteria by which
to judge them. If an unrecognized tag overlaps another tag (for example,
<MyNewTag><em>text</MyNewTag></em>), Dreamweaver marks it as an error but doesn’t rewrite the code.
Optionally, you can set Dreamweaver to highlight invalid code in Code view (in yellow). When you select a
highlighted section, the Property inspector displays information on how to correct the error.
XHTML code
Dreamweaver generates new XHTML code and cleans up existing XHTML code in a way that meets most of the
XHTML requirements. The tools that you need to meet the few XHTML requirements that remain are also provided.
Note: Some of the requirements also are required in various versions of HTML.
The following table describes the XHTML requirements that Dreamweaver meets automatically:
XHTML requirement Actions Dreamweaver performs
There must be a DOCTYPE declaration in the document prior to the
root element, and the declaration must reference one of the three
Document Type Definition (DTD) files for XHTML (strict, transitional, or
frameset).
Adds an XHTML DOCTYPE to an XHTML document:
<!DOCTYPE html PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Transitional//EN"
"http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-transitional.dtd">
Or, if the XHTML document has a frameset:
<!DOCTYPE html PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Frameset//EN"
"http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-frameset.dtd">
The root element of the document must be html, and the html
element must designate the XHTML namespace.
Adds the namespace attribute to the html element, as follows:
<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml">
A standard document must have the head, title, and body structural
elements. A frameset document must have the head, title, and
frameset structural elements.
In a standard document, includes the head, title, and body elements.
In a frameset document, includes the head, title, and frameset
elements.
All elements in the document must nest properly:
<p>This is a <i>bad example.</p></i> <p>This is a <i>good
example.</i></p>
Generates correctly nested code and, when cleaning up XHTML,
corrects nesting in code that was not generated by Dreamweaver.
All element and attribute names must be lowercase. Forces HTML element and attribute names to be lowercase in the
XHTML code that it generates and when cleaning up XHTML,
regardless of your tag and attribute case preferences.
Every element must have a closing tag, unless it is declared in the DTD
as EMPTY.
Inserts closing tags in the code that it generates, and when cleaning
up XHTML.
Empty elements must have a closing tag, or the opening tag must end
with />. For example, <br> is not valid; the correct form is <br></br>
or <br/>. Following are the empty elements: area, base, basefont, br,
col, frame, hr, img, input, isindex, link, meta, and param.
And for backwards-compatibility with browsers that are not XML-
enabled, there must be a space before the /> (for example, <br />, not
<br/>).
Inserts empty elements with a space before the closing slash in empty
tags in the code that it generates, and when cleaning up XHTML.
359
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
Regular expressions
Regular expressions are patterns that describe character combinations in text. Use them in your code searches to help
describe concepts such as lines that begin with “var” and attribute values that contain a number.
The following table lists the special characters in regular expressions, their meanings, and usage examples. To search
for text containing one of the special characters in the table, escape the special character by preceding it with a
backslash. For example, to search for the actual asterisk in the phrase some conditions apply*, your search pattern might
look like this: apply\*. If you don’t escape the asterisk, you’ll find all the occurrences of “apply” (as well as any of “appl,
applyy”, and “applyyy”), not just the ones followed by an asterisk.
Attributes can’t be minimized; for example, <td nowrap> is not valid;
the correct form is <td nowrap="nowrap">.
This affects the following attributes: checked, compact, declare, defer,
disabled, ismap, multiple, noresize, noshade, nowrap, readonly, and
selected.
Inserts full attribute-value pairs in the code that it generates, and
when cleaning up XHTML.
Note: If an HTML browser does not support HTML 4, it might fail to
interpret these Boolean attributes when they appear in their full form.
All attribute values must be surrounded by quotation marks. Places quotation marks around attribute values in the code that it
generates, and when cleaning up XHTML.
The following elements must have an id attribute as well as a name
attribute: a, applet, form, frame, iframe, img, and map. For example, <a
name="intro">Introduction</a> is not valid; the correct form is
<a id="intro">Introduction</a> or <a id="section1" name="intro">
Introduction</a>.
Sets the name and id attributes to the same value, whenever the name
attribute is set by a Property inspector, in the code that Dreamweaver
generates, and when cleaning up XHTML.
For attributes with values of an enumerated type, the values must be
lowercase.
An enumerated type value is a value from a specified list of allowed
values; for example, the align attribute has the following allowed
values: center, justify, left, and right.
Forces enumerated type values to be lowercase in the code that it
generates, and when cleaning up XHTML.
All script and style elements must have a type attribute.
(The type attribute of the script element has been required since
HTML 4, when the language attribute was deprecated.)
Sets the type and language attributes in script elements, and the type
attribute in style elements, in the code that it generates and when
cleaning up XHTML.
All img and area elements must have an alt attribute. Sets these attributes in the code that it generates and, when cleaning
up XHTML, reports missing alt attributes.
Character Matches Example
^Beginning of input or line. ^T matches “T” in “This good earth” but not in
“Uncle Toms Cabin”
$End of input or line. h$ matches “h” in “teach” but not in “teacher”
*The preceding character 0 or more times. um* matches “um” inrum,ummin
“yummy”, and “u” in “huge
+The preceding character 1 or more times. um+ matches “um” in “rum” and “umm” in
“yummy” but nothing in “huge”
?The preceding character at most once (that is,
indicates that the preceding character is
optional).
st?on matches “son” in “Johnson” and “ston” in
Johnston” but nothing in “Appleton” or
“tension
.Any single character except newline. .an matches “ran” and “can” in the phrase
“bran muffins can be tasty”
XHTML requirement Actions Dreamweaver performs
360
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
Use parentheses to set off groupings within the regular expression to be referred to later. Then use $1, $2, $3, and so on
in the Replace With field to refer to the first, second, third, and later parenthetical groupings.
x|y Either x or y. FF0000|0000FF matches “FF0000” in
bgcolor=”#FF0000” and “0000FF’” in font
color=”#0000FF”
{n} Exactly n occurrences of the preceding
character.
o{2} matches “oo” in “loom” and the first two
o’s in “mooooo” but nothing in “money”
{n,m} At least n, and at most m, occurrences of the
preceding character.
F{2,4} matches “FF” in “#FF0000” and the first
four Fs in #FFFFFF
[abc] Any one of the characters enclosed in the
brackets. Specify a range of characters with a
hyphen (for example, [a-f ] is equivalent to
[abcdef]).
[e-g] matches “e” in “bed”, “f” in “folly, and ”g”
in “guard”
[^abc] Any character not enclosed in the brackets.
Specify a range of characters with a hyphen
(for example, [^a-f] is equivalent to
[^abcdef]).
[^aeiou] initially matches “r” in “orange, “b” in
“book”, and “k” in “eek!”
\b A word boundary (such as a space or carriage
return).
\bb matches “b” in “book” but nothing in
goober” or “snob”
\B Anything other than a word boundary. \Bb matches “b” in “goober” but nothing in
“book”
\d Any digit character. Equivalent to [0-9]. \d matches “3” in “C3PO” and “2” in
“apartment 2G”
\D Any nondigit character. Equivalent to [^0-9]. \D matches “S” in “900S” and “Q” in “Q45”
\f Form feed.
\n Line feed.
\r Carriage return.
\s Any single white-space character, including
space, tab, form feed, or line feed.
\sbook matches ”book” in “blue book” but
nothing in “notebook”
\S Any single non-white-space character. \Sbook matches “book” in “notebook” but
nothing in “blue book”
\t A tab.
\w Any alphanumeric character, including
underscore. Equivalent to [A-Za-z0-9_].
b\w* matches “barking” in “the barking dog”
and both “big” and “black” in “the big black
dog
\W Any non-alphanumeric character. Equivalent
to [^A-Za-z0-9_].
\W matches “&” in “Jake&Mattie” and “%” in
“100%”
Control+Enter or Shift+Enter (Windows), or
Control+ Return or Shift+Return or
Command+ Return (Macintosh)
Return character. Make sure that you deselect
the Ignore Whitespace Differences option
when searching for this, if not using regular
expressions. Note that this matches a
particular character, not the general notion of
a line break; for instance, it doesn’t match a
<br> tag or a <p> tag. Return characters
appear as spaces in Design view, not as line
breaks.
Character Matches Example
361
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: In the Search For box, to refer to a parenthetical grouping earlier in the regular expression, use \1, \2, \3, and so on
instead of $1, $2, $3.
For example, searching for (\d+)\/(\d+)\/(\d+) and replacing it with $2/$1/$3 swaps the day and month in a date
separated by slashes, thereby converting between American-style dates and European-style dates.
Server behavior code
When you develop a dynamic page and select a server behavior from the Server Behaviors panel, Dreamweaver inserts
one or more code blocks into your page to make the server behavior work.
If you manually change the code within a code block, you can no longer use panels such as the Bindings and Server
Behaviors panels to edit the server behavior. Dreamweaver looks for specific patterns in the page code to detect server
behaviors and display them in the Server Behaviors panel. If you change a code blocks code in any way, Dreamweaver
can no longer detect the server behavior and display it in the Server Behaviors panel. However, the server behavior still
exists on the page, and you can edit it in the coding environment in Dreamweaver.
More Help topics
Code hints
Setting coding preferences
Customizing keyboard shortcuts
Make pages XHTML-compliant
Search for tags, attributes, or text in code
Save and recall search patterns
Optimizing the workspace for visual development
Setting up your coding environment
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Using coder-oriented workspaces
You can adapt the coding environment in Dreamweaver to fit the way you work. For example, you can change the way
you view code, set up different keyboard shortcuts, or import and use your favorite tag library.
Dreamweaver comes with several workspace layouts designed for an optimal coding experience. From the workspace
switcher on the Application bar, you can select from Application Developer, Application Developer Plus, Coder, and
Coder Plus workspaces. All of these workspaces show Code view by default (in either the entire Document window, or
in Code and Design views), and have panels docked on the left side of the screen. All but Application Developer Plus
eliminate the Property inspector from the default view.
If none of the pre-designed workspaces offer exactly what you need, you can customize your own workspace layout by
opening and docking panels where you want them, and then saving the workspace as a custom workspace.
362
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
Viewing code
You can view the source code for the current document in several ways: you can display it in the Document window by
enabling Code view, you can split the Document window to display both the page and its associated code, or you can
work in the Code inspector, a separate coding window. The Code inspector works just like Code view; you can think
of it as a detachable Code view for the current document.
View code in the Document window
Select View > Code.
Code and edit a page simultaneously in the Document window
1Select View > Code and Design.
The code appears in the top pane and the page appears in the bottom pane.
2To display the page on top, select Design View On Top from the View Options menu on the Document toolbar.
3To adjust the size of the panes in the Document window, drag the splitter bar to the desired position. The splitter
bar is located between the two panes.
Code view is updated automatically when you make changes in Design view. However, after making changes in
Code view, you must manually update the document in Design view by clicking in Design view or pressing F5.
View code in a separate window with the Code inspector
The Code inspector lets you work in a separate coding window, just like working in Code view.
Select Window > Code Inspector. The toolbar includes the following options:
File Management Puts or gets the file.
Preview/Debug In Browser Previews or debugs your document in a browser.
Refresh Design View Updates the document in Design view so that it reflects any changes you made in the code.
Changes you make in the code dont automatically appear in Design view until you perform certain actions, such as
saving the file or clicking this button.
Reference Opens the Reference panel. See Use language-reference material.
Code Navigation Lets you move quickly in the code. See Go to a JavaScript or VBScript function.
View Options Lets you determine how the code is displayed. See Set the code appearance.
To use the Coding toolbar along the left side of the window, see Insert code using the Coding toolbar.
Customizing keyboard shortcuts
You can use your favorite keyboard shortcuts in Dreamweaver. If youre accustomed to using specific keyboard
shortcuts—for example, Shift+Enter to add a line break, or Control+G to go to a specific position in the code—you can
add them to Dreamweaver using the Keyboard Shortcut Editor.
For instructions, see Customize keyboard shortcuts.
Open files in Code view by default
When you open a file type that normally doesnt contain any HTML (for example, a JavaScript file), the file opens in
Code view (or Code inspector) instead of Design view. You can specify which file types open in Code view.
1Select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh).
363
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
2Select File Types/Editors from the Category list on the left.
3In the Open In Code View box, add the filename extension of the file type you want to open automatically in Code
view.
Type a space between filename extensions. You can add as many extensions as you like.
More Help topics
Manage windows and panels
Save and switch workspaces
Customize keyboard shortcuts
Managing tag libraries
Change the code format
Set code hints preferences
Set the color theme for Code View
Work with code snippets
Use an external editor
Set Validator preferences
Setting coding preferences
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About coding preferences
You can set coding preferences such as code formatting and coloring, among others, to meet your specific needs.
Note: To set advanced preferences, use the Tag Library editor (see Managing tag libraries ).
Set the code appearance
You can set word wrapping, display line numbers for the code, highlight invalid code, set syntax coloring for code
elements, set indenting, and show hidden characters from the View > Code View Options menu.
1View a document in Code view or the Code inspector.
2Do one of the following:
Select View > Code View Options
Click the View Options button in the toolbar at the top of Code view or the Code inspector.
3Select or deselect any of the following options:
Word Wrap Wraps the code so that you can view it without scrolling horizontally. This option doesnt insert line
breaks; it just makes the code easier to view.
Line Numbers Displays line numbers along the side of the code.
364
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
Hidden Characters Displays special characters in place of white space. For example, a dot replaces each space, a
double chevron replaces each tab, and a paragraph marker replaces each line break.
Note: Soft line breaks that Dreamweaver uses for word wrapping are not displayed with a paragraph marker.
Highlight Invalid Code Causes Dreamweaver to highlight in yellow all HTML code that isn’t valid. When you select
an invalid tag, the Property inspector displays information on how to correct the error.
Syntax Coloring Enables or disables code coloring. For information on changing the coloring scheme, see Set the
color theme for Code View.
Auto Indent Makes your code indent automatically when you press Enter while writing code. The new line of code
indents to the same level as the previous line. For information on changing the indent spacing, see the Tab Size
option in Change the code format.
Change the code format
You can change the look of your code by specifying formatting preferences such as indentation, line length, and the case
of tag and attribute names.
All the Code Format options, except the Override Case Of option, are automatically applied only to new documents or
additions to documents that you subsequently create.
To reformat existing HTML documents, open the document, and select Commands > Apply Source Formatting.
1Select Edit > Preferences.
2Select Code Format from the Category list on the left.
3Set any of the following options:
Indent Indicates whether code generated by Dreamweaver should be indented (according to the indentation rules
specified in these preferences) or not.
Note: Most of the indentation options in this dialog box apply only to code generated by Dreamweaver, not to code that
you type. To make each new line of code that you type indent to the same level as the previous line, select View > Code
View Options Auto-Indent option. For more information, see Set the code appearance.
With (Text box and pop-up menu) Specifies how many spaces or tabs Dreamweaver should use to indent code that
it generates. For example, if you type 3 in the box and select Tabs in the pop-up menu, then code generated by
Dreamweaver is indented using three tab characters for every level of indentation.
Tab Size Determines how many characters wide each tab character appears in Code view. For example, if Tab Size
is set to 4, then each tab is displayed in Code view as a four-character-wide blank space. If, additionally, Indent With
is set to 3 Tabs, then code generated by Dreamweaver is indented using three tab characters for every level of
indentation, which appears in Code view as a twelve-character-wide blank space.
Note: Dreamweaver indents using either spaces or tabs; it doesn’t convert a run of spaces to a tab when inserting code.
Line Break Type Specifies the type of remote server (Windows, Macintosh, or UNIX) that hosts your remote site.
Choosing the correct type of line break characters ensures that your HTML source code appears correctly when
viewed on the remote server. This setting is also useful when you are working with an external text editor that
recognizes only certain kinds of line breaks. For example, use CR LF (Windows) if Notepad is your external editor,
and use CR (Macintosh) if SimpleText is your external editor.
365
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: For servers that you connect to using FTP, this option applies only to binary transfer mode; the ASCII transfer
mode in Dreamweaver ignores this option. If you download files using ASCII mode, Dreamweaver sets line breaks based
on the operating system of your computer; if you upload files using ASCII mode, the line breaks are all set to CR LF.
Default Tag Case and Default Attribute Case Control the capitalization of tag and attribute names. These options
are applied to tags and attributes that you insert or edit in Design view, but they are not applied to the tags and
attributes that you enter directly in Code view, or to the tags and attributes already in a document when you open
it (unless you also select one or both of the Override Case Of options).
Note: These preferences apply only to HTML pages. Dreamweaver ignores them for XHTML pages because uppercase
tags and attributes are invalid XHTML.
Override Case Of: Tags and Attributes Specifies whether to enforce your specified case options at all times,
including when you open an existing HTML document. When you select one of these options and click OK to
dismiss the dialog box, all tags or attributes in the current document are immediately converted to the specified case,
as are all tags or attributes in each document you open from then on (until you deselect this option again). Tags or
attributes you type in Code view and in the Quick Tag Editor are also converted to the specified case, as are tags or
attributes you insert using the Insert panel. For example, if you want tag names always to be converted to lowercase,
specify lowercase in the Default Tag Case option, and then select the Override Case Of: Tags option. Then when you
open a document that contains uppercase tag names, Dreamweaver converts them all to lowercase.
Note: Older versions of HTML allowed either uppercase or lowercase tag and attribute names, but XHTML requires
lowercase for tag and attribute names. The web is moving toward XHTML, so its generally best to use lowercase tag
and attribute names.
TD Tag: Do Not Include A Break Inside The TD Tag Addresses a rendering problem that occurs in some older
browsers when white space or line breaks exist immediately after a <td> tag, or immediately before a </td> tag.
When you select this option, Dreamweaver does not write line breaks after a <td> or before a </td> tag, even if the
formatting in the Tag Library indicates that the line break should be there.
Advanced Formatting Lets you set formatting options for Cascading Style Sheets(CSS) code and for individual tags
and attributes in the Tag Library Editor.
White Space Character (Japanese version only) Lets you select either &nbsp; or Zenkaku space for HTML code. The
white space selected in this option will be used for empty tags when creating a table and when the “Allow Multiple
Consecutive Spaces” option is enabled in Japanese Encoding pages.
Set the code rewriting preferences
Use the code rewriting preferences to specify how and whether Dreamweaver modifies your code while opening
documents, when copying and pasting form elements, and when entering attribute values and URLs using tools such
as the Property inspector. These preferences have no effect when you edit HTML or scripts in Code view.
If you disable the rewriting options, invalid-markup items are displayed in the Document window for HTML that it
would have rewritten.
1Select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh).
2Select Code Rewriting from the Category list on the left.
3Set any of the following options:
Fix Invalidly Nested and Unclosed Tags Rewrites overlapping tags. For example, <b><i>text</b></i> is rewritten as
<b><i>text</i></b>. This option also inserts closing quotation marks and closing brackets if they are missing.
Rename Form Items When Pasting Ensures you don’t have duplicate names for form objects. This option is enabled
by default.
366
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: Unlike the other options in this preferences dialog box, this option does not apply when you open a document,
only when you copy and paste a form element.
Remove Extra Closing Tags Deletes closing tags that have no corresponding opening tag.
Warn When Fixing Or Removing Tags Displays a summary of technically invalid HTML that Dreamweaver
attempted to correct. The summary notes the location of the problem (using line and column numbers) so that you
can find the correction and ensure that its rendering as intended.
Never Rewrite Code: In Files With Extensions Allows you to prevent Dreamweaver from rewriting code in files with
the specified filename extensions. This option is particularly useful for files that contain third-party tags.
Encode <, >, &, And " In Attribute Values Using & Ensures that attribute values that you enter or edit using
Dreamweaver tools such as the Property inspector contain only legal characters. This option is enabled by default.
Note: This option and the following options do not apply to URLs that you type in Code view. Also, they do not cause
existing code already in a file to change.
Do Not Encode Special Characters Prevents Dreamweaver from changing URLs to use only legal characters. This
option is enabled by default.
Encode Special Characters In URL Using &# Ensures that when you enter or edit URLs using Dreamweaver tools
such as the Property inspector, those URLs contain only legal characters.
Encode Special Characters In URL Using % Operates the same way as the preceding option, but uses a different
method of encoding special characters. This encoding method (using the percent sign) may be more compatible
with older browsers, but doesn’t work as well with characters from some languages.
Set the color theme for Code View
Use the code coloring preferences to specify a theme for Code View. You can customize the theme by choosing different
color shemes for backgrounds, foregrounds, and hidden characters.
For each listed document type, you can customize the colors for different categories of tags and code elements, such as
form-related tags or JavaScript identifiers. For example, with the Raven theme applied to all document types, you can
choose to have a blue color for form-related tags in only HTML documents.
All custom settings in a theme are saved when you click Apply and the customized theme is available for use across
Dreamweaver sessions.
Note: To set color preferences for a specific tag, edit the tag definition in the Tag Library editor.
Customize themes
The default theme is Classic. To change the theme or to customize a theme, peform the following steps:
1Select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh).
2Select Code Coloring from the Category list on the left.
3Select a theme from the Themes list.
367
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
4If you want to customize the theme, perform the following steps:
aTo change the background colors, use the following options:
Default background sets the default background color for Code view and the Code inspector.
Hidden characters sets the color for hidden characters.
Live Code background sets the background color for Live Code view. The default color is yellow.
Live Code changes sets the highlighting color of code that changes in Live Code view. The default color is pink.
Read only background sets the background color for read only text.
Selection background sets the background color for the selected code.
Selection foreground sets the foreground color for the selected code.
bTo change the coloring scheme of specific tag categories or code elements, select a document type from the
Document type list. Then, click Edit Theme Colors.
Note: Any edits you make to code coloring scheme of a selected document type will affect all documents of this
type.
In the Edit Coloring Scheme dialog box, select a code element from the Styles For list, and set its text color,
background color, and (optional) style (bold, italic, or underline). The sample code in the Preview pane changes
to match the new colors and styles.
368
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
cTo revert to the factory default settings of a theme, click Restore Defaults.
5Click Apply to save the changes.
You can keep the customized code themes synchronized between your Dreamweaver instances using the Sync Settings
option in Preferences. For more information, see Synchronizing Dreamweaver settings with Creative Cloud.
Add themes to the default list
If you want a customized theme to appear in the default theme list, perform the following steps:
1Copy and paste Themes.xml to your desktop from the following location:
On Win: C:\Program Files\Adobe\Adobe Dreamweaver CC 2015\configuration\themes
On Mac: Applications/Adobe Dreamweaver CC 2015/configuration/themes/
2Open Themes.xml in Notepad and add the following line before the closing tag <theme>:
<theme name="MyTheme"></theme>
3Replace the Themes.xml file in the following location with the file you edited:
On Win: C:\Program Files\Adobe\Adobe Dreamweaver CC 2015\configuration\themes
On Mac: Applications/Adobe Dreamweaver CC 2015/configuration/themes/
4To specify the color scheme for your theme, reuse the XML files for the existing themes in the following locations:
On Win: C:\Program Files\Adobe\Adobe Dreamweaver CC 2015\configuration\themes
On Mac: Applications/Adobe Dreamweaver CC 2015/configuration/themes/
For example, copy Raven.xml and defaultColorsRaven.xml, and then rename the copied files to MyTheme.xml and
defaultColorsMyTheme.xml.
369
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
5Relaunch Dreamweaver and check the default themes list (Preferences > Code Coloring) to see if your theme is
listed.
Use an external editor
You can specify an external editor to use for editing files with specific filename extensions. For example, you can start
a text editor such as BBEdit, Notepad, or TextEdit from Dreamweaver to edit JavaScript (JS) files.
You can assign different external editors for different filename extensions.
Set an external editor for a file type
1Select Edit > Preferences.
2Select File Types/Editors from the Category list on the left, set the options, and click OK.
Open In Code View Specifies the filename extensions that automatically open in Code view in Dreamweaver.
External Code Editor Specifies the text editor to use.
Reload Modified Files Specifies the behavior when Dreamweaver detects that changes were made externally to a
document that is open in Dreamweaver.
Save On Launch Specifies whether Dreamweaver should always save the current document before starting the
editor, never save the document, or prompt you to ask whether to save or not each time you start the external editor.
Fireworks Specifies editors for various media file types.
Start an external code editor
Select Edit > Edit with External Editor.
More Help topics
Viewing code
Coding toolbar overview
Set code hints preferences
Format CSS code
Set code hints preferences
Clean up Microsoft Word HTML files
Set code hints preferences
Customize code coloring preferences for a template
Edit libraries, tags, and attributes
Preview Live Code
Set code hints preferences
Open files in Code view by default
370
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
Writing and editing code
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Code hints
The code hints feature helps you insert and edit code quickly and without mistakes. As you type characters in Code
view, you see a list of candidates that automatically complete your entry. For example, when you type the first characters
of a tag, attribute, or CSS property name, you see a list of options beginning with those characters. This feature
simplifies the insertion and editing of code. You can also use it to see the available attributes for a tag, the available
parameters for a function, or the available methods for an object.
Code hints are available for several kinds of code. When you type the beginning character of a particular code type, you
see a list of appropriate candidates. For example, to display a list of code hints for HTML tag names, type a right angle
bracket (<). Similarly, to display JavaScript code hinting, type a period (dot operator) after an object.
For best results, especially when using code hints for functions and objects, set the Delay option in the Code Hints
preferences dialog box to 0 seconds.
The code hinting feature also recognizes custom JavaScript classes that are not built in to the language. You can write
these custom classes yourself or add them through third-party libraries like Prototype.
The list of code hints disappears when you press Backspace (Windows) or Delete (Macintosh).
For a video tutorial on code hinting, see www.adobe.com/go/lrvid4048_dw.
For a video overview from the Dreamweaver engineering team about JavaScript support in Dreamweaver, see
www.adobe.com/go/dw10javascript.
Supported languages and technologies
Dreamweaver supports code hinting for the following languages and technologies:
Adobe ColdFusion
Ajax
ASP JavaScript
ASP.NET C#
ASP.NET VB
ASP VBScript
CSS2 and CSS3
DOM (Document Object Model)
HTML4 and HTML5
jQuery (CS5.5 and later)
JavaScript (includes custom class hinting)
JSP
PHP MySQL
Spry
371
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
Display a code hints menu
The code hints menu appears automatically as you type in Code view. But you can also display the code hints menu
manually, without typing.
1In Code view (Window > Code), place the insertion point inside a tag.
2Press Control+Spacebar.
Insert code in Code view by using code hints
1Type the beginning of a piece of code. For example, to insert a tag, type a right angle bracket (<). To insert an
attribute, place the insertion point immediately after a tag name and press Spacebar.
A list of items (such as tag names or attribute names) appears.
To close the list at any time, press Esc.
2Scroll through the list by using the scroll bar or the Up Arrow and Down Arrow keys.
3To insert an item from the list, double-click it, or select it and press Enter (Windows) or Return (Macintosh).
If a recently created CSS style doesn’t appear in a code hints list of CSS styles, select Refresh Style List from the code
hints list. If Design view is visible, sometimes invalid code appears in Design view temporarily after you select
Refresh Style List. To remove that invalid code from Design view, press F5 to refresh after you finish inserting the style.
4To insert a closing tag, type </ (slash).
Note: By default, Dreamweaver determines when a closing tag is needed and inserts if automatically. You can change
this default behavior so that Dreamweaver inserts a closing tag after you type the final angle bracket (>) of the opening
tag. Alternatively, the default behavior can be to insert no closing tag at all. Select Edit > Preferences > Code Hints, and
then select one of the Close Tags options.
Edit a tag by using code hints
To replace an attribute with a different attribute, delete the attribute and its value. Then add an attribute and its value
as described in the previous procedure.
To change a value, delete the value, and then add a value as described in the previous procedure.
Refreshing JavaScript code hints
Dreamweaver automatically refreshes the list of available code hints as you work in JavaScript files. For example,
suppose you are working in a primary HTML file and switch to a JavaScript file to make a change. That change is
reflected in the list of code hints when you return to the primary HTML file. However, automatic updating works only
if you edit your JavaScript files in Dreamweaver.
If you edit your JavaScript files outside Dreamweaver, press Control+period to refresh the JavaScript code hints.
Code hinting and syntax errors
Code hints sometimes dont work properly if Dreamweaver detects syntax errors in your code. Dreamweaver alerts you
to syntax errors by displaying information about them in a bar at the top of the page. The Syntax Error Information Bar
displays the first line of code on which Dreamweaver encounters the error. As you fix errors, Dreamweaver continues
to display any errors that occur later.
Dreamweaver provides additional help by highlighting (in red) the line numbers where syntax errors occur. The
highlight appears in the Code view of the file that contains the error.
372
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
Dreamweaver displays syntax errors not only for the current page but also for related pages. For example, suppose you
are working on an HTML page that uses an included JavaScript file. If the included file contains an error, Dreamweaver
displays an alert for the JavaScript file as well. You can easily open the related file containing the error by clicking its
name at the top of the document.
You can disable the Syntax Error Information Bar by clicking the Syntax Error Alerts button in the Coding toolbar.
Set code hints preferences
You can change default preferences for code hints. For example, if you dont want to show CSS property names or Spry
code hints, you can deselect them in code hints preferences. You can also set preferences for code hint delay time and
closing tags.
Even if code hints are disabled, you can still display a pop-up hint in Code view by pressing Control+Spacebar.
1Select Edit > Preferences.
2Select Code Hints from the Category list on the left.
3Set any of the following options:
Close Tags Specifies how you want Dreamweaver to insert closing tags. By default, Dreamweaver inserts the closing
tag automatically after you type the characters </. You can change this default behavior so that the closing tag is
inserted after you type the final angle bracket (>) of the opening tag, or so that no closing tag is inserted at all.
Enable Code Hints Displays code hints while you enter code in Code view. Drag the Delay slider to set the time in
seconds before appropriate hints are displayed.
Enable Description Tooltips Displays an extended description (if available) of the selected code hint.
Menus Sets exactly which type of code hints you want displayed while typing. You can use all or some of the menus.
Site-specific code hints
Dreamweaver CS5 lets developers working with Joomla, Drupal, Wordpress or other frameworks, to view PHP code
hints as they write in Code view. To display these code hints, you first need to create a configuration file using the Site-
Specific Code Hints dialog box. The configuration tells Dreamweaver where to look for code hints that are specific to
your site.
For a video tutorial on working with Site-specific code hints, see www.adobe.com/go/learn_dw_comm13_en.
Create the configuration file
Use the Site-Specific Code Hints dialog box to create the configuration file needed to display code hints in
Dreamweaver.
By default, Dreamweaver stores the configuration file in the Adobe Dreamweaver
CS5\configuration\Shared\Dinamico\Presets directory.
373
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: The code hints you create are specifically for the site selected in the Dreamweaver Files panel. In order for the code
hints to display, the page you are working on must reside in the currently selected site.
1Select Site > Site-Specific Code Hints.
By default, the Site-Specific Code Hints feature scans your site to determine which Content Management System
(CMS) framework youre using. Dreamweaver supports three frameworks by default: Drupal, Joomla, and
Wordpress.
The four buttons to the right of the Structure pop-up menu let you import, save, rename, or delete framework
structures.
Note: You cannot delete or rename the existing default framework structures.
2In the sub-root text box, specify the sub-root folder where you store your frameworks files. You can click the folder
icon next to the text box to browse to the framework files’ location.
Dreamweaver displays a file tree structure of folders that contain your framework files. If the folders and/or files you
want to scan are all displayed, click OK to run the scan. If you want to customize the scan, go on to the next steps.
3Click the plus (+) button above the Files window to select a file or folder that you want to add to the scan. In the Add
Files/Folders dialog box, you can specify particular file extensions that you want to include.
Note: Specifying particular file extensions speeds up the scanning process.
4To remove files from the scan, select the files you don’t want scanned, and then click the minus (-) button above the
Files window.
Note: If Drupal or Joomla is the selected framework, the Site-Specific Code Hints dialog box displays an additional path
to a file within your Dreamweaver configuration folder. Don’t delete this—it’s required when using these frameworks.
5To customize how the Site-Specific Code Hints feature treats a particular file or folder, select it from the list and do
one of the following:
Select Scan This Folder to include the selected folder in the scan.
Select Recursive to include all files and folders within a selected directory.
Click the Extensions button to open the Find Extensions dialog box, where you can specify the file extensions
you want included in your scan for a particular file or folder.
Save site structure
You can save the customized site structure youve created in the Site-Specific Code Hints dialog box.
1Create the structure of files and folders as you want it, adding and deleting files and folders as necessary.
2Click the Save Structure button in the upper right-hand corner of the dialog box.
3Specify a name for your site structure and click Save.
Note: If the name you specify is already in use, Dreamweaver prompts you to enter a different name, or to confirm that you
want to overwrite the structure with the same name. You cannot overwrite any of the default framework structures.
Rename site structures
When renaming your site structure, keep in mind that you cannot use the names of any of the three default site
framework structures, or the wordcustom.
1Display the structure that you want to rename.
2Click the Rename Structure icon button in the upper right-hand corner of the dialog box.
374
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
3Specify a new name for the structure and click Rename.
Note: If the name you specify is already in use, Dreamweaver prompts you to enter a different name, or to confirm that you
want to overwrite the structure with the same name. You cannot overwrite any of the default framework structures.
Add files or folders to a site structure
You can add any files or folders that are associated with your framework. After that, you can specify the file extensions
of the files you want to scan. (See the next section.)
1Click the plus (+) button above the Files window to open the Add File/Folder dialog box.
2In the Add File/Folder text box, enter the path to the file or folder you want to add. You can also click the folder icon
next to the text box to browse to a file or folder.
3Click the plus (+) button above the Extensions window to specify the file extensions of files you want to scan.
Note: Specifying particular file extensions speeds up the scanning process.
4Click Add.
Scan a site for file extensions
Use the Find Extensions dialog box to view and edit file extensions that are included in the site structure.
1In the Site-Specific Code Hints dialog box, click the Extensions button.
The Find Extensions dialog box lists the current scannable extensions.
2To add another extension to the list, click the plus (+) button above the Extensions window.
3To delete an extension from the list, click the minus (-) button.
Insert code using the Coding toolbar
1Make sure you are in Code view (View > Code).
2Position the insertion point in the code, or select a block of code.
3Click a button in the Coding toolbar, or select an item from a pop-up menu in the toolbar.
To find out what each button does, position the pointer over it until a tooltip appears. The Coding toolbar displays
the following buttons by default:
Open Documents Lists the documents that are open. When you select one, it is displayed in the Document window.
Show Code Navigator Displays the Code Navigator. For more information, see Navigate to related code.
Expand All Restores all collapsed code.
Select Parent Tag Selects the content and surrounding opening and closing tags of the line in which you’ve placed
the insertion point. If you repeatedly click this button, and your tags are balanced, Dreamweaver eventually selects
the outermost html and /html tags.
Balance Braces Selects the content and surrounding parentheses, braces, or square brackets of the line in which you
placed the insertion point. If you repeatedly click this button, and your surrounding symbols are balanced,
Dreamweaver eventually selects the outermost braces, parentheses, or brackets in the document.
Line Numbers Lets you hide or show numbers at the beginning of each line of code.
Word Wrap Wraps all the text in Code view so that it appears within the defined space of the view.
Highlight Invalid Code Highlights invalid code in yellow.
375
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: This option is not available for HTML, CSS, and JS files. Use linting in these files to find potential errors in code.
Syntax Error Alerts in Info Bar Enables or disables an information bar at the top of the page that alerts you to syntax
errors. When Dreamweaver detects a syntax error, the Syntax Error Information Bar specifies the line in the code
where the error occurs. Additionally, Dreamweaver highlights the error’s line number on the left side of the
document in Code view. The info bar is enabled by default, but only appears when Dreamweaver detects syntax
errors in the page.
Note: This option is not available for HTML, CSS, and JS files. Use linting in these files to find potential errors in code.
Apply Comment Lets you wrap comment tags around selected code, or open new comment tags.
Apply HTML Comment wraps the selected code with <!-- and -->, or opens a new tag if no code is selected.
Apply // Comment inserts // at the beginning of each line of selected CSS or JavaScript code, or inserts a single
// tag if no code is selected.
Apply /* */ wraps the selected CSS or JavaScript code with /* and */.
Apply ' Comment is for Visual Basic code. It inserts a single quotation mark at the beginning of each line of a
Visual Basic script, or inserts a single quotation mark at the insertion point if no code is selected.
When you are working in a ASP, ASP.NET, JSP, PHP, or ColdFusion file and you select the Apply Server
Comment option, Dreamweaver automatically detects the correct comment tag and applies it to your selection.
Remove Comment Removes comment tags from the selected code. If a selection includes nested comments, only
the outer comment tags are removed.
Wrap Tag Wraps selected code with the selected tag from the Quick Tag Editor.
Recent Snippets Lets you insert a recently used code snippet from the Snippets panel. For more information, see
Work with code snippets.
Move or Convert CSS Lets you move CSS to another location, or convert inline CSS to CSS rules. For more
information, see Move/export CSS rulesand Convert inline CSS to a CSS rule .
Indent Code Shifts the selection to the right.
Outdent Code Shifts the selection to the left.
Format Source Code Applies previously specified code formats to selected code, or to the entire page if no code is
selected. You can also quickly set code formatting preferences by selecting Code Formatting Settings from the
Format Source Code button, or edit tag libraries by selecting Edit Tag Libraries.
The number of buttons available in the Coding toolbar varies depending on the size of the Code view in the
Document window. To see all of the available buttons, resize the Code view window or click the expander arrow at
the bottom of the Coding toolbar.
You can also edit the Coding toolbar to display more buttons (such as Word Wrap, Hidden Characters, and Auto
Indent) or hide buttons that you don’t want to use. To do this, however, you must edit the XML file that generates
the toolbar. For more information, see Extending Dreamweaver.
Note: The option to view hidden characters, which is not a default button in the Coding toolbar, is available from the
View menu (View > Code View Options > Hidden Characters).
Insert code with the Insert panel
1Position the insertion point in the code.
2Select an appropriate category in the Insert panel.
3Click a button in the Insert panel or select an item from a pop-up menu in the Insert panel.
376
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
When you click an icon, the code may appear in your page immediately, or a dialog box may appear requesting more
information to complete the code.
To find out what each button does, position the pointer over it until a tooltip appears. The number and type of
buttons available in the Insert panel varies depending on the current document type. It also depends on whether
youre using Code view or Design view.
Although the Insert panel provides a collection of frequently used tags, it is not comprehensive. To choose from a
more comprehensive selection of tags, use the Tag Chooser.
Insert code using Emmet
Emmet is a plug-in that allows high-speed coding and generation of HTML and CSS code. You can now use Emmet
abbreviations in Code View or Code Inspector in Dreamweaver and press the Tab key to expand these abbreviations
into HTML markups or CSS. HTML abbreviations expand in HTML and PHP pages. CSS abbreviations expand in CSS,
LESS, Sass, SCSS pages or within the style tag in an HTML page.
Following are a few examples on how to use Emmet abbreviations in Code View. For detailed information and
reference, see the Emmet documentation.
Note: Dreamweaver currently supports only Emmet 1.0 abbreviations.
Example 1: Inserting HTML code using Emmet
To quickly add HTML code for an unordered list with three elements, open the HTML file and type the following
Emmet abreviation in Code view within <body></body>:
div>(ul>li*3>{Lorem Ipsum})+p*4>lorem
Now, ensure that the cursor is placed right after the Emmet abbreviation and press Tab to expand the abbreviation.
Alternatively, select the entire abbreviation and then press Enter.
The abbreviation expands to the following code:
<div>
<ul>
<li>Lorem Ipsum</li>
<li>Lorem Ipsum</li>
<li>Lorem Ipsum</li>
</ul>
<p>Lorem ipsum dolor sit amet, consectetur adipisicing elit. Saepe, voluptatum, perferendis
ad impedit iste assumenda et laborum doloribus optio molestiae perspiciatis modi quaerat
corrupti velit cupiditate eligendi tempora temporibus vel.</p>
<p>Ipsa, distinctio, eveniet ad numquam libero quam doloremque culpa illo ex possimus
eligendi amet nesciunt provident inventore rerum facere ea veritatis itaque? Suscipit rem
asperiores excepturi sapiente enim architecto esse.</p>
<p>Harum, ad porro molestiae corporis natus aut non fugit. Recusandae, reprehenderit,
voluptate voluptas reiciendis voluptatum tempora vero vel libero facere fuga maiores ratione
eaque ad illum porro dignissimos sit eos.</p>
<p>Dignissimos, molestiae, quis ducimus ratione temporibus sed accusamus libero consequuntur
ex velit maiores illum repudiandae cum! Dolorum, dolore, pariatur, incidunt in saepe laudantium
consequatur provident totam vero velit nobis accusantium!</p>
</div>
Example 2: Inserting CSS code using Emmet
377
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
To insert CSS code for creating border radius with vendor prefixes, open your CSS file and type the following Emmet
abbrevation:
-bdrs
When you press Tab, the abbreviation expands to the following code:
-webkit-border-radius: ;
-moz-border-radius: ;
border-radius: ;
Insert tags with the Tag Chooser
Use the Tag Chooser to insert in your page any tag in the Dreamweaver tag libraries (which include ColdFusion and
ASP.NET tag libraries).
1Position the insertion point in the code, right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh), and select Insert Tag.
The Tag Chooser appears. The left pane contains a list of supported tag libraries, and the right pane shows the
individual tags in the selected tag library folder.
2Select a category of tags from the tag library, or expand the category and select a subcategory.
3Select a tag from the right pane.
4To view syntax and usage information for the tag in the Tag Chooser, click the Tag Info button. If available,
information about the tag appears.
5To view the same information about the tag in the Reference panel, click the <?> icon. If available, information about
the tag appears.
6To insert the selected tag into your code, click Insert.
If the tag appears in the right pane with angle brackets (for example, <title></title>), it doesn’t require additional
information, and its immediately inserted into the document at the insertion point.
If the tag does require additional information, a tag editor appears.
7If a tag editor opens, enter the additional information, and click OK.
8Click the Close button.
Insert HTML comments
A comment is descriptive text that you insert in HTML code to explain the code or provide other information. The text
of the comment appears only in Code view and is not displayed in a browser.
Insert a comment at the insertion point
Select Insert > Comment.
In Code view, a comment tag is inserted and the insertion point is placed in the middle of the tag. Type your
comment.
In Design view, the Comment dialog box appears. Enter the comment and click OK.
378
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
Display comment markers in Design view
Select View > Visual Aids > Invisible Elements.
Make sure that the Comments option is selected in the Invisible Elements preferences or the comment marker does
not appear.
Edit an existing comment
In Code view, find the comment and edit its text.
In Design view, select the Comment marker, edit the comments text in the Property inspector, and then click in the
Document window.
Copy and paste code
1Copy the code from Code view or from another application.
2Place the insertion point in Code view, and select Edit > Paste.
Preview images and colors in Code view
After you insert the relevant code for images and colors, you can preview them right within Code view.
Image preview
Color preview
Image preview
Hover your mouse over any image URL to see a preview of the image in Code view. You can preview images that are
referenced as any of the following:
url();
data-uri()
Src attribute value of img tag
Dreamweaver also shows image previews of remotely hosted images. For example, <img
src="https://a2.behance.net/img/profile/no-image-138.jpg?cb=1816124956" />. If Dreamweaver is unable to display
the preview for remote paths, the message "Unable to load image" is displayed.
You can get a preview for the following image file types:
JPEG
JPG
PNG
GIF
SVG
379
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
Color preview
Hover your mouse over color values to preview colors in Code View. The following are the supported formats:
3 and 6 digits Hexadecimal color values: #ff0000;
RGB: rgb(0, 0, 0);
RGBA: rgba(0, 255, 228,0.5);
HSL: hsl(120, 100%, 50%);
HSLA: hsla(120, 60%, 70%, 0.3);
Pre-defined color names, such as, Olive, Teal, red.
Press Control + Spacebar to see the color picker and change the color values quickly.
Color preview is available in all document types for the above color formats.
Analyze code
Dreamweaver supports linting, which is the process of analyzin code for potential errors. The Output panel lists the
errors and warnings detected through linting. For more information, see Lint code .
In addition, Dreamweaver also shows a quick error preview in the line number column of the erroneous line. The line
number is displayed in red to indicate that it contains errors, and when you hover over it, a brief description of the error
is displayed.
380
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note:Only the first error in the line is displayed. If the line contains only a warning, the description of the warning is
displayed. If the line contains a warning and an error, only the error description is displayed.
Edit tags with Tag editors
Use Tag editors to view, specify, and edit the attributes of tags.
1Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) a tag in Code view or an object in Design view, and select Edit
Tag from the pop-up menu. (The contents of this dialog box change depending on the selected tag.)
2Specify or edit attributes for the tag and click OK.
To get more information about the tag within the Tag editor, click Tag Info.
Edit code with the Coding context menu
1In Code view, select some code and right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh).
2Select the Selection submenu, and select any of the following options:
Expand All Restores all collapsed code.
Apply HTML Comment Wraps the selected code with <!-- and -->, or opens a new tag if no code is selected.
Apply /* */ Comment Wraps the selected CSS or JavaScript code with /* and */.
Apply // Comment Inserts // at the beginning of each line of selected CSS or JavaScript code, or inserts a single //
tag if no code is selected.
Apply ' Comment Inserts a single quotation mark at the beginning of each line of a Visual Basic script, or inserts a
single quotation mark at the insertion point if no code is selected.
Apply Server Comment Wraps the selected code. When you are working in a ASP, ASP.NET, JSP, PHP, or
ColdFusion file and you select the Apply Server Comment option, Dreamweaver automatically detects the correct
comment tag and applies it to your selection.
Apply Backslash-comment Hack Wraps the selected CSS code with comment tags that will cause Internet Explorer
5 for Macintosh to ignore the code.
Apply Caio Hack Wraps the selected CSS code with comment tags that will cause Netscape Navigator 4 to ignore
the code.
Remove Comment Removes comment tags from the selected code. If a selection includes nested comments, only
the outer comment tags are removed.
Remove Backslash-comment Hack Removes comment tags from the selected CSS code. If a selection includes
nested comments, only the outer comment tags are removed.
Remove Caio Hack Removes comment tags from the selected CSS code. If a selection includes nested comments,
only the outer comment tags are removed
Convert Tabs to Spaces Converts each tab in the selection to a number of spaces equal to the Tab Size value set in
Code Format preferences. For more information, see Change the code format.
Convert Spaces To Tabs Converts runs of spaces in the selection to tabs. Each run of spaces that has a number of
spaces equal to the tab size is converted to one tab.
Indent Indents the selection, shifting it to the right. For more information, see Indent code blocks.
Outdent Shifts the selection to the left.
381
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
Remove All Tags Removes all the tags in the selection.
Convert Lines To Table Wraps the selection in a table tag with no attributes.
Add Line Breaks Adds a br tag at the end of each line of the selection.
Convert To Uppercase Converts all letters in the selection (including tag and attribute names and values) to
uppercase.
Convert To Lowercase Converts all letters in the selection (including tag and attribute names and values) to
lowercase.
Convert Tags To Uppercase Converts all tag and attribute names and attribute values in the selection to uppercase.
Convert Tags To Lowercase Converts all tag and attribute names and attribute values in the selection to lowercase.
Edit a server-language tag with the Property inspector
Edit the code in a server-language tag (such as an ASP tag) without entering Code view by using the code Property
inspector.
1In Design view, select the server-language tag visual icon.
2In the Property inspector, click the Edit button.
3Make changes to the tag code, and click OK.
Indent code blocks
As you write and edit code in Code view or the Code inspector, you can change the indentation level of a selected block
or line of code, shifting it right or left by one tab.
Indent the selected block of code
Press Tab.
Select Edit > Indent Code.
Unindent the selected block of code
Press Shift+Tab.
Select Edit > Outdent Code.
Navigate to related code
The Code Navigator displays a list of code sources related to a particular selection on your page. Use it to navigate to
related code sources, such as internal and external CSS rules, server-side includes, external JavaScript files, parent
template files, library files, and iframe source files. When you click a link in the Code Navigator, Dreamweaver opens
the file containing the relevant piece of code. The file appears in the related files area, if it is enabled. If you don’t have
related files enabled, Dreamweaver opens the selected file as a separate document in the Document window.
If you click a CSS rule in the Code Navigator, Dreamweaver takes you directly to that rule. If the rule is internal to the
file, Dreamweaver displays the rule in Split view. If the rule is in an external CSS file, Dreamweaver opens the file and
displays the rule in the related files area above the main document.
You can access the Code Navigator from Design, Code, and Split views, as well as from the Code inspector.
For a video overview from the Dreamweaver engineering team about working with the Code Navigator, see
www.adobe.com/go/dw10codenav.
382
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
For a video tutorial on working with Live View, related files, and the Code Navigator, see
www.adobe.com/go/lrvid4044_dw.
Open the Code Navigator
Alt+click (Windows) or Command+Option+Click (Macintosh) anywhere on the page. The Code Navigator displays
links to the code affecting the area you clicked.
Click outside the Code Navigator to close it.
Note: You can also open the Code Navigator by clicking the Code Navigator indicator . This indicator appears near the
insertion point on your page when the mouse has been idle for 2 seconds.
Navigate to code with the Code Navigator
1Open the Code Navigator from the area of the page that youre interested in.
2Click the piece of code you want to go to.
The Code Navigator groups related code sources by file and lists the files alphabetically. For example, suppose that CSS
rules in three external files affect the selection in your document. In this case, the Code Navigator lists those three files
as well as the CSS rules relevant to the selection. For CSS related to a given selection, the Code Navigator functions like
the CSS Styles panel in Current Mode.
When you hover over links to CSS rules, the Code Navigator displays tool tips of the properties in the rule. These tool
tips are useful when you want to distinguish between many rules that share the same name.
Disable the Code Navigator indicator
1Open the Code Navigator.
2Select Disable Indicator in the lower-right corner.
3Click outside the Code Navigator to close it.
To re-enable the Code Navigator indicator, Alt+Click (Windows) or Command+Option+Click (Macintosh) to open
the Code Navigator and deselect the Disable Indicator option.
Go to a JavaScript or VBScript function
In Code view and the Code inspector, you can view a list of all of the JavaScript or VBScript functions in your code and
jump to any one of them.
1View the document in Code view (View > Code) or the Code inspector (Window > Code Inspector).
2Do one of the following:
In Code view, right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) anywhere in Code view, and select the
Functions submenu from the context menu.
The Functions submenu does not appear in Design view.
Any JavaScript or VBScript functions in your code appear in the submenu.
To see the functions listed in alphabetical order, Control-right-click (Windows) or Option-Control-click (Macintosh)
in Code view, and then select the Functions submenu.
In the Code inspector, click the Code Navigation button ({ }) on the toolbar.
3Select a function name to jump to the function in your code.
383
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
Extract JavaScript
The JavaScript Extractor (JSE) removes all or most of the JavaScript from your Dreamweaver document, exports it to
an external file, and links the external file to your document. The JSE can also remove event handlers such as onclick
and onmouseover from your code and then unobtrusively attach the JavaScript associated with those handlers to your
document.
You should be aware of the following limitations of the JavaScript Extractor before using it:
The JSE does not extract script tags in the body of the document (except in the case of Spry widgets). There is a
chance that externalizing these scripts could cause unexpected results. By default, Dreamweaver lists these scripts
in the Externalize JavaScript dialog box, but does not select them for extraction. (You can manually select them if
you want.)
The JSE does not extract JavaScript from editable regions of .dwt (Dreamweaver template) files, non-editable regions
of template instances, or Dreamweaver Library items.
After you extract JavaScript using the Externalize JavaScript and Attach Unobtrusively option, you can no longer
edit Dreamweaver behaviors in the Behaviors panel. Dreamweaver cannot inspect and populate the Behaviors panel
with behaviors that it has attached unobtrusively.
You cannot undo your changes once you close the page. You can, however, undo changes as long as you remain in
the same editing session. Select Edit > Undo Externalize JavaScript to undo.
Some very complex pages might not work as expected. Use care when extracting JavaScript from pages with
document.write() in the body and global variables.
For a video overview from the Dreamweaver engineering team about JavaScript support in Dreamweaver, see
www.adobe.com/go/dw10javascript.
To use the JavaScript Extractor:
1Open a page that contains JavaScript (for example, a Spry page).
2Select Commands > Externalize JavaScript.
3In the Externalize JavaScript dialog box, edit the default selections if necessary.
Select Only Externalize JavaScript if you want Dreamweaver to move any JavaScript to an external file, and to
reference that file in the current document. This option leaves event handlers such as onclick and onload in the
document, and leaves Behaviors visible in the Behaviors panel.
Select Externalize JavaScript and Attach Unobtrusively if you want Dreamweaver to 1) move JavaScript to an
external file and reference it in the current document, and 2) remove event handlers from the HTML and insert
them at runtime using JavaScript. When you select this option, you can no longer edit Behaviors in the Behaviors
panel.
In the Edit column, deselect any edits you do not want to make, or select edits that Dreamweaver did not select
by default.
By default, Dreamweaver lists but does not select the following edits:
Script blocks in the head of the document that contain document.write() or document.writeln() calls.
Script blocks in the head of the document that contain function signatures related to EOLAS handling code,
which is known to use document.write().
Script blocks in the body of the document, unless the blocks contain only Spry widget or Spry data set
constructors.
Dreamweaver automatically assigns IDs to elements that don’t already have IDs. If you don’t like these IDs, you
can change them by editing the ID text boxes.
384
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
4Click OK.
The summary dialog provides a summary of extractions. Review the extractions and click OK.
5Save the page.
Dreamweaver creates a SpryDOMUtils.js file, as well as another file that contains the extracted JavaScript.
Dreamweaver saves the SpryDOMUtils.js file in a SpryAssets folder in your site, and saves the other file at the same
level as the page from which you extracted the JavaScript. Don’t forget to upload both of these dependent files to your
web server when you upload the original page.
Work with code snippets
Code snippets let you store content for quick reuse. You can create, insert, edit, or delete snippets of HTML, JavaScript,
CFML, ASP, PHP, and more. You can also manage and share your code snippets with team members. Some predefined
snippets that you can use as a starting point are available.
Insert a code snippet
1Place the insertion point where you want to insert the code snippet, or select code to wrap a snippet around.
2In the Snippets panel (Window > Snippets), double-click the snippet.
You can also right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the snippet, and then select Insert from the pop-up
menu.
Create a code snippet
1In the Snippets panel, click the New Snippet icon at the bottom of the panel.
2Enter a name for the snippet.
Note: Snippet names can’t contain characters that are invalid in filenames, such as slashes(/ or \), special characters, or
double quotes (“).
3(Optional) Enter a text description of the snippet. This makes it easier for other team members to use the snippet.
4(Optional) Select a Preview Type: Code or Design.
Design Renders the code and displays it in the Preview pane of the Snippets panel.
Code Displays the code in the Preview pane.
5Click OK.
Edit or delete a code snippet
In the Snippets panel, select a snippet, and click the Edit Snippet button or the Remove button at the bottom of the
panel.
Create code snippet folders and manage code snippets
1In the Snippets panel, click the New Snippet Folder button at the bottom of the panel.
2Drag snippets to the new folder or other folders, as desired.
Add or edit a keyboard shortcut for a snippet
1In the Snippets panel, right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) and select Edit Keyboard Shortcuts.
The Keyboard Shortcuts Editor appears.
385
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
2In the Commands pop-up menu, select Snippets.
A list of snippets appears.
3Select a snippet and assign a keyboard shortcut to it.
For more information, see Customize keyboard shortcuts.
Share a snippet with other members of your team
1Find the file corresponding to the snippet that you want to share in the Configuration/Snippets folder in the
Dreamweaver application folder.
2Copy the snippet file to a shared folder on your computer or a network computer.
3Have the other members of the team copy the snippet file to their Configuration/Snippets folder.
Search for tags, attributes, or text in code
You can search for specific tags, attributes, and attribute values. For example, you can search for all img tags that have
no alt attribute.
You can also search for specific text strings that are within or not within a set of container tags. For example, you can
search for the word Untitled contained in a title tag to find all the untitled pages on your site.
1Open the document to search in, or select documents or a folder in the Files panel.
2Select Edit > Find And Replace.
3Specify which files to search in, and then specify the kind of search to perform, and text or tags to search for.
Optionally, specify replacement text as well. Then click one of the Find buttons or one of the Replace buttons.
4Click the Close button.
5To search again without displaying the Find And Replace dialog box, press F3 (Windows) or Command+G
(Macintosh).
Save and recall search patterns
You can save search patterns and reuse them later.
Save a search pattern
1In the Find And Replace dialog box (Edit > Find And Replace), set the parameters for the search.
2Click the Save Query button (the disk icon).
3In the dialog box that appears, navigate to the folder where you want to save queries. Then type a filename that
identifies the query, and click Save.
For example, if the search pattern involves looking for img tags with no alt attribute, you might name the query
img_no_alt.dwr.
Note: Saved queries have the filename extension .dwr. Some saved queries from older versions of Dreamweaver may
have the extension .dwq.
Recall a search pattern
1Select Edit > Find And Replace.
2Click the Load Query button (the folder icon).
386
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
3Navigate to the folder where your queries are saved. Then select a query file and click Open.
4Click Find Next, Find All, Replace, or Replace All to initiate the search.
Use language-reference material
The Reference panel provides you with a quick reference tool for markup languages, programming languages, and CSS
styles. It provides information on the specific tags, objects, and styles that you are working with in Code view (or the
Code inspector). The Reference panel also provides example code that you can paste into your documents.
Open the Reference panel
1Do one of the following in Code view:
Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) a tag, attribute, or keyword, and then select Reference from
the context menu.
Place the insertion point in a tag, attribute, or keyword, and then press Shift+F1.
The Reference panel opens and displays information about the tag, attribute, or keyword you clicked.
2To adjust the text size in the Reference panel, select Large Font, Medium Font, or Small Font from the options menu
(the small arrow at the upper right of the panel).
Paste example code into your document
1Click anywhere in example code in the reference content.
The entire code example is highlighted.
2Select Edit > Copy, and then paste the example code into your document in Code view.
Browse the reference content in the Reference panel
1To display tags, objects, or styles from another book, select a different book from the Book pop-up menu.
2To view information about a specific item, select it from the Tag, Object, Style, or CFML pop-up menu (depending
on which book you selected).
3To view information about an attribute of the selected item, select the attribute from the pop-up menu next to the
Tag, Object, Style, or CFML pop-up menu.
This menu contains the list of attributes for the item you select. The default selection is Description, which displays
a description of the chosen item.
387
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
Print code
You can print your code to edit it offline, archive it, or distribute it.
1Open a page in Code view.
2Select File > Print Code.
3Specify printing options, and then click OK (Windows) or Print (Macintosh).
Video tutorial
How to code HTML5 and CSS faster (30 min)
Build the structure of a tile-based web page using tag highlighting, line number highlighting, CSS selector code hinting,
and code completion.
More Help topics
Use the hints menu in the Quick Tag Editor
W3C Document Object Model
Code hinting tutorial
Verify tags and braces are balanced
Coding toolbar overview
Display toolbars
Use the Insert panel
About Dreamweaver tag libraries
Copy and move collapsed code fragments
Collapse and expand code fragments
Set up your computer for application development
Open Related Files
Code Navigator tutorial
Building Spry pages visually
Regular expressions
Search for and replace text
Regular expressions
Search for and replace text
Collapsing code
You can collapse and expand code fragments so that you can view different sections of your document without having
to use the scroll bar. For example, to see all of the CSS rules in the head tag that apply to a div tag farther down the page,
you can fold all the code between the head tag and the div tag so that you can see both sections of code at once.
388
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
You can collapse code in HTML, PHP, XML, and SVG files based on tag blocks. In CSS, LESS, Sass, SCSS, and JS files,
you can collapse code based on curly braces.
HTML files: The code between an opening and closing HTML tag is collapsed and the initial attributes, wherever
applicable, are displayed in the collapsed code. The collapsed code block is auto expanded when the code within the
block receives focus through Tag Selector, Find & Replace, Go To Line, Element Quick View, Live View, or
Undo/Redo. Once the selection in these features changes, the code is automatically collapsed back again.
CSS, LESS, SASS, SCSS, and JS files: Code within curly brackets is collapsed and the preview is displayed as {...}.
PHP files: HTML elements, CSS, and JS code blocks are collapsed in addition to PHP code blocks. You can collapse
any PHP code block that begins with <?php and ends with ?>.
Note: Files created from Dreamweaver templates display all code as fully expanded, even if the template file (.dwt) contains
collapsed code fragments.
Collapse and expand code fragments
By default, all the code in Code view is in expanded mode. You can specify the minimum number of lines for code
folding in Preferences.
Note: The collapsed or expanded states of code blocks are retained across Dreamweaver sessions.
1In Code view, hover your mouse over the line number column that corresponds to the code block you want to
collapse or expand . A small triangle appears next to the line numbers.
2Click the triangle to collapse or expand the code.
To expand all the collapsed code in the document, you can use the keyboard shortcut Control+Alt+E (Win);
Command+Alt+E (Mac).
Copy and move collapsed code fragments
You can copy and paste collapsed code fragments in the same document, or in other documents and applications. You
can also move collapsed code fragments by dragging them in Code view.
Copy and paste a collapsed code fragment
1Click the collapsed code fragment to select it.
2Select Edit > Copy.
3Place the cursor at the point where you want to paste the code.
4Select Edit > Paste.
Drag a collapsed code fragment
1Click the collapsed code fragment to select it.
2Drag the selection to the new location.
To drag a copy of the selection, Control-drag (Windows) or Alt-drag (Macintosh).
Note: You cannot drag code fragments to other documents.
389
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
Specify the code folding size
The default code folding size is two lines. This means, when you collapse code, all the code fragments that have at least
two lines of code are collapsed. Code fragments that are lesser than two lines are displayed in the expanded mode.
You can change the minimum number of lines for code folding in Preferences.
1Click Edit > Preferences (Win) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Mac).
2Click Code Format in the Category list and specify the minimum code folding size.
Lint code
Whether you are a rookie or an experienced coder, there are always chances of errors creeping in to your code
inadvertently or due to lack of knowledge. When the web page or even a portion of it doesn't look like what you
expected, you are forced to debug code to find any syntax or logical errors. Debugging can be an extremely strenuous
and a time-consuming process especially in cases of complex implementations.
Dreamweaver makes debugging code for common errors simple and easy with the help of linting. Linting is the process
of analyzing code to flag potential errors or suspicious usage of code. HTML syntax errors, parsing errors in CSS, or
warnings in JavaScript files are some of the things flagged by linting in Dreamweaver.
The errors and warnings found are listed in a separate (Output) panel docked at the bottom of the workspace. Each line
in the panel helps you jump to the portion of the code where the error has occurred, making it easy to find and fix the
code. Also, the line numbers of the erroneous code are highlighted in red for errors and yellow for warnings. When you
hover your mouse over the highlighted line numbers, a preview of the error or warning pops-up.
You can lint HTML, CSS, and JavaScript files in Dreamweaver using the following process:
1Specify linting rules by editing the HTML, CSS, and JS configuration files. See Specify linting rules for more
information.
2Enable linting and specify when the linting should be triggered. You can lint files when they are loaded, saved, or
edited. See Enable linting and set preferences for more information.
Errors and warnings found in the files are displayed in the output panel. For more information, see Linting results and
the Output panel .
Enable linting and set preferences
Click Edit > Preferences (Win) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Mac). Select Linting in the Category list.
Select Enable Linting.
Specify one or more triggers for linting. You can trigger linting when the file gets loaded, saved, and/or edited.
Specify linting rules
You can lint HTML, CSS, and JS files by editing the linting rules in the corresponding configuration files:
HTML: DW.htmlhintrc
CSS: DW.csslintrc
JS: DW.jshintrc
390
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
To access and edit these files, perform the following steps:
1Click Edit > Preferences (Win) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Mac).
2Select Linting in the Category list.
3In the Edit Rule Set section, click the required file type and click Edit & Apply Changes.
The corresponding configuration file opens in Dreamweaver.
4Edit or add linting rules to the configuration files. Refer to the following documentation for more information on
linting rules:
HTML Linter: https://github.com/yaniswang/HTMLHint/wiki/Rules
CSS Linter: https://github.com/CSSLint/csslint/wiki/Rules
JS Linter: http://jshint.com/docs/options/
In these configuration files, you can also set the type of errors or warnings to be displayed. In JS configuration files,
you can also set the maximum number of errors to be found.
Linting results and the Output panel
The linting results - errors and warnings - are listed in the Output panel. The Output panel is available in the docked
mode at the bottom of all default workspaces. If the Output panel is closed, you can open it by performing one of the
following actions:
By clicking the linting status icon in the Document window status bar
Using the keyboard shortcut, Shift+F6
Using Window > Results > Output
The linting icon in the Status bar indicates the linting results:
Red - The current document has errors and warnings
Yellow - The current document has warnings only
Green - The current document has no errors
You can use the linting icon in the Status bar to also toggle the Output panel (open/close) if the icon is red or yellow (not
green).
391
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
The lines that contain the errors or warnings are highlighted in red and yellow respectively. You can double click a
message in the Output panel to jump to the line where the error has occurred. In Code view, you can also hover your
mouse over the line numbers of the erroneous lines to see a preview of the error or warning.
The Output panel lists 50 messages at a time with the errors listed before warnings. As and when you fix the errors, the
list in the panel scrolls to display the next set of error.
Optimize code
Clean up code
You can automatically remove empty tags, combine nested font tags, and otherwise improve messy or unreadable
HTML or XHTML code.
For information on how to clean up HTML generated from a Microsoft Word document, see Open and edit existing
documents.
1Open a document:
If the document is in HTML, select Commands > Clean Up HTML.
If the document is in XHTML, select Commands > Clean Up XHTML.
For an XHTML document, the Clean Up XHTML command fixes XHTML syntax errors, sets the case of tag
attributes to lowercase, and adds or reports the missing required attributes for a tag in addition to performing
the HTML cleanup operations.
2In the dialog box that appears, select any of the options, and click OK.
Note: Depending on the size of your document and the number of options selected, it may take several seconds to
complete the cleanup.
Remove Empty Container Tags Removes any tags that have no content between them. For example, <b></b> and
<font color="#FF0000"></font> are empty tags, but the <b> tag in <b>some text</b> is not.
Remove Redundant Nested Tags Removes all redundant instances of a tag. For example, in the code <b>This is
what I <b>really</b> wanted to say</b>, the b tags surrounding the word really are redundant and would be
removed.
Remove Non-Dreamweaver HTML Comments Removes all comments that were not inserted by Dreamweaver. For
example, <!--begin body text--> would be removed, but <!--TemplateBeginEditable name="doctitle”--> wouldn’t,
because its a Dreamweaver comment that marks the beginning of an editable region in a template.
Remove Dreamweaver Special Markup Removes comments that Dreamweaver adds to code to allow documents to
be automatically updated when templates and library items are updated. If you select this option when cleaning up
code in a template-based document, the document is detached from the template. For more information, see Detach
a document from a template.
Remove Specific Tag(s) Removes the tags specified in the adjacent text box. Use this option to remove custom tags
inserted by other visual editors and other tags that you don’t want to appear on your site (for example, blink).
Separate multiple tags with commas (for example, font,blink).
392
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
Combine Nested <font> Tags When Possible Consolidates two or more font tags when they control the same range
of text. For example, <font size="7"><font color="#FF0000">big red</font></font> would be changed to <font
size="7" color="#FF0000">big red</font>.
Show Log On Completion Displays an alert box with details about the changes made to the document as soon as the
cleanup is finished.
Verify tags and braces are balanced
You can check to make sure the tags, parentheses (( )), braces ({ }), and square brackets ([ ]) in your page are balanced.
Balanced means that every opening tag, parenthesis, brace, or bracket has a corresponding closing one, and vice versa.
Check for balanced tags
1Open the document in Code view.
2Place the insertion point in the nested code you want to check.
3Select Edit > Select Parent Tag.
The enclosing matching tags (and their contents) are selected in your code. If you keep selecting Edit > Select Parent
Tag, and your tags are balanced, eventually Dreamweaver will select the outermost html and /html tags.
Check for balanced parentheses, braces, or square brackets
1Open the document in Code view.
2Place the insertion point in the code you want to check.
3Select Edit > Balance Braces.
All of the code between the enclosing parentheses, braces, or square brackets is selected. Choosing Edit > Balance
Braces again selects all of the code inside the parentheses, braces, or square brackets that enclose the new selection.
Check for browser compatibility
The Browser Compatibility Check (BCC) feature helps you locate combinations of HTML and CSS that can trigger
browser rendering bugs. This feature also tests the code in your documents for any CSS properties or values that are
unsupported by your target browsers.
Note: This feature replaces the former Target Browser Check feature, but retains the CSS functionality of that feature.
Validate XML documents
You can set preferences for the Validator, the specific problems that the Validator should check for, and the types of
errors that the Validator should report.
1Do one of the following:
For an XML or XHTML file, select File > Validate > As XML.
The Validation tab of the Results panel displays a “No errors or warnings” message or lists the syntax errors it
found.
2Double-click an error message to highlight the error in the document.
3To save the report as an XML file, click the Save Report button.
4To view the report in your primary browser (which lets you print the report), click the Browse Report button.
393
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
Validate documents using W3C validator
Dreamweaver helps you create standards-compliant web pages with its in-built support for the W3C validator. The
W3C validator validates your HTML documents for conformance to HTML or XHTML standards. You can validate
both open documents, and files posted on a live server.
Use the report that is generated after validation to fix errors in your file.
Validate an open document
1Select Window > Results > Validation to open the Validation panel. This panel displays the results of the validation.
2Select File > Validate > Validate Current Document (W3C).
Validate a live document
For live documents, Dreamweaver validates code received by the browser. This code is displayed when you right-click
in your browser, and choose the option to view the source code. Validating live documents is especially useful when
validating dynamic pages using PHP, JSP, and so on.
The Validate Live Document option is enabled only when the URL of the page being validated begins with http.
1Select Window > Results > Validation to open the Validation panel. This panel displays the results of the validation.
2Click Live View.
3Select File > Validate > Validate Live Document (W3C).
For live documents, when you double-click an error in the W3C validation panel, a separate window opens. The
window displays the browser-generated code, and the line with the error is highlighted.
Customize validation settings
1Select Window > Results > Validation to open the Validation panel.
2In the W3C Validation panel, click the W3C Validation (Play) icon. Select Settings.
3Select a DOCTYPE for validation if a DOCTYPE has not been explicitly specified for the document.
4If you do not want errors and warnings displayed, clear the options.
5Click Manage if you want to delete any warnings or errors that you have hidden using the W3C Validation panel.
When you remove warnings and errors, they are not displayed when you select Show All in the W3C validation
panel.
6Select Don't Show W3C Validator Notification Dialog if you do not want the W3C Validator Notification dialog
displayed when you begin validation.
Working with validation reports
After validation is complete, the validation reports are displayed in the W3C Validation panel.
For more information on the error or warning, select the error/warning in the W3C Validation panel. Click More
Info.
To save the report as an XML file, click Save Report.
To view the entire report in HTML, click Browse Report. The HTML report provides the complete list of errors and
warnings along with a summary.
To jump to the location in the code containing the error, select the error in the W3C Validation panel. Click the
Options button, and select Go to Line.
394
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
To hide errors/warnings, select the error/warning. Click the Options button, and select Hide Error.
To view all the errors and warnings, including the hidden errors, click the Options button. Select Show All. Any
hidden errors and warnings you deleted in the Preferences dialog are not listed.
To clear all the results in the W3C validation panel, click the Options button. Select Clear Results.
Set Validator preferences
The Validate tags feature has been deprecated as of Dreamweaver CS5. However, Dreamweaver still supports external
code validators that you install as extensions. When you install an external validator extension, Dreamweaver lists its
preferences in the Validator category of the Preferences dialog box.
1Select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh).
2Select W3C Validator from the Category list on the left.
3Select tag libraries to validate against.
You can’t select multiple versions of the same tag library or language; for example, if you select HTML 4.0, you cant
also select HTML 3.2 or HTML 2.0. Select the earliest version you want to validate against; for example, if a
document contains valid HTML 2.0 code, it will also be valid HTML 4.0 code.
4Select Display options for the types of errors and warnings that you want the Validator report to include.
5Click Apply to apply the changs, and click Close to close the Preferences dialog box.
Make pages XHTML-compliant
When you create a page, you can make it XHTML-compliant. You can also make an existing HTML document
XHTML-compliant.
Create XHTML-compliant documents
1Select File > New.
2Select a category and type of page to create.
3Select one of the XHTML document type definitions (DTD) from the DocType pop-up menu on the far right of the
dialog box, and click Create.
For example, you can make an HTML document XHTML-compliant by selecting XHTML 1.0 Transitional or
XHTML 1.0 Strict from the pop-up menu.
Note: Not all document types can be made XHTML-compliant.
Create XHTML-compliant documents by default
1Select Edit > Preferences or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Mac OS X), and select the New Document category.
2Select a default document and select one of the XHTML document type definitions from the Default Document
Type (DTD) pop-up menu, and click OK.
For example, you can make an HTML document XHTML-compliant by selecting XHTML 1.0 Transitional or
XHTML 1.0 Strict from the pop-up menu.
395
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
Make an existing HTML document XHTML-compliant
1Open a document, and do one of the following:
For a document without frames, select File > Convert, and then select one of the XHTML document type
definitions.
For example, you can make an HTML document XHTML-compliant by selecting XHTML 1.0 Transitional or
XHTML 1.0 Strict from the pop-up menu.
For a document with frames, select a frame and select File > Convert, and then select one of the XHTML
document type definitions.
2To convert the whole document, repeat this step for every frame and the frameset document.
Note: You can’t convert an instance of a template, because it must be in the same language as the template on which it’s
based. For example, a document based on an XHTML template will always be in XHTML, and a document based on a
non-XHTML-compliant HTML template will always be HTML and can’t be converted to XHTML or any other language.
More Help topics
Change the code format
Set the color theme for Code View
Check for cross-browser CSS rendering issues
XHTML code
Using ColdFusion components
Editing code in Design view
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About editing code in Design view
Dreamweaver lets you visually create and edit web pages without worrying about the underlying source code, but there
are times when you might need to edit the code for greater control or to troubleshoot your web page. Dreamweaver lets
you edit some code while working in Design view.
This section is designed for people who prefer to work in Design view, but who also want quick access to the code.
Selecting child tags in Design view
If you select an object in Design view that contains child tags—for example, an HTML table—you can quickly select
the first child tag of that object by selecting Edit > Select Child.
Note: This command is only enabled in Design view.
For example, the <table> tag normally has <tr> child tags. If you select a <table> tag in the tag selector, you can select
the first row in the table by selecting Edit > Select Child. Dreamweaver selects the first <tr> tag in the tag selector. Since
the <tr> tag itself has child tags, namely <td> tags, selecting Edit > Select Child again selects the first cell in the table.
396
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
Edit code with the Property inspector
You can use the Property inspector to inspect and edit the attributes of text or of objects on your page. The properties
shown in the Property inspector generally correspond to attributes of tags; changing a property in the Property
inspector generally has the same effect as changing the corresponding attribute in Code view.
Note: The Tag inspector and the Property inspector both let you view and edit a tag’s attributes. The Tag inspector lets you
to view and edit every attribute associated with a given tag. The Property inspector shows only the most common attributes,
but provides a richer set of controls for changing those attributes values, and lets you edit certain objects (such as table
columns) that don’t correspond to specific tags.
1Click in the text or select an object on the page.
The Property inspector for the text or object appears below the Document window. If the Property inspector is not
visible, select Window > Properties.
2Make changes to the attributes in the Property inspector.
Edit CFML with the Property inspector
Use the Property inspector to inspect and modify ColdFusion markup in Design view.
1In the Property inspector, click the Attributes button to edit the tags attributes or to add new ones.
2If the tag holds content between its opening and closing tags, click the Content button to edit the content.
The Content button appears only if the selected tag is not an empty tag (that is, if it has both an opening and a closing
tag).
3If the tag contains a conditional expression, make changes to it in the Expression box.
Change attributes with the Tag inspector
Use the Tag inspector to edit or add attributes and attributes’ values. The Tag inspector lets you edit tags and objects by
using a property sheet similar to the ones found in other integrated development environments (IDEs).
1Do one of the following in the Document window:
In Code view (or the Code inspector), click anywhere in a tag’s name or in its contents.
In Design view, select an object, or select a tag in the Tag Selector.
2Open the Tag inspector (Window > Tag Inspector), and select the Attributes tab.
The selections attributes and their current values appear in the Tag inspector.
3Do any of the following in the Tag inspector:
To view the attributes organized by category, click the Show Category View button .
To view the attributes in an alphabetical list, click the Show List View button .
To change the attributes value, select the value and edit it.
To add a value for an attribute with no value, click in the attribute-value column to the right of the attribute and
add a value.
If the attribute takes pre-defined values, select a value from the pop-up menu (or the color picker) to the right of
the attribute-value column.
If the attribute takes a URL value, click the Browse button or use the Point-To-File icon to select a file, or type
the URL in the box.
397
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
If the attribute takes a value from a source of dynamic content (such as a database), click the Dynamic Data
button to the right of the attribute-value column. Then select a source.
To delete the attributes value, select the value and press Backspace (Windows) or Delete (Macintosh).
To change the name of an attribute, select the attribute name and edit it.
Note: If you change the name of a standard attribute and then add a value for that attribute, the attribute and its new
value move to the appropriate category.
To add a new attribute not already listed, click in the empty space below the last listed attribute name and type a
new attribute name.
4Press Enter (Windows) or Return (Macintosh), or click elsewhere in the Tag inspector, to update the tag in your
document.
Quick Tag Editor overview
You use the Quick Tag Editor to quickly inspect, insert, and edit HTML tags without leaving Design view.
If you type invalid HTML in the Quick Tag Editor, Dreamweaver attempts to correct it for you by inserting closing
quotation marks and closing angle brackets where needed.
To set the Quick Tag Editor options, open the Quick Tag Editor by pressing Control-T (Windows) or Command-T
(Macintosh).
The Quick Tag Editor has three modes:
Insert HTML mode is used to insert new HTML code.
Edit Tag mode is used to edit an existing tag.
Insert HTML mode is used to insert new HTML code.
Edit Tag mode is used to edit an existing tag.
Wrap Tag mode is to wrap a new tag around the current selection.
Note: The mode in which the Quick Tag Editor opens depends on the current selection in Design view.
In all three modes, the basic procedure for using the Quick Tag Editor is the same: open the editor, enter or edit tags
and attributes, and then close the editor.
You can cycle through the modes by pressing Control+T (Windows) or Command+T (Macintosh) while the Quick Tag
Editor is active.
Edit code with the Quick Tag Editor
Use the Quick Tag Editor to quickly insert and edit HTML tags without leaving Design view.
Insert an HTML tag
1In Design view, click in the page to place the insertion point where you want to insert code.
2Press Control+T (Windows) or Command+T (Macintosh).
The Quick Tag Editor opens in Insert HTML mode.
398
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
3Enter the HTML tag and press Enter.
The tag is inserted into your code, along with a matching closing tag if applicable.
4Press Escape to exit without making any changes.
Edit an HTML tag
1Select an object in Design view.
You can also select the tag you want to edit from the tag selector at the bottom of the Document window. For more
information, see Edit code with the tag selector.
2Press Control+T (Windows) or Command+T (Macintosh).
The Quick Tag Editor opens in Edit Tag mode.
3Enter new attributes, edit existing attributes, or edit the tag’s name.
4Press Tab to move forward from one attribute to the next; press Shift+Tab to move back.
Note: By default, changes are applied to the document when you press Tab or Shift+Tab.
5To close the Quick Tag Editor and apply all the changes, press Enter.
6To exit without making any further changes, press Escape.
Wrap the current selection with HTML tags
1Select unformatted text or an object in Design view.
Note: If you select text or an object that includes an opening or closing HTML tag, the Quick Tag Editor opens in Edit
Tag mode instead of Wrap Tag mode.
2Press Control+T (Windows) or Command+T (Macintosh), or click the Quick Tag Editor button in the Property
inspector.
The Quick Tag Editor opens in Wrap Tag mode.
3Enter a single opening tag, such as strong, and press Enter (Windows) or Return (Macintosh).
The tag is inserted at the beginning of the current selection, and a matching closing tag is inserted at the end.
4To exit without making any changes, press Escape.
Use the hints menu in the Quick Tag Editor
The Quick Tag Editor includes an attributes hint menu that lists all the valid attributes of the tag you are editing or
inserting.
You can also disable the hints menu or adjust the delay before the menu pops up in the Quick Tag Editor.
To see a hints menu that lists valid attributes for a tag, pause briefly while editing an attribute name in the Quick Tag
Editor. A hints menu appears, listing all the valid attributes for the tag youre editing.
Similarly, to see a hints menu listing valid tag names, pause briefly while entering or editing a tag name in the Quick
Tag Editor.
Note: The Quick Tag Editor code hints preferences are controlled by the normal code hints preferences. For more
information, see Set code hints preferences.
399
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
Use a hints menu
1Do one of the following:
Begin to type a tag or attribute name. The selection in the Code Hints menu jumps to the first item that starts
with the letters you typed.
Use the Up and Down Arrow keys to select an item.
Use the scroll bar to find an item.
2Press Enter to insert the selected item, or double-click an item to insert it.
3To close the hints menu without inserting an item, press Escape or continue typing.
Disable the hints menu or change the delay before it appears
1Select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh) and select Code Hints.
The Code Hints Preferences dialog box appears.
2To disable the hints menu, deselect the Enable Code Hints option.
3To change the delay before the menu appears, adjust the Delay slider, and click OK.
Edit code with the tag selector
You can use the tag selector to select, edit, or remove tags without leaving Design view. The tag selector is located in the
status bar at the bottom of the Document window and shows a series of tags, as follows:
Edit or delete a tag
1Click in the document.
The tags that apply at the insertion point appear in the tag selector.
2Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) a tag in the tag selector.
3To edit a tag, select Edit Tag from the menu. Make your changes in the Quick Tag Editor. For more information, see
Edit code with the Quick Tag Editor.
4To delete a tag, select Remove Tag from the menu.
Select an object corresponding to a tag
1Click in the document.
The tags that apply at the insertion point appear in the tag selector.
2Click a tag in the tag selector.
The object represented by the tag is selected on the page.
Use this technique to select individual table rows (tr tags) or cells (td tags).
Write and edit scripts in Design view
You can work with client-side JavaScripts and VBScripts in both Code and Design views, in the following ways:
Write a JavaScript or VBScript script for your page without leaving Design view.
400
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
Create a link in your document to an external script file without leaving Design view.
Edit a script without leaving Design view.
Before starting, select View > Visual Aids > Invisible Elements to ensure that script markers appear on the page.
Write a client-side script
1Place the insertion point where you want the script.
2Select Insert > HTML > Script Objects > Script.
3Select the scripting language from the Language pop-up menu.
If you are using JavaScript and are unsure of the version, select JavaScript rather than JavaScript1.1 or JavaScript1.2.
4Type or paste your script code into the Content box.
You don’t need to include the opening and closing script tags.
5Type or paste HTML code into the No Script box. Browsers that dont support the chosen scripting language display
this code instead of running the script.
6Click OK.
Link to an external script file
1Place the insertion point where you want the script.
2Select Insert > HTML > Script Objects > Script.
3Click OK without typing anything in the Content box.
4Select the script marker in Design view of the Document window.
5In the Property inspector, click the folder icon and browse to and select the external script file, or type the filename
in the Source box.
Edit a script
1Select the script marker.
2In the Property inspector, click the Edit button.
The script appears in the Script Properties dialog box.
If you linked to an external script file, the file opens in Code view, where you can make your edits.
Note: If there is code between the script tags, the Script Properties dialog box opens even if there is also a link to an
external script file.
3In the Language box, specify either JavaScript or VBScript as the language of the script.
4In the Type pop-up menu, specify the type of script, either client-side or server-side.
5(Optional) In the Source box, specify an externally linked script file.
Click the folder icon or the Browse button to select a file, or type the path.
6Edit the script, and click OK.
Edit ASP server-side scripts in Design view
Use the ASP script Property inspector to inspect and modify ASP server-side scripts in Design view.
1In Design view, select the server-language tag visual icon.
401
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
2In the ASP script Property inspector, click the Edit button.
3Edit the ASP server-side script, and click OK.
Edit scripts on the page by using the Property inspector
1In the Property inspector, select the scripting language from the Language pop-up menu, or type a language name
in the Language box.
Note: If you are using JavaScript and are unsure of the version, select JavaScript rather than JavaScript1.1 or
JavaScript1.2.
2In the Type pop-up menu, specify the type of script, either client-side or server-side.
3(Optional) In the Source box, specify an externally linked script file. Click the folder icon to select the file, or
type the path.
4Click Edit to modify the script.
Using JavaScript behaviors
You can easily attach JavaScript (client-side) behaviors to page elements by using the Behaviors tab of the Tag inspector.
For more information, see Applying built-in JavaScript behaviors.
More Help topics
Using JavaScript behaviors (general instructions)
Defining sources of dynamic content
Working with head content for pages
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Pages contain elements that describe the information on the page, which is used by search browsers. You can set the
properties of head elements to control how your pages are identified.
View and edit head content
You can view the elements in the head section of a document by using the View menu, the Document window’s Code
view, or the Code inspector.
View elements in the head section of a document
Select View > Head Content. For each element of the head content, a marker appears at the top of the Document
window in Design view.
Note: If your Document window is set to show only Code view, View > Head Content is dimmed.
Insert an element into the head section of a document
1Select an item from the Insert > HTML > Head Tags submenu.
2Enter options for the element in the dialog box that appears, or in the Property inspector.
402
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
Edit an element in the head section of a document
1Select View > Head Content.
2Click one of the icons in the head section to select it.
3Set or modify the properties of the element in the Property inspector.
Set the meta properties for the page
A meta tag is a head element that records information about the current page, such as the character encoding, author,
copyright, or keywords. These tags can also be used to give information to the server, such as the expiration date, refresh
interval, and POWDER rating for the page. (POWDER, the Protocol for Web Description Resources, provides a
method for assigning ratings, such as movie ratings, to web pages.)
Add a meta tag
1Select Insert > HTML > Head Tags > Meta.
2Specify the properties in the dialog box that appears.
Edit an existing meta tag
1Select View > Head Content.
2Select the Meta marker that appears at the top of the Document window.
3Specify the properties in the Property inspector.
Meta tag properties
Set the meta tag properties as follows:
Attribute Specifies whether the meta tag contains descriptive information about the page (name) or HTTP header
information (http-equiv).
Value Specifies the type of information you’re supplying in this tag. Some values, such as description, keywords, and
refresh, are already well defined (and have their own individual Property inspectors in Dreamweaver), but you can
specify practically any value (for example, creationdate, documentID, or level).
Content Specifies the actual information. For example, if you specified level for Value, you might specify beginner,
intermediate, or advanced for Content.
Set the page title
There is only one title property: the title of the page. The title appears in the title bar of the Document window in
Dreamweaver as well as in the browser’s title bar when you view the page in most browsers. The title also appears in the
Document window toolbar.
Specify the title in the Document window
Enter the title in the Title text box in the Document window toolbar.
Specify the title in the head content
1Select View > Head Content.
2Select the Title marker that appears at the top of the Document window.
3Specify the page title in the Property inspector.
403
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
Specify keywords for the page
Many search-engine robots (programs that automatically browse the web gathering information for search engines to
index) read the contents of the Keywords meta tag and use the information to index your pages in their databases.
Because some search engines limit the number of keywords or characters they index, or ignore all keywords if you go
beyond the limit, its a good idea to use just a few well-chosen keywords.
Add a Keywords meta tag
1Select Insert > HTML > Head Tags > Keywords.
2Specify the keywords, separated by commas, in the dialog box that appears.
Edit a Keywords meta tag
1Select View > Head Content.
2Select the Keywords marker that appears at the top of the Document window.
3In the Property inspector, view, modify, or delete keywords. You can also add keywords separated by commas.
Specify descriptions for the page
Many search-engine robots (programs that automatically browse the web gathering information for search engines to
index) read the contents of the Description meta tag. Some use the information to index your pages in their databases,
and some also display the information on the search results page (instead of displaying the first few lines of your
document). Some search engines limit the number of characters they index, so it’s a good idea to limit your description
to a few words (for example, Pork barbecue catering in Albany, Georgia, or Web design at reasonable rates for clients
worldwide).
Add a Description meta tag
1Select Insert > HTML > Head Tags > Description.
2Enter descriptive text in the dialog box that appears.
Edit a Description meta tag
1Select View > Head Content.
2Select the Description marker that appears at the top of the Document window.
3In the Property inspector, view, modify, or delete the descriptive text.
Set the refresh properties of the page
Use the Refresh element to specify that the browser should automatically refresh your page—by reloading the current
page or going to a different one—after a certain amount of time. This element is often used to redirect users from one
URL to another, often after displaying a text message that the URL has changed.
Add a Refresh meta tag
1Select Insert > HTML > Head Tags > Refresh.
2Set the Refresh meta tag properties in the dialog box that appears.
Edit a Refresh meta tag
1Select View > Head Content.
404
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
2Select the Refresh marker that appears at the top of the Document window.
3In the Property inspector, set the Refresh meta tag properties.
Set the Refresh meta tag properties
Specify the Refresh meta tag properties as follows:
Delay The time in seconds to wait before the browser refreshes the page. To make the browser refresh the page
immediately after it finishes loading, enter 0 in this box.
URL or Action Specifies whether the browser should go to a different URL or refresh the current page, after the
specified delay. To make a different URL open (rather than refreshing the current page), click the Browse button,
then browse to and select the page to load.
Set the base URL properties of the page
Use the Base element to set the base URL that all document-relative paths in the page are considered relative to.
Add a Base meta tag
1Select Insert > HTML > Head Tags > Base.
2Specify the Base meta tag properties in the dialog box that appears.
Edit a Base meta tag
1Select View > Head Content.
2Select the Base marker that appears at the top of the Document window.
3In the Property inspector, specify the Base meta tag properties.
Specify the Base meta tag properties
Specify the Base meta tag properties as follows:
Href The base URL. Click the Browse button to browse to and select a file, or type a path in the box.
Target Specifies the frame or window in which all linked documents should open. Select one of the frames in the
current frameset, or one of the following reserved names:
_blank loads the linked document in a new, unnamed browser window.
_parent loads the linked document into the parent frameset or window of the frame that contains the link. If the
frame containing the link is not nested, then this is equivalent to _top; the linked document loads into the full
browser window.
_self loads the linked document in the same frame or window as the link. This target is the default, so you usually
don’t have to specify it.
_top loads the linked document in the full browser window, thereby removing all frames.
Set the link properties of the page
Use the link tag to define a relationship between the current document and another file.
Note: The link tag in the head section is not the same thing as an HTML link between documents in the body section.
405
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
Add a Link meta tag
1Select Insert > HTML > Head Tags > Link.
2Specify the Link meta tag properties in the dialog box that appears.
Edit a Link meta tag
1Select View > Head Content.
2Select the Link marker that appears at the top of the Document window.
3In the Property inspector, specify the Link meta tag properties.
Specify the Link meta tag properties
Set the Link meta tag properties as follows:
Href The URL of the file that you are defining a relationship to. Click the Browse button to browse to and select a
file, or type a path in the box. Note that this attribute does not indicate a file that youre linking to in the usual HTML
sense; the relationships specified in a Link element are more complex.
ID Specifies a unique identifier for the link.
Title Describes the relationship. This attribute has special relevance for linked style sheets; for more information,
see the External Style Sheets section of the HTML 4.0 specification on the World Wide Web Consortium website at
www.w3.org/TR/REC-html40/present/styles.html#style-external.
Rel Specifies the relationship between the current document and the document in the Href box. Possible values
include Alternate, Stylesheet, Start, Next, Prev, Contents, Index, Glossary, Copyright, Chapter, Section, Subsection,
Appendix, Help, and Bookmark. To specify more than one relationship, separate values with a space.
Rev Specifies a reverse relationship (the opposite of Rel) between the current document and the document in the
Href box. Possible values are the same as those for Rel.
Working with server-side includes
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About server-side includes
You can use Dreamweaver to insert server-side includes in your pages, edit the includes, or preview pages containing
includes.
A server-side include is a file that the server incorporates into your document when a browser requests your document
from the server.
When a visitors browser requests the document that contains the include instruction, your server processes the include
instruction and creates a new document in which the include instruction is replaced by the contents of the included
file. The server then sends this new document to the visitor’s browser. When you open a local document directly in a
browser, however, theres no server to process the include instructions in that document, so the browser opens the
document without processing those instructions, and the file thats supposed to be included doesn’t appear in the
browser. Thus, it can be difficult, without using Dreamweaver, to look at local files and see them as they’ll appear to
visitors after you’ve put them on the server.
406
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
With Dreamweaver you can preview documents just as they’ll appear after they’re on the server, both in the Design view
and when you use the Preview in Browser feature. To do so, however, you must make sure you are previewing the file
that contains the include as a temporary file. (Select Edit > Preferences, select the Preview in Browser category, and
make sure the Preview using temporary file option is selected.)
Note: If you are using a testing server, such as Apache or Microsoft IIS, to preview your files on your local drive, you do not
need to preview the file as a temporary file because the server does the processing for you.
Placing a server-side include in a document inserts a reference to an external file; it doesnt insert the contents of the
specified file in the current document. The contents of the specified file should only contain the content that you want
to include. That is, the include file should not contain any head tags, body tags, or html tags (meaning the <html> tag—
formatting HTML tags, such as p tags, div tags, and so on, are fine). If it does, these tags will conflict with the tags in
the original document, and Dreamweaver wont display the page properly.
You cannot edit the included file directly in a document. To edit the contents of a server-side include, you must directly
edit the file that youre including. Any changes to the external file are automatically reflected in every document that
includes it.
There are two types of server-side includes: Virtual and File. Dreamweaver inserts File type includes by default, but you
can use the Property inspector to select the one that is appropriate for the type of web server you use:
If your server is an Apache web server, select Virtual. In Apache, Virtual works in all cases, while File works only in
some cases.
If your server is a Microsoft Internet Information Server (IIS), select File. (Virtual works with IIS only in certain
circumstances.)
Note: Unfortunately, IIS won’t let you include a file in a folder above the current folder in the folder hierarchy, unless special
software has been installed on the server. If you must include a file from a folder higher in the folder hierarchy on an IIS
server, ask your system administrator if the necessary software is installed.
For other kinds of servers, or if you don’t know what kind of server youre using, ask your system administrator
which option to use.
Some servers are configured to examine all files to see if they contain server-side includes; other servers are
configured to examine only files with a particular file extension, such as .shtml, .shtm, or .inc. If a server-side include
isn’t working for you, ask your system administrator if you need to use a special extension in the name of the file
that uses the include. (For example, if the file is named canoe.html, you may have to rename it to canoe.shtml.) If
you want your files to retain .html or .htm extensions, ask your system administrator to configure the server to
examine all files (not just files with a certain extension) for server-side includes. Parsing a file for server-side
includes takes a little extra time, so pages that the server parses are served a little more slowly than other pages;
therefore, some system administrators won’t provide the option of parsing all files.
Insert server-side includes
You can use Dreamweaver to insert server-side includes in your page.
Insert a server-side include
1Select Insert > Server-Side Include.
2In the dialog box that appears, browse to and select a file.
By default, a File type of include is inserted.
407
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
3To change the type of the include, select the server-side include in the Document window and change the type in
the Property inspector (Window > Properties), as follows:
If your server is an Apache web server, select Virtual. In Apache, Virtual works in all cases, while File works only
in some cases.
If your server is a Microsoft Internet Information Server (IIS), select File. (Virtual works with IIS only in certain
specific circumstances.)
Note: Unfortunately, IIS won’t allow you to include a file in a folder above the current folder in the folder hierarchy,
unless special software has been installed on the server. If you need to include a file from a folder higher in the folder
hierarchy on an IIS server, ask your system administrator if the necessary software is installed.
For other kinds of servers, or if you don’t know what kind of server you’re using, ask your system administrator
which option to use.
Change which file is included
1Select the server-side include in the Document window.
2Open the Property inspector (Window > Properties).
3Do one of the following:
Click the folder icon and browse to and select a new file to include.
In the box, type the path and filename of the new file to include.
Edit the contents of server-side includes
You can use Dreamweaver to edit server-side includes. To edit the content associated with the included file, you must
open the file.
1Select the server-side include in either Design view or Code view, and click Edit in the Property inspector.
The included file opens in a new Document window.
2Edit the file, and then save it.
The changes are immediately reflected in the current document and in any subsequent document you open that
includes the file.
3Upload the include file to the remote site if necessary.
Managing tag libraries
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About Dreamweaver tag libraries
A tag library, in Dreamweaver, is a collection of tags of a particular type, along with information about how
Dreamweaver should format the tags. Tag libraries provide the information about tags that Dreamweaver uses for code
hints, target browser checks, the Tag Chooser, and other coding capabilities. Using the Tag Library editor, you can add
and delete tag libraries, tags, attributes, and attribute values; set properties for a tag library, including format (for easy
identification in the code); and edit tags and attributes.
408
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
Open and close the Tag Library editor
1Select Edit >Tag Libraries to open the Tag library editor.
The Tag Library Editor dialog box appears. (The options of this dialog box change depending on the selected tag.)
2Close the Tag Library editor in one of the following ways:
To save changes, click OK.
To close the editor without saving changes, click Cancel.
Note: When you click Cancel, all changes you’ve made in the Tag Library editor are discarded. If you deleted a tag or
tag library, it’s restored.
Add libraries, tags, and attributes
You can use the Tag Library editor to add tag libraries, tags, and attributes to the tag libraries in Dreamweaver.
Add a tag library
1In the Tag Library editor (Edit > Tag Libraries), click the Plus (+) button, and select New Tag Library.
2In the Library Name box, type a name (for example, Miscellaneous Tags), and click OK.
Add tags to a tag library
1In the Tag Library editor (Edit > Tag Libraries), click the Plus (+) button and select New Tags.
2Select Tag Library pop-up menu, and select a tag library.
3Type the name of the new tag. To add more than one tag, separate the tags’ names with a comma and a space (for
example: cfgraph, cfgraphdata).
4If the new tags have corresponding end tags (</...>), select Have Matching End Tags.
5Click OK.
Add attributes to a tag
1In the Tag Library editor (Edit > Tag Libraries), click the Plus (+) button and select New Attributes.
2In the Tag Library pop-up menu, select a tag library.
3In the Tag pop-up menu, select a tag.
4Type the name of the new attribute. To add more than one attribute, separate attributes’ names with a comma and a
space (for example: width, height).
5Click OK.
Edit libraries, tags, and attributes
Use the Tag Library editor to set properties for a tag library and edit tags and attributes in a library.
Set properties for a tag library
1In the Tag Librar y editor (Edit > Tag Libraries), select a tag library (not a tag) in the Tags list.
Note: The properties for tag libraries appear only when a tag library is selected. Tag libraries are represented by the top-
level folders in the Tags list; for example, the HTML Tags folder represents a tag library, while the abbr folder within the
HTML Tags folder represents a tag.
409
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
2In the Used In list, select every document type that should use the tag library.
The document types you select here determine which document types provide code hints for the given tag library.
For example, if the HTML option is not selected for a given tag library, code hints for that tag library don’t appear
in HTML files.
3(Optional) Enter the prefix for the tags in the Tag Prefix box.
Note: A prefix is used to identify a tag in the code as part of a particular tag library. Some tag libraries dont use prefixes.
4Click OK.
Edit a tag in a tag library
1In the Tag Library editor (Edit > Tag Libraries), expand a tag library in the Tags list and select a tag.
2Set any of the following Tag Format options:
Line Breaks Specifies where Dreamweaver inserts line breaks for a tag.
Contents Specifies how Dreamweaver inserts the contents of a tag; that is, if it applies line break, formatting, and
indentation rules to the content.
Case Specifies the case for a specific tag. Select from Default, Lowercase, Uppercase, or Mixed Case. If you select
Mixed Case, the Tag Name Mixed Case dialog box appears. Type the tag with the case Dreamweaver should use
when inserting it (for example, getProperty) and click OK.
Set Default Sets the default case for all tags. In the Default Tag Case dialog box that appears, select <UPPERCASE>
or <lowercase>, and click OK.
You might want to set your default case to be lowercase to comply with XML and XHTML standards.
Edit an attribute for a tag
1In the Tag Library editor (Edit > Tag Libraries), expand a tag library in the Tags box, expand a tag, and select a tag
attribute.
2In the Attribute Case pop-up menu, select the Default, Lowercase, Uppercase, or Mixed Case option.
If you select Mixed Case, the Attribute Name Mixed Case dialog box appears. Type the attribute with the case
Dreamweaver should use when inserting it (for example, onClick), and click OK.
Click the Set Default link to set the default case for all attribute names.
3In the Attribute Type pop-up menu, select the type of the attribute.
If you select Enumerated, type every allowed value for the attribute in the Values box. Separate the values with
commas, but no spaces. For example, the enumerated values of the showborder attribute of the cfchart tag are listed
as yes,no.
Delete libraries, tags, and attributes
1In the Tag Library editor (Edit > Tag Libraries), select a tag library, tag, or attribute in the Tags box.
2Click the Minus (–) button.
3Click OK to permanently delete the item.
The item is removed from the Tags box.
4Click OK to close the Tag Library editor and complete the deletion.
410
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
More Help topics
Importing custom tags into Dreamweaver
Setting coding preferences
Setting coding preferences
Importing custom tags into Dreamweaver
Setting coding preferences
Setting coding preferences
Importing custom tags into Dreamweaver
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About importing custom tags into Dreamweaver
You can import custom tags into Dreamweaver so that they become an integral part of the authoring environment. For
example, when you start typing an imported custom tag in Code view, a code hints menu appears, listing the tag’s
attributes and letting you select one.
Import tags from XML files
You can import tags from an XML Document Type Definition (DTD) file or a schema.
1Open the Tag Library editor (Edit > Tag Libraries).
2Click the Plus (+) button and select DTD Schema > Import XML DTD or Schema File.
3Enter the filename or URL of the DTD or schema file.
4Enter the prefix to be used with the tags.
Note: A prefix is used to identify a tag in the code as part of a particular tag library. Some tag libraries dont use prefixes.
5Click OK.
Import custom ASP.NET tags
You can import custom ASP.NET tags into Dreamweaver.
Before you begin, make sure that the custom tag is installed on the testing server defined in the Site Definition dialog
box (see Set up a testing server). Compiled tags (DLL files) must be placed in the site roots /bin folder. Noncompiled
tags (ASCX files) can reside in any virtual directory or subdirectory on the server. For more information, see the
Microsoft ASP.NET documentation.
1Open an ASP.NET page in Dreamweaver.
2Open the Tag Library editor (Edit > Tag Libraries).
3Click the Plus (+) button, select one of the following options, and click OK:
To import all the ASP.NET custom tags from the application server, select ASP.NET > Import All ASP.NET
Custom Tags.
411
Coding
Last updated 6/3/2015
To import only certain custom tags from the application server, select ASP.NET > Import Selected ASP.NET
Custom Tags. Control-click (Windows) or Command-click (Macintosh) tags from the list.
Import JSP tags from a file or server (web.xml)
Import a JSP tag library into Dreamweaver from a variety of file types or a JSP server.
1Open a JSP page in Dreamweaver.
2Open the Tag Library editor (Edit > Tag Libraries).
3Click the Plus (+) button, and select JSP > Import From File (*.tld, *.jar, *.zip), or JSP > Import from Server
(web.xml.)
4Click the Browse button or enter a filename for the file that contains the tag library.
5Enter a URI to identify the tag library.
The URI (Uniform Resource Identifier) often consists of the URL of the organization maintaining the tag library.
The URL is not used to view the organizations website; it is used to uniquely identify the tag library.
6(Optional) Enter the prefix to be used with the tags. Some tag libraries use a prefix to identify a tag in the code as
part of a particular tag library.
7Click OK.
Import JRun tags
If you use Adobe® JRun™, you can import your JRun tags into Dreamweaver.
1Open a JSP page in Dreamweaver.
2Open the Tag Library editor (Edit > Tag Libraries).
3Click the Plus (+) button and select JSP > Import JRun Server Tags From Folder.
4Enter a folder name for the folder that contains the JRun tags.
5Enter a URI to identify the tag library.
The URI (Uniform Resource Identifier) often consists of the URL of the organization maintaining the tag library.
The URL is not used to view the organizations website; it is used to uniquely identify the tag library.
6(Optional) Enter the prefix to be used with the tags. Some tag libraries use a prefix to identify a tag in the code as
part of a particular tag library.
7Click OK.
412
Last updated 6/3/2015
Chapter 11: Javascript
Using JavaScript behaviors (general instructions)
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About JavaScript behaviors
Adobe Dreamweaver behaviors place JavaScript code in documents so that visitors can change a web page in various
ways or initiate certain tasks. A behavior is a combination of an event and an action triggered by that event. In the
Behaviors panel, you add a behavior to a page by specifying an action and then specifying the event that triggers that
action.
Note: Behavior code is client-side JavaScript code; that is, it runs in browsers, not on servers.
Events are, effectively, messages generated by browsers indicating that a visitor to your page has done something. For
example, when a visitor moves the pointer over a link, the browser generates an onMouseOver event for that link; the
browser then checks whether it should call some JavaScript code (specified in the page being viewed) in response.
Different events are defined for different page elements; for example, in most browsers onMouseOver and onClick are
events associated with links, whereas onLoad is an event associated with images and with the body section of the
document.
An action is pre-written JavaScript code for performing a task, such as opening a browser window, showing or hiding
an AP element, playing a sound, or stopping an Adobe Shockwave movie. The actions provided with Dreamweaver
provide maximum cross-browser compatibility.
After you attach a behavior to a page element, the behavior calls the action (JavaScript code) associated with an event
whenever that event occurs for that element. (The events that you can use to trigger a given action vary from browser
to browser.) For example, if you attach the Popup Message action to a link and specify that it will be triggered by the
onMouseOver event, then your message pops up whenever someone places the pointer over that link.
A single event can trigger several different actions, and you can specify the order in which those actions occur.
Dreamweaver provides about two dozen actions; additional actions can be found on the Exchange website at
www.adobe.com/go/dreamweaver_exchange as well as on third-party developer sites. You can write your own actions
if you are proficient in JavaScript.
Note: The terms behavior and action are Dreamweaver terms, not HTML terms. From the browser’s point of view, an
action is just like any other piece of JavaScript code.
Behaviors panel overview
You use the Behaviors panel (Window > Behaviors) to attach behaviors to page elements (more specifically to tags) and
to modify parameters of previously attached behaviors.
413
Javascript
Last updated 6/3/2015
Behaviors that have already been attached to the currently selected page element appear in the behavior list (the main
area of the panel), listed alphabetically by event. If several actions are listed for the same event, they will be executed in
the order in which they appear on the list. If no behaviors appear in the behavior list, no behaviors have been attached
to the currently selected element.
The Behaviors panel has the following options:
Show Set Events Displays only those events that have been attached to the current document. Events are organized into
client-side and server-side categories. Each category’s events are in a collapsible list. Show Set Events is the default view.
Show All Events Displays an alphabetical list of all events for a given category.
Add Behavior (+) Displays a menu of actions that can be attached to the currently selected element. When you select
an action from this list, a dialog box appears in which you can specify parameters for the action. If all the actions are
dimmed, no events can be generated by the selected element.
Remove Event (–) Removes the selected event and action from the behavior list.
Up and down arrow buttons Move the selected action up or down in the behavior list for a particular event. You can
change the order of actions only for a particular event—for example, you can change the order in which several actions
occur for the onLoad event, but all the onLoad actions stay together in the behavior list. The arrow buttons are disabled
for actions that cant be moved up or down in the list.
Events Displays a pop-up menu, visible only when an event is selected, of all the events that can trigger the action (this
menu appears when you click the arrow button next to the selected event name). Different events appear depending on
the object selected. If the events you expect dont appear, make sure that the correct page element or tag is selected. (To
select a specific tag, use the tag selector at the lower-left corner of the Document window.)
Note: Event names in parentheses are available only for links; selecting one of these event names automatically adds a null
link to the selected page element, and attaches the behavior to that link instead of to the element itself. The null link is
specified as href="javascript:;" in the HTML code.
About events
Each browser provides a set of events that you can associate with the actions listed in the Behavior panels Actions (+)
menu. When a visitor to your web page interacts with the page—for example, by clicking an image—the browser
generates events; those events can be used to call JavaScript functions that perform an action. Dreamweaver supplies
many common actions that you can trigger with these events.
For names and descriptions of the events provided by each browser, see the Dreamweaver Support Center at
www.adobe.com/go/dreamweaver_support.
Different events appear in the Events menu depending on the selected object. To find out what events a given browser
supports for a given page element, insert the page element in your document and attach a behavior to it, then look at
the Events menu in the Behaviors panel. (By default, events are drawn from the HTML 4.01 events list, and are
supported by most modern browsers.) Events may be disabled (dimmed) if the relevant objects do not yet exist on the
page or if the selected object cannot receive events. If the expected events don’t appear, make sure the correct object is
selected.
If you’re attaching a behavior to an image, some events (such as onMouseOver) appear in parentheses. These events are
available only for links. When you select one of them, Dreamweaver wraps an <a> tag around the image to define a null
link. The null link is represented by javascript:; in the Property inspector’s Link box. You can change the link value if
you want to turn it into a real link to another page, but if you delete the JavaScript link without replacing it with another
link, you will remove the behavior.
414
Javascript
Last updated 6/3/2015
To see which tags you can use with a given event in a given browser, search for the event in one of the files in the
Dreamweaver/Configuration/Behaviors/Events folder.
Apply a behavior
You can attach behaviors to the entire document (that is, to the <body> tag) or to links, images, form elements, and
several other HTML elements.
The target browser you select determines which events are supported for a given element.
You can specify more than one action for each event. Actions occur in the order in which they’re listed in the Actions
column of the Behaviors panel, but you can change that order.
1Select an element on the page, such as an image or a link.
To attach a behavior to the entire page, click the <body> tag in the tag selector at the lower-left corner of the
Document window.
2Choose Window > Behaviors.
3Click the Plus (+) button and select an action from the Add Behavior menu.
Actions that are dimmed in the menu can’t be chosen. They may be dimmed because a required object doesnt exist
in the current document. For example, the Control Shockwave or SWF action is dimmed if the document contains
no Shockwave or SWF files.
When you select an action, a dialog box appears, displaying parameters and instructions for the action.
4Enter parameters for the action, and click OK.
All actions provided in Dreamweaver work in modern browsers. Some actions do not work in older browsers, but
they will not cause errors.
Note: Targeted elements require a unique ID. For example, if you want to apply the Swap Image behavior to an image,
the image requires an ID. If you don’t have an ID specified for the element, Dreamweaver automatically specifies one
for you.
5The default event to trigger the action appears in the Events column. If this is not the trigger event you want, select
another event from the Events pop-up menu. (To open the Events menu, select an event or action in the Behaviors
panel, and click the downward-pointing black arrow that appears between the event name and the action name.)
Change or delete a behavior
After attaching a behavior, you can change the event that triggers the action, add or remove actions, and change
parameters for actions.
1Select an object with a behavior attached.
2Choose Window > Behaviors.
3Make your changes:
To edit an actions parameters, double-click its name, or select it and press Enter (Windows) or Return
(Macintosh); then change parameters in the dialog box and click OK.
To change the order of actions for a given event, select an action and click the Up or Down arrow. Alternatively,
you can select the action and cut and paste it into the desired location among the other actions.
To delete a behavior, select it and click the Minus (–) button or press Delete.
415
Javascript
Last updated 6/3/2015
Update a behavior
1Select an element that has the behavior attached to it.
2Choose Window > Behaviors and double-click the behavior.
3Make your changes and click OK in the behavior’s dialog box.
All occurrences of that behavior in that page are updated. If other pages on your site have that behavior, you must
update them page by page.
Download and install third-party behaviors
Many extensions are available on the Exchange for Dreamweaver website
(www.adobe.com/go/dreamweaver_exchange).
1Choose Window > Behaviors and select Get More Behaviors from the Add Behavior menu.
Your primary browser opens, and the Exchange site appears.
2Browse or search for packages.
3Download and install the extension package you want.
For more information, see Add and manage extensions in Dreamweaver .
Applying built-in JavaScript behaviors
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Using built-in behaviors
The behaviors included with Dreamweaver have been written to work in modern browsers. The behaviors fail silently
in older browsers.
Note: The Dreamweaver actions have been carefully written to work in as many browsers as possible. If you remove code
from a Dreamweaver action by hand, or replace it with your own code, you may lose cross-browser compatibility.
Although the Dreamweaver actions were written to maximize cross-browser compatibility, some browsers do not
support JavaScript at all, and many people who browse the web keep JavaScript turned off in their browsers. For best
cross-platform results, provide alternative interfaces enclosed in <noscript> tags so that people without JavaScript can
use your site.
Apply the Call JavaScript behavior
The Call JavaScript behavior executes a custom function or line of JavaScript code when an event occurs. (You can write
the script yourself, or you can use code provided by various freely available JavaScript libraries on the web.)
1Select an object and choose Call JavaScript from the Add Behavior menu of the Behaviors panel.
2Type the exact JavaScript to be executed, or type the name of a function.
For example, to create a Back button, you might type if (history.length > 0){history.back()}. If you have encapsulated
your code in a function, type only the function name (for example, hGoBack()).
3Click OK and verify that the default event is correct.
416
Javascript
Last updated 6/3/2015
Apply the Change Property behavior
Use the Change Property behavior to change the value of one of an object’s properties (for example, the background
color of a div or the action of a form).
Note: Use this behavior only if you are very familiar with HTML and JavaScript.
1Select an object and choose Change Property from the Add Behavior menu of the Behaviors panel.
2From the Type Of Element menu, select an element type to display all the identified elements of that type.
3Select an element from the Element ID menu.
4Select a property from the Property menu, or enter the name of the property in the box.
5Enter the new value for the new property in the New Value field.
6Click OK and verify that the default event is correct.
Apply the Check Browser behavior
This behavior has been deprecated as of Dreamweaver CS5.
Apply the Check Plugin behavior
Use the Check Plugin behavior to send visitors to different pages depending on whether they have the specified plug-in
installed. For example, you might want visitors to go to one page if they have Shockwave and another page if they do
not.
Note: You cannot detect specific plug-ins in Internet Explorer using JavaScript. However, selecting Flash or Director will
add the appropriate VBScript code to your page to detect those plug-ins in Internet Explorer on Windows. Plug-in detection
is impossible in Internet Explorer on Mac OS.
1Select an object and choose Check Plugin from the Add Behavior menu of the Behaviors panel.
2Select a plug-in from the Plugin menu, or click Enter and type the exact name of the plug-in in the adjacent box.
You must use the exact name of the plug-in as specified in bold on the About Plug-ins page in Netscape Navigator.
(In Windows, select Navigator’s Help > About Plug-ins command; on Mac OS, select About Plug-ins from the Apple
menu.)
3In the If Found, Go To URL box, specify a URL for visitors who have the plug-in.
If you specify a remote URL, you must include the http:// prefix in the address. If you leave the field blank, visitors
will stay on the same page.
4In the Otherwise, Go To URL box, specify an alternative URL for visitors who don’t have the plug-in. If you leave
the field blank, visitors will stay on the same page.
5Specify what to do if plug-in detection is not possible. By default, when detection is impossible, the visitor is sent to
the URL listed in the Otherwise box. To instead send the visitor to the first (If Found) URL, select the option Always
Go To First URL If Detection Is Not Possible. When selected, this option effectively means “assume that the visitor
has the plug-in, unless the browser explicitly indicates that the plug-in is not present.” In general, select this option
if the plug-in content is integral to your page; if not leave it deselected.
Note: This option applies only to Internet Explorer; Netscape Navigator can always detect plug-ins.
6Click OK and verify that the default event is correct.
417
Javascript
Last updated 6/3/2015
Apply the Control Shockwave or SWF behavior
This behavior has been deprecated as of Dreamweaver CS5.
Apply the Drag AP Element behavior
The Drag AP Element behavior lets the visitor drag an absolutely positioned (AP) element. Use this behavior to create
puzzles, slider controls, and other movable interface elements.
You can specify in which direction the visitor can drag the AP element (horizontally, vertically, or in any direction), a
target to which the visitor should drag the AP element, whether to snap the AP element to the target if the AP element
is within a certain number of pixels of the target, what to do when the AP element hits the target, and more.
Because the Drag AP Element behavior must be called before the visitor can drag the AP element, you should attach
Drag AP Element to the body object (with the onLoad event).
1Select Insert > Layout Objects > AP Div or click the Draw AP Div button on the Insert panel and draw an AP Div
in the Document window’s Design view.
2Click <body> in the tag selector at the lower-left corner of the Document window.
3Select Drag AP Element from the Add Behavior menu of the Behaviors panel.
If Drag AP Element is unavailable, you probably have an AP element selected.
4In the AP Element pop-up menu, select the AP element.
5Select either Constrained or Unconstrained from the Movement pop-up menu.
Unconstrained movement is appropriate for puzzles and other drag-and-drop games. For slider controls and
moveable scenery such as file drawers, curtains, and mini-blinds, select constrained movement.
6For constrained movement, enter values (in pixels) in the Up, Down, Left, and Right boxes.
Values are relative to the starting position of the AP element. To constrain movement within a rectangular region,
enter positive values in all four boxes. To allow only vertical movement, enter positive values for Up and Down and
0 for Left and Right. To allow only horizontal movement, enter positive values for Left and Right and 0 for Up and
Down.
7Enter values (in pixels) for the drop target in the Left and Top boxes.
The drop target is the spot to which you want the visitor to drag the AP element. An AP element is considered to
have reached the drop target when its left and top coordinates match the values you enter in the Left and Top boxes.
Values are relative to the top left corner of the browser window. Click Get Current Position to automatically fill the
text boxes with the current position of the AP element.
8Enter a value (in pixels) in the Snap If Within box to determine how close the visitor must get to the drop target
before the AP element snaps to the target.
Larger values make it easier for the visitor to find the drop target.
9For simple puzzles and scenery manipulation, you can stop here. To define the drag handle for the AP element, track
the movement of the AP element while it is being dragged, and trigger an action when the AP element is dropped,
click the Advanced tab.
10 To specify that the visitor must click a particular area of the AP element to drag the AP element, select Area within
element from the Drag Handle menu; then enter the left and top coordinates and the width and height of the drag
handle.
418
Javascript
Last updated 6/3/2015
This option is useful when the image inside the AP element contains an element that suggests dragging, such as a
title bar or drawer handle. Do not set this option if you want the visitor to be able to click anywhere in the AP
element to drag it.
11 Select any While Dragging options that you want to use:
Select Bring Element To Front if the AP element should move to the front of the stacking order while it is being
dragged. If you select this option, use the pop-up menu to select whether to leave the AP element in front or
restore it to its original position in the stacking order.
Enter JavaScript code or a function name (for example, monitorAPelement()) in the Call JavaScript box to
repeatedly execute the code or function while the AP element is being dragged. For example, you could write a
function that monitors the coordinates of the AP element and displays hints such as “youre getting warmer” or
“youre nowhere near the drop target” in a text box.
12 Enter JavaScript code or a function name (for example, evaluateAPelementPos()) in the second Call JavaScript box
to execute the code or function when the AP element is dropped. Select Only If Snapped if the JavaScript should be
executed only if the AP element has reached the drop target.
13 Click OK and verify that the default event is correct.
Gathering information about the draggable AP element
When you attach the Drag AP element behavior to an object, Dreamweaver inserts the MM_dragLayer() function into
the head section of your document. (The function retains the old naming convention for AP elements [that is, “Layer”]
so that layers created in previous versions of Dreamweaver will remain editable.) In addition to registering the AP
element as draggable, this function defines three properties for each draggable AP element—MM_LEFTRIGHT,
MM_UPDOWN, and MM_SNAPPED—that you can use in your own JavaScript functions to determine the relative
horizontal position of the AP element, the relative vertical position of the AP element, and whether the AP element has
reached the drop target.
Note: The information provided here is intended for experienced JavaScript programmers only.
For example, the following function displays the value of the MM_UPDOWN property (the current vertical position
of the AP element) in a form field called curPosField. (Form fields are useful for displaying continuously updated
information because they are dynamic—that is, you can change their contents after the page has finished loading.)
function getPos(layerId){
var layerRef = document.getElementById(layerId);
var curVertPos = layerRef.MM_UPDOWN;
document.tracking.curPosField.value = curVertPos;
}
Instead of displaying the values of MM_UPDOWN or MM_LEFTRIGHT in a form field, you could use those values
in a variety of other ways. For example, you could write a function that displays a message in the form field depending
on how close the value is to the drop zone, or you could call another function to show or hide an AP element depending
on the value.
It is especially useful to read the MM_SNAPPED property when you have several AP elements on the page, all of which
must reach their targets before the visitor can advance to the next page or task. For example, you could write a function
to count how many AP elements have an MM_SNAPPED value of true and call it whenever an AP element is dropped.
When the snapped count reaches the desired number, you could send the visitor to the next page or display a message
of congratulations.
419
Javascript
Last updated 6/3/2015
Apply the Go To URL behavior
The Go To URL behavior opens a new page in the current window or in the specified frame. This behavior is useful for
changing the contents of two or more frames with one click.
1Select an object and choose Go To URL from the Add Behavior menu of the Behaviors panel.
2Select a destination for the URL from the Open In list.
The Open In list automatically lists the names of all frames in the current frameset as well as the main window. If
there are no frames, the main window is the only option.
Note: This behavior may produce unexpected results if any frame is named top, blank, self, or parent. Browsers
sometimes mistake these names for reserved target names.
3Click Browse to select a document to open, or enter the path and filename of the document in the URL box.
4Repeat steps 2 and 3 to open additional documents in other frames.
5Click OK and verify that the default event is correct.
Apply the Jump Menu behavior
When you create a jump menu by using Insert > Form > Jump Menu, Dreamweaver creates a menu object and attaches
the Jump Menu (or Jump Menu Go) behavior to it. There is usually no need to attach the Jump Menu behavior to an
object by hand.
You can edit an existing jump menu in either of two ways:
You can edit and rearrange menu items, change the files to jump to, and change the window in which those files
open, by double-clicking an existing Jump Menu behavior in the Behaviors panel.
You can edit the items in the menu just as you would edit items in any menu, by selecting the menu and using the
List Values button in the Property inspector.
1Create a jump menu object if there isn’t one already in your document.
2Select the object and choose Jump Menu from the Add Behavior menu of the Behaviors panel.
3Make changes as desired in the Jump Menu dialog box and then click OK.
Apply the Jump Menu Go behavior
The Jump Menu Go behavior is closely associated with the Jump Menu behavior; Jump Menu Go lets you associate a
Go button with a jump menu. (Before you use this behavior, a jump menu must already exist in the document.) Clicking
the Go button opens the link thats selected in the jump menu. A jump menu doesn’t normally need a Go button;
selecting an item from a jump menu generally causes a URL to load without any need for further user action. But if the
visitor selects the same item thats already chosen in the jump menu, the jump doesn’t occur. In general, that doesnt
matter, but if the jump menu appears in a frame, and the jump menu items link to pages in other frames, a Go button
is often useful, to allow visitors to re-select an item that’s already selected in the jump menu.
Note: When you use a Go button with a jump menu, the Go button becomes the only mechanism that “jumps” the user to
the URL associated with the selection in the menu. Selecting a menu item in the jump menu no longer re-directs the user
automatically to another page or frame.
1Select an object to use as the Go button (generally a button image), and choose Jump Menu Go from the Add
Behavior menu of the Behaviors panel.
2In the Choose Jump Menu menu, select a menu for the Go button to activate and click OK.
420
Javascript
Last updated 6/3/2015
Apply the Open Browser Window behavior
Use the Open Browser Window behavior to open a page in a new window. You can specify the properties of the new
window, including its size, attributes (whether it is resizable, has a menu bar, and so on), and name. For example, you
can use this behavior to open a larger image in a separate window when the visitor clicks a thumbnail image; with this
behavior, you can make the new window the exact size of the image.
If you specify no attributes for the window, it opens at the size and with the attributes of the window from which it was
opened. Specifying any attribute for the window automatically turns off all other attributes that are not explicitly turned
on. For example, if you set no attributes for the window, it might open at 1024 x 768 pixels and have a navigation bar
(showing the Back, Forward, Home and Reload buttons), location toolbar (showing the URL), status bar (showing
status messages, at the bottom), and menu bar (showing File, Edit, View and other menus). If you explicitly set the width
to 640 and the height to 480 and set no other attributes, the window opens at 640 x 480 pixels, without toolbars.
1Select an object and choose Open Browser Window from the Add Behavior menu of the Behaviors panel.
2Click Browse to select a file, or enter the URL you want to display.
3Set the options for window width and height (in pixels) and for the incorporation of various toolbars, scroll bars,
resize handles, and the like. Give the window a name (use no spaces or special characters) if you want it to be the
target of links or want to control it with JavaScript.
4Click OK and verify that the default event is correct.
Apply the Play Sound behavior
This behavior has been deprecated as of Dreamweaver CS5.
Apply the Popup Message behavior
The Popup Message behavior displays a JavaScript alert with the message you specify. Because JavaScript alerts have
only one button (OK), use this behavior to give the user information rather than to present a choice.
You can embed any valid JavaScript function call, property, global variable, or other expression in the text. To embed a
JavaScript expression, place it inside braces ({}). To display a brace, precede it with a backslash (\{).
Example:
The URL for this page is {window.location}, and today is {new Date()}.
Note: The browser controls the appearance of the alert. If you want more control over the appearance, consider using the
Open Browser Window behavior.
1Select an object and choose Popup Message from the Add Behavior menu of the Behaviors panel.
2Enter your message in the Message box.
3Click OK and verify that the default event is correct.
Apply the Preload Images behavior
The Preload Images behavior shortens display time by caching images that are not shown when the page first appears
(for instance, images that will be swapped in with behaviors or scripts).
Note: The Swap Image behavior automatically preloads all highlight images when you select the Preload Images option in
the Swap Image dialog box, so you do not need to manually add Preload Images when using Swap Image.
1Select an object and choose Preload Images from the Add Behavior menu of the Behaviors panel.
421
Javascript
Last updated 6/3/2015
2Click Browse to select an image file, or enter the path and filename of an image in the Image Source File box.
3Click the Plus (+) button at the top of the dialog box to add the image to the Preload Images list.
4Repeat steps 2 and 3 for all remaining images that you want to preload on the current page.
5To remove an image from the Preload Images list, select it and click the Minus (–) button.
6Click OK and verify that the default event is correct.
Apply the Set Nav Bar Image behavior
This behavior has been deprecated as of Dreamweaver CS5.
Apply the Set Text Of Frame behavior
The Set Text Of Frame behavior allows you to dynamically set the text of a frame, replacing the content and formatting
of a frame with the content you specify. The content can include any valid HTML code. Use this behavior to display
information dynamically.
Although the Set Text Of Frame behavior replaces the formatting of a frame, you can select Preserve Background Color
to preserve the page background and text color attributes.
You can embed any valid JavaScript function call, property, global variable, or other expression in the text. To embed a
JavaScript expression, place it inside braces ({}). To display a brace, precede it with a backslash (\{).
Example:
The URL for this page is {window.location}, and today is {new Date()}.
1Select an object and choose Set Text > Set Text Of Frame from the Add Behavior menu of the Behaviors panel.
2In the Set Text Of Frame dialog box, select the target frame from the Frame menu.
3Click the Get Current HTML button to copy the current contents of the target frames body section.
4Enter a message in the New HTML box.
5Click OK and verify that the default event is correct.
Apply the Set Text Of Container behavior
The Set Text Of Container behavior replaces the content and formatting of an existing container (that is, any element
that can contain text or other elements) on a page with the content you specify. The content can include any valid
HTML source code.
You can embed any valid JavaScript function call, property, global variable, or other expression in the text. To embed a
JavaScript expression, place it inside braces ({}). To display a brace, precede it with a backslash (\{).
Example:
The URL for this page is {window.location}, and today is {new Date()}.
1Select an object and select Set Text > Set Text Of Container from the Add Behavior menu of the Behaviors panel.
2In the Set Text Of Container dialog box, use the Container menu to select the target element.
3Enter the new text or HTML in the New HTML box.
4Click OK and verify that the default event is correct.
422
Javascript
Last updated 6/3/2015
Apply the Set Text Of Status Bar behavior
The Set Text Of Status Bar behavior shows a message in the status bar at the lower-left corner of the browser window.
For example, you can use this behavior to describe the destination of a link in the status bar instead of showing the URL
associated with it. Visitors often ignore or overlook messages in the status bar (and not all browsers provide full support
for setting the text of the status bar); if your message is important, consider displaying it as a pop-up message or as the
text of an AP element.
Note: If you use the Set Text Of Status Bar behavior in Dreamweaver, the text of the status bar in the browser is not
guaranteed to change because some browsers require special adjustments when changing status bar text. Firefox, for
example, requires that you change an Advanced option that lets JavaScript change status bar text. For more information,
see your browser’s documentation.
You can embed any valid JavaScript function call, property, global variable, or other expression in the text. To embed a
JavaScript expression, place it inside braces ({}). To display a brace, precede it with a backslash (\{).
Example:
The URL for this page is {window.location}, and today is {new Date()}.
1Select an object and choose Set Text > Set Text Of Status Bar from the Add Behavior menu of the Behaviors panel.
2In the Set Text Of Status Bar dialog box, type your message in the Message box.
Keep the message concise. The browser truncates the message if it doesn’t fit in the status bar.
3Click OK and verify that the default event is correct.
Apply the Set Text Of Text Field behavior
The Set Text Of Text Field behavior replaces the content of a forms text field with the content you specify.
You can embed any valid JavaScript function call, property, global variable, or other expression in the text. To embed a
JavaScript expression, place it inside braces ({}). To display a brace, precede it with a backslash (\{).
Example:
The URL for this page is {window.location}, and today is {new Date()}.
Create a named text field
1Select Insert > Form > Text Field.
If Dreamweaver prompts you to add a form tag, click Yes.
2In the Property inspector, type a name for the text field. Make sure the name is unique on the page (don’t use the
same name for multiple elements on the same page, even if theyre in different forms).
Apply Set Text Of Text Field
1Select a text field and choose Set Text > Set Text Of Field from the Add Behavior menu of the Behaviors panel.
2Select the target text field from the Text Field menu and enter your new text.
3Click OK and verify that the default event is correct.
423
Javascript
Last updated 6/3/2015
Apply the Show-Hide Elements behavior
The Show-Hide Elements behavior shows, hides, or restores the default visibility of one or more page elements. This
behavior is useful for displaying information as the user interacts with the page. For example, as the user moves the
pointer over an image of a plant, you could show a page element giving details about the plant’s growing season and
region, how much sun it needs, how large it can grow, and so on. The behavior only shows or hides the pertinent
element—it does not actually remove the element from the flow of the page when it is hidden.
1Select an object and select Show-Hide Elements from the Add Behavior menu of the Behaviors panel.
If Show-Hide Elements is unavailable, you probably have an AP element selected. Because AP elements do not
accept events in both 4.0 browsers, you must select a different object—such as the <body> tag or a link (<a>) tag.
2From the Elements list, select the element you want to show or hide and click Show, Hide, or Restore (which restores
the default visibility).
3Repeat step 2 for all remaining elements whose visibility you want to change. (You can change the visibility of
multiple elements with a single behavior.)
4Click OK and verify that the default event is correct.
Apply the Show Pop-Up Menu behavior
This behavior has been deprecated as of Dreamweaver CS5.
Add, remove, and rearrange pop-up menu items
This behavior has been deprecated as of Dreamweaver CS5.
Format a pop-up menu
This behavior has been deprecated as of Dreamweaver CS5.
Position a pop-up menu in a document
This behavior has been deprecated as of Dreamweaver CS5.
Modify a pop-up menu
This behavior has been deprecated as of Dreamweaver CS5.
Apply the Swap Image behavior
The Swap Image behavior swaps one image for another by changing the src attribute of the <img> tag. Use this behavior
to create button rollovers and other image effects (including swapping more than one image at a time). Inserting a
rollover image automatically adds a Swap Image behavior to your page.
Note: Because only the src attribute is affected by this behavior, you should swap in an image that has the same dimensions
(height and width) as the original. Otherwise, the image you swap in shrinks or expands to fit the dimensions of the original
image.
424
Javascript
Last updated 6/3/2015
There is also a Swap Image Restore behavior, which restores the last set of swapped images to their previous source files.
This behavior is automatically added whenever you attach the Swap Image behavior to an object; if you leave the
Restore option selected while attaching Swap Image, you should never need to select the Swap Image Restore behavior
manually.
1Select Insert > Image or click the Image button on the Insert panel to insert an image.
2In the Property inspector, enter a name for the image in the leftmost text box.
It isn’t mandatory to name images; they’re named automatically when you attach the behavior to an object. However,
it is easier to distinguish images in the Swap Image dialog box if you name all the images beforehand.
3Repeat steps 1 and 2 to insert additional images.
4Select an object (generally the image you’re going to swap) and choose Swap Image from the Add Behavior menu of
the Behaviors panel.
5From the Images list, select the image whose source you want to change.
6Click Browse to select the new image file, or enter the path and filename of the new image in the Set Source To box.
7Repeat steps 5 and 6 for any additional images you want to change. Use the same Swap Image action for all the
images you want to change at once; otherwise, the corresponding Swap Image Restore action won’t restore all of
them.
8Select the Preload Images option to cache the new images when the page is loaded.
This prevents downloading delays when it is time for the images to appear.
9Click OK and verify that the default event is correct.
Apply the Validate Form behavior
The Validate Form behavior checks the contents of specified text fields to ensure that the user has entered the correct
type of data. Attach this behavior to individual text fields with the onBlur event to validate the fields as the user is filling
out the form, or attach it to the form with the onSubmit event to evaluate several text fields at once when the user clicks
the Submit button. Attaching this behavior to a form prevents the submission of forms with invalid data.
1Select Insert > Form or click the Form button in the Insert panel to insert a form.
2Select Insert > Form > Text Field or click the Text Field button in the Insert panel to insert a text field.
Repeat this step to insert additional text fields.
3Choose a validation method:
To validate individual fields as the user fills out the form, select a text field and select Window > Behaviors.
To validate multiple fields when the user submits the form, click the <form> tag in the tag selector at the lower-
left corner of the Document window and choose Window > Behaviors.
4Select Validate Form from the Add Behavior menu.
5Do one of the following:
If you are validating individual fields, select the same field that you selected in the Document window from the
Fields list.
If you are validating multiple fields, select a text field from the Fields list.
6Select the Required option if the field must contain some data.
7Select one of the following Accept options:
Use Anything Checks that a required field contains data; the data can be of any type.
425
Javascript
Last updated 6/3/2015
Use E-mail address Checks that the field contains an @ symbol.
Use Number Checks that the field contains only numerals.
Use Number From Checks that the field contains a number in a specific range.
8If you have chosen to validate multiple fields, repeat steps 6 and 7 for any additional fields that you want to validate.
9Click OK.
If you are validating multiple fields when the user submits the form, the onSubmit event automatically appears in
the Events menu.
10 If you are validating individual fields, check that the default event is onBlur or onChange. If not, select one of those
events.
Both events trigger the Validate Form behavior when the user moves away from the field. The difference is that
onBlur occurs whether or not the user has typed in the field, and onChange occurs only if the user changed the
contents of the field. The onBlur event is preferred if the field is required.
More Help topics
Jump menus
Insert or change a dynamic HTML form menu
Create frames and framesets
Insert an AP Div
426
Last updated 6/3/2015
Chapter 12: Cross-product
Add-Ons
Add-ons are new features that you can add easily to Dreamweaver. You can use many types of add-ons; for example,
there are add-onsthat let you reformat tables, connect to back-end databases, or help you write scripts for browsers.
Note: To install add-ons that all users have access to in a multiuser operating system, you must be logged in as
Administrator (Windows) or root (Mac OS X). For more information on using Dreamweaver on multiuser systems, About
customizing Dreamweaver in multiuser systems.
Using add-ons in Dreamweaver
Click Windows > Browse Add-Ons to browse and install add-ons. When you click Browse Add-Ons, the Adobe
Creative Cloud Add-Ons page appears.
On the Adobe Creative Cloud Add-Ons page, click Dreamweaver on the left to view Dreamweaver-specific add-ons.
You can also use the search box on the right to search for a specific add-on.
427
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
Important: Before installing add-ons, ensure that you have enabled file sync for your Adobe Creative Cloud account.
See Enable file sync on Adobe Creative Cloud for more details.
Follow the on-screen instructions to install the add-on.
To view the add-ons that you have installed or shared, click All Your Purchases And Shared Items under My Add-Ons.
Enable file sync on Adobe Creative Cloud
Before installing add-ons from Adobe Creative Cloud, ensure that you enable file sync through your Adobe Creative
Cloud client.
1Click on your system tray to open the Adobe Creative Cloud client.
2Click , and then click Preferences.
428
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
3In the Files tab, set Sync On/Off to On.
429
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
Cross-application integration
About Photoshop, Flash, and Fireworks integration
Photoshop, Fireworks, and Flash are powerful web-development tools for creating and managing graphics and SWF
files. You can tightly integrate Dreamweaver with these tools to simplify your web design workflow.
Note: There is also limited integration with some other applications. For example, you can export an InDesign file as
XHTML and continue working on it in Dreamweaver. For a tutorial on this workflow, see www.adobe.com/go/vid0202.
You can easily insert images and content created with Adobe Flash (SWF and FLV files) in a Dreamweaver document.
You can also edit an image or SWF file in its original editor after you insert it in a Dreamweaver document.
Note: To use Dreamweaver in conjunction with these Adobe applications, you must have these applications installed on
your computer.
For Fireworks and Flash, product integration is achieved through roundtrip editing. Roundtrip editing ensures that
code updates are transferred correctly between Dreamweaver and these other applications (for example, to preserve
rollover behaviors or links to other files).
Dreamweaver also relies on Design Notes for product integration. Design Notes are small files that allow Dreamweaver
to locate the source document for an exported image or SWF file. When you export files from Fireworks, Flash, or
Photoshop directly to a Dreamweaver defined site, Design Notes containing references to the original PSD, PNG, or
Flash authoring file (FLA) are automatically exported to the site along with the web-ready file (GIF, JPEG, PNG, or
SWF).
430
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
In addition to location information, Design Notes contain other pertinent information about exported files. For
example, when you export a Fireworks table, Fireworks writes a Design Note for each exported image file in the table.
If the exported file contains hotspots or rollovers, the Design Notes include information about the scripts for them.
As part of the export operation, Dreamweaver creates a folder named _notes in the same folder as the exported asset.
This folder contains the Design Notes that Dreamweaver needs to integrate with Photoshop, Flash, or Fireworks.
Note: In order to use Design Notes, you must make sure they are not disabled for your Dreamweaver site. They are enabled
by default. However, even if they are disabled, when you insert a Photoshop image file, Dreamweaver creates a Design Note
to store the location of the source PSD file.
For a tutorial on Dreamweaver and Fireworks integration, see www.adobe.com/go/vid0188.
For a tutorial on Dreamweaver and Photoshop integration, see www.adobe.com/go/lrvid4043_dw.
More Help topics
About Design Notes
Enable and disable Design Notes for a site
Dreamweaver InDesign tutorial
Working with Fireworks and Dreamweaver
Insert a Fireworks image
Dreamweaver and Fireworks recognize and share many of the same file-editing procedures, including changes to links,
image maps, table slices, and more. Together, the two applications provide a streamlined workflow for editing,
optimizing, and placing web graphics files in HTML pages.
You can place a Fireworks exported graphic directly in a Dreamweaver document using the Insert Image command, or
you can create a new Fireworks graphic from a Dreamweaver image placeholder.
1In the Dreamweaver document, place the insertion point where you want the image to appear, then do one of the
following:
Select Insert > Image.
In the Common category of the Insert panel, click the Image button or drag it to the document.
2Navigate to the desired Fireworks exported file, and click OK (Windows) or Open (Macintosh).
Note: If the Fireworks file is not in the current Dreamweaver site, a message appears asking whether you want to copy
the file to the root folder. Click Yes.
Edit a Fireworks image or table from Dreamweaver
When you open and edit an image or an image slice that is part of a Fireworks table, Dreamweaver starts Fireworks,
which opens the PNG file from which the image or table was exported.
Note: This assumes that Fireworks is set as the primary external image editor for PNG files. Fireworks is often also set as
the default editor for JPEG and GIF files, although you may wish to set Photoshop as the default editor for these file types.
431
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
When the image is part of a Fireworks table, you can open the entire Fireworks table for edits, as long as the <!--fw
table--> comment exists in the HTML code. If the source PNG file was exported from Fireworks to a Dreamweaver site
using the Dreamweaver Style HTML And Images setting, the Fireworks table comment is automatically inserted in the
HTML code.
1In Dreamweaver, open the Property inspector (Window > Properties) if it isn’t already open.
2Click the image or image slice to select it.
When you select an image that was exported from Fireworks, the Property inspector identifies the selection as a
Fireworks image or table and displays the name of the PNG source file.
3To start Fireworks for editing, do one of the following:
In the Property inspector, click Edit.
Hold down Control (Windows) or Command (Macintosh) and double-click the selected image.
Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the selected image and select Edit With Fireworks from the
context menu.
Note: If Fireworks cannot locate the source file, you are prompted to locate the PNG source file. When you work with
the Fireworks source file, changes are saved to both the source file and the exported file; otherwise, only the exported file
is updated.
4In Fireworks, edit the source PNG file and click Done.
Fireworks saves the changes in the PNG file, exports the updated image (or HTML and images), and returns focus
to Dreamweaver. In Dreamweaver, the updated image or table appears.
For a tutorial about Dreamweaver and Fireworks integration, see www.adobe.com/go/vid0188.
Optimize a Fireworks image from Dreamweaver
You can use Dreamweaver to make quick changes to Fireworks images and animations. From within Dreamweaver, you
can change optimization settings, animation settings, and the size and area of the exported image.
1In Dreamweaver, select the desired image and do one of the following:
Select Command > Optimize Image
Click the Edit Image Settings button in the Property inspector.
2Make your edits in the Image Preview dialog box:
To edit optimization settings, click the Options tab.
To edit the size and area of the exported image, click the File tab.
3When you finish, click OK.
Use Fireworks to modify Dreamweaver image placeholders
You can create a placeholder image in a Dreamweaver document and then start Fireworks to design a graphic image or
Fireworks table to replace it.
To create a new image from an image placeholder, you must have both Dreamweaver and Fireworks installed on your
system.
1Make sure you’ve already set Fireworks as the image editor for PNG files.
2In the Document window, click the image placeholder to select it.
432
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
3Start Fireworks in Editing From Dreamweaver mode by doing one of the following:
In the Property inspector, click Create.
Press Control (Windows) or Command (Macintosh) then double-click the image placeholder.
Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the image placeholder, then select Create Image In
Fireworks.
4Use Fireworks options to design the image.
Fireworks recognizes the following image placeholder settings you may have set while working with the image
placeholder in Dreamweaver: image size (which correlates to Fireworks canvas size), image ID (which Fireworks
uses as the default document name for the source file and export file you create), and text alignment. Fireworks also
recognizes links and certain behaviors (such as swap image, pop-up menu, and set text) you attached to the image
placeholder while working in Dreamweaver.
Note: Although Fireworks doesn’t show links you’ve added to an image placeholder, they are preserved. If you draw a
hotspot and add a link in Fireworks, it will not delete the link you added to the image placeholder in Dreamweaver;
however, if you cut out a slice in Fireworks in the new image, Fireworks will delete the link in the Dreamweaver
document when you replace the image placeholder.
Fireworks doesn’t recognize the following image placeholder settings: image alignment, color, Vspace and Hspace,
and maps. They are disabled in the image placeholder Property inspector.
5When you finish, click Done to display the save prompt.
6In the Save In text box, select the folder you defined as your Dreamweaver local site folder.
If you named the image placeholder when you inserted it in the Dreamweaver document, Fireworks populates the
File Name box with that name. You can change the name.
7Click Save to save the PNG file.
The Export dialog box appears. Use this dialog box to export the image as a GIF or JPEG file, or, in the case of sliced
images, as HTML and images.
8For Save In, select the Dreamweaver local site folder.
The Name box automatically displays the name you used for the PNG file. You can change the name.
9For Save As Type, select the type of file or files you want to export; for example, Images Only or HTML And Images.
10 Click Save to save the exported file.
The file is saved, and focus returns to Dreamweaver. In the Dreamweaver document, the exported file or Fireworks
table replaces the image placeholder.
About Fireworks pop-up menus
Fireworks lets you quickly and easily create CSS-based pop-up menus.
In addition to being extensible and fast to download, the pop-up menus you create with Fireworks give you the
following advantages:
The menu items can be indexed by search engines.
The menu items can be read by screen readers, making your pages more accessible.
The code generated by Fireworks complies to standards and can be validated.
You can edit Fireworks pop-up menus with Dreamweaver or with Fireworks, but not both. Changes made in
Dreamweaver are not preserved in Fireworks.
433
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
Edit Fireworks pop-up menus in Dreamweaver
You can create a pop-up menu in Fireworks 8 or later and then edit it with Dreamweaver or with Fireworks (using
roundtrip editing), but not with both. If you edit your menus in Dreamweaver and then edit them in Fireworks, you
will lose all your previous edits except for the text content.
If you prefer to edit your menus with Dreamweaver, you can use Fireworks to create the pop-up menu and then use
Dreamweaver exclusively to edit and customize the menu.
If you prefer to edit the menus in Fireworks, you can use the roundtrip editing feature in Dreamweaver, but you should
not edit the menus directly in Dreamweaver.
1In Dreamweaver, select the Fireworks table that contains the pop-up menu, and then click Edit in the Property
inspector.
The source PNG file opens in Fireworks.
2In Fireworks, edit the menu with the Pop-up Menu Editor, and then click Done on the Fireworks toolbar.
Fireworks sends the edited pop-up menu back to Dreamweaver.
If you created a pop-up menu in Fireworks MX 2004 or earlier, you can edit it in Dreamweaver using the Show
Pop-Up Menu dialog box, available from the Behaviors panel.
Edit a pop-up menu created in Fireworks MX 2004 or earlier
1In Dreamweaver, select the hotspot or image that triggers the pop-up menu.
2In the Behaviors panel (Shift+F3), double-click Show Pop-Up Menu in the Actions list.
3Make your changes in the Pop-Up Menu dialog box and click OK.
Specify launch-and-edit preferences for Fireworks source files
When you use Fireworks to edit images, the images in your web pages are normally exported by Fireworks from a
source PNG file. When you open an image file in Dreamweaver to edit it, Fireworks automatically opens the source
PNG file, prompting you to locate the PNG file if it cannot be found. If you prefer, you can set preferences in Fireworks
to have Dreamweaver open the inserted image, or you can have Fireworks give you the option of using the inserted
image file or the Fireworks source file every time you open an image in Dreamweaver.
Note: Dreamweaver recognizes the Fireworks launch-and-edit preferences only in certain cases. Specifically, you must be
opening and optimizing an image that is not part of a Fireworks table and contains a correct Design Notes path to a source
PNG file.
1In Fireworks, select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Fireworks > Preferences (Macintosh) and then click the
Launch And Edit tab (Windows) or select Launch And Edit from the pop-up menu (Macintosh).
2Specify the preference options to use when editing or optimizing Fireworks images placed in an external application:
Always Use Source PNG Automatically opens the Fireworks PNG file that is defined in the Design Note as the
source of the placed image. Updates are made to the source PNG file and its corresponding placed image.
Never Use Source PNG Automatically opens the placed Fireworks image, whether or not a source PNG file exists.
Updates are made to the placed image only.
Ask When Launching Displays a message asking whether to open the source PNG file. You can also specify global
launch-and-edit preferences from this message.
434
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
Insert Fireworks HTML code in a Dreamweaver document
From Fireworks, you can use the Export command to export and save optimized images and HTML files to a location
inside a Dreamweaver site folder. You can then insert the file in Dreamweaver. Dreamweaver lets you insert Fireworks-
generated HTML code, complete with associated images, slices, and JavaScript, into a document.
1In Dreamweaver document, place the insertion point where you want to insert the Fireworks HTML code.
2Do one of the following:
Select Insert > Image Objects > Fireworks HTML.
In the Common category of the Insert panel, click the Images button and choose Insert Fireworks HTML from
the popup menu.
3Click Browse to select a Fireworks HTML file.
4If you will have no further use for the file, select Delete File After Insertion. Selecting this option has no effect on
the source PNG file associated with the HTML file.
Note: If the HTML file is on a network drive, it is permanently deleted—not moved to the Recycle Bin or Trash.
5Click OK to insert the HTML code, along with its associated images, slices, and JavaScript, into the Dreamweaver
document.
Paste Fireworks HTML code into Dreamweaver
A fast way to place Fireworks-generated images and tables in Dreamweaver is to copy and paste Fireworks HTML code
directly into a Dreamweaver document.
Copy and paste Fireworks HTML code into Dreamweaver
1In Fireworks, select Edit > Copy HTML Code.
2Follow the wizard as it guides you through the settings for exporting your HTML and images. When prompted,
specify your Dreamweaver site folder as the destination for the exported images.
The wizard exports the images to the specified destination and copies the HTML code to the Clipboard.
3In Dreamweaver document, place the insertion point where you want to paste the HTML code, and select Edit >
Paste Fireworks HTML.
All HTML and JavaScript code associated with the Fireworks files you exported is copied into the Dreamweaver
document, and all links to images are updated.
Export and paste Fireworks HTML code into Dreamweaver
1In Fireworks, select File > Export.
2Specify your Dreamweaver site folder as the destination for the exported images.
3In the Export pop-up menu, select HTML And Images.
4In the HTML pop-up menu, select Copy To Clipboard, and then click Export.
5In the Dreamweaver document, place the insertion point where you want to paste the exported HTML code, and
select Edit > Paste Fireworks HTML.
All HTML and JavaScript code associated with the Fireworks files you exported is copied into the Dreamweaver
document, and all links to images are updated.
435
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
Update Fireworks HTML code placed in Dreamweaver
In Fireworks, the File > Update HTML command provides an alternative to the launch-and-edit technique for updating
Fireworks files placed in Dreamweaver. With Update HTML, you can edit a source PNG image in Fireworks and then
automatically update any exported HTML code and image files placed in a Dreamweaver document. This command
lets you update Dreamweaver files even when Dreamweaver is not running.
1In Fireworks, open the source PNG file and make your edits.
2Select File > Save.
3In Fireworks, select File > Update HTML.
4Navigate to the Dreamweaver file containing the HTML you want to update, and click Open.
5Navigate to the folder destination where you want to place the updated image files, and click Select (Windows) or
Choose (Macintosh).
Fireworks updates the HTML and JavaScript code in the Dreamweaver document. Fireworks also exports updated
images associated with the HTML and places the images in the specified destination folder.
If Fireworks cannot find matching HTML code to update, it gives you the option of inserting new HTML code into
the Dreamweaver document. Fireworks places the JavaScript section of the new code at the beginning of the
document and places the HTML table or link to the image at the end.
Create a web photo album
The Create Web Photo Album feature has been deprecated as of Dreamweaver CS5.
More Help topics
About Photoshop, Flash, and Fireworks integration
Use an external image editor
Dreamweaver Fireworks tutorial
Setting Image Preview dialog box options
Apply the Show Pop-Up Menu behavior
Working with Flash and Dreamweaver
Edit a SWF file from Dreamweaver in Flash
If you have both Flash and Dreamweaver installed, you can select a SWF file in a Dreamweaver document and use Flash
to edit it. Flash does not edit the SWF file directly; it edits the source document (FLA file) and re-exports the SWF file.
1In Dreamweaver, open the Property inspector (Window > Properties).
2In the Dreamweaver document, do one of the following:
Click the SWF file placeholder to select it; then in the Property inspector click Edit.
Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the placeholder for the SWF file, and select Edit With Flash
from the context menu.
436
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
Dreamweaver switches the focus to Flash, and Flash attempts to locate the Flash authoring file (FLA) for the
selected SWF file. If Flash cannot locate the Flash authoring file, you are prompted to locate it.
Note: If the FLA file or SWF file is locked, check out the file in Dreamweaver.
3In Flash, edit the FLA file. The Flash Document window indicates that you are modifying the file from within
Dreamweaver.
4When you finish making edits, click Done.
Flash updates the FLA file, re-exports it as a SWF file, closes, and then returns the focus to the Dreamweaver
document.
Note: To update the SWF file and keep Flash open, in Flash select File > Update for Dreamweaver.
5To view the updated file in the document, click Play in the Dreamweaver Property inspector or press F12 to preview
your page in a browser window.
Working with Adobe Bridgeand Dreamweaver
About Adobe Bridge
Dreamweaver provides seamless integration with Adobe Bridge, the cross-platform file browser included with Adobe
Creative Suite 5 components. Adobe Bridge helps you locate, organize, and browse the assets you need to create print,
web, video, and mobile content. You can start Adobe Bridge from any Creative Suitecomponent (except Acrobat 9), and
use it to access both Adobe and non-Adobe asset types.
From Adobe Bridge, you can:
Preview, search, sort, and process files without opening individual Creative Suite applications. You can also edit
metadata for files and use Adobe Bridge to place files into your documents, projects, or compositions.
Import and edit photos from a digital camera card, group related photos into stacks, and open and edit Camera Raw
files without starting Photoshop.
Perform automated tasks, such as batch commands.
Synchronize color settings across color-managed Creative Suite components.
Start Adobe Bridge from Dreamweaver
You can start Adobe Bridge from Dreamweaver to view your files before placing them or dragging them in your page
layout.
You can start Adobe Bridge in several different ways:
Select File > Browse In Bridge.
Click the Browse In Bridge button in the Standard toolbar.
Press the Browse In Bridge shortcut from the keyboard: Control+Alt+O (Windows) or Command+Option+O
(Macintosh).
Adobe Bridge opens in File Browser mode, showing the contents of the last-opened folder in Dreamweaver. If Adobe
Bridge was already open, it becomes the active window.
437
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: Adobe Bridge is only installed with Dreamweaver CS5 when you install Creative Suite CS5; it is not included with
the standalone version of Dreamweaver CS5. However, Adobe Bridge was included if you previously installed
Dreamweaver CS3 or CS4, so if you still have Adobe Bridge installed from those versions, Dreamweaver CS5 can access
it and use it.
Placing files into Dreamweaver from Adobe Bridge
You can insert files into Dreamweaver pages by inserting them or by dragging them from Adobe Bridge into your page.
The Dreamweaver document in which you want to insert the file must be open and in Design view to use this feature.
You can insert most file types into your pages, but Dreamweaver handles them differently:
If you insert a web-ready image (JPEG, GIF, or PNG), Dreamweaver inserts the image files directly into your page
and places a copy in your websites default images folder.
If you insert a Photoshop PSD file, you need to define its optimization settings before Dreamweaver can place it in
your page.
If you insert a non-image file, such as mp3, PDF, or a file with an unknown file type, Dreamweaver inserts a link to
the source file.
If you insert an HTML file, Dreamweaver inserts a link to the source file.
(Windows only) If you have Microsoft Office installed and you are inserting a Microsoft Word or Excel file, you
must specify if you want to insert the file itself or insert a link to the source file. If you want to insert the file, you can
specify how much of the files formatting you want to keep.
Place an Adobe Bridge file in your page
1In Dreamweaver (Design view), place the insertion point on your page where you want the file inserted.
2In Adobe Bridge, select the file and choose File > Place In Dreamweaver.
3If the file is not in your sites root folder, you are prompted to copy it there.
4If you have set Edit > Preferences > Accessibility to show attributes when inserting images, the Image Tag
Accessibility Attributes dialog box is displayed when you insert web-ready images such as JPEG and GIF.
Note: If your insertion point is in Code view, Adobe Bridge starts as usual but cannot place the file. You can only place files
in Design view.
Drag a file from Bridge into your page
1In Dreamweaver (Design view), place the insertion point on your page where you want the image inserted.
2Start Adobe Bridge if it isn't already open.
3In Adobe Bridge, select one or more files and drag them into your Dreamweaver page.
4If a file is not in your sites root folder, you are prompted to copy it there.
5If you have set Edit > Preferences > Accessibility to show attributes when inserting images, the Image Tag
Accessibility Attributes dialog box is displayed when you insert web-safe images such as JPEG and GIF.
Note: If your insertion point is in Code view, Adobe Bridge starts as usual but cannot place the file. You can only place files
in Design view.
438
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
Start Dreamweaver from Adobe Bridge
Select a file in Adobe Bridge and do one of the following:
Select File > Open With > Adobe Dreamweaver.
Right-click (Control-click on Macintosh) and then choose Open With > Adobe Dreamweaver from the context
menu.
Note: If Dreamweaver is already open, this action makes the program active. If Dreamweaver is not open, Adobe Bridge
starts it, bypassing the Welcome Screen.
More Help topics
Creative Suite 5 - Bridge
Create a Smart Object
Working with Photoshop and Dreamweaver
Working with Device Central and Dreamweaver
Using Adobe Device Central with Dreamweaver
Device Central enables Dreamweaver web designers and developers to preview how Dreamweaver files will look on a
wide variety of mobile devices. Device Central uses Operas Small-Screen Rendering™ to give designers and developers
an impression of how their web page looks on a small screen. It also enables designers and developers to test if their
CSS behaves correctly.
For example, a web developer may have a customer who wants to make a website available on mobile phones. The web
developer can use Dreamweaver to create preliminary pages and use Device Central to test how those pages look on
different devices.
1Start Dreamweaver.
2Open a file.
3Do one of the following:
Select File > Preview in Browser > Device Central.
On the document window toolbar, click and hold the Preview/Debug In browser button and select Preview
In Device Central.
Tips for creating Dreamweaver web content for mobile devices
Device Central previews web pages created in Dreamweaver using Operas Small-Screen Rendering. This preview can
give you a good idea of what a web page looks like on a mobile device.note: Operas Small-Screen Rendering may or may
not be pre-installed on any individual emulated device. Device Central simply gives a preview of how the content would
look if Operas Small-Screen Rendering was installed.
439
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
Use the tips below to ensure that web pages created in Dreamweaver display well on mobile devices.
If you use the Adobe® Spry framework to develop content, add the following line of HTML to your pages so they can
render CSS and execute JavaScript™ correctly in Device Central:<link href="SpryAccordion.css" media="screen"
rel="stylesheet" type="text/css"/> <link href="SpryAccordion2.css" media="handheld" rel="stylesheet"
type="text/css"/>
Operas Small-Screen Rendering does not support frames, pop-ups, underlining, strikethrough, overlining, blink,
and marquee. Try to avoid these design elements.
Keep web pages for mobile devices simple. In particular, use a minimum number of fonts, font sizes, and colors.
Scaling down image sizes and reducing the number of colors required increase the chances that the images will
appear as intended. Use CSS or HTML to specify an exact height and width for each image used. Provide alt text for
all images.
Note: The Opera software website is a good source of information about optimizing web pages for mobile devices.
For more tips and techniques for creating content for mobile phones and devices, see
www.adobe.com/go/learn_cs_mobilewiki_en.
More Help topics
Adobe Device Central Help
Working with ConnectNow and Dreamweaver
Working with ConnectNow
Adobe® ConnectNow provides you with a secure, personal online meeting room where you can meet and collaborate
with others via the web in real time. With ConnectNow, you can share and annotate your computer screen, send chat
messages, and communicate using integrated audio. You can also broadcast live video, share files, capture meeting
notes, and control an attendee's computer.
You can access ConnectNow directly from the application interface.
1Choose File > Share My Screen.
2In the Sign In to Adobe CS Live dialog box, enter your email address and password, and click Sign In. If you dont
have an Adobe ID, click the Create Adobe ID button.
3To share your screen, click the Share My Computer Screen button at the center of the ConnectNow application
window.
For complete instructions on using ConnectNow, see Adobe ConnectNow Help.
For a video tutorial about using ConnectNow, see Using ConnectNow to share your screen (7:12). (This demonstration
is in Dreamweaver.)
440
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
AIR Extension for Dreamweaver
The Adobe® AIR® Extension for Dreamweaver® lets you transform a web-based application into a desktop application.
Users can then run the application on their desktops and, in some cases, without an Internet connection.
You can use the extension with Dreamweaver CS3 and later. It is not compatible with Dreamweaver 8.
Note: Adobe AIR does not support Adobe InContext Editing. If you use the AIR Extension for Dreamweaver to export an
application that contains InContext Editing regions, the InContext Editing functionality will not work.
Installing the AIR Extension for Dreamweaver
The AIR Extension for Dreamweaver helps you to create rich Internet applications for the desktop. For example, you
might have a set of web pages that interact with each other to display XML data. You can use the Adobe AIR Extension
for Dreamweaver to package this set of pages into a small application that can be installed on a user’s computer. When
the user runs the application from their desktop, the application loads and displays the website in its own application
window, independent of a browser. The user can then browse the website locally on their computer without an Internet
connection.
Dynamic pages such as Adobe® ColdFusion® and PHP pages won’t run in Adobe AIR. The runtime only works with
HTML and JavaScript. However, you can use JavaScript in your pages to call any web service exposed on the Internet
including ColdFusion- or PHP-generated services—with Ajax methods such as XMLHTTPRequest or Adobe AIR-
specific APIs.
System requirements
To use the Adobe AIR Extension for Dreamweaver, the following software must be installed and properly configured:
Dreamweaver CS3 or later
Adobe® Extension Manager CS3 or later
Java JRE 1.4 or later (necessary for creating the Adobe AIRfile). The Java JRE is available at http://java.sun.com/.
The preceding requirements are only for creating and previewing Adobe AIR applications in Dreamweaver. To
install and run an Adobe AIRapplication on the desktop, you must also install Adobe AIR on your computer. To
download the runtime, see www.adobe.com/go/air.
Install the Adobe AIR Extension for Dreamweaver
1Download the Adobe AIR Extension for Dreamweaver here: http://www.adobe.com/products/air/tools/ajax/.
2Double-click the .mxp extension file in Windows Explorer(Windows) or in the Finder (Macintosh).
3Follow the onscreen instructions to install the extension.
4After you’re finished, restart Dreamweaver.
For information about using the Adobe AIR Extension for Dreamweaver, see Using the AIR Extension for
Dreamweaver.
Creating an AIR application in Dreamweaver
To create an HTML-based AIR application in Dreamweaver, you select an existing site to package as an AIR application.
1Make sure that the web pages you want to package into an application are contained in a defined Dreamweaver site.
2In Dreamweaver, open the home page of the set of pages you want to package.
441
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
3Select Site > Air Application Settings.
4Complete the AIR Application and Installer Settings dialog box, and then click Create AIR File.
For more information, see the dialog box options listed below.
The first time you create an Adobe AIR file, Dreamweaver creates an application.xml file in your site root folder.
This file serves as a manifest, defining various properties of the application.
The following describes the options in the AIR Application and Installer Settings dialog box:
Application File Name is the name used for the application executable file. By default, the extension uses the name
of the Dreamweaver site to name the file. You can change the name if you prefer. However, the name must contain
only valid characters for files or folder names. (That is, it can only contain ASCII characters, and cannot end with a
period.) This setting is required.
Application Name is the name that appears on installation screens when users install the application. Again, the
extension specifies the name of the Dreamweaver site by default. This setting does not have character restrictions,
and is not required.
Application ID identifies your application with a unique ID. You can change the default ID if you prefer. Do not use
spaces or special characters in the ID. The only valid characters are 0-9, a-z, A-Z, . (dot), and - (dash). This setting
is required.
Version specifies a version number for your application. This setting is required.
Initial Content specifies the start page for your application. Click the Browse button to navigate to your start page
and select it. The chosen file must reside inside the site root folder. This setting is required.
Description lets you specify a description of the application to display when the user installs the application.
Copyright lets you specify a copyright that is displayed in the About information for Adobe AIR applications
installed on the Macintosh. This information is not used for applications installed on Windows.
Window Style specifies the window style (or chrome) to use when the user runs the application on their computer.
System chrome surrounds the application with the operating system standard window control. Custom chrome
(opaque) eliminates the standard system chrome and lets you create a chrome of your own for the application. (You
build the custom chrome directly in the packaged HTML page.) Custom chrome (transparent) is like Custom
chrome (opaque), but adds transparent capabilities to the edges of the page, allowing for application windows that
are not rectangular in shape.
Window Size specifies the dimensions of your application window when it opens.
Icon lets you select custom images for the application icons. (The default images are Adobe AIR images that come
with the extension.) To use custom images, click the Select Icon Images button. Then, in the Icon Images dialog box
that appears, click the folder for each icon size and select the image file you want to use. AIR only supports PNG
files for application icon images.
Note: Selected custom images must reside in the application site, and their paths must be relative to the site root.
Associated File Types lets you associate file types with your application. For more information, see the section that
follows.
Application Updates determines whether the Adobe AIR Application Installer or the application itself performs
updates to new versions of Adobe AIRapplications. The check box is selected by default, which causes the Adobe
AIR Application Installer to perform updates. If you want your application to perform its own updates, deselect the
checkbox. Keep in mind that if you deselect the checkbox, you then need to write an application that can perform
updates.
442
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
Included Files specifies which files or folders to include in your application. You can add HTML and CSS files,
image files, and JavaScript library files. Click the Plus (+) button to add files, and the folder icon to add folders. You
should not include certain files such as _mmServerScripts, _notes, and so on. To delete a file or folder from your
list, select the file or folder and click the Minus (-) button.
Digital Signature Click Set to sign your application with a digital signature. This setting is required. For more
information, see the section that follows.
Program Menu Folder specifies a subdirectory in the Windows Start Menu where you want the applications
shortcut created. (Not applicable on Macintosh.)
Destination specifies where to save the new application installer (.air file). The default location is the site root. Click
the Browse button to select a different location. The default file name is based on the site name with an .air extension
added to it. This setting is required.
The following is an example of the dialog box with some basic options set:
443
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
Signing an application with a digital certificate
A digital signature provides an assurance that the code for an application has not been altered or corrupted since its
creation by the software author. All Adobe AIR applications require a digital signature, and can’t be installed without
one. You can sign your application with a purchased digital certificate, create your own certificate, or prepare an Adobe
AIRI file (an Adobe AIR intermediate file) that youll sign at a later time.
1In the AIR Application and Installer Settings dialog box, click the Set button next to the Digital Signature option.
2In the Digital Signature dialog box, do one of the following:
To sign an application with a pre-purchased digital certificate, click the Browse button, select the certificate, enter
the corresponding password, and click OK.
To create your own self-signed digital certificate, click the Create button and complete the dialog box. The
certificate Type option refers to the level of security: 1024-RSA uses a 1024-bit key (less secure), and 2048-RSA
uses a 2048-bit key (more secure). When youre finished click OK. Then enter the corresponding password in the
Digital Signature dialog box and click OK.
Select Prepare an AIRI package that will be signed later and click OK. This option lets you create an AIR
Intermediate (AIRI) application without a digital signature. A user is not able to install the application, however,
until you add a digital signature.
About Timestamping
When you sign an Adobe AIR application with a digital certificate, the packaging tool queries the server of a timestamp
authority to obtain an independently verifiable date and time of signing. The timestamp obtained is embedded in the
AIR file. As long as the signing certificate is valid at the time of signing, the AIR file can be installed, even after the
certificate has expired. On the other hand, if no timestamp is obtained, the AIR file ceases to be installable when the
certificate expires or is revoked.
By default, the Adobe AIR Extension for Dreamweaver obtains a timestamp when creating an Adobe AIR application.
You can, however, turn timestamping off by deselecting the Timestamp option in the Digital Signature dialog box. (You
might want to do this, for example, if a timestamping service is unavailable.) Adobe recommends that all publically
distributed AIR files include a timestamp.
The default timestamp authority used by the AIR packaging tools is Geotrust. For more information on timestamping
and digital certificates, see Digitally signing an AIR file.
Editing associated AIR file types
You can associate different file types with your Adobe AIR application. For example, if you want file types with an .avf
extension to open in Adobe AIR when a user double-clicks them, you can add the .avf extension to your list of
associated file types.
1In the AIR Application and Installer Settings dialog box, click the Edit list button next to the Associated File Types
option.
2In the Associated File Types dialog box, do one of the following:
Select a file type and click the minus (-) button to delete the file type.
Click the plus (+) button to add a file type.
If you click the plus button to add a file type, the File Type Settings dialog box appears. Complete the dialog box
and click OK to close it.
Following is a list of options:
444
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
Namespecifies the name of the file type that appears in the Associated File Types list. This option is required, and
can only include alphanumeric ASCII characters (a-z, A-Z, 0-9) and dots (for example, adobe.VideoFile). The
name must start with a letter. The maximum length is 38 characters.
Extensionspecifies the extension of the file type. Do not include a preceding dot. This option is required, and
can only include alphanumeric ASCII characters (a-z, A-Z, 0-9). The maximum length is 38 characters.
Descriptionlets you specify an optional description for the file type.
Content Typespecifies the MIME type or media type for the file (for example text/html, image/gif, and so on).
Icon File Locationslets you select custom images for the associated file types. (The default images are Adobe AIR
images that come with the extension.)
Editing AIR application settings
You can edit the settings for your Adobe AIR application at any time.
Select Site > AIR Application Settings and make your changes.
Previewing a web page in an AIR application
You can preview an HTML page in Dreamweaver as it would appear in an Adobe AIR application. Previewing is useful
when you want to see what a web page will look like in the application without having to create the entire application.
On the Document toolbar, click the Preview/Debug in Browser button, and then select Preview In AIR.
You can also press Ctrl+Shift+F12 (Windows) or Cmd+Shift+F12 (Macintosh).
Using AIR code hinting and code coloring
The Adobe AIR Extension for Dreamweaver also adds code hinting and code coloring for Adobe AIR language
elements in Code view in Dreamweaver.
Open an HTML or JavaScript file in Code view and enterAdobe AIR code.
Note: The code hinting mechanism only works inside <script> tags, or in .js files.
For more information on the Adobe AIR language elements, see the developer documentation in the rest of this
guide.
Accessing the Adobe AIR documentation
The Adobe AIR extension adds a Help menu item in Dreamweaver that lets you access Developing AIR Applications
with HTML and Ajax.
Select Help > Adobe AIR Help.
Using Dreamweaver with Adobe Online services
Adobe online services are hosted web applications that work similarly to traditional desktop tools. The advantage of
online services, however, is that they are always up to date because they are hosted on the web, as opposed to on your
computer.
445
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
Dreamweaver integrates directly with Adobe® BrowserLab and Adobe® Business Catalyst InContext Editing. Help for
working with those services is included in the Help sections that follow.
Dreamweaver also integrates with Adobe® CS Live online services (which includes BrowserLab). For more information
on working with CS Live, see Using Adobe CS Live.
For information on managing Adobe online services, see the Adobe website at
www.adobe.com/go/learn_creativeservices_en.
BrowserLab
Adobe BrowserLab lets you preview local web content from within Dreamweaver, without requiring you to post it to a
publicly-accessible server first. You can preview files from your local Dreamweaver site, or from a remote or testing
server.
For information about using the BrowserLab online service, including information about using BrowserLab with
Dreamweaver, see www.adobe.com/go/lr_abl_en.
Business Catalyst InContext Editing
Business Catalyst InContext Editing
Adobe Business Catalyst InContext Editing is an editing component of Adobe Business Catalyst that lets users make
simple content changes within a web browser. To change a web page, users simply browse to the page, log into
InContext Editing, and edit the page. The editing options are simple and elegant, and using them requires no previous
knowledge of HTML code or web editing.
Before you enable users to make live changes on the web, however, you use Dreamweaver to make your HTML pages
editable. You do this by specifying regions on the page that you want to allow users to edit. For example, you might have
a news page with titles and blurbs for articles. You can select this content and then transform it into an InContext
Editing editable region so that when a user logs into InContext Editing, they can edit the titles and blurbs directly in a
browser.
This documentation tells you how to work with InContext Editing editable regions in Dreamweaver; but Adobe also
provides other resources to help you work with InContext Editing:
For documentation on using InContext Editing to edit pages in a browser, see
www.adobe.com/go/learn_dw_incontextediting_browser_en.
For documentation on working with the InContext Editing Administration Panel, see
www.adobe.com/go/learn_dw_incontextediting_administration_guide_en.
For more information about Adobe Business Catalyst, visit www.businesscatalyst.com.
Note: Adobe AIR does not support Adobe Business Catalyst InContext Editing. If you use the AIR Extension for
Dreamweaver to export an application that contains InContext Editing regions, the InContext Editing functionality will
not work.
Create an InContext Editing editable region
An InContext Editing editable region is a pair of HTML tags that includes the ice:editable attribute in the opening tag.
The editable region defines an area on the page that a user can edit directly in a browser.
446
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: If you are adding an InContext Editing editable region to a page that’s based on a Dreamweaver template, the new
InContext Editing editable region must exist within a region that is already editable.
1Do one of the following:
Select a div, th, or td tag that you want to transform into an editable region.
Place the insertion point where you want to insert a new editable region on the page.
Select exactly one editable region in a Dreamweaver template (DWT file).
Select other content on your page that you want to make editable (for example, a block of text).
2Choose Insert > InContext Editing > Create Editable Region.
3Your options vary, depending on your selection.
If you selected a div, th, or td tag, Dreamweaver transforms the tag into an editable region without any further
steps.
If you’re inserting a new, blank editable region do one of the following:
Select Insert New Editable Region at the Current Insertion Point and click OK. Dreamweaver inserts a div tag
in your code with the ice:editable attribute in the opening tag.
Select Transform the Parent Tag Into an Editable Region if you want Dreamweaver to make the parent tag of
the selection the container element for the region. Only certain HTML tags are transformable: div, th, and td.
Note: This second option is only available when the parent node meets the exact criteria for transformation. For
example, it must be one of the listed transformable tags, and it must not be subject to any of the errors listed in InContext
Editing Error messages.
If you selected a Dreamweaver template editable region, click OK in the Create Editable Region dialog box.
Dreamweaver wraps the template editable region with a div tag that acts as a container for the new InContext
Editing editable region.
If you selected other content that you want to make editable, do one of the following:
Select Wrap Current Selection With a DIV Tag and Then Transform It if you want to wrap whatever you selected
with a div tag and turn it into an editable region. The div tag with which Dreamweaver wraps the content acts as
the container for the editable region.
Note: Adding div tags to pages might alter page rendering and the effects of CSS rules. For example, if you have a CSS
rule that applies a red border around div tags, you would see a red border around your current selection when
Dreamweaver wraps it with a div tag and transforms it. If you want to avoid this type of conflict, you can rewrite the
CSS rules that affect the current selection, or you can undo the transformation (Edit > Undo), and then select and
transform a supported tag that Dreamweaver doesn’t need to wrap with a div tag.
Select Transform the Parent Tag Into an Editable Region if you want Dreamweaver to make the parent tag of the
selection the container element for the editable region. Only certain HTML tags are transformable: div, th, and
td.
4In Design view, click the blue tab of the editable region to select it if it’s not already selected.
Note: If you are working in a Dreamweaver template, be sure to select the InContext Editing editable region (the
container region), and not the Dreamweaver template editable region.
5Select or deselect options in the Editable Regions Property inspector. The options you select will be available to a
user when they edit the contents of the editable region in a browser. For example, if you select the Bold option, the
user will be able to make text bold; if you select the Numbered List and Bulleted List option, the user will be able to
create numbered and bulleted lists; if you select the Link option, the user will be able to create links; and so on. Hover
over the icon of each option to see a tooltip of what the option enables.
447
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
6Save the page.
If this is the first time youre adding InContext Editing functionality to a page, Dreamweaver informs you that it is
adding InContext Editing supporting files to your site: ice.conf.js, ice.js, and ide.html. Be sure to upload these files
to the server when you upload your page, otherwise InContext Editing functionality will not work in a browser.
Create an InContext Editing repeating region
An InContext Editing repeating region is a pair of HTML tags that includes the ice:repeating attribute in the opening
tag. The repeating region defines an area on the page that a user can “repeat” and add content to when editing in a
browser. For example, if you have a heading and a paragraph of text that follows it, you can transform these elements
into a repeating region that a user can then duplicate on a page.
In addition to adding repeating regions based on the original region, you can also give the user the option to delete
regions, add completely new regions (not based on the content of the original region), and to move the regions up or
down.
When you create a repeating region, Dreamweaver wraps it in another container called a repeating regions group. This
container—a div tag with the ice:repeatinggroup attribute added to the opening tag—acts as the container for all of the
editable repeating regions that a user might add to the group. You cannot move repeating regions outside of their
repeating regions group containers. Additionally, you should not manually add repeating regions group tags to your
page. Dreamweaver adds them for you automatically when necessary.
Note: When creating a repeating region from a table row (tr tag), Dreamweaver applies the repeating regions group
attribute to the parent tag (for example, the table tag), and does not insert a div tag.
If you are working on a page that already contains a repeating regions group, and you try to add a repeating region
immediately after the existing group, Dreamweaver detects that a repeating regions group precedes the region you are
trying to add, and gives you the option of adding the new region to the existing group. You can choose to add the new
repeating region to the existing group, or create an entirely new repeating regions group.
Note: If you are adding an InContext Editing repeating region to a page that’s based on a Dreamweaver template, the new
InContext Editing repeating region must exist within a region that is already editable.
448
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
To create a repeating region in Dreamweaver, follow these steps.
1Do one of the following:
Select a tag that you want to transform into a repeating region. The list of possible tags is extensive: a, abbr,
acronym, address, b, big, blockquote, center, cite, code, dd, dfn, dir, div, dl, dt, em, font, h1, h2, h3, h4, h5, h6, hr,
i, img, ins, kbd, label, li, menu, ol, p, pre, q, s, samp, small, span, strike, strong, sub, sup, table, tbody, tr, tt, u, ul,
and var.
Note: Only div tags can contain the editable region and repeating region attributes simultaneously.
Place the insertion point where you want to insert a new repeating region on the page.
Select exactly one repeating region in a Dreamweaver template (DWT file).
Select other content on your page that you want to make repeatable (for example, a heading and a block of text).
2Choose Insert > InContext Editing > Create Repeating Region.
3Your options vary, depending on your selection.
If you selected a transformable tag, Dreamweaver transforms the tag into a repeating region without any further
steps.
If youre inserting a new, blank repeating region, do one of the following:
Select Insert New Repeating Region at the Current Insertion Point and click OK.
Select Transform the Parent Tag Into a Repeating Region if you want Dreamweaver to make the parent tag of
the selection the container element for the region. Only certain HTML tags are transformable: a, abbr,
acronym, address, b, big, blockquote, center, cite, code, dd, dfn, dir, div, dl, dt, em, font, h1, h2, h3, h4, h5, h6,
hr, i, img, ins, kbd, label, li, menu, ol, p, pre, q, s, samp, small, span, strike, strong, sub, sup, table, tbody, tr, tt,
u, ul, and var.
Note: This second option is only available when the parent node meets the exact criteria for transformation. For
example, it must be one of the listed transformable tags, and it must not be subject to any of the errors listed in InContext
Editing Error messages.
If you selected a Dreamweaver template repeating region, click OK in the Create Repeating Region dialog box.
Dreamweaver wraps the template repeating region with a div tag that acts as a container for the new InContext
Editing repeating region.
If you selected other content that you want to make repeatable, do one of the following:
Select Wrap Current Selection With a DIV Tag and Then Transform It if you want to wrap whatever you
selected with a div tag and turn it into a repeating region. The div tag with which Dreamweaver wraps the
content acts as the container for the repeating region.
Select Transform the Parent Tag Into a Repeating Region if you want Dreamweaver to make the parent tag of
the selection the container element for the repeating region. Only certain HTML tags are transformable: a,
abbr, acronym, address, b, big, blockquote, center, cite, code, dd, dfn, dir, div, dl, dt, em, font, h1, h2, h3, h4,
h5, h6, hr, i, img, ins, kbd, label, li, menu, ol, p, pre, q, s, samp, small, span, strike, strong, sub, sup, table, tbody,
tr, tt, u, ul, and var.
4In Design view, click the blue tab of the repeating region to select it if its not already selected. Notice that
Dreamweaver actually forces you to select the tab for the repeating regions group. This is because all repeating
regions exist within a repeating regions group, and you must set options for repeating regions by setting options for
the entire group.
449
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
5Select or deselect options in the Repeating Regions Group Property inspector. Two options are available: Reorder
and Add/Remove. When you select Reorder, users will be able to move repeating regions up or down when editing
in a browser. When you select Add/Remove, users will be able to add or remove repeating regions when editing in
a browser. Both options are selected by default, and you must always have at least one of them selected.
6Save the page.
If this is the first time youre adding InContext Editing functionality to a page, Dreamweaver informs you that it is
adding InContext Editing supporting files to your site: ice.conf.js, ice.js, and ide.html. Be sure to upload these files
to the server when you upload your page, otherwise InContext Editing functionality will not work in a browser.
Delete a region
It’s best to delete a region by using the regions Property inspector. Using the regions Property inspector ensures that
you delete all of the code associated with the region.
1Select an editable region, a repeating region, or a repeating regions group.
2In the regions Property inspector, click the Remove Region button.
Specify CSS classes for formatting
The InContext Editing Manage Available CSS Classes feature has been deprecated as of Dreamweaver CS5.
InContext Editing Error messages
Cannot apply InContext Editing to tags containing script tags or server-side block(s) of code
If your selection contains server-side code, Dreamweaver does not allow you to transform it into an editable or
repeating region. This issue has to do with how InContext Editing saves editable pages when the user is working in the
browser. When a user saves the page after editing, InContext Editing removes server-side code from the region.
Current selection cannot be transformed or wrapped with a DIV tag because the parent node
doesn't allow DIV as child tag
When the selection you want to transform on your page cant be transformed directly, Dreamweaver needs to wrap the
selection with div tags that will act as the container for your new editable or repeating region. For this reason, the parent
tags of what you want to transform must allow div tags as children. If the parent tag of the tag youre trying to transform
doesnt permit child div tags, Dreamweaver will not allow you to perform the transformation.
Current selection already contains or is inside of an Editable Region. Nested Editable
Regions are not allowed.
If your selection is inside an editable region, or if there is an editable region within the selection, Dreamweaver does not
allow you to perform the transformation. InContext Editing does not support nested editable regions.
Editable Regions should not contain Repeating Regions or Repeating Regions Groups
InContext Editing editable regions cannot contain any other InContext Editing functionality. If you try to add a
repeating region or a repeating regions group to an editable region, Dreamweaver does not allow you to perform the
transformation.
450
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
Repeating Regions should not be inside Editable Regions or contain Repeating Regions
Groups
InContext Editing editable regions cannot contain any other InContext Editing functionality. If you try to add a
repeating region or a repeating regions group to an editable region, Dreamweaver does not allow you to perform the
transformation. Additionally, Dreamweaver will not transform an element into an editable or repeating region if it
already contains a repeating regions group.
Current selection already contains or is inside of a Repeating Region. Nested Repeating
Regions are not allowed.
If your selection is inside a repeating region, or if there is a repeating region within the selection, Dreamweaver does
not allow you to perform the transformation. InContext Editing does not support nested repeating regions.
Selection must contain exactly one Dreamweaver template editable/repeating region, or be
inside any Dreamweaver template editable region
When working with Dreamweaver template files (.dwt files), you must follow certain rules. To transform a
Dreamweaver template editable/repeating region into an InContext Editing editable/repeating region, you must select
exactly one Dreamweaver template editable/repeating region on the page and then transform it. To transform another
selection on the page (for example, a block of text), the selection must be within a Dreamweaver template editable
region.
Only DIV tags can have both Editable Region and Repeating Region functionality applied at
the same time
If your selection is not a div tag, and already has a repeating region attribute applied to it, Dreamweaver will not allow
you to apply the editable region attribute to that tag as well. Only div tags can have the editable region and repeating
region attributes applied simultaneously.
Dreamweaver detected that a Repeating Regions Group tag precedes the Repeating Region
All InContext Editing repeating regions must exist within a repeating regions group. When you add a new repeating
region to a page, Dreamweaver detects if there is already a repeating regions group immediately before it. If there is,
Dreamweaver gives you the option of adding the new repeating region to the repeating regions group that is already
there, or creating a new repeating regions group to contain the new repeating region.
451
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
Extract in Dreamweaver CC
Extract integration with Dreamweaver lets web designers and developers apply design information and extract web-
optimized assets directly within the coding environment. Extract provides a complete, self-contained solution for
extracting style information and assets from PSD comps, reducing the need to go back and forth between Photoshop
and Dreamweaver.
With the Extract panel in Dreamweaver, you can extract CSS, images, fonts, colors, gradients, and measurements, right
into your web page. In addition to these primary Extract features, Dreamweaver also provides the following unique
features:
Direct access to your PSD files on Creative Cloud and to those PSD files that are shared
with you in a collaborative folder
Contextual code hinting to easily define fonts, colors, and gradients in your CSS
Drag-and-drop support to create image tags from PSD layers
Paste styles directly into Live View (for example, CSS Designer and Element Display)
452
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
Getting started with Extract
Extract in Dreamweaver lets you access your PSD files directly from within the Extract panel in Dreamweaver. Read
the following topics to know more about the Extract panel and workspace, and about loading your PSD files in the
Extract panel:
Extract panel and workspace
Upload PSD files to Creative Cloud
Open PSD files in Extract panel
Getting started with Extract Set Extract preferences Extract CSS
Copy text
Extract images Extract measurements Extract fonts, colors,
and gradients
453
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
Hands-on tutorial
Extract a Photoshop design into code in Dreamweaver
(Try-it, 13 min)
Extract panel and workspace
The Extract workspace is designed to help you use Extract with Dreamweaver effectively. In this workspace, the Extract
panel appears on the left and your web page appears on the right in split view (Live and Code Views). You can customize
the workspace by dragging, docking, collapsing, or expanding panels to suit your needs. You can also save the
customized workspace for future use.
Note: If you happen to close the Extract panel, use the keyboard shortcut - Ctrl + K (Win); Cmd + K (Mac), or select
Window > Extract to open the panel again.
Upon the first launch of Dreamweaver, the Extract panel displays an interactive tutorial to get you started with the
workflows. You can use the drop-down list at the top of the panel to switch between different tutorials.
After you have used the tutorial, you can click Get Started to begin using Extract in Dreamweaver. The Extract panel
displays a thumbnail view of folders and PSD files in your Creative Cloud account. These files are those that are either
uploaded or synced from your desktop, or those that are shared with you through a collaborative folder on Creative
Cloud.
454
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
To relaunch the tutorial, click the pop-up menu on the upper right corner of the panel and select Launch Tutorial.
Upload PSD files to Creative Cloud
You can upload a PSD file to your Creative Cloud by clicking the Upload PSD icon in the Extract panel. If the PSD
comps are developed by another person or team, you can have them shared on Creative Cloud. You can then download
the files, and upload them to your account either directly by logging in to Creative Cloud or through the Extract panel
in Dreamweaver.
Open PSD files in Extract panel
Click the thumbnail image of the required PSD file in the Extract panel. If an updated version of the PSD file becomes
available on Creative Cloud after you open it, reload the PSD file in the Extract panel. To do so, click the name of the
PSD file or click Reload PSD in pop-up menu on upper right. To go back to the thumbnail view and select a different
file, click the Creative Cloud icon on the upper left of the panel.
To magnify the view and take a closer look at the design, change the zoom level at the top of the Extract panel or use
Alt +/-. Use the Layers tab or the Layer Comp drop-down list to show or hide elements in the PSD file.
You are now all set to translate the PSD comp to a website.
Set Extract preferences
Using Extract preferences, you can specify the default file format in which the images must be extracted and also, the
default unit for fonts that is to be displayed in the Extract panel.
1Select Edit > Preferences (Win) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Mac).
2Select Extract in the Category list.
3(Optional) Change the default format in which the images must be extracted.
455
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
4(Optional) In the Extract For Devices section, select the required resolutions. These settings will be used when you
choose to save an image in multiple resolution versions.
To save the versions with suffixes, click the corresponding row under the Suffix column, and type the text.
To save the multiple resolution versions in separate output folders, click the corresponding row under the Folder
column, and specify the relative path.
5(Optional) Click Clear Cache to delete the cached data related to Extract usage.
6Click Apply, and then close the Preferences dialog box.
7To see the changes in the Extract panel, reload the PSD (pop-up menu > Reload PSD).
Extract CSS from PSD files
You can copy all or specific CSS properties of elements in a PSD comp and directly paste the styles into CSS Designer,
Element Display in Live View, or into your code (CSS source or HTML document).
Also, code hints are automatically populated with the CSS properties of the element you select in the PSD comp. If you
prefer coding, you can use these code hints to extract the CSS properties into the code.
1In the Extract panel (Window > Extract), click the required PSD file. The thumbnail view of the PSD expands,
allowing you to view the comp clearly.
2In the PSD file, click the required elment or asset. A popup with a list of CSS properties of the element appears and
provides you the option to select and copy them. You can view the width and height of the selected element in pixels
or percentage.
456
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: If you choose percentage here, the measurements too will be displayed in percentage units.
To copy CSS, select the properties you want to copy, and then click Copy CSS.
3Paste the CSS in your document using one of the following methods:
To paste the CSS in CSS Designer, right-click the required selector, and click Paste Styles.
To paste the CSS using Element Display, right-click a selector, and click Paste Styles.
To paste the CSS in the code, place the insertion point at the required location, right-click, and click Paste.
To use code hints for extracting CSS, perform the following steps:
1Open a CSS source attached to your document or switch to the Code View of an HTML document.
2In the Extract panel, click the required PSD file, and then the required element in the comp.
3In your document, place the insertion point at the required location in the code.
4Start typing the name of a CSS property to see the code hints containing the CSS properties of the selected element
in the PSD comp. Click the required CSS property to insert into the code.
457
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
5To extract multiple CSS properties, select the required properties in the Extract panel popup. Then, in code hints,
click Insert Selected.
Copy text from PSD files
Text or content in your PSD comps can be inserted into your web page with a single click. To copy text from your PSD
comp in the Extract panel, select a text element and click Copy Text. The text is copied to your clipboard. You can then
paste the text wherever required.
458
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
After you have extracted the text, you can extract properties, such as, font and colors that are associated with the text.
For more information, see Extract fonts, colors, and gradients from PSD files .
Extract images from PSD files
You can simply drag any layer in your PSD comps from the Extract panel to a precise location in the Live view of your
web page. Visual aids in Live View such as Live Guides and DOM icon help drag and place an element. When you pause
for a while before dropping the element, the DOM icon (</>) appears. The DOM structure is displayed when you hover
your mouse over the </> icon and you can drop the element inside the structure. If you prefer coding, you can use the
contextual code hinting and extract images. Code hints allow you to extract colors and gradients as images.
Before inserting the extracted image, Dreamweaver displays the image name, which you can edit. By default, the image
is saved in the site root folder. If you want to save the image in a custom location, you can include the complete directory
path along with the filename.
Note: If you are extracting an image into a document that does not belong to a defined site, the image is extracted into
the directory in which the document exists. For unsaved documents, you are prompted to first save the document.
You can also save the image on your local disk and call it into your web page at a later point in time. Also, if you are
designing a responsive website, you can save multiple resolution versions of an image for devices with a single click.
1In the Extract panel, click the PSD file from which you want to download the images.
2Click the required image in the PSD file.
Note: Use the Layers tab and the Layer Comps drop-down list in the Extract panel to show or hide images in the PSD
comp. If an image consists of multiple layers, you can select individual layer of the image to extract.
Notice that the code hints popup in the Code View on the right side of the workspace.
3To import multiple images, hold down the Shift or the Command key, and click the required images. The selected
images are extracted as a single image.
4Perform one of the following actions:
In the popup that appears when you click the image, click . Specify the path, filename, file format, and scaling
factor (if required). Then, perform one of the following actions:
Click Save to save the image at 1x resolution. To scale the image, select Scale At, and specify the scaling factor.
Click Save Multiple to save multiple resolution versions of the image. The PSD file need not necessarily
contain these versions; Dreamweaver can save the image in multiple resolutions during extraction.
You can specify the required resolution versions and the corresponding output folder in Preferences ( ).
459
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
Drag the image into the Live View of your document. Live Guides appear in the Live View to help you position
the image.
When you drop the image, Dreamweaver displays the name of the image. You can not only edit the name of the
image, but also the extension, and press Enter to save the image. The image is saved in the site root folder by default.
To save the image in a custom location, enter the path along with the filename.
460
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
When you click the image, contextual code hints in Dreamweaver are populated. In the Code View of your
HTML document or in your CSS document, place the cursor at the insertion point. After you type the
background-image property name or the <img> tag, the name of the selected image appears in the code hints.
Select the image, modify the name and extension if required, and press Enter.
By default, the image is saved in the site root folder. To save the image in a custom location, enter the custom file
path along with the filename.
461
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
Extract measurements from PSD files
Using the Extract panel, you can easily view and extract the measurement value between any two elements in the PSD
comp.
1In the PSD file in the Extract panel, click the required elements by holding down the Shift or the Command key.
The Extract panel displays the horizontal and vertical distance between the two elements.
Note: To view the measurements in percentage units, click any element and then click percentage.
2Click the required value to copy it to the clipboard.
3Paste the value wherever required, for example, in the CSS properties of CSS Designer or in your code.
Extract fonts, colors, and gradients from PSD files
Using the Extract panel, you can extract the CSS properties of fonts, colors, or gradients used in your PSD comp.
1In the Extract panel, click Styles.
2To extract fonts, perform the following actions in the Fonts section.
aExpand the required font type.
To know more about the font, click the Adobe TypeKit icon ( ).
bClick the format and size that you want to copy, and in the popup that appears, click Copy CSS. Extract tags the
text elements that use the font, format, and size that you clicked.
462
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: You can change the unit of the font to 'em' or 'rem' in Extract preferences (Preferences > Extract). Click Reload
PSD in the pop-up menu on the upper right corner of the Extract panel to see the changes.
cPaste the CSS wherever required, for example, in the code or CSS Designer.
3To extract colors, perform the following actions in the Colors section:
aClick the required color swatch. Extract tags the elements that use the selected color.
Note: You can also pick any other color from the PSD comp using the color picker.
bIn the popup that appears when you click the color swatch, select the required color model (RGB, Hex, or HSL),
and then copy (Ctrl+c; Cmd+c) the color value.
cPaste the color value wherever required, for example, in the code or CSS Designer.
463
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
4To extract gradients, click a gradient swatch in the Gradients section. In the popup that appears, click Copy CSS.
Paste the CSS wherever required, for example, in the code or in CSS Designer.
Vendor prefixes that are selected in the preferences (Preferences > CSS Styles) are also pasted along with the
gradients. If you extract a radial gradient, the corresponding CSS is inserted without a vendor prefix since radial
gradients are not supported.
Dreamweaver-Business Catalyst integration
Note: Business Catalyst extension for Dreamweaver is unavailable in Dreamweaver CC 2015 release and later. For
information on using Business Catalyst with Dreamweaver, see the Business Catalyst documentation.
Business Catalyst is a hosted application for building and managing online businesses. Using this unified platform and
without back-end coding, you can build everything from websites to powerful online stores.
Dreamweaver's integration with Business Catalyst allows you to create and update a Business Catalyst site in
Dreamweaver. After you create a Business Catalyst site, you can connect to the Business Catalyst server. The server
provides you with files and templates that you can use to build your site.
Install the Business Catalyst add-on
To install the add-on, go to Window > Browse Add-Ons. The Adobe Creative Cloud Add-Ons page appears. Search for
the Business Catalyst add-on and follow the on-screen instructions to install the add-on.
Important: Before installing add-ons, ensure that you have enabled file sync for your Adobe Creative Cloud account.
See Enable file sync on Adobe Creative Cloud for more details.
464
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
Create a temporary Business Catalyst site
1Select Site > Manage Sites.
2Click New Business Catalyst Site.
3Sign in using your Adobe ID credentials.
4Enter your date of birth and click Update.
5In the Create Temporary Site dialog, enter the details for your site, and click Create Free Temporary Site.
Note: Emails related to your Business Catalyst account details are sent to you after you create your site. These emails
contain information of your site such as getting started information, the URL of the site that you created and that of the
administration site.
6Choose a folder on your computer for the local site.
Note: If you click Cancel, the site is created in Business Catalyst but is not displayed in Dreamweaver. The same scenario
occurs if there is a network problem while creating a Business Catalyst site.
7Enter the password associated with your Adobe ID.
8When the file activity is complete, click Done.
9Select Window > File. The local view of the site that you created is displayed.
10 Select Remote Server from the menu.
11 Enter the Adobe ID associated with your password.
The file structure on the remote server is displayed.
Import a Business Catalyst site
For information on migrating sites that you previously created using the Business Catalyst extension, see Migrating
Business Catalyst sites to Dreamweaver CS6.
1Select Site > Manage Sites.
2Click Import Business Catalyst Site. The list of Business Catalyst sites you created with the Adobe ID is displayed.
3Select the site, and click Import Site.
4For the site that you are trying to import, specify a location on your computer.
5Enter the password related to your Adobe ID.
6When the file activity is complete, click Done.
Manage files
Because Business Catalyst is also a web hosting service, you can use Dreamweaver to manage local and remote site files.
For more information, see the following topics:
Managing files and folders
Getting and putting files to and from your server
Checking in and checking out files
465
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
Insert modules, data, or snippets
1Select Window > Business Catalyst to open the Business Catalyst panel.
2Do one of the following:
To insert a Business Catalyst module, select the Modules tab.
To insert tags, select the Data tab. Tags are displayed if you are editing files that support tags such as the
affiliate.html page in the Layouts/Affiliate/ folder.
3Expand the module and click the module that you want to add to the file.
4Provide the required information, and click Insert.
5If your current site uses the new rendering engine, the Snippets tab is displayed. Using the options in the Snippet
tab, you can add code snippets, such as repeating and conditional regions, comment sections, and include (works
similar to server-side include).
6Click Live to preview the page as it would appear in a web browser.
Edit properties of Business Catalyst objects
Similar to editing other objects on a web page, you can use the Property inspector to edit properties of objects in
Business Catalyst modules.
If you don’t see the options to edit properties, check whether you have permissions to edit the file. Also, for some
modules, you can edit the page only on the online Admin website.
Import Microsoft Office documents (Windows only)
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
You can insert the full contents of a Microsoft Word or Excel document in a new or existing web page. When you import
a Word or Excel document, Dreamweaver receives the converted HTML and inserts it into your web page. The files
size, after Dreamweaver receives the converted HTML, must be less than 300K.
Instead of importing the entire contents of a file, you can also paste portions of a Word document and preserve the
formatting.
Note: If you use Microsoft Office 97, you cannot import the contents of a Word or Excel document; you must insert a link
to the document.
1Open the web page into which you want to insert the Word or Excel document.
2In Design view, do one of the following to select the file:
Drag the file from its current location to the page where you want the content to appear.
Select File > Import > Word Document or File > Import > Excel Document.
3In the Insert Document dialog box, browse to the file you want to add, select any of the formatting options from the
Formatting pop-up menu at the bottom of the dialog box, and then click Open.
Text Only Inserts unformatted text. If the original text is formatted, all formatting will be removed.
466
Cross-product
Last updated 6/3/2015
Text With Structure Inserts text that retains structure, but does not retain basic formatting. For example, you can
paste text and retain the structure of paragraphs, lists, and tables, without retaining bold, italics, and other
formatting.
Text With Structure Plus Basic Formatting Inserts both structured and simple HTML-formatted text (e.g.,
paragraphs and tables, as well as text formatted with the b, i, u, strong, em, hr, abbr, or acronym tag).
Text With Structure Plus Full Formatting Inserts text that retains all structure, HTML formatting, and CSS styles.
Clean Up Word Paragraph Spacing Eliminates extra space between paragraphs when you paste your text if you
selected Text With Structure or Basic Formatting.
The contents of the Word or Excel document appear in your page.
467
Last updated 6/3/2015
Chapter 13: Templates
About Dreamweaver templates
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Understanding Dreamweaver templates
A template is a special type of document that you use to design a “fixed” page layout; you can then create documents
based on the template that inherit its page layout. As you design a template, you specify as “editable” which content
users can edit in a document based on that template. Templates enable template authors to control which page elements
template users—such as writers, graphic artists, or other web developers—can edit. There are several types of template
regions the template author can include in a document.
Note: Templates enable you to control a large design area and reuse complete layouts. If you want to reuse individual design
elements, such as a sites copyright information or a logo, create library items.
Using templates enables you to update multiple pages at once. A document that is created from a template remains
connected to that template (unless you detach the document later). You can modify a template and immediately update
the design in all documents based on it.
Note: Templates in Dreamweaver differ from templates in some other Adobe Creative Suite software in that page sections
of Dreamweaver templates are fixed (or uneditable) by default.
Types of template regions
When you save a document as a template, most regions of a document are locked. As a template author, you specify
which regions of a template-based document will be editable by inserting editable regions or editable parameters in the
template.
As you create the template, you can make changes to both editable and locked regions. In a document based on the
template, however, a template user can make changes only in the editable regions; the locked regions can’t be modified.
There are four types of template regions:
An editable region An unlocked region in a template-based document—a section a template user can edit. A template
author can specify any area of a template as editable. For a template to be effective, it should contain at least one editable
region; otherwise, pages based on the template can’t be edited.
A repeating region A section of the document layout that is set so that the template user can add or delete copies of the
repeating region in a document based on the template as necessary. For example, you can set a table row to repeat.
Repeating sections are editable so that the template user can edit the content in the repeating element, while the design
itself is under the control of the template author.
There are two types of repeating regions you can insert in a template: repeating region and repeating table.
An optional region A section of a template that holds content—such as text or an image—that may or may not appear
in a document. In the template-based page, the template user usually controls whether the content is displayed.
468
Templates
Last updated 6/3/2015
An editable tag attribute Lets you unlock a tag attribute in a template, so the attribute can be edited in a template-based
page. For example, you can “lock” which image appears in the document but let the template user set the alignment to
left, right, or center.
Links in templates
When you create a template file by saving an existing page as a template, the new template in the Templates folder, and
any links in the file are updated so that their document-relative paths are correct. Later, when you create a document
based on that template and save it, all the document-relative links are updated again to continue to point to the correct
files.
When you add a new document-relative link to a template file, its easy to enter the wrong path name if you type the
path into the link text box in the Property inspector. The correct path in a template file is the path from the Templates
folder to the linked document, not the path from the template-based document’s folder to the linked document. Ensure
that the correct paths for links exist by using either the folder icon or the Point-to-file icon in the Property inspector
when creating links in templates.
Dreamweaver 8.01 link update preference
Previous to Dreamweaver 8 (that is, Dreamweaver MX 2004 and earlier), Dreamweaver did not update links to files that
resided in the Templates folder. (For example, if you had a file called main.css in the Templates folder, and had written
href="main.css" as a link in the template file, Dreamweaver would not update this link when creating a template-based
page.)
Some users took advantage of the way Dreamweaver treated links to files in the Templates folder, and used this
inconsistency to create links that they intentionally did not want to update when creating template-based pages. For
example, if you are using Dreamweaver MX 2004, and have a site with different folders for different applications—
Dreamweaver, Flash, and Photoshop. Each product folder contains a template-based index.html page, and a unique
version of the main.css file at the same level. If the template file contains the document-relative link href="main.css" (a
link to a version of the main.css file in the Templates folder), and you want your template-based index.html pages also
to contain this link as written, you can create the template-based index.html pages without having to worry about
Dreamweaver updating those particular links. When Dreamweaver MX 2004 creates the template-based index.html
pages, the (un-updated) href="main.css" links refer to the main.css files that reside in the Dreamweaver, Flash, and
Photoshop folders, not to the main.css file that resides in the Templates folder.
In Dreamweaver 8, however, this behavior was changed so that all document-relative links are updated when creating
template-based pages, regardless of the apparent location of the linked files. In this scenario, Dreamweaver examines
the link in the template file (href="main.css") and creates a link in the template-based page that is relative to the location
of the new document. For example, if you are creating a template-based document one level up from the Templates
folder, Dreamweaver would write the link in the new document as href="Templates/main.css". This update in
Dreamweaver 8 broke links in pages created by those designers who had taken advantage of Dreamweavers former
practice of not updating links to files in the Templates folder.
Dreamweaver 8.01 added a preference that enables you to turn the update relative links behavior on and off. (This
special preference only applies to links to files in the Templates folder, not to links in general.) The default behavior is
to not update these links (as in Dreamweaver MX 2004 and before), but if you want Dreamweaver to update these kinds
of links when creating template-based pages, you can deselect the preference. (You would only do this if, for example,
you had a Cascading Style Sheets (CSS) page, main.css, in your Templates folder, and you wanted a template-based
document to contain the link href="Templates/main.css"; but this is not recommended practice as only Dreamweaver
template (DWT) files should reside in the Templates folder.)
469
Templates
Last updated 6/3/2015
To have Dreamweaver update document-relative paths to non-template files in the Templates folder, select the
Templates category in the Site Setup dialog box (it’s under Advanced Settings), and deselect the Don’t Rewrite
Document Relative Paths option.
For more information, see the Dreamweaver TechNote on the Adobe website at www.adobe.com/go/f55d8739.
Server scripts in templates and template-based documents
Some server scripts are inserted at the very beginning or end of the document (before the <html> tag or after the
</html> tag). Such scripts require special treatment in templates and template-based documents. Normally, if you
make changes to script code before the <html> tag or after the </html> tag in a template, the changes are not copied to
documents based on that template. This can cause server errors if other server scripts, within the main body of the
template, depended on the scripts that are not copied. An alert warns you if you change scripts before the <html> tag
or after the </html> tag in a template.
To avoid this problem, you can insert the following code in the head section of the template:
<!-- TemplateInfo codeOutsideHTMLIsLocked="true" -->
When this code is in a template, changes to scripts before the <html> tag or after the </html> tag are copied to
documents based on that template. However, you will no longer be able to edit those scripts in documents based on the
template. Thus, you can choose to either edit these scripts in the template, or in documents based on the template, but
not both.
Template parameters
Template parameters indicate values for controlling content in documents based on a template. Use template
parameters for optional regions or editable tag attributes, or to set values you want to pass to an attached document.
For each parameter, you select a name, a data type, and a default value. Each parameter must have a unique name that
is case sensitive. They must be one of five permitted data types: text, boolean, color, URL, or number.
Template parameters are passed to the document as instance parameters. In most cases, a template user can edit the
parameter’s default value to customize what appears in a template-based document. In other cases, the template author
might determine what appears in the document, based on the value of a template expression.
Template expressions
Template expressions are statements that compute or evaluate a value.
You can use an expression to store a value and display it in a document. For example, an expression can be as simple as
the value of a parameter, such as @@(Param)@@, or complex enough to compute values which alternate the
background color in a table row, such as @@((_index & 1) ? red : blue)@@.
You can also define expressions for if and multiple-if conditions. When an expression is used in a conditional statement,
Dreamweaver evaluates it as true or false. If the condition is true, the optional region appears in the template-based
document; if it is false, it doesn’t appear.
You can define expressions in Code view or in the Optional Region dialog box when you insert an optional region.
In Code view, there are two ways to define template expressions: use the <!-- TemplateExpr expr="your expresson"-->
comment or @@(your expression)@@. When you insert the expression in the template code, an expression marker
appears in Design view. When you apply the template, Dreamweaver evaluates the expression and displays the value in
the template-based document.
470
Templates
Last updated 6/3/2015
Template expression language
The template expression language is a small subset of JavaScript, and uses JavaScript syntax and precedence rules. Use
JavaScript operators to write an expression like this:
@@(firstName+lastName)@@
The following features and operators are supported:
numeric literals, string literals (double-quote syntax only), Boolean literals (true or false)
variable reference (see the list of defined variables later in this section)
field reference (thedot operator)
unary operators: +, -, ~, !
binary operators: +, -, *, /, %, &, |, ^, &&, ||, <, <=, >, >=, ==, !=, <<, >>
conditional operator: ?:
parentheses: ()
The following data types are used: Boolean, IEEE 64-bpc floating point, string, and object. Dreamweaver templates
do not support the use of JavaScript “null” or “undefined” types. Nor do they allow scalar types to be implicitly
converted into an object; thus, the expression "abc".length would trigger an error, instead of yielding the value 3.
The only objects available are those defined by the expression object model. The following variables are defined:
_documentContains the document-level template data with a field for each parameter in the template.
_repeatOnly defined for expressions which appear inside a repeating region. Provides built-in information about
the region
_indexThe numerical index (from 0) of the current entry
_numRowsThe total number of entries in this repeating region
_isFirstTrue if the current entry is the first entry in its repeating region
_isLastTrue if the current entry is the last entry in its repeating region
_prevRecordThe _repeat object for the previous entry. It is an error to access this property for the first entry in the
region.
_nextRecordThe _repeat object for the next entry. It is an error to access this property for the last entry in the
region.
_parentIn a nested repeated region, this gives the _repeat object for the enclosing (outer) repeated region. It is an
error to access this property outside of a nested repeated region.During expression evaluation, all fields of the
_document object and _repeat object are implicitly available. For example, you can enter title instead of
_document.title to access the document’s title parameter.In cases where there is a field conflict, fields of the _repeat
object take precedence over fields of the _document object. Therefore, you shouldn’t need to explicitly reference
_document or _repeat except that _document might be needed inside a repeating region to reference document
parameters that are hidden by repeated region parameters.When nested repeated regions are used, only fields of the
innermost repeated regions are available implicitly. Outer regions must be explicitly referenced using _parent.
Multiple If condition in template code
You can define template expressions for if and multiple-if conditions. This example demonstrates defining a parameter
named "Dept", setting an initial value, and defining a multiple-if condition which determines which logo to display.
471
Templates
Last updated 6/3/2015
The following is an example of the code you might enter in the head section of the template:
<!-- TemplateParam name="Dept" type="number" value="1" -->
The following condition statement checks the value assigned to the Dept parameter. When the condition is true or
matches, the appropriate image is displayed.
<!-- TemplateBeginMultipleIf -->
<!-- checks value of Dept and shows appropriate image-->
<!-- TemplateBeginIfClause cond="Dept == 1" --> <img src=".../sales.gif"></img> <!--
TemplateEndIfClause -->
<!-- TemplateBeginIfClause cond="Dept == 2" --> <img src=".../support.gif"></img> <!--
TemplateEndIfClause-->
<!-- TemplateBeginIfClause cond="Dept == 3" --> <img src=".../hr.gif"></img> <!--
TemplateEndIfClause -->
<!-- TemplateBeginIfClause cond="Dept != 3" --> <img src=".../spacer.gif"></img> <!--
TemplateEndIfClause -->
<!-- TemplateEndMultipleIf -->
When you create a template-based document, the template parameters are automatically passed to it. The template user
determines which image to display.
More Help topics
Managing assets and libraries
Creating a Dreamweaver template
Editing content in a template-baseddocument
Creating editable regions intemplates
Creating repeating regions in templates
Using optional regions in templates
Defining editable tag attributes in templates
Link to documents using the Point-To-File icon
Document-relative paths
Using optional regions in templates
Defining editable tag attributesin templates
Modify template properties
Recognizing templates and template-based documents
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Recognizing templates in Design view
In Design view, editable regions appear in the Document window surrounded by rectangular outlines in a preset
highlight color. A small tab appears at the upper-left corner of each region, showing the name of the region.
472
Templates
Last updated 6/3/2015
You can identify a template file by looking at the title bar in the Document window. The title bar for a template file
contains the word <<Template>> in the title bar, and the filename extension for the file is .dwt.
Recognizing templates in Code view
In Code view, editable content regions are marked in HTML with the following comments:
<!-- TemplateBeginEditable> and <!-- TemplateEndEditable -->
You can use code color preferences to set your own color scheme so you can easily distinguish template regions when
you view a document in Code view.
Everything between these comments will be editable in documents based on the template. The HTML source code for
an editable region might look like this:
<table width="75%" border="1" cellspacing="0" cellpadding="0">
<tr bgcolor="#333366">
<td>Name</td>
<td><font color="#FFFFFF">Address</font></td>
<td><font color="#FFFFFF">Telephone Number</font></td>
</tr>
<!-- TemplateBeginEditable name="LocationList" -->
<tr>
<td>Enter name</td>
<td>Enter Address</td>
<td>Enter Telephone</td>
</tr>
<!-- TemplateEndEditable -->
</table>
Note: When you edit template code in Code view, be careful not to change any of the template-related comment tags that
Dreamweaver relies on.
473
Templates
Last updated 6/3/2015
Recognizing template-based documents in Design view
In a document based on a template (a template-based document), editable regions appear in the Design view of the
Document window surrounded by rectangular outlines in a preset highlight color. A small tab appears at the upper-left
corner of each region, showing the name of the region.
In addition to the editable-region outlines, the entire page is surrounded by a different-colored outline, with a tab in
the upper-right corner giving the name of the template that the document is based on. This highlighted rectangle
reminds you that the document is based on a template and that you can’t change content outside the editable regions.
Recognizing template-based documents in Code view
In Code view, editable regions of a document derived from a template appear in a different color than code in the non-
editable regions. You can make changes only to code in the editableregions or editable parameters but you cannot type
in locked regions.
Editable content is marked in HTML with the following Dreamweaver comments:
<!-- InstanceBeginEditable> and <!-- InstanceEndEditable -->
Everything between these comments is editable in a template-based document. The HTML source code for an editable
region might look like this:
474
Templates
Last updated 6/3/2015
<body bgcolor="#FFFFFF" leftmargin="0">
<table width="75%" border="1" cellspacing="0" cellpadding="0">
<tr bgcolor="#333366">
<td>Name</td>
<td><font color="#FFFFFF">Address</font></td>
<td><font color="#FFFFFF">Telephone Number</font></td>
</tr>
<!-- InstanceBeginEditable name="LocationList" -->
<tr>
<td>Enter name</td>
<td>Enter Address</td>
<td>Enter Telephone</td>
</tr>
<!-- InstanceEndEditable -->
</table>
</body>
The default color for non-editable text is gray; you can select a different color for the editable and non-editable regions
in the Preferences dialog box.
More Help topics
Customize code coloring preferences for a template
Set highlighting preferences for template regions
Customize code coloring preferences for a template
Creating a Dreamweaver template
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About creating Dreamweaver templates
You can create a template from an existing document (such as an HTML, Adobe ColdFusion, or Microsoft Active
Server Pages document) or you can create a template from a new document.
Note: Support for ColdFusion and ASP are removed in Dreamweaver CC and later.
After you create a template, you can insert template regions, and set template preferences for code color and template
region highlight color.
You can store additional information about a template (such as who created it, when it was last changed, or why you
made certain layout decisions) in a Design Notes file for the template. Documents based on a template do not inherit
the templates Design Notes.
Note: Templates in Adobe Dreamweaver differ from templates in some other Adobe Creative Suite products in that page
sections of Dreamweaver templates are fixed (or uneditable) by default.
For a tutorial on creating templates, see www.adobe.com/go/vid0157.
For a tutorial on using templates, see www.adobe.com/go/vid0158.
475
Templates
Last updated 6/3/2015
Create a template from an existing document
You can create a template from an existing document.
1Open the document you want to save as a template.
2Do one of the following:
Select File > Save As Template.
In the Common category of the Insert panel, click the Templates button, then select Make Template from the
pop-up menu.
Note: Unless you selected Don’t Show This Dialog Again in the past, you’ll receive a warning that says the document
you’re saving has no editable regions. Click OK to save the document as a template, or click Cancel to exit this dialog
box without creating a template.
3Select a site to save the template in from the Site pop-up menu, and then enter a unique name for the template in
the Save As box.
4Click Save. Dreamweaver saves the template file in the sites Templates folder in the local root folder of the site, with
a .dwt filename extension. If the Templates folder does not already exist in the site, Dreamweaver automatically
creates it when you save a new template.
Note: Do not move your templates out of the Templates folder, or put any non-template files in the Templates folder.
Also, do not move the Templates folder out of your local root folder. Doing so causes errors in paths in the templates.
Use the Assets panel to create a new template
1In the Assets panel (Window > Assets), select the Templates category on the left side of the panel .
2Click the New Template button at the bottom of the Assets panel.
A new, untitled template is added to the list of templates in the Assets panel.
3While the template is still selected, enter a name for the template, then press Enter (Windows) or Return
(Macintosh).
Dreamweaver creates a blank template in the Assets panel and in the Templates folder.
About creating templates for Contribute sites
Using Dreamweaver, you can create templates to help Adobe® Contribute® users create new pages, to provide a
consistent look and feel for your site, and to enable you to update the layout of many pages at once.
When you create a template and upload it to the server, it becomes available to all Contribute users who connect to your
site, unless you’ve set restrictions on template use for certain Contribute roles. If you have set restrictions on template
use, you might need to add each new template to the list of templates a Contribute user can use (see Administering
Contribute).
Note: Make sure that the site root folder defined in each Contribute user’s site definition is the same as the site root folder
defined in your site definition in Dreamweaver. If a users site root folder doesnt match yours, that user won’t be able to use
templates.
In addition to Dreamweaver templates, you can create non-Dreamweaver templates using the Contribute
administration tools. A non-Dreamweaver template is an existing page that Contribute users can use to create new
pages; it’s similar to a Dreamweaver template, except that pages that are based on it don’t update when you change the
template. Also, non-Dreamweaver templates can’t contain Dreamweaver template elements such as editable, locked,
repeating, and optional regions.
476
Templates
Last updated 6/3/2015
When a Contribute user creates a new document within a site containing Dreamweaver templates, Contribute lists the
available templates (both Dreamweaver and non-Dreamweaver templates) in the New Page dialog box.
To include pages that use encodings other than Latin-1 in your site, you might need to create templates (either
Dreamweaver templates or non-Dreamweaver templates). Contribute users can edit pages that use any encoding, but
when a Contribute user creates a new blank page, it uses the Latin-1 encoding. To create a page that uses a different
encoding, a Contribute user can create a copy of an existing page that uses a different encoding, or can use a template
that uses a different encoding. However, if there are no pages or templates in the site that use other encodings, then you
must first create a page or a template in Dreamweaver that uses that other encoding.
Create a template for a Contribute site
1Select Site > Manage Sites.
2Select a site and click Edit.
3In the Site Setup dialog box, select the Contribute category.
4If you haven’t already done so, you need to enable Contribute compatibility.
Select Enable Contribute Compatibility, and then enter a site root URL.
5Click Administer Site In Contribute.
6If prompted, enter the administrator password, and then click OK.
7In the Users And Roles category, select a role, and then click the Edit Role Settings button.
8Select the New Pages category, and then add existing pages to the list under Create A New Page By Copying A Page
From This List.
For more information, see Administering Contribute.
9Click OK twice to close the dialog boxes.
477
Templates
Last updated 6/3/2015
More Help topics
Types of template regions
Setting authoring preferences for templates
Associate Design Notes with files
Creating templates tutorial
Using templates tutorial
Create a blank template
Creating and opening documents
Prepare a site for use with Contribute
Creating editable regions in templates
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Insert an editable region
Editable template regions control which areas of a template-based page a user can edit. Before you insert an editable
region, save the document you are working in as a template.
Note: If you insert an editable region in a document rather than a template file, an alert warns you that the document will
automatically be saved as a template.
You can place an editable region anywhere in your page, but consider the following points if you are making a table or
an absolutely-positioned element (AP element) editable:
You can mark an entire table or an individual table cell as editable, but you can’t mark multiple table cells as a single
editable region. If a <td> tag is selected, the editable region includes the region around the cell; if not, the editable
region affects only content inside the cell.
AP elements and AP element content are separate elements; making an AP element editable lets you change the
position of the AP element as well as its contents, but making an AP elements contents editable lets you change only
the content of the AP element, not its position.
1In the Document window, do one of the following to select the region:
Select the text or content that you want to set as an editable region.
Place the insertion point where you want to insert an editable region.
2Do one of the following to insert an editable region:
Select Insert > Template Objects > Editable Region.
Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh), then select Templates > New Editable Region.
In the Common category of the Insert panel, click the Templates button, then select Editable Region from the
pop-up menu.
3In the Name box, enter a unique name for the region. (You cannot use the same name for more than one editable
region in a particular template.)
Note: Do not use special characters in the Name box.
478
Templates
Last updated 6/3/2015
4Click OK. The editable region is enclosed in a highlighted rectangular outline in the template, using the highlighting
color that is set in preferences. A tab at the upper-left corner of the region shows the name of the region. If you insert
an empty editable region in the document, the name of the region also appears inside the region.
Select editable regions
You can easily identify and select template regions in both the template document and template-based documents.
Select an editable region in the Document window
Click the tab in the upper-left corner of the editable region.
Find an editable region and select it in the document
Select Modify > Templates, then select the name of the region from the list at the bottom of that submenu.
Note: Editable regions that are inside a repeated region do not appear in the menu. You must locate these regions by
looking for tabbed borders in the Document window.
The editable region is selected in the document.
Remove an editable region
If you’ve marked a region of your template file as editable and you want to lock it (make it noneditable in template-
based documents) again, use the Remove Template Markup command.
1Click the tab in the upper-left corner of the editable region to select it.
2Do one of the following:
Select Modify > Templates > Remove Template Markup.
Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh), then select Templates > Remove Template Markup.
The region is no longer editable.
Change an editable regions name
After you insert an editable region, you can later change its name.
1Click the tab in the upper-left corner of the editable region to select it.
2In the Property inspector (Window > Properties), enter a new name.
3Press Enter (Windows) or Return (Macintosh).
More Help topics
Creating a Dreamweaver template
Set highlighting preferences for template regions
Creating repeating regions in templates
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
479
Templates
Last updated 6/3/2015
About template repeating regions
A repeating region is a section of a template that can be duplicated many times in a template-based page. Typically,
repeating regions are used with tables but you can define a repeating region for other page elements.
Repeating regions enable you to control your page layout by repeating certain items, such as a catalog item and
description layout, or a row for data such as a list of items.
There are two repeating region template objects you can use: repeating region and repeating table.
Create a repeating region in a template
Repeating regions enable template users to duplicate a specified region in a template as often as desired. A repeating
region is not necessarily an editable region.
To make content in a repeating region editable (for example, to allow a user to enter text in a table cell in a template-
based document), you must insert an editable region in the repeating region.
1In the Document window, do one of the following:
Select the text or content you want to set as a repeating region.
Place the insertion point in the document where you want to insert the repeating region.
2Do one of the following:
Select Insert > Template Objects > Repeating Region.
Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh), then select Templates > New Repeating Region.
In the Common category of the Insert panel, click the Templates button, then select Repeating Region from the
pop-up menu.
3In the Name box, enter a unique name for the template region. (You cannot use the same name for more than one
repeating region in a template.)
Note: When you name a region, do not use special characters.
4Click OK.
Insert a repeating table
You can use a repeating table to create an editable region (in table format) with repeating rows. You can define table
attributes and set which table cells are editable.
1In the Document window, place the insertion point in the document where you want to insert the repeating table.
2Do one of the following:
Select Insert > Template Objects > Repeating Table.
In the Common category of the Insert panel, click the Templates button, and then select Repeating Table from
the pop-up menu.
3Specify the following options and click OK.
Rows Determines the number of rows the table has.
Columns Determines the number of columns the table has.
Cell Padding Determines the number of pixels between a cell’s content and the cell boundaries.
Cell Spacing Determines the number of pixels between adjacent table cells.
480
Templates
Last updated 6/3/2015
If you dont explicitly assign values for cell padding and cell spacing, most browsers display the table as if cell padding
were set to 1 and cell spacing were set to 2. To ensure that browsers display the table with no padding or spacing, set
Cell Padding and Cell Spacing to 0.
Width Specifies the width of the table in pixels, or as a percentage of the browser window’s width.
Border Specifies the width, in pixels, of the tables borders.
If you don’t explicitly assign a value for border, most browsers display the table as if the border were set to 1. To
ensure that browsers display the table with no border, set Border to 0. To view cell and table boundaries when the
border is set to 0, select View > Visual& Aids > Table Borders.
Repeat Rows of the Table Specify which rows in the table are included in the repeating region.
Starting Row Sets the row number entered as the first row to include in the repeating region.
Ending Row Sets the row number entered as the last row to include in the repeating region.
Region Name Lets you set a unique name for the repeating region.
Set alternating background colors in a repeating table
After you insert a repeating table in a template, you can customize it by alternating the background color of the table
rows.
1In the Document window, select a row in the repeating table.
2Click the Show Code View or Show Code And Design Views button in the Document toolbar so you can access the
code for the selected table row.
3In Code view, edit the <tr> tag to include the following code:
<tr bgcolor="@@( _index &amp; 1 ? '#FFFFFF' : '#CCCCCC' )@@">
You can replace the #FFFFFF and #CCCCCC hexadecimal values with other color choices.
4Save the template.
The following is a code example of a table that includes alternating background table row colors:
<table width="75%" border="1" cellspacing="0" cellpadding="0">
<tr><th>Name</th><th>Phone Number</th><th>Email Address</th></tr>
<!-- TemplateBeginRepeat name="contacts" -->
<tr bgcolor="@@(_index &amp; 1 ? '#FFFFFF' : '#CCCCCC')@@">
<td> <!-- TemplateBeginEditable name="name" --> name <!-- TemplateEndEditable -->
</td>
<td> <!-- TemplateBeginEditable name="phone" --> phone <!-- TemplateEndEditable -->
</td>
<td> <!-- TemplateBeginEditable name="email" --> email <!-- TemplateEndEditable -->
</td>
</tr>
<!-- TemplateEndRepeat -->
</table>
More Help topics
Types of template regions
Insert an editable region
481
Templates
Last updated 6/3/2015
Using optional regions in templates
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About template optional regions
An optional region is a region in a template that users can set to show or to hide in a template-based document. Use an
optional region when you want to set conditions for displaying content in a document.
When you insert an optional region, you can either set specific values for a template parameter or define conditional
statements (If...else statements) for template regions. Use simple true/false operations, or define more complex
conditional statements and expressions. You can later modify the optional region if necessary. Based on the conditions
you define, template users can edit the parameters in template-based documents they create and control whether the
optional region is displayed.
You can link multiple optional regions to a named parameter. In the template-based document, both regions will show
or hide as a unit. For example, you can show a “closeout image and sales price text area for a sale item.
Insert an optional region
Use an optional region to control content that may or may not be displayed in a template-based document. There are
two types of optional regions:
Non-editable optional regions, which enable template users to show and hide specially marked regions without
enabling them to edit the content.
The template tab of an optional region is preceded by the word if. Based on the condition set in the template, a
template user can define whether the region is viewable in pages they create.
Editable optional regions, which enable template users to set whether the region shows or hides, and enable users to
edit content in the region.
For example, if the optional region includes an image or text, the template user can set whether the content is
displayed, as well as make edits to the content if desired. An editable region is controlled by a conditional statement.
Insert a non-editable optional region
1In the Document window, select the element you want to set as an optional region.
2Do one of the following:
Select Insert > Template Objects > Optional Region.
Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the selected content, then select Templates > New Optional
Region.
In the Common category of the Insert panel, click the Templates button, then select Optional Region from the
pop-up menu.
3Enter a name for the optional region, click the Advanced tab if you want to set values for the optional region, and
then click OK.
Insert an editable optional region
1In the Document window, place the insertion point where you want to insert the optional region.
482
Templates
Last updated 6/3/2015
You cannot wrap a selection to create an editable optional region. Insert the region, then insert the content in the
region.
2Do one of the following:
Select Insert > Template Objects > Editable Optional Region.
In the Common category of the Insert panel, click the Templates button, then select Editable Optional Region
from the pop-up menu.
3Enter a name for the optional region, click the Advanced tab if you want to set values for the optional region, and
click OK.
Set values for an optional region
You can edit optional region settings after you’ve inserted the region in a template. For example, you can change
whether the default setting for the content is to be displayed or not, to link a parameter to an existing optional region,
or to modify a template expression.
Create template parameters and define conditional statements (If...else statements) for template regions. You can use
simple true/false operations, or define more complex conditional statements and expressions.
In the Advanced tab you can link multiple optional regions to a named parameter. In the template-based document,
both regions will show or hide as a unit. For example, you can show acloseout” image and sales price text area for a
sale item.
You can also use the Advanced tab to write a template expression that evaluates a value for the optional region and
shows it or hides it based on the value.
1In the Document window, do one of the following:
In Design view, click the template tab of the optional region you want to modify.
In Design view, place the insertion point in the template region; then in the tag selector at the bottom of the
Document window, select the template tag, <mmtemplate:if>.
In Code view, click the comment tag of the template region you want to modify.
2In the Property inspector (Window > Properties), click Edit.
3In the Basics tab, enter a name for the parameter in the Name box.
4Select Show By Default to set the selected region to show in the document. Deselect it to set the default value to false.
Note: To set a different value for the parameter, in Code view locate the parameter in the section of the document and
edit the value.
5(Optional) Click the Advanced tab, then set the following options:
If you want to link optional region parameters, click the Advanced tab, select Use Parameter, then from the
pop-up menu select the existing parameter you want to link the selected content to.
If you want to write a template expression to control the display of an optional region, click the Advanced tab,
select Enter Expression, then enter the expression in the box.
Note: Dreamweaver inserts double-quotation marks around the text you enter.
6Click OK.
When you use the Optional Region template object, Dreamweaver inserts template comments in the code. A
template parameter is defined in the head section, as in the following example:<!-- TemplateParam
name="departmentImage" type="boolean" value="true" -->
483
Templates
Last updated 6/3/2015
More Help topics
Modify template properties
Types of template regions
Modify template properties
Modify template properties
Template expressions
Defining editable tag attributes in templates
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Specify editable tag attributes in a template
You can allow a template user to modify specified tag attributes in a document created from a template.
For example, you can set a background color in the template document, yet enable template users to set a different
background color for pages they create. Users can update only the attributes you specify as editable.
You can also set multiple editable attributes in a page so that template users can modify the attributes in template-based
documents. The following data types are supported: text, Boolean (true/false), color, and URL.
Creating an editable tag attribute inserts a template parameter in the code. An initial value for the attribute is set in the
template document; when a template-based document is created, it inherits the parameter. A template user can then
edit the parameter in the template-based document.
Note: If you make the link to a style sheet an editable attribute, then the attributes of the style sheet are no longer available
for either viewing or editing in the template file.
1In the Document window, select an item you want to set an editable tag attribute for.
2Select Modify > Templates > Make Attribute Editable.
3In the Attribute box, enter a name or select an attribute in the Editable Tag Attributes dialog box by doing one of the
following:
If the attribute you want to make editable is listed in the Attribute pop-up menu, select it.
If the attribute you want to make editable isnt listed in the Attribute pop-up menu, click Add, and in the dialog
box that opens, enter the name of the attribute you want to add, then click OK.
4Make sure the Make Attribute Editable option is selected.
5In the Label box, enter a unique name for the attribute.
At the location where the optional region is inserted, code similar to the code below appears:
<!-- TemplateParam name="departmentImage" type="boolean" value="true" -->
Do Not Use<!-- TemplateBeginIf cond="departmentImage" -->
<p><img src="/images/airfare_on.gif" width="85" height="22"></img> </p>
<!-- TemplateEndIf -->
You can access and edit template parameters in the template-based document.
484
Templates
Last updated 6/3/2015
To make it easier to identify a specific editable tag attribute later, use a label that identifies the element and the
attribute. For example, you might label an image whose source is editable logoSrc or label the editable background
color of a body tag bodyBgcolor.
6In the Type menu, select the type of value allowed for this attribute by setting one of the following options:
To enable a user to enter a text value for the attribute, select Text. For example, you can use text with the align
attribute; the user can then set the attributes value to left, right, or center.
To insert a link to an element, such as the file path to an image, select URL. Using this option automatically
updates the path used in a link. If the user moves the image to a new folder, the Update Links dialog box appears.
To make the color picker available for selecting a value, select Color.
To enable a user to select a true or false value on the page, select True/False.
To enable a template user to type a numerical value to update an attribute (for example, to change the height or
width values of an image), select Number.
7The Default Value box displays the value of the selected tag attribute in the template. Enter a new value in this box
to set a different initial value for the parameter in the template-based document.
8(Optional) If you want to make changes to another attribute of the selected tag, select the attribute and set the
options for that attribute.
9Click OK.
Make an editable tag attribute uneditable
A tag previously marked as editable can be marked as uneditable.
1In the template document, click the element associated with the editable attribute or use the tag selector to select the
tag.
2Select Modify > Templates > Make Attribute Editable.
3In the Attributes pop-up menu, select the attribute you want to affect.
4Deselect Make Attribute Editable and click OK.
5Update documents based on the template.
More Help topics
Modify template properties
Creating a nested template
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About nested templates
A nested template is a template whose design and editable regions are based on another template. Nested templates are
useful for controlling content in pages of a site that share many design elements, but have a few variations between
pages. For example, a base template might contain broader design areas and be usable by many content contributors for
a site, while a nested template might further define the editable regions in pages for a specific section in a site.
485
Templates
Last updated 6/3/2015
Editable regions in a base template are passed through to the nested template, and remain editable in pages created from
a nested template unless new template regions are inserted in these regions.
Changes to a base template are automatically updated in templates based on the base template, and in all template-based
documents that are based on the main and nested templates.
In the following example, the template trioHome contains three editable regions, named Body, NavBar, and Footer:
To create a nested template, a new document based on the template was created and then saved as a template and named
TrioNested. In the nested template, two editable regions have been added in the editable region named Body.
486
Templates
Last updated 6/3/2015
When you add a new editable region in an editable region passed through to the nested template, the highlighting color
of the editable region changes to orange. Content you add outside the editable region, such as the graphic in the
editableColumn, is no longer editable in documents based on the nested template. The blue highlighted editable areas,
whether added in the nested template or passed through from the base template, remain editable in documents that are
based on the nested template. Template regions that do not contain an editable region pass through to template-based
documents as editable regions.
Create a nested template
Nested templates let you create variations of a base template. You can nest multiple templates to define increasingly
specific layouts.
By default, all editable template regions from the base template pass through the nested template to the document based
on the nested template. That means that if you create an editable region in a base template, then create a nested template,
the editable region appears in documents based on the nested template (if you did not insert any new template regions
in that region in the nested template).
Note: You can insert template markup inside an editable region so that it won’t pass through as an editable region in
documents based on the nested template. Such regions have an orange border instead of a blue border.
1Create a document from the template on which you want to base the nested template by doing one of the following:
In the Assets panel’s Templates category, right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the template you
want to create a new document from, then select New From Template from the context menu.
Select File > New. In the New Document dialog box, select the Page from Template category, then select the site
that contains the template you want to use; in the Template list, double-click the template to create a new
document.
487
Templates
Last updated 6/3/2015
2Select File > Save As Template to save the new document as a nested template:
3Enter a name in the Save As box and click OK.
Prevent an editable region from passing through to a nested template
In nested templates, pass-through editable regions have a blue border. You can insert template markup inside an
editable region so that it wont pass through as an editable region in documents based on the nested template. Such
regions have an orange border instead of a blue border.
1In Code view, locate the editable region you want to prevent from passing through.
Editable regions are defined by template comment tags.
2Add the following code to the editable region code:
@@(" ")@@
This template code can be placed anywhere within the <!-- InstanceBeginEditable --><!-- InstanceEndEditable -->
tags that surround the editable region. For example:
<!-- InstanceBeginEditable name="EditRegion1" -->
<p>@@("")@@ Editable 1 </p>
<!-- InstanceEndEditable -->
More Help topics
Server scripts in templates and template-based documents
Editing, updating, and deleting templates
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About editing and updating templates
When you make changes to and save a template, all the documents based on the template are updated. You can also
manually update a template-based document or the entire site if necessary.
Note: To edit a template for a Contribute site, you must use Dreamweaver; you cannot edit templates in Contribute.
Use the Templates category of the Assets panel to manage existing templates, including renaming template files and
deleting template files.
You can perform the following template management tasks with the Assets panel:
Create a template
Edit and update templates
Apply or remove a template from an existing document
Dreamweaver checks template syntax when you save a template but its a good idea to manually check the template
syntax while youre editing a template.
488
Templates
Last updated 6/3/2015
Open a template for editing
You can open a template file directly for editing, or you can open a template-based document, then open the attached
template for editing.
When you make a change to a template, Dreamweaver prompts you to update the documents based on the template.
Note: You can also manually update the documents for template changes if necessary.
Open and edit a template file
1In the Assets panel (Window > Assets), select the Templates category on the left side of the panel .
The Assets panel lists all of the available templates for your site and displays a preview of the selected template.
2In the list of available templates, do one of the following:
Double-click the name of the template you want to edit.
Select a template to edit, then click the Edit button at the bottom of the Assets panel.
3Modify the contents of the template.
To modify the templates page properties, select Modify > Page Properties. (Documents based on a template inherit
the templates page properties.)
4Save the template. Dreamweaver prompts you to update pages based on the template.
5Click Update to update all documents based on the modified template; click Don’t Update if you don’t want to
update documents based on the modified template.
Dreamweaver displays a log indicating the files that were updated.
Open and modify the template attached to the current document
1Open the template-based document in the Document window.
2Do one of the following:
Select Modify > Templates > Open Attached Template.
Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh), then select Templates > Open Attached Template.
3Modify the contents of the template.
To modify the templates page properties, select Modify > Page Properties. (Documents based on a template inherit
the templates page properties.)
4Save the template. Dreamweaver prompts you to update pages based on the template.
5Click Update to update all documents based on the modified template; click Don’t Update if you don’t want to
update documents based on the modified template.
Dreamweaver displays a log indicating the files that were updated.
Rename a template
1In the Assets panel (Window > Assets), select the Templates category on the left side of the panel .
2Click the name of the template to select it.
3Click the name again so that the text is selectable, then enter a new name.
489
Templates
Last updated 6/3/2015
This method of renaming works in the same way as renaming a file in Windows Explorer (Windows) or the Finder
(Macintosh). As with Windows Explorer and the Finder, be sure to pause briefly between clicks. Do not double-click
the name, because that opens the template for editing.
4Click in another area of the Asset panel, or press Enter (Windows) or Return (Macintosh) for the change to take
effect.
An alert asks if you want to update documents that are based on this template.
5To update all documents in the site that are based on this template, click Update. Click Don’t Update if you do not
want to update any document based on this template.
Change a template description
The template description appears in the New Document dialog box when youre creating a page from an existing
template.
1Select Modify > Templates > Description.
2In the Template Description dialog box, edit the description and click OK.
Manually update documents based on templates
When you make a change to a template, Dreamweaver prompts you to update the documents based on the template,
but you can manually update the current document or the entire site if necessary. Manually updating template-based
documents is the same as reapplying the template.
Apply template changes to the current template-based document
1Open the document in the Document window.
2Select Modify > Templates > Update Current Page.
Dreamweaver updates the document with any template changes.
Update the entire site or all documents that use a specified template
You can update all the pages in the site, or only update pages for a specific template.
1Select Modify > Templates > Update Pages.
2In the Look In menu, do one of the following:
To update all the files in the selected site to their corresponding templates, select Entire Site, then select the site
name from the adjacent pop-up menu.
To update files for a specific template, select Files That Use, then select the template name from the adjacent
pop-up menu.
3Make sure Templates is selected in the Update option.
4If you dont want to see a log of the files Dreamweaver updates, deselect the Show Log option; otherwise, leave that
option selected.
5Click Start to update the files as indicated. If you selected the Show Log option, Dreamweaver provides information
about the files it attempts to update, including information on whether they were updated successfully.
6Click Close.
490
Templates
Last updated 6/3/2015
Update templates in a Contribute site
Contribute users cant make changes to a Dreamweaver template. You can, however, use Dreamweaver to change a
template for a Contribute site
Keep these factors in mind when updating templates in a Contribute site:
Contribute retrieves new and changed templates from the site only when Contribute starts up and when a
Contribute user changes their connection information. If you make changes to a template while a Contribute user
is editing a file based on that template, the user won’t see the changes to the template until they restart Contribute.
If you remove an editable region from a template, a Contribute user editing a page based on that template might be
confused about what to do with the content that was in that editable region.
To update a template in a Contribute site, complete the following steps.
1Open the Contribute template in Dreamweaver, edit it, and then save it. For instructions, see Open a template for
editing.
2Notify all of the Contribute users who are working on the site to restart Contribute.
Delete a template file
1In the Assets panel (Window > Assets), select the Templates category on the left side of the panel .
2Click the name of the template to select it.
3Click the Delete button at the bottom of the panel, then confirm that you want to delete the template.
Note: After you delete a template file, you can’t retrieve it. The template file is deleted from your site.
Documents that are based on a deleted template are not detached from the template; they retain the structure and
editable regions that the template file had before it was deleted. You can convert such a document into an HTML
file without editable or locked regions.
More Help topics
Creating a Dreamweaver template
Check template syntax
Applying or removing a template from an existing document
Check template syntax
Creating a Dreamweaver template
Applying or removing a template from an existing document
Creating a Dreamweaver template
Detach a document from a template
Applying or removing a template from an existing document
Creating a Dreamweaver template
491
Templates
Last updated 6/3/2015
Exporting and importing template content
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About template XML content
You can think of a document based on a template as containing data represented by name-value pairs. Each pair
consists of the name of an editable region, and the contents of that region.
You can export the name-value pairs into an XML file so that you can work with the data outside of Dreamweaver (for
example, in an XML editor or a text editor, or a database application). Conversely, if you have an XML document thats
structured appropriately, you can import the data from it into a document based on a Dreamweaver template.
Export a document’s editable regions as XML
1Open a template-based document that contains editable regions.
2Select File > Export > Template Data As XML.
3Select one of the Notation options:
If the template contains repeating regions or template parameters, select Use Standard Dreamweaver XML Tag.
If the template does not contain repeating regions or template parameters, select Use Editable Region Names as
XML Tags.
4Click OK.
5In the dialog box that appears, select a folder location, enter a name for the XML file, and then click Save.
An XML file is generated that contains the material from the documents parameters and editable regions, including
editable regions inside repeating regions or optional regions. The XML file includes the name of the original
template, as well as the name and contents of each template region.
Note: Content in the non-editable regions is not exported to the XML file.
Import XML content
1Select File > Import > Import XML into Template.
2Select the XML file and click Open.
Dreamweaver creates a new document based on the template specified in the XML file. It fills in the contents of each
editable region in that document using the data from the XML file. The resulting document appears in a new
Document window.
If your XML file isn’t set up exactly the way Dreamweaver expects, you might not be able to import your data. One
solution to this problem is to export a dummy XML file from Dreamweaver, so that youll have an XML file with
exactly the right structure. Then copy the data from your original XML file into the exported XML file. The result is an
XML file with the correct structure that contains the appropriate data, ready to be imported.
Export a site without template markup
You can export template-based documents in a site to another site without including the template markup.
1Select Modify > Templates > Export Without Markup.
492
Templates
Last updated 6/3/2015
2In the Folder box, enter the file path to the folder you want to export the file to or click Browse and select the folder.
Note: You must select a folder outside of the current site.
3If you want to save an XML version of exported template-based documents, select Keep Template Data Files.
4If you want to update changes to previously exported files, select Extract Only Changed Files and click OK.
Applying or removing a template from an existing
document
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Apply a template to an existing document
When you apply a template to a document which contains existing content, Dreamweaver attempts to match the
existing content to a region in the template. If you are applying a revised version of one of your existing templates, the
names are likely to match.
If you apply a template to a document that hasn’t had a template applied to it, there are no editable regions to compare
and a mismatch occurs. Dreamweaver tracks these mismatches so you can select which region or regions to move the
current pages content to, or you can delete the mismatched content.
You can apply a template to an existing document using the Assets panel or from the Document window. You can undo
a template application if necessary.
Note: When you apply a template to an existing document, the template replaces the document’s contents with the
templates boilerplate content. Always back up a pages contents before applying a template to it.
Apply a template to an existing document using the Assets panel
1Open the document you want to apply the template to.
2In the Assets panel (Window > Assets), select the Templates category on the left side of the panel .
3Do one of the following:
Drag the template you want to apply from the Assets panel to the Document window.
Select the template you want to apply, then click the Apply button at the bottom of the Assets panel.
If content exists in the document that cant be automatically assigned to a template region, the Inconsistent
Region Names dialog box appears.
4Select a destination for the content by using the Move Content to New Region menu to select one of the following:
Select a region in the new template to move the existing content to.
Select Nowhere to remove the content from the document.
5To move all unresolved content to the selected region, click Use For All.
6Click OK to apply the template or click Cancel to cancel the application of the template to the document.
Note: When you apply a template to an existing document, the template replaces the document’s contents with the
templates boilerplate content. Always back up a pages contents before applying a template to it.
493
Templates
Last updated 6/3/2015
Apply a template to an existing document from the Document window
1Open the document you want to apply the template to.
2Select Modify > Templates > Apply Template to Page.
The Select Template dialog box appears.
3Choose a template from the list, then click Select.
If content exists in the document that cant be automatically assigned to a template region, the Inconsistent Region
Names dialog box appears.
4Select a destination for the content by using the Move Content to New Region menu to select one of the following:
Select a region in the new template to move the existing content to.
Select Nowhere to remove the content from the document.
5To move all unresolved content to the selected region, click Use For All.
6Click OK to apply the template or click Cancel to cancel the application of the template to the document.
Note: When you apply a template to an existing document, the template replaces the document’s contents with the
templates boilerplate content. Always back up a pages contents before applying a template to it.
Undo the template changes
Select Edit > Undo Apply Template.
The document reverts to its state before the template was applied.
Detach a document from a template
To make changes to the locked regions of a document based on a template, you must detach the document from the
template. When the document is detached, the entire document becomes editable.
Note: You cannot convert a template file (.dwt) to a normal file by simply resaving the template file as an HTML (.html)
file. Doing so does not delete the template code that appears throughout the document. If you want to convert a template
file to a normal file, you can save the document as a normal HTML file, but must then manually delete all of the template
code in Code view.
1Open the template-based document you want to detach.
2Select Modify > Templates > Detach from Template.
The document is detached from the template and all template code is removed.
Editing content in a template-based document
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About editing content in template-based documents
Dreamweaver templates specify regions that are locked (uneditable) and others that are editable for template-based
documents.
494
Templates
Last updated 6/3/2015
In pages based on templates, template users can edit content in editable regions only. You can easily identify and select
editable regions to edit content. Template users cannot edit content in locked regions.
Note: If you try to edit a locked region in a document based on a template when highlighting is turned off, the mouse pointer
changes to indicate that you can’t click in a locked region.
Template users can also modify properties and edit entries for a repeating region in template-based documents.
Modify template properties
When template authors create parameters in a template, documents based on the template automatically inherit the
parameters and their initial value settings. A template user can update editable tag attributes and other template
parameters (such as optional region settings).
Modify an editable tag attribute
1Open the template-based document.
2Select Modify > Template Properties.
The Template Properties dialog box opens, showing a list of available properties. The dialog box shows optional
regions and editable tag attributes.
3In the Name list, select the property.
The bottom area of the dialog box updates to show the selected property’s label and its assigned value.
4In the field to the right of the property label, edit the value to modify the property in the document.
Note: The field name and updateable values are defined in the template. Attributes that do not appear in the Name list
are not editable in the template-based document.
5Select Allow Nested Templates To Control This if you want to pass the editable property along to a documents based
on the nested template.
Modify optional region template parameters
1Open the template-based document.
2Select Modify > Template Properties.
The Template Properties dialog box opens, showing a list of available properties. The dialog box shows optional
regions and editable tag attributes.
3In the Name list, select a property.
The dialog box updates to show the selected property’s label and its assigned value.
4Select Show to display the optional region in the document, or deselect Show to hide the optional region.
Note: The field name and default setting are defined in the template,.
5Select Allow Nested Templates To Control This if you want to pass the editable property along to a documents based
on the nested template.
Add, delete, and change the order of a repeating region entry
Use repeating region controls to add, delete, or change the order of entries in template-based documents. When you
add a repeating region entry, a copy of the entire repeating region is added. To update the content in the repeating
regions, the original template must include an editable region in the repeating region.
495
Templates
Last updated 6/3/2015
Add, delete, or change the order of a repeating region
1Open the template-based document.
2Place the insertion point in the repeating region to select it.
3Do one of the following:
Click the Plus (+) button to add a repeating region entry below the currently selected entry.
Click the Minus (–) button to delete the selected repeating region entry.
Click the Down Arrow button to move the selected entry down one position.
Click the Up Arrow button to move the selected entry up one position.
Note: Alternatively, you can select Modify > Template, then select one of the repeating entry options near the bottom of
the context menu. You can use this menu to insert a new repeating entry or move the selected entry’s position.
Cut, copy, and delete entries
1Open the template-based document.
2Place the insertion point in the repeating region to select it.
3Do one of the following:
To cut a repeating entry, select Edit > Repeating Entries > Cut Repeating Entries.
To copy a repeating entry, select Edit > Repeating Entries > Copy Repeating Entries.
To remove a repeating entry, select Edit > Repeating Entries > Delete Repeating Entries.
To paste a repeating entry, select Edit > Paste.
Note: Pasting inserts a new entry; it does not replace an existing entry.
More Help topics
Create a page based on an existing template
About Dreamweaver templates
Select editable regions
Template parameters
Using optional regions in templates
Defining editable tag attributes in templates
Creating repeating regions in templates
496
Templates
Last updated 6/3/2015
Template syntax
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
General syntax rules
Dreamweaver uses HTML comment tags to specify regions in templates and template-based documents, so template-
based documents are still valid HTML files. When you insert a template object, template tags are inserted in the code.
General syntax rules are as follows:
Wherever a space appears, you can substitute any amount of white space (spaces, tabs, line breaks). The white space
is mandatory except at the very beginning or end of a comment.
Attributes can be given in any order. For example, in a TemplateParam, you can specify the type before the name.
Comment and attribute names are case sensitive.
All attributes must be in quotation marks. Single or double quotes can be used.
Template tags
Dreamweaver uses the following template tags:
<!-- TemplateBeginEditable name="..." -->
<!-- TemplateEndEditable -->
<!-- TemplateParam name="..." type="..." value="..." -->
<!-- TemplateBeginRepeat name="..." -->
<!-- TemplateEndRepeat -->
<!-- TemplateBeginIf cond="..." -->
<!-- TemplateEndIf -->
<!-- TemplateBeginPassthroughIf cond="..." -->
<!-- TemplateEndPassthroughIf -->
<!-- TemplateBeginMultipleIf -->
<!-- TemplateEndMultipleIf -->
<!-- TemplateBeginPassthroughMultipleIf -->
<!-- TemplateEndPassthroughMultipleIf -->
<!-- TemplateBeginIfClause cond="..." -->
<!-- TemplateEndIfClause -->
<!-- TemplateBeginPassthroughIfClause cond="..." -->
<!-- TemplateEndPassthroughIfClause -->
<!-- TemplateExpr expr="..." --> (equivalent to @@...@@)
<!-- TemplatePassthroughExpr expr="..." -->
<!-- TemplateInfo codeOutsideHTMLIsLocked="..." -->
Instance tags
Dreamweaver uses the following instance tags:
497
Templates
Last updated 6/3/2015
<!-- InstanceBegin template="..." codeOutsideHTMLIsLocked="..." -->
<!-- InstanceEnd -->
<!-- InstanceBeginEditable name="..." -->
<!-- InstanceEndEditable -->
<!-- InstanceParam name="..." type="..." value="..." passthrough="..." -->
<!-- InstanceBeginRepeat name="..." -->
<!-- InstanceEndRepeat -->
<!-- InstanceBeginRepeatEntry -->
<!-- InstanceEndRepeatEntry -->
Check template syntax
Dreamweaver checks the template syntax when you save a template, but you can manually check the template syntax
prior to saving a template. For example, if you add a template parameter or expression in Code view, you can check that
the code follows correct syntax.
1Open the document you want to check in the Document window.
2Select Modify > Templates > Check Template Syntax.
An error message appears if the syntax is badly formed. The error message describes the error and refers to the
specific line in the code where the error exists.
More Help topics
Recognizing templates and template-based documents
Template expressions
Setting authoring preferences for templates
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Customize code coloring preferences for a template
Code color preferences control the text, background color, and style attributes of the text displayed in Code view. You
can set your own color scheme so you can easily distinguish template regions when you view a document in Code view.
1Select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh).
2Select Code Coloring from the category list on the left.
3Select HTML from the Document Type list, then click the Edit Coloring Scheme button.
4In the Styles For list select Template Tags.
5Set color, background color, and style attributes for the Code view text by doing the following:
If you want to change the text color, in the Text Color box type the hexadecimal value for the color you want to
apply to the selected text, or use the color picker to select a color to apply to the text. Do the same in the
Background field to add or change an existing background color for the selected text.
If you want to add a style attribute to the selected code, click the B (bold), I (italic), or U (underline) buttons to
set the desired format.
6Click OK.
498
Templates
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: If you want to make global changes, you can edit the source file that stores your preferences. On Windows XP, this
is located at C:\Documents and Settings\%username%\Application Data\Adobe\Dreamweaver
9\Configuration\CodeColoring\Colors.xml. On Windows Vista, this is located at C:\Users\%username%\Application
Data\Adobe\Dreamweaver 9\Configuration\CodeColoring\Colors.xml.
Set highlighting preferences for template regions
You can use the Dreamweaver highlighting preferences to customize the highlight colors for the outlines around the
editable and locked regions of a template in Design view. The editable region color appears in the template as well as in
documents based on the template.
Change template highlight colors
1Select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh).
2Select Highlighting from the category list on the left.
3Click the Editable Regions, Nested Regions, or Locked Regions color box, then select a highlight color using the
color picker (or enter the hexadecimal value for the highlight color in the box).
For information about using the color picker, see Use the color picker.
4(Optional) Repeat the process for other template region types, as necessary.
5Click the Show option to enable or disable displaying colors in the Document window.
Note: Nested Region does not have a Show option; its display is controlled by the Editable Region option.
6Click OK.
View highlight colors in the Document window
Select View > Visual Aids > Invisible Elements.
Highlight colors appear in the document window only when View > Visual Aids > Invisible Elements is enabled and
the appropriate options are enabled in Highlighting preferences.
Note: If invisible elements are showing but the highlight colors are not, select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or
Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh), and then select the Highlight category. Make sure that the Show option next
to the appropriate highlight color is selected. Also make sure that the desired color is visible against the background color
of your page.
More Help topics
Recognizing template-based documents in Design view
Recognizing templates in Design view
499
Last updated 6/3/2015
Chapter 14: Mobile and multiscreen
Creating media queries
You can use media queries to specify CSS files based on the reported characteristics of a device (responsive design). The
browser on a device checks the media query and uses the corresponding CSS file to display the web page.
For example, the following media query specifies the phone.css file for devices that are 300-320 pixels wide.
<link href="css/orig/phone.css" rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" media="all and (min-width:
300px) and (max-width: 320px)">
For an extensive introduction to media queries see Don Booths article on the Adobe Developer Center
www.adobe.com/go/learn_dw_medquery_don_en.
For more information on media queries from the W3C see www.w3.org/TR/css3-mediaqueries/.
More Help topics
Responsive design using fluid grid layouts
Create a media query
In Dreamweaver, you can create a site-wide media query file, or a document-specific media query. Site-wide media
query fileSpecifies display settings for all pages in your site that include the file.The site-wide media query file acts as
the central repository for all media queries in your site. After you create this file, link to it from pages in your site that
must use the media queries in the file for their display.Document-specific media queryThe media query is inserted
directly into the document, and the page is displayed based on the inserted media query.
1Create a web page.
2Select Modify > Media Queries.
3Do one of the following:
To create a site-wide media query file, select Site Wide Media Queries File.
To create a document-specific media query, select This Document.
4For site-wide media query, do the following:
aClick Specify.
bSelect Create New File.
cSpecify a name for the file, and click OK.
5It is possible that some devices do not report their actual width. To force devices to report their actual width, ensure
that the option Force Devices To Report Actual Width is enabled.
The following code is inserted into your file when you choose this option.
<meta name="viewport" content="width=device-width">
500
Mobile and multiscreen
Last updated 6/3/2015
6Do one of the following:
Click "+" to define the properties for the media query file.
Click Default Presets if you want to begin with standard presets.
7Select rows in the table, and edit their properties using the options under Properties.
Description The description of the device for which the CSS file must be used. For example, phone, TV, tablet, and
so on.
Min Width and Max width The CSS file is used for devices whose reported width is within the specified values.
Note: Leave either Min Width or Max Width blank if you do not want to specify an explicit range for a device. For
example, it is common to leave Min Width blank if you want to target phones, which are 320px wide, or less.
CSS file Select Use Existing File, and browse to the CSS file for the device.
If you want to specify a CSS file that you are yet to create, select Create New File. Enter the name of the CSS file. The
file is created when you press OK.
8Click OK.
9For site-wide media query, a new file is created. Save it.
Site-wide media query: For existing pages, ensure that you include the media query file in all the pages in the <head>
tag.
Example of a media query link where mediaquery_adobedotcom.css is the site-wide media query file for the site
www.adobe.com:
<link href="mediaquery_adobedotcom.css" rel="stylesheet" type="text/css">
Use an existing media queries file
1Create a web page, or open an existing page.
2Select Modify > Media Queries.
3Select Site-Wide Media Queries File.
4Click Specify.
5Select Use Existing File if you have already created a CSS file with the Media Query.
6Click the browse icon to navigate to, and specify the file. Click OK.
7Select Site-Wide Media Queries File.
8To force devices to report their actual width, ensure that the option Force Devices To Report Actual Width is
enabled. The following code is inserted into your file when you choose this option.
<meta name="viewport" content="width=device-width">
9Click OK.
Choose a different site-wide media queries file
Use this procedure to change the site-wide media queries file that you have set in the Media Queries dialog box.
1Select Site > Manage Sites.
2In the Manage Sites dialog, select your site.
3Click Edit. The Site Setup dialog box is displayed.
501
Mobile and multiscreen
Last updated 6/3/2015
4Under Advanced Settings in the left panel, select Local Info.
5In Site-Wide Media Query File on the right panel, click Browse to select the media query CSS file.
Note: Changing the site-wide media queries file does not affect documents linked to a different or previous site-wide
media query file.
6Click Save.
Viewing web pages based on media query
Dimensions specified in a media query appear in the options for Multiscreen button/window size. When you select a
dimension from the menu, the following changes are seen:
The view size changes to reflect the specified dimensions. The document frame size is unaltered.
The CSS file specified in the media query is used to display the page.
Change page orientation for mobile devices
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
In most advanced mobile devices, the orientation of a page changes based on how the device is held. When the user
holds the phone vertically, the portrait view is displayed. When the user flips the device horizontally, the page readjusts
itself to fit the landscape dimensions.
In Dreamweaver, the option to view a page in either Portrait or Landscape orientation is available in both Live View
and Design View. Using these options you can test how your page adapts to these settings. You can then, if necessary,
modify your CSS file such that the page is displayed as intended in both these orientations.
Select View > Window Size > Orientation Landscape, or Orientation Portrait.
Creating web applications for mobile devices
Dreamweavers integration with jQuery Mobile helps you quickly design a web application that works on most mobile
devices while adapting itself to the dimensions of the device.
Creating a web application using jQuery Mobile
Open a jQuery Mobile starter page, or create a HTML5 page
Use the jQuery Mobile starter pages in Dreamweaver to create your application. Alternatively, you can start creating
your web application with a new HTML5 page.
The jQuery Mobile starter pages include the HTML, CSS, JavaScript, and image files that help you get started with
designing your application. You can use the CSS and JavaScript files hosted on a CDN, your own server, or files installed
along with Dreamweaver.
Note: To identify the location of the linked files, see the <link> and <script src> tags in code view.
Insert jQuery Mobile components from the Insert panel
Insert jQuery Mobile components from the Insert panel into the HTML page. The jQuery Mobile CSS and JavaScript
files define the style and behavior of the components.
502
Mobile and multiscreen
Last updated 6/3/2015
About CDNs and local jQuery Mobile files
CDNs
A CDN (content delivery network) is a computer network containing copies of data placed at various points in the
network. When you create a web application using the URL for a CDN, the CSS and JavaScript files specified in the
URL are used for your application. By default, Dreamweaver uses the jQuery Mobile CDN.
Alternatively, you can use URLs of CDNs from other sites such as Microsoft and Google. In code view, edit the server
location of the CSS and JavaScript files specified in the <link> and <script src> tags.
The files downloaded from a CDN are read-only.
Local jQuery Mobile files
When you install Dreamweaver, a copy of the jQuery Mobile files is copied to your computer. The HTML page that
opens when you choose the jQuery Mobile (local) starter page is linked to local CSS, JavaScript, and image files.
Starter pages for jQuery Mobile
Dreamweaver provides you with the following starter pages to create your web application:
jQuery Mobile (CDN)
Use this starter page if you plan to host the jQuery Mobile library on a CDN.
jQuery Mobile (Local)
Use this starter page if you plan to host the assets yourself, or if your application doesn’t rely on an Internet connection.
jQuery Mobile (PhoneGap)
Use this starter page if your web application, when deployed as a mobile application, accesses features native to mobile
devices. For more information, see Packaging web applications .
Use starter pages to create an application for mobile devices
1Select File > New.
2Select one of the following based on your requirement:
Page From Sample > Mobile Starters > jQuery Mobile (CDN).
Page From Sample > Mobile Starters > jQuery Mobile (Local).
3Click Create.
In the page that appears, enable Follow Links Continuously (View > Live View Options), and switch to Live View.
Use the navigation components to test how the application works.
503
Mobile and multiscreen
Last updated 6/3/2015
Use the options in the Multiscreen menu to see how the design is displayed in devices with various dimensions.
Disable Live view, and switch back to the Design view.
4In the Insert panel (Window > Insert), select jQuery Mobile. The components that you can add to the web
application are displayed.
5In Design view, place the cursor at the location where you want to insert the component, and click the component
in the Insert Panel. In the dialog box that appears, customize the components using the options.
6(jQuery Mobile - Local) After you save the HTML file, the jQuery Mobile files, including image files, are copied to
a folder in the HTML file location.
Preview the page in Live view. Some of the CSS classes are applied only in the Live view.
Create a web application for mobile devices from a new page
The Page component acts as the container for all the other jQuery Mobile components. Add the Page component before
you proceed to insert other components.
1Select File > New.
2Select Blank Page > HTML.
Some of the jQuery Mobile components use HTML5-specific attributes. To ensure HTML5 compliance during
validation, ensure that you select HTML5 as your DocType.
3In the Insert panel (Window > Insert), select jQuery Mobile from the menu. The jQuery Mobile components appear
in the panel.
4From the Insert panel, drag the Page component to Design view.
5In the jQuery Mobile Files dialog, select one of the following:
Remote (CDN) If you want to connect to a remote CDN server hosting the jQuery Mobile files. Use the default
option for the jQuery site if you have not configured a site containing jQuery Mobile files. You can also choose to
use other CDN servers.
Local The files that are available in Dreamweaver are displayed. To specify a different folder, click Browse, and
navigate to the folder containing the jQuery Mobile files.
The CSS and JavaScript files are copied to a local temp directory until you save the HTML file to your computer.
After you save the HTML file, all associated jQuery Mobile and image files are copied to a folder in the sites root
folder.
6Enter the properties for the Page component.
7In Design view, place the cursor at the location where you want to insert the component, and click the component
in the Insert Panel. In the dialog box that appears, customize the components using the options.
Preview the page in Live view. Some of the CSS classes are applied only in the Live view.
Using custom files and folders
You can choose to create custom CSS and JS files for your application. Ensure that your files are named jquery.mobile.js,
jquery.mobile.css, and jquery.js
If you are using custom folders, do the following:
1Download the uncompressed version of the jQuery 1.5 core library from
http://docs.jquery.com/Downloading_jQuery#Download_jQuery.
504
Mobile and multiscreen
Last updated 6/3/2015
2Save the file to the core folder containing the other resources.
More Help topics
http://jquerymobile.com/demos/1.0a3/
http://docs.jquery.com/Downloading_jQuery#CDN_Hosted_jQuery
http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Content_delivery_network
http://docs.jquery.com/Downloading_jQuery
505
Last updated 6/3/2015
Chapter 15: XML
About XML and XSLT
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Using XML and XSL with web pages
Extensible Markup Language (XML) is a language that lets you structure information. Like HTML, XML lets you
structure your information using tags, but XML tags are not predefined as HTML tags are. Instead, XML lets you create
tags that best define your data structure (schema). Tags are nested within others to create a schema of parent and child
tags. Like most HTML tags, all tags in an XML schema have an opening and closing tag.
The following example shows the basic structure of an XML file:
<?xml version=“1.0”>
<mybooks>
<book bookid=“1”>
<pubdate>03/01/2004</pubdate>
<title>Displaying XML Data with Adobe Dreamweaver</title>
<author>Charles Brown</author>
</book>
<book bookid=“2”>
<pubdate>04/08/2004</pubdate>
<title>Understanding XML</title>
<author>John Thompson</author>
</book>
</mybooks>
In this example, each parent <book> tag contains three child tags: <pubdate>, <title>, and <author>. But each <book>
tag is also a child tag of the <mybooks> tag, which is one level higher in the schema. You can name and structure XML
tags in any way, provided that you nest tags accordingly within others, and assign each opening tag a corresponding
closing tag.
XML documents do not contain any formatting—they are simply containers of structured information. Once you have
an XML schema, you can use the Extensible Stylesheet Language (XSL) to display the information. In the way that
Cascading Style Sheets (CSS) let you format HTML, XSL lets you format XML data. You can define styles, page
elements, layout, and so forth in an XSL file and attach it to an XML file so that when a user views the XML data in a
browser, the data is formatted according to whatever you’ve defined in the XSL file. The content (the XML data) and
presentation (defined by the XSL file) are entirely separate, providing you with greater control over how your
information appears on a web page. In essence, XSL is a presentation technology for XML, where the primary output
is an HTML page.
506
XML
Last updated 6/3/2015
Extensible Stylesheet Language Transformations (XSLT) is a subset language of XSL that actually lets you display XML
data on a web page, and “transform” it, along with XSL styles, into readable, styled information in the form of HTML.
You can use Dreamweaver to create XSLT pages that let you perform XSL transformations using an application server
or a browser. In a server-side XSL transformation, the server does the work of transforming the XML and XSL, and
displaying it on the page. In a client-side transformation, a browser (such as Internet Explorer) does the work.
The approach you ultimately take (server-side transformations versus client-side transformations) depends on what
you are trying to achieve as an end result, the technologies available to you, the level of access you have to XML source
files, and other factors. Both approaches have their own benefits and limitations. For example, server-side
transformations work in all browsers while client-side transformations are restricted to modern browsers only (Internet
Explorer 6, Netscape 8, Mozilla 1.8, and Firefox 1.0.2). Server-side transformations let you display XML data
dynamically from your own server or from anywhere else on the web, while client-side transformations must use XML
data that is locally hosted on your own web server. Finally, server-side transformations require that you deploy your
pages to a configured application server, while client-side transformations only require access to a web server.
For a tutorial about understanding XML, see www.adobe.com/go/vid0165.
Server-side XSL transformations
Dreamweaver provides methods for creating XSLT pages that let you perform server-side XSL transformations. When
an application server performs the XSL transformation, the file containing the XML data can reside on your own server,
or anywhere else on the web. Additionally, any browser can display the transformed data. Deploying pages for server-
side transformations, however, is somewhat complex, and requires that you have access to an application server.
When working with server-side XSL transformations, you can use Dreamweaver to create XSLT pages that generate full
HTML documents (entire XSLT pages), or XSLT fragments that generate a portion of an HTML document. An entire
XSLT page is similar to a regular HTML page. It contains a <body> tag and a <head> tag, and lets you display a
combination of HTML and XML data on the page. An XSLT fragment is a piece of code, used by a separate document,
that displays formatted XML data. Unlike an entire XSLT page, it is an independent file that contains no <body> or
<head> tag. If you want to display XML data on a page of its own, you would create an entire XSLT page, and bind your
XML data to it. If, on the other hand, you wanted to display XML data in a particular section of an existing dynamic
page—for example, a dynamic home page for a sporting goods store, with sports scores from an RSS feed displayed on
one side of the page—you would create an XSLT fragment and insert a reference to it in the dynamic page. Creating
XSLT fragments, and using them in conjunction with other dynamic pages to display XML data, is the more common
scenario.
The first step in creating these types of pages is to create the XSLT fragment. It is a separate file that contains the layout,
formatting, and so on of the XML data that you eventually want to display in the dynamic page. Once you create the
XSLT fragment, you insert a reference to it in your dynamic page (for example, a PHP or ColdFusion page). The
inserted reference to the fragment works much like an Server Side Include (SSI) — the formatted XML data (the
fragment) resides in a separate file, while in Design view, a placeholder for the fragment appears on the dynamic page
itself. When a browser requests the dynamic page containing the reference to the fragment, the server processes the
included instruction and creates a new document in which the formatted contents of the fragment appear instead of
the placeholder.
507
XML
Last updated 6/3/2015
A Browser requests dynamic page B Web server finds page and passes it to application server C Application server scans page for instructions
and gets XSLT fragment D Application server performs transformation (reads XSLT fragment, gets and formats xml data) E Application server
inserts transformed fragment into page and passes it back to the web server F Web server sends finished page to browser
You use the XSL Transformation server behavior to insert the reference to an XSLT fragment in a dynamic page. When
you insert the reference, Dreamweaver generates an includes/MM_XSLTransform/ folder in the sites root folder that
contains a runtime library file. The application server uses the functions defined in this file when transforming the
specified XML data. The file is responsible for fetching the XML data and XSLT fragments, performing the XSL
transformation, and outputting the results on the web page.
The file containing the XSLT fragment, the XML file containing your data, and the generated run-time library file must
all be on the server for your page to display correctly. (If you select a remote XML file as your data source—one from
an RSS feed, for example—that file must of course reside somewhere else on the Internet.)
You can also use Dreamweaver to create entire XSLT pages for use with server-side transformations. An entire XSLT
page works in exactly the same way as an XSLT fragment, only when you insert the reference to the entire XSLT page
using the XSL Transformation server behavior, you are inserting the full contents of an HTML page. Thus, the dynamic
page (the .cfm, .php, or .asp page that acts as the container page) must be cleared of all HTML before you insert the
reference.
Dreamweaver supports XSL transformations for ColdFusion, ASP, and PHP pages.
Note: Your server must be correctly configured to perform server-side transformations. For more information, contact your
server administrator.
Client-side XSL transformations
You can perform XSL transformations on the client without the use of an application server. You can use Dreamweaver
to create an entire XSLT page that will do this; however, client-side transformations require manipulation of the XML
file that contains the data you want to display. Additionally, client-side transformations will only work in modern
browsers (Internet Explorer 6, Netscape 8, Mozilla 1.8, and Firefox 1.0.2). For more information on browsers that do
and dont support XSL transformations, see www.w3schools.com/xsl/xsl_intro.asp.
508
XML
Last updated 6/3/2015
First, create an entire XSLT page and attach an XML data source. (Dreamweaver prompts you to attach the data source
when you create the new page.) You can create an XSLT page from scratch, or you can convert an existing HTML page
to an XSLT page. When you convert an existing HTML page to an XSLT page you must attach an XML data source
using the Bindings panel (Window > Bindings).
After you’ve created your XSLT page, you must link it to the XML file containing the XML data by inserting a reference
to the XSLT page in the XML file itself (much like you would insert a reference to an external CSS style sheet in the
<head> section of an HTML page). Your site visitors must view the XML file (not the XSLT page) in a browser. When
your site visitors view the page, the browser performs the XSL transformation and displays the XML data, formatted by
the linked XSLT page.
The relationship between the linked XSLT and XML pages is conceptually similar, yet different from the external
CSS/HTML page model. When you have an HTML page that contains content (such as text), you use an external style
sheet to format that content. The HTML page determines the content, and the external CSS code, which the user never
sees, determines the presentation. With XSLT and XML, the situation is reversed. The XML file (which the user never
sees in its raw form), determines the content while the XSLT page determines the presentation. The XSLT page contains
the tables, layout, graphics, and so forth that the standard HTML usually contains. When a user views the XML file in
a browser, the XSLT page formats the content.
A Browser requests XML file B Server responds by sending XML file to browser C Browser reads XML directive and calls XSLT file D Server
sends XSLT file to browser E Browser transforms XML data and displays it in browser
When you use Dreamweaver to link an XSLT page to an XML page, Dreamweaver inserts the appropriate code for you
at the top of the XML page. If you own the XML page to which youre linking (that is, if the XML file exclusively lives
on your web server), all you need to do is use Dreamweaver to insert the appropriate code that links the two pages.
When you own the XML file, the XSL transformations performed by the client are fully dynamic. That is, whenever you
update the data in the XML file, any HTML output using the linked XSLT page will be automatically updated with the
new information.
Note: The XML and XSL files you use for client-side transformations must reside in the same directory. If they don’t, the
browser will read the XML file and find the XSLT page for the transformation, but will fail to find assets (style sheets,
images, and so on) defined by relative links in the XSLT page.
509
XML
Last updated 6/3/2015
If you don’t own the XML page to which youre linking (for example, if you want to use XML data from an RSS feed
somewhere out on the web), the workflow is a bit more complicated. To perform client-side transformations using XML
data from an external source, you must first download the XML source file to the same directory where your XSLT page
resides. When the XML page is in your local site, you can use Dreamweaver to add the appropriate code that links it to
the XSLT page, and post both pages (the downloaded XML file and the linked XSLT page) to your web server. When
the user views the XML page in a browser, the XSLT page formats the content, just like in the previous example.
The disadvantage of performing client-side XSL transformations on XML data that comes from an external source is
that the XML data is only partially “dynamic.” The XML file that you download and alter is merely a “snapshot” of the
file that lives elsewhere on the web. If the original XML file out on the web changes, you must download the file again,
link it to the XSLT page, and repost the XML file to your web server. The browser only renders the data that it receives
from the XML file on your web server, not the data contained in the original XML source file.
XML data and repeating elements
The Repeating Region XSLT object lets you display repeating elements from an XML file within a page. Any region
containing an XML data placeholder can be turned into a repeated region. However, the most common regions are a
table, a table row, or a series of table rows.
The following example shows how the Repeating Region XSLT object is applied to a table row that displays menu
information for a restaurant. The initial row displays three different elements from the XML schema: item, description,
and price. When the Repeating Region XSLT object is applied to the table row, and the page is processed by an
application server or a browser, the table is repeated with unique data inserted in each new table row.
510
XML
Last updated 6/3/2015
When you apply a Repeating Region XSLT object to an element in the Document window, a thin, tabbed, gray outline
appears around the repeated region. When you preview your work in a browser (File > Preview in Browser), the gray
outline disappears and the selection expands to display the specified repeating elements in the XML file, as in the
previous illustration.
When you add the Repeating Region XSLT object to the page, the length of the XML data placeholder in the Document
window is truncated. This is because Dreamweaver updates the XPath (XML Path language) expression for the XML
data placeholder so that it is relative to the path of the repeating element.
For example, the following code is for a table that contains two dynamic placeholders, without a Repeating Region
XSLT object applied to the table:
<table width="500" border="1">
<tr>
<td><xsl:value-of select="rss/channel/item/title"/></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td><xsl:value-of select="rss/channel/item/description"/></td>
</tr>
</table>
The following code is for the same table with the Repeating Region XSLT object applied to it:
<xsl:for-each select="rss/channel/item">
<table width="500" border="1">
<tr>
<td><xsl:value-of select="title"/></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td><xsl:value-of select="description"/></td>
</tr>
</table>
</xsl:for-each>
In the previous example, Dreamweaver has updated the XPath for the items that fall within the Repeating Region (title
& description) to be relative to the XPath in the enclosing <xsl:for-each> tags, rather than the full document.
Dreamweaver generates context-relative XPath expressions in other cases as well. For example, if you drag an XML data
placeholder to a table that already has a Repeating Region XSLT object applied to it, Dreamweaver automatically
displays the XPath relative to the existing XPath in the enclosing <xsl:for-each> tags.
Previewing XML data
When you use Preview in Browser (File > Preview in Browser) to preview XML data that you’ve inserted in an XSLT
fragment or an entire XSLT page, the engine that performs the XSL transformation differs from situation to situation.
For dynamic pages containing XSLT fragments, the application server always performs the transformation. At other
times, either Dreamweaver or the browser might be performing the transformation.
The following table summarizes the situations when using Preview in Browser, and the engines that perform the
respective transformations:
Type of page previewed in browser Data transformation performed by
Dynamic page containing XSLT fragment Application server
XSLT fragment or entire XSLT page Dreamweaver
XML file with link to entire XSLT page Browser
511
XML
Last updated 6/3/2015
The following topics provide guidelines for helping you determine the appropriate previewing methods, based on your
needs.
Previewing pages for server-side transformations
In the case of server-side transformations, the content the site visitor ultimately sees is transformed by your application
server. When building XSLT and dynamic pages for use with server-side transformations, it is always preferable to
preview the dynamic page that contains the XSLT fragment instead of the XSLT fragment itself. In the former scenario,
you make use of the application server, which ensures that your preview is consistent with what your site visitors will
see when they visit your page. In the latter scenario, Dreamweaver performs the transformation, and could provide
slightly inconsistent results. You can use Dreamweaver to preview your XSLT fragment while you are building it, but
youll be able to see the most accurate results of the data rendering if you use the application server to preview your
dynamic page after you’ve inserted the XSLT fragment.
Previewing pages for client-side transformations
In the case of client-side transformations, the content the site visitor ultimately sees is transformed by a browser. You
accomplish this by adding a link from the XML file to the XSLT page. If you open the XML file in Dreamweaver and
preview it in a browser, you force the browser to load the XML file and perform the transformation. This provides you
with the same experience as that of your site visitor.
Using this approach, however, makes it more difficult to debug your page because the browser transforms the XML and
generates the HTML internally. If you select the browser’s View Source option to debug the generated HTML, you will
only see the original XML that the browser received, not the full HTML (tags, styles, and so forth) responsible for the
rendering of the page. To see the full HTML when viewing source code, you must preview the XSLT page in a browser
instead.
Previewing entire XSLT pages and XSLT fragments
When creating entire XSLT pages and XSLT fragments, you’ll want to preview your work to make sure that your data
is being displayed correctly. If you use Preview in Browser to display an entire XSLT page or an XSLT fragment,
Dreamweaver performs the transformation using a built-in transformation engine. This method gives you quick
results, and makes it easier for you to incrementally build and debug your page. It also provides a way for you to view
the full HTML (tags, styles, and so forth) by selecting the View Source option in the browser.
Note: This previewing method is commonly used when you begin building XSLT pages, regardless of whether you use the
client or the server to transform your data.
More Help topics
XML tutorial
Performing XSL transformations on the server
Performing XSL transformations on the client
Display repeating XML elements
Performing XSL transformationson the server
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
512
XML
Last updated 6/3/2015
Workflow for performing server-side XSL transformations
You can perform server-side XSL transformations on the server. Read about server-side and client-side XSL
transformations and about using XML and XSL with web pages before building pages that display XML data.
Note: Your server must be correctly configured to perform server-side transformations. For more information, contact your
server administrator.
The general workflow for performing server-side XSL transformations is as follows (each step is described in other
topics):
1.Set up a Dreamweaver site.
2.Choose a server technology and set up an application server.
3.Test the application server.
For example, create a page that requires processing, and make sure that the application server processes the page.
4.Create an XSLT fragment or page, or convert an HTML page to an XSLT page.
In your Dreamweaver site, create an XSLT fragment or an entire XSLT page.
Convert an existing HTML page to an entire XSLT page.
5.Attach an XML data source to the page.
6.Display XML data by binding the data to the XSLT fragment or to the entire XSLT page.
7.If appropriate, add a Repeating Region XSLT object to the table or table row that contains the XML data
placeholders.
8.Insert references.
To insert a reference to the XSLT fragment in your dynamic page, use the XSL Transformation server behavior.
To insert a reference to the entire XSLT page in the dynamic page, delete all of the HTML code from a dynamic page,
and then use the XSL Transformation server behavior.
9.Post the page and the fragment.
Post both the dynamic page and the XSLT fragment (or entire XSLT page) to your application server. If you are using
a local XML file, you will need to post that as well.
10.View the dynamic page in a browser.
When you do so, the application server transforms the XML data, inserts it in the dynamic page, and displays it in the
browser.
Create an XSLT page
You can create XSLT pages that let you display XML data on web pages. You can create either an entire XSLT page—an
XSLT page that contains a <body> tag and a <head> tag—or you can create an XSLT fragment. When you create an
XSLT fragment, you create an independent file that contains no body or head tag—a simple piece of code that is later
inserted in a dynamic page.
Note: If you are starting with an existing XSLT page, you need to attach an XML data source to it.
1Select File > New.
2In the Blank Page category of the New Document dialog box, select one of the following from the Page Type column:
Select XSLT (Entire page) to create an entire XSLT page.
513
XML
Last updated 6/3/2015
Select XSLT (Fragment) to create an XSLT fragment.
3Click Create and do one of the following in the Locate XML Source dialog box:
Select Attach A Local File, click the Browse button, browse to a local XML file on your computer, and click OK.
Select Attach A Remote File, enter the URL of an XML file on the Internet (such as one coming from an RSS
feed), and click OK.
Note: Clicking the Cancel button generates a new XSLT page with no attached XML data source.
The Bindings panel is populated with the schema of your XML data source
The following table provides an explanation of the various elements in the schema that might appear:
4Save your new page (File > Save) with the .xsl or .xslt extension (.xsl is the default).
Convert HTML pages to XSLT pages
You can also convert existing HTML pages to XSLT pages. For example, if you have a predesigned static page to which
you want to add XML data, you can convert the page to an XSLT page, instead of creating an XSLT page and redesigning
the page from scratch.
1Open the HTML page that you want to convert.
2Select File > Convert > XSLT 1.0.
A copy of the page opens in the Document window. The new page is an XSL style sheet, saved with the .xsl extension.
Attach XML data sources
If you are starting with an existing XSLT page, or if you don’t attach an XML data source when creating a new XSLT
page with Dreamweaver, you must attach an XML data source using the Bindings panel.
1In the Bindings panel (Window > Bindings), click the XML link.
Element Represents Details
<> Required non-repeating XML element An element that appears exactly once
within its parent node
<>+ Repeating XML element An element that appears one or more
times within its parent node
<>+ Optional XML element An element that appears zero or more
times within its parent node
Element node in boldface type Current context element Normally the repeating element when the
insertion point is inside a repeating region
@XML attribute
514
XML
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: You can also click the Source link at the upper-right corner of the Bindings panel to add an XML data source.
2Do one of the following:
Select Attach A Local File, click the Browse button, browse to a local XML file on your computer, and click OK.
Select Attach A Remote File, and enter the URL of an XML file on the Internet (such as one coming from an RSS
feed).
3Click OK to close the Locate XML Source dialog box.
The Bindings panel is populated with the schema of your XML data source.
Display XML data in XSLT pages
After you’ve created an XSLT page and attached an XML data source, you can bind data to the page. To do this, you add
an XML data placeholder to your page and then use the XPath Expression Builder or the Property inspector to format
selected data that will be displayed on the page.
1Open an XSLT page with an attached XML data source.
2(Optional) Select Insert > Table to add a table to the page. A table helps you organize your XML data.
Note: In most cases, you use the Repeating Region XSLT object to display repeating XML elements on a page. In this
case, you might want to create a single-row table with one or more columns, or a two-row table if you want to include
a table header.
3In the Bindings panel, select an XML element and drag it to the place on the page where you want to insert data.
515
XML
Last updated 6/3/2015
An XML data placeholder appears on the page. The placeholder is highlighted and in curly brackets. It uses the
XPath (XML Path language) syntax to describe the hierarchical structure of the XML schema. For example, if you
drag the child element title to the page, and that element has the parent elements rss, channel, and item, then the
syntax for the dynamic content placeholder will be {rss/channel/item/title}.
Double-click the XML data placeholder on the page to open the XPath Expression Builder. The XPath Expression
Builder lets you format selected data, or select other items from the XML schema.
4(Optional) Apply styles to your XML data by selecting an XML data placeholder and applying styles to it like any
other piece of content using the Property inspector or the CSS Styles panel. Alternatively, you can use Design-time
style sheets to apply styles to XSLT fragments. Each of these methods has its own set of benefits and limitations.
5Preview your work in a browser (File > Preview in Browser).
Note: When you preview your work using Preview in Browser, Dreamweaver performs an internal XSL transformation
without the use of an application server.
Display repeating XML elements
The Repeating Region XSLT object lets you display repeating elements from an XML data source in a web page. For
example, if you are displaying article titles and descriptions from a news feed, and that news feed contains between 10
and 20 articles, each title and description in the XML file would probably be a child element of a repeating element.
Any region in Design view containing an XML data placeholder can be changed to a repeated region. However, the
most common regions are tables, table rows, or a series of table rows.
1In Design view, select a region that contains an XML data placeholder or placeholders.
The selection can be anything, including a table, a table row, or even a paragraph of text.
To select a region on the page precisely, you can use the tag selector in the lower-left corner of the Document window.
For example, if the region is a table, click inside the table on the page, and then click the tag in the tag selector.
2Do one of the following
Select Insert > XSLT Objects > Repeating Region.
In the XSLT category of the Insert panel, click the Repeating Region button.
3In the XPath Expression Builder, select the repeating element, indicated by a small plus sign.
516
XML
Last updated 6/3/2015
4Click OK.
In the Document window, a thin, tabbed, gray outline appears around the repeated region. When you preview your
work in a browser (File > Preview in Browser), the gray outline disappears and the selection expands to display the
specified repeating elements in the XML file.
When you add the Repeating Region XSLT object to the page, the XML data placeholder in the Document window
is truncated. This is because Dreamweaver truncates the XPath for the XML data placeholder so that it is relative to
the path of the repeating element.
Set Repeating Region (XSL) properties
In the Property inspector, you can select a different XML node to create the repeating region.
In the Select box, enter a new node, and then press the lightning bolt icon and select the node from the XML schema
tree that appears.
Edit a Repeating Region XSLT object
After you’ve added a Repeating Region XSLT object to a region, you can edit it using the Property inspector.
1Select the object by clicking the gray tab that surrounds the repeated region.
2In the Property inspector (Window > Properties), click the dynamic icon next to the Select text field.
3In the XPath Expression Builder, make your changes and click OK.
Insert XSLT fragments in dynamic pages
After you have created an XSLT fragment, you can insert it in a dynamic web page using the XSL Transformation server
behavior. When you add the server behavior to your page and view the page in a browser, an application server
performs a transformation that displays the XML data from the selected XSLT fragment. Dreamweaver supports XSL
transformations for ColdFusion, ASP, or PHP pages.
517
XML
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: If you want to insert the contents of an entire XSLT page in a dynamic page, the procedure is exactly the same. Before
using the XSL Transformation server behavior to insert the entire XSLT page, delete all HTML code from the dynamic page.
1Open an existing ColdFusion, ASP, or PHP page.
2In Design view, place the insertion point in the location where you want to insert the XSLT fragment.
Note: When inserting XSLT fragments, you should always click the Show Code And Design Views button after placing
the insertion point on the page so that you can ensure that the insertion point is in the correct location. If it isn’t, you
might need to click somewhere else in Code view to place the insertion point where you want it.
3In the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors), click the Plus (+) button and select XSL
Transformation.
4In the XSL Transformation dialog box, click the Browse button and browse to an XSLT fragment or an entire XSLT
page.
Dreamweaver populates the next text field with the file path or URL of the XML file that is attached to the specified
fragment. To change it, click the Browse button and browse to another file.
5(Optional) Click the Plus (+) button to add an XSLT parameter.
6Click OK to insert a reference to the XSLT fragment in the page. The fragment is not editable. You can double-click
the fragment to open the fragment’s source file and edit it.
An includes/MM_XSLTransform/ folder is also created in the sites root folder that contains a runtime library file.
The application server uses the functions defined in this file to perform the transformation.
7Upload the dynamic page to your server (Site > Put) and click Yes to include dependent files. The file containing the
XSLT fragment, the XML file containing your data, and the generated run-time library file must all be on the server
for your page to display correctly. (If you selected a remote XML file as your data source, that file must reside
somewhere else on the Internet.)
518
XML
Last updated 6/3/2015
Delete XSLT fragments from dynamic pages
You can remove an XSLT fragment from a page by deleting the XSL Transformation server behavior used to insert the
fragment. Deleting the server behavior deletes the XSLT fragment only—it does not delete the associated XML, XSLT,
or run-time library files.
1In the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors), select the XSL Transformation server behavior that you
want to delete.
2Click the minus (-) button.
Note: You should always remove server behaviors in this fashion. Manually deleting the generated code only partially
removes the server behavior, even though the server behavior may disappear from the Server Behaviors panel.
Edit XSL Transformation server behaviors
After you’ve added an XSLT fragment to a dynamic web page, you can edit the XSL Transformation server behavior at
any time.
1In the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors), double-click the XSL Transformation server behavior
that you want to edit.
2Make your changes and click OK.
Create a dynamic link
You can create a dynamic link on your XSLT page that links to a specific URL when the user clicks a specified word or
group of words from your XML data. For full instructions, see the Dreamweaver errata at
www.adobe.com/go/dw_documentation.
Applying styles to XSLT fragments
When you create an entire XSLT page (that is, an XSLT page that contains <body> and <head> tags), you can display
XML data on the page and then format the data like any other piece of content using the Property inspector or the CSS
Styles panel. When you create an XSLT fragment for insertion in a dynamic page, however (for example, a fragment for
insertion in an ASP, PHP, or Cold Fusion page), the rendering of styles in the fragment and in the dynamic page
becomes more complicated. Although you work on an XSLT fragment separately from the dynamic page, it is
important to remember that the fragment is intended for use within the dynamic page, and that the output from the
XSLT fragment ultimately resides somewhere within the <body> tags of the dynamic page. Given this workflow, it is
important to make sure that you do not include <head> elements (such as style definitions or links to external style
sheets) in XSLT fragments. Doing so will cause the application server to place these elements into the <body> of the
dynamic page, thereby generating invalid markup.
For example, you might want to create an XSLT fragment for insertion in a dynamic page and format the fragment
using the same external style sheet as the dynamic page. If you attach the same style sheet to the fragment, the resulting
HTML page contains a duplicate link to the style sheet (one in the <head> section of the dynamic page, and another in
the <body> section of the page, where the content of the XSLT fragment appears). Instead of this approach, you should
use Design-time style sheets to reference the external style sheet.
When formatting the content of XSLT fragments, use the following workflow:
First, attach an external style sheet to the dynamic page. (This is a best practice for applying styles to the content of
any web page).
Next, attach the same external style sheet to the XSLT fragment as a Design-time style sheet. As the name implies,
Design-time style sheets only work in the Dreamweaver Design view.
519
XML
Last updated 6/3/2015
After you have completed the two previous steps, you can create new styles in your XSLT fragment using the same
style sheet that you’ve attached to your dynamic page. The HTML output will be cleaner (because the reference to
the style sheet is only valid while working in Dreamweaver), and the fragment will still display the appropriate styles
in Design view. Additionally, all of your styles will be applied to both the fragment and the dynamic page when you
view the dynamic page in Design view, or preview the dynamic page in a browser.
Note: If you preview the XSLT fragment in a browser, the browser does not display the styles. Instead you should preview
the dynamic page in the browser to see the XSLT fragment within the context of the dynamic page.
Use parameters with XSL transformations
You can define parameters for your XSL transformation when adding the XSL Transformation server behavior to a web
page. A parameter controls how XML data is processed and displayed. For example, you might use a parameter to
identify and list a specific article from a news feed. When the page loads in a browser, only the article you specified with
the parameter appears.
Add an XSLT parameter to an XSL transformation
1Open the XSL Transformation dialog box. You can do this by double-clicking an XSL Transformation server
behavior in the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors), or by adding a new XSL Transformation
server behavior.
2In the XSL Transformation dialog box, click the Plus (+) button next to XSLT Parameters.
3In the Add Parameters dialog box, enter a name for the parameter in the Name box. The name can only contain
alphanumeric characters. It cannot contain spaces.
4Do one of the following:
If you want to use a static value, enter it in the Value box.
If you want to use a dynamic value, click the dynamic icon next to the Value box, complete the Dynamic Data
dialog box, and click OK. For more information, click the Help button in the Dynamic Data dialog box.
5In the Default Value box, enter the value you want the parameter to use if the page receives no run-time value, and
click OK.
Edit an XSLT parameter
1Open the XSL Transformation dialog box. You can do this by double-clicking an XSL Transformation server
behavior in the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors), or by adding a new XSL Transformation
server behavior.
2Select a parameter from the XSLT parameters list.
520
XML
Last updated 6/3/2015
3Click the Edit button.
4Make your changes and click OK.
Delete an XSLT parameter
1Open the XSL Transformation dialog box. You can do this by double-clicking an XSL Transformation server
behavior in the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors), or by adding a new XSL Transformation
server behavior.
2Select a parameter from the XSLT parameters list.
3Click the minus (-) button.
Create and edit conditional XSLT regions
You can create simple conditional regions or multiple conditional regions on an XSLT page. You can either select an
element in Design view and apply a conditional region to the selection, or you can insert a conditional region wherever
the insertion point is in the document.
For example, if you wanted to display the word “Unavailable” next to the price of an item when the item is unavailable,
you type the text “Unavailable” on the page, select it, and then apply a conditional region to the selected text.
Dreamweaver surrounds the selection with <xsl:if> tags, and only displays the word “Unavailable” on the page when
the data match the conditions of the conditional expression.
Apply a conditional XSLT region
You can write a simple conditional expression to insert into your XSLT page. If content is selected when you open the
Conditional Region dialog box, the content will be wrapped in an <xsl:if> block. If you rcontent is not selected, the
<xsl:if> block is added at the insertion point on the page. It’s a good idea to use the dialog box to get started and then
customize the expression in Code view.
The <xsl:if> element is similar to the if statement in other languages. The element provides a way for you to test a
condition and take a course of action based on the result. The <xsl:if> element allows you to test an expression for a
single true or false value.
1Select Insert > XSLT Objects > Conditional Region or click the Conditional Region icon in the XLST category of the
Insert panel.
2In the Conditional Region dialog box, enter the conditional expression to use for the region.
In the following example, you want to test to see if the context nodes @available attribute value is true.
3Click OK.
The following code is inserted in your XSLT page:
<xsl:if test="@available=&apos;true&apos;">
Content goes here
</xsl:if>
521
XML
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: You must surround string values such as true in quotes. Dreamweaver encodes the quotes for you (&apos;) so that
they are entered as valid XHTML.
In addition to testing nodes for values, you can use any of the supported XSLT functions in any conditional
statement. The condition is tested for the current node within your XML file. In the following example, you want to
test for the last node in the result set:
For more information and examples on writing conditional expressions, see the <xsl:if> section in the Reference
panel (Help > Reference).
Apply multiple conditional XSLT regions
You can write a simple conditional expression to insert into your XSLT page. If content is selected when you open the
Conditional Region dialog box, the content is wrapped in an <xsl:choose> block. If you do not select content, the
<xsl:choose> block is added at the insertion point on the page. Its a good idea to use the dialog box to get started and
then customize the expression in Code view.
The <xsl:choose> element is similar to the case statement in other languages. The element provides a way for you to
test a condition and take a course of action based on the result. The <xsl:choose> element allows you to test for multiple
conditions.
1Select Insert > XSLT Objects > Multiple Conditional Region or click the Multiple Conditional Region icon in the
XLST category of the Insert panel.
2In the Multiple Conditional Region dialog box, enter the first condition.
In the following example, you want to test to see if the context nodes price subelement is less than 5.
3Click OK.
In the example, the following code is inserted in your XSLT page:
<xsl:choose>
<xsl:when test="price&lt;5">
Content goes here
</xsl:when>
<xsl:otherwise>
Content goes here
</xsl:otherwise>
</xsl:choose>
522
XML
Last updated 6/3/2015
4To insert another condition, place the insertion point in Code view between <xsl:when> tag pairs or just before the
<xsl:otherwise> tag, and then insert a conditional region (Insert > XSLT Objects > Conditional Region).
After you specify the condition and click OK, another <xsl:when> tag is inserted in the <xsl:choose> block.
For more information and examples on writing conditional expressions, see the <xsl:choose> sections in the
Reference panel (Help > Reference).
Set conditional region (If) properties
The purpose of the Set Conditional Region Property inspector is to change the condition used in a conditional region
in your XSL page. The conditional region tests the condition and takes a course of action based on the result.
In the Test box, enter a new condition, and then press Enter.
Set conditional (When) properties
The purpose of the Set Conditional Region Property inspector is to change the condition used in a multiple conditional
region in your XSL page. The multiple conditional region tests the condition and takes a course of action based on the
result.
In the Test box, enter a new condition, and then press Enter.
Insert XSL comments
You can add XSL comment tags to a document, or you can wrap a selection in XSL comment tags.
Add XSL comment tags to a document
Do one of the following:
In Design view, select Insert > XSLT Objects > XSL Comment, type the contents of the comment (or leave the
box blank), and click OK.
In Code view, select Insert > XSLT Objects > XSL Comment.
You can also click on the XSL Comment icon in the XSLT category of the Insert panel.
Wrap a selection in XSL comment tags
1Switch to Code view (View > Code).
2Select the code you want to comment.
3In the Coding toolbar, click the Apply Comment button and select Apply <xsl:comment></xsl:comment>
Comment.
Use the XPath Expression Builder to add expressions for XML data
XPath (XML Path Language) is a non-XML syntax for addressing portions of an XML document. It is used mostly as
a query language for XML data, just as the SQL language is used to query databases. For more information on XPath,
see the XPath language specification on the W3C website at www.w3.org/TR/xpath.
523
XML
Last updated 6/3/2015
The XPath Expression Builder is a Dreamweaver feature that lets you build simple XPath expressions for identifying
specific nodes of data and for repeating regions. The advantage of using this method instead of dragging values from
the XML schema tree is that you can format the value that is displayed. The current context is identified based on the
position of the insertion point in the XSL file when the XPath Expression Builder dialog box is opened. The current
context is in boldface type in the XML schema tree. As you make selections within this dialog box, the correct XPath
statements, relative to your current context, are generated. This simplifies the process of writing correct XPath
expressions for beginners and advanced users.
Note: This feature is designed to help you build simple XPath expressions to identify a specific node or for repeating regions.
It does not allow you to edit the expressions by hand. If you need to create complex expressions, use the XPath Expression
Builder to get started and then customize your expressions in Code view or with the Property inspector.
Create an XPath expression to identify a specific node
1Double-click the XML data placeholder on the page to open the XPath Expression Builder.
2In the XPath Expression Builder (Dynamic Text) dialog box, select any node in the XML schema tree.
The correct XPath expression is written in the Expression box to identify the node.
Note: If you select a different node in the XML schema tree, the expression changes to reflect your choice.
In the following example, you want to display the price subelement of the item node:
This selection would insert the following code in your XSLT page:
<xsl:value-of select="price"/>
3(Optional) Select a formatting option from the Format pop-up menu.
Formatting a selection is useful when the value of your node returns a number. Dreamweaver provides a predefined
list of formatting functions. For a complete list of available formatting functions and examples, see the Reference
panel.
In the following example, you want to format the price subelement as a currency with two decimal places:
524
XML
Last updated 6/3/2015
These options would insert the following code in your XSLT page:<xsl:value-of select="format-
number(provider/store/items/item/price,'$#.00')"/>
<xsl:value-of select="format-number(provider/store/items/item/price,'$#.00')"/>
4Click OK.
5To display the value of each node in the XML file, apply a repeating region to the element containing the dynamic
text (for example, an HTML table row or a paragraph).
For more information and examples on selecting nodes to return a value, see the <xsl:value-of/> section in the
Reference panel.
Select a node to repeat
You can select a node to repeat over and, optionally, to filter the results. In the XPath Expression Builder dialog box,
your selected content will be wrapped inside an <xsl:for-each> block. If you have not selected content, the <xsl:for-
each> block will be entered at the insertion point of your cursor.
1Double-click the XML data placeholder on the page to open the XPath Expression Builder.
2In the XPath Expression Builder (Repeating Region) dialog box, select the item to repeat in the XML schema tree.
The correct XPath expression is written in the Expression box to identify the node.
Note: Repeating items are identified with a Plus (+) symbol in the XML schema tree.
In the following example, you want to repeat each item node within the XML file.
525
XML
Last updated 6/3/2015
When you click OK, the following code is inserted in your XSLT page:
<xsl:for-each select="provider/store/items/item">
Content goes here
</xsl:for-each>
In some cases, you may want to work with a subset of the repeating nodes—for example, you may only want items
where an attribute has a specific value. In this case, you need to create a filter.
Filter the data to be repeated
Use a filter to identify repeating nodes that have specific attribute values.
1In the XML schema tree, select a node to repeat.
2Click the Build Filter expander button.
3Click the Plus (+) button to create an empty filter.
4Enter the filter criteria in the following fields:
Filter By Specifies the repeating node that contains the data you want to filter by. The pop-up menu provides a list
of ancestor nodes relative to the node you selected in the XML schema tree.
Where Specifies the attribute or subelement of the Filter By node that will be used to limit the results. You can select
an attribute or subelement from the pop-up menu, or you can enter your own XPath expression in this field to
identify children that exist deeper within the schema tree.
Operator Specifies the comparison operator to use in the filter expression.
Value Specifies the value to check for in the Filter By node. Enter the value. If dynamic parameters are defined for
your XSLT page, you can select one from the pop-up menu.
5To specify another filter, click the Plus (+) button again.
As you enter values or make selections in the pop-up menus, the XPath expression in the Expression box changes.
In the following example, you want to restrict the result set to those item nodes where the value of the @available
attribute is true.
526
XML
Last updated 6/3/2015
When you click OK, the following code is inserted in your XSLT page:<xsl:for-each
select="provider/store/items/item[@available = &apos;true&apos;]"> Content goes here </xsl:for-each>
<xsl:for-each select="provider/store/items/item[@available = &apos;true&apos;]">
Content goes here
</xsl:for-each>
Note: You need to surround string values such as true in quotes. Dreamweaver encodes the quotes for you (&apos;) so
that they are entered as valid XHTML.
You can create more complex filters that allow you to specify parent nodes as part of your filter criteria. In the
following example, you want to restrict the result set to those item nodes where the stores @id attribute is equal to
1 and the items price node is greater than 5.
527
XML
Last updated 6/3/2015
When you click OK, the following code is inserted in your XSLT page:<xsl:for-each select="provider/store[@id =
1]/items/item[price &gt; 5]"> Content goes here </xsl:for-each>
For more information and examples of repeating regions, see the <xsl:for-each> section in the Reference panel.
<xsl:for-each select="provider/store[@id = 1]/items/item[price &gt; 5]">
Content goes here
</xsl:for-each>
More Help topics
Working with Dreamweaver sites
Using XML and XSL with web pages
Client-side XSL transformations
Server-side XSL transformations
Previewing XML data
Presenting content with tables
XML data and repeating elements
Server-side XSL transformations
Use Design-Time style sheets
528
XML
Last updated 6/3/2015
Performing XSL transformationson the client
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Workflow for performing client-side XSL transformations
You can perform client-side XSL transformations. Read about server-side and client-side XSL transformations and
about using XML and XSL with web pages before building pages that display XML data.
The general workflow for performing client-side XSL transformations is as follows (each step is described in other
topics):
Set up a Dreamweaver site.
Create an XSLT page or convert an HTML page to XSLT.
In your Dreamweaver site, create an entire XSLT page.
Convert an existing HTML page to an entire XSLT page.
Attach an XML data source to the page (if you haven’t already done so).
The XML file that you attach must reside in the same directory as the XSLT page.
Bind your XML data to the XSLT page.
Display XML data by binding the data to the entire XSLT page.
If appropriate, add a Repeating Region XSLT object to the table or table row that contains the XML data
placeholder(s).
Attach the XSLT page to the XML page.
Post both the XML page and the linked XSLT page to your web server.
View the XML page in a browser.
When you do so, the browser transforms the XML data, formats it with the XSLT page, and displays the styled page in
the browser.
Creating entire XSLT pages and displaying data
You must use an entire XSLT page for client-side transformations. (XSLT fragments dont work for this type of
transformation.) Follow these general steps for creating, binding XML data to, and formatting XSLT pages for client-
side transformations:
Create the XSLT page.
Display data in the XSLT page.
Display repeating elements in the XSLT page.
Link an XSLT page to an XML page
After you have an entire XSLT page with dynamic content placeholders for your XML data, you must insert a reference
to the XSLT page in the XML page.
529
XML
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: The XML and XSL files you use for client-side transformations must reside in the same directory. If they don’t, the
browser will read the XML file and find the XSLT page for the transformation, but will fail to find assets (style sheets,
images, and so on) defined by relative links in the XSLT page.
1Open the XML file that you want to link to your XSLT page.
2Select Commands > Attach an XSLT Stylesheet.
3In the dialog box, click the Browse button, browse to the XSLT page you want to link to, select it, and click OK.
4Click OK to close the dialog box and insert the reference to the XSLT page at the top of the XML document.
More Help topics
Working with Dreamweaver sites
Using XML and XSL with web pages
Client-side XSL transformations
Server-side XSL transformations
Create an XSLT page
Display XML data in XSLT pages
Display repeating XML elements
Missing character entities for XSLT
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Specify a missing character entity
In XSLT, some characters are not allowed in certain contexts. For example, you cannot use the less than sign (<) and
the ampersand (&) in the text between tags or in an attribute value. The XSLT transformation engine will give you an
error if those characters are used incorrectly. To solve the problem, you can specify character entities to replace the
special characters.
A character entity is a string of characters that represents other characters. Character entities are either named or
numbered. A named entity begins with an ampersand (&) followed by the name or characters, and ends with a
semicolon (;). For example, &lt; represents the left angle bracket character (<). Numbered entities also start and end the
same way, except that a hash sign (#) and a number specify the character.
XSLT has the following five predefined entities:
Character Entity Code
< (less-than) &lt;
& (ampersand) &amp;
530
XML
Last updated 6/3/2015
If you use other character entities in an XSL file, you need to define them in the DTD section of the XSL file.
Dreamweaver provides several default entity definitions that you can see at the top of an XSL file created in
Dreamweaver. These default entities cover a broad selection of the most commonly used characters.
When you preview your XSL file in a browser, Dreamweaver checks the XSL file for undefined entities and notifies you
if an undefined entity is found.
If you preview an XML file attached to an XSLT file or if you preview a server-side page with an XSLT transformation,
the server or browser (instead of Dreamweaver) notifies you of an undefined entity. The following is an example of a
message you may get in Internet Explorer when you request an XML file transformed by an XSL file with a missing
entity definition:Reference to undefined entity 'auml'. Error processing resource 'http://localhost/testthis/list.xsl'. Line
28, Position 20 <p class=''test''>&auml;</p> -------------------^
To correct the error in your page, you must add the entity definition to your page manually.
Reference to undefined entity 'auml'. Error processing resource
'http://localhost/testthis/list.xsl'. Line 28, Position 20
<p class=''test''>&auml;</p>
-------------------^
Specify a missing entity definition
1Look up the missing character in the character entity reference page on the W3C website at www.w3.org/TR/REC-
html40/sgml/entities.html.
This web page contains the 252 allowed entities in HTML 4 and XHTML 1.0.
For example, if the character entity Egrave is missing, search for “Egrave” on the W3C web page. You will find the
following entry:
<!ENTITY Egrave CDATA "&#200;" -- latin capital letter E with grave, U+00C8 ISOlat1 -->
2Make a note of the entity name and entity code in the entry.
In the example, Egrave is the entity name, and &#200 is the entity code.
3With this information, switch to Code view and enter the following entity tag at the top of your XSL file (following
the Doctype declaration and with the other entity tags):
<!ENTITY entityname "entitycode;">
In the example, you would enter the following entity tag:<!ENTITY Egrave "&#200;">
<!ENTITY Egrave "&#200;">
4Save your file.
If you repeatedly use the same character entities, you may want to permanently add their definitions in the XSL files
Dreamweaver creates by default when you use File > New.
> (greater-than) &gt;
" (quote) &quot;
‘ (apostrophe) &apos;
Character Entity Code
531
XML
Last updated 6/3/2015
Add entity definitions to the XSL files Dreamweaver creates by default
1Locate the following configuration file in the Dreamweaver application folder and open it in any text editor:
Configuration/DocumentTypes/MMDocumentTypeDeclarations.xml
2Locate the declaration called mm_xslt_1:
<documenttypedeclaration id="mm_xslt_1">
3Enter the new entity tag or tags in the list of entity tags, as follows:
<!ENTITY entityname "entitycode;">
4Save the file and restart Dreamweaver.
532
Last updated 6/3/2015
Chapter 16: Dynamic sites, pages and web
forms
Understanding web applications
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About web applications
A web application is a website that contains pages with partly or entirely undetermined content. The final content of a
page is determined only when the visitor requests a page from the web server. Because the final content of the page
varies from request to request based on the visitors actions, this kind of page is called a dynamic page.
Web applications are built to address a variety of challenges and problems. This section describes common uses for web
applications and gives a simple example.
Common uses for web applications
Web applications have many uses for both site visitors and developers, including the following:
Let visitors find information quickly and easily on a content-rich website.
This kind of web application gives visitors the ability to search, organize, and navigate content as they see fit.
Examples include company intranets, Microsoft MSDN (www.msdn.microsoft.com), and Amazon.com
(www.amazon.com).
Collect, save, and analyze data provided by site visitors.
In the past, data entered in HTML forms was sent as e-mail messages to employees or CGI applications for
processing. A web application can save form data directly into a database and also extract the data and create web-
based reports for analysis. Examples include online banking pages, store check-out pages, surveys, and user-
feedback forms.
Update websites that have constantly changing content.
A web application frees the web designer from continually updating the sites HTML. Content providers such as
news editors provide the web application with content, and the web application updates the site automatically.
Examples include the Economist (www.economist.com) and CNN (www.cnn.com).
Web application example
Janet is a professional web designer and longtime Dreamweaver user responsible for maintaining the intranet and
Internet sites of a medium-sized company of 1000 employees. One day, Chris from Human Resources comes to her with
a problem. HR administers an employee fitness program that gives employees points for every mile walked, biked, or
run. Each employee must report his or her monthly mile totals in an e-mail to Chris. At the end of the month, Chris
gathers all the e-mail messages and awards employees small cash prizes according to their point totals.
533
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Chriss problem is that the fitness program has grown too successful. So many employees now participate that Chris is
inundated with e-mails at the end of each month. Chris asks Janet if a web-based solution exists.
Janet proposes an intranet-based web application that performs the following tasks:
Lets employees enter their mileage on a web page using a simple HTML form
Stores the employees’ mileage in a database
Calculates fitness points based on the mileage data
Lets employees track their monthly progress
Gives Chris one-click access to point totals at the end of each month
Janet gets the application up and running before lunchtime using Dreamweaver, which has the tools she needs to
build this kind of application quickly and easily.
How a web application works
A web application is a collection of static and dynamic web pages. A static web page is one that does not change when
a site visitor requests it: The web server sends the page to the requesting web browser without modifying it. In contrast,
a dynamic web page is modified by the server before it is sent to the requesting browser. The changing nature of the page
is why its called dynamic.
For example, you could design a page to display fitness results, while leaving certain information (such as employee
name and results) to be determined when the page is requested by a particular employee.
The next sections describe how web applications work in greater detail.
Processing static web pages
A static website comprises a set of related HTML pages and files hosted on a computer running a web server.
A web server is software that serves web pages in response to requests from web browsers. A page request is generated
when a visitor clicks a link on a web page, selects a bookmark in a browser, or enters a URL in a browser’s address text
box.
The final content of a static web page is determined by the page designer and doesnt change when the page is requested.
Heres an example:
<html>
<head>
<title>Trio Motors Information Page</title>
</head>
<body>
<h1>About Trio Motors</h1>
<p>Trio Motors is a leading automobile manufacturer.</p>
</body>
</html>
Every line of the pages HTML code is written by the designer before the page is placed on the server. Because the HTML
doesn’t change once it’s on the server, this kind of page is called a static page.
Note: Strictly speaking, a “static” page may not be static at all. For example, a rollover image or Flash content (a SWF file)
can make a static page come alive. However, this documentation refers to a page as static if it is sent to the browser without
modifications.
534
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
When the web server receives a request for a static page, the server reads the request, finds the page, and sends it to the
requesting browser, as the following example shows:
A Web browser requests static page. B Web server finds page. C Web server sends page to requesting browser.
In the case of web applications, certain lines of code are undetermined when the visitor requests the page. These lines
must be determined by some mechanism before the page can be sent to the browser. The mechanism is discussed in
the following section.
Processing dynamic pages
When a web server receives a request for a static web page, the server sends the page directly to the requesting browser.
When the web server receives a request for a dynamic page, however, it reacts differently: It passes the page to a special
piece of software responsible for finishing the page. This special software is called an application server.
The application server reads the code on the page, finishes the page according to the instructions in the code, and then
removes the code from the page. The result is a static page that the application server passes back to the web server,
which then sends the page to the requesting browser. All the browser gets when the page arrives is pure HTML. Heres
a view of the process:
535
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
A Web browser requests dynamic page. B Web server finds page and passes it to application server. C Application server scans page for
instructions and finishes page. D Application server passes finished page back to web server E Web server sends finished page to requesting
browser
Accessing a database
An application server lets you work with server-side resources such as databases. For example, a dynamic page may
instruct the application server to extract data from a database and insert it into the page’s HTML. For more information,
see www.adobe.com/go/learn_dw_dbguide.
Using a database to store content allows you to separate your websites design from the content you want to display to
site users. Instead of writing individual HTML files for every page, you only need to write a page—or template—for the
different kinds of information you want to present. You can then upload content into a database and then have the
website retrieve that content in response to a user request. You can also update information in a single source, and then
populate that change throughout the website without having to manually edit each page. You can use Adobe
Dreamweaver to design web forms to insert, update, or delete data from the database.
The instruction to extract data from a database is called a database query. A query consists of search criteria expressed
in a database language called SQL (Structured Query Language). The SQL query is written into the pages server-side
scripts or tags.
An application server cannot communicate directly with a database because the databases proprietary format renders
the data undecipherable in much the same way that a Microsoft Word document opened in Notepad or BBEdit may be
undecipherable. The application server can communicate with the database only through the intermediary of a
database driver: software that acts like an interpreter between the application server and the database.
After the driver establishes communication, the query is executed against the database and a recordset is created. A
recordset is a set of data extracted from one or more tables in a database. The recordset is returned to the application
server, which uses the data to complete the page.
Heres a simple database query written in SQL:
SELECT lastname, firstname, fitpoints
FROM employees
This statement creates a three-column recordset and fills it with rows containing the last name, first name, and fitness
points of all employees in the database. For more information, see www.adobe.com/go/learn_dw_sqlprimer.
536
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
The following example shows the process of querying a database and returning data to the browser:
A Web browser requests dynamic page. B Web server finds page and passes it to application server. C Application server scans page for
instructions. D Application server sends query to database driver. E Driver executes the query against the database. F Recordset is returned to
driver. G Driver passes recordset to application server H Application server inserts data in page, and then passes the page to the web server I Web
server sends finished page to requesting browser.
You can use almost any database with your web application, as long as the appropriate database driver for it is installed
on the server.
If you plan to build small low-cost applications, you can use a file-based database, such as one created in Microsoft
Access. If you plan to build robust, business-critical applications, you can use a server-based database, such as one
created in Microsoft SQL Server, Oracle 9i, or MySQL.
If your database is located on a system other than your web server, make sure you have a fast connection between the
two systems so that your web application can operate quickly and efficiently.
Authoring dynamic pages
Authoring a dynamic page consists of writing the HTML first, and then adding the server-side scripts or tags to the
HTML to make the page dynamic. When you view the resulting code, the language appears embedded in the pages
HTML. Accordingly, these languages are known as HTML embedded programming languages. The following basic
example uses ColdFusion Markup Language (CFML): note: CFML support is removed from Dreamweaver CC and later.
537
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
<html>
<head>
<title>Trio Motors Information Page</title>
</head>
<body>
<h1>About Trio Motors</h1>
<p>Trio Motors is a leading automobile manufacturer.</p>
<!--- embedded instructions start here --->
<cfset department="Sales">
<cfoutput>
<p>Be sure to visit our #department# page.</p>
</cfoutput>
<!--- embedded instructions end here --->
</body>
</html>
The embedded instructions on this page perform the following actions:
1Create a variable called department and assign the string "Sales" to it.
2Insert the variables value, "Sales", in the HTML code.
The application server returns the following page to the web server:
<html>
<head>
<title>Trio Motors Information Page</title>
</head>
<body>
<h1>About Trio Motors</h1>
<p>Trio Motors is a leading automobile manufacturer.</p>
<p>Be sure to visit our Sales page.</p>
</body>
</html>
The web server sends the page to the requesting browser, which displays it as follows:
About Trio Motors
Trio Motors is a leading automobile manufacturer.
Be sure to visit our Sales page.
You choose a scripting or tag-based language to use depending on the server technology available on your server. Here
are the most popular languages for the server technologies supported by Dreamweaver:
Dreamweaver can create the server-side scripts or tags necessary to make your pages work, or you can write them by
hand in the Dreamweaver coding environment.
Server technology Language
ColdFusion ColdFusion Markup Language (CFML)
Active Server Pages (ASP) VBScript
JavaScript
PHP PHP
538
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Web application terminology
This section defines frequently used terms relating to web applications.
An application server Software that helps a web server process web pages containing server-side scripts or tags. When
such a page is requested from the server, the web server hands the page off to the application server for processing
before sending the page to the browser. For more information, see .
Common application servers include ColdFusion and PHP.
A database A collection of data stored in tables. Each row of a table constitutes one record and each column constitutes
a field in the record, as shown in the following example:
A database driver Software that acts as an interpreter between a web application and a database. Data in a database is
stored in a proprietary format. A database driver lets the web application read and manipulate data that would
otherwise be undecipherable.
A database management system (DBMS, or database system) Software used to create and manipulate databases.
Common database systems include Microsoft Access, Oracle 9i, and MySQL.
A database query The operation that extracts a recordset from a database. A query consists of search criteria expressed
in a database language called SQL. For example, the query can specify that only certain columns or only certain records
be included in the recordset.
A dynamic page A web page customized by an application server before the page is sent to a browser.
A recordset A set of data extracted from one or more tables in a database, as in the following example:
A relational database A database containing more than one table, with the tables sharing data. The following database
is relational because two tables share the DepartmentID column.
539
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
A server technology The technology that an application server uses to modify dynamic pages at runtime.
The Dreamweaver development environment supports the following server technologies:
Adob ColdFusion®
Microsoft Active Server Pages (ASP)
PHP: Hypertext Preprocessor (PHP)
You can also use the Dreamweaver coding environment to develop pages for any other server technology not listed.
A static page A web page that is not modified by an application server before the page is sent to a browser. For more
information, see .
A web application A website that contains pages with partly or entirely undetermined content. The final content of
these pages is determined only when a visitor requests a page from the web server. Because the final content of the page
varies from request to request based on the visitors actions, this kind of page is called a dynamic page.
A web server Software that sends out web pages in response to requests from web browsers. A page request is generated
when a visitor clicks a link on a web page in the browser, selects a bookmark in the browser, or enters a URL in the
browser’s address text box.
Popular web servers include Microsoft Internet Information Server (IIS) and Apache HTTP Server.
More Help topics
Beginner's guide to databases
Set up your computer for application development
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
What you need to build web applications
To build web applications in Adobe Dreamweaver, you need the following software:
A web server
An application server that works with your web server
Note: In the context of web applications, the terms web server and application server refer to software, not hardware.
If you want to use a database with your application, you require the following additional software:
A database system
540
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
A database driver that supports your database
Several web hosting companies offer plans that let you use their software to test and deploy web applications. In
some cases, you can install the required software on the same computer as Dreamweaver for development purposes.
You can also install the software on a network computer (typically a Windows 2000 or XP computer) so that other
developers on your team can work on a project.
If you want to use a database with your web application, you must first connect to it.
Web server basics
To develop and test dynamic web pages, you need a functioning web server. A web server is software that serves web
pages in response to requests from web browsers. A web server is sometimes called an HTTP server. You can install and
use a web server on your local computer.
If youre a Macintosh user, you can use the Apache web server already installed on your Macintosh.
Note: Adobe does not provide technical support for third-party software such as Microsoft Internet Information Server. If
you need assistance with a Microsoft product, please contact Microsoft technical support.
If you use Internet Information Server (IIS) to develop web applications, the default name of your web server is the
name of your computer. You can change the server name by changing the name of your computer. If your computer has
no name, the server uses the word localhost.
The server name corresponds to the server’s root folder, which (on a Windows computer) is most likely
C:\Inetpub\wwwroot. You can open any web page stored in the root folder by entering the following URL in a browser
running on your computer:
http://your_server_name/your_file_name
For example, if the server name is mer_noire and a web page called soleil.html is stored in C:\Inetpub\wwwroot\, you
can open the page by entering the following URL in a browser running on the local computer:
http://mer_noire/soleil.html
Note: Remember to use forward slashes, not backslashes, in URLs.
You can also open any web page stored in any subfolder of the root folder by specifying the subfolder in the URL. For
example, suppose the soleil.html file is stored in a subfolder called gamelan, as follows:
C:\Inetpub\wwwroot\gamelan\soleil.html
You can open this page by entering the following URL in a browser running on your computer:
http://mer_noire/gamelan/soleil.html
When the web server is running on your computer, you can replace the server name with localhost. For example, the
following URLs open the same page in a browser:
http://mer_noire/gamelan/soleil.html
http://localhost/gamelan/soleil.html
Note: .Another expression you can use instead of the server name or localhost is 127.0.0.1 (for example,
http://127.0.0.1/gamelan/soleil.html).
541
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Choosing a web server
To develop and test web applications, you can choose from a number of common web servers including Microsoft
Internet Information Server (IIS) and Apache HTTP Server.
If youre not using a web hosting service, choose a web server and install it on your local computer for development
purposes. Windows and Macintosh users who want to develop ColdFusion web applications can use the web server
included in the developer edition of the ColdFusion 8 application server, which you can install and use for free.
Other Windows users can run a web server on their local computer by installing IIS. This web server may already be
installed on your system. Check your folder structure to see if it contains a C:\Inetpub or D:\Inetpub folder. IIS creates
this folder during installation.
Mac OS users can use the local Apache web server installed with the operating system.
For information on installing and configuring other web servers, see the server vendors documentation or your system
administrator.
Choosing an application server
An application server is software that helps a web server process dynamic pages. When choosing an application server,
you should consider several factors, including your budget, the server technology you want to use (ColdFusion, ASP,
or PHP), and the type of web server.
Budget Some vendors sell high-end application servers that are expensive to buy and administer. Others vendors
provide easier, more cost-effective solutions (an example is ColdFusion). Some application servers are built into web
servers (such as Microsoft IIS) and others can be downloaded for free from the Internet (such as PHP).
Server technology Application servers use different technologies. Dreamweaver supports three server technologies:
ColdFusion, ASP, and PHP. The following table shows common application servers available for the server technologies
supported by Dreamweaver:
To learn more about ColdFusion, select ColdFusion Help from the Help menu.
To learn more about ASP, visit the Microsoft website at http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/aa286483.aspx.
To learn more about PHP, visit the PHP website at www.php.net/.
Choosing a database
Databases come in many forms depending upon the amount and the complexity of the data they must store. When
choosing a database, you should consider several factors, including your budget and the number of users you anticipate
will access the database.
Budget Some vendors produce high-end application database servers that are expensive to buy and administer. Others
vendors provide easier, more cost-effective solutions, such as Microsoft Access or the open-source database MySQL.
Users If you anticipate a large user community accessing the site, select a database designed to support your sites
intended user base. For websites requiring greater flexibility in their data modeling, and the ability to support large,
Server technology Application server
ColdFusion Adobe ColdFusion 8
ASP Microsoft IIS
PHP PHP server
542
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
concurrent user communities, consider server-based relational databases (typically referred to as RDBMS) like
Microsoft SQL Server and Oracle.
Setting up a ColdFusion development environment
For detailed instructions on setting up a ColdFusion development environment for Dreamweaver on your Windows or
Mac computer, see the Adobe website at www.adobe.com/devnet/dreamweaver/articles/setup_cf.html.
Both Windows and Macintosh users can download and install a free, fully functional, developer edition of the
ColdFusion application server from the Adobe website at www.adobe.com/go/coldfusion/.
Note: The Developer Edition is for non-commercial use for developing and testing web applications. It is not licensed for
deployment. It supports requests from the local host and two remote IP addresses. You can use it to develop and test your
web applications as long as you want; the software does not expire. For more information, see ColdFusion help (Help >
ColdFusion Help).
During installation, you can configure ColdFusion to use the web server built into ColdFusion or another web server
installed on your system. Generally, its best to match your development environment to your production environment.
Therefore, if you have an existing web server such as Microsoft IIS on your development computer, you may want to
use it instead of the built-in ColdFusion web server.
Setting up a PHP development environment
For detailed instructions on setting up a PHP development environment for Dreamweaver on your Windows or Mac
computer, see the Adobe website at www.adobe.com/devnet/dreamweaver/articles/setup_php.html.
Editions of the PHP application server exist for Windows, Linux, UNIX, HP-UX, Solaris, and Mac OS X systems. For
more information on the application server, see the PHP documentation, which you can also download from the PHP
website at www.php.net/download-docs.php.
Setting up an ASP development environment
For detailed instructions on setting up an ASP development environment for Dreamweaver on your Windows or Mac
computer, see the Adobe website at www.adobe.com/devnet/dreamweaver/articles/setup_asp.html.
To run ASP pages, you need an application server that supports Microsoft Active Server Pages 2.0., such as Microsoft
IIS (Internet Information Services), which comes with Windows 2000 and Windows XP Professional. Windows XP
Professional users can install and run IIS on their local computer. Macintosh users can use a web hosting service with
an ASP plan or install IIS on a remote computer.
Creating a root folder for the application
After signing up with a web hosting company or setting up the server software yourself, create a root folder for your
web application on the computer running the web server. The root folder can be local or remote, depending on where
your web server is running.
The web server can serve any file in this folder or in any of its subfolders in response to an HTTP request from a web
browser. For example, on a computer running ColdFusion 8, any file in the \ColdFusion8\wwwroot folder or any of its
subfolders can be served to a web browser.
The following are the default root folders of selected web servers:
543
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
To test the web server, place a test HTML page in the default root folder and attempt to open it by entering the pages
URL in a browser. The URL comprises the domain name and the filename of the HTML page, as follows:
www.example.com/testpage.htm.
If the web server is running on your local computer, you can use localhost instead of a domain name. Enter one of the
following localhost URLs to match your web server:
Note: By default the ColdFusion web server runs on port 8500 and the Apache web server for Windows runs on port 80.
If the page doesn’t open as expected, check for the following errors:
The web server is not started. Consult the web servers documentation for starting instructions.
The file does not have an .htm or .html extension.
You entered the pages file path (for example, c:\ColdFusion8\wwwroot\testpage.htm), not its URL (for example,
http://localhost:8500/testpage.htm), in the browser’s address text box.
The URL contains a typing mistake. Check for errors and make sure the filename is not followed by a slash, such as
http://localhost:8080/testpage.htm/.
After creating a root folder for your application, define a Dreamweaver site to manage your files.
About defining a Dreamweaver site
After configuring your system to develop web applications, define a Dreamweaver site to manage your files.
Before you start, make sure you meet the following requirements:
You have access to a web server. The web server can be running on your local computer, on a remote computer such
as a development server, or on a server maintained by a web hosting company.
An application server is installed and running on the system running your web server.
You created a root folder for your web application on the system running your web server.
Defining a Dreamweaver site for your web application consists of three steps:
1. Define a local folder
Web server Default root folder
ColdFusion 8 \ColdFusion8\wwwroot
IIS \Inetpub\wwwroot
Apache (Windows) \apache\htdocs
Apache (Macintosh) Users:MyUserName:Sites
Web server Localhost URL
ColdFusion 8 http://localhost:8500/testpage.htm
IIS http://localhost/testpage.htm
Apache (Windows) http://localhost:80/testpage.htm
Apache (Macintosh) http://localhost/~MyUserName/testpage.htm (where MyUserName is
your Macintosh user name)
544
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
The local folder is the folder you use to store working copies of site files on your hard disk. You can define a local folder
for each new web application you create. Defining a local folder also gives you the ability to manage your files and to
transfer files to and from your web server easily.
2. Define a remote folder
Define a folder located on the computer running your web server as a Dreamweaver remote folder. The remote folder
is the folder you created for your web application on the web server.
3. Define a testing folder
Dreamweaver uses this folder to generate and display dynamic content and connect to databases while you work. The
testing server can be your local computer, a development server, a staging server, or a production server. As long as it
can process the kind of dynamic pages you plan to develop, the choice doesnt matter.
After the Dreamweaver site is defined, you can start building your web application.
More Help topics
Working with Dreamweaver sites
Database connections for ColdFusion developers
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Connecting to a ColdFusion database
When developing a ColdFusion web application in Dreamweaver, you connect to a database by selecting a ColdFusion
data source defined in Dreamweaver or in ColdFusion Administrator, the server’s management console.
Before connecting to a database, you must set up a ColdFusion web application. You must also set up a database on your
local computer or on a system to which you have network or FTP access.
Make sure that Dreamweaver knows where to find the ColdFusion data sources. To retrieve the ColdFusion data
sources at design time, Dreamweaver places scripts in a folder on the computer running ColdFusion. You must specify
this folder in the Testing Server category of the Site Definition dialog box.
Next, you must create a ColdFusion data source in Dreamweaver or in ColdFusion Administrator (if one doesn’t
already exist). After creating a ColdFusion data source, you can use it in Dreamweaver to connect to the database.
Create or modify a ColdFusion data source
Before you can use database information in your page, you must create a ColdFusion data source. If you’re running
ColdFusion MX 7 or later, you can create or modify the data source directly in Dreamweaver. If you’re running
ColdFusion MX, you must use the server’s management console, ColdFusion MX Administrator, to create or modify
the data source. You can still use Dreamweaver to open ColdFusion MX Administrator in that case.
Create or modify a ColdFusion data source if running ColdFusion MX 7 or later
1Make sure a computer running ColdFusion MX 7 or later is defined as a testing server for your site.
2Open any ColdFusion page in Dreamweaver.
545
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
3To create a new data source, click the Plus (+) button in the Databases panel (Windows > Databases) and enter the
parameter values specific to the database driver.
Note: Dreamweaver displays the Plus (+) button only if you’re running ColdFusion MX 7 or later.
4To modify a data source, double-click the database connection in the Databases panel and make your changes.
You can edit any parameter except the name of the data source. For more information, see the driver vendor’s
documentation or consult your system administrator.
Create or modify a ColdFusion data source if running ColdFusion MX 6.1 or 6.0
1Open any ColdFusion page in Dreamweaver.
2In the Databases panel (Window > Databases) in Dreamweaver, click Modify Data Sources in the panel toolbar.
3Log in to ColdFusion MX Administrator, and create or modify the data source.
For instructions, see ColdFusion help (Help > ColdFusion Help).
You must provide certain parameter values to create the ColdFusion data source. For the parameter values specific
to your database driver, see the driver vendors documentation or consult your system administrator.
After you create a ColdFusion data source, you can use it in Dreamweaver.
Connecting to the database in Dreamweaver
After creating a ColdFusion data source, use it to connect to the database in Dreamweaver.
Open any ColdFusion page in Dreamweaver, then open the Databases panel (Window > Databases). Your ColdFusion
data sources should appear in the panel.
If the data sources do not appear, complete the checklist in the panel. Make sure that Dreamweaver knows where to find
the ColdFusion data sources. In the Testing Server category of the Site Definition dialog box, specify the sites root
folder on the computer running ColdFusion.
More Help topics
Set up a testing server
Enable the ColdFusion enhancements
Database connections for ASP developers
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About ASP database connections
An ASP application must connect to a database through an open database connectivity (ODBC) driver or an object
linking and embedding database (OLE DB) provider. The driver or provider acts as an interpreter that lets the web
application communicate with the database. The following table shows some drivers you can use with Microsoft Access,
Microsoft SQL Server, and Oracle databases:
546
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
You can use a data source name (DSN) or a connection string to connect to the database. You must use a connection
string if youre connecting through an OLE DB provider or an ODBC driver not installed on a Windows system.
A DSN is a one-word identifier, such as myConnection, that points to the database and contains all the information
needed to connect to it. You define a DSN in Windows. You can use a DSN if you’re connecting through an ODBC
driver installed on a Windows system.
A connection string is a hand-coded expression that identifies the database and lists the information needed to connect
to it, as shown in the following example:
Driver={SQL Server};Server=Socrates;Database=AcmeMktg;
UID=wiley;PWD=roadrunner
Note: You can also use a connection string if youre connecting through an ODBC driver installed on a Windows system,
but using a DSN is easier.
About OLE DB connections
You can use an OLE DB provider to communicate with your database (OLE DB is available only on Windows NT, 2000,
or XP). Creating a direct database-specific OLE DB connection can improve the speed of your connection by
eliminating the ODBC layer between your web application and the database.
If you don’t specify an OLE DB provider for your database, ASP uses the default OLE DB provider for ODBC drivers
to communicate with an ODBC driver, which in turn communicates with the database.
Different OLE DB providers exist for different databases. You can obtain OLE DB providers for Microsoft Access and
SQL Server by downloading and installing the Microsoft Data Access Components (MDAC) 2.5 and 2.7 packages on
the Windows computer running IIS. You can download the MDAC packages for free from the Microsoft website at
http://msdn.microsoft.com/data/mdac/downloads/.
Note: Make sure you install MDAC 2.5 before installing MDAC 2.7.
You can download OLE DB providers for Oracle databases from the Oracle website at
www.oracle.com/technology/software/tech/windows/ole_db/index.html (registration is required).
In Dreamweaver, you create an OLE DB connection by including a Provider parameter in a connection string. For
example, here are parameters for common OLE DB providers for Access, SQL Server, and Oracle databases,
respectively:
Provider=Microsoft.Jet.OLEDB.4.0;...
Provider=SQLOLEDB;...
Provider=OraOLEDB;...
For the parameter value of your OLE DB provider, see your provider vendor’s documentation, or consult your system
administrator.
Database Database driver
Microsoft Access Microsoft Access Driver (ODBC)
Microsoft Jet Provider for Access (OLE DB)
Microsoft SQL Server Microsoft SQL Server Driver (ODBC)
Microsoft SQL Server Provider (OLE DB)
Oracle Microsoft Oracle Driver (ODBC)
Oracle Provider for OLE DB
547
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
About connection strings
A connection string combines all the information your web application needs to connect to a database. Dreamweaver
inserts this string in your pages server-side scripts for later processing by your application server.
A connection string for Microsoft Access and SQL Server databases consists of a combination of the following
parameters separated by semicolons:
Provider Specifies the OLE DB provider for your database. For example, here are parameters for common OLE DB
providers for Access, SQL Server, and Oracle databases, respectively:
Provider=Microsoft.Jet.OLEDB.4.0;...
Provider=SQLOLEDB;...
Provider=OraOLEDB;...
For the parameter value of your OLE DB provider, see your provider vendor’s documentation, or consult your system
administrator.
If you don’t include a Provider parameter, then the default OLE DB provider for ODBC is used and you must specify
an appropriate ODBC driver for your database.
Driver Specifies the ODBC driver to use if you don’t specify an OLE DB provider for your database.
Server Specifies the server hosting the SQL Server database if your web application runs on a different server.
Database The name of a SQL Server database.
DBQ The path to a file-based database such as one created in Microsoft Access. The path is the one on the server
hosting the database file.
UID Specifies the user name.
PWD Specifies the user password.
DSN The data source name, if you use one. Depending on how you define the DSN on your server, you can omit the
connection strings other parameters. For example, DSN=Results can be a valid connection string if you define the
other parameters when you create the DSN.
Connection strings for other kinds of databases may not use the parameters listed above, or will have different names
or uses for the parameters. For more information, see your database vendor’s documentation, or consult your system
administrator.
Heres an example of a connection string that will create an ODBC connection to an Access database called trees.mdb:
Driver={Microsoft Access Driver (*.mdb)};
DBQ=C:\Inetpub\wwwroot\Research\trees.mdb
Heres an example of a connection string that will create an OLE DB connection to a SQL Server database called Mothra
located on a server called Gojira:
Provider=SQLOLEDB;Server=Gojira;Database=Mothra;UID=jsmith;
PWD=orlando8
Create a connection using a local DSN
Note: This section assumes you have set up an ASP application. It also assumes a database is set up on your local computer
or on a system to which you have network or FTP access.
You can use a data source name (DSN) to create an ODBC connection between your web application and your database.
A DSN is a name containing all the parameters needed to connect to a specific database using an ODBC driver.
548
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Because you can only specify an ODBC driver in a DSN, you must use a connection string if you want to use an OLE
DB provider.
You can use a locally defined DSN to create a database connection in Dreamweaver.
1Define a DSN on the Windows computer running Dreamweaver.
For instructions, see the following articles on the Microsoft website:
If the computer runs Windows 2000, see Microsoft Knowledge Base Article 300596 at
http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;300596
If the computer runs Windows XP, see Microsoft Knowledge Base Article 305599 at
http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;305599
2Open an ASP page in Dreamweaver, and then open the Databases panel (Window > Databases).
3Click the Plus (+) button on the panel and select Data Source Name (DSN) from the menu.
4Enter a name for the new connection, without spaces or special characters.
5Select the Using Local DSN option and choose the DSN you want to use from the Data Source Name (DSN) menu.
If you want to use a local DSN but haven’t defined one yet, click Define to open the Windows ODBC Data Source
Administrator.
6Complete the User Name and Password boxes.
7You can restrict the number of database items Dreamweaver retrieves at design time by clicking Advanced, and
entering a schema or catalog name.
Note: You cannot create a schema or catalog in Microsoft Access.
8Click Test to connect to the database, and then click OK. If the connection fails, double-check the connection string
or check the settings for the test folder Dreamweaver uses to process dynamic pages.
Create a connection using a remote DSN
Note: This section assumes you have set up an ASP application. It also assumes a database is set up on your local computer
or on a system to which you have network or FTP access.
Note: Dreamweaver can retrieve only server DSNs created with the Windows ODBC Data Source Administrator.
You can use a DSN defined on a remote computer to create a database connection in Dreamweaver. If you want to use
a remote DSN, the DSN must be defined on the Windows computer running your application server (probably IIS).
Note: Because you can only specify an ODBC driver in a DSN, you must use a connection string if you want to use an OLE
DB provider.
1Define a DSN on the remote system running your application server.
For instructions, see the following articles on the Microsoft website:
If the remote computer runs Windows 2000, see Microsoft Knowledge Base Article 300596 at
http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;300596
If the remote computer runs Windows XP, see Microsoft Knowledge Base Article 305599 at
http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;305599
2Open an ASP page in Dreamweaver, then open the Databases panel (Window > Databases).
3Click the Plus (+) button on the panel and select Data Source Name (DSN) from the menu.
4Enter a name for the new connection, without spaces or special characters.
549
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
5Select Using DSN On Testing Server.
Note: Macintosh users can ignore this step because all database connections use DSNs on the application server.
6Enter the DSN or click the DSN button to connect to the server and select the DSN for the database you want, then
complete the options.
7Complete the User Name and Password boxes.
8You can restrict the number of database items Dreamweaver retrieves at design time by clicking Advanced and
entering a schema or catalog name.
Note: You cannot create a schema or catalog in Microsoft Access.
9Click Test to connect to the database, and then click OK. If the connection fails, double-check the connection string
or check the settings for the testing folder Dreamweaver uses to process dynamic pages.
Create a connection using a connection string
You can use a DSN-less connection to create an ODBC or OLE DB connection between your web application and your
database. You use a connection string to create this kind of connection.
1Open an ASP page in Dreamweaver, and then open the Databases panel (Window > Databases).
2Click the Plus (+) button on the panel, select Custom Connection String from the menu, complete the options, and
click OK.
3Enter a name for the new connection without spaces or special characters.
4Enter a connection string to the database. If you do not specify an OLE DB provider in the connection string—that
is, if you don’t include a Provider parameter—ASP will automatically use the OLE DB provider for ODBC drivers.
In that case, you must specify an appropriate ODBC driver for your database.
If your site is hosted by an ISP and you dont know the full path to your database, use the MapPath method of the
ASP server object in your connection string.
5If the database driver specified in the connection string is not installed on the same computer as Dreamweaver,
select Using Driver On Testing Server.
Note: Macintosh users can ignore this step because all database connections use the application server.
6You can restrict the number of database items Dreamweaver retrieves at design time by clicking Advanced and
entering a schema or catalog name.
Note: You cannot create a schema or catalog in Microsoft Access.
7Click Test to connect to the database, and then click OK. If the connection fails, double-check the connection string
or check the settings for the testing folder Dreamweaver uses to process dynamic pages.
Connecting to a database on an ISP
If you’re an ASP developer working with a commercial Internet service provider (ISP), you often don’t know the
physical path of the files you upload, including your database file or files.
If your ISP doesn’t define a DSN for you or is slow to do so, you must find another way to create the connections to your
database files. One alternative is to create a DSN-less connection to a database file, but you can define such a connection
only if you know the physical path of the database file on the ISP server.
You can obtain the physical path of a database file on a server by using the MapPath method of the ASP server object.
Note: The techniques discussed in this section apply only if your database is file-based, such as a Microsoft Access database
where data is stored in an .mdb file.
550
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Understanding physical and virtual paths
After using Dreamweaver to upload your files to a remote server, the files reside in a folder in the server’s local directory
tree. For example, on a server running Microsoft IIS, the path to your home page could be as follows:
c:\Inetpub\wwwroot\accounts\users\jsmith\index.htm
This path is known as the physical path to your file.
The URL to open your file, however, does not use the physical path. It uses the name of the server or domain followed
by a virtual path, as in the following example:
www.plutoserve.com/jsmith/index.htm
The virtual path, /jsmith/index.htm, stands in for the physical path,
c:\Inetpub\wwwroot\accounts\users\jsmith\index.htm.
Find a files physical path with the virtual path
If you work with an ISP, you dont always know the physical path to the files you upload. ISPs typically provide you with
an FTP host, possibly a host directory, and a login name and password. ISPs also specify a URL to view your pages on
the Internet, such as www.plutoserve.com/jsmith/.
If you know the URL, then you can get the files virtual path—it’s the path that follows the server or domain name in a
URL. Once you know the virtual path, you can get the files physical path on the server using the MapPath method.
The MapPath method takes the virtual path as an argument and returns the files physical path and filename. Heres the
method’s syntax:
Server.MapPath("/virtualpath")
If a files virtual path is /jsmith/index.htm, then the following expression returns its physical path:
Server.MapPath("/jsmith/index.htm")
You can experiment with the MapPath method as follows.
1Open an ASP page in Dreamweaver and switch to Code view (View > Code).
2Enter the following expression in the pages HTML code.
<%Response.Write(stringvariable)%>
3Use the MapPath method to obtain a value for the stringvariable argument.
Heres an example:
<% Response.Write(Server.MapPath("/jsmith/index.htm")) %>
4Switch to Live view (View > Live View) to view the page.
The page displays the physical path of the file on the application server, for example:
c:\Inetpub\wwwroot\accounts\users\jsmith\index.htm
For more information on the MapPath method, consult the online documentation that comes with Microsoft IIS.
Use a virtual path to connect to a database
To write a DSN-less connection string to a database file located on a remote server, you must know the physical path
to the file. The following example is a typical DSN-less connection string for a Microsoft Access database:
Driver={Microsoft Access Driver (*.mdb)};
DBQ=c:\Inetpub\wwwroot\accounts\users\jsmith\data\statistics.mdb
551
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
If you dont know the physical path of your files on the remote server, you can get the path by using the MapPath
method in your connection string.
1Upload the database file to the remote server and make a note of its virtual path—for example,
/jsmith/data/statistics.mdb.
2Open an ASP page in Dreamweaver, then open the Databases panel (Window > Databases).
3Click the Plus (+) button on the panel and select Custom Connection String from the menu.
4Enter a name for the new connection, without spaces or special characters.
5Enter the connection string and use the MapPath method to supply the DBQ parameter.
Suppose that the virtual path to your Microsoft Access database is /jsmith/data/statistics.mdb; the connection string
can be expressed as follows if you use VBScript as your scripting language:
“Driver={Microsoft Access Driver (*.mdb)};DBQ=” &amp; Server.MapPath¬
("/jsmith/data/statistics.mdb")
The ampersand (&) is used to concatenate (combine) two strings. The first string is enclosed in quotation marks and
the second is returned by the Server.MapPath expression. When the two strings are combined, the following string
is created:
Driver={Microsoft Access Driver (*.mdb)};
DBQ=C:\Inetpub\wwwroot\accounts\users\jsmith\data\statistics.mdb
If you use JavaScript, the expression is identical except that you use a Plus (+) sign instead of an ampersand (&) to
concatenate the two strings:
“Driver={Microsoft Access Driver (*.mdb)};DBQ=” + Server.MapPath¬
("/jsmith/data/statistics.mdb")
6Select Using Driver On Testing Server, click Test, and then click OK.
Note: Macintosh users can ignore this step because all database connections use the application server.
Note: If the connection fails, double-check the connection string or contact your ISP to make sure that the database
driver you specified in the connection string is installed on the remote server. Also check that the ISP has the most recent
version of the driver. For example, a database created in Microsoft Access 2000 will not work with Microsoft Access
Driver 3.5. You need Microsoft Access Driver 4.0 or later.
7Update the database connection of existing dynamic pages (open the page in Dreamweaver, double-click the
recordset name in the Bindings panel or Server Behaviors panel, and select the connection you just created from the
Connection menu) and use the new connection with any new page you build.
Edit or delete a database connection
When you create a database connection, Dreamweaver stores the connection information in an include file in the
Connections subfolder in the sites local root folder. You can edit or delete the connection information in the file
manually or as follows.
Edit a connection
1Open an ASP page in Dreamweaver and then open the Databases panel (Window > Databases).
2Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the connection and select Edit Connection from the menu.
3Edit the connection information and click OK.
Dreamweaver updates the include file, which updates all the pages in the site that use the connection.
552
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Delete a connection
1Open an ASP page in Dreamweaver and then open the Databases panel (Window > Databases).
2Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the connection and select Delete Connection from the menu.
3In the dialog box that appears, confirm that you want to delete the connection.
Note: To avoid receiving errors after deleting a connection, update every recordset that uses the old connection by
double-clicking the name of the recordset in the Bindings panel and choosing a new connection.
More Help topics
Set up your computer for application development
Set up your computer for application development
Connecting to a ColdFusion database
Database connections for PHP developers
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About PHP database connections
For PHP development, Dreamweaver only supports the MySQL database system. Other database systems such as
Microsoft Access or Oracle are not supported. MySQL is open-source software you can download for free from the
Internet for non-commercial use. For more information, see the MySQL website at http://dev.mysql.com/downloads/.
This section assumes you have set up a PHP application. It also assumes a MySQL database is set up on your local
computer or on a system to which you have network or FTP access.
For development purposes, download and install the Windows Essentials version of the MySQL database server.
Connect to a database
To connect to a database when developing a PHP application in Dreamweaver, you must have one or more MySQL
databases and the MySQL server must be started.
1Open a PHP page in Dreamweaver, and then open the Databases panel (Window > Databases).
553
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
2Click the Plus (+) button on the panel, select MySQL Connection from the menu, and complete the dialog box.
Enter a name for the new connection, without spaces or special characters.
In the MySQL Server box, enter an IP address or a server name for the computer hosting MySQL. If MySQL is
running on the same computer as PHP, you can enter localhost.
Enter your MySQL user name and password.
In the Database box, enter the name of the database, or click Select and select the database from the list of MySQL
databases, and click Test.
Dreamweaver attempts to connect to the database. If the connection fails, double-check the server name, user name,
and password. If the connection still fails, check the settings for the testing folder Dreamweaver uses to process
dynamic pages.
Dreamweaver makes a best guess at auto-populating the value for the URL prefix in the Testing Server category of
the Site Definition dialog box, but sometimes you will have to adjust the URL prefix to get your connection to work.
Make sure that the URL prefix is the URL that users type in their browsers to open the web application, minus the
file name (or start page) of the application.
3Click OK.
Note: If you encounter the error message “Client does not support authentication protocol requested. Consider
upgrading MySQL client” when testing a PHP database connection to MySQL 4.1, see .
Edit or delete a database connection
When you create a database connection, Dreamweaver stores the connection information in an include file in the
Connections subfolder in the sites local root folder. You can edit or delete the connection information in the file
manually or as follows.
Edit a connection
1Open a PHP page in Dreamweaver, and then open the Databases panel (Window > Databases).
2Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the connection and select Edit Connection from the menu.
3Edit the connection information and click OK.
Dreamweaver updates the include file, which updates all the pages in the site that use the connection.
Delete a connection
1Open a PHP page in Dreamweaver, and then open the Databases panel (Window > Databases).
2Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the connection and select Delete Connection from the menu.
3In the dialog box that appears, confirm that you want to delete the connection.
Note: To avoid getting errors after deleting a connection, update every recordset that uses the old connection by double-
clicking the name of the recordset in the Bindings panel and selecting a new connection in the Recordset dialog box.
More Help topics
554
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Troubleshooting database connections
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Troubleshooting permissions problems
One of the most common problems is insufficient folder or file permissions. If your database is located on a Windows
2000 or Windows XP computer and you receive an error message when you try to view a dynamic page in a web browser
or in Live view, the error might be due to a permissions problem.
The Windows account attempting to access the database doesnt have sufficient permissions. The account might be
either the anonymous Windows account (by default, IUSR_computername) or a specific user account, if the page has
been secured for authenticated access.
You must change the permissions to give the IUSR_computername account the correct permissions so the web server
can access the database file. In addition, the folder containing the database file must also have certain permissions set
to write to that database.
If the page is meant to be accessed anonymously, give the IUSR_computername account full control to the folder and
database file, as described in the procedure below.
Additionally, if the path to the database is being referenced using UNC (\\Server\Share), make sure the Share
Permissions give the IUSR_computername account full access. This step applies even if the share is on the local web
server.
If you copy the database from another location, it may not inherit the permissions from its destination folder and you
may have to change the permissions for the database.
Check or change the database file permissions (Windows XP)
1Make sure that you have administrator privileges on the computer.
2In Windows Explorer, locate the database file or the folder containing the database, right-click the file or folder, and
select Properties.
3Select the Security tab.
Note: This step applies only if you have an NTFS file system. If you have an FAT file system, the dialog box won't have
a Security tab.
4If the IUSR_computername account is not listed in the Group or User Names list, click the Add button to add it.
5In the Select Users or Groups dialog box, click Advanced.
The dialog box changes to show more options.
6Click Locations and select the computer’s name.
7Click Find Now to display a list of account names associated with the computer.
8Select the IUSR_computername account and click OK; then click OK again to clear the dialog box.
9To assign the IUSR account full permissions, select Full Control and click OK.
Check or change the database file permissions (Windows 2000)
1Make sure that you have administrator privileges on the computer.
555
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
2In Windows Explorer, locate the database file or the folder containing the database, right-click the file or folder, and
select Properties.
3Select the Security tab.
Note: This step applies only if you have an NTFS file system. If you have an FAT file system, the dialog box won't have
a Security tab.
4If the IUSR_computername account is not listed among the Windows accounts in the File Permissions dialog box,
click the Add button to add it.
5In the Select Users, Computers, or Groups dialog box, select the computer name from the Look In menu to display
a list of account names associated with the computer.
6Select the IUSR_computername account and click Add.
7To assign the IUSR account full permissions, select Full Control from the Type Of Access menu and click OK.
For added security, permissions can be set so that Read permission is disabled for the web folder containing the
database. Browsing the folder won’t be permitted, but web pages will still be able to access the database.
For more information about the IUSR account and web server permissions, see the following TechNotes on the
Adobe Support Center:
Understanding anonymous authentication and the IUSR account at www.adobe.com/go/authentication
Setting IIS web server permissions at www.adobe.com/go/server_permissions
Troubleshooting Microsoft error messages
These Microsoft error messages can occur when you request a dynamic page from the server if you use Internet
Information Server (IIS) with a Microsoft database system such as Access or SQL Server.
Note: Adobe does not provide technical support for third-party software such as Microsoft Windows, and IIS. If this
information does not fix your problem, please contact Microsoft technical support or visit the Microsoft support website at
http://support.microsoft.com/.
For more information on 80004005 errors, see “INFO: Troubleshooting Guide for 80004005 Errors in Active Server
Pages and Microsoft Data Access Components (Q306518),” on the Microsoft website at
http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;Q306518.
[Reference]80004005—Data source name not found and no default driver specified]
This error occurs when you attempt to view a dynamic page in a web browser or in Live view. The error message may
vary depending on your database and web server. Other variations of the error message include:
80004005—Driver's SQLSetConnectAttr failed
80004005—General error unable to open registry key 'DriverId'
Here are possible causes and solutions:
The page cant find the DSN. Make sure a DSN has been created on both the web server and on the local machine.
The DSN might have been set up as a user DSN, not as a system DSN. Delete the user DSN and create a system DSN
to replace it.
Note: If you don’t delete the user DSN, the duplicate DSN names produce a new ODBC error.
556
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
If you use Microsoft Access, the database file (.mdb) might be locked. The lock might be due to a DSN with a different
name accessing the database. In Windows Explorer, search for the lock file (.ldb) in the folder containing the database
file (.mdb) and delete the .ldb file. If another DSN is pointing to the same database file, delete the DSN to prevent the
error in the future. Reboot the computer after making any changes.
[Reference]80004005—Couldn’t use ‘(unknown)’; file already in use]
This error occurs when you use a Microsoft Access database and attempt to view a dynamic page in a web browser or
in Live view. Another variation of this error message is “80004005—Microsoft Jet database engine cannot open the file
(unknown).
The probable cause is a permissions problem. Here are some specific causes and solutions:
The account being used by Internet Information Server (usually IUSR) might not have the correct Windows
permissions for a file-based database or for the folder containing the file. Check the permissions on the IIS account
(IUSR) in the user manager.
You might not have permission to create or destroy temporary files. Check the permissions on the file and the folder.
Make sure that you have permission to create or destroy any temporary files. Temporary files are usually created in
the same folder as the database, but the file may also be created in other folders such as /Winnt.
In Windows 2000, the time-out value may need to be changed for the Access database DSN. To change the time-out
value, select Start > Settings > Control Panel > Administrative Tools > Data Sources (ODBC). Click the System tab,
highlight the correct DSN, and click the Configure button. Click the Options button and change the Page Timeout
value to 5000.
If you still have problems, see the following Microsoft Knowledge Base articles:
PRB: 80004005 “Couldn't Use ‘(unknown)’; File Already in Use” at
http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;Q174943.
PRB: Microsoft Access Database Connectivity Fails in Active Server Pages at
http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;Q253604.
PRB: Error “Cannot Open File Unknown Using Access at http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-
us;Q166029.
[Reference]80004005—Logon Failed()]
This error occurs when you use Microsoft SQL Server and attempt to view a dynamic page in a web browser or in Live
view.
This error is generated by SQL Server if it doesnt accept or recognize the logon account or password being submitted
(if you’re using standard security), or if a Windows account does not map to a SQL account (if you’re using integrated
security).
Here are possible solutions:
If you use standard security, the account name and password might be incorrect. Try the system Admin account and
password (UID= “sa” and no password), which must be defined in the connection string line. (DSNs do not store
user names and passwords.)
If you use integrated security, check the Windows account calling the page and find its mapped SQL account (if any).
SQL Server does not allow an underscore in SQL account names. If someone manually maps the Windows
IUSR_machinename account to a SQL account of the same name, it will fail. Map any account that uses an
underscore to an account name on SQL that does not use an underscore.
557
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
[Reference]80004005—Operation must use an updateable query]
This error occurs when an event is updating a recordset or inserting data in a recordset.
Here are possible causes and solutions:
The permissions set on the folder containing the database are too restrictive. IUSR privileges must be set to
read/write.
The permissions on the database file itself does not have full read/write privileges in effect.
The database might be located outside the Inetpub/wwwroot directory. Though you can view and search the data,
you might not be able to update it unless the database is located in the wwwroot directory.
The recordset is based on a non-updateable query. Joins are good examples of non-updateable queries within a
database. Restructure your queries so they are updateable.
For more information on this error, see “PRB: ASP ‘Error The Query Is Not Updateable’ When You Update Table
Record,” in the Microsoft Knowledge Base at http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;Q174640.
[Reference]80040e07—Data type mismatch in criteria expression]
This error occurs when the server tries to process a page containing an Insert Record or Update Record server behavior,
and the server behavior attempts to set the value of a Date/Time column in a Microsoft Access database to an empty
string ("").
Microsoft Access has strong data typing; it imposes a rigorous set of rules on given column values. The empty string
value in the SQL query cannot be stored in an Access Date/Time column. Currently, the only known workaround is to
avoid inserting or updating Date/Time columns in Access with empty strings ("") or with any other value that does not
correspond to the range of values specified for the data type.
[Reference]80040e10—Too few parameters]
This error occurs when a column specified in your SQL query does not exist in the database table. Check the column
names in your database table against the SQL query. The cause of this error is often a typographical error.
[Reference]80040e10—COUNT field incorrect]
This error occurs when you preview a page containing an Insert Record server behavior in a web browser and try to
use it to insert a record in a Microsoft Access database.
You might be trying to insert a record into a database field that has a question mark (?) in its field name. The question
mark is a special character for some database engines, including Microsoft Access, and should not be used for database
table names or field names.
Open your database system and delete the question mark (?) from the field names, and update the server behaviors on
your page that refer to this field.
[Reference]80040e14—Syntax error in INSERT INTO statement]
This error occurs when the server tries to process a page containing an Insert Record server behavior.
This error typically results from one or more of the following problems with the name of a field, object, or variable in
the database:
Using a reserved word as a name. Most databases have a set of reserved words. For example, “date” is a reserved word
and cannot be used for column names in a database.
Using special characters in the name. Examples of special characters include:
. / * : ! # & - ?
558
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Using a space in the name.
The error can also occur when an input mask is defined for an object in the database, and the inserted data does not
conform to the mask.
To fix the problem, avoid using reserved words such as “date, “name, “select, “where,” and “level” when specifying
column names in your database. Also, eliminate spaces and special characters.
See the following web pages for lists of reserved words for common database systems:
Microsoft Access at http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;Q209187
MySQL at http://dev.mysql.com/doc/mysql/en/reserved-words.html
[Reference]80040e21—ODBC error on Insert or Update]
This error occurs when the server tries to process a page containing an Update Record or Insert Record server behavior.
The database cannot handle the update or insert operation the server behavior is trying to perform.
Here are possible causes and solutions:
The server behavior is trying to update a database tables auto-number field or to insert a record into an auto-
number field. Because auto-number fields are populated automatically by the database system, any attempt to
externally populate them with a value fails.
The data the server behavior is updating or inserting is the wrong type for the database field, such as inserting a date
into a Boolean (yes/no) field, inserting a string into a numeric field, or inserting an improperly formatted string into
Date/Time field.
[Reference]800a0bcd—Either BOF or EOF is true]
This error occurs when you attempt to view a dynamic page in a web browser or in Live view.
The problem occurs when the page tries to display data from an empty recordset. To solve the problem, apply the Show
Region server behavior to the dynamic content to be displayed on the page, as follows:
1Highlight the dynamic content on the page.
2In the Server Behaviors panel, click the Plus (+) button and select Show Region > Show Region If Recordset Is Not
Empty.
3Select the recordset supplying the dynamic content and click OK.
4Repeat steps 1 to 3 for each element of dynamic content on the page.
Troubleshooting MySQL error messages
One common error message that you might encounter when testing a PHP database connection to MySQL 4.1 is
Client does not support authentication protocol requested. Consider upgrading MySQL client.
You may have to revert to an earlier version of MySQL, or install PHP 5 and copy some dynamic link libraries (DLLs).
For detailed instructions, see .
Removing connection scripts
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
559
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Using the Remove Connection Scripts command
You can use the Remove Connection Scripts command to remove scripts that Dreamweaver places in a remote folder
to access databases. These scripts are only needed for design-time authoring in Dreamweaver.
When you select the Using Driver On Testing Server option or the Using DSN On Testing Server option in the Database
Connections dialog box, Dreamweaver uploads an MMHTTPDB script file to the testing server. This allows
Dreamweaver to manipulate the remote database driver with the HTTP protocol, which in turn allows Dreamweaver
to get the database information it needs to help you create your site. However, this file does make it possible to see the
data source names (DSNs) defined on the system. If the DSNs and databases are not password protected, the script also
enables an attacker to issue SQL commands to the database.
The MMHTTPDB script files are located in the _mmServerScripts folder, which is located in the root of your website.
Note: The Dreamweaver file browser (the Files panel) hides the _mmServerScripts folder. You can see the
_mmServerScripts folder if you use a third-party FTP client or the file browser.
In some configurations these scripts are not necessary at all. The scripts are not involved when serving web pages to
visitors to your website, so they should not be placed on a production server.
If you’ve uploaded the MMHTTPDB scripts file to a production server, you should delete the MMHTTPDB scripts file.
The Remove Connection Scripts command automatically removes the script files for you.
Designing dynamic pages
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Dreamweaver and dynamic page design
Follow these general steps to successfully design and create a dynamic website.
1Design the page.
A key step in designing any website—whether static or dynamic—is the visual design of the page. When adding
dynamic elements to a web page, the design of the page becomes crucial to its usability. You should carefully
consider how users will interact with both individual pages and the website as a whole.
A common method of incorporating dynamic content into a web page is to create a table to present content, and
import dynamic content into one or more of the tables cells. Using this method you can present information of
various types in a structured format.
2Create a source of dynamic content.
Dynamic websites require a content source from which to extract data before they can display it on a web page.
Before you can use content sources in a web page, you must do the following:
Create a connection to the dynamic content source (such as a database) and the application server processing the
page. Create the data source by using the Bindings panel; then you can select and insert the data source in the
page.
Specify what information in the database you want to display, or what variables to include in the page by creating
a recordset. You can also test the query from within the Recordset dialog box, and make any needed adjustments
before adding it to the Bindings panel.
Select and insert dynamic content elements into the selected page.
560
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
3Add dynamic content to a web page.
After you define a recordset or other data source, and add it to the Bindings panel, you can insert the dynamic
content the recordset represents into the page. The Dreamweaver menu-driven interface makes adding dynamic
content elements as easy as selecting a dynamic content source from the Bindings panel, and inserting it into an
appropriate text, image, or form object within the current page.
When you insert a dynamic content element or other server behavior into a page, Dreamweaver inserts a server-side
script into the pages source code. This script instructs the server to retrieve data from the defined data source and
render it within the web page. To place dynamic content within a web page, you can do one of the following:
Place it at the insertion point in either Code or Design view.
Replace a text string or other placeholder.
Insert it into an HTML attribute. For example, dynamic content can define the src attribute of an image or the
value attribute of a form field.
4Add server behaviors to a page.
In addition to adding dynamic content, you can incorporate complex application logic into web pages by using
server behaviors. Server behaviors are predefined pieces of server-side code that add application logic to web pages,
providing greater interaction and functionality.
The Dreamweaver server behaviors let you add application logic to a website without having to write the code
yourself. The server behaviors supplied with Dreamweaver support ColdFusion, ASP, and PHP document types.
The server behaviors are written and tested to be fast, secure, and robust. The built-in server behaviors support
cross-platform web pages for all browsers.
Dreamweaver provides a point-and-click interface that makes applying dynamic content and complex behaviors to
a page as easy as inserting textual and design elements. The following server behaviors are available:
Define a recordset from an existing database. The recordset you define is then stored in the Bindings panel.
Display multiple records on a single page. You select either an entire table or individual cells or rows that contain
dynamic content, and specify the number of records to display on each page view.
Create and insert a dynamic table into a page, and associate the table with a recordset. You can later modify both
the tables appearance and the repeating region by using the Property inspector and Repeating Region Server
Behavior, respectively.
Insert a dynamic text object into a page. The text object you insert is an item from a predefined recordset, to
which you can apply any of the data formats.
Create record navigation and status controls, master/detail pages, and forms for updating information in a
database.
Display more than one record from a database record.
Create recordset navigation links that allow users to view the previous or next records from a database record.
Add a record counter to help users keep track of how many records were returned, and where they are in the
returned result.
You can also extend Dreamweaver server behaviors by writing your own, or installing server behaviors written by
third parties.
5Test and debug the page.
Before making a dynamic page—or an entire website—available on the web, you should test its functionality. You
should also consider how your applications functionality might affect people with disabilities.
561
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
More Help topics
Presenting content with tables
Adding and modifying images
Inserting SWF files
Dynamic content sources overview
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About dynamic content sources
A dynamic content source is a store of information from which you can retrieve and display dynamic content for use in
a web page. Sources of dynamic content include not only information stored in a database, but values submitted by
HTML forms, values contained in server objects, and other content sources.
Dreamweaver lets you easily connect to a database and create a recordset from which to extract dynamic content. A
recordset is the result of a database query. It extracts the specific information you request and allows you to display that
information within a specified page. You define the recordset based on the information contained in the database and
the content you want to display.
Different technology vendors may use different terminology for a recordset. In ASP and ColdFusion, a recordset is
defined as a query. If you are using other sources of data, such as user input or server variables, the name of the data
source that is defined in Dreamweaver is the same as the data source name itself.
Dynamic websites require a data source from which to retrieve and display dynamic content. Dreamweaver lets you use
databases, request variables, URL variables, server variables, form variables, stored procedures, and other sources of
dynamic content. Depending on the data source, you can either retrieve new content to satisfy a request, or modify the
page to meet the needs of users.
Any content source that you define in Dreamweaver is added to the list of content sources in the Bindings panel. Then
you can insert the content source into the currently selected page.
About recordsets
Web pages can’t directly access the data stored in a database. Instead, they interact with a recordset. A recordset is a
subset of the information (records), extracted from the database using a database query. A query is a search statement
designed to find and extract specific information from a database.
When using a database as a content source for a dynamic web page, you must first create a recordset in which to store
the retrieved data. Recordsets serve as an intermediary between the database storing the content and the application
server generating the page. Recordsets are temporarily stored in the application server’s memory for faster data
retrieval. The server discards the recordset when it is no longer needed.
A query can produce a recordset that includes only certain columns, only certain records, or a combination of both. A
recordset can also include all the records and columns of a database table. However, because applications rarely need
to use every piece of data in a database, you should strive to make your recordsets as small as possible. Because the web
server temporarily holds the recordset in memory, using a smaller recordset uses less memory, and can potentially
improve server performance.
562
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Database queries are written in Structured Query Language (SQL, pronounced “sequel”), a simple language that allows
you to retrieve, add, and delete data to and from a database. The SQL builder included with Dreamweaver lets you
create simple queries without having to understand SQL. However, if you want to create complex SQL queries, a basic
knowledge of this language lets you create more advanced queries, and provides you with greater flexibility in designing
dynamic pages.
Before you define a recordset for use with Dreamweaver, you must create a connection to a database and—if no data
exists yet—enter data into the database. If you have not yet defined a database connection for your site, refer to the
database connection chapter for the server technology you are developing for, and follow the instructions on creating
a database connection.
About URL and form parameters
URL parameters store retrieved information input by users. To define a URL parameter you create a form or hypertext
link that uses the GET method to submit data. The information is appended to the URL of the requested page and
communicated to the server. When using URL variables, the query string contains one or more name-value pairs that
are associated with the form fields. These name-value pairs are appended to the URL.
Form parameters store retrieved information that is included in the HTTP request for a web page. If you create a form
that uses the POST method, the data submitted by the form is passed to the server. Before you begin, make sure you
pass a form parameter to the server.
About session variables
Session variables let you store and display information maintained for the duration of a user’s visit (or session). The
server creates a different session object for each user and maintains it for a set period of time or until the object is
explicitly terminated.
Because session variables last throughout the user’s session and persist when the user moves from page to page within
the website, they’re ideal for storing user preferences. Session variables can also be used for inserting a value in the
pages HTML code, assigning a value to a local variable, or providing a value to evaluate a conditional expression.
Before defining session variables for a page, you must create them in the source code. After you create a session variable
in the web applications source code, you can use Dreamweaver to retrieve its value and use it in a web page.
How session variables work
Session variables store information (usually form or URL parameters submitted by users) and make it available to all
of a web applications pages for the duration of the user’s visit. For example, when users log on to a web portal that
provides access to e-mail, stock quotes, weather reports, and daily news, the web application stores the login
information in a session variable that identifies the user throughout the site’s pages. This allows the user to see only the
types of content they have selected as they navigate through the site. Session variables can also provide a safety
mechanism by terminating the user’s session if the account remains inactive for a certain period of time. This also frees
server memory and processing resources if the user forgets to log off a website.
Session variables store information for the life of the use session. The session begins when the user opens a page within
the application and ends when the user does not open another page in the application for a certain period of time, or
when the user explicitly terminates the session (typically by clicking a “log-off” link). While it exists, the session is
specific to an individual user, and every user has a separate session.
Use session variables to store information that every page in a web application can access. The information can be as
diverse as the user’s name, preferred font size, or a flag indicating whether the user has successfully logged in. Another
common use of session variables is to keep a running tally, such as the number of questions answered correctly so far
in an online quiz, or the products the user selected so far from an online catalog.
563
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Session variables can only function if the user’s browser is configured to accept cookies. The server creates a session ID
number that uniquely identifies the user when the session is first initiated, then sends a cookie containing the ID
number to the user’s browser. When the user requests another page on the server, the server reads the cookie in the
browser to identify the user and to retrieve the user’s session variables stored in the server’s memory.
Collecting, storing, and retrieving information in session variables
Before creating a session variable, you must first obtain the information you want to store, and then send it to the server
for storage. You can gather and send information to the server using HTML forms or hypertext links containing URL
parameters. You can also obtain information from cookies stored on the user’s computer, from the HTTP headers sent
by the user’s browser with a page request, or from a database.
A typical example of storing URL parameters in session variables is a product catalog that uses hard-coded URL
parameters created using a link to send product information back to the server to be stored in a session variable. When
a user clicks the “Add to shopping cart” link, the product ID is stored in a session variable while the user continues to
shop. When the user proceeds to the check-out page, the product ID stored in the session variable is retrieved.
A form-based survey is a typical example of a page that stores form parameters in session variables. The form sends the
selected information back to the server, where an application page scores the survey and stores the responses in a
session variable to be passed to an application that might tally up the responses gathered from the survey population.
Or the information might be stored in a database for later use.
After information is sent to the server, you store the information in session variables by adding the appropriate code
for your server model to the page specified by the URL or form parameter. Referred to as the destination page, this page
is specified in either the action attribute of the HTML form or the href attribute of the hypertext link on the starting
page.
After you store a value in a session variable, you can use Dreamweaver to retrieve the value from session variables and
use it in a web application. After you define the session variable in Dreamweaver, you can insert its value in a page.
The HTML syntax for each appears as follows:
<form action="destination.html" method="get" name="myform"> </form>
<param name="href"value="destination.html">
Both the server technology used and the method you use to obtain the information determines the code used to store
the information in a session variable. The basic syntax for each server technology is as follows:
ColdFusion
<CFSET session.variable_name = value>
ASP
<% Session("variable_name") = value %>
The value expression is usually a server expression such as Request.Form(“lastname”). For example, if you use a URL
parameter called product (or an HTML form with the GET method and a text field called product) to gather
information, the following statements store the information in a session variable called prodID:
ColdFusion
<CFSET session.prodID = url.product>
ASP
<% Session("prodID") = Request.QueryString("product") %>
If you use an HTML form with the post method and a text field called txtProduct to gather the information, then the
following statements store the information in the session variable:
564
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
ColdFusion
<CFSET session.prodID = form.txtProduct>
ASP
<% Session("prodID") = Request.Form("txtProduct") %>
Example of information stored in session variables
Youre working on a site with a large audience of senior citizens. In Dreamweaver, add two links to the Welcome screen
that let users customize the size of the sites text. For larger, easy-to-read text, the user clicks one link, and for regular-
size text, the user clicks another link.
Each link has a URL parameter called fontsize that submits the users text preference to the server, as the following
Adobe ColdFusion® example shows:
<a href="resort.cfm?fontsize=large">Larger Text</a>
<a href="resort.cfm?fontsize=small">Normal Text</a>
Store the user’s text preference in a session variable and use it to set the font size on each page the user requests.
Near the top of the destination page, enter the following code to create a session called font_pref that stores the user’s
font size preference.
ColdFusion
<CFSET session.font_pref = url.fontsize>
ASP
<% Session("font_pref") = Request.QueryString("fontsize") %>
When the user clicks the hypertext link, the page sends the user’s text preference in a URL parameter to the destination
page. The code on the destination page stores the URL parameter in the font_pref session variable. For the duration of
the users session, all the pages of the application retrieve this value and display the selected font size.
ASP and ColdFusion application variables
In ASP and ColdFusion, you can use application variables to store and display information that is maintained for the
lifetime of the application and persists from user to user. The applications lifetime lasts from the time the first user
requests a page in the application to the time the web server is stopped. (An application is defined as all the files in a
virtual directory and its subdirectories.)
Because application variables last for the lifetime of the application, and persist from user to user, they’re ideal for
storing information that must exist for all users, such as the current time and date. The value of the application variable
is defined in the applications code.
565
Last updated 6/3/2015
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
ASP server variables
You can define the following ASP server variables as sources of dynamic content: Request.Cookie,
Request.QueryString, Request.Form, Request.ServerVariables, and Request.ClientCertificates.
ColdFusion server variables
You can define the following ColdFusion server variables:
Client variables Associate data with a specific client. Client variables maintain the applications state as the user moves
from page to page in the application, as well as from session to session. “Maintaining state means to preserve
information from one page (or session) to the next so that the application remembers the user, and the users previous
choices and preferences.
Cookie variables Access cookies passed to the server by the browser.
CGI variables Provide information about the server running ColdFusion, the browser requesting a page, and other
information about the processing environment.
Server variables Can be accessed by all clients and applications on the server. They persist until the server is stopped.
Local variables Created with the CFSET tag or CFPARAM tag within a ColdFusion page.
More Help topics
URL parameters
Adding dynamic content to pages
Defining sources of dynamic content
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Define a recordset without writing SQL
You can create a recordset without manually entering SQL statements.
1 In the Document window, open the page that will use the recordset.
2 Select Windows > Bindings to display the Bindings panel.
3 In the Bindings panel, click the Plus (+) button and select Recordset (Query) from the pop-up menu.
The simple Recordset dialog box appears. If you are developing a ColdFusion site, the Recordset dialog box is
slightly different. (If the advanced Recordset dialog appears instead, click the Simple button to switch to the simple
Recordset dialog box.)
566
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
4Complete the Recordset dialog box for your document type.
For instructions, see the topics below.
5Click the Test button to execute the query and ensure that it retrieves the information you intended.
If you defined a filter that uses parameters input by users, enter a value in the Test Value box, and click OK. If an
instance of the recordset is successfully created, a table appears that displays data extracted from the recordset.
6Click OK to add the recordset to the list of available content sources in the Bindings panel.
Options for the simple Recordset dialog box (PHP, ASP)
1In the Name box, enter a name for the recordset.
A common practice is to add the prefix rs to recordset names to distinguish them from other object names in the
code, for example: rsPressReleases.
Recordset names can only contain letters, numbers, and the underscore character (_). You cannot use special
characters or spaces.
2Select a connection from the Connection pop-up menu.
If no connection appears in the list, click Define to create one.
3In the Table pop-up menu, select the database table that will provide data to the recordset.
The pop-up menu displays all tables in the specified database.
4To include a subset of the tables columns in the recordset, click Selected and choose the desired columns by Control-
clicking (Windows) or Command-clicking (Macintosh) them in the list.
5To further limit the records returned from the table, complete the Filter section:
From the first pop-up menu, select a column in the database table to compare against a test value you define.
From the second pop-up menu, select a conditional expression to compare the selected value in each record
against the test value.
From the third pop-up menu, select Entered Value.
In the box, enter the test value.
If the specified value in a record meets your filtering condition, the record is included the recordset.
6(Optional) To sort the records, select a column to sort by, and then specify whether the records should be sorted in
ascending order (1, 2, 3... or A, B, C...) or descending order.
7Click Test to connect to the database and create an instance of the data source, and click OK to close the data source.
A table appears displaying the returned data. Each row contains a record and each column represents a field in that
record.
8Click OK. The newly defined recordset appears in the Bindings panel.
567
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Options for the simple Recordset dialog box (ColdFusion)
Define a recordset for ColdFusion document types as a source of dynamic content without you having to hand code
SQL statements.
1In the Name box, enter a name for the recordset.
A common practice is to add the prefix rs to recordset names to distinguish them from other object names in your
code. For example: rsPressReleases
Recordset names can only contain letters, numbers, and the underscore character (_). You cannot use special
characters or spaces.
2If you’re defining a recordset for a ColdFusion component (that is, if a CFC file is currently open in Dreamweaver),
select an existing CFC function from the Function pop-up menu, or click the New Function button to create a new
function.
Note: The Function pop-up menu is only available if a CFC file is the current document and you have access to a
computer running ColdFusion MX 7 or better.
The recordset is defined in the function.
3Select a data source from the Data Source pop-up menu.
If no data source appears in the pop-up menu, you must create a ColdFusion data source.
4In the Username and Password boxes, enter the user name and password for the ColdFusion application server if
required.
Data sources in ColdFusion may require a user name and password to access them. If you do not have the user name
and password to access a data source in ColdFusion, contact your organizations ColdFusion administrator.
5In the Table pop-up menu, select the database table that will provide data to the recordset.
The Table pop-up menu displays all tables in the specified database.
6To include a subset of the tables columns in the recordset, click Selected and choose the desired columns by
Control-clicking (Windows) or Command-clicking (Macintosh) them in the list.
7To further limit the records returned from the table, complete the Filter section:
From the first pop-up menu, select a column in the database table to compare against a test value you define.
From the second pop-up menu, select a conditional expression to compare the selected value in each record
against the test value.
From the third pop-up menu, select Entered Value.
In the box, enter the test value.
If the specified value in a record meets your filtering condition, the record is included in the recordset.
8(Optional) To sort the records, select a column to sort by, and then specify whether the records should be sorted in
ascending (1, 2, 3... or A, B, C...) or descending order.
9Click Test to connect to the database and create an instance of the data source.
A table appears displaying the returned data. Each row contains a record and each column represents a field in that
record. Click OK to close the test recordset.
10 Click OK. The newly defined ColdFusion recordset appears in the Bindings panel.
568
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Define an advanced recordset by writing SQL
Write your own SQL statements by using the advanced Recordset dialog box, or create a SQL statement by using the
graphical Database Items tree.
1In the Document window, open the page that will use the recordset.
2Select Windows > Bindings to display the Bindings panel.
3In the Bindings panel, click the Plus (+) button and select Recordset (Query) from the pop-up menu.
The advanced Recordset dialog box appears. If you are developing a ColdFusion site, the Recordset dialog box is
slightly different. (If the simple Recordset dialog box appears instead, switch to the advanced Recordset dialog box
by clicking the Advanced button.)
4Complete the advanced Recordset dialog box.
For instructions, see the topics below.
5Click the Test button to execute the query and ensure that it retrieves the information you intended.
If you defined a filter that uses parameters input by users, the Test button displays the Test Value dialog box. Enter
a value in the Test Value box and click OK. If an instance of the recordset is successfully created, a table displaying
the data from the recordset appears.
6Click OK to add the recordset to the list of available content sources in the Bindings panel.
Options for the advanced Recordset dialog box (PHP, ASP)
Define a recordset as a source of dynamic content by writing a custom SQL statement, or by creating a SQL statement
using the graphical Database Items tree.
1In the Name box, enter a name for the recordset.
A common practice is to add the prefix rs to recordset names to distinguish them from other object names in the
code. For example: rsPressRelease
Recordset names can only contain letters, numbers, and the underscore character (_). You cannot use special
characters or spaces.
2Select a connection from the Connection pop-up menu.
3Enter a SQL statement in the SQL text area or use the graphical Database Items tree at the bottom of the dialog box
to build a SQL statement from the chosen recordset.
Do the following to use the Database Items tree to build the SQL statement:
Ensure the SQL text area is blank.
Expand the branches of the tree until you find the database object you need—a column in a table, for example,
or a stored procedure in the database.
Select the database object and click one of the buttons on the right side of the tree.
For example, if you select a table column, the available buttons are SELECT, WHERE, and ORDER BY. Click one
of the buttons to add the associated clause to your SQL statement.
You can also use a predefined SQL statement in a stored procedure by selecting the stored procedure from the
Database Items tree and clicking the Procedure button. Dreamweaver automatically fills in the SQL and Variable
areas.
569
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
4If the SQL statement contains variables, define their values in the Variables area by clicking the Plus (+) button and
entering the variables name, type (integer, text, date, or floating point number), default value (the value the variable
should take if no run-time value is returned), and run-time value.
Note: When using variables in a SQL statement in PHP, Dreamweaver automatically adds a leading dollar sign to the
variable name, so you should omit the dollar sign (e.g., colname, instead of $colname).
If the SQL statement contains variables, make sure the Default Value column of the Variables box contains valid test
values.
The run-time value is usually a URL or form parameter entered by a user in an HTML form field.
URL parameters in the Run-time Value column:
Form parameters in the Run-time Value column:
5Click Test to connect to the database and create an instance of the recordset.
If the SQL statement contains variables, make sure the Default Value column of the Variables box contains valid test
values before clicking Test.
If successful, a table appears displaying the data in your recordset. Each row contains a record and each column
represents a field in that record. Click OK to clear the recordset.
6If satisfied with your work, click OK.
Options for the advanced Recordset dialog box (ColdFusion)
Use the advanced Recordset dialog box to write custom SQL queries, or use the Database Items tree to author SQL
queries using a point-and-click interface.
1In the Name box, enter a name for the recordset.
A common practice is to add the prefix rs to recordset names to distinguish them from other object names in your
code. For example: rsPressReleases
Recordset names can only contain letters, numbers, and the underscore character (_). You cannot use special
characters or spaces.
If you’re defining a recordset for a ColdFusion component (that is, if a CFC file is currently open in Dreamweaver),
select an existing CFC function from the Function pop-up menu, or click the New Function button to create a new
function.
Note: The Function pop-up menu is only available if a CFC file is the current document and you have access to a
computer running ColdFusion MX 7 or better.
The recordset is defined in the function.
2Select a data source from the Data Source pop-up menu.
Server Model Run-Time value expression for URL parameter
ASP Request.QueryString(“formFieldName”)
PHP $_GET['formFieldName']
Server Model Run-Time value expression for form parameter
ASP Request.Form(“formFieldName”)
PHP $_POST['formFieldName']
570
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
If no data source appears in the pop-up menu list, you will need to first create a ColdFusion data source.
3In the Username and Password boxes, enter the user name and password for the ColdFusion application server if
required.
Data sources in ColdFusion may require a user name and password to access them. If you do not have the user name
and password to access a data source in ColdFusion, contact your organizations ColdFusion administrator.
4Enter a SQL statement in the SQL text area or use the graphical Database Items tree at the bottom of the dialog box
to build a SQL statement from the chosen recordset.
5(Optional) Do the following to use the Database Items tree to build the SQL statement:
Ensure the SQL text area is blank.
Expand the branches of the tree until you find the database object you need—for example, a column in a table.
Select the database object and click one of the buttons on the right side of the tree.
For example, if you select a table column, the available buttons are Select, Where, and Order By. Click one of the
buttons to add the associated clause to your SQL statement.
If your SQL statement contains parameters, define their values in the Parameters area by clicking the Plus (+) button
and entering the parameters name and default value (the value the parameter should take if no run-time value is
returned).
If the SQL statement contains parameters, make sure the Default Value column of the Parameters box contains valid
test values.
The Page Parameters allow you to provide default values for run-time value references in the SQL you write. For
example, the following SQL statement selects an employee record based on the value of the employees ID. You can
assign a default value to this parameter, ensuring that a run-time value is always returned. In this example,
FormFieldName refers to a form field in which the user enters an employee ID:
SELECT * FROM Employees WHERE EmpID = + (Request.Form(#FormFieldName#))
The Add Page Parameters dialog box would contain a name-value pairing similar to:
The run-time value is usually a URL or form parameter entered by a user in an HTML form field.
6Click Test to connect to the database and create an instance of the recordset.
If the SQL statement contains run-time references, make sure the Default Value column of the Page Parameters field
contains valid test values before clicking Test.
If successful, a table appears displaying the data in your recordset. Each row contains a record and each column
represents a field in that record. Click OK to clear the recordset.
7If satisfied with your work, click OK.
Define parameters in a SQL statement (ColdFusion)
Define parameters in a SQL statement; the default value is the value that the parameter should use if no run-time value
is returned.
1Select a parameter name from the Name pop-up menu.
2Enter a default value for the parameter in the Default Parameter box, and click OK.
Name Default values
FormFieldName 0001
571
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Define parameters in a SQL statement (PHP)
Define parameters in a SQL statement; the default value is the value that the parameter should use if no run-time value
is returned.
1Enter a parameter name in the Name box.
2Enter a default value for the parameter in the Default Parameter box.
3Enter a run-time value for a parameter in the Run-time Value box, and click OK.
Create SQL queries using the Database Items tree
Instead of manually typing SQL statements into the SQL box, you can use the Database Items point-and-click interface
to create complex SQL queries. The Database Items tree lets you select database objects and link them using the SQL
SELECT, WHERE, and ORDER BY clauses. After you create a SQL query, you can define any variables using the
Variables area of the dialog box.
The next two examples describe two SQL statements and the steps for creating them using the advanced Recordset
dialog box’s Database Items tree.
Example: Selecting a table
This example selects the entire contents of the Employees table. The SQL statement defining the query appears as
follows:
SELECT * FROM Employees
To create this query, follow these steps.
1Expand the Tables branch to display all of the tables in the selected database.
2Select the Employees table.
3Click the Select button.
4Click OK to add the recordset to the Bindings panel.
Example: Selecting specific rows from a table and ordering the results
The following example selects two rows from the Employees table, and selects the job type using a variable that you
must define. The results are then ordered by employee name.
SELECT emplNo, emplName
FROM Employees
WHERE emplJob = 'varJob'
ORDER BY emplName
1Expand the Tables branch to display all of the tables in the selected database; then expand the Employees table to
display the individual table rows.
2Build the SQL statement as follows:
Select emplNo, and click the Select button.
Select emplName, and click the Select button.
Select emplJob, and click the Where button.
Select emplName, and click the Order By button.
3Place the insertion point after WHERE emplJob in the SQL text area and type ='varJob' (include the equal sign).
572
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
4Define the variable 'varJob' by clicking the Plus (+) button in the Variables area and entering the following values in
the Name, Default Value, and Run-Time Value columns: varJob, CLERK, Request("job").
5Click OK to add the recordset to the Bindings panel.
Define URL parameters
URL parameters store retrieved information input by users. Before you begin, make sure you pass a form or URL
parameter to the server. After you define the URL variable, you can use its value in the currently selected page.
1In the Document window, open the page that will use the variable.
2Select Windows > Bindings to display the Bindings panel.
3In the Bindings panel, click the Plus (+) button and select one of the following from the pop-up menu:
4In the URL Variable dialog box, enter the name of the URL variable in the box, and click OK.
The URL variable name is normally the name of the HTML form field or object used to obtain its value.
5The URL variable appears in the Bindings panel.
Define form parameters
Form parameters store retrieved information that is included in the HTTP request for a web page. If you create a form
that uses the POST method, the data submitted by the form is passed to the server. Before you begin, make sure you
pass a form parameter to the server. After you define the form parameter as a content source, you can use its value in
your page.
1In the Document window, open the page that will use the variable.
2Select Windows > Bindings to display the Bindings panel.
3In the Bindings panel, click the Plus (+) button and select one of the following from the pop-up menu:
4In the Form Variable dialog box, enter the name of the form variable, and click OK. The form parameter name is
normally the name of the HTML form field or object used to obtain its value.
The form parameter appears in the Bindings panel.
Document Types Menu item in Bindings panel for URL variable
ASP Request Variable > Request.QueryString
ColdFusion URL Variable
PHP URL Variable
Document Types Menu item in Bindings panel for form variable
ASP Request Variable > Request.Form
ColdFusion Form Variable
PHP Form Variable
573
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Define session variables
You can use session variables to store and display information maintained for the duration of a user’s visit (or session).
The server creates a different session object for each user and maintains it for a set period of time or until the object is
explicitly terminated.
Before defining session variables for a page, you must create them in the source code. After you create a session variable
in the web applications source code, you can use Dreamweaver to retrieve its value and use it in a web page.
1Create a session variable in the source code, and assign a value to it.
For example, this ColdFusion example instantiates a session called username, and assigns it the value Cornelius:
<CFSET session.username = Cornelius>
2Select Window > Bindings to display the Bindings panel.
3Click the Plus (+) button, and select Session Variable from the pop-up menu.
4Enter the name of the variable you defined in the applications source code, and click OK.
Define application variables for ASP and ColdFusion
In ASP and ColdFusion, you can use application variables to store and display information that is maintained for the
lifetime of the application and persists from user to user. After you define the application variable, you can use its value
in a page.
Note: There are no application variable objects in PHP.
1Open a dynamic document type in the Document window.
2Select Window > Bindings to display the Bindings panel.
3Click the Plus (+) button, and select Application Variable from the pop-up menu.
4Enter the name of the variable as defined in the applications source code, and click OK.
The application variable appears in the Bindings panel under the Application icon.
574
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Use a variable as a data source for a ColdFusion recordset
When you define a recordset for a page in the Bindings panel, Dreamweaver enters the name of the ColdFusion data
source in the cfquery tag on the page. For more flexibility, you can store a data source name in a variable and use the
variable in the cfquery tag. Dreamweaver provides a visual method of specifying such a variable in your recordsets.
1Make sure a ColdFusion page is active in the Document window.
2In the Bindings panel, click the Plus (+) button and select Data Source Name Variable from the pop-up menu.
The Data Source Name Variable dialog box appears.
3Define a variable, and click OK.
4When defining the recordset, select the variable as the data source for the recordset.
In the Recordset dialog box, the variable appears in the Data Source pop-up menu along with the ColdFusion data
sources on the server.
5Complete the Recordset dialog box, and click OK.
6Initialize the variable.
Dreamweaver does not initialize the variable for you so that you can initialize it how and where you want. You can
initialize the variable in the page code (before the cfquery tag), in an include file, or in some other file as a session
or application variable.
Define server variables
You define server variables as sources of dynamic content for use within a web application. Server variables vary from
document type to document type and include form variables, URL variables, session variables, and application
variables.
Server variables can be accessed by all clients that access the server, and by any applications running on the server. The
variables persist until the server is stopped.
Define ColdFusion server variables
1Open the Bindings panel (Window > Bindings). In the Server Variable dialog box, enter the name of the server
variable, and click OK.
2Click the Plus (+) button and select the server variable from the pop-up menu.
3Enter the name of the variable, and click OK. The ColdFusion server variable appears in the Bindings panel.
The following table lists the built-in ColdFusion server variables:
575
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Define a ColdFusion local variable
Local variables are variables created with the CFSET or CFPARAM tag within a ColdFusion page. The defined local
variable appears in the Bindings panel.
In the Local Variable dialog box, enter the name of the local variable and click OK.
Define ASP server variables
You can define the following ASP server variables as sources of dynamic content: Request.Cookie,
Request.QueryString, Request.Form, Request.ServerVariables, and Request.ClientCertificates.
1Open the Bindings panel (Window > Bindings).
2Click the Plus (+) button, and select Request Variable from the pop-up menu.
3In the Request Variable dialog box, select one of the following request collections from the Type pop-up menu:
The QueryString collection Retrieves information appended to the sending pages URL, such as when the page has
an HTML form using the GET method. The query string consists of one or more name-value pairs (for example,
last=Smith, first=Winston) appended to the URL with a question mark (?). If the query string has more than one
name-value pair, they are combined with ampersands (&).
The Form collection Retrieves form information included in the body of the HTTP request by an HTML form using
the POST method.
The ServerVariables collection Retrieves the values of predefined environment variables. The collection has a long
list of variables, including CONTENT_LENGTH (the length of content submitted in the HTTP request, which you
can use to see if a form is empty), and HTTP_USER_AGENT (provides information about the user’s browser).
For example, Request.ServerVariables("HTTP_USER_AGENT") contains information about the submitting
browser, such as Mozilla/4.07 [en] (WinNT; I), which denotes a Netscape Navigator 4.07 browser.
For a complete list of ASP server environment variables, see the online documentation installed with Microsoft
Personal Web Server (PWS) or Internet Information Server (IIS).
The Cookies collection Retrieves the values of the cookies sent in an HTTP request. For example, suppose the page
reads a cookie called "readMe" on the user’s system. On the server, the values of the cookie are stored in the variable
Request.Cookies("readMe").
The ClientCertificate collection Retrieves the certification fields from the HTTP request sent by the browser. The
certification fields are specified in the X.509 standard.
Variable Description
Server.ColdFusion.ProductName ColdFusion product name.
Server.ColdFusion.ProductVersion ColdFusion version number.
Server.ColdFusion.ProductLevel ColdFusion edition (Enterprise, Professional).
Server.ColdFusion.SerialNumber Serial number of currently installed version of ColdFusion.
Server.OS.Name Name of operating system running on the server (Windows XP,
Windows 2000, Linux).
Server.OS.AdditionalInformation Additional information about installed operating system (service
packs, updates).
Server.OS.Version Version of installed operating system.
Server.OS.BuildNumber Build number of installed operating system.
576
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
4Specify the variable in the collection that you want to access, and click OK.
For example, if you want to access the information in the Request.ServerVariables("HTTP_USER_AGENT")
variable, enter the argument HTTP_USER_AGENT. If you want to access the information in the
Request.Form("lastname") variable, enter the argument lastname.
The request variable appears in the Bindings panel.
Define PHP server variables
Define server variables as a source of dynamic content for PHP pages. The PHP server variables appear in the Bindings
panel.
1Open the Bindings panel (Window > Bindings).
2Click the Plus (+) button, and select the variable from the pop-up menu.
3In the Request Variable dialog box, enter the name of the variable (for example, REQUEST_METHOD), and click
OK.
For more information, search for the keyword $_SERVER in the PHP documentation.
Define a ColdFusion client variable
Define a ColdFusion client variable as a source of dynamic content for the page. The newly defined ColdFusion client
variables appear in the Bindings panel.
In the Client Variable dialog box, enter the name of the variable, and click OK.
For example, to access the information in the Client.LastVisit ColdFusion variable, enter LastVisit.
Client variables are variables created in the code to associate data with a specific client. Client variables maintain the
applications state as the user moves from page to page within the application, as well as from session to session.
Client variables can be user-defined or built-in. The following table lists the built-in ColdFusion client variables:
Define a ColdFusion cookie variable
Cookie variables are created in the code, and access information contained in cookies passed to the server by a browser.
The defined cookie variable appears in the Bindings panel.
In the Cookie Variable dialog box, enter the name of the cookie variable, and click OK.
Variable Description
Client.CFID An incremental ID for each client that connects to the server.
Client.CFTOKEN A randomly generated number used to uniquely identify a
particular client.
Client.URLToken A combination of CFID and CFTOKEN to be passed between
templates when cookies are not used.
Client.LastVisit Records the timestamp of the last visit made by a client.
Client.HitCount The number of page requests tied to a single client (tracked using
CFID and CFTOKEN).
Client.TimeCreated Records the timestamp when CFID and CFTOKEN were first
created for a particular client.
577
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Define a ColdFusion CGI variable
The defined CGI variable appears in the Bindings panel.
In the CGI Variable dialog box, enter the name of the variable, and click OK.
For example, if you want to access the information in the CGI.HTTP_REFERER variable, enter HTTP_REFERER.
The following table lists the most common ColdFusion CGI variables that are created on the server:
The following table lists the most common CGI variables created by the browser and passed to the server:
Variable Description
SERVER_SOFTWARE The name and version of the information server software
answering the request (and running the gateway). Format:
name/version.
SERVER_NAME The server's hostname, DNS alias, or IP address as it appears in self-
referencing URLs.
GATEWAY_INTERFACE The revision of the CGI specification to which this server complies.
Format: CGI/revision.
SERVER_PROTOCOL The name and revision of the information protocol this request
came in with. Format: protocol/revision.
SERVER_PORT The port number to which the request was sent.
REQUEST_METHOD The method with which the request was made. For HTTP, this is
Get, Head, Post, and so on.
PATH_INFO The extra path information, as given by the client. Scripts can be
accessed by their virtual pathname, followed by extra information
at the end of this path. The extra information is sent as PATH_INFO.
PATH_TRANSLATED The server provides a translated version of PATH_INFO, which
takes the path and does any virtual-to-physical mapping to it.
SCRIPT_NAME A virtual path to the script being executed; used for self-
referencing URLs.
QUERY_STRING The query information that follows the question mark (?) in the
URL that referenced this script.
REMOTE_HOST The hostname making the request. If the server does not have this
information, it sets REMOTE_ADDR and does not set
REMOTE_HOST.
REMOTE_ADDR The IP address of the remote host making the request.
AUTH_TYPE If the server supports user authentication, and the script is
protected, this is the protocol-specific authentication method
used to validate the user.
REMOTE_USER AUTH_USER If the server supports user authentication, and the script is
protected, this is the user name they have authenticated as. (Also
available as AUTH_USER.)
REMOTE_IDENT If the HTTP server supports RFC 931 identification, this variable is
set to the remote user name retrieved from the server. Use this
variable for logging only.
CONTENT_TYPE For queries that have attached information, such as HTTP POST
and PUT, this is the content type of the data.
CONTENT_LENGTH The length of the content as given by the client.
578
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Cache content sources
You can cache—or store—sources of dynamic content in a Design Note. This lets you work on a site even if you don’t
have access to the database or application server storing the sources of dynamic content. Caching may also speed up
development by eliminating repeated access across a network to the database and application server.
Click the arrow button in the top right corner of the Bindings panel and toggle Cache in the pop-up menu.
If you make changes to one of the content sources, you can refresh the cache by clicking the Refresh button (the circle-
arrow icon) in the upper-right corner of the Bindings panel. (Expand the panel if you don’t see the button.)
Change or delete content sources
You can change or delete any existing source of dynamic content—that is, any content source listed in the Bindings
panel.
Changing or deleting a content source in the Bindings panel does not change or delete any instance of that content on
the page. It merely changes or deletes it as a possible source of content for the page.
Change a content source in the Bindings panel
1In the Bindings panel (Window > Bindings), double-click the name of the content source you want to edit.
2Make your changes in the dialog box that appears.
3If satisfied with your work, click OK.
Delete a content source from the Bindings panel
1In the Bindings panel (Window > Bindings), select the content source from the list.
2Click the Minus (-) button.
Copy a recordset from one page to another page
You can copy a recordset from one page to another within a defined site.
1Select the recordset in either the Bindings panel or the Server Behaviors panel.
2Right-click the recordset, and select Copy from the pop-up menu.
3Open the page you want to copy the recordset to.
4Right-click the Bindings panel or the Server Behaviors toolbar, and select Paste from the pop-up menu.
Variable Description
HTTP_REFERER The referring document. This is the document that linked to or
submitted form data.
HTTP_USER_AGENT The browser the client is currently using to send the request.
Format: software/version library/version.
HTTP_IF_MODIFIED_SINCE The last time the page was modified. This variable is sent at the
discretion of the browser, usually in response to the server having
sent the LAST_MODIFIED HTTP header. It can be used to take
advantage of browser-side caching.
579
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
More Help topics
Database connections for ASP developers
Database connections for PHP developers
Defining sources of dynamic content
Add a stored procedure (ColdFusion) (CS6)
SQL primer
Adding dynamic content to pages
URL parameters
Using forms to collect information from users
Adding dynamic content to pages
URL parameters
HTML form parameters
Adding dynamic content to pages
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About adding dynamic content
After you define one or more sources of dynamic content, you can use the sources to add dynamic content on the
page. Content sources can include a column in a recordset, a value submitted by an HTML form, the value contained
in a server object, or other data.
In Dreamweaver, you can place dynamic content almost anywhere in a web page or its HTML source code. You can
place dynamic content at the insertion point, replace a text string, or insert it as an HTML attribute. For example,
dynamic content can define the src attribute of an image, or the value attribute of a form field.
You can add dynamic content to a page by selecting a content source in the Bindings panel. Dreamweaver inserts a
server-side script in the pages code instructing the server to transfer the data from the content source to the pages
HTML code when the page is requested by a browser.
Last updated 6/3/2015
580
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
There is often more than one way to make a given page element dynamic. For example, to make an image dynamic you
can use the Bindings panel, the Property inspector, or the Image command in the Insert menu.
By default, an HTML page can display only one record at a time. To display the other records in the recordset, you can
add a link to move through the records one at a time, or you can create a repeating region to display more than one
record on a single page.
About dynamic text
Dynamic text adopts any text formatting applied to the existing text or to the insertion point. For example, if a
Cascading Style Sheet (CSS) style affects the selected text, the dynamic content replacing it is also affected by the style.
You can add or change the text format of dynamic content by using any of the Dreamweaver text formatting tools.
You can also apply a data format to dynamic text. For example, if your data consists of dates, you can specify a particular
date format such as 04/17/00 for U.S. visitors, or 17/04/00 for Canadian visitors.
Make text dynamic
You can replace existing text with dynamic text, or you can place dynamic text at a given insertion point on the page.
Add dynamic text
1In Design view, select text on the page, or click where you want to add dynamic text.
2In the Bindings panel (Window > Bindings), select a content source from the list. If you select a recordset, specify
the column you want in the recordset.
The content source should contain plain text (ASCII text). Plain text includes HTML. If no content sources appear
in the list, or if the available content sources dont meet your needs, click the Plus (+) button to define a new content
source.
3(Optional) Select a data format for the text.
4Click Insert, or drag the content source onto the page.
A dynamic content placeholder appears. (If you selected text on the page, the placeholder replaces the text
selection.) The placeholder for recordset content uses the syntax {RecordsetName.ColumnName}, where Recordset
is the name of the recordset and ColumnName is the name of the column you chose from the recordset.
Sometimes, the length of the placeholders for dynamic text distorts the pages layout in the Document window. You
can solve the problem by using empty curly braces as placeholders, as described in the next topic.
Display placeholders for dynamic text
1Select Edit > Preferences > Invisible Elements (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences > Invisible Elements
(Macintosh).
2In the Show Dynamic Text As pop-up menu, select { }, and click OK.
Make images dynamic
You can make images on your page dynamic. For example, suppose you design a page to display items for sale at a
charity auction. Each page would include descriptive text and a photo of one item. The pages general layout would
remain the same for each item, but the photo (and descriptive text) could change.
1With the page open in Design view (View > Design), place the insertion point where you want the image to appear
on the page.
581
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
2Select Insert > Image.
The Select Image Source dialog box appears.
3Click the Data Sources option (Windows) or the Data Source button (Macintosh).
A list of content sources appears.
4Select a content source from the list, and click OK.
The content source should be a recordset that contains the paths to your image files. Depending on the file structure
of your site, the paths can be absolute, document relative, or root relative.
Note: Dreamweaver does not currently support binary images stored in a database.
If no recordsets appear in the list, or if the available recordsets don’t meet your needs, define a new recordset.
Make HTML attributes dynamic
You can dynamically change the appearance of a page by binding HTML attributes to data. For example, you can change
the background image of a table by binding the tables background attribute to a field in a recordset.
You can bind HTML attributes with the Bindings panel or with the Property inspector.
Make HTML attributes dynamic with the Bindings panel
1Open the Bindings panel by choosing Window > Bindings.
2Ensure that the Bindings panel lists the data source you want to use.
The content source should contain data that’s appropriate for the HTML attribute you want to bind. If no sources of
content appear in the list, or if the available content sources don’t meet your needs, click the Plus (+) button to define
a new data source.
3In Design view, select an HTML object.
For example, to select an HTML table, click inside the table and click the <table> tag in the tag selector on the
bottom-left of the Document window.
4In the Bindings panel, select a content source from your list.
5In the Bind To box, select an HTML attribute from the pop-up menu.
6Click Bind.
The next time the page runs on the application server, the value of the data source will be assigned to the HTML
attribute.
Make HTML attributes dynamic with the Property inspector
1In Design view, select an HTML object and open the Property inspector (Window > Properties).
For example, to select an HTML table, click inside the table and click the <table> tag in the tag selector on the
bottom-left of the Document window.
2How you bind a dynamic content source to the HTML attribute depends on where it is located.
If the attribute you want to bind has a folder icon next to it in the Property inspector, click the folder icon to open
a file selection dialog box; then click the Data Sources option to display a list of data sources.
If the attribute you want to bind does not have a folder icon next to it, click the List tab (the lower of the two tabs)
on the left side of the inspector.
The Property inspector’s List view appears.
582
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
If the attribute you want to bind is not listed in the List view, click the Plus (+) button; then enter the attributes
name or click the small arrow button and select the attribute from the pop-up menu.
3To make the attributes value dynamic, click the attribute; then click the lightning-bolt icon or folder icon at the end
of the attributes row.
If you clicked the lightning bolt icon, a list of data sources appears.
If you clicked the folder icon, a file selection dialog box appears. Select the Data Sources option to display a list of
content sources.
4Select a source of content from the list of content sources, and click OK.
The content source should hold data thats appropriate for the HTML attribute you want to bind. If no content
sources appear in the list, or if the available content sources don’t meet your needs, define a new content source.
The next time the page runs on the application server, the value of the data source will be assigned to the HTML
attribute.
Make ActiveX, Flash, and other object parameters dynamic
You can make the parameters of Java applets and plug-ins dynamic, as well as the parameters of ActiveX, Flash,
Shockwave, Director, and Generator objects.
Before starting, make sure the fields in your recordset hold data thats appropriate for the object parameters you want
to bind.
1In Design view, select an object on the page and open the Property inspector (Window > Properties).
2Click the Parameters button.
3If your parameter does not appear in the list, click the Plus (+) button and enter a parameter name in the Parameter
column.
4Click the parameters Value column, and then click the lightning-bolt icon to specify a dynamic value.
A list of data sources appears.
5Select a data source from the list, and click OK.
The data source should hold data thats appropriate for the object parameter you want to bind. If no data sources
appear in the list, or if the available data sources dont meet your needs, define a new data source.
More Help topics
Defining sources of dynamic content
Defining sources of dynamic content
583
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Changing dynamic content
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About dynamic content
You can change the dynamic content on your page by editing the server behavior that provides the content. For
example, you can edit a recordset server behavior to provide more records to your page.
Dynamic content on a page is listed in the Server Behaviors panel. For example, if you add a recordset to your page, the
Server Behaviors panel lists it as follows:
Recordset(myRecordset)
If you add another recordset to your page, the Server Behaviors panel lists both recordsets as follows:
Recordset(mySecondRecordset)Recordset(myRecordset)
Edit dynamic content
1Open the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors).
2Click the Plus (+) button to display the server behaviors, and double-click the server behavior in the panel.
The dialog box that you used to define the original data source appears.
3Make your changes in the dialog box, and click OK.
Delete dynamic content
After adding dynamic content to a page, delete it in one the following ways:
Select the dynamic content on the page, and press Delete.
Select the dynamic content in the Server Behaviors panel, and click the Minus (-) button.
Note: This operation removes the server-side script in the page that retrieves the dynamic content from the database. It
does not delete the data in the database.
Test dynamic content
You can preview and edit dynamic content using Live view.
While dynamic content is displayed, you can perform the following tasks:
Adjust the pages layout using the page-design tools
Add, edit, or delete dynamic content
Add, edit, or delete server behaviors
1Click the Live view button to display dynamic content.
2Make the necessary changes to the page. You’ll need to toggle between Live view and Design or Code view to make
changes and see how they take effect.
584
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Let Adobe Contribute users edit dynamic content
When a Contribute user edits a page containing dynamic content or invisible elements (such as scripts and comments),
Contribute displays the dynamic content and invisible elements as yellow markers. By default, Contribute users cant
select or delete these markers.
If you want Contribute users to be able to select and delete dynamic content and other invisible elements from a page,
you can change permission-group settings to allow them to do so; Contribute users normally can never edit dynamic
content, even when you allow them to select it.
Note: Using some server technologies, you can display static text using a server tag or function. To allow Contribute users
to edit the static text in a dynamic page that uses such a server technology, place the static text outside of the server tags.
For more information, see Administering Adobe Contribute.
1 Select Site > Administer Contribute Site.
2 If certain required options for Contribute compatibility aren’t enabled, a dialog box appears, asking if you want to
enable those options. Click OK to enable those options and Contribute compatibility.
3 If prompted, enter the administrator password, and then click OK.
The Administer Website dialog box appears.
4 In the Users And Roles category, select a role, and then click the Edit Role Settings button.
5 Select the Editing category, and deselect the option to protect scripts and forms.
6 Click OK to close the Edit Settings dialog box.
7 Click Close to close the Administer Website dialog box.
Modify recordsets with the Property inspector
Use the Property inspector is to modify the selected recordset. The available options vary depending on the server
model.
1 Open the Property inspector (Window > Properties) and then select the recordset in the Server Behaviors panel
(Window > Server Behavior).
2 Edit any of the options. When you select a new option in the inspector, Dreamweaver updates the page.
More Help topics
HTML form parameters
URL parameters
Managing Contribute sites
Create a template for a Contribute site
Displaying database records
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
Last updated 6/3/2015
585
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
About database records
Displaying database records involves retrieving information stored in a database or other source of content, and
rendering that information to a web page. Dreamweaver provides many methods of displaying dynamic content, and
provides several built-in server behaviors that let you both enhance the presentation of dynamic content, and allow
users to more easily search through and navigate information returned from a database.
Databases and other sources of dynamic content provide you with more power and flexibility in searching, sorting, and
viewing large stores of information. Using a database to store content for websites makes sense when you need to store
large amounts of information, and then retrieve and display that information in a meaningful way. Dreamweaver
provides you with several tools and prebuilt behaviors to help you effectively retrieve and display information stored in
a database.
Server behaviors and formatting elements
Dreamweaver provides the following server behaviors and formatting elements to let you enhance the display of
dynamic data:
Formats let you apply different types of numerical, monetary, date/time, and percentage values to dynamic text.
For example, if the price of an item in a recordset reads 10.989, you can display the price on the page as $10.99 by
selecting the Dreamweaver “Currency - 2 Decimal Places” format. This format displays a number using two decimal
places. If the number has more than two decimal places, the data format rounds the number to the closest decimal. If
the number has no decimal places, the data format adds a decimal point and two zeros.
Repeating Region server behaviors let you display multiple items returned from a database query, and let you specify
the number of records to display per page.
Recordset Navigation server behaviors let you insert navigation elements that allow users to move to the next or
previous set of records returned by the recordset. For example, if you choose to display 10 records per page using the
Repeating Region server object, and the recordset returns 40 records, you can navigate through 10 records at a time.
Recordset Status Bar server behaviors let you include a counter that shows users where they are within a set of records
relative to the total number of records returned.
Show Region server behaviors let you choose to show or hide items on the page based on the relevance of the currently
displayed records. For example, if a user has navigated to the last record in a recordset, you can hide the Next link, and
display only the Previous records link.
Applying typographic and page layout elements to dynamic data
A powerful feature of Dreamweaver is the ability to present dynamic data within a structured page, and to apply
typographic formatting using HTML and CSS. To apply formats to dynamic data in Dreamweaver, format the tables
and placeholders for the dynamic data using the Dreamweaver formatting tools. When the data is inserted from its data
source, it automatically adopts the font, paragraph, and table formatting you specified.
Navigating database recordset results
Recordset navigation links let users move from one record to the next, or from one set of records to the next. For
example, after designing a page to display five records at a time, you might want to add links such as Next or Previous
that let users display the five next or previous records.
You can create four types of navigation links to move through a recordset: First, Previous, Next, and Last. A single page
can contain any number of these links, provided they all work on a single recordset. You can’t add links to move through
a second recordset on the same page.
586
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Recordset navigation links require the following dynamic elements:
A recordset to navigate
Dynamic content on the page to display the record or records
Text or images on the page to serve as a clickable navigation bar
A Move To Record set of server behaviors to navigate the recordset
You can add the last two elements by using the Record Navigation Bar server object, or you can add them separately
by using the design tools and the Server Behaviors panel.
Create a recordset navigation bar
You can create a recordset navigation bar in a single operation using the Recordset Navigation Bar server behavior. The
server object adds the following building blocks to the page:
An HTML table with either text or image links
A set of Move To server behaviors
A set of Show Region server behaviors
The text version of the Recordset Navigation Bar looks like this:
Before placing the navigation bar on the page, make sure the page contains a recordset to navigate and a page layout in
which to display the records.After placing the navigation bar on the page, you can use the design tools to customize the
bar to your liking. You can also edit the Move To and Show Region server behaviors by double-clicking them in the
Server Behaviors panel.Dreamweaver creates a table that contains text or image links that allow the user to navigate
through the selected recordset when clicked. When the first record in the recordset is displayed, the First and Previous
links or images are hidden. When the last record in the recordset is displayed, the Next and Last links or images are
hidden.You can customize the layout of the navigation bar by using the design tools and the Server Behaviors panel.
1In Design view, place the insertion point at the location on the page where you want the navigation bar to appear.
2Display the Recordset Navigation Bar dialog box (Insert > Data Objects > Recordset Paging > Recordset Navigation
Bar).
3Select the recordset you want to navigate from the Recordset pop-up menu.
4From the Display Using section, select the format to display the navigation links on the page, and click OK.
Text Places text links on the page.
Images Includes graphical images as links. Dreamweaver uses its own image files. You can replace these images with
image files of your own after placing the bar on the page.
Custom recordset navigation bars
You can create your own recordset navigation bar that uses more complex layout and formatting styles than the simple
table created by the Recordset Navigation Bar server object.
To create your own recordset navigation bar, you must:
Create navigation links in text or images
Place the links in the page in Design view
587
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Assign individual server behaviors to each navigation link
This section describes how to assign individual server behaviors to the navigation links.
Create and assign server behaviors to a navigation link
1In Design view, select the text string or image on the page you want to use as a record navigation link.
2Open the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors), and click the Plus (+) button.
3Select Recordset Paging from the pop-up menu; then select a server behavior appropriate to that link from the listed
server behaviors.
If the recordset contains a large number of records, the Move To Last Record server behavior can take a long time
to run when the user clicks the link.
4In the Recordset pop-up menu, select the recordset that contains the records, and click OK.
The server behavior is assigned to the navigation link.
Set the Move To (server behavior) dialog box options
Add links that let the user navigate through records in a recordset.
1If you didnt select anything on the page, select a link from the pop-up menu.
2Select the recordset that contains the records to page through, and click OK.
Note: If the recordset contains a large number of records, the Move To Last Record server behavior can take a long time
to run when the user clicks the link.
Navigation bar design tasks
When creating a custom navigation bar, begin by creating its visual representation using the Dreamweaver page-design
tools. You dont have to create a link for the text string or image, Dreamweaver creates one for you.
The page you create the navigation bar for must contain a recordset to navigate. A simple recordset navigation bar
might look like this, with link buttons created out of images, or other content elements:
After you have added a recordset to a page, and have created a navigation bar, you must apply individual server
behaviors to each navigation element. For example, a typical recordset navigation bar contains representations of the
following links matched to the appropriate behavior:
Navigation link Server behavior
Go to first page Move to first page
Go to previous page Move to previous page
Go to next page Move to next page
Go to last page Move to last page
588
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Display and hide regions based on recordset results
You can also specify that a region be displayed or hidden based on whether the recordset is empty. If a recordset is
empty (for example, no records were found matching the query), you can display a message informing the user that no
records were returned. This is especially useful when creating search pages that rely on user input search terms to run
queries against. Similarly, you can display an error message if there is a problem connecting to a database, or if a user’s
user name and password do not match those recognized by the server.
The Show Region server behaviors are:
Show If Recordset Is Empty
Show If Recordset Is Not Empty
Show If First Page
Show If Not First Page
Show If Last Page
Show If Not Last Page
1In Design view, select the region on the page to show or hide.
2In the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors), click the Plus (+) button.
3Select Show Region from the pop-up menu, select one of the listed server behaviors, and click OK.
Display multiple recordset results
The Repeating Region server behavior lets you display multiple records from a recordset within a page. Any dynamic
data selection can be turned into a repeating region. However, the most common regions are a table, a table row, or a
series of table rows.
1In Design view, select a region that contains dynamic content.
The selection can be anything, including a table, a table row, or even a paragraph of text.
To select a region on the page precisely, you can use the tag selector on the left corner of the document window. For
example, if the region is a table row, click inside the row on the page, then click the rightmost <tr> tag in the tag
selector to select the table row.
2Select Window > Server Behaviors to display the Server Behaviors panel.
3Click the Plus (+) button, and select Repeating Region.
4Select the name of the recordset to use from the pop-up menu.
5Select the number of records to display per page, and click OK.
In the Document window, a thin, tabbed, gray outline appears around the repeating region.
Modify repeating regions in the Property inspector
Modify the selected repeating region by changing any of the following options:
The name of the repeating region.
The recordset providing the records for the repeating region.
The number of records displayed
When you select a new option, Dreamweaver updates the page.
589
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Reuse PHP recordsets
For a tutorial on reusing PHP recordsets, see David Powers’s tutorial, How Do I Reuse a PHP Recordset in More Than
One Repeat Region?
Create a dynamic table
The following example illustrates how the Repeating Region server behavior is applied to a table row, and specifies that
nine records are displayed per page. The row itself displays four different records: city, state, street address, and ZIP
code.
To create a table such as the one in the previous example, you must create a table that contains dynamic content, and
apply the Repeating Region server behavior to the table row containing the dynamic content. When the page is
processed by the application server, the row is repeated the number of times specified in the Repeating Region server
object, with a different record inserted in each new row.
1Do one of the following to insert a dynamic table:
Select Insert > Data Objects > Dynamic Data > Dynamic Table to display the Dynamic Table dialog box.
From the Data category of the Insert panel, click the Dynamic Data button and select the Dynamic Table icon
from the pop-up menu.
2Select the recordset from the Recordset pop-up menu.
3Select the number of records to display per page.
4(Optional) Input values for the table border, cell padding, and cell spacing.
The Dynamic Table dialog box retains the values you enter for table borders, cell padding, and cell spacing.
Note: If you are working on a project that requires several dynamic tables with the same appearance, enter the table
layout values, which further simplifies page development. You can adjust these values after inserting the table by using
the table Property inspector.
590
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
5Click OK.
A table and placeholders for the dynamic content defined in its associated recordset are inserted into the page.
In this example, the recordset contains four columns: AUTHORID, FIRSTNAME, LASTNAME, and BIO. The
tables heading row is populated with the names of each column. You can edit the headings using any descriptive
text, or replace them with representative images.
Create record counters
Record counters give users a reference point when they are navigating through a set of records. Typically, record
counters display the total number of records returned, and the current records being viewed. For example, if a recordset
returns 40 individual records, and 8 records are displayed per page, the record counter on the first page would indicate
“Displaying records 1-8 of 40.
Before you create a record counter for a page, you must create a recordset for the page, an appropriate page layout to
contain the dynamic content, and then a recordset navigation bar.
Create simple record counters
Record counters let users know where they are within a given set of records relative to the total number of records
returned. For this reason record counters are a useful behavior that can significantly add to the usability of a web page.
Create a simple record counter by using the Recordset Navigation Status server object. This server object creates a text
entry on the page to display the current record status. You can customize the record counter by using Dreamweaver
page-design tools.
1Place the insertion point where you want to insert the record counter.
2Select Insert > Data Objects > Display Record Count > Recordset Navigation Status, select the recordset from the
Recordset pop-up menu, and click OK.
The Recordset Navigation Status server object inserts a text record counter that appears similar to the following
example:
When viewed in Live view, the counter appears similar to the following example:
Build and add the record counter to the page
In the Insert Recordset Navigation Status dialog box, select the recordset to track, and click OK.
591
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Create custom record counters
You use individual record count behaviors to create custom record counters. Creating a custom record counter lets you
create a record counter beyond the simple, single row table inserted by the Recordset Navigation Status server object.
You can arrange design elements in a number of creative ways, and apply an appropriate server behavior to each
element.
The Record Count server behaviors are:
Display Starting Record Number
Display Ending Record Number
Display Total Records
Before you create a custom record counter for a page, you must first create a recordset for the page, an appropriate page
layout to contain the dynamic content, and a recordset navigation bar.
This example creates a record counter that appears similar to the example in “Simple record counters.” In this example,
the text in sans-serif font represents the record count placeholders that will be inserted in the page. The record counter
in this example appears as follows:
Displaying records StartRow through EndRow of RecordSet.RecordCount.
1In Design view, enter the counter’s text on the page. The text can be anything you want, for example:
Displaying records thru of .
2Place the insertion point at the end of the text string.
3Open the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors).
4Click the Plus (+) button in the upper-left corner, and click Display Record Count. Within this submenu, select
Display Total Records. The Display Total Records behavior is inserted into the page, and a placeholder is inserted
where the insertion point was. The text string now appears as follows:
Displaying records thru of {Recordset1.RecordCount}.
5Place the insertion point after the word records, and select the Display Starting Record Count Number from the
Server Behaviors > Plus (+) button > Record Count panel. The text string now appear as follows:
Displaying records {StartRow_Recordset1} thru of {Recordset1.RecordCount}.
6Now place the insertion point between the words thru and of, and select the Display Starting Record Count Number
from the Server Behaviors > Plus (+) button > Record Count panel. The text string now appear as follows:
Displaying records {StartRow_Recordset1} thru {EndRow_Recordset1}
of{Recordset1.RecordCount}.
7Confirm that the counter functions correctly by viewing the page in Live view; the counter is similar to the following
example:
Displaying records 1 thru 8 of 40.
If the results page has a navigation link to move to the next set of records, clicking the link updates the record
counter to read as follows:
Showing records 9 thru 16 of 40.
Use predefined data formats
Dreamweaver includes several predefined data formats that you can apply to dynamic data elements. The data format
styles include date and time, currency, numerical, and percentage formats.
592
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Apply data formats to dynamic content
1Select the dynamic content placeholder in the Document window.
2Select Window > Bindings to display the Bindings panel.
3Click the down arrow button in the Format column.
If the down arrow is not visible, expand the panel.
4From the Format pop-up menu, select the data format category you want.
Ensure that the data format is appropriate for the type of data you are formatting. For example, the Currency formats
work only if the dynamic data consists of numerical data. Note that you cannot apply more than one format to the
same data.
5Verify that the format was applied correctly by previewing the page in Live view.
Customize a data format
1Open a page that contains dynamic data in Design view.
2Select the dynamic data you want to create a custom format for.
The bound data item whose dynamic text you selected is highlighted in the Bindings panel (Window > Bindings).
The panel displays two columns for the selected item—Binding and Format. If the Format column is not visible,
widen the Bindings panel to reveal it.
3In the Bindings panel, click the down arrow in the Format column to expand the pop-up menu of available data
formats.
If the down arrow is not visible, widen the Bindings panel more.
4Select Edit Format List from the pop-up menu.
5Complete the dialog box, and click OK.
a.Select the format from the list, and click Edit.
b.Change any of the following parameters in the Currency, Number, or Percent dialog boxes, and click OK.
The number of digits to display after the decimal point
Whether to place a leading zero in front of fractions
Whether to use parentheses or a minus sign for negative values
Whether to group digits
c.To delete a data format, click the format in the list, and click the Minus (-) button.
Create a data format (ASP only)
1Open a page containing dynamic data in Design view.
2Select the dynamic data you want to create a custom format for.
3Select Window > Bindings to display the Bindings panel, and click the down arrow in the Format column. If the
down arrow is not visible, expand the panel.
4Select Edit Format List from the pop-up menu.
5Click the Plus (+) button, and select a format type.
6Define the format, and click OK.
7Enter a name for the new format in the Name column, and click OK.
593
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: Though Dreamweaver only supports creating data formats for ASP pages, ColdFusion and PHP users can
download formats that other developers created, or create server formats and post them to the Dreamweaver Exchange.
For more information on the Server Format API, see Extending Dreamweaver(Help > Extending Dreamweaver >
Server Formats).
More Help topics
Viewing live data
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
The View Live Data feature has been deprecated as of Dreamweaver CS5. It has been replaced by the more streamlined
Live view feature.
To view live data in Live view, make sure that you have done the following:
Define a folder to process dynamic pages (for example, a root folder on a ColdFusion server, either on your
computer or on a remote machine).
If the page displays an error message when you enter Live View, make sure the Web URL in the Site Definition dialog
box is correct.
Copy related files (if any) to the folder.
Provide the page with any parameters a user would normally provide.
Provide the page with live data in Live view
1Open the Live View Settings dialog box (View > Live View Options > HTTP Request Settings).
2In the URL Request area, click the Plus (+) button and enter a parameter your page expects.
3Specify a name and a test value for each parameter.
4In the Method pop-up menu, select the HTML form method your page expects: POST or GET.
5To save your settings for the current page, select Save SettingsFor This Document, and click OK.
Note: To save the settings, you must enable Design Notes (File > Design Notes).
Troubleshooting live data in Live view
Many problems viewing live data in Live view can be traced back to missing or incorrect values in the Site Definition
dialog box (Site > Edit Sites).
Check the settings for the server that youve specified as your testing server. You need to specify a folder capable of
processing dynamic pages where the Site Definition dialog asks for a server folder or root directory. Heres an example
of a suitable server folder if youre running IIS or PWS on your hard disk:
C:\Inetpub\wwwroot\myapp\
594
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Verify that the Web URL box specifies a URL that corresponds (maps) to the server folder. For example, if PWS or IIS
is running on your local computer, then the following remote folders have the following Web URLs:
More Help topics
Switch between views in the Document window
Preview pages in Live view
Adding custom server behaviors
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About custom server behaviors
Dreamweaver comes with a set of built-in server behaviors that lets you easily add dynamic capabilities to a site. You
can extend the Dreamweaver functionality by creating server behaviors to suit your development needs, or by obtaining
server behaviors from the Dreamweaver Exchange website.
Before creating your own server behaviors, you should check the Dreamweaver Exchange website to see if another party
has already created a server behavior that supplies the functionality youd like to add to your website. Often, a third-
party developer has created and tested a server behavior that will address your needs.
Access Dreamweaver Exchange
1In Dreamweaver, access Dreamweaver Exchange in one of these ways:
Select Help > Dreamweaver Exchange.
Select Window > Server Behaviors, click the Plus (+) button, and select Get More Server Behaviors.
The Dreamweaver Exchange web page opens in your browser.
2Log on to the Exchange using your Adobe ID, or, if you have not yet created a Dreamweaver Exchange ID for
yourself, follow the instructions to open an Adobe account.
Install a server behavior or other extension in Dreamweaver
1Start the Extension Manager by selecting Commands > Manage Extensions.
2Select File > Install Package in the Extension Manager.
For more information, see Using the Extension Manager.
Remote folder Web URL
C:\Inetpub\wwwroot\ http://localhost/
C:\Inetpub\wwwroot\myapp\ http://localhost/myapp/
C:\Inetpub\wwwroot\fs\planes http://localhost/fs/planes
595
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Custom server behaviors workflow
If you are a web developer proficient in ColdFusion, JavaScript, VBScript, or PHP, you can write your own server
behaviors. The steps to create a server behavior include the following tasks:
Write one or more code blocks that perform the required action.
Specify where the code block should be inserted within the pages HTML code.
If the server behavior requires that a value be specified for a parameter, create a dialog box that prompts the web
developer applying the behavior to supply an appropriate value.
Test the server behavior before making it available to others.
Use the Server Behavior Builder
Use the Server Behavior Builder to add the code block or blocks that the behavior inserts into a page.
1In the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors), click the Plus (+) button, and select New Server
Behavior.
2From the Document Type pop-up menu, select the document type that you are developing the server behavior for.
3In the Name box, enter a name for the server behavior.
4(Optional) To copy an existing server behavior to add to the behavior you are creating, select the Copy Existing
Server Behavior option, and then select the server behavior in the Behavior to Copy pop-up menu. Click OK.
The Server Behavior Builder dialog box is displayed.
5To add a new code block, click the Plus (+) button, enter a name for the code block, and click OK.
The name you enter appears in the Server Behavior Builder, with the appropriate scripting tags visible in the Code
block box.
6In the Code Block box, enter the run-time code necessary to implement the server behavior.
Note: When entering code in the Code Block box, you can only insert a single tag or code block for each named code
block (for example, myBehavior_block1, myBehavior_block2, myBehavior_blockn, etc.). If you have to enter multiple
tags or code blocks, create an individual code block for each one. You can also copy and paste code from other pages.
7Place the insertion point in the code block where youd like to insert the parameter, or select a string to replace with
a parameter.
8Click the Insert Parameters in Code Block button.
9Enter a name for the parameter in the Parameter Name box (for example, Session), and click OK.
The parameter is inserted into the code block at the location where you placed the insertion point prior to defining
the parameter. If you selected a string, every instance of the selected string in the code block is replaced with a
parameter marker (for example, @@Session@@).
10 Select an option from the Insert Code pop-up menu specifying where to embed the code blocks.
11 (Optional) To specify additional information about the server behavior, click the Advanced button.
12 To create more code blocks, repeat steps 5 through 11.
13 If the server behavior requires that parameters be supplied to it, you must create a dialog box that accepts parameters
from the person applying the behavior. See the link below.
14 After you perform the required steps to create the server behavior, click OK.
The Server Behaviors panel lists the server behavior.
596
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
15 Test the server behavior and ensure that it functions properly.
Advanced options
After you specify the source code and insert location for each code block, the server behavior is completely defined. In
most cases, you dont need to specify any additional information.
If you are an advanced user, you can set any of the following options:
Identifier Specifies whether the code block should be treated as an identifier.
By default, every code block is an identifier. If Dreamweaver finds an identifier code block anywhere in a document, it
lists the behavior in the Server Behaviors panel. Use the Identifier option to specify whether the code block should be
treated as an identifier.
At least one of the server behavior’s code blocks must be an identifier. A code block should not be an identifier if one
of the following conditions applies: the same code block is used by some other server behavior; or the code block is so
simple that it might occur naturally on the page.
Server Behavior Title Specifies the title of the behavior in the Server Behaviors panel.
When the page designer clicks the Plus (+) button on the Server Behaviors panel, the new server behavior’s title will
appear in the pop-up menu. When a designer applies an instance of a server behavior to a document, the behavior
appears in the list of applied behaviors in the Server Behaviors panel. Use the Server Behavior Title box to specify the
contents of the Plus (+) pop-up menu and the list of applied behaviors.
The initial value in the box is the name you supplied in the New Server Behavior dialog box. As parameters are defined,
the name is automatically updated so that the parameters appear inside parentheses after the server behavior name.
Set Session Variable (@@Name@@, @@Value@@)
If the user accepts the default value, everything before the parentheses appears in the Plus (+) pop-up menu (for
example, Set Session Variable). The name plus the parameters will appear in the list of applied behaviorsfor example,
Set Session Variable ("abcd", "5").
Code Block to Select Specifies what code block is selected when the user selects the behavior in the Server Behaviors
panel.
When you apply a server behavior, one of the code blocks within the behavior is designated the “code block to select.
If you apply the server behavior and then select the behavior in the Server Behaviors panel, the designated block is
selected in the Document window. By default, Dreamweaver selects the first code block that is not above the html tag.
If all the code blocks are above the html tag, then the first one is selected. Advanced users can specify which code block
is the selected one.
Creating code blocks
The code blocks you create in the Server Behavior Builder are encapsulated in a server behavior that appears in the
Server Behaviors panel. The code can be any valid run-time code for the specified server model. For example, if you
choose ColdFusion as the document type for your custom server behavior, the code you write must be valid ColdFusion
code that runs on a ColdFusion application server.
You can create the code blocks either directly in the Server Behavior Builder, or you can copy and paste the code from
other sources. Each code block you create in the Server Behavior Builder must be a single tag or script block. If you
must insert multiple tag blocks, split them into separate code blocks.
Conditions in code blocks
597
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Dreamweaver lets you develop code blocks that incorporate control statements that execute conditionally. The Server
Behavior Builder uses if, elseif, and else statements, and may also contain server behavior parameters. This enables you
to insert alternate text blocks based on the values of OR relationships among server behavior parameters.
The following example shows the if, elseif, and else statements. The square brackets ([ ]) denote optional code and the
asterisk (*) denotes zero or more instances. To execute a portion of a code block or the entire code block only if a certain
condition or conditions apply, use the following syntax:
<@ if (expression1) @> conditional
text1[<@ elseif (expression2) @> conditional text2]*[<@ else @>
conditional text3]<@ endif @>
Condition expressions can be any JavaScript expression that can be evaluated using the JavaScript eval() function, and
may include a server behavior parameter marked by @@’s. (The @@s distinguish the parameter from JavaScript
variables and keywords.)
Effectively using conditional expressions
When using if, else, and elseif directives within the insertText XML tag, the participant text is preprocessed to resolve
the if directives and to determine which text to include in the result. The if and elseif directives take the expression as
an argument. The condition expression is the same as that for JavaScript condition expressions, and can also contain
server behavior parameters. Directives such as this allow you to choose between alternative code blocks based on the
values of, or relationships between, server behavior parameters.
For example, the following JSP code comes from a Dreamweaver server behavior that uses a conditional code block:
@@rsName@@.close();
<@ if (@@callableName@@ != '') @>
@@callableName@@.execute();
@@rsName@@ = @@callableName@@.getResultSet();<@ else @>
@@rsName@@ = Statement@@rsName@@.executeQuery();
<@ endif @>
@@rsName@@_hasData = @@rsName@@.next();
The conditional code block starts with <@ if (@@callableName@@ != '') @> and ends with <@ endif @>. According to
the code, if the user enters a value for the @@callableName@@ parameter in the server behavior's Parameter dialog
box—in other words, if the @@callableName@@ parameter value is not null, or (@@callableName@@ != '')—then the
conditional code block is replaced with the following statements:
@@callableName@@.execute();
@@rsName@@ = @@callableName@@.getResultSet();
Otherwise, the code block is replaced with the following statement:
@@rsName@@ = Statement@@rsName@@.executeQuery();
Positioning a code block
When you create code blocks using the Server Behavior Builder, you must specify where to insert them in the pages
HTML code.
For example, if you insert a code block above the opening <html> tag, you must then specify the code blocks position
relative to other tags, scripts, and server behaviors in that section of the pages HTML code. Typical examples include
positioning a behavior either before or after any recordset queries that might also exist in the page code above the
opening <html> tag.
598
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
When you select a positioning option from the Insert Code pop-up menu, the options available in the Relative Position
pop-up menu change to provide relevant options for that part of the page. For example, if you select Above The <html>
Tag In The Insert Code pop-up menu, the positioning options available in the Relative Position pop-up menu reflect
choices relevant for that part of the page.
The following table shows the code block insert options, and the relative positioning options available for each:
To specify a custom position, you must assign a weight to the code block. Use the Custom Position option when you
need to insert more than one code block in a particular order. For example, to insert an ordered series of three code
blocks after the code blocks that open recordsets, you would enter a weight of 60 for the first block, 65 for the second,
and 70 for the third.
By default, Dreamweaver assigns a weight of 50 to all recordset-opening code blocks inserted above the <html> tag. If
the weight of two or more blocks match, Dreamweaver randomly sets the order among the blocks.
Position a code block (general instructions)
1Using the Server Behavior Builder, write a code block.
2In the Server Behavior Builder dialog box, select a position in which to insert the code block from the Insert Code
pop-up menu.
3In the Server Behavior Builder dialog box, select a position relative to that which you selected in the Insert Code
pop-up menu.
4If you complete the authoring of the code block, click OK.
The server behavior is listed in the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behavior); click the Plus (+) button to
view the server behavior.
5Test the server behavior and ensure that it functions properly.
Insert Code options Relative position options
Above the <html> Tag At the beginning of the file
Just before the recordsets
Just after the recordsets
Just above the <html> tag
Custom position
Below the </html> Tag Before the end of the file
Before the recordset close
After the recordset close
After the </html> tag
Custom position
Relative to a Specific Tag Select a tag from the Tag pop-up menu, and then choose from the tag
positioning options.
Relative to the Selection Before the selection
After the selection
Replace the selection
Wrap the selection
599
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Position a code block relative to another tag on the page
1In the Insert Code pop-up menu, select Relative To A Specific Tag.
2In the Tag box, enter the tag or select one from the pop-up menu.
If you enter a tag, don’t include the angled brackets (<>).
3Specify a location relative to the tag by choosing an option in the Relative Position pop-up menu.
Position a code block relative to a tag selected by the page designer
1In the Insert Code pop-up menu, select Relative To The Selection.
2Specify a location relative to the selection by choosing an option in the Relative Position pop-up menu.
You can insert your code block just before or just after the selection. You can also replace the selection with your
code block, or you can wrap the code block around the selection.
To wrap the code block around a selection, the selection must consist of an opening and closing tag with nothing in
between, as follows:
<CFIF Day=”Monday”></CFIF>
Insert the opening tag piece of the code block before the selections opening tag and the closing tag piece of the code
block after the selections closing tag.
Repeating code blocks with the loop directive
To repeat a portion of a code block or the entire code block a number of times, use the following syntax:
<@ loop (@@param1@@,@@param2@@) @> code
block<@ endloop @>
When creating server behaviors, you can use looping constructs to repeat a code block a specified number of times. <@
loop (@@param1@@,@@param2@@,@@param3@@,@@param_n@@) @> code block <@ endloop @>The loop
directive accepts a comma-separated list of parameter arrays as arguments. In this case, parameter array arguments
allow a user to supply multiple values for a single parameter. The repeating text is duplicated n times, where n is the
length of the parameter array arguments. If more than one parameter array argument is specified, all the arrays must
have the same length. On the ith evaluation of the loop, the ith elements of the parameter arrays replace the associated
parameter instances in the code block.
When you create a dialog box for the server behavior, you can add a control to the dialog box that lets the page designer
create parameter arrays. Dreamweaver includes a simple array control that you can use to create dialog boxes. This
control, called Text Field Comma Separated List, is available through the Server Behavior Builder. To create user
interface elements of greater complexity, see the API documentation to create a dialog box with a control to create
arrays (a grid control, for example).
You can nest any number of conditionals or a loop directive within a conditional directive. For example, you can specify
that if an expression is true to execute a loop.
The following example shows how such repeating code blocks can be used to create server behaviors (the example is a
ColdFusion behavior used to access a stored procedure):
<@ loop (@@param1@@,@@param2@@,@@param3@@,@@param_n@@) @> code block
<@ endloop @>
600
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
<CFPROCPARAM type="IN"
dbvarname="@@paramName@@"
value="@@value@@"
cfsqltype="@@type@@">
<@ endloop @>
</CFSTOREDPROC>
Note: New lines after each “@>” are ignored.
If the user entered the following parameter values in the Server Behavior Builder dialog box:
procedure = "proc1"
conn = "connection1"
paramName = ["@CategoryId", "@Year", "@ISBN"]
value = ["#Form.CategoryId#", "#Form.Year#", "#Form.ISBN#"]
type = ["CF_SQL_INTEGER", "CF_SQL_INTEGER", "CF_SQL_VARCHAR"]
The server behavior would insert the following run-time code in the page:
<CFSTOREDPROC procedure="proc1"
datasource=#MM_connection1_DSN#
username=#MM_connection1_USERNAME#
password=#MM_connection1_PASSWORD#>
<CFPROCPARAM type="IN" dbvarname="@CategoryId" value="#Form.CategoryId#"
cfsqltype="CF_SQL_INTEGER">
<CFPROCPARAM type="IN" dbvarname="@Year" value="#Form.Year#"
cfsqltype="CF_SQL_INTEGER">
<CFPROCPARAM type="IN" dbvarname="@ISBN" value="#Form.ISBN#"
cfsqltype="CF_SQL_VARCHAR">
</CFSTOREDPROC>
Note: Parameter arrays cannot be used outside of a loop except as part of a conditional directive expression.
Using the loop directives _length and _index variables
<CFPROCPARAM type="IN" dbvarname="@CategoryId" value="#Form.CategoryID#"
cfsqltype="CF_SQL_INTEGER">
<CFPROCPARAM type="IN" dbvarname="@ISBN" value="#Form.ISBN#"
cfsqltype="CF_SQL_VARCHAR">
</CFSTOREDPROC>
In this example, the CFSTOREDPROC tag can include zero or more CFPROCPARAM tags. However, without
support for the loop directive, there is no way to include the CFPROCPARAM tags within the inserted
CFSTOREDPROC tag. If this were to be created as a server behavior without the use of the loop directive, you
would need to divide this example into two participants: a main CFSTOREDPROC tag, and a CFPROCPARAM tag
whose participant type is multiple.
Using the loop directive, you can write the same procedure as follows:
<CFSTOREDPROC procedure="@@procedure@@"
datasource=#MM_@@conn@@_DSN#
username=#MM_@@conn@@_USERNAME#
password=#MM_@@conn@@_PASSWORD#>
<@ loop (@@paramName@@,@@value@@,@@type@@) @>
datasource=#MM_connection_DSN#
username=#MM_connection_USERNAME#
password=#MM_connection_PASSWORD#>
<CFSTOREDPROC procedure="AddNewBook"
601
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
The loop directive includes two built-in variables that you can use for embedded if conditions. The variables are:
_length and _index. The _length variable evaluates to the length of the arrays processed by the loop directive, while the
_index variable evaluates to the current index of the loop directive. To ensure that the variables are only recognized as
directives, and not as actual parameters to be passed into the loop, do not enclose either variable in @@s.
An example of using built-in variables is to apply them to the import attribute of the page directive. The import attribute
requires comma separation of packages. If the loop directive extends around the entire import attribute, you would only
output the attribute name import= on the first iteration of the loop—this includes the closing double quote (")—and
not output a comma on the last iteration of the loop. Using the built-in variable, you can express this as follows:
<@loop (@@Import@@)@>
<@ if(_index == 0)@>import="
<@endif@>@@Import@@<@if (_index == _length-1)@>"<@else@>,
<@ endif @>
<@endloop@>
Request a parameter for the server behavior
Server behaviors often require that the page designer supply a parameter value. This value must be inserted before the
server behaviors code is inserted into the page.
You create the dialog box by defining the designer-supplied parameters in the code. Then you generate a dialog box for
the server behavior, which prompts the page designer for a parameter value.
Note: A parameter is added to your code block without your intervention if you specify that your code should be inserted
relative to a specific tag chosen by the page designer (that is, you chose Relative to a Specific Tag in the Insert Code pop-up
menu). The parameter adds a tag menu to the behavior’s dialog box to let the page designer select a tag.
Define the parameter in the server behavior code
1Enter a parameter marker in the code where you want to insert the supplied parameter value. The parameter has the
following syntax:
@@parameterName@@
2Enclose the formParam string in parameter markers (@@):
<% Session(“lang_pref”) = Request.Form(“@@formParam@@”); %>
For example, if the server behavior contains the following code block:
<% Session(“lang_pref”) = Request.Form(“Form_Object_Name”); %>
To require the page designer to supply the value of Form_Object_Name, enclose the string in parameter markers
(@@):<% Session(“lang_pref”) = Request.Form(“@@Form_Object_Name@@”); %>
<% Session(“lang_pref”) = Request.Form(“@@Form_Object_Name@@”); %>
You can also highlight the string and click the Insert Parameter In Code Block button. Enter a parameter name and
click OK. Dreamweaver replaces every instance of the highlighted string with the specified parameter name enclosed
in parameter markers.
Dreamweaver uses the strings that you enclose in parameter markers to label the controls in the dialog box it generates
(see the following procedure). In the previous example, Dreamweaver creates a dialog box with the following label:
Note: Parameter names in the server behavior code cannot have any spaces. Therefore, the dialog box labels cannot have
any spaces. If you want to include spaces in the label, you can edit the generated HTML file.
602
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Create a dialog box for your server behavior to request the parameter value
1In the Server Behavior Builder, click Next.
2To change the display order of the dialog box controls, select a parameter and click the up and down arrows.
3To change a parameters control, select the parameter and select another control in the Display As column.
4Click OK.
Dreamweaver generates a dialog box with a labeled control for each designer-supplied parameter that you defined.
View the dialog box
Click the Plus (+) button in the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors), and select your custom server
behavior from the pop-up menu.
Edit the dialog box you created for the server behavior
1In the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors), click the Plus (+) button, and select Edit Server
Behaviors from the pop-up menu.
2Select your server behavior from the list, and click Open.
3Click Next.
A dialog box appears listing all the designer-supplied parameters that you defined in your code.
4To change the display order of the dialog box controls, select a parameter and click the up and down arrows.
5To change a parameters control, select the parameter and select another control in the Display As column.
6Click OK.
Edit and modify server behaviors
You can edit any server behavior created with the Server Behavior Builder, including server behaviors you download
from the Dreamweaver Exchange website, and other third-party developers.
If you apply a server behavior to a page and then edit the behavior in Dreamweaver, instances of the old behavior no
longer appear in the Server Behaviors panel. The Server Behaviors panel searches the page for code that matches the
code of known server behaviors. If the code of a server behavior changes, the panel does not recognize earlier versions
of the behavior on that page.
Retain the old and new versions of the behavior in the panel
Click the Plus (+) button on the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors), select New Server Behavior,
and create a copy of the old server behavior.
603
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Edit the code of a server behavior created with the Server Behavior Builder
1In the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors), click the Plus (+) button and select Edit Server
Behaviors from the pop-up menu.
The Edit Server Behaviors dialog box displays all the behaviors for the current server technology.
2Select the server behavior and click Edit.
3Select the appropriate code block and modify the code, the parameter marks, or the position of the code block to be
inserted in pages.
4If the modified code does not contain any designer-supplied parameters, click OK.
Dreamweaver regenerates the server behavior without a dialog box. The new server behavior appears in the Plus (+)
pop-up menu of the Server Behaviors panel.
5If the modified code does contain designer-supplied parameters, click Next.
Dreamweaver asks you whether you want to create a new dialog box, overwriting the old one. Make your changes
and click OK.
Dreamweaver saves all changes in the server behavior’s EDML file.
Coding guidelines
In general, your server behavior’s code should be compact and robust. Web application developers are very sensitive to
the code added to their pages. Follow generally accepted coding practices for the document types language
(ColdFusion, JavaScript, VBScript, or PHP). When writing comments, consider the different technical audiences that
might need to understand the code, such as web and interaction designers, or other web application developers. Include
comments that accurately describe the purpose of the code, and any special instructions for including it within a page.
Keep in mind the following coding guidelines when you create server behaviors:
Error checking An important requirement. The server behavior’s code should handle error cases gracefully. Try to
foresee every possibility. For example, what if a parameter request fails? What if no records are returned from a query?
Unique names Help to ensure that your code is clearly identifiable and avoids name collisions with existing code. For
example, if the page contains a function called hideLayer() and a global variable called ERROR_STRING, and your
server behavior inserts code that uses those names too, the server behavior may conflict with the existing code.
Code prefixes Allow you to identify your own run-time functions and global variables in a page. One convention is to
use your initials. Never use the MM_ prefix, as it is reserved for Dreamweaver use only. Dreamweaver precedes all
functions and global variables with the prefix MM_ to prevent them from conflicting with any code that you write.
var MM_ERROR_STRING = "...";
function MM_hideLayer() {
Avoid similar code blocks so that the code you write doesn’t resemble too closely the code in other blocks. If a code
block looks too much like another code block on the page, the Server Behaviors panel might mistakenly identify the
first code block as an instance of the second code block (or conversely). A simple solution is to add a comment to a code
block to make it more unique.
Testing server behaviors
The Dreamweaver Exchange recommends performing the following tests on each server behavior you create:
Apply the behavior from the Server Behaviors panel. If it has a dialog box, enter valid data in each field and click
OK. Verify that no error occurs when the behavior is applied. Verify that the run-time code for the server behavior
appears in the Code inspector.
604
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Apply the server behavior again and enter invalid data in each field of the dialog box. Try leaving the field blank,
using large or negative numbers, using invalid characters (such as /, ?, :, *, and so on), and using letters in numeric
fields. You can write form validation routines to handle invalid data (validation routines involve hand-coding, which
is beyond the scope of this book).
After successfully applying your server behavior to the page, verify the following:
Check the Server Behaviors panel to make sure the name of the server behavior appears in the list of behaviors added
to the page.
If applicable, verify that server-side script icons show up on the page. The generic server-side script icons are gold
shields. To see the icons, enable Invisible Elements (View > Visual Aids > Invisible Elements).
In Code view (View > Code), verify that no invalid code is generated.
In addition, if your server behavior inserts code in the document establishing a connection to a database, create a
test database to test the code inserted in the document. Verify the connection by defining queries that produce
different sets of data, and different sizes of data sets.
Finally, upload the page to the server and open it in a browser. View the pages HTML source code and verify that
no invalid HTML has been generated by the server-side scripts.
More Help topics
Adding custom server behaviors
About building forms
Note: The user interface in Dreamweaver CC and later has been simplified. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
When a visitor enters information into a web form displayed in a web browser and clicks the submit button, the
information is sent to a server where a server-side script or application processes it. The server responds by sending the
processed information back to the user (or client), or by performing some other action based on the forms contents.
You can use Dreamweaver to create forms that submit data to most application servers, including PHP, ASP, and
ColdFusion. If you use ColdFusion, you can also add ColdFusion-specific form controls to your forms. Your forms can
have text fields, password fields, radio buttons, check boxes, pop-up menus, clickable buttons, and other form objects.
Dreamweaver can also write code that validates the information a visitor provides. For example, you can check that an
e-mail address that a user enters contains an “@” symbol, or that a required text field contains a value.
Note: Support for ColdFusion and ASP is removed in Dreamweaver CC and later.
Using forms to collect information from users
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
605
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
About collecting information from users
You can use web forms or hypertext links to gather information from users, store that information in the servers
memory, and then use the information to create a dynamic response based on the user’s input. The most common tools
for gathering user information are HTML forms and hypertext links.
HTML forms Let you gather information from users and store it in the server’s memory. An HTML form can send the
information either as form parameters or as URL parameters.
Hypertext links Let you gather information from users and store it in the server’s memory. You specify a value (or
values) to be submitted when a user clicks a link—a preference, for example—by appending the value to the URL
specified in the anchor tag. When a user clicks the link, the browser sends the URL and the appended value to the
server.
HTML form parameters
Form parameters are sent to the server by means of an HTML form using either the POST or GET method.
When using the POST method, parameters are sent to the web server as part of the document's header, and are not
visible or accessible to anyone who's viewing the page using standard methods. The POST method should be used for
values that affect database content (for example inserting, updating, or deleting records), or for values that are sent by
email.
The GET method appends parameters to the requested URL. The parameters are in turn visible to anyone viewing the
page. The GET method should be used for search forms.
You can use Dreamweaver to quickly design HTML forms that send form parameters to the server. Be aware of the
method you use to transmit information from the browser to the server.
Form parameters take the names of their corresponding form objects. For example, if your form contains a text field
named txtLastName, then the following form parameter is sent to the server when the user clicks the Submit button:
txtLastName=enteredvalue
In cases where a web application expects a precise parameter value (for example, when it performs an action based on
one of several options), use a radio button, check box, or list/menu form object to control the values the user can
submit. This prevents users from typing information incorrectly and causing an application error. The following
example depicts a pop-up menu form offering three choices:
Each menu choice corresponds to a hard-coded value that is submitted as a form parameter to the server. The List
Values dialog box in the following example matches each list item to a value (Add, Update, or Delete):
606
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
After a form parameter is created, Dreamweaver can retrieve the value and use it in a web application. After defining
the form parameter in Dreamweaver, you can insert its value within a page.
URL parameters
URL parameters let you pass user-supplied information from the browser to the server. When a server receives a
request and parameters are appended to the URL of the request, the server gives the requested page access to the
parameters before serving that page to the browser.
A URL parameter is a name-value pair appended to a URL. The parameter begins with a question mark (?) and takes
the form name=value. If more than one URL parameter exists, each parameter is separated by an ampersand (&). The
following example shows a URL parameter with two name-value pairs:
http://server/path/document?name1=value1&name2=value2
In this example workflow, the application is a web-based storefront. Because the developers of the site want to reach the
widest possible audience, the site is designed to support foreign currencies. When users log in to the site, they can select
the currency in which to view the prices of the available items.
1The browser requests the report.cfm page from the server. The request includes the URL parameter
Currency="euro". The Currency="euro" variable specifies that all monetary amounts retrieved be displayed as the
European Union euro.
2The server temporarily stores the URL parameter in memory.
3The report.cfm page uses the parameter to retrieve the cost of items in euros. These monetary amounts can either
be stored in a database table of different currencies, or converted from a single currency associated with each item
(any currency supported by the application).
4The server sends the report.cfm page to the browser and displays the value of items in the requested currency. When
this user ends the session, the server clears the value of the URL parameter, freeing server memory to hold new user
requests.
URL parameters are also created when the HTTP GET method is used in conjunction with an HTML form. The
GET method specifies that the parameter value be appended to the URL request when the form is submitted.
Typical uses of URL parameters include personalizing websites based on user preferences. For example, a URL
parameter consisting of a user name and password can be used to authenticate a user, displaying only information
that user has subscribed to. Common examples of this include financial websites that display individual stock prices
based on stock market symbols the user has previously chosen. Web application developers commonly use URL
parameters to pass values to variables within applications. For example, you could pass search terms to SQL
variables in a web application to generate search results.
607
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Creating URL parameters using HTML links
You create URL parameters within an HTML link by using the href attribute of the HTML anchor tag. You can enter
the URL parameters directly in the attribute in Code view (View > Code), or by appending the URL parameters at the
end of the link URL in the Property inspector Link box.
In the following example, three links create a single URL parameter (action) with three possible values (Add, Update,
and Delete). When the user clicks a link, a parameter value is sent to the server, and the requested action is performed.
<a href="http://www.mysite.com/index.cfm?action=Add">Add a record</a>
<a href="http://www.mysite.com/index.cfm?action=Update">Update a record</a>
<a href="http://www.mysite.com/index.cfm?action=Delete">Delete a record</a>
The Property inspector (Window > Properties) lets you create the same URL parameters by selecting the link and
appending the URL parameter values at the end of the link URL in the Link box.
After a URL parameter is created, Dreamweaver can retrieve the value and use it in a web application. After defining
the URL parameter in Dreamweaver, you can insert its value within a page.
More Help topics
Creating web forms
Adding dynamic content to pages
Linking
608
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Building ColdFusion forms
Note: Support for ColdFusion is removed in Dreamweaver CC and later.
About ColdFusion forms
ColdFusion forms provide you with several built-in mechanisms to validate form data. For example, you can check
to make sure a user has entered a valid date. Some form controls have additional features. Several do not have
HTML counterparts, and others directly support dynamically populating the control from data sources.
Dreamweaver provides a number of enhancements for ColdFusion developers who use ColdFusion MX 7 or later as
their development server. These enhancements include more Insert panel buttons, menu items, and Property
inspectors so that you can rapidly build and set the properties of ColdFusion forms. You can also generate code that
validates the information provided by site visitors. For example, you can check that the e-mail address provided by
a user contains the @ symbol, or that a required text field contains a certain type of value.
Enable the ColdFusion enhancements
Some of these enhancements require that you define a computer running ColdFusion MX 7 or later as a testing
server for Dreamweaver. For example, the Property inspectors for form controls are available only if you specify the
correct testing server.
You define a testing server only once. Dreamweaver then automatically detects the testing server version and makes
the enhancements available if it detects ColdFusion.
1 If you haven’t already done so, define a Dreamweaver site for your ColdFusion project.
2 Select Site > Manage Sites, select your site from the list, and click Edit.
3 Select the Servers category and specify a computer running ColdFusion MX 7 or later as the testing server for your
Dreamweaver site. Ensure that you specify a valid Web URL.
4 Open any ColdFusion document.
You won’t see any visible changes to the Dreamweaver work space until you open a ColdFusion document.
Create ColdFusion forms
You can use a number of Insert panel buttons, menu items, and Property inspectors to rapidly create ColdFusion forms
and set their properties in Dreamweaver.
Note: These enhancements are available only if you have access to a computer running ColdFusion MX 7 or later.
1Open a ColdFusion page and place the insertion point where you want the ColdFusion form to appear.
2Select Insert > ColdFusion Objects > CFForm > CFForm, or select the CFForm category from the Insert panel and
click the CF Form icon.
Dreamweaver inserts an empty ColdFusion form. In Design view, the form is indicated by a dotted red outline. If
you dont see this outline, make sure that View > Visual Aids > Invisible Elements is selected.
609
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
3Ensure that the form is still selected, and then use the Property inspector to set any of the following form properties.
CFForm Sets the name of the form.
Action Lets you specify the name of the ColdFusion page to be processed when the form is submitted.
Method Lets you define the method that the browser uses to send the form data to the server:
POSTSends the data using the HTTP post method; this method sends the data in a separate message to the server.
GETSends the data using the HTTP get method, placing the form field contents in the URL query string.
Target Lets you to modify the value of the target attribute of the cfform tag.
Encoding Type Specifies the encoding method used for transmitting the form data.
Note: Encoding type does not refer to character encoding. This attribute specifies the content type used to submit the
form to the server (when the value of method is post). The default value for this attribute is application/x-www-form-
urlencoded.
Format Determines what kind of form is created:
HTMLGenerates an HTML form and sends it to the client. The cfgrid and cftree child controls can be in Flash or
applet format.
FlashGenerates a Flash form and sends it to the client. All controls are in Flash format.
XMLGenerates XForms XML and puts the results in a variable with the ColdFusion form name. Does not send
anything to the client. The cfgrid and cftree child controls can be in Flash or applet format.
Style Lets you specify a style for the form. For more information, see the ColdFusion documentation.
Flash/XML Skin Lets you specify a halo color to stylize the output. The theme determines the color used for
highlighted and selected elements.
Preserve Data Determines whether to override the initial control values with submitted values when the form posts
to itself.
If False, values specified in the control tag attributes are used.
If True, submitted values are used.
Scripts src Specifies the URL, relative to the web root, of the JavaScript file that contains client-side code used by
the tag and its child tags. This attribute is useful if the file is not in the default location. This attribute may be required
in some hosting environments and configurations that block access to the /CFIDE directory. The default location is
set in the ColdFusion Administrator; by default, it is /CFIDE/scripts/cfform.js.
Archive Specifies the URL of downloadable Java classes for cfgrid, cfslider, and cftree applet controls. The default
location is /CFIDE/classes/cfapplets.jar.
Height Specifies the height of the form.
Width Specifies the width of the form.
Display Tag Editor for cfform Lets you edit properties not listed in the Property inspector.
4Insert ColdFusion form controls.
Place the insertion point where you want the ColdFusion form control to appear in the ColdFusion form, and then
select the control from the Insert menu (Insert > ColdFusion Objects > CFForm), or from the CFForm category in
the Insert panel.
5If required, set the properties of the control with the Property inspector.
610
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Make sure the control is selected in Design view and then set the properties in the Property inspector. For more
information on the properties, click the Help icon in the Property inspector.
6Adjust the layout of the ColdFusion form.
If youre creating an HTML-based form, you can use line breaks, paragraph breaks, preformatted text, or tables to
format your forms. You cannot insert a ColdFusion form in another ColdFusion form (that is, you cannot overlap
tags), but you can include more than one ColdFusion form in a page.
If youre creating a Flash-based form, use Cascading Style Sheets (CSS) styles to lay out your form. ColdFusion
ignores any HTML in the form.
Remember to label the ColdFusion form fields with descriptive text to let users know what they are responding to.
For example, create a “Type your name label” to request name information.
Insert ColdFusion form controls
Use the Insert panel or Insert menu to quickly insert ColdFusion form controls into a ColdFusion form. You need to
create a blank ColdFusion form before inserting controls in it.
Note: These enhancements are only available if you have access to a computer running ColdFusion MX 7 or later.
1In Design view, place the insertion point inside the form outline.
2Select the control from the Insert menu (Insert > ColdFusion Objects > CFForm), or from the CFForm category in
the Insert panel.
3Click the control on the page to select it and then set its properties in the Property inspector.
For information on the properties of specific controls, see the topics about the controls.
Insert ColdFusion text fields
You can visually insert a ColdFusion text field or password field into your form, and then set its options.
Note: This enhancement is available only if you have access to a computer running ColdFusion MX 7 or later.
Visually insert a ColdFusion text field
1In Design view, place the insertion point inside the form outline.
2In the CFForm category of the Insert panel, click the CF Text Field icon or select Insert > ColdFusion Objects >
CFForm > CFtextfield.
A text field appears in the form.
3Select the text field and set its properties in the Property inspector.
4To label the text field on the page, click beside it and enter text for the label.
Visually insert a password field
1Repeat steps 1 and 2 in the previous procedure for inserting a text field.
2Select the inserted text field to display its Property inspector.
3Select the Password value from the Text Mode pop-up menu in the Property inspector.
611
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
CFTextField options (ColdFusion)
To set the options of a ColdFusion text or password field, set any of the following options in the CFTextField Property
inspector:
CFtextfield Sets the id attribute of the <cfinput> tag.
Value Lets you specify text to be displayed in the field when the page first opens in a browser. The information can
either be static or dynamic.
To specify a dynamic value, click the lightning bolt icon beside the Value box and select a recordset column in the
Dynamic Data dialog box. The recordset column supplies a value to the text field when you view the form in a browser.
Text Mode Lets you switch between the standard text input field and the password input field. The attribute modified
by this control is type.
Read Only Lets you make the displayed text read-only.
Max Length Sets the maximum number of characters accepted by the text field.
Mask Lets you specify a mask for your requested text. You use this property to validate the user input. The mask format
is composed of A, 9, X and ? characters.
Note: The mask attribute is ignored for the cfinput type="password" tag.
Validate Specifies the type of validation for the current field.
Validate At Specifies when the field is validated: onSubmit, onBlur or onServer.
Label Lets you specify a label for the text field.
Pattern Lets you specify a JavaScript regular expression pattern to validate input. Omit leading and trailing slashes. For
more information, see the ColdFusion documentation.
Height Lets you specify the height of the control, in pixels.
Width Lets you specify the width of the control, in pixels.
Size Lets you specify the size of the control.
Required Lets you specify whether the text field must contain data before the form is submitted to the server.
Display Tag Editor Lets you edit properties not listed in the Property inspector.
Insert ColdFusion hidden fields
You can visually insert a ColdFusion hidden field into your form and set its properties. Use hidden fields to store and
submit information that the user does not enter. The information is hidden from the user.
Note: This enhancement is available only if you have access to a computer running ColdFusion MX 7 or later.
1In Design view, place the insertion point inside the form outline.
2In the CFForm category of the Insert panel, click the CF Hidden Field icon.
A marker appears in the ColdFusion form. If you dont see the marker, select View > Visual Aids > Invisible
Elements.
3Select the hidden field on the page and set any of the following options in the Property inspector:
Cfhiddenfield Lets you specify the unique name for the hidden field.
Value Lets you specify a value for the hidden field. The data can either be static or dynamic.
612
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
To specify a dynamic value, click the lightning bolt icon beside the Value box and select a recordset column in the
Dynamic Data dialog box. The recordset column supplies a value to the text field when you view the form in a
browser.
Validate Specifies the type of validation for the current field.
Validate At Specifies when the field is validated: onSubmit, onBlur or onServer.
Label Lets you specify a label for the control. This property is ignored by the ColdFusion server at run time.
Pattern Lets you specify a JavaScript regular expression pattern to validate input. Omit leading and trailing slashes.
For more information, see the ColdFusion documentation.
Height Lets you specify the height of the control, in pixels. This property is ignored by the ColdFusion server at run
time.
Width Lets you specify the width of the control, in pixels. This property is ignored by the ColdFusion server at run
time.
Size Lets you specify the size of the control. This property is ignored by the ColdFusion server at run time.
Required Lets you specify whether the hidden field must contain data before the form is submitted to the server.
Display Tag Editor Lets you edit properties not listed in the Property inspector.
Insert ColdFusion text areas
You can visually insert a ColdFusion text area into your form and set its properties. A text area is an input element that
consists of multiple lines of text.
Note: This enhancement is available only if you have access to a computer running ColdFusion MX 7 or later.
1Place the insertion point inside the form outline.
2In the CFForm category of the Insert panel, click the CF Text Area icon.
A text area appears in the ColdFusion form.
3Select the text area on the page and set any of the following options in the Property inspector:
Cftextarea Lets you specify a unique name for the control.
Char Width Lets you set the number of characters per line.
Num Lines Lets you set the number of rows to display in the text area.
Wrap Lets you specify how you want the text entered by users to wrap.
Required Lets you specify whether the user must enter data in the field (checked) or not (unchecked).
Initial Value Lets you specify text to display in the text area when the page is initially opened in a browser.
Validate Specifies the type of validation for the field.
Validate At Specifies when the field is validated: onSubmit, onBlur, or onServer.
Label Lets you specify a label for the control.
Style Lets you specify a style for the control. For more information, see the ColdFusion documentation.
Height Lets you specify the height of the control, in pixels. This property is ignored by the ColdFusion server at run
time.
Width Lets you specify the width of the control, in pixels. This property is ignored by the ColdFusion server at run
time.
613
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Display Tag Editor Lets you edit properties not listed in the Property inspector.
4To label the text area, click beside it and enter text for the label.
Insert ColdFusion buttons
You can visually insert a ColdFusion button into your form and set its properties. ColdFusion buttons control
ColdFusion form operations. Buttons can be used to submit ColdFusion form data to the server or to reset the
ColdFusion form. Standard ColdFusion buttons are typically labeled Submit, Reset, or Send. You can also assign other
processing tasks that you defined in a script. For example, the button might calculate the total cost of selected items
based on assigned values.
Note: This enhancement is available only if you have access to a computer running ColdFusion MX 7 or later.
1Place the insertion point inside the ColdFusion form outline.
2In the CFForm category of the Insert panel, click the CF Button icon.
A button appears in the ColdFusion form.
3Select the button on the page and set any of the following options in the Property inspector:
Cfbutton Lets you specify a unique name for the control.
Action Lets you specify the type of button to create.
Display Tag Editor Lets you edit properties not listed in the Property inspector.
The other properties are ignored by the ColdFusion server at run time.
Insert ColdFusion check boxes
You can visually insert a ColdFusion check box into your form and set its properties. Use check boxes to let users select
more than one option from a set of options.
Note: This enhancement is available only if you have access to a computer running ColdFusion MX 7 or later.
1Place the insertion point inside the form outline.
2In the CFForm category of the Insert panel, click the CF Checkbox icon.
A check box appears in the ColdFusion form.
3Select the check box on the page and set any of the following options in the Property inspector:
Cfcheckbox Lets you specify a unique name for the control.
Checked Value Lets you specify a value to be returned by the check box if the user checks it.
Initial State Lets you specify whether the check box is checked when the page first opens in a browser.
Validate Specifies the type of validation for the check box.
Validate At Specifies when the check box is validated: onSubmit, onBlur, or onServer.
Label Lets you specify a label for the check box.
Pattern Lets you specify a JavaScript regular expression pattern to validate input. Omit leading and trailing slashes.
For more information, see the ColdFusion documentation.
Height Lets you specify the height of the control, in pixels. This property is ignored by the ColdFusion server at run
time.
614
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Width Lets you specify the width of the control, in pixels. This property is ignored by the ColdFusion server at run
time.
Size Lets you specify the size of the control. This property is ignored by the ColdFusion server at run time.
Required Lets you specify whether the checkbox must be checked before the form is submitted to the server.
Display Tag Editor Lets you edit properties not listed in the Property inspector.
4To label the check box, click next to the check box on the page and enter text for the label.
Insert ColdFusion radio buttons
You can visually insert a ColdFusion radio button into your form and set its properties. Use radio buttons when you
want users to select only one choice from a set of options. Radio buttons are typically used in groups. All radio buttons
in a group must have the same name.
Note: This enhancement is available only if you have access to a computer running ColdFusion MX 7 or later.
1Place the insertion point inside the form outline.
2Select Insert > ColdFusion Objects > CFForm > CFradiobutton.
A radio button appears in the ColdFusion form.
3Select the radio button on the page and set any of the following options in the Property inspector:
Cfradiobutton Lets you specify a unique name for the control.
Checked Value Lets you specify a value to be returned by the radio button if the user checks it.
Initial State Lets you specify whether the radio button is checked when the page first opens in a browser.
Validate Specifies the type of validation for the radio button.
Validate At Specifies when the radio button is validated: onSubmit, onBlur, or onServer.
Label Lets you specify a label for the radio button.
Pattern Lets you specify a JavaScript regular expression pattern to validate input. Omit leading and trailing slashes.
For more information, see the ColdFusion documentation.
Height Lets you specify the height of the control, in pixels. This property is ignored by the ColdFusion server at run
time.
Width Lets you specify the width of the control, in pixels. This property is ignored by the ColdFusion server at run
time.
Size Lets you specify the size of the control. This property is ignored by the ColdFusion server at run time.
Required Lets you specify whether the radio button must be checked before the form is submitted to the server.
Display Tag Editor Lets you edit properties not listed in the Property inspector.
4To label the radio button, click beside it on the page and enter text for the label.
Insert ColdFusion select boxes
You can visually insert a ColdFusion select box into your form and set its properties. A select box lets a visitor select
one or more items from a list. Select boxes are useful when you have a limited amount of space, but need to display
many items. They’re also useful when you want to control the values returned to the server. Unlike text fields, where
users can type anything they want, including invalid data, with select boxes, you can set the exact values returned by a
menu.
615
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
You can insert two types of select boxes into a form: a menu that “drops down” when the user clicks it, or a menu that
displays a scrollable list of items that the user can select.
Note: This enhancement is available only if you have access to a computer running ColdFusion MX 7 or later.
1Place the insertion point inside the form outline.
2In the CFForm category of the Insert panel, click the CF Select icon.
A select box appears in the ColdFusion form.
3Select the select box on the page and set any of the following options in the Property inspector:
Cfselect Lets you specify a unique name for the control.
Type Lets you choose between a pop-up menu or a list. If you select the list type, the List Height and Allow Multiple
List Selections options become available.
List Height Lets you specify the number of lines to display in the list menu. Available only if you select the list type.
Allow Multiple List Selections Lets you specify whether the user can select more than one option from the list at a
time. Available only if you select the list type.
Edit Values Opens a dialog box that lets you add, edit, or remove options from the select box.
Initially Selected Lets you specify which option is selected by default. You can select more than one option if you
selected the Allow Multiple List Selections option.
Recordset Lets you specify the name of the ColdFusion query you want to use to populate the list or menu.
Display Column Lets you specify the recordset column to supply the display label of each list element. Used with
Recordset property.
Value Column Lets you specify the recordset column to supply the value of each list element. Used with the
Recordset property.
Flash Label Lets you specify a label for the select box.
Flash Height Lets you specify the height of the control, in pixels. This property is ignored by the ColdFusion server
at run time.
Flash Width Lets you specify the width of the control, in pixels. This property is ignored by the ColdFusion server
at run time.
Message Specifies the message to be displayed if the Required property is set to Yes and the user failed to make a
selection before submitting the form.
Required Lets you specify whether a menu item must be selected before the form is submitted to the server.
Display Tag Editor Lets you edit properties not listed in the Property inspector.
Insert ColdFusion image fields
You can visually insert a ColdFusion image field into your form and set its options. Use image fields to make custom
buttons.
Note: This enhancement is available only if you have access to a computer running ColdFusion MX 7 or later.
1In Design view, place the insertion point inside the form outline.
2In the CFForm category of the Insert panel, click the CF Image Field icon. Browse to select the image to insert, and
click OK. Alternatively, you can enter the path of the image file in the Src box.
616
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: If the image is outside the site root folder, you should copy the image to the root folder. Images outside the root
folder might not be accessible when you publish the site.
3Select the image field on the page and set any of the following options in the Property inspector:
Cfimagefield Lets you specify a unique name for the control.
Src Lets you specify the URL of the inserted image.
Alt Lets you specify a message when the image cannot be displayed.
Align Lets you specify the alignment of the picture.
Border Lets you set the width of the image border.
Edit Image Opens the image in your default image editor.
To define a default image editor, select Edit > Preferences > File Types / Editors. Otherwise, the Edit Image button
does not perform any action.
Validate Specifies the type of validation for the image field.
Validate At Specifies when the field is validated: onSubmit, onBlur, or onServer.
Label Lets you specify a label for the radio button.
Pattern Lets you specify a JavaScript regular expression pattern to validate input. Omit leading and trailing slashes.
For more information, see the ColdFusion documentation.
Height Lets you specify the height of the control, in pixels.
Width Lets you specify the width of the control, in pixels.
Size Lets you specify the size of the control. This property is ignored by the ColdFusion server at run time.
Required Lets you specify whether the control must contain data before the form is submitted to the server.
Display Tag Editor Lets you edit properties not listed in the Property inspector.
Insert ColdFusion file fields
You can visually insert a ColdFusion file field into your form and set its properties. Use a file field to let users select a
file from their computer, such as a word processing document or a graphics file, and upload it to the server. A
ColdFusion file field looks like other text fields, except it also has a Browse button. Users can manually enter the path
to the file they want to upload, or use the Browse button to locate and select the file.
File fields require that you use the POST method to transmit files from the browser to the server. The file is posted to
the address that you specify in the forms Action box. Contact your server administrator to confirm that anonymous
file uploads are allowed before using a file field in your form.
File fields also require that the form encoding be set to multipart/form. Dreamweaver sets this automatically when you
insert a file field control.
Note: This enhancement is available only if you have access to a computer running ColdFusion MX 7 or later.
1In Design view, select the CFForm to display its Property inspector.
To quickly select the form, click anywhere in the form outline and click the <cfform> tag in the tag selector at the
bottom of the Document window.
2In the Property inspector, set the form method to POST.
3From the Enctype pop-up menu, select multipart/form-data.
617
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
4Position the insertion point inside the form outline where you want to file field to appear.
5Select Insert > ColdFusion Objects > CFForm > CFfilefield.
A file field appears in the document.
6Select the file field on the page and set any of the following properties in the Property inspector:
Cffilefield Lets you specify a unique name for the control.
Max Length Lets you specify the maximum number of characters that the path to the file can have.
Validate Specifies the type of validation for the field.
Validate At Specifies when the field is validated: onSubmit, onBlur, or onServer.
Label Lets you specify a label for the field.
Pattern Lets you specify a JavaScript regular expression pattern to validate input. Omit leading and trailing slashes.
For more information, see the ColdFusion documentation.
Height Lets you specify the height of the control, in pixels. This property is ignored by the ColdFusion server at run
time.
Width Lets you specify the width of the control, in pixels. This property is ignored by the ColdFusion server at run
time.
Size Lets you specify the size of the control.
Required Lets you specify whether the file field must contain data before the form is submitted to the server.
Display Tag Editor Lets you edit properties not listed in the Property inspector.
Insert ColdFusion date fields
Although you cant visually insert a ColdFusion date field in Dreamweaver, you can visually set its properties. A
ColdFusion date field is a special type of text field that lets users select a date from a pop-up calendar to insert it in the
text field.
Note: This enhancement is available only if you have access to a computer running ColdFusion MX 7 or later.
1In Design view, select the CFForm to display its Property inspector.
To quickly select the form, click anywhere in the form outline and click the <cfform> tag in the tag selector at the
bottom of the Document window.
2In the Property inspector, set the forms Format property to Flash.
The date field control can only be rendered in Flash-based ColdFusion forms.
3Switch to Code view (View > Code) and enter the following tag anywhere between the opening and closing CFForm
tags:
<cfinput name="datefield" type="datefield">
4Switch to Design view, select the date field on the page, and then set any of the following options in the Property
inspector:
Cfdatefield Lets you specify a unique name for the control.
Value Lets you specify a date to be displayed in the field when the page first opens in a browser. The date can either
be static or dynamic.
618
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
To specify a dynamic value, click the lightning bolt icon beside the Value box and select a recordset column in the
Dynamic Data dialog box. The recordset column supplies a value to the date field when you view the form in a
browser.
Validate Specifies the type of validation for the field.
Validate At Specifies when the field is validated: onSubmit, onBlur, or onServer.
Label Lets you specify a label for the field.
Pattern Lets you specify a JavaScript regular expression pattern to validate input. Omit leading and trailing slashes.
For more information, see the ColdFusion documentation.
Height Lets you specify the height of the control, in pixels.
Width Lets you specify the width of the control, in pixels.
Size Lets you specify the size of the control.
Required Lets you specify whether the date field must contain a value before the form is submitted to the server.
Display Tag Editor Lets you edit properties not listed in the Property inspector.
Modify ColdFusion form controls
You can visually change the properties of ColdFusion form controls whether youre working in Design view or Code
view.
Note: This enhancement is available only if you have access to a computer running ColdFusion MX 7 or later.
1In Design view, select the form control on the page; in Code view, click anywhere inside the controls tag.
The Property inspector displays properties of the form control.
2Change the controls properties in the Property inspector.
For more information, click the Help icon in the Property inspector.
3To set more properties, click the Display Tag Editor button in the Property inspector and set the properties in the
Tag editor that appears.
Validate ColdFusion form data
You can build ColdFusion forms in Dreamweaver that check the contents of specified fields to ensure the user entered
the correct data type.
Note: This enhancement is available only if you have access to a computer running ColdFusion MX 7 or later.
1Create a ColdFusion form that includes at least one input field and one Submit button. Ensure that every ColdFusion
field that you want to validate has a unique name.
2Select a field in the form that you want to validate.
3In the Property inspector, specify how you want to validate the field.
The lower part of each input Property inspector contains controls to help you define the specific validation rule. For
example, you might want to specify that a text field should contain a telephone number. To do this, select Telephone
from the Value pop-up menu in the Property inspector. You can also specify when to validate from the Validate At
pop-up menu.
619
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
More Help topics
Securing a folder in your application (ColdFusion)
Working with Dreamweaver sites
Set up a testing server
Create an HTML form
Creating web forms
Note: Support for HTML form elements has been enhanced in Dreamweaver Creative Cloud updates. For information, see
Enhanced HTML5 support for form elements.
About web forms
When a visitor enters information into a web form displayed in a web browser and clicks the submit button, the
information is sent to a server where a server-side script or application processes it. The server responds by sending the
processed information back to the user (or client), or by performing some other action based on the forms contents.
You can create forms that submit data to most application servers, including PHP, ASP, and ColdFusion. If you use
ColdFusion, you can also add ColdFusion-specific form controls to your forms.
Note: You can also send form data directly to an e-mail recipient.
Form objects
In Dreamweaver, form input types are called form objects. Form objects are the mechanisms that allow users to input
data. You can add the following form objects to a form:
Text fields Accept any type of alphanumeric text entry. The text can be displayed as a single line, multiple lines, and as
a password field where entered text is replaced by asterisks or bullets to hide the text from onlookers.
620
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: Passwords and other information sent to a server using a password field are not encrypted. The transferred data can
be intercepted and read as alphanumeric text. For this reason, you should always provide encryption for data you want to
keep secure.
Hidden fields Store information entered by a user, such as a name, e-mail address, or viewing preference, and then use
that data when the user next visits the site.
Buttons Perform actions when clicked. You can add a custom name or label for a button, or use one of the predefined
“Submit or “Reset” labels. Use a button to submit form data to the server or to reset the form. You can also assign other
processing tasks that you define in a script. For example, the button might calculate the total cost of items selected based
on assigned values.
Check boxes Allow multiple responses within a single group of options. A user can select as many options as apply. The
following example shows three check box items selected: Surfing, Mountain Biking, and Rafting.
Radio buttons Represent exclusive choices. Selecting a button within a radio button group deselects all others in the
group (a group consists of two or more buttons that share the same name). In the example below, Rafting is the currently
selected option. If the user clicks Surfing, the Rafting button is automatically cleared.
List menus Display option values within a scrolling list that allows users to select multiple options. The List option
displays the option values in a menu that allows users to select only a single item. Use menus when you have a limited
amount of space, but must display many items, or to control the values returned to the server. Unlike text fields where
users can type anything they want, including invalid data, you set the exact values returned by a menu.
Note: A pop-up menu on an HTML form is not the same as a graphical pop-up menu. For information on creating, editing,
and showing and hiding a graphical pop-up menu, see the link at the end of this section.
Jump menus Navigational lists or pop-up menus that let you insert a menu in which each option links to a document
or file.
File fields Let users browse to a file on their computer and upload the file as form data.
621
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Image fields Let you insert an image in a form. Use image fields to make graphical buttons such as Submit or Reset
buttons. Using an image to perform tasks other than submitting data requires attaching a behavior to the form object.
Create an HTML form
(Creative Cloud users only): As part of HTML5 support, new attributes have been introduced in the Properties panel
for form elements. In addition, four new form elements (E-mail, search, telephone, URL) have been introduced in the
Forms section of the Insert panel. For more information, see Enhanced HTML5 support for form elements.
1Open a page and place the insertion point where you want the form to appear.
2Select Insert > Form, or select the Forms category in the Insert panel and click the Form icon.
In Design view, forms are indicated by a dotted red outline. If you don’t see this outline, select View > Visual Aids >
Invisible Elements.
3Set the properties of the HTML form in the Property inspector (Window >Properties):
a.In the Document window, click the form outline to select the form.
b.In the Form Name box, type a unique name to identify the form.
Naming a form makes it possible to reference or control the form with a scripting language, such as JavaScript or
VBScript. If you do not name the form, Dreamweaver generates a name using the syntax formn, and increments the
value of n for each form added to the page.
c.In the Action box, specify the page or script that will process the form data by typing the path, or clicking the folder
icon to navigate to the appropriate page or script. Example: processorder.php.
d.In the Method pop-up menu, specify the method to transmit the form data to the server.
Set any of the following options:
Default Uses the browser’s default setting to send the form data to the server. Typically, the default value is the GET
method.
GET Appends the value to the URL requesting the page.
POST Embeds the form data in the HTTP request.
Do not use the GET method to send long forms. URLs are limited to 8192 characters. If the amount of data sent is
too large, data will be truncated, leading to unexpected or failed processing results.
Dynamic pages generated by parameters passed by the GET method can be bookmarked because all the values
needed to regenerate the page are contained in the URL displayed in the browser’s Address box. In contrast, dynamic
pages generated by parameters passed by the POST method cannot be bookmarked.
If you collect confidential user names and passwords, credit card numbers, or other confidential information, the
POST method may appear more secure than the GET method. However, the information sent by the POST method
is not encrypted and can easily be retrieved by a hacker. To ensure security, use a secure connection to a secure
server.
e.(Optional) In the Enctype pop-up menu, specify the MIME encoding type of the data submitted to the server for
processing.
The default setting of application/x-www-form-urlencode is typically used in conjunction with the POST method.
If you are creating a file-upload field, specify the multipart/form-data MIME type.
622
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
f.(Optional) In the Target pop-up menu, specify the window in which to display the data returned by the invoked
program.
If the named window is not already open, a new window with that name opens. Set any of the following target values:
_blank Opens the destination document in a new unnamed window.
_parent Opens the destination document in the parent window of the one displaying the current document.
_self Opens the destination document in the same window as the one in which the form was submitted.
_top Opens the destination document in the body of the current window. This value can be used to ensure that the
destination document takes over the full window even if the original document was displayed in a frame.
4Insert form objects in the page:
a.Place the insertion point where the form object should appear in the form.
b.the object in the Insert > Form menu, or in the Forms category of the Insert panel.
c.Complete the Input Tag Accessibility Attributes dialog box. For more information, click the Help button in the
dialog box.
Note: If you don’t see the Input Tag Accessibility Attributes dialog box, you might have had the Insertion point in Code
view when you tried to insert the form object. Make sure the Insertion point is in Design view and try again. For more
information on this topic, see David Powerss article Creating HTML forms in Dreamweaver.
d.Set the properties of the objects.
e.Enter a name for the object in the Property inspector.
Every text field, hidden field, check box, and list/menu object must have a unique name that identifies the object in
the form. Form object names cannot contain spaces or special characters. You can use any combination of
alphanumeric characters and an underscore (_). The label you assign to the object is the variable name that stores
the value (the entered data) of the field. This is the value sent to the server for processing.
Note: All radio buttons in a group must have the same name.
f.To label the text field, check box, or radio button object on the page, click beside the object and type the label.
5Adjust the layout of the form.
Use line breaks, paragraph breaks, preformatted text, or tables to format your forms. You cannot insert a form in
another form (that is, you cannot overlap tags), but you can include more than one form in a page.
When designing forms, remember to label the form fields with descriptive text to let users know what they’re
responding to—for example, “Type your name” to request name information.
Use tables to provide structure for form objects and field labels. When using tables in forms make sure all the table
tags are included between the form tags.
For a tutorial on creating forms, see www.adobe.com/go/vid0160.
For a tutorial on styling forms with CSS, see www.adobe.com/go/vid0161.
Text Field object properties
Select the text field object, and set any of the following options in the Property inspector:
Char Width Specifies the maximum number of characters that can be displayed in the field. This number can be less
than Max Chars, which specifies the maximum number of characters that can be entered in the field. For example, if
623
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
the Char Width is set to 20 (the default value) and a user enters 100 characters, only 20 of those characters will be
viewable in the text field. Although you cannot view the characters in the field, they are recognized by the field object
and are sent to the server for processing.
Max Chars Specifies the maximum number of characters that the user can enter in the field for single-line text fields.
Use Max Chars to limit zip codes to 5 digits, limit passwords to 10 characters, and so on. If you leave the Max Chars
box blank, users can enter any amount of text. If the text exceeds the character width of the field the text will scroll. If
a user exceeds the maximum number of characters, the form produces an alert sound.
Num Lines (Available when the Multiline option is selected) Sets the height of the field for multiple-line text fields.
Disabled Disables the text area.
Read-only Makes the text area a read-only text area.
Type Designates the field as a single-line, multiple-line, or password field.
Single-line Results in an input tag with its type attribute set to text. The Char Width setting maps to the size attribute,
and the Max Chars setting maps to the maxlength attribute.
Multi-line Results in a textarea tag. The Char Width setting maps to the cols attribute, and the Num Lines setting maps
to the rows attribute.
Password Results in an input tag with its type attribute set to password. The Char Width and Max Chars settings map
to the same attributes as in single-line text fields. When a user types in a password text field, the input appears as bullets
or asterisks to protect it from observation by others.
Init val Assigns the value displayed in the field when the form first loads. For example, you might indicate that the user
enters information in the field by including a note or example value.
Class Lets you apply CSS rules to the object.
Button object options
Button Name Assigns a name to the button. Two reserved names, Submit and Reset, tell the form to submit the form
data to the processing application or script, or to reset all the form fields to their original values, respectively.
Value Determines the text that appears on the button.
Action Determines what happens when the button is clicked.
Submit Form Submits the form data for processing when the user clicks the button. The data is submitted to the page
or script specified in the forms Action property.
Reset Form Clears the contents of the form when the button is clicked.
None Specifies the action to be performed when the button is clicked. For example, you can add a JavaScript behavior
that opens another page when the user clicks the button.
Class Applies CSS rules to the object.
Check Box object options
Checked Value Sets the value to be sent to the server when the check box is checked. For example, in a survey you might
set a value of 4 for strongly agree and a value of 1 for strongly disagree.
Initial State Determines whether the check box is selected when the form loads in the browser.
Dynamic Lets the server dynamically determine the initial state of the check box. For example, you can use check boxes
to visually present the Yes/No information stored in a database record. At design time, you dont know that information.
At run time the server reads the database record and selects the check box if the value is Yes.
624
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Class Applies Cascading Style Sheets (CSS) rules to the object.
Single radio button object options
Checked Value Sets the value to be sent to the server when the radio button is selected. For example, you might type
skiing in the Checked Value box to indicate a user chose skiing.
Initial State Determines whether the radio button is selected when the form loads in the browser.
Dynamic Lets the server dynamically determine the initial state of the radio button. For example, you can use radio
buttons to visually present information stored in a database record. At design time, you dont know that information.
At run time the server reads the database record and checks the radio button if the value matches one you specified.
Class Applies CSS rules to the object.
Menu options
List/Menu Assigns a name to the menu. The name must be unique.
Type Indicates whether the menu drops down when clicked (the Menu option) or displays a scrollable list of items (the
List option). Select the Menu option if you want only one option to be visible when the form is displayed in a browser.
To display the other choices, the user must click the down arrow.
Select the List option to list some or all the options when the form is displayed in a browser, to let users select multiple
items.
Height (List type only) Sets the number of items displayed in the menu.
Selections (List type only) Indicates whether the user can select multiple items from the list.
List Values Opens a dialog box that lets you add the items to a form menu:
1Use the Plus (+) and Minus (–) buttons to add and remove items in the list.
2Enter label text and an optional value for each menu item.
Each item in the list has a label (the text that appears in the list) and a value (the value that is sent to the processing
application if the item is selected). If no value is specified, the label is sent to the processing application instead.
3Use the up and down arrow buttons to rearrange items in the list.
Items appear in the menu in the same order as they appear in the List Values dialog box. The first item on the list is
the selected item when the page is loaded in a browser.
Dynamic Lets the server dynamically select an item in the menu when it is first displayed.
Class Lets you apply CSS rules to the object.
Initially Selected Sets the items selected in the list by default. Click the item or items in the list.
Insert file-upload fields
You can create a file-upload field that lets users select a file on their computer—such as a word processing document
or graphics file—and upload the file to the server. A file field looks like other text fields except it also contains a Browse
button. The user either manually enters the path to the file they want to upload, or uses the Browse button to locate and
select the file.
Before you can use file-upload fields, you must have a server-side script or a page capable of handling file submissions.
Consult the documentation of the server technology you use to process form data. For example, if you use PHP, see
“Handling files uploads” in the online PHP Manual at http://us2.php.net/features.file-upload.php.
625
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
File fields require that you use the POST method to transmit files from the browser to the server. The file is posted to
the address you specify in the forms Action box.
Note: Contact your server’s administrator to confirm that anonymous file uploads are allowed before using the file field.
1Insert a form in the page (Insert > Form).
2Select the form to display its Property inspector.
3Set the form Method to POST.
4From the Enctype pop-up menu, select multipart/form-data.
5In the Action box, specify the server-side script or page capable of handling the uploaded file.
6Place the insertion point inside the form outline, and select Insert > Form > File Field.
7Set any of the following options in the Property inspector:
File Field Name Specifies the name for the file field object.
Char Width Specifies the maximum number of characters that can be displayed in the field.
Max Chars Specifies the maximum number of characters the field will hold. If the user browses to locate the file, the
filename and path can exceed the specified Max Chars value. However, if the user attempts to type in the filename
and path, the file field will only allow the number of characters specified by the Max Chars value.
Insert an image button
You can use images as button icons. Using an image to perform tasks other than submitting data requires attaching a
behavior to the form object.
1In the document, place the insertion point inside the form outline.
2Select Insert > Form > Image Field.
The Select Image Source dialog box appears.
3Select the image for the button in the Select Image Source dialog box, and click OK.
4Set any of the following options in the Property inspector:
ImageField Assigns a name to the button. Two reserved names, Submit and Reset, tell the form to submit the form
data to the processing application or script, or to reset all the form fields to their original values, respectively.
Src Specifies the image you want to use for the button.
Alt Lets you enter descriptive text in case the image fails to load in the browser.
Align Sets the align attribute of the object.
Edit Image Starts your default image editor and opens the image file for editing.
Class Lets you apply CSS rules to the object.
5To attach a JavaScript behavior to the button, select the image, and then select the behavior in the Behaviors panel
(Window > Behaviors).
Hidden field object options
HiddenField Specifies the name for the field.
Value Assigns a value to the field. This value is passed to the server when the form is submitted.
626
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Insert a group of radio buttons
1Place the insertion point inside the form outline.
2Select Insert > Form > Radio Group.
3Complete the dialog box and click OK.
a.In the Name box, enter a name for the radio button group.
If you set the radio buttons to pass parameters back to the server, the parameters are associated with the name. For
example, if you name the group myGroup and set the form method to GET (that is, you want the form to pass URL
parameters instead of form parameters when the user clicks the submit button), the expression
myGroup="CheckedValue" is passed in the URL to the server.
b.Click the Plus (+) button to add a radio button to the group. Enter a label and checked value for the new button.
c.Click the up or down arrows to reorder the buttons.
d.To set a particular radio button to be selected when the page opens in a browser, enter a value equal to the radio
buttons value in the Select Value Equal To box.
Enter a static value or specify a dynamic one by clicking the lightning bolt icon beside the box and selecting a
recordset that contains possible checked values. In either case, the value you specify should match the checked value
of one of the radio buttons in the group. To view the checked values of the radio buttons, select each radio button
and open its Property inspector (Window > Properties).
e. Select the format in which you want Dreamweaver to lay out the buttons. Lay out the buttons using line breaks or
a table. If you select the table option, Dreamweaver creates a single-column table, and places the radio buttons on
the left and the labels on the right.
You can also set the properties in the Property inspector or directly in Code view.
Insert a group of check boxes
1Place the insertion point inside the form outline.
2Select Insert > Form > Checkbox Group.
3Complete the dialog box and click OK.
a.In the Name box, enter a name for the check box group.
If you set the check boxes to pass parameters back to the server, the parameters are associated with the name. For
example, if you name the group myGroup and set the form method to GET (that is, you want the form to pass URL
parameters instead of form parameters when the user clicks the submit button), the expression
myGroup="CheckedValue" is passed in the URL to the server.
b.Click the Plus (+) button to add a check box to the group. Enter a label and checked value for the new check box.
c.Click the up or down arrows to reorder the check boxes.
d.To set a particular check box to be selected when the page opens in a browser, enter a value equal to the check box’s
value in the Select Value Equal To box.
Enter a static value or specify a dynamic one by clicking the lightning bolt icon beside the box and selecting a
recordset that contains possible checked values. In either case, the value you specify should match the checked value
of one of the check boxes in the group. To view the checked values of the check boxes, select each check boxand open
its Property inspector (Window > Properties).
e.Select the format in which you want Dreamweaver to lay out the check boxes.
627
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Lay out the check boxes using line breaks or a table. If you select the table option, Dreamweaver creates a single-
column table, and places the check boxes on the left and the labels on the right.
You can also set the properties in the Property inspector or directly in Code view.
About dynamic form objects
A dynamic form object is a form object whose initial state is determined by the server when the page is requested from
the server, not by the form designer at design time. For example, when a user requests a PHP page that contains a form
with a menu, a PHP script in the page automatically populates the menu with values stored in a database. The server
then sends the completed page to the user’s browser.
Making form objects dynamic can simplify site maintenance. For example, many sites use menus to present users with
a set of options. If the menu is dynamic, you can add, remove, or change menu items in a single place—the database
table in which the items are stored—to update all instances of the same menu on the site.
Insert or change a dynamic HTML form menu
You can dynamically populate an HTML form menu or list menu with entries from a database. For most pages, you can
use an HTML menu object.
Before you begin, you must insert an HTML form in a ColdFusion, PHP, or ASP page, and you must define a recordset
or other source of dynamic content for the menu.
1Insert an HTML List/Menu form object in your page:
a.Click inside the HTML form on the page (Insert > Form > Form).
b.Select Insert > Form > List/Menu to insert the form object.
2Do one of the following:
Select the new or an existing HTML List/Menu form object, and then click the Dynamic button in the Property
inspector.
Select Insert > Data Objects > Dynamic Data > Dynamic Select List.
3Complete the Dynamic List/Menu dialog box, and click OK.
a.In the Options From Recordset pop-up menu, select the recordset to use as a content source. You also use this
menu to edit both static and dynamic list/menu items later.
b.In the Static Options area, enter a default item in the list or menu. Also, use this option to edit static entries in a
list/menu form object after adding dynamic content.
c.(Optional) Use the Plus (+) and Minus (–) buttons to add and remove items in the list. Items are in the same order
as in the Initial List Values dialog box. The first item on the list is the selected item when the page is loaded in a
browser. Use the up and down arrow buttons to rearrange items in the list.
d.In the Values pop-up menu, select the field containing the values of the menu items.
e.In the Labels pop-up menu, select the field containing the labels for the menu items.
f.(Optional) To specify that a particular menu item is selected when the page opens in a browser or when a record
is displayed in the form, enter a value equal to the menu items value, in the Select Value Equal To box.
You can enter a static value or you can specify a dynamic one by clicking the lightning bolt icon beside the box, and
selecting a dynamic value from the list of data sources. In either case, the value you specify should match one of the
menu item values.
628
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Make existing HTML form menus dynamic
1In Design view, select the list/menu form object.
2In Property inspector, click the Dynamic button.
3Complete the dialog box, and click OK.
Display dynamic content in HTML text fields
You can display dynamic content in HTML text fields when the form is viewed in a browser.
Before you begin, you must create the form in a ColdFusion, PHP, or ASP page, and you must define a recordset or
other source of dynamic content for the text field.
1Select the text field in the HTML form on your page.
2In the Property inspector, click the lightning bolt icon beside the Init Val box to display the Dynamic Data dialog
box.
3Select the recordset column that will supply a value to the text field, and then click OK.
Set the Dynamic Text Field dialog box options
1Select the text field to make dynamic from the Text Field pop-up menu.
2Click the lightning bolt icon beside the Set Value To box, select a data source from the list of data sources, and click
OK.
The data source should contain textual information. If no data sources appear in the list, or if the available data
sources dont meet your needs, click the Plus (+) button to define a new data source.
Dynamically preselect an HTML check box
You can let the server decide whether to select a check box when the form is displayed in a browser.
Before you begin, you must create the form in a ColdFusion, PHP, or ASP page, and you must define a recordset or
other source of dynamic content for the check boxes. Ideally, the source of content should contain Boolean data, such
as Yes/No or true/false.
1Select a check box form object on your page.
2In the Property inspector, click the Dynamic button.
3Complete the Dynamic CheckBox dialog box, and click OK:
Click the lightning bolt icon beside the Check If box and select the field from the list of data sources.
The data source must contain Boolean data such as Yes and No, or true and false. If no data sources appear in the
list, or if the available data sources don’t meet your needs, click the Plus (+) button to define a new data source.
In the Equal To box, enter the value the field must have for the check box to appear selected.
For example, for the check box to appear selected when a specific field in a record has a value of Yes, enter Yes in
the Equal To box.
Note: This value is also returned to the server if the user clicks the forms Submit button.
629
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Dynamically preselect an HTML radio button
Dynamically preselect an HTML radio button when a record is displayed in the HTML form in a browser.
Before you begin, you must create the form in a ColdFusion, PHP, or ASP page, and insert at least one group of HTML
radio buttons (Insert > Form > Radio Group). You must also define a recordset or other source of dynamic content for
the radio buttons. Ideally, the source of content should contain Boolean data, such as Yes/No or true/false.
1In Design view, select a radio button in the radio group.
2In the Property inspector, click the Dynamic button.
3Complete the Dynamic Radio Group dialog box, and click OK.
Set the Dynamic Radio Group dialog box options
1In the Radio Button Group pop-up menu, select a form and radio button group in the page.
The Radio Button Value box displays the values of all radio buttons in the group.
2Select a value to dynamically preselect from the list of values. This value is displayed in the Value box.
3Click the lightning bolt icon beside the Select Value Equal To box and select a recordset that contains possible
checked values for the radio buttons in the group.
The recordset you select contains values that match the radio buttons’ checked values. To view the checked values
of the radio buttons, select each radio button and open its Property inspector (Window > Properties).
4Click OK.
Set the Dynamic Radio Group dialog box options (ColdFusion)
1Select a radio group and form from the Radio Group pop-up menu.
2Click the lightning bolt icon next to Select Value Equal To box.
3Complete the Dynamic Data dialog box, and click OK.
a.Select a data source from the list of data sources.
b.(Optional) Select a data format for the text.
c.(Optional) Modify the code that Dreamweaver inserts in your page to display the dynamic text.
4Click OK to close the Dynamic Radio Group dialog box, and insert the dynamic content placeholder in the Radio
Group.
Validate HTML form data
Dreamweaver can add JavaScript code that checks the contents of specified text fields to ensure that the user has entered
the correct type of data.
You can use Spry form widgets to build your forms and validate the contents of specified form elements. For more
information, consult the Spry topics listed below.
You can also build ColdFusion forms in Dreamweaver that validate the contents of specified fields. For more
information, consult the ColdFusion chapter listed below.
1Create an HTML form that includes at least one text field and one Submit button.
Make sure every text field that you want to validate has a unique name.
2Select the Submit button.
630
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
3In the Behaviors panel (Window > Behaviors), click the Plus (+) button and select the Validate Form behavior from
the list.
4Set the validation rules for each text field, and click OK.
For example, you might specify that a text field for a persons age accepts only numbers.
Note: The Validate Form behavior is available only if a text field has been inserted into the document.
Attach JavaScript behaviors to HTML form objects
You can attach JavaScript behaviors stored in Dreamweaver to HTML form objects such as buttons.
1Select the HTML form object.
2In the Behaviors panel (Window > Behaviors), click the Plus (+) button, and select a behavior from the list.
Attach custom scripts to HTML form buttons
Some forms use JavaScript or VBScript to perform form processing or some other action on the client as opposed to
sending the form data to the server for processing. You can use Dreamweaver to configure a form button to run a
specific client-side script when the user clicks the button.
1Select a Submit button in a form.
2In the Behaviors panel (Window > Behaviors), click the Plus (+) button, and select Call JavaScript from the list.
3In the Call JavaScript box, enter the name of the JavaScript function to run when the user clicks the button, and click
OK.
For example, you can enter the name of a function that doesnt exist yet, such as processMyForm().
4If your JavaScript function doesn’t exist in the head section of the document yet, add it now.
For example, you could define the following JavaScript function in the head section of the document to display a
message when the user clicks the Submit button:
function processMyForm(){
alert('Thanks for your order!');
}
Create accessible HTML forms
When you insert an HTML form object, you can make the form object accessible, and change the accessibility attributes
later.
Add an accessible form object
1The first time you add accessible form objects, activate the Accessibility dialog box for form objects (see Optimizing
the workspace for visual development ).
This is a one-time-only step.
2In the document, place the insertion point where you want the form object to appear.
3Select Insert > Form, and select a form object to insert.
The Input Tag Accessibility Attributes dialog box appears.
4Complete the dialog box, and click OK. Here is a partial list of options:
631
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: The screen reader reads the name you enter as the Label attribute for the object.
ID assigns an ID to the form field. This value can be used to refer to the field from JavaScript; it's also used as the
value of the for attribute if you choose the Attach Label Tag Using For option under the Style options.
Wrap With Label Tag Wraps a label tag around the form item, as follows:
<label> <input type="radio" name="radiobutton" value="radiobutton"> RadioButton1</label>
Attach Label Tag Using For Uses the for attribute to wrap a label tag around the form item, as follows:
<input type="radio" name="radiobutton" value="radiobutton" id="radiobutton"> <label
for="radiobutton">RadioButton2</label>
This choice causes the browser to render text associated with a check box and radio button with a focus rectangle,
and enables the user to select the check box and radio button by clicking anywhere in the associated text instead of
just the check box or radio button control.
note: This is the preferred option for accessibility; however, the functionality may vary depending on the browser.
No Label Tag Does not use a label tag, as follows:
<input type="radio" name="radiobutton" value="radiobutton"> RadioButton3
Access Key Uses a keyboard equivalent (one letter) and the Alt key (Windows) or the Control key (Macintosh) to
select the form object in the browser. For example, if you enter B as the Access Key, users with a Macintosh browser
could type Control+B to select the form object.
Tab Index Specifies a tab order for the form objects. If you set tab order for one object, you must set the tab order
for all objects.
Setting a tab order is useful when you have other links and form objects on the page and need the user to tab through
them in a specific order.
5Click Yes to insert a form tag.
The form object appears in the document.
Note: If you press Cancel, the form object appears in the document, but Dreamweaver does not associate accessibility
tags or attributes with it.
Edit accessibility values for a form object
1In the Document window, select the object.
2Do one of the following:
Edit the appropriate attributes in Code view.
Right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh), and then select Edit Tag.
More Help topics
Using forms to collect information from users
Building ColdFusion forms
Apply the Show Pop-Up Menu behavior
Using forms to collect information from users
632
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Building ColdFusion forms
Building Spry pages visually
Creating forms tutorial
Styling forms tutorial
Defining sources of dynamic content
Defining sources of dynamic content
Working with the Spry Validation Text Field widget
Working with the Spry Validation Text Area widget
Working with the Spry Validation Select widget
Working with the Spry Validation Checkbox widget
Validate ColdFusion form data
Apply the Call JavaScript behavior
Enhanced HTML5 support for form elements
In line with continued support for HTML5 in Dreamweaver, new attributes have been introduced for some form
elements. In addition, four new HTML5 form elements have been introduced.
You can locate the form elements in the Insert panel. Select Window > Insert. In the Insert panel menu, select Forms.
More Help topics
Creating Web Forms
New attributes common to form elements
The following new attributes are common to all form elements:
Disabled: Select this option if you want the browser to disable the element
Required: Select this option if you want the browser to check if a value has been specified
Auto complete: Select this option to auto fill values when user enters information in a browser.
Auto focus: Select this option if you want the focus to be on this element when browser loads the page.
Read only: Select this option to set the value of the element to read-only.
Form: Specifies one or more forms to which an <input> element belongs.
Name: Unique name used to reference the element in the code.
Place holder: Hint that describes the expected value of an input field
Pattern: Regular expression against which the element's value is validated.
Title: Extra information about an element. Displayed as a tool tip.
Tab Index: Specifies the position of the current element in the tab order for the current document.
633
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Form elements with modified attributes
Form No Validate: Select this option to disable form validation. This selection overrides the No Validate attribute at
form level.
Form Enc Type: A MIME type with which a user agent is meant to associate this element for form submission.
Form Target: A browsing context name or keyword that represents the target of the control.
Accept charset: Specifies the character encodings used for form submission.
Note: The links for attributes contain information on all attributes listed in the HTML5 specifications. Not all these
attributes are present in the Properties panel. You can use the code view to add attributes not present in the panel.
HTML5 form elements
Form Element New attributes specific to the element Description of attributes
Text Field List http://www.w3.org/TR/html-
markup/input.text.html
Button <No specific new attribute> http://www.w3.org/wiki/HTML/Elements/but
ton
Check Box <No specific new attribute> http://www.w3.org/TR/html-
markup/input.checkbox.html
File Multiple http://www.w3.org/TR/html-
markup/input.file.html
Form No validate, Accept charset http://www.w3.org/TR/2012/WD-html-
markup-20120329/form.html
Hidden <No specific new attribute> http://www.w3.org/TR/2012/WD-html-
markup-20120329/input.hidden.html
Password <No specific new attribute> http://www.w3.org/TR/html-
markup/input.password.html
Image Width, Height, Action, Method, Form no
Validate, Form Enc Type, Form target.
http://www.w3.org/TR/html-
markup/input.image.html
Reset <No specific new attribute> http://dev.w3.org/cvsweb/html5/markup/bu
tton.reset.html
Submit Form No Validate, Form Enc type, Form target,
Action, Tab Index, Method.
http://www.w3.org/TR/html-
markup/input.submit.html
Radio <No specific new attribute> http://www.w3.org/TR/html-
markup/input.radio.html
Text Area Rows, Cols, Place Holder, Wrap, Max Length,
Tab Index
http://www.w3.org/TR/html-
markup/textarea.html
Select Size http://www.w3.org/wiki/HTML/Elements/sele
ct
Form element Available in Description Description of attributes
Color 12.2 For input fields that should
contain a color.
http://www.w3.org/TR/html-
markup/input.color.html
Date 12.2 Control that helps the user select
a date.
http://www.w3.org/TR/html-
markup/input.date.html
634
Dynamic sites, pages and web forms
Last updated 6/3/2015
Date Time 12.2 Allows the user to select a date
and time (with the time zone).
http://www.w3.org/TR/html-
markup/input.datetime.html
Date Time Local 12.2 Allows the user to select a date
and time (no time zone)
http://www.w3.org/TR/html-
markup/input.datetime-
local.html
Month 12.2 Allows the user to select a month
and year.
http://www.w3.org/TR/html-
markup/input.month.html
Number 12.2 For fields that should contain only
numbers.
http://www.w3.org/TR/html-
markup/input.number.html
Range 12.2 For fields that should contain
values from a range of numbers.
http://www.w3.org/TR/html-
markup/input.range.html
Time 12.2 Allows the user to select a time. http://www.w3.org/TR/html-
markup/input.time.html
Week 12.2 Allows the user to select a week
and year.
http://www.w3.org/TR/html-
markup/input.week.html
E-mail 12.1 A control for editing a list of email
addresses given in the element’s
value.
http://www.w3.org/TR/html-
markup/input.email.html
Search 12.1 A one-line plain-text edit control
for entering one or more search
terms.
http://www.w3.org/TR/html-
markup/input.search.html
Telephone (Tel) 12.1 A one-line plain-text edit control
for entering a telephone number.
http://www.w3.org/TR/html-
markup/input.tel.html
URL 12.1 A control for editing an absolute
URL given in the element’s value.
http://www.w3.org/TR/html-
markup/input.url.html
635
Last updated 6/3/2015
Chapter 17: Building applications visually
Building master and detail pages
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About master and detail pages
Master and detail pages are sets of pages used to organize and display recordset data. These pages provide a visitor to
your site with both an overview and a detailed view. The master page lists all of the records and contains links to detail
pages that display additional information about each record.
636
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
You can build master and detail pages by inserting a data object to create a master page and detail page in one operation
or by using server behaviors to build the master and detail pages in a more customized way. When using server
behaviors to build master and detail pages, you first create a master page to list the records and then add links from the
list to the detail pages.
Build a master page
Before you start, ensure that you define a database connection for your site.
1To create a blank page, select File > New > Blank Page, select a page type, and click Create. This page becomes the
master page.
2Define a recordset.
In the Bindings panel (Windows > Bindings), click the Plus (+) button, select Recordset, and choose options. If you
want to write your own SQL statement, click Advanced.
Ensure that the recordset contains all the table columns you need to create your master page. The recordset must
also include the table column containing the unique key of each record—that is, the record ID column. In the
following example, the Code column contains the unique key of each record.
637
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
Typically, the recordset on the master page extracts a few columns from a database table while the recordset on the
detail page extracts more columns from the same table to provide the extra detail.
The recordset can be defined by the user at run time. For more information, see Building search and results pages .
3Insert a dynamic table to display the records.
Place the insertion point where you want the dynamic table to appear on the page. Select Insert > Data Objects >
Dynamic Data > Dynamic Table, set the options, and click OK.
If you don’t want to show record IDs to users, you can delete the column from the dynamic table. Click anywhere
on the page to move the focus to the page. Move the cursor near the top of the column in the dynamic table until
the column cells are outlined in red, and then click to select the column. Press Delete to delete the column from the
table.
Create links to the detail page
After building the master page and adding the recordset, you create links that open the detail page. You then modify
the links to pass the IDs of the records the user selects. The detail page uses this ID to find the requested record in the
database and display it.
Note: You create links to update pages using the same process. The results page is similar to a master page, and the update
page is similar to a detail page.
Open the detail page and pass a record ID (ColdFusion, PHP)
1In the dynamic table, select the content placeholder for text that will serve as a link.
2In the Property inspector, click the folder icon beside the Link box.
3Browse and select the detail page. The detail page appears in the Link box in the Property inspector.
638
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
In the dynamic table, the selected text appears linked. When the page runs on the server, the link is applied to the
text in every table row.
4On the master page, select the link in the dynamic table.
5(ColdFusion) In the Link box in the Property inspector, add the following string at the end of the URL:
?recordID=#recordsetName.fieldName#
The question mark tells the server that what follows is one or more URL parameters. The word recordID is the name
of the URL parameter (you can make up any name you like). Make a note of the name of the URL parameter because
you'll use it in the detail page later.
The expression after the equal sign is the value of the parameter. In this case, the value is generated by a ColdFusion
expression that returns a record ID from the recordset. A different ID is generated for each row in the dynamic table.
In the ColdFusion expression, replace recordsetName with the name of your recordset, and replace fieldName with
the name of the field in your recordset that uniquely identifies each record. In most cases, the field will consist of a
record ID number. In the following example, the field consists of unique location codes.
locationDetail.cfm?recordID=#rsLocations.CODE#
When the page runs, the values of the recordset's CODE field are inserted in the corresponding rows in the dynamic
table. For example, if the Canberra, Australia, rental location has the code CBR, the following URL is used in the
Canberra row in the dynamic table:
locationDetail.cfm?recordID=CBR
6(PHP) In the Link field in the Property inspector, add the following string at the end of the URL:
?recordID=<?php echo $row_recordsetName['fieldName']; ?>
The question mark tells the server that what follows is one or more URL parameters. The word recordID is the name
of the URL parameter (you can use any name you like). Make a note of the name of the URL parameter because
youll use it in the detail page later.
The expression after the equal sign is the value of the parameter. In this case, the value is generated by a PHP
expression that returns a record ID from the recordset. A different ID is generated for each row in the dynamic table.
In the PHP expression, replace recordsetName with the name of your recordset, and replace fieldName with the
name of the field in your recordset that uniquely identifies each record. In most cases, the field will consist of a
record ID number. In the following example, the field consists of unique location codes.
locationDetail.php?recordID=<?php echo $row_rsLocations['CODE']; ?>
When the page runs, the values of the recordsets CODE field are inserted in the corresponding rows in the dynamic
table. For example, if the Canberra, Australia, rental location has the code CBR, the following URL is used in the
Canberra row in the dynamic table:
locationDetail.php?recordID=CBR
7Save the page.
Open the detail page and pass a record ID (ASP)
1Select the dynamic content to double as a link.
2In the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors), click the Plus (+) button, and select Go to Detail Page
from the pop-up menu.
3In the Detail Page box, click Browse and locate the page.
4Specify the value you want to pass to the detail page by selecting a recordset and a column from the Recordset and
Column pop-up menus. Typically the value is unique to the record, such as the records unique key ID.
639
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
5If desired, pass existing page parameters to the detail page by selecting the URL Parameters or Form Parameters
options.
6Click OK.
A special link surrounds the selected text. When the user clicks the link, the Go To Detail Page server behavior
passes a URL parameter containing the record ID to the detail page. For example, if the URL parameter is called id
and the detail page is called customerdetail.asp, the URL looks something like the following when the user clicks on
the link:
http://www.mysite.com/customerdetail.asp?id=43
The first part of the URL, http://www.mysite.com/customerdetail.asp, opens the detail page. The second part,
?id=43, is the URL parameter. It tells the detail page what record to find and display. The term id is the name of the
URL parameter and 43 is its value. In this example, the URL parameter contains the records ID number, 43.
Find and display the requested record on the detail page
In order to display the record requested by the master page, you must define a recordset to hold a single record and bind
the recordset columns to the detail page.
1Switch to the detail page. If you don’t have a detail page yet, create a blank page (File > New).
2In the Bindings panel (Window > Bindings), click the Plus (+) button and select Recordset (Query) or DataSet
(Query) from the pop-up menu.
The simple Recordset or DataSet dialog box appears. If the advanced dialog box appears instead, click Simple.
3Name the recordset, and select a data source and the database table that will provide data to your recordset.
4In the Columns area, select the table columns to include in the recordset.
The recordset can be identical to or different from the recordset on the master page. Usually a detail page recordset
has more columns to display more detail.
If the recordsets are different, make sure the recordset on the detail page contains at least one column in common
with the recordset on the master page. The common column is usually the record ID column, but it can also be the
join field of related tables.
To include only some of the tables columns in the recordset, click Selected and choose the desired columns by
Control-clicking (Windows) or Command-clicking (Macintosh) them in the list.
5Complete the Filter section as to find and display the record specified in the URL parameter passed by the master
page:
From the first pop-up menu in the Filter area, select the column in the recordset containing values that match
the value of the URL parameter passed by the master page. For example, if the URL parameter contains a record
ID number, select the column containing record ID numbers. In the example discussed in the previous section,
the recordset column called CODE contains the values that match the value of the URL parameter passed by the
master page.
From the pop-up menu beside the first menu, select the equal sign (it should already be selected).
From the third pop-up menu, select URL Parameter. The master page uses a URL parameter to pass information
to the detail page.
In the fourth box, enter the name of the URL parameter passed by the master page.
6Click OK. The recordset appears in the Bindings panel.
640
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
7Bind the recordset columns to the detail page by selecting the columns in the Bindings panel (Window > Bindings)
and dragging them onto the page.
After uploading both the master and detail pages to the server, you can open the master page in a browser. After
clicking a detail link on the master page, the detail page opens with more information about the selected record.
Find a specific record and display it on a page (ASP)
You can add a server behavior that finds a specific record in a recordset so that you can display the record data on the
page. The server behavior is only available when using the ASP server model.
1Create a page that has the following prerequisites:
A record ID contained in a URL parameter passed by another page to the current page. You can create URL
parameters on the other page with HTML hyperlinks or with an HTML form. For more information, see Using
forms to collect information from users .
A recordset defined for the current page. The server behavior extracts the record details from this recordset. For
instructions, see or .
Recordset columns bound to the page. The specific record must be displayed on the page. For more information,
see .
2Add the server behavior to find the record specified by the URL parameter by clicking the Plus (+) button on the
Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors) and selecting Recordset Paging > Move to Specific Record.
3In the Move To Record In pop-up menu, select the recordset you defined for the page.
4In the Where Column pop-up menu, select the column that contains the value passed by the other page.
For example, if the other page passes a record ID number, select the column containing record ID numbers.
5In the Matches URL Parameter box, enter the name of the URL parameter passed by the other page.
For example, if the URL the other page used to open the detail page is id=43, enterid in the Matches URL Parameter
box.
6Click OK.
The next time the page is requested by a browser, the server behavior will read the record ID in the URL parameter
passed by the other page and move to the specified record in the recordset.
Build master and detail pages in one operation
When developing web applications, you can quickly build master and detail pages using the Master Detail Page Set data
object.
1To create a blank dynamic page, select File > New > Blank Page, select a dynamic page from the Page Type list, and
click Create.
This page becomes the master page.
2Define a recordset for the page.
Make sure the recordset contains not only all the columns you’ll need for the master page, but also all the columns
you’ll need for the detail page. Typically, the recordset on the master page extracts a few columns from a database
table while the recordset on the detail page extracts more columns from the same table to provide the extra detail.
3Open the master page in Design view, and select Insert > Data Objects > Master Detail Page Set.
641
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
4In the Recordset pop-up menu, make sure the recordset containing the records you want to display on the master
page is chosen.
5In the Master Page Fields area, select the recordset columns to display on the master page.
By default, all the columns in the recordset are selected. If your recordset contains a unique key column such as
recordID, select it and click the Minus (-) button so that it is not displayed on your page.
6To change the order in which the columns appear on the master page, select a column in the list and click the up or
down arrow.
On the master page, the recordset columns will be arranged horizontally in a table. Clicking the up arrow moves the
column to the left; clicking the down arrow moves the column to the right.
7In the Link To Detail From pop-up menu, select the column in the recordset that will display a value that also serves
as a link to the detail page.
For example, if you want each product name on your master page to have a link to the detail page, select the recordset
column containing product names.
8In the Pass Unique Key pop-up menu, select the column in the recordset containing values identifying the records.
Usually, the column chosen is the record ID number. This value is passed to the detail page so that it can identify
the record chosen by the user.
9Deselect the Numeric option if the unique key column is not numeric.
Note: This option is selected by default; it does not appear for all server models.
10 Specify the number of records to display on the master page.
11 In the Detail Page Name box, click Browse and locate the detail page file you created, or enter a name and let the
data object create one for you.
12 In the Detail Page Fields area, select the columns to be displayed on the detail page.
By default, all the columns in the master pages recordset are selected. If the recordset contains a unique key column
such as recordID, select it and click the Minus (-) button so that it is not displayed on the detail page.
13 To change the order in which the columns appear on the detail page, select a column in the list and click the up or
down arrow.
On the detail page, the recordset columns are arranged vertically in a table. Clicking the up arrow moves the column
up; clicking the down arrow moves the column down.
14 Click OK.
The data object creates a detail page (if you didnt already create one) and adds dynamic content and server
behaviors to both the master and detail pages.
15 Customize the layout of the master and detail pages to suit your needs.
You can fully customize the layout of each page by using the Dreamweaver page-design tools. You can also edit the
server behaviors by double-clicking them in the Server Behaviors panel.
After creating master and detail pages with the data object, use the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server
Behaviors) to modify the various building blocks the data object inserts into the pages.
642
Last updated 6/3/2015
Building applications visually
Building an update record page
Set up a testing server
Defining sources of dynamic content
Building search and results pages
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About search and results pages
You can use Dreamweaver to build a set of pages to let users search your database and view the search results.
In most cases, you need at least two pages to add this feature to your web application. The first page is a page that
contains an HTML form in which users enter search parameters. Although this page doesn’t do any actual searching,
it is referred to as the search page.
The second page you need is the results page, which performs most of the work. The results page does the following
tasks:
Reads the search parameters submitted by the search page
Connects to the database and searches for records
Builds a recordset with the records found
Displays the contents of the recordset
Optionally, you can add a detail page. A detail page gives users more information about a particular record on the
results page.
If you have only one search parameter, Dreamweaver lets you add search capabilities to your web application
without using SQL queries and variables. Simply design your pages and complete a few dialog boxes. If you have
more than one search parameter, you need to write a SQL statement and define multiple variables for it.
Dreamweaver inserts the SQL query in your page. When the page runs on the server, each record in the database
table is checked. If the specified field in a record meets your SQL query conditions, the record is included in a
recordset. The SQL query in effect builds a recordset containing only the search results.
For example, field sales staff might have information about customers in a certain area who have incomes above a
certain level. In a form on a search page, the sales associate enters a geographical area and a minimum income level,
and then clicks the Submit button to send the two values to a server. On the server, the values are passed to the results
pages SQL statement, which then creates a recordset containing only customers in the specified area with incomes
above the specified level.
Build the search page
A search page on the web typically contains form fields in which the user enters search parameters. At minimum, your
search page must have an HTML form with a Submit button.
More Help topics
643
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
To add an HTML form to a search page, complete the following procedure.
1Open the search page or a new page, and select Insert > Form > Form.
An empty form is created on the page. You might need to enable Invisible Elements (View > Visual Aids > Invisible
Elements) to see the forms boundaries, which are represented by thin red lines.
2Add form objects for users to enter their search parameters by selecting Form from the Insert menu.
Form objects include text fields, menus, options, and radio buttons. You can add as many form objects as you want
to help users refine their searches. However, keep in mind that the greater the number of search parameters on the
search page, the more complex your SQL statement will be.
3Add a Submit button to the form (Insert > Form > Button).
4(Optional) Change the label of the Submit button by selecting the button, opening the Property inspector (Window
> Properties), and entering a new value in the Value box.
Next, youll tell the form where to send the search parameters when the user clicks the Submit button.
5Select the form by selecting the <form> tag in the tag selector at the bottom of the Document window, as the
following image shows:
6In the Action box in the forms Property inspector, enter the filename of the results page that will conduct the
database search.
7In the Method pop-up menu, select one of the following methods to determine how the form sends data to the
server:
GET sends the form data by appending it to the URL as a query string. Because URLs are limited to 8192
characters, dont use the GET method with long forms.
POST sends the form data in the body of a message.
Default uses the browser’s default method (usually GET).
The search page is done.
Build a basic results page
When the user clicks the forms Search button, the search parameters are sent to a results page on the server. The results
page on the server, not the search page on the browser, is responsible for retrieving records from the database. If the
search page submits a single search parameter to the server, you can build the results page without SQL queries and
variables. You create a basic recordset with a filter that excludes records that don’t meet the search parameter submitted
by the search page.
Note: If you have more than one search condition, you must use the advanced Recordset dialog box to define your recordset
(see ).
Create the recordset to hold the search results
1Open your results page in the Document window.
If you don’t have a results page yet, create a blank dynamic page (File > New > Blank Page).
2Create a recordset by opening the Bindings panel (Window > Bindings), clicking the Plus (+) button, and selecting
Recordset from the pop-up menu.
644
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
3Make sure the simple Recordset dialog box appears.
If the advanced dialog box appears instead, switch to the simple dialog box by clicking the Simple button.
4Enter a name for the recordset, and select a connection.
The connection should be to a database containing data you want the user to search.
5In the Table pop-up menu, select the table to be searched in the database.
Note: In a single-parameter search, you can search for records in only a single table. To search more than one table at a
time, you must use the advanced Recordset dialog box and define a SQL query.
6To include only some of the tables columns in the recordset, click Selected and select the desired columns by
Control-clicking (Windows) or Command-clicking (Macintosh) them in the list.
You should include only the columns containing information you want to display on the results page.
Leave the Recordset dialog box open for now. You’ll use it next to retrieve the parameters sent by the search page
and create a recordset filter to exclude records that don’t meet the parameters.
Create the recordset filter
1From the first pop-up menu in the Filter area, select a column in the database table in which to search for a match.
For example, if the value sent by the search page is a city name, select the column in your table that contains city
names.
2From the pop-up menu beside the first menu, select the equal sign (it should be the default).
3From the third pop-up menu, select Form Variable if the form on your search page uses the POST method, or URL
Parameter if it uses the GET method.
The search page uses either a form variable or a URL parameter to pass information to the results page.
4In the fourth box, enter the name of the form object that accepts the search parameter on the search page.
The name of the object doubles as the name of the form variable or URL parameter. You can get the name by
switching to the search page, clicking the form object on the form to select it, and checking the object’s name in the
Property inspector.
645
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
For example, suppose you want to create a recordset that includes only adventure trips to a specific country. Assume
you have a column in the table called TRIPLOCATION. Also assume the HTML form on your search page uses the
GET method and contains a menu object called Location that displays a list of countries. The following example
shows how your Filter section should look:
5(Optional) Click Test, enter a test value, and click OK to connect to the database and create an instance of the
recordset.
The test value simulates the value that would otherwise have been returned from the search page. Click OK to close
the test recordset.
6If youre satisfied with the recordset, click OK.
A server-side script is inserted on your page that checks each record in the database table when it runs on the server.
If the specified field in a record meets the filtering condition, the record is included in a recordset. The script builds
a recordset that contains only the search results.
The next step is to display the recordset on the results page. For more information, see .
Build an advanced results page
If the search page submits more than one search parameter to the server, you must write a SQL query for the results
page and use the search parameters in SQL variables.
Note: If you have only one search condition, you can use the simple Recordset dialog box to define your recordset (see ).
1Open the results page in Dreamweaver, and then create a recordset by opening the Bindings panel (Window >
Bindings), clicking the Plus (+) button, and selecting Recordset from the pop-up menu.
2Make sure the advanced Recordset dialog box appears.
The advanced dialog box has a text area to enter SQL statements. If the simple dialog box appears instead, switch to
the advanced dialog box by clicking the Advanced button.
3Enter a name for the recordset, and select a connection.
The connection should be to a database containing data you want the user to search.
4Enter a Select statement in the SQL text area.
Make sure the statement includes a WHERE clause with variables to hold the search parameters. In the following
example, the variables are called varLastName and varDept:
SELECT EMPLOYEEID, FIRSTNAME, LASTNAME, DEPARTMENT, EXTENSION FROM EMPLOYEE ¬
WHERE LASTNAME LIKE 'varLastName' ¬
AND DEPARTMENT LIKE 'varDept'
To reduce the amount of typing, you can use the tree of database items at the bottom of the advanced Recordset
dialog box. For instructions, see .
For help on SQL syntax, see the SQL primer at www.adobe.com/go/learn_dw_sqlprimer.
5Give the SQL variables the values of the search parameters by clicking the Plus (+) button in the Variables area and
entering the variables name, default value (the value the variable should take if no run-time value is returned), and
run-time value (usually a server object holding a value sent by a browser, such as a request variable).
646
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
In the following ASP example, the HTML form on the search page uses the GET method and contains one text field
called LastName and another called Department:
In ColdFusion, the run-time values would be #LastName# and #Department#. In PHP, the run-time values would
be $_REQUEST["LastName"] and $_REQUEST["Department"].
6(Optional) Click Test to create an instance of the recordset using the default variable values.
The default values simulate the values that would otherwise have been returned from the search page. Click OK to
close the test recordset.
7If youre satisfied with the recordset, click OK.
The SQL query is inserted in your page.
The next step is to display the recordset on the results page.
Display the search results
After creating a recordset to hold the search results, you must display the information on the results page. Displaying
the records can be a simple matter of dragging individual columns from the Bindings panel to the results page. You can
add navigation links to move forward and backward through the recordset, or you can create a repeating region to
display more than one record on the page. You can also add links to a detail page.
For more information on methods of displaying dynamic content on a page other than displaying results in a dynamic
table, see .
1Place the insertion point where you want the dynamic table to appear on the results page, and select Insert > Data
Objects > Dynamic Data > Dynamic Table.
2Complete the Dynamic Table dialog box, selecting the recordset you defined to hold the search results.
3Click OK. A dynamic table that displays search results is inserted on the results page.
Create a detail page for a results page
Your set of search and results pages can include a detail page to display more information about specific records on the
results page. In this situation, your results page also doubles as the master page in a master-detail page set.
Create a link to open a related page (ASP)
You can create a link that opens a related page and that passes existing parameters to that page. The server behavior is
only available when using the ASP server model.
Before adding a Go To Related Page server behavior to a page, make sure the page receives form or URL parameters
from another page. The job of the server behavior is to pass these parameters to a third page. For example, you can pass
search parameters received by a results page to another page and save the user from entering the search parameters
again.
647
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
Also, you can select text or an image on the page to serve as the link to the related page, or you can position your pointer
on the page without selecting anything, and the link text is inserted.
1In the Go To Related Page box, click Browse and locate the related page file.
If the current page submits data to itself, enter the current pages file name.
2If the parameters you want to pass were received directly from an HTML form using the GET method, or are listed
in the pages URL, select the URL Parameters option.
3If the parameters you want to pass were received directly from an HTML form using the POST method, select the
Form Parameters option.
4Click OK.
When the new link is clicked, the page passes the parameters to the related page using a query string.
More Help topics
Defining sources of dynamic content
Building search and results pages
Creating web forms
Using forms to collect information from users
Building a record insert page
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of
the options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About building record insert pages
Your application can contain a page that lets users insert new records in a database.
An insert page consists of two building blocks:
An HTML form that lets users enter data
An Insert Record server behavior that updates the database
When a user clicks Submit on a form, the server behavior inserts records in a database table.
You can add these building blocks in a single operation using the Record Insertion Form data object or you can add
them separately using the Dreamweaver form tools and the Server Behaviors panel.
Note: The insert page can contain only one record-editing server behavior at a time. For example, you cannot add an
Update Record or a Delete Record server behavior to the insert page.
Build an insert page block by block
You can also build an insert page by using the forms tools and server behaviors.
Add an HTML form to an insert page
1Create a dynamic page (File > New > Blank Page), and lay out your page using the Dreamweaver design tools.
648
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
2Add an HTML form by placing the insertion point where you want the form to appear and selecting Insert > Form
> Form.
An empty form is created on the page. You may have to enable Invisible Elements (View > Visual Aids > Invisible
Elements) to see the forms boundaries, which are represented by thin red lines.
3Name the HTML form by clicking the <form> tag at the bottom of the Document window to select the form,
opening the Property inspector (Window > Properties), and entering a name in the Form Name box.
You don’t need to specify an action or method attribute for the form to tell it where and how to send the record data
when the user clicks the Submit button. The Insert Record server behavior sets these attributes for you.
4Add a form object such as a text field (Insert > Form > Text Field) for each column in the database table you want
to insert records into.
The form objects are for data entry. Text fields are common for this purpose, but you can also use menus, options,
and radio buttons.
5Add a Submit button to the form (Insert > Form > Button).
You can change the label of the Submit button by selecting the button, opening the Property inspector (Window >
Properties), and entering a new value in the Label box.
Add a server behavior to insert records in a database table (ColdFusion)
1In the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors), click the Plus (+) button and select Insert Record from
the pop-up menu.
2Select a form from the Submit Values From pop-up menu.
3In the Data Source pop-up menu, select a connection to the database.
4Enter your user name and password.
5In the Insert Into Table pop-up menu, select the database table to insert the record in.
6Specify a database column to insert the record in, select the form object that will insert the record from the Value
pop-up menu, and then select a data type for the form object from the Submit As pop-up menu.
The data type is the kind of data the column in your database table is expecting (text, numeric, Boolean option
values).
Repeat the procedure for each form object in your form.
7In the After Inserting, Go To box, enter the page to open after the record is inserted in the table or click the Browse
button to browse to the file.
8Click OK.
Dreamweaver adds a server behavior to the page that lets users insert records in a database table by filling out the
HTML form and clicking the Submit button.
Add a server behavior to insert records in a database table (ASP)
1In the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors), click the Plus (+) button and select Insert Record from
the pop-up menu.
2In the Connection pop-up menu, select a connection to the database.
Click the Define button if you need to define a connection.
3In the Insert Into Table pop-up menu, select the database table into which the record should be inserted.
649
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
4In the After Inserting, Go To box, enter the page to open after the record is inserted into the table or click Browse
to browse to the file.
5In the Get Values From pop-up menu, select the HTML form used to enter the data.
Dreamweaver automatically selects the first form on your page.
6Specify a database column to insert the record in, select the form object that will insert the record from the Value
pop-up menu, and then select a data type for the form object from the Submit As pop-up menu.
The data type is the kind of data the column in your database table is expecting (text, numeric, Boolean option
values).
Repeat the procedure for each form object in your form.
7Click OK.
Dreamweaver adds a server behavior to the page that lets users insert records in a database table by filling out the
HTML form and clicking the Submit button.
To edit the server behavior, open the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors) and double-click the
Insert Record behavior.
Add a server behavior to insert records in a database table (PHP)
1In the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors), click the Plus (+) button and select Insert Record from
the pop-up menu.
2Select a form from the Submit Values From pop-up menu.
3In the Connection pop-up menu, select a connection to the database.
4In the Insert Table pop-up menu, select the database table to insert the record in.
5Specify a database column to insert the record in, select the form object that will insert the record from the Value
pop-up menu, and then select a data type for the form object from the Submit As pop-up menu.
The data type is the kind of data the column in your database table is expecting (text, numeric, Boolean option
values).
Repeat the procedure for each form object in your form.
6In the After Inserting, Go To box, enter the page to open after the record is inserted in the table or click the Browse
button to browse to the file.
7Click OK.
Dreamweaver adds a server behavior to the page that lets users insert records in a database table by filling out the
HTML form and clicking the Submit button.
Build the insert page in one operation
1Open the page in Design view, and select Insert > Data Objects > Insert Record > Record Insertion Form Wizard.
2In the Connection pop-up menu, select a connection to the database. Click Define if you need to define a
connection.
3In the Insert Into Table pop-up menu, select the database table into which the record should be inserted.
4If you use ColdFusion, enter a user name and password.
5In the After Inserting, Go To box, enter the page to open after the record is inserted into the table or click the Browse
button to browse to the file.
650
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
6In the Form Fields area, specify the form objects you want to include on the insert pages HTML form, and which
columns in your database table each form object should update.
By default, Dreamweaver creates a form object for each column in the database table. If your database automatically
generates unique key IDs for each new record created, remove the form object corresponding to the key column by
selecting it in the list and clicking the Minus (-) button. This eliminates the risk that the user of the form will enter
an ID value that already exists.
You can also change the order of the form objects on the HTML form by selecting a form object in the list and
clicking the up or down arrow on the right side of the dialog box.
7Specify how each data-entry field should be displayed on the HTML form by clicking a row in the Form Fields table
and entering the following information in the boxes below the table:
In the Label box, enter a descriptive label to display beside the data-entry field. By default, Dreamweaver displays
the table columns name in the label.
In the Display As pop-up menu, select a form object to serve as the data-entry field. You can select Text Field,
Text Area, Menu, Checkbox, Radio Group, and Text. For read-only entries, select Text. You can also select
Password Field, File Field, and Hidden Field.
Note: Hidden fields are inserted at the end of the form.
In the Submit As pop-up menu, select the data format accepted by your database table. For example, if the table
column only accepts numeric data, select Numeric.
Set the form object’s properties. You have different options depending on the form object you select as your data-
entry field. For text fields, text areas, and text, you can enter an initial value. For menus and radio groups, you
open another dialog box to set the properties. For options, select the Checked or Unchecked option.
8Click OK.
Dreamweaver adds both an HTML form and an Insert Record server behavior to your page. The form objects are
laid out in a basic table, which you can customize using the Dreamweaver page design tools. (Make sure all the form
objects remain within the forms boundaries.)
To edit the server behavior, open the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors) and double-click the
Insert Record behavior.
More Help topics
Creating web forms
Building an update record page
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About record update pages
Your application can contain a set of pages that lets users update existing records in a database table. The pages normally
consist of a search page, a results page, and an update page. The search and results page let users retrieve the record and
the update page lets users modify the record.
651
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
Search for the record to update
When users want to update a record, they must first find that record in the database. Accordingly, you need a search
and a results page to work with the update page. The user enters search criteria in the search page and selects the record
on the results page. When the user clicks the record on the results page, the update page opens and displays the record
in an HTML form.
Create links to the update page
After creating the search and results pages, you create links on the results page to open the update page. You then
modify the links to pass the IDS of the records the user selects. The update page uses this ID to find the requested record
in the database and display it.
You use the same process to open the update page and pass a record ID that you do to open a detail page and pass a
record ID. For more information, see .
Retrieve the record to update
After the results page passes a record ID to the update page identifying the record to update, the update page must read
the parameter, retrieve the record from the database table, and store it temporarily in a recordset.
1Create a page in Dreamweaver and save it.
The page will become your update page.
2In the Bindings panel (Window > Bindings), click the Plus (+) button and select Recordset.
If the advanced dialog box appears, click Simple. The advanced dialog box has a text area to enter SQL statements;
the simple one does not.
3Name the recordset and specify where the data you want to update is located using the Connection and Table
pop-up menus.
4Click Selected, and select a key column (usually the record ID column) and the columns that contain the data to be
updated.
5Configure the Filter area so that the value of your key column equals the value of the corresponding URL parameter
passed by the results page.
This kind of filter creates a recordset that contains only the record specified by the results page. For example, if your
key column contains record ID information and is called PRID, and if the results page passes the corresponding
record ID information in the URL parameter called id, the Filter area should look like the following example:
6Click OK.
When the user selects a record on the results page, the update page generates a recordset containing only the selected
record.
Complete the update page block by block
An update page has three building blocks:
A filtered recordset to retrieve the record from a database table
An HTML form to let users modify the records data
652
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
An Update Record server behavior to update the database table
You can add the final two basic building blocks of an update page separately using the form tools and the Server
Behaviors panel.
Add an HTML form to an update page
1Create a page (File > New > Blank Page). This becomes your update page.
2Lay out your page using the Dreamweaver design tools.
3Add an HTML form by placing the insertion point where you want the form to appear and selecting Insert > Form
> Form.
An empty form is created on the page. You may have to enable Invisible Elements (View > Visual Aids > Invisible
Elements) to see the forms boundaries, which are represented by thin red lines.
4Name the HTML form by clicking the <form> tag at the bottom of the Document window to select the form,
opening the Property inspector (Window > Properties), and entering a name in the Form Name box.
You dont have to specify an action or method attribute for the form to tell it where and how to send the record data
when the user clicks the Submit button. The Update Record server behavior sets these attributes for you.
5Add a form object such as a text field (Insert > Form > Text Field) for each column you want to update in the
database table.
The form objects are for data entry. Text fields are common for this purpose, but you can also use menus, options,
and radio buttons.
Each form object should have a corresponding column in the recordset you defined earlier. The only exception is
the unique key column, which should have no corresponding form object.
6Add a Submit button to the form (Insert > Form > Button).
You can change the label of the Submit button by selecting the button, opening the Property inspector (Window >
Properties), and entering a new value in the Label box.
Display the record in the form
1Make sure you defined a recordset to hold the record the user wants to update.
See Retrieve the record to update.
2Bind each form object to data in the recordset, as described in the following topics:
Display dynamic content in HTML text fields
Dynamically preselect an HTML check box
Dynamically preselect an HTML radio button
Insert or change a dynamic HTML form menu
Make existing HTML form menus dynamic
Add a server behavior to update the database table
1In the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors), click the Plus (+) button and select Update Record from
the pop-up menu.
The Update Record dialog box appears.
2Select a form from the Submit Values From pop-up menu.
653
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
3In the Data Source or Connection pop-up menu, select a connection to the database.
4Enter your user name and password if applicable.
5In the Update Table pop-up menu, select the database table that contains the record you are updating.
6(ColdFusion, PHP) Specify a database column to update, select the form object that will update the column from
the Value pop-up menu, select a data type for the form object from the Submit As pop-up menu, and select Primary
Key if you want to identify this column as the primary key.
The data type is the kind of data the column in your database table is expecting (text, numeric, Boolean option
values).
Repeat the procedure for each form object in your form.
7(ASP) In the Select Record From pop-up menu, specify the recordset that contains the record displayed in the
HTML form. In the Unique Key Column pop-up menu, select a key column (usually the record ID column) to
identify the record in the database table. Select the Numeric option if the value is a number. A key column usually
accepts only numeric values, but sometimes accepts text values.
8In the After Updating or On Success, Go To box, enter the page to open after the record updates in the table or click
the Browse button to browse to the file.
9(ASP) Specify a database column to update, select the form object that will update the column from the Value
pop-up menu, and then select a data type for the form object from the Submit As pop-up menu. The data type is the
kind of data the column in your database table is expecting (text, numeric, Boolean option values). Repeat the
procedure for each form in your form.
10 Click OK.
Dreamweaver adds a server behavior to the page that lets users update records in a database table by modifying the
information displayed in the HTML form and clicking the Submit button.
To edit the server behavior, open the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors) and double-click the
Update Record behavior.
Complete the update page in one operation
An update page has three building blocks:
A filtered recordset to retrieve the record from a database table
An HTML form to let users modify the records data
An Update Record server behavior to update the database table
You can add the final two building blocks of an update page in a single operation using the Record Update Form data
object. The data object adds both an HTML form and an Update Record server behavior to the page.
Before you can use the data object, your web application must be able to identify the record to update, and your update
page must be able to retrieve it.
After the data object places the building blocks on the page, you can use the Dreamweaver design tools to customize
the form to your liking, or the Server Behaviors panel to edit the Update Record server behavior.
Note: The update page can contain only one record-editing server behavior at a time. For example, you cannot add an
Insert Record or a Delete Record server behavior to the update page.
1Open the page in Design view, and select Insert > Data Objects > Update Record > Record Update Form Wizard.
The Record Update Form dialog box appears.
654
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
2In the Connection pop-up menu, select a connection to the database.
Click the Define button if you need to define a connection.
3In the Table To Update pop-up menu, select the database table that contains the record to update.
4In the Select Record From pop-up menu, specify the recordset that contains the record displayed in the HTML form.
5In the Unique Key Column pop-up menu, select a key column (usually the record ID column) to identify the record
in the database table.
If the value is a number, select the Numeric option. A key column usually accepts only numeric values, but
sometimes it accepts text values.
6In the After Updating, Go To box, enter the page to open after the record updates in the table.
7In the Form Fields area, specify which columns in your database table each form object should update.
By default, Dreamweaver creates a form object for each column in the database table. If your database automatically
generates unique key IDs for each new record created, remove the form object corresponding to the key column by
selecting it in the list and clicking the Minus (-) button. This eliminates the risk that the user of the form will enter
an ID value that already exists.
You can also change the order of the form objects on the HTML form by selecting a form object in the list and
clicking the up or down arrow on the right side of the dialog box.
8Specify how each data-entry field should appear on the HTML form by clicking a row in the Form Fields table and
entering the following information in the boxes below the table:
In the Label box, enter a descriptive label to display beside the data-entry field. By default, Dreamweaver displays
the table columns name in the label.
In the Display As pop-up menu, select a form object to serve as the data-entry field. You can select Text Field,
Text Area, Menu, Checkbox, Radio Group, and Text. For read-only entries, select Text. You can also select
Password Field, File Field, and Hidden Field.
Note: Hidden fields are inserted at the end of the form.
In the Submit As pop-up menu, select the data format expected by your database table. For example, if the table
column only accepts numeric data, select Numeric.
Set the form object’s properties. You have different options depending on the form object you select as your data-
entry field. For text fields, text areas, and text, you can enter an initial value. For menus and radio groups, you
open another dialog box to set the properties. For options, select the Checked or Unchecked option.
9Set the properties of other form objects by selecting another Form Fields row and entering a label, Display As value,
and Submit As value.
For menus and radio groups, open another dialog box to set the properties. For options, define a comparison
between the current record’s value for the option and a given value to determine whether the option is checked when
the record is displayed.
10 Click OK.
Dreamweaver adds both an HTML form and an Update Record server behavior to your page.
The data object adds both an HTML form and an Update Record server behavior to your page. The form objects are
laid out in a basic table, which you can customize using the Dreamweaver page design tools. (Make sure all the form
objects remain within the forms boundaries.)
To edit the server behavior, open the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors) and double-click the
Update Record behavior.
655
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
Form Element Properties options
The purpose of the Form Element Properties dialog box is to set the options for form elements on pages that let users
update records in a database.
1Select either Manually or From Database, depending on how you plan to create the form element.
2Click the Plus (+) button to add an element.
3Enter a label and value for the element.
4In the Select Value Equal To box, if you want a particular element selected when the page opens in a browser or when
a record displays in the form, enter a value equal to the elements value.
You can enter a static value or you can specify a dynamic value by clicking the lightning bolt icon, and selecting a
dynamic value from the list of data sources. In either case, the value you specify should match one of the elements
values.
More Help topics
Building search and results pages
URL parameters
Creating web forms
Insert or change a dynamic HTML form menu
Building a delete record page
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About record delete pages
Your application can contain a set of pages that lets users delete records in a database. The pages normally consist of a
search page, a results page, and a delete page. A delete page is usually a detail page working in tandem with a results
page. The search and results pages let the user retrieve the record and the delete page lets the user confirm and delete
the record.
After creating the search and results pages, you add links on the results page to open the delete page and then build a
delete page that displays the records and a Submit button.
Search for the record to delete
When users want to delete a record, they must first find that record in the database. Accordingly, you need a search and
a results page to work with the delete page. The user enters search criteria in the search page and selects the record on
the results page. When the user clicks the record, the delete page opens and displays the record in an HTML form.
Create links to a delete page
After creating the search and results pages, you must create links on the results page to open the delete page. You then
modify the links to pass the IDs of the records the user wants to delete. The delete page uses this ID to find and display
the record.
656
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
To create the links manually
1On the results page, create a column in the table used to display records by clicking inside the last table column and
selecting Modify > Table > Insert Rows or Columns.
2Select the Columns option and the After Current Column option, and click OK.
A column is added to the table.
3In the newly created table column, enter the string Delete in the row containing the dynamic content placeholders.
Make sure you enter the string inside the tabbed repeating region.
You can also insert an image with a word or symbol for delete.
4Select the Delete string to apply a link to it.
5In the Property inspector, enter the delete page in the Link box. You can enter any filename.
After clicking outside the Link box, the Delete string appears linked in the table. If you Live view, you can see that
the link is applied to the same text in every table row.
6Select the Delete link on the results page.
7(ColdFusion) In the Link box in the Property inspector, add the following string at the end of the URL:
?recordID=#recordsetName.fieldName#
The question mark tells the server that what follows is one or more URL parameters. The word recordID is the name
of the URL parameter (you can make up any name you like). Note the name of the URL parameter because you'll
use it in the delete page later.
The expression after the equal sign is the value of the parameter. In this case, the value is generated by a ColdFusion
expression that returns a record ID from the recordset. A different ID is generated for each row in the dynamic table.
In the ColdFusion expression, replace recordsetName with the name of your recordset, and replace fieldName with
the name of the field in your recordset that uniquely identifies each record. In most cases, the field will consist of a
record ID number. In the following example, the field consists of unique location codes:
confirmDelete.cfm?recordID=#rsLocations.CODE#
When the page runs, the values of the recordset's CODE field are inserted in the corresponding rows in the dynamic
table. For example, if the Canberra, Australia, rental location has the code CBR, the following URL is used in the
Canberra row in the dynamic table:
confirmDelete.cfm?recordID=CBR
8(PHP) In the Link field in the Property inspector, add the following string at the end of the URL:
?recordID=<?php echo $row_recordsetName['fieldName']; ?>
The question mark tells the server that what follows is one or more URL parameters. The word recordID is the name
of the URL parameter (you can make up any name you like). Note the name of the URL parameter because you'll
use it in the delete page later.
The expression after the equal sign is the value of the parameter. In this case, the value is generated by a PHP
expression that returns a record ID from the recordset. A different ID is generated for each row in the dynamic table.
In the PHP expression, replace recordsetName with the name of your recordset, and replace fieldName with the
name of the field in your recordset that uniquely identifies each record. In most cases, the field will consist of a
record ID number. In the following example, the field consists of unique location codes:
confirmDelete.php?recordID=<?php echo $row_rsLocations['CODE']; ?>
657
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
When the page runs, the values of the recordset's CODE field are inserted in the corresponding rows in the dynamic
table. For example, if the Canberra, Australia, rental location has the code CBR, the following URL is used in the
Canberra row in the dynamic table:
confirmDelete.php?recordID=CBR
9(ASP) In the Link field in the Property inspector, add the following string at the end of the URL:
?recordID=<%=(recordsetName.Fields.Item("fieldName").Value)%>
The question mark tells the server that what follows is one or more URL parameters. The word recordID is the name
of the URL parameter (you can make up any name you like). Note the name of the URL parameter because you'll
use it in the delete page later.
The expression after the equal sign is the value of the parameter. In this case, the value is generated by an ASP
expression that returns a record ID from the recordset. A different ID is generated for each row in the dynamic table.
In the ASP expression, replace recordsetName with the name of your recordset, and replace fieldName with the
name of the field in your recordset that uniquely identifies each record. In most cases, the field will consist of a
record ID number. In the following example, the field consists of unique location codes:
confirmDelete.asp?recordID=<%=(rsLocations.Fields.Item("CODE").Value)%>
When the page runs, the values of the recordset's CODE field are inserted in the corresponding rows in the dynamic
table. For example, if the Canberra, Australia, rental location has the code CBR, the following URL is used in the
Canberra row in the dynamic table:
confirmDelete.asp?recordID=CBR
10 Save the page.
To create the links visually (ASP only)
1On the results page, create a column in the table used to display records by clicking inside the last table column and
selecting Modify > Table > Insert Rows or Columns.
2Select the Columns option and the After Current Column option, and click OK.
A column is added to the table.
3In the newly created table column, enter the string Delete in the row containing the dynamic content placeholders.
Make sure you enter the string inside the tabbed repeating region.
You can also insert an image with a word or symbol for delete.
4Select the Delete string to apply a link to it.
5In the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors), click the Plus (+) button, and select Go to Detail Page
from the pop-up menu.
6In the Detail Page box, click Browse and locate the delete page.
7In the Pass URL Parameter box, specify the name of your parameter, such as recordID.
You can make up any name you like, but take note of the name because you'll use it in the delete page later.
8Specify the value you want to pass to the delete page by selecting a recordset and a column from the Recordset and
Column pop-up menus. Typically the value is unique to the record, such as the records unique key ID.
9Select the URL Parameters option.
10 Click OK.
658
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
A special link surrounds the selected text. When the user clicks the link, the Go To Detail Page server behavior
passes a URL parameter containing the record ID to the specified delete page. For example, if the URL parameter is
called recordID and the delete page is called confirmdelete.asp, the URL looks something like the following when
the user clicks on the link:
http://www.mysite.com/confirmdelete.asp?recordID=43
The first part of the URL, http://www.mysite.com/confirmdelete.asp, opens the delete page. The second part,
?recordID=43, is the URL parameter. It tells the delete page what record to find and display. The term recordID is
the name of the URL parameter and 43 is its value. In this example, the URL parameter contains the records ID
number, 43.
Build the delete page
After completing the page listing the records, switch to the delete page. The delete page shows the record and asks the
user if they're sure they want to delete it. When the user confirms the operation by clicking the form button, the web
application deletes the record from the database.
Building this page consists of creating an HTML form, retrieving the record to display in the form, displaying the record
in the form, and adding the logic to delete the record from the database. Retrieving and displaying the record consists
of defining a recordset to hold a single record—the record the user wants to delete—and binding the recordset columns
to the form.
Note: The delete page can contain only one record-editing server behavior at a time. For example, you cannot add an Insert
Record or an Update Record server behavior to the delete page.
Create an HTML form to display the record
1Create a page and save it as the delete page you specified in the previous section.
You specified a delete page when you created the Delete link in the previous section. Use this name when saving the
file for the first time (for example, deleteConfirm.cfm).
2Insert an HTML form on the page (Insert > Form > Form).
3Add a hidden form field to the form.
The hidden form field is required to store the record ID passed by the URL parameter. To add a hidden field, place
the insertion point in the form and select Insert > Form > Hidden Field.
4Add a button to the form.
The user will click the button to confirm and delete the displayed record. To add a button, place the insertion point
in the form and select Insert > Form > Button.
5Enhance the design of the page any way you want and save it.
Retrieve the record the user wants to delete
1In the Bindings panel (Window > Bindings), click the Plus (+) button and select Recordset (Query) from the pop-up
menu.
The simple Recordset or DataSet dialog box appears. If the advanced Recordset dialog box appears instead, click
Simple.
2Name the recordset, and select a data source and the database table that contains the records that users can delete.
3In the Columns area, select the table columns (record fields) you want to display on the page.
659
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
To display only some of the records fields, click Selected and choose the desired fields by Control-clicking
(Windows) or Command-clicking (Macintosh) them in the list.
Make sure to include the record ID field even if you won't be displaying it.
4Complete the Filter section as follows to find and display the record specified in the URL parameter passed by the
results page:
From the first pop-up menu in the Filter area, select the column in the recordset containing values that match
the value of the URL parameter passed by the page with the Delete links. For example, if the URL parameter
contains a record ID number, select the column containing record ID numbers. In the example discussed in the
previous section, the recordset column called CODE contains the values that match the value of the URL
parameter passed by the page with the Delete links.
From the pop-up menu beside the first menu, select the equal sign, if not already selected.
From the third pop-up menu, select URL Parameter. The page with the Delete links uses a URL parameter to
pass information to the delete page.
In the fourth box, enter the name of the URL parameter passed by the page with the Delete links.
5Click OK.
The recordset appears in the Bindings panel.
Display the record the user wants to delete
1Select the recordset columns (record fields) in the Bindings panel, and drag them to the delete page.
Make sure you insert this read-only dynamic content within the form boundaries. For more information on
inserting dynamic content in a page, see .
Next, you must bind the record ID column to the hidden form field.
2Make sure Invisible Elements are enabled (View > Visual Aids > Invisible Elements), and then click the yellow shield
icon that represents the hidden form field.
The hidden form field is selected.
3In the Property inspector, click the lightning bolt icon beside the Value box.
4In the Dynamic Data dialog box, select the record ID column in the recordset.
660
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
In the following example, the record ID column, CODE, contains unique store codes.
5Click OK and save the page.
Add logic to delete the record
After displaying the selected record on the delete page, you must add logic to the page that deletes the record from the
database when the user clicks the Confirm Deletion button. You can add this logic quickly and easily by using the Delete
Record server behavior.
To add a server behavior to delete the record (ColdFusion, PHP)
1Make sure the ColdFusion or PHP delete page is open in Dreamweaver.
2In the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors), click the Plus (+) button, and select Delete Record.
3In the First Check If Variable Is Defined box, make sure Primary Key Value is selected.
You specify the primary key value later in the dialog box.
661
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
4In the Connection or Data Source (ColdFusion) pop-up menu, select a connection to the database so that the server
behavior can connect to the affected database.
5In the Table pop-up menu, select the database table that contains the records that will be deleted.
6In the Primary Key Column pop-up menu, select the table column that contains record IDs.
The Delete Record server behavior searches this column for a match. The column should contain the same record
ID data as the recordset column you bound to the hidden form field on the page.
If the record ID is numeric, select the Numeric option.
7(PHP) In the Primary Key Value pop-up menu, select the variable on your page that contains the record ID
identifying the record to be deleted.
The variable is created by your hidden form field. It has the same name as the name attribute of the hidden field and
is either a form or URL parameter, depending on the forms method attribute.
8In the After Deleting, Go To box, or the On Success, Go To box, specify a page to open after the record has been
deleted from the database table.
You can specify a page that contains a brief success message to the user, or a page listing the remaining records so
that the user can verify that the record has been deleted.
9Click OK, and save your work.
To add a server behavior to delete the record (ASP)
1Make sure the ASP delete page is open in Dreamweaver.
2In the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors), click the Plus (+) button, and select Delete Record.
3In the Connection pop-up menu, select a connection to the database so that the server behavior can connect to the
affected database.
Click the Define button if you need to define a connection.
4In the Delete from Table pop-up menu, select the database table that contains the records to be deleted.
5In the Select Record From pop-up menu, specify the recordset that contains the records to be deleted.
6In the Unique Key Column pop-up menu, select a key column (usually the record ID column) to identify the record
in the database table.
If the value is a number, select the Numeric option. A key column usually accepts only numeric values, but
sometimes it accepts text values.
7In the Delete By Submitting pop-up menu, specify the HTML form with the Submit button that sends the delete
command to the server.
662
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
8In the After Deleting, Go To box, specify a page to open after the record has been deleted from the database table.
You can specify a page that contains a brief success message to the user, or a page listing the remaining records so
that the user can verify that the record has been deleted.
9Click OK, and save your work.
Test your delete pages
1Upload the search, results, and delete pages to your web server, open a browser and search for a disposable test
record to delete.
When you click a Delete link on the results page, the delete page should appear.
2Click the Confirm button to delete the record from the database.
3Verify that the record has been deleted by searching for the record again. The record should no longer appear in the
results page.
More Help topics
Building search and results pages
URL parameters
Building pages with advanced data manipulation
objects (ColdFusion, ASP)
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About ASP command objects
An ASP command object is a server object that performs some operation on a database. The object can contain any valid
SQL statement, including one that returns a recordset, or one that inserts, updates, or deletes records in a database. A
command object can alter the structure of a database if the SQL statement adds or deletes a column in a table. You can
also use a command object to run a stored procedure in a database.
A command object can be reusable, in the sense that the application server can reuse a single compiled version of the
object to execute the command a number of times. You make a command reusable by setting the Prepared property of
the Command object to true, as in the following VBScript statement:
mycommand.Prepared = true
If you know the command will be executed more than a few times, having a single compiled version of the object can
make database operations more efficient.
Note: Not all database providers support prepared commands. If your database does not support it, it might return an error
when you set this property to true. It might even ignore the request to prepare the command and set the Prepared property
to false.
A command object is created by scripts on an ASP page, but Dreamweaver lets you create command objects without
writing a line of ASP code.
663
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
Use ASP commands to modify a database
You can use Dreamweaver to create ASP command objects that insert, update, or delete records in a database. You
supply the command object with the SQL statement or stored procedure that performs the operation on the database.
1In Dreamweaver, open the ASP page that will run the command.
2Open the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors), click the Plus (+) button, and select Command.
3Enter a name for the command, select a connection to the database that contains the records you want to edit, and
select the editing operation that you want the command to perform—Insert, Update, or Delete.
Dreamweaver starts the SQL statement, based on the type of operation you select. For example, if you select Insert,
the dialog box looks like the following example:
4Complete the SQL statement.
For information on writing SQL statements that modify databases, consult a Transact-SQL manual.
5Use the Variables area to define any SQL variables. Provide the name and run-time value. Specifying the type and
size of each variable prevents injection attacks.
The following example shows an Insert statement that contains three SQL variables. The values of these variables
are provided by URL parameters passed to the page, as defined in the Run-Time Value column of the Variables area.
To get the Size value, use the Databases panel in Dreamweaver. Find your database in the Databases panel and
expand it. Next, find the table youre working with and expand it. The table lists the sizes for your fields. For example,
it might say ADDRESS (WChar 50). In this example, 50 is the size. You can also find the size in your database
application.
Note: Numeric, Boolean and date/time data types always use -1 as the size.
To determine the Type value, see the following table:
664
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
For more information on the type and size of SQL variables, see www.adobe.com/go/4e6b330a.
6Close the dialog box.
Dreamweaver inserts ASP code in your page that, when run on the server, creates a command that inserts, updates,
or deletes records in the database.
By default, the code sets the Prepared property of the Command object to true, which makes the application server
reuse a single compiled version of the object every time the command is run. To change this setting, switch to Code
view and change the Prepared property to false.
7Create a page with an HTML form so users can enter record data. In the HTML form, include three text fields
(txtCity, txtAddress, and txtPhone) and a submit button. The form uses the GET method and submits the text field
values to the page that contains your command.
About stored procedures
Although you can use server behaviors to build pages that modify databases, you can also use database manipulation
objects such as stored procedures or ASP command objects to build the pages.
A stored procedure is a reusable database item that performs some operation on the database. A stored procedure
contains SQL code that can, among other things, insert, update, or delete records. Stored procedures can also alter the
structure of the database itself. For example, you can use a stored procedure to add a table column or even delete a table.
A stored procedure can also call another stored procedure, as well as accept input parameters and return multiple values
to the calling procedure in the form of output parameters.
A stored procedure is reusable in the sense that you can reuse a single compiled version of the procedure to execute a
database operation a number of times. If you know a database task will be executed more than a few times—or the same
task will be executed by different applications—using a stored procedure to execute that task can make database
operations more efficient.
Note: MySQL and Microsoft Access databases do not support stored procedures.
Type in database Type in Dreamweaver Size
Numeric (MS Access, MS SQL Server,
MySQL)
Double -1
Boolean, Yes/No (MS Access, MS SQL
Server, MySQL)
Double -1
Date/Time (MS Access, MS SQL Server,
MySQL)
DBTimeStamp -1
All other types of text fields, including the
MySQL text data types char, varchar and
longtext
LongVarChar check database table
Text (MS Access) or nvarchar, nchar (MS
SQL Server)
VarWChar check database table
Memo (MS Access), ntext (MS SQL Server),
or fields that support large amounts of
text
LongVarWChar 1073741823
665
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
Add a stored procedure (ColdFusion) (CS6)
You can use a stored procedure to modify a database. A stored procedure is a reusable database item that performs some
operation on the database.
Before you use a stored procedure to modify a database, make sure the stored procedure contains SQL that modifies
the database in some way. To create and store one in your database, consult your database documentation and a good
Transact-SQL manual.
1In Dreamweaver, open the page that will run the stored procedure.
2In the Bindings panel (Window > Bindings), click the Plus (+) button, and then select Stored Procedure.
3In the Data Source pop-up menu, select a connection to the database containing the stored procedure.
4Enter the ColdFusion Data Source user name and password.
5Select a stored procedure from the Procedures pop-up menu.
Dreamweaver automatically fills in any parameters.
6Select a parameter, and click Edit if you have to make changes.
The Edit Stored Procedure Variable dialog box appears. The name of the variable you are editing appears in the
Name box.
Note: You must enter test values for any stored procedure input parameters.
7Make changes as necessary:
Select a Direction from the pop-up menu. A stored procedure might have input values, output values, or both
input and output values.
Select a SQL type from the pop-up menu. Enter a return variable, a run-time value, and a test value.
8If the stored procedure takes a parameter, click the Plus (+) button to add a page parameter.
Note: You must enter corresponding page parameters for each stored procedure parameter return value. Do not add
page parameters unless there is a corresponding return value.
Click the Plus (+) button again to add another page parameter, if necessary.
9Select a page parameter, and click the Minus (-) button to delete the parameter if necessary or click Edit to make
changes to the parameter.
10 Select the Returns Recordset Named option, and then enter a name for the recordset; if the stored procedure returns
a recordset, click the Test button to see the recordset that the stored procedure returns.
Dreamweaver runs the stored procedure and displays the recordset, if any.
Note: If the stored procedure returns a recordset and takes parameters, you must enter a value in the Default Value
column in the Variables box to test the stored procedure.
You can use different test values to generate different recordsets. To change test values, click the Edit button for
Parameter, and change the test value, or click the Edit button for Page Parameter and change the default value.
11 Select the Returns Status Code Named option, enter a name for the status code, if the stored procedure returns a
status code return value. Click OK.
After you close the box, Dreamweaver inserts ColdFusion code in your page that calls a stored procedure in the
database, when the code runs on the server. The stored procedure in turn performs a database operation, such as
inserting a record.
666
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
If the stored procedure takes parameters, you can create a page that gathers the parameter values and submits them
to the page with the stored procedure. For example, you may create a page that uses URL parameters or an HTML
form to gather parameter values from users.
Run a stored procedure (ASP) (CS6)
With ASP pages, you must add a command object to a page to run a stored procedure. For more information on
command objects, see About ASP command objects.
1In Dreamweaver, open the page that will run the stored procedure.
2In the Bindings panel (Window > Bindings), click the Plus (+) button, and then select Command (Stored
Procedure).
The Command dialog box appears.
3Enter a name for the command, select a connection to the database containing the stored procedure, and then select
Stored Procedure from the Type pop-up menu.
4Select your stored procedure by expanding the Stored Procedures branch in the Database Items box, selecting the
stored procedure from the list, and clicking the Procedure button.
5Enter any required parameters in the Variables table.
You don’t need to enter any parameters for any RETURN_VALUE variable.
6Click OK.
After you close the dialog box, ASP code is inserted in your page. When the code runs on the server, the code creates
a command object that runs a stored procedure in the database. The stored procedure in turn performs a database
operation, such as inserting a record.
By default, the code sets the Prepared property of the Command object to true, which makes the application server
reuse a single compiled version of the object every time the stored procedure is run. If you know the command will
be executed more than a few times, having a single compiled version of the object can improve the efficiency of
database operations. However, if the command will only be executed one or two times, using one might actually slow
down your web application because the system has to pause to compile the command. To change the setting, switch
to Code view and change the Prepared property to false.
Note: Not all database providers support prepared commands. If your database does not support it, you might get an
error message when you run the page. Switch to Code view and change the Prepared property to false.
If the stored procedure takes parameters, you might create a page that gathers the parameter values and submits
them to the page with the stored procedure. For example, you may create a page that uses URL parameters or an
HTML form to gather parameter values from users.
More Help topics
Building a registration page
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
667
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
About registration pages
Your web application can contain a page that requires users to register the first time they visit your site.
A registration page is made up of the following building blocks:
A database table to store login information about the users
An HTML form that lets users select a user name and password
You can also use the form to obtain other personal information from users.
An Insert Record server behavior to update the database table of site users
A Check New Username server behavior to make sure the user name entered by the user is not taken by another user
Storing login information about users
A registration page requires a database table to store the login information entered by users.
Make sure your database table contains a user name and a password column. If you want logged-in users to have
different access privileges, include an access privilege column.
If you want to set a common password for all users of the site, configure your database application (Microsoft Access,
Microsoft SQL Server, Oracle, and so on) to enter the password in each new user record by default. In most database
applications, you can set a column to a default value each time a new record is created. Set the default value to the
password.
You can also use the database table to store other useful information about the user.
The next step in creating a registration page is to add an HTML form to the registration page to let users choose a
user name and password (if applicable).
Add an HTML form for selecting a user name and password
You add an HTML form to the registration page to let users select a user name and password (if applicable).
1Create a page (File > New > Blank Page) and lay out your registration page using the Dreamweaver design tools.
2Add an HTML form by placing the insertion point where you want the form to appear and selecting Form from the
Insert menu.
An empty form is created on the page. You may have to enable Invisible Elements (View > Visual Aids > Invisible
Elements) to see the forms boundaries, which are represented by thin red lines.
3Name the HTML form by clicking the <form> tag at the bottom of the Document window to select the form,
opening the Property inspector (Window > Properties), and entering a name in the Form Name box.
You dont have to specify an action or method attribute for the form to tell it where and how to send the record data
when the user clicks the Submit button. The Insert Record server behavior sets these attributes for you.
4Add text fields (Insert > Form > Text Field) to let the user enter a user name and password.
The form can also have more form objects to record other personal data.
You should add labels (either as text or images) beside each form object to tell users what they are. You should also
line up the form objects by placing them inside an HTML table. For more information on form objects, see Creating
web forms.
5Add a Submit button to the form (Insert > Form > Button).
668
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
You can change the label of the Submit button by selecting the button, opening the Property inspector (Window >
Properties), and entering a new value in the Value box.
The next step in creating a registration page is to add the Insert Record server behavior to insert records in the table
of users in the database.
Update the database table of users
You must add an Insert Record server behavior to the registration page to update the table of users in the database.
1In the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors), click the Plus (+) button and select Insert Record from
the pop-up menu.
The Insert Record dialog box appears.
2Complete the dialog box, making sure to specify the table of users in the database into which the user data will be
inserted. Click OK.
The final step in creating a registration page is to make sure the user name is not used by another registered user.
Add a server behavior to ensure a unique user name
You can add a server behavior to a user registration page that verifies that the user name is unique before adding that
user to your database of registered users.
When the user clicks the Submit button on the registration page, the server behavior compares the user name entered
by the user against the user names stored in a database table of registered users. If no matching user name is found in
the database table, the server behavior carries out the insert record operation normally. If a matching user name is
found, the server behavior cancels the insert record operation and opens a new page (usually a page alerting the user
that the user name is already taken).
1In the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors), click the Plus (+) button and select User Authentication
>Check New Username from the pop-up menu.
2In the Username Field pop-up menu, select the form text field that your visitors use to enter a user name.
3In the If Already Exists, Go To box, specify a page to open if a matching user name is found in the database table,
and click OK.
The opened page should alert the user that the user name is already taken and let the user try again.
More Help topics
Build an insert page block by block
Building a login page
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About login pages
Your web application can contain a page that lets registered users log in to the site.
669
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
A login page is made up of the following building blocks:
A database table of registered users
An HTML form to let users enter a user name and password
A Log In User server behavior to make sure the entered user name and password are valid
A session variable consisting of the user name is created for the user when the user logs in successfully.
Create a database table of registered users
You need a database table of registered users to verify that the user name and password entered in the login page are
valid.
Use your database application and a registration page to create the table. For instructions, see the related topic link
below.
The next step in building a login page is to add an HTML form to the page to let users log in. See the next topic for
instructions.
Add an HTML form to let users log in
You add an HTML form to the page to let users log in by entering a user name and password.
1Create a page (File > New > Blank Page), and lay out your login page using the Dreamweaver design tools.
2Add an HTML form by placing the insertion point where you want the form to appear and choosing Form from the
Insert menu.
An empty form is created on the page. You may have to enable Invisible Elements (View > Visual Aids > Invisible
Elements) to see the forms boundaries, which are represented by thin red lines.
3Name the HTML form by clicking the <form> tag at the bottom of the Document window to select the form,
opening the Property inspector (Window > Properties), and entering a name in the Form Name box.
You dont have to specify an action or method attribute for the form to tell it where and how to send the record data
when the user clicks the Submit button. The Log In User server behavior sets these attributes for you.
4Add a user name and a password text field (Insert > Form > Text Field) to the form.
Add labels (either as text or images) beside each text field, and line up the text fields by placing them inside an
HTML table and setting the tables border attribute to 0.
5Add a Submit button to the form (Insert > Form > Button).
You can change the label of the Submit button by selecting the button, opening the Property inspector (Window >
Properties), and entering a new value in the Label box.
The next step in building a login page is to add the Log In User server behavior to verify that the entered user name
and password are valid.
Verify the user name and password
You must add a Log In User server behavior to the login page to ensure that the user name and password that a user
enters are valid.
670
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
When a user clicks the Submit button on the login page, the Log In User server behavior compares the values entered
by the user against the values for registered users. If the values match, the server behavior opens one page (usually the
sites Welcome screen). If the values do not match, the server behavior opens another page (usually a page alerting the
user that the login attempt failed).
1In the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors), click the Plus (+) button and select User Authentication
> Log In User from the pop-up menu.
2Specify the form and the form objects that visitors use to enter their user name and password.
3(ColdFusion) Enter your user name and password if applicable.
4Specify the database table and columns that contain the user names and passwords of all the registered users.
The server behavior compares the user name and password a visitor enters on the login page against the values in
these columns.
5Specify a page to open if the login process succeeds.
The specified page is usually the sites Welcome screen.
6Specify a page to open if the login process fails.
The specified page usually alerts the user that the login process failed and lets the user try again.
7If you want users forwarded to the login page after attempting to access a restricted page to return to that restricted
page after logging in, select the Go To Previous URL option.
If a user tries to access your site by opening a restricted page without first logging in, the restricted page can forward
the user to the login page. After the user logs in successfully, the login page redirects the user to the restricted page
that forwarded them to the login page in the first place.
When you complete the dialog box for the Restrict Access To Page server behavior on these pages, ensure that you
specify your login page in the If Access Denied, Go To box.
8Specify whether to grant access to the page based on user name and password alone, or based on authorization level
too, and click OK.
A server behavior is added to the login page that ensures the user name and password entered by a visitor are valid.
More Help topics
Building a registration page
Building a page that only authorized users can access
Building a page that only authorized users can access
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of
the options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About protected pages
Your web application can contain a protected page that only authorized users can access.
671
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
For example, if a user attempts to bypass the login page by typing the protected pages URL in a browser, the user is
redirected to another page. Similarly, if you set the authorization level for a page to Administrator only users with
Administrator access privileges can view the page. If a logged-in user attempts to access the protected page without the
proper access privileges, the user is redirected to another page.
You can also use authorization levels to review newly registered users before granting them full access to the site. For
example, you may want to receive payment before allowing a user access to the member pages of the site. To do so, you
can protect the member pages with a Member authorization level and only grant newly registered users Guest
privileges. After receiving payment from the user, you can upgrade the user’s access privileges to Member (in the
database table of registered users).
If you do not plan to use authorization levels, you can protect any page on your site simply by adding a Restrict Access
To Page server behavior to the page. The server behavior redirects to another page any user who has not successfully
logged in.
If you do plan to use authorization levels, you can protect any page on your site with the following building blocks:
A Restrict Access To Page server behavior to redirect unauthorized users to another page
An extra column in your users database table to store each user’s access privileges
Regardless of whether you use authorization levels, you can add a link to the protected page that lets a user log out
and clears any session variables.
Redirect unauthorized users
To prevent unauthorized users from accessing a page, add a Restrict Access To Page server behavior to it. The server
behavior redirects the user to another page if the user attempts to bypass the login page by typing the protected pages
URL in a browser, or if the user is logged in but attempts to access the protected page without the proper access
privileges.
Note: The Restrict Access To Page server behavior can only protect HTML pages. It does not protect other site resources such
as image files and audio files.
If you want to give many pages on your site the same access rights, you can copy and paste access rights from one page
to another.
Redirect unauthorized users to another page
1Open the page you want to protect.
2In the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors), click the Plus (+) button and select User Authentication
> Restrict Access To Page from the pop-up menu.
3Select the level of access for the page. To allow only users with certain access privileges to view the page, select the
Username, Password, and Access Level option and specify the authorization levels for the page.
For example, you can specify that only users with Administrator privileges can view the page by selecting
Administrator in the authorization levels list.
4To add authorization levels to the list, click Define. In the Define Access Levels list that appears, enter a new
authorization level, and click the Plus (+) button. The new authorization level is stored for use with other pages.
Ensure that the string for the authorization level matches exactly the string stored in your user database. For
example, if the authorization column in your database contains the value “Administrator, enter Administrator, not
Admin, in the Name box.
672
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
5To set more than one authorization level for a page, Control-click (Windows) or Command-click (Macintosh) the
levels in the list.
For example, you can specify that any user with Guest, Member, or Administrator privileges can view the page.
6Specify the page to open if an unauthorized user attempts to open the protected page.
Ensure that the page you choose is not protected.
7Click OK.
Copy and paste a pages access rights to other pages on the site
1Open the protected page and select the Restrict Access To Page server behavior listed in the Server Behaviors panel
(not the one in the Plus (+) pop-up menu).
2Click the arrow button in the upper-right corner of the panel, and select Copy from the pop-up menu.
The Restrict Access To Page server behavior is copied to your systems Clipboard.
3Open another page you want to protect in the same way.
4In the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Server Behaviors), click the arrow button in the upper-right corner, and
select Paste from the pop-up menu.
5Repeat steps 3 and 4 for each page you want to protect.
Store access privileges in the user database
This building block is required only if you want certain logged-in users to have different access privileges. If you simply
require users to log in, you don’t have to store access privileges.
1To provide certain logged-in users with different access privileges, make sure your database table of users contains
a column specifying each user’s access privileges (Guest, User, Administrator, and so on). The access privileges of
each user should be entered in the database by the site administrator.
In most database applications, you can set a column to a default value each time a new record is created. Set the
default value to the most common access privilege on your site (for example, Guest); then manually change the
exceptions (for example, changing Guest to Administrator). The user now has access to all administrator pages.
2Make sure each user in the database has a single access privilege, such as Guest or Administrator, not multiple
privileges like User, Administrator. To set multiple access privileges for your pages (for example, all guests and
administrators can see this page), set those privileges at the page level, not the database level.
Log out users
When a user logs in successfully, a session variable is created that consists of the user name. When the user leaves your
site, you can use the Log Out User server behavior to clear the session variable and redirect the user to another page
(usually a goodbye or thank you page).
You can invoke the Log Out User server behavior when the user clicks a link or when a specific page loads.
Add a link to let users log out
1Select text or an image on a page to serve as the link.
2In the Server Behaviors panel (Window > Behaviors), click the Plus (+) button and select User Authentication > Log
Out User.
3Specify a page to open when the user clicks the link, and click OK.
673
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
The page is usually a goodbye or thank you page.
Log out users when a specific page loads
1Open the page that will load in Dreamweaver.
The page is usually a goodbye or thank you page.
2In the Server Behaviors panel, click the Plus (+) button and select User Authentication > Log Out User.
3Select the Log Out When Page Loads option, and click OK.
More Help topics
Securing a folder in your application (ColdFusion)
Securing a folder in your application (ColdFusion)
Note: Support for ColdFusion is removed in Dreamweaver CC and later.
Secure a folder or site on the server (ColdFusion)
You can use Dreamweaver to password-protect a specific folder in your ColdFusion application, including the
applications root folder. When a visitor to your site requests any page in the specified folder, ColdFusion prompts the
visitor for a user name and password. ColdFusion stores the user name and password in session variables so the visitor
doesn’t need to enter them again during the session.
Note: This feature is available only if you have access to a computer running ColdFusion MX 7 or later.
1With a ColdFusion document open in Dreamweaver, select Commands > ColdFusion Login Wizard.
2Complete the ColdFusion Login Wizard.
a.Specify the full path to the folder you want to secure and click Next.
b.In the next screen, select one of the following authentication types:
Simple Authentication Secures your application with a single user name and password for all users.
Windows NT Authentication Secures your application using NT user names and passwords.
LDAP Authentication Secures your application with user names and passwords stored on an LDAP server.
c.Specify whether you want users to log in using a ColdFusion login page or a pop-up menu.
d.In the next screen, specify the following settings:
If you selected simple authentication, specify the user name and password that each visitor must enter.
If you selected Windows NT authentication, specify the NT domain to validate against.
If you selected LDAP authentication, specify the LDAP server to validate against.
3.Upload the new files to your remote site. The files are located in your local site folder.
674
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
More Help topics
Enable the ColdFusion enhancements
Building a page that only authorized users can access
Securing a folder in your application (ColdFusion)
Using ColdFusion components
Note: Support for ColdFusion is removed in Dreamweaver CC and later.
About ColdFusion components
ColdFusion component (CFC) files let you encapsulate application and business logic into self-contained, reusable
units. CFCs also provide a fast, easy way to create web services.
A CFC is a reusable software unit written in ColdFusion markup language (CFML), which makes it easy to reuse and
maintain your code.
You can use Dreamweaver to work with CFCs. For information on CFC tags and syntax, see the ColdFusion
documentation from within Dreamweaver (Help > Using ColdFusion).
Note: You can use CFCs only with ColdFusion MX or later. CFCs are not supported in ColdFusion 5.
CFCs are meant to provide a simple yet powerful way for developers to encapsulate elements of their websites.
Generally, you should use components for application or business logic. Use customs tags for presentation elements
such as customized greetings, dynamic menus, and so on.
As with many other types of construction, dynamic sites can often benefit from interchangeable parts. For example, a
dynamic site may run the same query repeatedly, or calculate the total price of shopping cart pages and recalculate it
every time an item is added. These tasks can be handled by components. You can fix, improve, extend, and even replace
a component with minimal impact to the rest of your application.
Suppose an online store calculates shipping charges based on the price of orders. For orders under $20, the shipping
charge is $4; for orders between $20 and $40, the shipping charge is $6, and so on. You could insert the logic for
calculating the shipping charge in both the shopping cart page and the checkout page, but that would mix HTML
presentation code and CFML logic code and generally make the code difficult to maintain and reuse.
You decide to create a CFC called Pricing that has, among other things, a function called ShippingCharge. The function
takes a price as an argument and returns a shipping charge. For example, if the value of the argument is 32.80, the
function returns 6.
In both the shopping cart page and the checkout page, you insert a special tag to invoke the ShippingCharge function.
When the page is requested, the function is invoked and a shipping charge is returned to the page.
Later, the store announces a special promotion: free shipping for all orders above $100. You make the change to the
shipping rates in one place—the ShippingCharge function of the Pricing component—and all the pages using the
function automatically get accurate shipping charges.
Components panel overview (ColdFusion)
Use the Components panel (Window > Components) to view and edit ColdFusion components, and add code in the
page that invokes the function when the CFM page is requested.
675
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: The Components panel is available only when viewing a ColdFusion page in Dreamweaver.
Create or delete a CFC in Dreamweaver
You can use Dreamweaver to visually define a CFC and its functions. Dreamweaver creates a .cfc file and inserts the
necessary CFML tags for you.
Note: Depending on the component, you may have to complete some code by hand.
1Open a ColdFusion page in Dreamweaver.
2In the Components panel (Window > Components), select CF Components from the pop-up menu.
3Click the Plus (+) button, and complete the Create Components dialog box, and click OK.
a.In the Components section, enter the details about the component. Here is a partial list:
Name Specifies the filename of the component. The name must contain only alphanumeric characters and
underscores (_). Don’t specify the .cfc file extension when entering the name.
Component Directory Specifies where the component is saved. Select the web applications root folder (such as
\Inetpub\wwwroot\myapp\) or any of its subfolders.
b.To define one or more functions for the component, select Functions from the Section list, click the Plus (+)
button, and enter the details of the new function.
Ensure that you specify the type of the value returned by the function in the Return Type option.
If you select remote from the Access menu, the function becomes available as a web service.
c.To define one or more arguments for a function, select Arguments from the Section list, select the function from
the pop-up menu, click the Plus (+) button, and enter the details of the new argument on the right.
4If you use a remote development server, upload the CFC file and any dependent files (such as those used to
implement a function or include files) to the remote server.
Uploading the files ensures that Dreamweaver features such as Live view and Preview In Browser work properly.
Dreamweaver writes a CFC file and saves it in the folder you specified. The new component also appears in the
Components panel (after clicking Refresh).
5If you use a remote development server, upload the CFC file and any dependent files (such as those used to
implement a function or include files) to the remote server.
View CFCs in Dreamweaver
Dreamweaver provides a way to visually examine the ColdFusion components (CFCs) located in your site folder or on
the server as a whole. Dreamweaver reads the CFC files and displays information about them in an easy-to-navigate
tree view in the Components panel.
Dreamweaver looks for the components on your testing server (see Connecting to the database in Dreamweaver ). If
you create CFCs or make changes to existing CFCs, make sure to upload the CFC files to the testing server so they are
accurately reflected in the Components panel.
To view components located on another server, change the testing server settings.
You can view any of the following information about your CF components:
List all of the ColdFusion components defined on the server.
676
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
If youre running ColdFusion MX 7 or later, filter the list to show only the CFCs located in your site folder.
Explore the functions and arguments of each component.
Inspect the properties of functions that serve as web services.
To use Dreamweaver to inspect CFCs residing in the server root while also managing your site files in a different website
root, you can define two Dreamweaver sites. Set the first site to point to the server root and the second to point to the
website root. Use the site pop-up menu on the Files panel to switch quickly between the two sites.
To view CFCs in Dreamweaver, follow these steps:
1Open any ColdFusion page in Dreamweaver.
2In the Components panel (Window > Components), select CF Components from the pop-up menu.
3Click the Refresh button in the panel to retrieve the components.
The components package is displayed on the server. A component package is a folder that contains CFC files.
If existing component packages do not appear, click the Refresh button in the panel toolbar.
4To display only the CFCs located in your site folder, click the Show Only Current Sites CFCs button in the
Components panel toolbar.
Note: This feature is available only if youve defined a computer running ColdFusion MX 6 or later as a testing server
for Dreamweaver.
Note: If the current site is listed in a virtual folder on the remote server, the filtering does not work.
5Click the Plus (+) button beside the package name to view the components stored in the package.
To list the functions of a component, click the Plus (+) button beside the component name.
To see the arguments a function takes, as well as the arguments’ type and whether they are required or optional,
open the functions branch in the tree view.
Functions that take no arguments have no Plus (+) button beside them.
To quickly view the details of an argument, a function, a component, or a package, select the item in the tree view,
and click the Get Details button in the panel toolbar.
You can also right-click (Windows) or Control-click (Macintosh) the item and select Get Details from the pop-up
menu.
Details about the item are displayed in a message box.
Edit CFCs in Dreamweaver
Dreamweaver provides a streamlined way of editing the code of the ColdFusion components defined for your site. For
example, you can add, change, or delete any component function without leaving Dreamweaver.
To use this feature, your development environment must be set up as follows:
ColdFusion must be running locally.
In the advanced Site Definition dialog box in Dreamweaver, the Access type specified in the Testing Server category
must be Local/Network.
In the advanced Site Definition dialog box, the path of your local root folder must be the same as the path of the
testing server folder (for example, c:\Inetpub\wwwroot\cf_projects\myNewApp\). You can examine and change
these paths by selecting Site > Edit Sites.
The component must be stored in the local site folder or any of its subfolders on your hard disk.
677
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
Open any ColdFusion page in Dreamweaver and display the components in the Components panel. To display the
components, open the Components panel (Window > Components), select CF Components from the panel’s pop-up
menu, and click the Refresh button on the panel.
Because ColdFusion is running locally, Dreamweaver displays component packages on your hard disk.
Use the following procedure to edit a component.
1Open any ColdFusion page in Dreamweaver and display the components in the Components panel (Window >
Components).
2Select CF Components from the panel’s pop-up menu, and click the Refresh button on the panel.
Because ColdFusion is running locally, Dreamweaver displays component packages on your hard disk.
Note: To edit the CFC recordset visually, double-click it in the Bindings panel.
3To edit a component file generally, open the package and double-click the component name in the tree view.
The components file opens in Code view.
4To edit a specific function, argument, or property, double-click the item in the tree view.
5Make your changes by hand in Code view.
6Save the file (File > Save).
7To see any new function in the Components panel, refresh the view by clicking the Refresh button on the panel
toolbar.
Build web pages that use CFCs
One way to use a component function in your web pages is to write code in the page that invokes the function when
the page is requested. You can use Dreamweaver to help you write this code.
Note: For other ways to use components, see the ColdFusion documentation from within Dreamweaver (Help > Using
ColdFusion).
1In Dreamweaver, open the ColdFusion page that will use the component function.
2Switch to Code view (View > Code).
3Open the Components panel (Window > Components), and select CF Components from the panel’s pop-up menu.
4Find the component you want and insert it using one of the following techniques:
Drag a function from the tree view to the page. Code is inserted in the page to invoke the function.
Select the function in the panel and click the Insert button on the panel toolbar (the second button on the right).
Dreamweaver inserts the code in the page at the insertion point.
5If you insert a function that has arguments, complete the argument code by hand.
For more information, see the ColdFusion documentation from within Dreamweaver (Help > Using ColdFusion).
6Save the page (File > Save).
Define a recordset in a CFC
Dreamweaver can help you define a recordset (also known as a ColdFusion query) in a ColdFusion component (CFC).
By defining a recordset in a CFC, you dont need to define the recordset on each page that uses it. You define the
recordset once in the CFC and use the CFC on different pages.
678
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
Note: This feature is available only if you have access to a computer running ColdFusion MX 7 or later. For more
information, see Enable the ColdFusion enhancements .
1Create or open an existing CFC file in Dreamweaver.
2In the Bindings panel (Window > Bindings), click the Plus (+) button and select Recordset (Query) from the pop-up
menu.
The Recordset dialog box appears. You can work in either the simple or the advanced Recordset dialog boxes.
3To use an existing function in the CFC, select the function from the Function pop-up menu and skip to step 5.
The recordset is defined in the function.
4To define a new function in the CFC, click the New Function button, enter a name for the function in the dialog box
that appears, and then click OK.
The name must contain only alphanumeric characters and underscores (_).
5To define a recordset for the function, complete the Recordset dialog box options.
The new function is inserted into the CFC that defines the recordset.
Use a CFC recordset as a source of dynamic content
You can use a ColdFusion component (CFC) as a source of dynamic content for your pages if the component contains
a function defining a recordset.
Note: This feature is available only if you have access to a computer running ColdFusion MX 7 or later. For more
information, see Enable the ColdFusion enhancements.
1Open a ColdFusion page in Dreamweaver.
2In the Bindings panel (Window > Bindings), click the Plus (+) button and select Recordset (Query) from the pop-up
menu.
The Recordset dialog box appears. You can work in either the simple or the advanced Recordset dialog box.
3Click the CFC Query button.
4Complete the CFC query dialog box, click OK, and then click OK again to add the CFC recordset to the list of
available content sources in the Bindings panel.
5Use the Bindings panel to bind the recordset to various page elements.
For more information, see Adding dynamic content to pages .
Define dynamic content by using a CFC
You can define a recordset as a source of dynamic content in Dreamweaver by using a CFC that contains a recordset
definition.
1.In the Name box, enter a name for the CFC recordset.
A common practice is to add the prefix rs to recordset names to distinguish them from other object names in the code,
for example: rsPressRelease.
Recordset names must contain only alphanumeric characters and underscores (_). You cannot use special characters
or spaces.
2.Select a package from the ones already defined on the server.
679
Building applications visually
Last updated 6/3/2015
If the package does not appear in the pop-up menu, you can refresh the list of packages by clicking the Refresh button
near the pop-up menu.
Make sure you upload your CFCs to the testing server first. Only CFCs on the testing server are displayed.
3.Select a component from the ones defined in the currently selected package.
If the Component pop-up menu does not contain any components, or if none of your previously created components
appear in the menu, you should upload the CFC files to the testing server.
4.(Optional) To create a component, click the Create New Component button.
a.In the Name box, enter the name for the new CFC. The name must contain only alphanumeric characters and
underscores (_).
b.In the Component Directory box, enter the location for your CFC, or browse to locate the folder.
Note: The folder must be the relative path to the site root folder.
5.From the Function pop-up menu, select the function that contains the recordset definition.
The Function pop-up menu contains only the functions defined in the currently selected component. If no function
appears in this pop-up menu, or if your last changes are not reflected in the currently listed functions, check that your
last changes were saved and uploaded to server.
Note: The Connection and SQL boxes are read-only.
6.Edit each parameter (type, value, and default value) that must be passed as a function argument by clicking the Edit
button.
a.Enter a value for the current parameter by selecting the value type from the Value pop-up menu and entering the value
in the box to the right. The value type can be a URL parameter, a form variable, a cookie, a session variable, an
application variable, or an entered value.
b.Enter a default value for the parameter in the Default Value box. If no run-time value is returned, the default
parameter value is used.
c.Click OK.
You cannot modify the database connection and the SQL query for the recordset. These fields are always disabled—the
connection and SQL query are displayed for your information.
7.Click Test to connect to the database and create an instance of the recordset.
If the SQL statement contains page parameters, ensure that the Default Value column of the Parameters box contains
valid test values before clicking Test.
If the query was executed successfully, a table displays the recordset. Each row contains a record and each column
represents a field in that record.
Click OK to clear the CFC Query.
8.Click Ok.
680
Last updated 6/3/2015
Chapter 18: Accessibility
Dreamweaver and accessibility
Note: The user interface has been simplified in Dreamweaver CC and later. As a result, you may not find some of the
options described in this article in Dreamweaver CC and later. For more information, see this article.
About accessible content
Accessibility refers to making websites and web products usable for people with visual, auditory, motor, and other
disabilities. Examples of accessibility features for software products and websites include screen reader support, text
equivalents for graphics, keyboard shortcuts, change of display colors to high contrast, and so on. Dreamweaver
provides tools that make it accessible to use and tools that help you author accessible content.
For Dreamweaver developers who need to use accessibility features, the application offers screen reader support,
keyboard navigation, and operating system accessibility support.
For web designers who need to create accessible content, Dreamweaver assists you in creating accessible pages that
contain useful content for screen readers and comply with federal government guidelines. For example, dialog boxes
prompt you to enter accessibility attributes—such as text equivalents for an image—when you insert page elements.
Then, when the image appears on a page for a user with visual disabilities, the screen reader reads the description.
Note: For more information about two significant accessibility initiatives, see the World Wide Web Consortium Web
Accessibility Initiative (www.w3.org/wai) and Section 508 of the U.S. Federal Rehabilitation Act (www.section508.gov).
Note: For more information about Japan Industry Standard accessibility guidelines, see JIS X 8341-3 (www.jisc.go.jp).
No authoring tool can automate the development process. Designing accessible websites requires you to understand
accessibility requirements and make ongoing decisions about how users with disabilities interact with web pages. The
best way to ensure that a website is accessible is through deliberate planning, development, testing, and evaluation.
Using screen readers with Dreamweaver
A screen reader recites text that appears on the computer screen. It also reads non-textual information, such as button
labels or image descriptions in the application, provided in accessibility tags or attributes during authoring.
As a Dreamweaver designer, you can use a screen reader to assist you in creating your web pages. The screen reader
starts reading from the upper-left corner of the Document window.
Dreamweaver supports JAWS for Windows, from Freedom Scientific (www.freedomscientific.com), and Window-Eyes
screen readers, from GW Micro (www.gwmicro.com).
Support for operating system accessibility features
Dreamweaver supports accessibility features in both the Windows and Macintosh operating systems. For example, on
the Macintosh you set the visual preferences in the Universal Access Preferences dialog box (Apple > System
Preferences). Your settings are reflected in the Dreamweaver work space.
681
Accessibility
Last updated 6/3/2015
The Windows operating systems high contrast setting is also supported. You activate this option through the Windows
Control Panel and it affects Dreamweaver as follows:
Dialog boxes and panels use system color settings. For example, if you set the color to White on Black, all
Dreamweaver dialog boxes and panels appear with a white foreground color and black background.
Code view uses the system and window text color. For example, if you set the system color to White on Black, and
then change text colors in Edit > Preferences > Code Coloring, Dreamweaver ignores those color settings and
displays the code text with a white foreground color and black background.
Design view uses the background and text colors you set in Modify > Page Properties so that pages you design
render colors as a browser will.
Optimize the work space for accessible page design
When you create accessible pages, you need to associate information, such as labels and descriptions, with your page
objects to make your content accessible to all users.
To do this, activate the Accessibility dialog box for each object, so that Dreamweaver prompts you for accessibility
information when you insert objects. You can activate a dialog box for any of the objects in the Accessibility category
in Preferences.
1Select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Macintosh).
2Select Accessibility from the Category list on the left, select an object, set any of the following options, and click OK.
Show Attributes When Inserting Select the objects for which you want to activate accessibility dialog boxes. For
example, form objects, frames, media, and images.
Keep Focus In The Panel Maintains focus on the panel, which makes it accessible to the screen reader. (If you don’t
select this option, the focus remains in Design or Code view when a user opens a panel.)
Offscreen Rendering Select this option when using a screen reader.
Note: Accessibility attributes appear in the Insert Table dialog box when you insert a new table.
Dreamweaver accessibility validation report feature
The Dreamweaver accessibility validation report feature has been deprecated as of Dreamweaver CS5.
Navigate Dreamweaver using the keyboard
You can use the keyboard to navigate panels, inspectors, dialog boxes, frames, and tables without a mouse.
Note: Tabbing and the use of arrow keys are supported for Windows only.
Navigate panels
1In the Document window, press Control+F6 to shift focus to a panel.
A dotted line around the panel title indicates that focus is on that panel. The screen reader reads the panel title bar
that has focus.
2Press Control+F6 again to shift focus until you have focus on the panel you want to work in. (Press
Control+Shift+F6 to shift focus to the previous panel.)
3If the panel you want to work in is not open, use the keyboard shortcuts in the Windows menu to display the
appropriate panel; then press Control+F6.
682
Accessibility
Last updated 6/3/2015
If the panel you want to work in is open, but not expanded, place focus on the panel title bar, and then press the
Spacebar. Press the Spacebar again to collapse the panel.
4Press the Tab key to move through the options in the panel.
5Use the arrow keys as appropriate:
If an option has choices, use the arrow keys to scroll through the choices, and then press the Spacebar to make a
selection.
If there are tabs in the panel group to open other panels, place focus on the open tab, and then use the left or right
arrow key to open another tabs. Once you open a new tab, press the Tab key to move through the options in that
panel.
Navigate the Property inspector
1Press Control+F3 to display the Property inspector, if it is not visible.
2Press Control+F6 (Windows only) until you shift focus to the Property inspector.
3Press the Tab key to move through the Property inspector options.
4Use the arrow keys as appropriate to move through option choices.
5Press Control+Down arrow/Up arrow (Windows) or Command Down arrow/Up arrow (Macintosh) to open and
close the expanded section of the Property inspector, as necessary, or, with focus on the expander arrow in the lower-
right corner, press the Spacebar.
Note: Keyboard focus must be inside the Property inspector (and not on the panel title) for expanding and collapsing to
work.
Navigate a dialog box
1Press the Tab key to move through the options in a dialog box.
2Use the arrow keys to move through choices for an option.
3If the dialog box has a Category list, press Control+Tab (Windows) to shift focus to the category list, and then use
the arrow keys to move up or down the list.
4Press Control+Tab again to shift to the options for a category.
5Press Enter to exit the dialog box.
Navigate frames
If your document contains frames, you can use the arrow keys to shift focus to a frame.
Select a frame
1Press Alt+Down Arrow to place the insertion point in the Document window.
2Press Alt+Up Arrow to select the frame that currently has focus.
3Continue pressing Alt+Up Arrow to shift focus to the frameset, and then to the parent framesets, if there are nested
framesets.
4Press Alt+Down Arrow to shift focus to a child frameset or a single frame within the frameset.
5With focus on a single frame, press Alt+Left or Right Arrow to move between frames.
Navigate a table
1Use the arrow keys or press Tab to move to other cells in a table as necessary.
683
Accessibility
Last updated 6/3/2015
Pressing Tab in a right-most cell adds another row to the table.
2To select a cell, press Control+A (Windows only) while the insertion point is in the cell.
3To select the entire table, press Control+A twice if the insertion point is in a cell, or once if a cell is selected.
4To exit the table, press Control+A three times if the insertion point is in a cell, twice if the cell is selected, or once if
the table is selected, and then press the Up, Left, or Right Arrow key.
684
Last updated 6/3/2015
Chapter 19: Dreamweaver and Creative
Cloud
Synchronizing Dreamweaver settings with Creative
Cloud
Adobe Creative Cloud subscription account lets you activate Dreamweaver on two machines. A subscription account
is basically the Adobe ID account using which you purchased the subscription. Synchronization with the cloud is
tightly tied with your subscription account.
The cloud sync feature helps you keep the following Dreamweaver settings synchronized between the two machines:
Application Preferences:
General: All preferences except Enable Related Files, andDiscover Dynamically-Related Files.
Code Coloring: All preferences.
Code Format: All preferences except tag libraries.
Code Hints: All preferences except changes done using the link Tag Library Editor.
Code Rewriting: All preferences.
Copy/Paste: All preferences.
CSS Styles: All preferences.
File Compare: This setting is synchronized only between computers running on the same operating system.
File Types/Editors: Only Reload Modified Files and Save On Launch.
Highlighting: All preferences.
New Document: All preferences except Default Document Type (DTD) and Default Encoding.
Preview In Browser: Only Preview Using Temporary File is synchronized.
Site: All preferences except Always Show <options> On the <Right/Left>.
W3C validator: All preferences except changes made using ‘Manage.
Window Sizes: All preferences.
On Mac, Application bar and Application frame settings.
Note: Except File Compare, all the other Preferences listed above are synchronized between computers irrespective of
the operating system they are running on. For example, Mac to Windows.
Site settings: All site settings (except username and password) are synchronized between computers running on the
same operating system. username and password cannot be synchronized.
The path and name of the local site folder is synchronized if a folder with the same name exists in the same path.
685
Dreamweaver and Creative Cloud
Last updated 6/3/2015
If a site does not exist on a machine, Dreamweaver creates a new site folder in the default location and all the paths are
relative to this folder. You can change this path at any point in time. For all subsequent synchronizations, only the
changes in the site folder are synchronized.
Keyboard shortcuts: The keyboard shortcuts are synchronized only between computers running on the same
operating system.
Workspaces: Workspaces are saved when you quit Dreamweaver and are then synchronized with the cloud. If you
want to synchronize Workspace changes without exiting Dreamweaver (in the current session), click Save Current
in the Workspace menu and then manually synchronize the settings (Preferences > Sync Settings).
Workspaces are synchronized only between computers running on the same operating system.
Note: You can choose not to synchronize a specific setting, for example, Preferences. Deselect the required check box in the
Preferences (Sync Settings) dialog box.
Synchronization with Creative Cloud is not supported in the following scenarios:
You have a volume license and are signed in as an anonymous user.
Your machine is configured to connect to the Internet through a proxy server.
You switch from an Administrator accout to a standard user account.
First-time synchronization
When you launch Dreamweaver on the machine you installed it first, the following dialog box appears:
Sync Settings Now Synchronizes the settings with the cloud immediately.
Always Sync Settings Automatically Synchronizes the settings automatically. For more information, see Automatic
Synchronization .
Disable Sync Settings Disables synchronization.
Note: You can enable synchronization at any point in time using the Preferences dialog box.
Advanced Opens the Sync Settings options in the Preferences dialog box.
686
Dreamweaver and Creative Cloud
Last updated 6/3/2015
On your second machine, the following dialog box appears when you launch Dreamweaver:
Sync Cloud Brings in the settings on the cloud. Application preferences in the second machine are overridden with the
settings on the cloud. Site settings in the cloud are added to the ones on the second machine.
Sync Local Changes made to preferences and site settings on the second machine are retained and are pushed to the
cloud as well.
Always Sync Settings Automatically Synchronizes the settings automatically. For more information, see Automatic
Synchronization .
Advanced Opens the Sync Settings options in the Preferences dialog box.
The following scenarios help you understand the difference between Sync Cloud and Sync Local options:
687
Dreamweaver and Creative Cloud
Last updated 6/3/2015
Scenario 1
You change the Preferences on the first machine and sync those changes with the cloud. On the second machine too,
you change the Preferences. Then, when you click:
Sync Cloud Changes to Preferences on the first machine are synchronized with the second machine. The changes you
made on the second machine are lost.
Sync Local Changes to Preferences on the second machine are retained and are also synchronized with the cloud. The
next time you synchronize the first machine and choose Sync Cloud, these changes are reflected on the first machine.
Scenario 2
Sync Cloud Changes to site settings on the first machine are ‘added’ to the settings on the second machine.
Sync Local Changes on the second machine are retained and are synchronized with the cloud. The next time you
synchronize the first machine and choose Sync Cloud, the new site gets added to the settings on the first machine.
Note: Any settings in Preferences that you change while the synchronization is in progress do not take effect.
Import settings from previous versions of Dreamweaver
If you had synchronized Dreamweaver settings with Creative Cloud even once in the previous version of Dreamweaver,
the new version of Dreamweaver displays the following dialog box upon first launch:
To import settings that are stored on Creative Cloud, click Import Sync Settings.
Note: This option is not made available to you at a later point in time.
To synchronize the settings in the current Dreamweaver instance with Creative Cloud, click Sync Local.
To synchronize settings automatically hereafter, select Always Sync Settings Automatically.
To view advanced sync settings options, click Advanced.
If you had not synchronized the settings with Creative Cloud using the previous version of Dreamweaver, the options
described in First-time synchronization are displayed.
If you want to import settings at a later point in time, you can do so using the Preferences dialog box.
1Select Edit > Preferences to open the Preferences dialog box.
2Click Sync Settings in the Category list.
688
Dreamweaver and Creative Cloud
Last updated 6/3/2015
3Select Import Sync Settings, and click Close.
4Quit Dreamweaver and launch it again to apply the imported settings.
Important: The options that you choose in the Settings To Sync section are not applicable for importing settings saved
on the cloud. All settings saved on the cloud are imported and the local settings are overridden when you choose the
Import Sync Settings option.
Edit preferences for sync settings
Using the Preferences dialog box, you can choose the settings that you want to synchronize, specify conflict resolution
settings, enable automatic synchronization, or trigger an on-demand synchronization.
1Select Edit > Preferences (Windows) or Dreamweaver > Preferences (Mac).
689
Dreamweaver and Creative Cloud
Last updated 6/3/2015
2Click Sync Settings in the Category list.
3In the Settings To Sync section, click the setting you want to synchronize.
4In the Conflict Resolution list, click an option to resolve conflicts during synchronization. For more information,
see Resolve conflicts during synchronization .
5To enable automatic synchronization every 30 minutes, click Enable Automatic Sync.
6To synchronize the settings at any given point in time (on-demand synchronization), click Synchronize Settings
Now.
(13.1) If there are updates on the cloud that are downloaded onto your computer, the Sync Settings Now button
changes to Apply Updates. You can choose to apply the updates immediately or close the Preferences dialog box to
apply the updates at a later point in time. If you make any changes to the Dreamweaver instance on the computer
before applying the updates, a conflict can arise, which is resolved based on the Conflict Resolution Settings.
690
Dreamweaver and Creative Cloud
Last updated 6/3/2015
7Click Apply to save the changes you made to the sync settings preferences.
8Click Close to exit the Preferences dialog box.
Automatic Synchronization
You can enable automatic synchronization in one of the following ways:
Select Always Sync Settings Automatically in the Sync Settings dialog box.
Note: The Sync Settings dialog boxes appear only when you access Dreamweaver for the first time after installing it on
your machines. For subsequent synchronizations, use the Preferences dialog box or the toast notification ( ).
Select Edit > Preferences (Win) and Dreamweaver > Preferences (Mac), and then select Sync Settings > Enable
Automatic Sync.
When you enable automatic synchronization, Dreamweaver checks for changes on the cloud every 30 minutes and
synchronizes the settings automatically if there is a change.
Manual synchronization
Click Sync Settings Now in the Sync settings dialog box.
Click Edit > (your Adobe ID) > Sync Settings Now.
Click Sync Settings Now in the toast notification. To open the notification dialog box, click in the document
toolbar.
691
Dreamweaver and Creative Cloud
Last updated 6/3/2015
(13.1) If there are updates available on the cloud, they are downloaded onto the computer. The Sync Settings Now
button in the toast notification changes to Apply Now. You can choose to apply the updates immediately or at a later
point in time. If you make any changes to Dreamweaver settings before applying the downloaded updates, a conflict
can arise, which is resolved based on conflict resolution settings .
(On Mac) Dreamweaver > Sync Settings Now and on Windows, Edit > Sync Settings Now.
Resolve conflicts during synchronization
When there is a difference between the settings on the machines and the cloud, the conflict is resolved based on the
Conflict Resolution settings in the Preferences dialog box.
If the Conflict Resolution is set to My Preference, the following dialog box appears when a conflict arises:
If you select the Remember My Preference option, the option you choose (Sync Local or Sync Cloud) gets selected in
the Preferences dialog box.
IMPORTANT: If you press Esc to close the Conflicting Settings dialog box, the Sync Local action is executed.
Access resources on Creative Cloud directly
You can open, select, or save files on Creative Cloud directly from the Dreamweaver user interface. Install the ‘Creative
Cloud Connection Preview’ utility from http://creative.adobe.com.
When you install this utility, the Creative Cloud Files option (highlighted in the screenshot) becomes available in the
Open, Save, and Select dialog boxes of Dreamweaver.
692
Dreamweaver and Creative Cloud
Last updated 6/3/2015
693
Last updated 6/3/2015
Chapter 20: System Requirements
System requirements for Dreamweaver
System requirements for Dreamweaver

Navigation menu